CORNELL imiVERSITY LIBRARY ■*■/' GOLDWIN SMITH HALL ■FROM THE jFUND GIVEN BY GOLDWIN SMITH 1909 ' ' liOVs Date Due DEC 13 1354 wn 1984 f 1 lyss iJmJil -MAf^S64=^J 19P I MOIM-XIQCA -wevT: 8^35^" um-^^ms ^^^^w^^, ms WtM Cornell University Llbrmy DF 77.B74 1915 Hellenic civilization / 3 1924 006 655 496 Cornell University Library The original of tiiis book is in tine Cornell University Library. There are no known copyright restrictions in the United States on the use of the text. http://www.archive.org/details/cu31924006655496 Records of Civilization SOURCES AND STUDIES EDITED BY JAMES T. SHOTWELL, Ph.D. PROFESSOR OF HISTORY IN COLUMBIA UNIVERSITY IN COLLABORATION WITH FRANKLIN H. GIDDINGS, PH.D., LL.D, PROFESSOR OF SOCIOLOGY AND THE HISTORY OF CIVILIZATION IN COLUMBIA UNIVERSITY MUNROE SMITH, J.U.D.. LL.D. PROFESSOR OP ROMAN LAW AND COMPARATIVE JURISPRUDENCE )N COLUMBIA UNIVERSITY WILLIAM R. SHEPHERD, PH.D. PROFESSOR OF HISTORY IN COLUMBIA UNIVERSITY GEORGE W. BOTSFORD, Ph.D. PROFESSOR OF HISTORY IN COLUMBIA UNIVERSITY JULIUS A. BEWER. PH.D. PROFESSOR OF OLD TESTAMENT EXEGESIS IN UNION THEOLOGICAL SEMINARY CARLTON H. HAYES. PH.D. ASSOCIATE PROFESSOR OF HISTORY IN COLUMBIA UNIVERSITY ELLERY C. STOWELL, Ph.D. ASSISTANT PROFESSOR OF INTERNATIONAL • LAW IN COLUMBIA UNIVERSITY HAROLD H. TRYON. M.A.. B.D. INSTRUCTOR IN NEW TESTAMENT AND CHURCH HISTORY IN UNION THB01J>GICAL SEMINARY "Mtia gorft COLUMBIA UNIVERSITY PRESS 1915 /III rights restrved RECORDS OF CIVILIZATION SOURCES AND STUDIES EDITED BY JAMES T. SHOTWELL A COMPREHENSIVE SERIES CONSISTING OF DOCUMENTS IN TRANSLATION COMMENTARIES AND INTERPRETATIONS BIBLIOGRAPHICAL GUIDES For titles of volumes, see list at end of this volume. IRecorbs of CtviUsation: Sources anb Stubies HELLENIC CIVILIZATION EDITED BY G. W. BOTSFORD PROFESSOR OF HISTORY IN COLUMBIA UNIVERSITY AND E. G. SIHLER PROFESSOR OF THE LATIN LANGUAGE AND LITERATURE IN NEW YORK UNIVERSITY WITH CONTRIBUTIONS FROM Professor Wiluam L. Wkstermann (University of Wisconsin) Charles J. Ogden, Ph.D., and others Wefa gorfe COLUMBIA UNIVERSITY PRESS 191S All rights reserved , (x » S > rt > 11 ■ nor GrS. 2-303 Copyright, 1915, By COLUMBIA UNIVERSITY PRESS. Set up and electrotyped. Published Aug^ust, 19x5. J. S. Gushing: Go. — Berwick & Smith Go. Norwood^ Mass., U.S.A. PREFACE The aim of the series of which this volume forms a part is two- fold. In the first place, its intention is to make accessible those sources of the history of Europe and of the near East which are of prime importance for the understanding of Western civilization. In the second place, both by the treatment of these texts and by special studies it covers the work of modern scholars in these fields. It is, therefore, a guide both to the original documents and to recent criticism. The material, furthermore, is given in English translation, in order that it may be readily accessible to students and readers who do not have that knowledge of classical and other foreign languages which is essential for specialized research. The present volume departs slightly from the general plan of the series owing to the peculiar editorial problems which it in- volves. While, in most other cases, documents are given in extenso, this is necessarily an anthology. The very wealth of the literary and monumental remains of Greek civilization renders any other treatment impossible. Even more important, however, is the fact that so much of the available material is of interest to the historian for other reasons than those which determined its original form. Casual references in literature, whether prose or poetry, frequently possess a distinctive value sufficient to make them by themselves, apart from their context, documents for the study of Hellenic civilization.' Beside these must often be placed texts from obscure sources or fragments revealed by recent archae- ological research. In short, in this volume the intricacies of a very complex subject demanded an adjustment of text to topic in order to illustrate the general lines of Greek history. vi PREFACE In view of these difficulties, the volume as a whole was originally placed under the editorial control of Professor Botsford. As he found, however, that the labor of selecting and preparing excerpts illustrative of Hellenic civilization from the vast field of ancient Greek literature, inscriptions, and papyri exceeded the limits of time at his disposal, he was fortunate in securing the cooperation of his friend Professor Sihler in the editorial work, and contribu- tions from other scholars. The parts severally taken by these associates are explained below, and the editors wish here to thank them for their aid and their interest in the work. The selections have been made, not for specialists, but for those who are interested in general Hellenic culture. Nothing could be easier than to suggest the lengthening or shortening of passages and the addition or substitution of other selections. No two schol- ars could agree as to what is absolutely best for a volume of the kind ; and those who have cooperated in its preparation can only hope that it may in some degree contribute to an understanding of the spirit of ancient Hellas and add to the interest in her culture. For the selections from printed translations permission has been obtained from the translators or the publishers. Individual acknowledgments are made elsewhere. This permission has ren- dered it possible to give the volume a literary quality to which it could not otherwise have attained. The grouping of selections in chapters on sQciety,_ religion, political conditions, etc., is nec- essarily more or less arbitrary, as the same passage often throws light on several of these aspects of life ; yet this arrangement will probably be found as convenient as any that could be devised. The notes are for the general reader, and represent the minimum of information required for an understanding of the passages. Those who desire special knowledge are referred to the bibliog- raphies, the compilation of which has extended through years. Throughout the book will be found occasional references to the closely interrelated " Hellenic History," by Professor Botsford, which will probably be ready for the printer within ten or twelve months after the appearance of the present work. It is hoped that this volume may appeal to a wide range of users, that the student may find it an illuminating companion to his textbook or his course of lectures, and that men and women who are interested in the cultural history of mankind, even though PREFACE vii classically educated, may obtain through it fresh and inspiring glimpses of the wonderfully endowed people from whom these messages have come. JAMES T. SHOTWELL. New York, June I, 1915. DIVISION OF LABOR Professor Westermann has contributed Chapter XVI entire. Mr. Wallace E. Caldwell (fellow in history, Columbia University), Dr. Ogden, and Professor William C. Lawton (Hobart College) have translated the selections credited to them and have furnished the greater part of the material for the introductions and annota- tions of these excerpts. Professor Munroe Smith has aided in the interpretation of the Gortynian law. All have read the proofs of their respective contributions. Professor Sihler has made the translations credited to him, has revised, by a comparison with the original texts, the greater number of excerpts from published trans- lations, and has furnished some of the niaterial for the introductory chapter. He has also read the proofs of the whole work, with the aid of Mr. F. M. Barranco, and has prepared the index. Professor Shotwell has made suggestions at various points in the preparation of the volume and has read the proofs. Professor Botsford has chosen and arranged the selections, excepting those of Chapter XVI, has translated the passages credited to him, has prepared the introductory chapter and most of the special introductions and notes. He has compiled the bibliographies, read the proofs, and edited the selections contributed by others. The bibliographical work has been facilitated by the courteous aid of Miss Isadore G. Mudge of the Columbia University Library. CONTENTS CHAPTER I. II. III. IV. V. \VI. VII. VIII. IX. X. XI. XII. XIII. XIV. XV. XVI. XVII. XVIII. XIX. INDEX The Sources of Hellenic History The Minoan and Homeric Civilizations Colonization (750-479 b.c.) Government and Political Conditions (750-479 b.c.) Economy and Society (750-479 b.c.) General Political Conditions (479-404 b.c.) The Confederacy of Delos and the Athenian Empire (478-404 B.C.) .... Private and Criminal Law (479-404 b.c.) Medical Science (Fifth Century b.c.) Aspects of Hellenic Society (479-404 b.c.) Religion (479-404 b.c.) .... Hellenic Interstate Relations (404-337 b.c The State (404-337 b.c.) .... Social Conditions (404-337 b.c.) Personal Character, Literary Criticism, and Art (404-337 B.C.) Administration, Industry, and Education in the Hel- lenistic Kingdoms (337-30 b.c.) Politics of the Greek Homeland; The Unions (323-146 b.c.) Science and Inventions (330-100 b.c.) . Social Conditions (after 337 b.c.) •) Federal PAGES 1-62 I 63-117* 118-130 «3>-«74 175-209 210-254 « 255-274 275-292 293-302 303-348 • 349-37 J 372-422 423-470 j 471-526 ^ 527-567 568-609 ; 610-626 627-656 657-708 ■ 709-719 ABBREVIATIONS MOST COMMONLY USED Abbott = Abbott, E., History of Greece, 3 vols. (New York : Putnam, 1892-1900). Acad, des Inscr. = Memoires de I'acad^mie des inscriptions et belles-lettres. Acad. roy. de Belg. Bull. = Academie royale de Belgique : Bulletins de la classe des lettres et des sciences morales et politiques, etc. Am. Journ. Arch. = American Journal of Archaeology. Am. Journ. Philol. = American Journal of Philology. Archiv. soc. Bull. = Archives sociologiques, Bulletin (Brussels). Ath. Mitt. = Mitteilungen des kaiserlich deutschen archaologischen Instituts : Athenische Abteilung. B.S.A. = Annual of the British School at Athens. Beloch, Griech. Gesch. = Beloch, J., Griechische Geschichte (I and II. 1, second ed. ; the remainder, first ed.). Berl. Philol. Woch. = Berliner philologische Wochenschrift Bury =Bury, J. B., History of Greece (revised ed., Macmillan, 1913). Busolt, Griech. Gesch. = Busolt, G., Griechische Geschichte, 3 vols, (second ed., Gotha, 1893-1904). Christ, Griech. Lit. = Christ, W. von, Geschichte der griechischen litteiatur, 2 vols. revised by Schmid, W. (fifth ed., Munich, 1908-1913). CIA. = Corpus inscriptionum atticarum ; v. Inscr. grsc. C.J.O. = Charles J. Ogden. Class. Journ. = Classical Journal. Class. Philol. = Classical Philology. Class. Quart. = Classical Quarterly. Class. Rev. = Classical Review. CI. Weekly = Classical Weekly. CoUitz, SGDI. = Sammlung der griechischen Dialektinschriften, 4 vols. (1884-1911). Curtius = Curtius, E., History of Greece, 5 vols. (New York : Scribner, 1886). Daremberg-Saglio, Diet. = Dictionnaire des antiquites grecques et romaines (begin- ning 1873). Diss., Dissert. = Dissertation. Ditt. Or. graec. inscrs. = Dittenberger, W., Orientis graeci inscriptiones selectae (Leipzig, 1903). Ditt., Ditt. Syll. = Sylloge inscriptionum grsecarum, 3 vols, (second ed., Leipzig, 1898-1901). E.G.S. = Ernest G. Sihler. Encycl. Brit. = Encyclopsedia Britannica (eleventh ed.). Eng. Hist. Rev. = English Historical Review. Ergzb. = Erganzungsband. xii ABBREVIATIONS Gesch. u. Kult. des Alt. = Studien zur Geschichte und Kultur des Altertums. Gilbert, Const Antiq. = Gilbert, G., Constitutional Antiquities of Sparta and Athens (Macmillan, 1895). Griech. = Griechisch. Gott. gelehrt. Anz. = Gottingische gelehrte Anzeigen. Gott. Gesellsch. = Nachrichten von der koniglichen Gesellschaft der Wissenschaften zu Gottingen. Greenidge, Gk. Const. Hist. = Handbook of Greek Constitutional History (Mac- millan, 1896). Grote = Grote, G., History of Greece, 12 vols, (reprint from original ed., New York : Harper). G.W.B. = George W. Botsford. Harv. St in CI. Philol. = Harvard Studies in Classical Philology. Herm. = Hermes. Hicks and Hill = Hicks, E. L., and Hill, G. F., Manual of Greek Historical Inscrip- tions (new ed., Oxford, 1901). Hist Zeitschr. = Historische Zeitschrift Holm = Holm, A., History of Greece, 4 vols. (Macmillan, 1895-1898). Inscr. grffic. = Inscriptiones grascse, 14 vols. (Berlin, 1873-1890). The old edition is occasionally cited as CIA. Jahresb. = Jahresberichte iiber die Fortschritte der klassischen Altertumswissen- schaft. J.H.S. = Journal of Hellenic Studies. Jouguet, Pap. grecs = Papyrus grecs (Paris, 1907). Journ. Philol. = (English) Journal of Philology. Kock, Th., Com. att. frag. = Comicorum atticorum fragmenta. Meyer, Ed., Forsch. = Forschungen zur alten Geschichte, 2 vols. (Halle, 1892, 1899). Gesch. d. Alt = Geschichte des Altertums, 5 vols. (I. 1, third ed. ; 1. 2, second ed. ; II-V, first ed.). Michel = Michel, Ch., Recueil d'inscriptions grecques (Brussels, 1900). Mitt. Vorderas. Ges. = Mitteilungen der vorderasiatischen Gesellschaft MSller, Frag, hist grajc. = Fragmenta historicorum grascorum, 5 vols. (Paris : Didot 1841). Mus. belg. = Le Musee beige, revue de philologie classique. N. Jahrb. = Neue Jahrbiicher fiir das klassische Altertum, Geschichte, etc. Pauly-Wissowa, Real-Encycl. = Pauly's Real-Encyclopadie der classischen Altertums- '. wissenschaft, revised by Wissowa, G. (beginning 1894) ; the later vols, by KroU, W., and Witte, K. References are all to the enU Seihe. A eweiU Reihe began to appear in 1914. Philol. = Philologus. Pohlmann Griech. Gesch. = Pohlmann, R. von, Grundriss der griechischen Ge- schichte (fourth ed., Munich, 1909). Pol. Sci. Quart. = Political Science Quarterly. R. Acad. d. sci. atti = Atti della reale accademia delle scienze di Torino. Rev. des ^t. gr. = Revue des etudes grecques. Rev. hist = Revue historique. Rhein. Mus. = Rheinisches Museum. Roberts and Gardner = Roberts, E. S., and Gardner, E. A,, Introduction to Greek Epigraphy, 2 vols. (Cambridge : University Press, 1887, 1905). ABBREVIATIONS xiii Sachs. Gesellsch. = Abhandlungen der koniglich sachsischen Gesellschaft der Wis- senschaften. Philologische-historische Klasse. Sitz. Berl. Akad. = Sitzungsberichte der koniglich preussischen Akademie der Wis- senschaften zu Berlin. Supplb. = Supplementband. Supplem. = Suppleraentum (of the Inscr. grsec). Trans. Am. Philol. Ass. = Transactions and Proceedings of the American Philologi- cal Association. Versamml. d. Philolog. = Versammlung deutscher Fhilologen und Schulmanner. Verhandlungen. W.C.L. = William C. Lawton. W.E.C. = Wallace E. Caldwell. W.L.W. = William L. Westermann. Zeitsch. f. Ethnol. = Zeitschrift fUr Ethnologic. HELLENIC CIVILIZATION CHAPTER I THE SOURCES OF HELLENIC HISTORY I. Introduction The sources for the history of Hellas include everything from which may be derived information of service to the historian. They comprise, accordingly, not only literature and written docu- ments, but also products of workmanship found by exploration, and even the physical features and conditions of the country, the cKmate, soil, and products, the practicabilities of communication with other countries ; in brief, everytbSng that in any way throws light upon the factors that determined the historical development. The language itself is a highly important source for the origin of the Hellenes, their relations with other early peoples, their sub- division into the so-called races, which are in fact large dialect groups, and for the gradual development of their ideas on all sub- jects of which they thought. This volume, however, is limited to the written sources. It has to do, accordingly, with Kterature, with inscriptions on stone or bronze, and with documents com- mitted to papyri, many of which have recently been discovered in Egypt. To the scholar of a few decades ago, whose chief interest was in political and military narrative, the Greek historians were all- important sources. Recently, however, history has so expanded as to take into account all human conditions and activities, physical, mental, and emotional. In this wider view it embraces economy, society, philosophy and science, reHgion, poetry and art, as well as political institutions, party struggles, and warfare, and thus renders the lyric poet and the dramatist equal in importance to 2 THE SOURCES the historian. In all oscillations of judgment regarding the relative importance of things there is danger of going to extremes. The culture of a people without their economy and politics is like the decorations of a dwelling without its foundation and frame- work. It is for the purpose of illustrating all these aspects of Greek civilization that the material of the present volume has been selected and organized. II. The MmoAN Age Our sources for the Minoan period, approximately 3000-1 200 B.C., are nearly all archaeological. Various Hellenic authors, however, have written of that time and have referred to it the origin of cer- tain conditions and institutions existing in historical Greece. Some of this material has been included in this present volume, and the reasons for so doing have been given in the introduction to Chap- ter II. Whereas scholars have thus far taken great interest in pointing to artistic and religious survivals from the Minoan age, the present study breaks ground in calling attention also to survivals of social and political conditions. III. Homer The ancients are at variance regarding the place and time of Homer. The weight of their evidence, however, connects him with Smyrna, Chios, or their neighborhood, where with an original Mo]ic population lonians were afterward mingled. They are at one in placing him after the Trojan war, although they differ by centuries as to the length of time that intervened between that event and his birth (cf. Christ, Grieck. Lit. I. 34 sq.). Their idea of his personality, that of a blind old minstrel who wandered about chanting his sweet lays, is best expressed in the Homeric Hymn to the Delian Apollo (165 sqq) : — "But come now, be gracious, Apollo, be gracious, Artemis, and ye maidens all, farewell ; but remember me even in time to come, when any of earthly men, yea, any stranger that much hath seen and much endured, comes hither and asks : — " 'Maidens, who is the sweetest to you of smgers here conversant, and in whose song are ye most glad?' " Then do you all with one voice make answer : — " 'A blind man is he, and he dwells in rocky Chios ; his song will ever have the mastery, ay, in all time to come.'" (Lang.) THE HOMERIC QUESTION 3 The picture is that of the typical rhapsodist, the professional chanter of epic verse, rather than of a historical person. For a time all existing epics were indiscriminately assigned to Homer; but as early as Herodotus the work of sifting was under way. On the ground of internal contradictions he separated in authorship the poem entitled Cypria from the Iliad and the Odyssey (ii. 117). The work of criticism thus begun resulted in the definite segre- gation, apart from Homer, of the group of epics known as cyclic. In this use, as in the word cyclopedia, cycle has reference merely to a definite scope or range of material. In the Alexandrian age the so-called separatists, Xenon and Hellanicus, advanced a step farther in Homeric criticism when they assumed distinct authors for the two poems. Here the work of sifting rested till near the close of the eighteenth century, when Wolf in his Prolegomena ad Homerum, on the basis of inconsistencies and other alleged defects, pronounced both poems the work of a number of poets. From his time throughout the nineteenth century scholars of all countries have devoted their Uves to laborious analysis of the poems to dis- cover earher and later parts and to estabhsh theories as to their process of growth. ' During all this time there were conservatives who protested against such dissection; and since the beginning of the present century a strong reaction has set in in favor of unity, although there remain doughty champions of plural authorship. Meanwhile, the minute studies in Homer mentioned above have not been in vain, as they have given us a knowledge of the poet which could not otherwise have accumulated. To the student of -history the chief interest is not whether these poems were the product of one mind, but rather what historical value they have. As it is evident that they are not history pure and simple, the chief problem is, by sifting out the fiction, to dis- cover the residuum of 'truth. If we are in search of light on poKtical and social conditions and on material civilization, we may begin by rejecting the gods, their relations with men, and everything supernatural. Here it is possible to discard more than is necessary, for the Homeric Olympus is evidently a glorified reflection from a royal court ; so that by a study of the gods we may gain knowledge of Homeric men and society. The individual human beings, 4 THE SOURCES Agamemnon, Helen, Aretd, and the rest, are also fictions. Should any Homeric person have had a real being, there are no criteria by which we may discover the fact, or having discovered it, separate the fiction in his character from the reaUty. The same principle holds for the activities of persons individually and in combination. We cannot be certain even of the main event — thie siege and sack of Troy by an army that had come from the Greek mainland. Some scholars are ready to afl&rm the truth of this event, while others as strenuously deny it. We know that the "sixth" city, the most splendid of the successive settlements at Troy, was destroyed by fire, and was followed by a poor village ; we know that at about this time the ^Eolians colonized Asia Minor; but whether they attacked and destroyed Troy cannot as yet be proved. The mi- gration of the Cohans, their conflict with the natives, the hardships of life in the new world, and the sight of the ruined city, burned by whatever hands, would be enough to inspire the poet to his great achievement. The elimination of the elements thus far mentioned leaves but a small residuum. The question arises, why should we not con- tinue the process of elimination still farther? Why could not Homer have invented his palaces, the armor of men, the dress of women, and aU the products of handicraft which he mentions? Perhaps he could ; but the fact is that many of these objects ac- tually existed in the Minoan age and can now be seen in the mu- seums by readers of Homer. The poet describes them so accurately as to force us to the conclusion that he must either have seen them or learned of them through trustworthy sources; either he lived in the splendor of the Minoan age or a literature, oral or written, descriptive of Minoan material civilization must have been pre- served to his time. Many reasons compel us to place him in a later period. On this point scholars are agreed. There is, however, the widest dif- ference of opinion as to when, within the approximate limits, 1200-700 B.C., lived and wrought this transcendent genius. On this subject, which is still under controversy, the writer can do no more than express his own view. The weight of ancient authority, as has been said, places Homer in Chios, Smsnrna, or their neigh- borhood — that is, after the Hellenic colonization of Asia Minor. ORIGIN OF THE HOMERIC POEMS 5 His dialect was an ^olizing Ionic, such as must have been spoken in those places, and so far as we are aware, nowhere else in Hellas. It has often been assumed that the culture of Homer was that of Ionia, about 1000-700 B.C. To that view, however, Andrew Lang {World of Homer) has offered insuperable objections. It is in fact well established that the Ionian civilization of this period was essentially decadent Minoan, whereas many Homeric ideas and usages were distinctly Indo-European. Thus far Lang's conclu- sions are acceptable. But instead of placing Homer back to iioo or 1200, as he does, it is well to note the fact that the Cohans of Thessaly, and hence of their colonies, were thoroughly Indo-Eu- ropean, scarcely touched by Minoan culture (Wace and Thompson, Prehistoric Theisaly, 191 2). This fact completes the evidence that Homer's habitat was the borderland between .^olis and Ionia. We may suppose, then, that songs and perhaps other literature descriptive of the splendors of Minoan Hfe passed down into the Middle Age, which followed the Minoan period, and into the lan- guage of the Hellenes, and that Hellenic bards on the Greek main- land and in the colonies continued to sing the glories of gods and heroes, intermingling their own customs and ideas with traditions. The greatest of these bards was Homer, who lived in Asia Minor, perhaps in the ninth or in the eighth century. He incorporated nothing, but created his great poems afresh, making use, however, of much traditional subject matter. The Odyssey was composed after the Iliad; yet both may have been the product of one genius. After their completion by Homer the poems were to some extent interpolated. No analysis of the subject matter for historical purposes will satisfy every scholar. Much of the material civihzation is clearly Minoan, and may be distinguished by archaeological study, although important elements are later than that period. In the political sphere the vast pretensions of king and nobles and their contempt for the commons seem Minoan, whereas the actualities of political life are largely those of Homer's time and place. The same prin- ciple holds for society. The rehgion, too, is composite; earher and contemporary elements are mingled. In a word, each detail of Homeric life requires individual consideration, and on many points, because of a lack of determinative facts, it will be impossible for scholars to agree. THE SOURCES BIBLIOGRAPHY I. The Homeric Question ; Artistic Aspect. — Under this heading are included questions of time and place, origin, historical relations, unity, per- sonality, and literary character. All histories of Greek literature deal with the subject, and do not require individual mention. The books and articles here enumerated treat mainly of the subjects above mentioned, while those which have to do chiefly with life are placed under (2). The amount of liter- ature on Homer produced during the present century is enormous. A few only of the vast number of titles are given here. Indispensable guides to this literature are Mulder, D., "Bericht iiber die Literatur zu Homer," in Jahresb. CLVII (1912). 170-325; CLXI (1913). 73-171; Rothe, C, Der augenbUck- licJie Stand der homerischen Prage (Berlin, 191 2); Shewan, A., in Class. Rev. XXVII (1914). 128-32. Burrows, R. M., Discoveries in Crete, ch. xii; Browne, H., Handbook of Homeric Study (Longmans, 1905) ; Stawell, F. M., Homer and the Iliad: an Essay to determine the Scope and Character of the Original Poem (London: Dent, 1909) ; Shewan, A., "Does the Odyssey imitate the Iliad?" in Class. Quart. VII (1913). 234-42; "Continuation of the Odyssey," in Class. Philol. VIII (1913). 284-300; IX. 35 sqq.; Perrin, B., "The Odyssey under Source- Criticism," in Am. Journ. Philol. VIII (1887). 415-32 ; Lang, A., Homer and the Epic (1893) ; Allen, T. W., "Canonicity of Homer," in Class. Quart. VII (1913). 221-33; "Lives of Homer," in J. H. S. XXXII (1912). 250-60; XXXIII. 19-26; "Homeridae," in Class. Quart. I (1907). 135-43; "Peisis- tratus and Homer," ib. VII (1913). 33 sqq. ; "Homeric Catalogue," in J. H. S. XXX (1910). 292-322 ; Scott, J. A., various articles in Class. Philol. V (1910). 41 sqq. ; VI. 156 sqq., 419 sqq. ; VII. 293 sqq. ; Class. Rev. XXIV (1910). 8 sqq. Bonitz, H., Ueber den Ursprung der homerischen Gedichte (5th ed. Vienna, 1881) ; Cauer, Grundfragen der Homerkritik (Leipzig, 1909) ; "Erfundenes und Ueberliefertes bei Homer," in N. Jahrb. VIII (1905). 1-18; "Soil die Homerkritik abdanken?" ib. XV (1912). 98-111 ; Croiset, M., "La question homerique au debut du XX' siecle," in Rev. des deux mondes, 1907, p. 600 sqq. ; Laurand, L., Progrbs et recul de la critique (Paris, 1912) ; Rothe, C, Ilias aJs Dichtung (Paderborn, 1910) ; Die Odyssee als Dichtung und ihr Verhdltnis zur Ilias (ib. 1914), by one of the greatest upholders of unity ; Belzner, E., Home- rische Probleme, I : Die Kulturellen Verhaltnisse der Odyssee als kritische Instanz (Teubner, 191 1) ; Bethe, E., "Die trojanischen Ausgrabimgen und die Homer- kritik," in N. Jahrb. XUI (1904). i-ii ; "Die Einheit unserer lUas," ib. XXXIII (1914). 362-71 ; Maas, E., "Die Person Homers," ib. XIV (1911). 539- 50 ; Kammer, E., Ein aesthetischer Kommentar zu Homer's Ilias (3d ed. Pader- born, 1906) ; Lawton, W. C, Art and Humanity in Homer (Macmillan, 1896). II. Life. — Lang, A., Homer and his Age (Longmans, 1906); Leaf, W., Troy: A Study of Homeric Geography (Macmillan, 1912) ; Keller, A. C, Homeric Society (London, 1902); Isham, N. M., Homeric Palace (Providence, 1898); Dickins, G., "Some Points with regard to the Homeric House," in /. H. S. POST-HOMERIC EPICS 7 XXIII (1903). 325 sgq. ; Sihler, E. G., Testimonium Anima, ch. iii; Harrison, J. E., Myths of the Odyssey in Art and Literature (London, 1882) ; Seymour, D., Life in the Homeric Age (Macmillan, 1907) ; " Slavery and Servitude in Homer," in Am. Journ. Arch. V (1902). 23 sqq. ; Symonds, J. A., Studies in the Greek Poets, II. ch. iii (women) ; Bonner, "Justice in the Age of Homer," in Class. Philol. VI (1911). 12-36 ; Sidgwick, H., "Trial Scene in lUad xviii. 4^7-508," m Class. Rev. VIII (1894). 1-3. Buchholz, E., Hom^rische Realien, 3 vols. (Leipzig, 1871-84) ; Finsler, G., Homer (Teubner, 1908), a new ed. is appearing in pts. ; Drerup, E., Anfange der hellenischen Kultur: Homsr (Munich, 1903) ; Omero (Bergamo, 1910), revision of preceding German work; Reichel, W., Homerische Waff en (2d ed. Vienna, 1891) ; Helbig, W., Das homerische Epos aus den DenkmUlern erlautert (2d ed. Teubner, 1887). IV. The Cyclic Epics, the Homeric Hymns, and Hesiod The cyclic epics (p. 3), which have all disappeared with the exception of a few scant fragments, once constituted a large body of literature. Among them were the Theogonia, (Edipodeia, Thebais, Epigoni, Cypria, Mthiopis, Little Iliad, and Nosti. Younger than Homer, they belong, some to the eighth and more to the seventh century. Even the ancients did not know the authors by name ; and we can only say that the bulk of this literature seems to have been Ionic. The value of the poems lies in the fact that they were the chief sources for the Attic dramatists. They were the creations of talent rather than of genius; but the customs they pictured, their ideas and general tone were better adapted to the Attic stage than were those of the true Homeric poems. Particularly the priestly lore, the oracles, the belief in ghosts, in the guilt wrought by homicide and its purification by swine's blood, in the hereditary curse that brought the family to ruin, finally the gloomy aspects of religion characteristic of Minoan civilization but foreign to Homer, were all far more appropriate to Attic tragedy than was the sunny life of the Iliad and Odyssey. To the student of history the important fact is that the characteristics of the cycHc epos above mentioned belong to Ionia along with other regions formerly under Minoan dominance, as distinguished from Indo-European Thessaly and iEohs. It was in fact from the conditions represented by these inferior poems, far more than from Homeric fife, that the Athenian civilization developed. 8 THE SOURCES As a prelude to his epic recitation at a festive gathering it was customary for the rhapsodist to chant a song in honor of the god to whose glory the festival was held. A group of songs ostensibly composed for this purpose was collected in ancient times, and is stiU preserved, imder the name of Homeric Hymns. The earliest among these poems is the Hymn to the Delian Apollo, which belongs most probably to the seventh century. Composed at widely different times and places, they throw light on the thought and feeling of poet and audience, and reveal in occasional passages charming pictures of life. Hundreds of rhapsodists assumed and transmitted in epics a poetry of gods and heroes which mirrored the aristocratic form of Greek life. It was a world of song and noble feats which certainly — apart from the broader sketches of the Shield — was somewhat one- sided though lofty. Thersites and Eumaeus, men of the lower class, appear too, but they are foils for an essentially aristocratic society. In Hesiod we come down to an actuality which moves no longer among gods and inen of might ; but in his work the common and the commonplace are mirrored, we may say, with photographic fideKty. The father of Hesiod {Works, 633 sqq^ came from Cym6 in the ^Eolic littoral of Asia Minor to .iEolic Bceotia, fleeing from poverty at home. He acquired a farmstead at Ascra at the foot of Mount Helicon, near Thespiae. The poet, a shepherd and farmer, suffered from scoundrelly litigation at the hands of his brother Perses. Out of such experiences the Works and Days came forth. The seasons of the year, and all the tasks and toil which they fcring in their train, are here set forth. The poet's time has been computed for about 700 B.C. or perhaps somewhat later. In his personality there are reflected thoughtfulness and meditation rather than imagination and enthusiasm. His Theogony was the first effort of the Hellenic world to construct through a system of genealogies and pedigrees a unity of Heaven and Earth and their history. The epic of the Heroines (^ ota) continued this con- structive process and dovetailed it into the ancestral legends of the chief families associated with the principal communities or states of Greece. The fact that but one elaborate simile occurs in Hesiod is significant of his prosaic character, while the deliberate and di- HESIOD 9 dactic trend of his manner and mind is equally manifest in both epics. There are two sides in him : he is gifted in presenting actual, even minor and petty things, with remarkable precision. On the other hand, he is indeed a man of deep reflection. From this vein, particularly in the Theogony, a world of abstractions arises, which the poet of Ascra knows how to clothe with dazzling nomenclature. "Common to both epics, specifically speaking, is the conception of Woman, a gift of Zeus which he bestowed on mankind in his wrath. The Pandora-myth in both poems is episodical ; but favor- ite themes and favorite plaints are apt to crop out and to steal in — as episodes — particularly in didactic poetry. If anything, the Pandora episode of the Works (94 sqq.) is more malicious, be- cause there woman is made responsible for the diffusion of evils through the world, evils tempered only by the retention of Hope. Hesiod's ethics are those of Cato the Censor and Franklin's Poor Richard: they are largely based on the virtues clustering around Frugalitas." (Sihler, in Am. Philol. Assoc. 1902, p. xvii.) If we take the art of Homer, of Pindar, of ^Eschylus, there is a trend toward large and lofty themes, there is a certain aflSnity for a splendid elevation of being and feeling which many readers are tempted to use as the atmosphere and perspective for their general outlook upon the Hellenic world. It is the privilege, nay the proper function of such art to eliminate or ignore the common and the commonplace. For this one-sided estheticism of vision and of judg- ment the Works and Days of Hesiod furnishes an admirable cor- rective. We are brought into a world of the workday and of the toil requisite for the support of life. The hero and the man of splendid feats have entirely disappeared. In Hesiod the word Basileus ("king") evidently means nothing very great. The judges are called "kings": the poet describes them as "swallowers of bribes" (Soapo^dyoi, Works, 264). So far as we know, it was Hesiod who made the first attempt to divide the past into periods ; and far from conceiving a develop- ment, he assumed a succession of declines. He calls his own time the Iron age, before which have come and passed the Golden, the Silver, and the Bronze. Curiously enough, this process of recession and decline was for an epoch stopped or inhibited, — that is, the Fourth age was an heroic age, the period of the Seven against lo THE SOURCES Thebes and of the Trojan war, but now there is no intimation of any survival of that heroic spirit. Socially the horizon of the As- cran farmer is narrow, morally it is large and wide. If we look at the abundant data of material living, there is here a detail of the year and of the husbandnian's changing task, of house and home, of summer and winter, of wife and children and fireside, of servants and slaves, of crops and harvests and vintage, of seafaring and of a form of trade, which, in part, may still have been barter. No other piece of ancient literature brings us into so close and realistic touch with country people and rural conditions. It is obvious that the proverbs and general truths in which the Works and Days abound were not all composed by Hesiod himself, but constitute a gradual aggregation. The whole, however, had a large place in Greek schools and schooHng to the latest times. BIBLIOGRAPHY I. The Cyclic Epos. — The fragments of the cyclic epics have been collected by Kinkel, G., Epicorum Gracorum fragmenta, I (Teubner, 1877). Most of them are too brief to be serviceable to the historian. AH in which the student of history could take an interest are translated by Lawton, W. C, SzKcessors of Homer (London: Innes, 1898), ch. i. Fjom this work a few selections have been taken for this volume. The most complete discussion of the subject is by Welcker, F. G., Der epische Cyclus, 2 vols. (Bonn, 1835, 1849; vol. I, 2d ed. 1865). See also Wilamowitz-MoeUendorff, in Home- rische Uniersuchungen^ VII. 328-80. On the illustration of cyclic subjects in Greek art, see Luckenbach, O., "Das Verhaltniss der griech. VasenbUder zu den Gedichten des epischen Kyklos," in Jakrb.f. Philol. Supplb. XI (1880), 491-637 ; Jahn, O., Griech. Bilderchroniken, ed. by A. Michaelis (Bonn, 1873) ; Robert, K., Winckelmannsprogram (HaUe, 1891) ; BendorfiE, O., and Nie- mann, G., Das Heroon von Gj olbaschi-Trysa (Vienna, 1889). A briefer treatment of the cyclic epos wiU be found in any history of Greek literature. Especially new and valuable is Allen, T. W., "The Epical Cycle," in Class. Quart. II (1908). 81-8. II. The Homeric Hymns. — Edition by Baumeister, A. (Teubner, 1910). See also the English edition by A. Goodwin and T. W. Allen (Ox- ford, 1893), and by Allen and Sikes (1904). Lang, A., Homeric Hymns: A New Prose Translation (Longmans, 1899), is a charming translation. From it the material in the present volume has been drawn. The best treatment in English is by Lawton, W. C, Successors of Homer, chs. iv-vi. See in gen- eral the histories of Greek literature. III. Hesiod. — An excellent guide to the recent literature on Hesiod is PERSONAL POETRY ii Rzach, A., "Bericht iiber die Publikationen zu Hesiodos 1899-1908," in Jahresb. CLII (1911). I-7S- The most recent critical edition is that by Rzach (Leip- zig, 1902). The explanatory notes in Flach's revision of Gottling's edition have also proved useful to the editors. The best English translation is Mair, A. W., Hesiod: The Poems and Fragments done into English Prose (Oxford: Clarendon Press, 1908), from which the selections of the present volume have been taken, verified on the basis of the text by E. G. S. There is also a trans- lation by C. A. Elton (London, 1894). Newly discovered fragments may be found in GrenfeU, B., and Hunt, A., Oxyrhynchus Papyri, various volumes; cf. especially Wilamowitz-MoeUendorff, V., "Neue Bruckstiicke der hes. Kata- loge," in Sitzb. Berl. Akad. 1900, pp. 839-51 ; Berliner Klassiker Texte, V. i. On Hesiod's life and writings, in addition to the histories of Greek literature, see Schwartz, E., Charakterkopfe aiis der antiken Liter atur (3d ed. Teubner, 1911), ch. i; Sjrmonds, J. A., Studies of the Greek Poets, II, ch. iv; Sihler, E. G., Testimonium Animce, ch. iii; Aly, W., "Hesiod von Ascra und die Verfasser der Theogonie," in Bkein. Mus. LXVIII (1913). 22-67 ; Waltz, P., HSsiode et son pobme moral (Bordeaux, 1906) ; Meyer, E., "Hesiods Erga und das Gedicht von den fiinf Menschengeschlechtern," in Carl Robert zum 8. Mdrz, igio GenetMiakon ; Steitz, A., Die Werke des Landbaus in den Werken und Tagen des Hesiodos (Frankfurt am Main, 1866) ; Scott, J. A., Comparative Study of Hesiod and Pindar (Chicago, 1898) ; Bonner, R. J., "Administration of Justice in the Age of Hesiod," in Class. Philol. VII (1912). 17-23 ; Rzach, A., in Pauly-Wissowa, Real-Encyd. VIII. 1167-1240. V. The Elegiac, Iambic, and Lyric Poets 700-479 B.C. For the period extending from the seventh century to the close of the great war between Hellas and Persia almost our only con- temporary sources are the poets of that time. Of elegiac, iambic, and Ijnric poetry we have in general nothing but fragments ; but from this material, however scanty, may be derived precious in- formation on a great diversity of subjects, including personal traits, society, economy, warfare, religion, and intelligence. Below are presented brief sketches of the lives and literary works of the poets represented in the present volume. They give expression to a period of stormy life and of brilliant varied emotion. "The change from rural to industrial economy in this time, the growth of cities and of a leisurely class, as well as contact with the entire Medi- terranean world through commerce and colonization, afforded the means and the impetus to a magnificent literature. The abolition 12 THE Sources of kingship and the rise of aristocracies and tyrannies, involving fierce factional struggles, added to the intensity of life. To express these complex conditions the old epic verse of calm stately meter — the dactylic hexameter — proved whoUy inadequate. It gave way, accordingly, to new and varied measures, which would better exhibit the play of individual or communal thought and emotion characteristic of the new era. The first variation from the epic verse is found in the elegiac pentameter, whose spirit may be either meditative or emotional. Accompanied by the pipe, it lent itself equally to the expression of political and socjal thought, religious devotion, and martial fire." (Botsford, Hellenic History, ch. viii.) Among the earlier elegiac poets was Tyrtseus, who composed martial elegies at Sparta in the second half of the seventh century. The story that he was an Athenian schoolmaster, sent on request to lead the Lacedaemonians in war with the Messenians, is an in- sipid fiction. It would harmonize far better with the conditions of the time to connect his origin with Ionia, the home of the elegy, as Suidas actually does (Adiccav f) Mt\^o-to?, "Laconian or Milesian"). It is perfectly possible, however, that he was a Laconian by birth ; at all events he addresses the Spartans as a native, and enters into their spirit like one of their number. Philochorus, the Attic chronicler (Frag. 56), who is no mean authority, states that through his generalship the Spartans overcame the Messenians. If this assertion is true, he was a commander in war, and therefore a native. In addition to martial songs, he composed a poem entitled Eunomia (Good Order), in which he counsels the Spartans to cease from po- Utical dissensions. It would not be difficult to think of him as a general and statesman, like Solon, who used the elegy, in lack of prose, to inspire his troops with courage and to make known his political views. Alcman, a contemporary of Tyrtaeus, is likewise reputed to have been of foreign birth. An allusion in one of his poems led the ancients to believe that he was a native of Sardis. It was even said that he was brought as a slave to Sparta and there emancipated. Some modern scholars regard him as an Ionian, invited, like other foreign poets, to Sparta, to devote his genius to the good of that community. Another tradition represents him as a native Spartan of the deme Messoa, where he was buried (Suidas s. 'AXK/idv; ALCMAN AND ARCHILOCHUS 13 Pausanias iii. 15. 2). The^fact is that this century saw the culmi- nation of Laconian civilization, and that after the decline had far advanced, no Greek critic or antiquarian could believe that Sparta had ever been capable of producing a poet of the rank of Alcman or Tyrtaeus. Whatever his origin, he identifies himself heart and soul with Spartan life. He writes not of war and politics, however, but of sleeping nature, dancing, ceryl birds, and fair athletic girls. Here is an expression of the gentle refinement of early Sparta, which centuries of cramping miUtary discipUne gradually crushed. The form of poetry in which he excelled is the choral lyric, to be simg by a group of persons appropriately dressed and trained to dance in accompaniment. The Doric state set the example of using this form of song and dance as a means of civic education. In our review of the seventh-century poets we now pass from the mainland on either side of the ^gean to the islands of that sea. A native of Paros, land of marble, was Archilochus, the reputed in- ventor of the iambic. This form of verse is adapted to the ex- pression of the passions from love to hate, scorn, and invective. It is the measure used by the Greek dramatists in their dialogues and by modem poets in the so-called heroic verse. The iambic is appro- priate to satire, and its inventor was the first to write that kind of poetry. He was the author, too, of certain grotesque combinations in which the stately hexameter is fused with scolding iambics, a truly mongrel verse. This poet, the son of an aristocratic father and slave mother, pours into his verse the storm and strife that filled the age. In early life he joined a colony, a pack of scoundrels as he describes it, on the island of Thasos. It was rich in gold, of which Kttle fell to his lot, while he had to fight along with his fellow- colonists against the native barbarians. On one of these occasions he threw away his shield, a most disgraceful act, and afterward boasted of it in verse. Unable to remain in Thasos, because, as he says, he was too insolent, abusing friend and foe alike, and perhaps fearing to return to Paros, he became a wanderer over land and sea, a soldier of fortune, and seemingly a pirate. This life is reflected in the fragments of his verse. Admiring his bold inventiveness, the courage that always rallied from every overthrow, the versatility of his poetic genius, and his intense personality, the ancients placed him, as the unrivaled master of personal song, next to Homer. 14 THE SOURCES Regarding Semonides of Amorgos little was known even to the ancients. As he used the iambic measure, he must be placed after Archilochus, seemingly as a younger contemporary. It is said that he was born in Samos and himself conducted a colony to Amorgos. This author is interesting to us chiefly for his satire on women, in which he compares their various types to animals. In homeliness of thought and style he is akin to Hesiod, while his treatment of animals makes him a forerunner of ^sop. The tone of contempt for women, his denunciation of them as the main or only source of human ills, he shares with Hesiod ; in lact this spirit, in contrast with Homer's chivalry, extended far beyond the limitations of these two authors. In our study of Solon, about 639-559, we pass from the seventh to the sixth century. While reaching firmer historical ground, we come to deal with a far more conspicuous personaUty than any mentioned above, made known to us through Aristotle's Constitu- tion of the Athenians, 5-13, Plutarch's genial biography, and the mediocre life by Diogenes Laertius. In the spirit of Tyrtaeus, Solon composed at least one martial elegy, all of which, with the exception of eight lines, has perished. Like Tyrtaeus, he used the elegy for the propagation of his statesmanly views, for informing and per- suading the people. In fact, from the fragments of his political verses, scant as they are, we may gather the aims and the results of his social and constitutional reforms. Not limiting himself to one kind of verse or to the topics above mentioned, he employed the iambic and expressed his views on various social and moral subjects. With Solon Athens entered upon a new era. Through him she acquired a body of Kberal statutes and such an extension of the civic franchise as to interest the masses in her well-being, an open door to desirable alien immigrants, a commercial and cultural touch with Ionia, Egypt, and other countries, and lastly a worthy beginning of the most beautiful Uterature known to the world. It is not strange, then, that after ages looked back to Solon as the father of free gov- ernment, the greatest of beneficent legislators, and the wisest of men. Mimnermus of Colophon, a contemporary of Solon and per- haps his elder in years, lived in the shadow of Lydian imperialism which hung over the Asiatic Greeks. In one of his poems, a martial FROM SEMONIDES TO ALC^EUS 15 lay worthy of Tyrtaeus, he glorifies a Smyrnaean hero, who battled with the Lydians, probably against King Gyges, and "scattered the dense phalanxes of Lydian cavalry throughout the plain of Hermus stream." This elegy was perhaps to encourage his fellowr-citizens to defense against King Sadyattes (Christ, Griech. Lit. I. 163 sq.), who died about 604. His poems in general offer us the Kvely and impressionable strain of Ionic character. To the ancients, who knew his verse more fully than we do, his poetry was the typical note of sadness for the brief and passing springtime of human life and human joys, soft and mournful but too devoid of the elements of firmness, virility, and endurance, an embodiment of the "volup- tuous and melancholy worldweariness of Ionia." Most of the larger remnants have been preserved to us by Stobaus. The poets thus far mentioned have been Dorian and Ionian. With Alcaeus we return to the home of the ^olians, who were a factor in the creation of the Homeric poems, and who in Lesbos kept equal pace with their Ionic kinsmen. This island lay in the highest cultural area of the age ; it shared with the lonians the advantages of trade with Orient, and while equally refined and intellectual, it showed less tendency than Ionia to physical and moral enfeeble- ment. Its people had their political troubles. The aristocracy, to which Alcaeus belonged, had weakened itself through factions, till the government fell a prey to demagogues and tyrants. In the midst of such turmoil Alcaeus passed his troubled life, an active participator in events, now the inspiring genius of his party, now wandering in lonely exile. Some of the details of his life are given in connection with his poems (ch. v) . He was the first great master of the lyric monody, the song of individual experience sung to one- self or to friends. The lyric was so named because it was accom- panied by the lyre, in contrast with the pipe, which was used with the elegy. His songs covered a wide range of subjects, including war, politics, drinking, love, and the beauties of nature. We have one or two entire poems remaining and many small fragments — enough for a high appreciation of his genius and for affording a glimpse of his island home within his Hfetime. In all human history, down nearly to our own time, the sixth century, B.C., with a part of the early fifth, formed the great age of women, the age in which their gifted representatives reached the i6 THE SOURCES utmost height of art and intelligence. It is true that in Ionia the tendency was to her segregation, and in Athens her Kberty, once large, was being restricted by legislation. The high place of women in Laconia is well known ; there they shared in the education of men, an education which was athletic rather than intellectual, and often appeared as the moral advisers of sons, husbands, or fathers. Throughout the greater part of Hellas they enjoyed large freedom and influence, while the reach of their intelligence is proved by the great number of poetesses who flourished in this period. They include Myrtis and Corinna of Boeotia, Praxilla of Sicyon, Telesilla of Argos, and especially Sappho of Lesbos. Sappho was a contemporary and a friend of Alcaeus ; their lives belong to the early part of the sixth century. Little is known of the poetess. It is said that she was banished for political reasons, and afterward recalled. In Mytilene, appreciation of her genius grew till the state stamped her image on its coins. There was perhaps no place in Hellas where women were so free to develop their taste for music and poetry as Lesbos; and Sappho took advantage of this liberty to gather about her a school of briUiant, beautiful girls, her pupils in the composition of verse and melody. Many of her poems refer to these companions, their social relations, partings, marriages, and the telepathic sympathy of widely separated friends. She gives attention also to other subjects, to her spendthrift brother in Egypt, to a chorus of Cretan women about an altar, to the stars and moon, to orchards where cool streams call through the branches of apple-trees and slumber streams from quivering leaves. In all themes her inspiration is love and loveKness. Anacreon of Teos, an Ionic city, is distinctly later than Sappho and belongs to the latter half of the century, yet the erotic tone of his verse connects him in a way with the Lesbic group of poets. When in g45 Harpagus, the lieutenant of Cyrus, assailed Anacreon's native city, he fled, with his fellow-citizens, to the Teian colony Ab- dera on the Thracian coast. This event found an echo in his song. During the reign of Polycrates, the magnificent tyrant ofSamos (533-522), he served at his court as a sort of minister of pleasure. Afterward invited by Hipparchus to Athens, he made the acquaint- ance of Athenians who were then prominent or destined to prom- inence in the impending war with Persia. Still later it is said that SAPPHO, ANACREON, AND THEOGNIS 17 he visited the mighty family of the Aleuadae in Thessaly. The Alexandrian scholars had at hand his elegies, epigrams, iambics, and lyrics in five books, of which we have but two poems and many diminutive fragments. In his generation Ionia was full of intellectual energy ; it was the age in which Hellenic philosophy, science, geog- raphy, and history were born. But as in every highly developed civihzation luxury, dissipation, and vice also abounded ; and it was the ambition of Anacreon to represent the decadent tendencies of his period. Theognis, a contemporary of Anacreon, was an aristocrat of Megara, that httle Doric commonwealth which lay between Attica and Corinth. His time was the second half of the sixth century and beyond, for in some of his verse (764 sqq.) the eastern horizon is darkened by the impending danger of Persian invasion. Much of his life he lived in exile, as at Thebes and in Sicily, where Megara Hyblaea was a colony of his native commonwealth. It would seem to be an elusive task to reconstruct his life and movements in detail from the verses traditionally ascribed to him, as the English scholar John Hookham Frere attempted to do {Works, 2 vols. 1842). This work was brilliant for its time, but the critical labors of Bergk have rendered many of its assumptions untenable. In his wanderings the Megarian exile visited Sparta, too, and Euboea, and received much kindly hospitality (784 sqq.), but nothing, he declared, could assuage the yearning for home and country. Much of his elegiac verse was composed to embeUish a social occasion. The pipe (241) still accompanied the recitation. The general truths relating to the wise conduct of life gave to much of his verse a lasting currency among the Hellenes. In fact the remnants are an anthology in which social moralizing predominates. For the general purposes of this volume have been chosen some passages which exhibit the proud and stubborn consciousness of the aristocrat who considers the political and social domination of his own class as a self-evident principle, nay as a very postulate of nature. The aristocrats are the good and the excellent ; the com- mon folk are the mean and the bad. As the life of Theognis connects the old aristocratic r6gime with the great war of Hellenic independence, that of Simonides of Ceos (556-469) spans the period between the age of the Peisistratidae i8 THE SOURCES and the age of Themistocles. It is a curious fact that the same poet enjoyed the patronage of the last Athenian tyrant and of the founder of the Athenian naval supremacy. Like Anacreon he wandered about from place to place at the call of tyrant, aristocrat, or imperial democrat, ever ready to compose for the one who offered a sufficient fee. We hear of him at the court of Hippias, at the aris- tocratic courts of the tyrant's friends in Thessaly ; then after the battle of Marathon we find him again at Athens, where in poetical competition he won a victory over ^schylus. Still later, Hieron called him to Sicily, where he entered into rivalry with Pindar. There he ended his days, and his tomb stood long before the gates of Syracuse. The conspicuous success of his art in a characteristic way il- lustrates an aspect of the Greek spirit — a craving for immortaUty by means of a Uterary monument. The faculty of inscriptional composition which Simonides possessed in a high degree was sought for by aristocrats, tyrants, wealthy individuals of every party, and even by commonwealths such as Athens in the age of Themistocles. The most lasting of his verses are of the character mentioned above, which we may call commemorative, to give enduring distinction to historical monuments erected for great achievements and emi- nent persons of his time. He was one of the famous figures and voices of his own age ; his muse, ready at the tinkle of silver, pos- sessed a certain adroitness and versatility of worldly wisdom noted in his own generation. The Alexandrian critics studied and per- petuated his commemorative verse, called Epigramma by the Greeks. In addition to this kind of poetry, however, he wrote choral songs for religious and secular purposes, paeans, hymns, odes for the victors in the games, skoKa, dithyrambs, lamentations, in brief every kind of verse of which his age had knowledge. BIBLIOGRAPHY I. General. — Sitzler, J., "Bericht iiber die griech. Lyriker, 1898- 1905," in Jahresb. CXXXIII (1907). 104-322, for editions and literature appearing in the years indicated. Standard texts are those of Bergk, Th., Antholegia Lyrica (Teubner) ; Hiller, E., Anthologia Lyrica (Teubner) ; Smyth, H. M., Greek Melic Poets (Macmillan, 1900), the best English edition; Har- tung, J. A., Die griech. Lyriker, 2 vols. (Engelmann, 1856), with German trans- SIMONIDES; BIBLIOGRAPHY 19 lations; Appleton, W. K., Greek Poets in English Verse (Houghton Mifflin, 1893), selected translations by various authors. II. Seventh-century Poets. — Hauvette, A., Un poke ionien du VIP sihcle, Archiloque; sa vie et ses poesies (Paris, 1905) ; Crusius, in Pavily- Wissowa, Real-Encycl. II. 487-507. Schwartz, E., "Tyrtaeos," in Hermes, XXXIV (1899). 428-68; Verrall, A. W., "Tyrtasus, a Graeco-Roman Tradition," in Class. Rev. X (1896) ; Schul- hof, J. M., "CaUinus and Tyrtaeus," in Class. Rev. XIV ^1900). 103 sqq.; Opitz, R., "Ueber den Weiberspiegel des Semonides von Amorgos," in Philol. L (1891). 13-30. " III. Algous, Sappho, Coeinna, and Telesilla. — Easby-Smith, J. S., Songs of Alcceus, Memoir and Text with Literal and Verse Translations (Wash- ington: Lowdermilk, 1901), from which some of the selections of this volume have been taken; Edmonds, J. M., The New Fragments of Alcceus, Sappho, and Corinna (London: Bell, 1909), text of new fragments discovered before that date; "Newly discovered Fragments of Alcaeus," in Class. Rev. XXIII (1910). 72-4, 241-3; "New Lyric Fragments," ib. XXVIII (1914). 73-8, from these three articles selections have been taken for the present volume. A criticism on the last-named article is made by Hunt, A. S., ib. 126 sq. See also Schubart, W., "Neue Bruchstiicke der Sappho und des Alkaios," iaSitzb. Berl. Akad. 1902, pp. 195-214; Wilamowitz-MoeUendorff, V., "Neue lesbische Lyrik," in N. Jahrb. XXXIH (1914). 225-47. Wharton, H. T., Sappho: Memoir, Text, and Selected Renderings (Chicago : McClurg, 1887), from which selections have been made for this volume ; Easby- Smith, J. S., Songs of Sappho (Washington: Stormont and Jackson, 1891), English translation; Brandt, P., Sappho: Ein Lebensbild aus den Fruhlings- tagen' altgriechischer Dichtung (Leipzig, 1905), biography and literary apprecia- tion; Steiner, B., Sappho (Jena, 1907), selections and appreciation; Bas- coul, J. M. F., 'H oyva SaTrc^cu : La chaste Sappho de Lesbos et le movement f&me- niste A Athhnes au IV' siecle avant J.-C. (Paris, 191 1) ; Paulides, 1. 1., SaT<^a) ^ MvTiXrivaia (Leipzig, 1885), doctorate dissertation in modern Greek; Reinach, Th., "Nouveaux fragments de Sappho," in Rev. des it. gr. XV (1902). 60-70; Wilamowitz-MoeUendorfE, V., Sappho und Simonides: Untersuchungen Uber griechische Lyriker (Weidmann, 1913). Cronert, G., "CorinnEe quae supersunt," in Rhein. Mus. LXIII (1908). 161-89, contains text; Herzog, R., "Auf den Spuren der Telesilla," in Philol. LXXI (1912). 1-23, a few short fragments. IV. Solon, Mimnermus, Theognis, Anacreon, and Simonides of Ceos. — Wilamowitz-MoellendorfE, Y., Aristoteles und Athen, I. 39-75; II. 304-15; Keil, B., Die Solonische Verfassung in Aristoteles' Verfassungs- geschichte Athens (Gaertner, 1892) ; Mitchell, J. M., "Solon," in Encycl. Brit. nth ed. ; Piatt, A., notes on Solon, in Journ. of Philol. XXIV (1896). 248- 62; XXVI. 64-8; Jebb, R. C, "On a Fragment of Solon," ib. XXV (1897). 98-105. Wilamowitz-Moellendorff, V, "Mimnermos und Properz," in Sitzb. Berl. 20 THE SOURCES Akad. 1912, pp. 100-22; Frere, J. H., Works, 2 vols. (London: Pickering, 1872), containing translations and interpretations of Theognis; Hudson- Williams, T., ELegies of Theognis and other Elegies included in the Theognidean Sylloge (London: Bell, 1910), best edition; "Theognis and his Poems," in J. H. S. XXIII (1903). 1-23; Unger, G. F., "Die Heimat des Theognis," in Philol. XLV (1886). 18-33; BuUen, A. H., Anacreon, with Th. Stanley's translation (London, 1893) ; Crusius, "Anakreon," in Pauly-Wissowa, S£al- Encycl. I. 2035-50; Wilamowitz-Moellendorff, V., Sappho und Simonides, mentioned under III. VI. The Logographi and Herodotus In the sixth century B.C., the age that saw the birth of Hellenic science, the epics current under the name of Homer and Hesiod's genealogical poems formed in the mind of the Greeks the background of their history. Thus far they had taken no literary interest in recent or contemporary happenings, and for that reason had pro- duced no chronicles, as had the Oriental kings from immemorial time. The awakening of the scientific spirit, however, which led the Hellenes in search of the origin of the physical world, interested them equally in the beginnings of mankind, of their own race, of the various states, and of the leading families in each. Hence arose a class of writers, who, in a manner parallel with that of the contemporary "philosophers," busied themselves with such matters. They have been called logographi, "writers of prose" (logos), as distinguished from the composers of poetry (epos). If Cadmus of Miletus, reputed the earhest writer of this class, and author of the Settlement of Ionia (Phny, Natural History, v. 112; cf. vii. 205), was a real person, at least nothing has been preserved from his book. Acusilaiis of Argos, about 500 B.C., is the earliest of whose work we have fragments. He composed Genealogies, a treatise which converted into prose and perhaps further expanded the Hesiodic genealogies. The fragments are but meager quotations by later writers. So far as we may infer from these scant remains, Acusilaiis hraited himself to the beginnings of the gods, of the great things of nature, and of the human race. Nowhere does he ap- proach historical times. Such was doubtless the nature of all early logography." In no respect, therefore, could it be termed history. The change, however, from verse to prose clipped the wings of imagination and accentuated correspondingly system and reason. HECAT^US AND HERODOTUS 21 A notable advance was made by Hecataeus of Miletus, a younger contemporary of Acusilaiis. He was the author of a geography entitled Circuit oj the Earth. The voyages of the lonians to all parts of the Mediterranean and its tributary waters for commerce and colonization supplied him with the knowledge necessary for such a work. If the fragments collected by Miiller, Frag. Hist. GrcRc. I. p. I sqq., actually belong to this treatise, it must have been a great achievement for that age. The genuineness has been questioned, seemingly on insufficient ground (see Jacoby, F., "Hekataios," in Pauly-Wissowa, Real-Encycl. VH. 2667 sqq). His Genealogies differs from those of his predecessors in dealing exten- sively with the historical period. The extant fragments prove, too, that he was gifted with a nascent critical spirit. There can be no doubt that Herodotus drew extensively from him, and that though he is set down among the logographi, he deserves to be called the earUest of historians. From Hecataeus to Herodotus the advance is not so much in critical ability and accuracy of statement as in Uterary genius, in largeness of mind, and amiability of character. It is clear, however, that Herodotus doubted some things which Hecataeus accepted, that in the later writer there was an appreciable growth of the his- torical spirit. Herodotus was born in Halicarnassus, a Dorian city which had become so Ionized as to use the Ionic dialect for official purposes (see Hicks and Hill, no. 27 with comment). Thus it was that this dialect, which Herodotus adopted for his History, was his native speech. He was born in 484 or thereabout and lived through the early years of the Peloponnesian war, to about 425. In early life he was involved in a civil war with Lygdamis, the Carian tyrant of his city. In this struggle his uncle Panyasis, an epical poet of some note, was killed, and Herodotus had to flee into exile, about 452. Thence arose his journe3dngs, which resulted in the creation of his great work. It is not easy or even necessary to deterfnine whether the historian developed from the traveler, or the traveler from the historian. Doubtless the two parallel interests stimulated each other ; and certainly the deUght in geographical and ethnographical knowledge, gained by direct experience and vision, was a leading motive in his Uterary planning. He went to Egypt and ascended 22 THE SOURCES the Nile as far as Elephantine ; he visited Cyrene and Phoenicia ; he traversed the Persian empire as far as Susa. He came into personal acquaintance with the Black Sea region, including the Hellenic communities along its northern shore. For a time he was a citizen of the Periclean colony of Thurii in southern Italy. Attempts have beeti made, with partial success, to establish the chronology of his journeys and of the composition of his history. For a study of this subject the reader is referred to the bibliography given below. The object of his literary labor is expressed in his preface: " This is a presentation of the Inquiry — Historia — of Herodotus of Halicarnassus to the end that time may not obliterate the great and marvellous deeds of the Hellenes and the Barbarians, and especially that the causes for which they waged war with one another may not be forgotten." So far as we know, he is the. first to apply the word Historia to the department of literature of which he was laying the foundation. In his mind the term cause (aMij), far from signifying historical causation in the modern sense, meant in particular the grievances of the parties to the war, which expressed themselves in the series of events leading to that struggle. In tracing these events he narrates from the earliest known times the notable achievements of all the peoples engaged in the great struggle. His production may be described therefore as a universal history, the uhifying element of which is the ultimate conflict. The word history in the sense of inquiry aptly describes his method of collecting information. It is true that he gathered some material from books, but the greater part of his knowledge came through personal inquiry of those who were supposed to know the facts. Not content with what he learned from one class of in- formants or from one locality, he visited different places to make inquiry of different persons (c/. ii. 3, 44) ; thus he introduced the method of comparative inquiry with a view to the sifting of his material. The object of his History, as he conceived it, required him to tell all he had thus heard, but not necessarily to accept it as fact: "I am under obligation to tell what is reported, though I am not bound altogether to believe it ; and let this saying hold good for every narrative in the History." We find him accordingly comparing the less with the more credible account and expressing doubt as to this or that story. HERODOTUS 23 One of the greatest of his qualities is his breadth of mind which enabled him to sympathize with foreigners, and to see that among them there could be good customs, able men, and admirable char- acters (c/. especially iii. 38). Ordinarily this quality lifts him above the prejudices of nationality, of states, and parties to the high level of the universal historian. On the other hand, the very lack of a well-developed critical method placed him at the mercy of his sources. It was but natural that he should gravitate to Athens, already beconndng the intellectual metropolis of the world, and should write from the Athenian point of view, with the prejudices roused in Athens by the opening of the Peloponnesian war (see especially ix. 54). This prejudice colors many of the details of his chapters on Athenian and Peloponnesian history. It was but natural, too, that his chief informants on the internal affairs of Athens during the past were in the Periclean circle; and thus it happens that the enemies of the Alcmeonidae suffer at his hands. He has, for instance, no just appreciation of Themistocles, the founder of Athenian greatness, the ablest statesman who had thus far ap- peared in history. The fault is not one of character ; and in fact no historian has ever been readier to do justice to men than Herodotus. In the religious sphere Herodotus is by no means credulous, but accepts the enlightened orthodoxy of his age. Although a genera- tion younger than ^Eschylus, he looks upon human hfe and human pride essentially with the same eyes. Under the sunny gleam of his rippling narrative there is a substratum of deep melancholy and of the awe concerned with the anger and envy of the gods. King Croesus, whom the auriferous Pactolus made the richest of men, Polycrates, tyrant of Samos, or Periander, despot of opulent Corinth — their pride and their end are merely iterations and reverberations of the stern melody of human success and divine retribution and the humiliation of man, exemplified most signally in Xerxes himself. An exponent of this doctrine is the Great King's adviser Artabanus, from whose lips issues the wisdom of jEschylus: "Thou seest how the Deity strikes with thunderbolt those beasts that tower above their fellows, but the little ones worry him not ; and thou seest also how his missiles always smite the largest bmldings and trees of such kind ; for God loves to trun- 24 THE SOURCES cate all those things that rise too high. Thus, too, a large army may be ruined by a small one, when God in his jealousy hurls a panic or a thunderbolt, through which they are shockingly de- stroyed; for God permits none but himself to entertain grand ideas" (vii. lo. 5). BIBLIOGRAPHY I. LoGOGRAPHi. — Christ, Griech. Lit. I (1909). 424-34; Bury, Ancient Greek Historians, lect. i ; Busolt, Griech. Gesch, I. 146-50 ; Gercke and Nor- den, Einleitung in die Altertumswissensckafl, III (1912). 76-8. Schwartz, "Akusilaus," in Pauly-Wissowa, Real-Encycl. I. 1222 sq. Fragments in Miiller, Frag. hist. grac. I. 100-103. Jacoby, F., "Hekataios," in Paidy- Wissowa, op. cit. VII. 2666-769; Bunbury, E. H., History vf Ancient Geog- raphy (London, 1883), I. ch. v; Berger, H., Geschichte der wiss. Erdkunde bei den Griechen (Leipzig, 1903), see Index. Pirro, "Studi erodotei, Ecateo e Xante," in Stttdi Storici, I (Pisa, 1893). 424 sqq. Fragments in Miiller, op. cit. 1. 1-31. II. Herodotus. — Report on recent literature, in Jahresb. 191b. Stand- ard critical edition by Stein, H., 2 vols., Berlin, 1869-71. The same editor's annotated edition, 5 vols. (Berlin, 1883-93), Bks. iv-vi (1895), vii-ix (1908), ed. with excellent commentary by Macan, R. W. (London). How, W. W., and Wells, J., Commentary on Herodotus, 2 vols. (Oxford: Clarendon Press, 191 2). English translations by Rawlinson, G., 4 vols, with abundant notes (3d ed., London, 1874) ; Macaulay, G. C, 2 vols. (Macmillan, 1890). Selections taken from the latter for this volume have been revised on the basis of the Greek text by E. G. S. Hauvette, A., H&rodote historien des guerres mSdiques (Paris, 1894) ; "Hero- dote et les loniens,'' in Revue des Studes grecques, I. 257 sqq. ; Hock, A., Hero- dot und sein Geschichtswerk (Gtitersloh, 1904) ; Kirchhoff, A., Ueber die Ent- stehungszeit des herodoteischen Gesckichtswerkes (2d ed., Berlin, 1878) ; Diels, H., "Herodot und Hekataios," in Hermes, XXII (1887). 411-444; Lipsius, J. H., "Der Schluss des herod. Werks," in Leipziger Studien, XX (1902). 195-202; Grassl, A., Herodot als Ethnologe; ein Beitrag zur Geschichte der Volkerkunde (Munich, 1904) ; Myres, J. L., "Herodotus and Anthropology," in Marett, R. R., Anthropology and the Classics (1908), 121-68; Croiset, A., "La veracit6 d'HIrodote," in Reme des etudes grecques, I. 154 sqq.; Sihler, E. G., Testimonium AnimcB, 159-68; Bury, Ancient Greek Historians, lect. ii. VII. Hellanicus and Thucydides; Inscriptions Hellanicus of Mytilene lived to see the close of the Peloponnesian war, and occupied accordingly a place next after that of Herodotus. In spirit and method, however, he connected closely with the HELLANICUS 25 logographi ; his chief interest was in myth and genealogy. It was his task to carry much farther than his predecessors the extension and systematizing of pedigrees. As a basis he seems to have taken the list of priestesses in the Argive Heraeum (see his Priestesses of Hera, in Miiller, Frag. hist. grmc. I. p. 51 sq.) . In the form in which he employed it, this list, beginning in the thirteenth century B.C., continued unbroken to his own time, and included the number of years that each priestess officiated (Frag. 53, Miiller). It is evi- dent that the first five centuries or thereabout were fictitious, but we cannot say through whose hands the reconstruction took place. A part of the work of Hellanicus was to bring the early chronology of other states into harmony with that of Argos. In his Atthis — Attic chronicle — for example, he inserted new names in the exist- ing list of kings in order to synchronize Athenian with Argive his- tory ; and we may assume that in the case of other states his method was similar. His works, Baotica, Argolica, Lesbica, Thettalica, Founding of Chios, etc., included all or nearly all Hellenic countries, while accounts of prominent foreign nations were given in his Concerning Lydia, Phosnicica, ^gyptiaca, Persica, etc. (c/. Miiller, op. cit. I. pp. 45-69) . It seems clear that the chronological outline of early Hellas accepted by later authors was largely his work. The portion dealing with the period anterior to about 750 is almost wholly fictitious, an arbitrary system of myth and actual invention joined with an extremely scant and uncertain tradition. While his chief interest was in remote antiquity, he treated meagerly of recent times. His Atthis extended to the close of the Peloponnesian war. While we possess mere shreds of the vast works of Hellanicus, we are fortunate in having the entire production of Thucydides, universally reputed the greatest of ancient historians. We do not know when he was born. He says (v. 26) that at the beginning of the Peloponnesian war he was at the height of his power, a state- ment which would make him perhaps about thirty years old at the time, and he must have died soon after the close of the Pelopon- nesian war, as he left his History of that conflict unfinished. He was related to Cimon, the Athenian general and statesman, and was probably with him a descendant of the Thracian chief Olorus. 26 THE SOURCES Evidently these connections gave him an interest in the gold mines^ at Scapte-Hyle, Thrace. A man of wealth and of distinguished family, he was elected to the board of generals for the year 424. His failure to protect Amphipolis from the Lacedaemonians under Brasidas, whatever may have been its cause, resulted in his exile for twenty years, 424-404. We do not know whether he was actually banished or withdrew in fear of trial and condemnation. However that may have been, his exile presented to the wealthy man of affairs a leisure which he resolutely and consistently used in the collection of information for his history of the war. From its very beginning, 431, nay even before the outbreak of hostilities, he had conceived the purpose of writing this history. It was a well-matured resolution. Probably no man in the Hellenic world, not even Herodotus, had at the time so good a knowledge and so clear a grasp of Hellenic affairs. This preparation he enlarged by the persistent industry of his long exile in gathering all ppssible facts relating to the conflict. The period anterior to the war he surveys by way of introduction to his theme ; and yet this portion, brief as it is, is of the highest value not only for the facts it contains, but also as an illustration of the author's method: "The character of the events which pre- ceded (the war), whether immediately or in more remote antiquity, owing to the lapse of time cannot be made out with certainty" (i. i). This utterance is likely to weaken our faith in the logo- graphic accounts of early Hellas. If the events of the Persian war and of the pentecontaetia which followed, 480-431, could not be made out with certainty by Thucydides, it would be absurd for us to accept the Greek stories of so remote happenings, as for instance ^ the Dorian migration. The difficulty of knowing the past, he con- tinues, lies partly in the nature of our sources. For the Trojan j war, which he regards as a fact, he has the authority of Homer: "He was a poet, and may therefore be expected to exaggerate" (i. 10). The difficulty Kes partly, too, in our dependence on oral tradition: "Men do not discriminate, and too readily receive ancient traditions about their own as well as about other coun- tries" (i. 20). Even regarding events of a hundred years before his time, events of profound interest to his countrymen, they entertained the grossest misconceptions. Notwithstanding these THUCYDIDES 27 uncertainties the historian sketches the political development and the progress of civilization from the earliest time to the beginning of the war (i. 2-23) : "Yet anyone who upon the grounds I have given arrives at some such conclusion as my own about those ancient times, would not be far wrong. He must not be misled by the exaggerated fancies of the poets or by the tales of logographi, who seek to please the ear rather than to speak the truth. He cannot test their accounts ; and most of the facts in the lapse of ages have passed into the regions of romance. At such a distance he must make up his mind to be satisjSed with conclusions resting upon the clearest evidence which can be had" (i. 21). He attempts to reconstruct the primitive condition of Hellas (i) from survivals of customs and conditions. Certain tribes re- mained primitive down to his own day, and he infers that all the Hellenes once lived as did these tribes in his time. These conclu- sions, he adds, are confirmed by the ancient poets (i. 5, 6). (2) He makes use of archasology. The primitive islanders he studied by means of their tombs. When the Athenians purified Delosin the Peloponnesian war and opened the tombs in that island, it appeared that more than half of the occupants were Carian, as was - proved by their arms and their mode of burial (i. 8). He is wrong, however, in supposing that he here has evidence of race; he has proved only that the occupants had a civilization like that of the present Carians. His method of drawing deductions from the survival of customs and conditions and from archaeological remains and of making allowances for the mistakes and exaggerations of earlier authors has been adopted by modern historians. Historians before Thucydides liriiited themselves to the time before the Persian war or to that war itself. The period interven- ing between the Persian and the Peloponnesian war was omitted by all with the exception of Hellanicus ; and he, where he touched upon it in his Attic chronicle (Syngraphe), was very brief, and in his chronology inaccurate (i. 97). Thucydides adopts what he considers a better chronological system: "I would have a person reckon the actual periods of time and not rely upon catalogues of the archons or other official personages whose names may be used in different cities to mark the dates of past events. For whether an event occurred in the beginning or in the middle, or whatever 28 THE SOURCES might be the exact point of a magistrate's term of office, is left uncertain by such a mode of reckoning. But if he measures by summers and winters as they are here set down, and counts each summer and each winter as a half year, he will find that ten summers and ten winters have passed in the first part of the war" (v. 20). The advantage of reckoning time by the natural year, rather than by the conflicting civil years of the various states, Thucydides fully appreciates, although he seems to have no conception of the importance of an era of chronology for fixing the period of his history in its appropriate universal relation. This shortcoming is probably due in the main to the concentra- tion of his attention upon the present, which he regards as all- important: "Former ages were not great either in their wars or in anything else" (i. i) ; "The greatest achievement of former times was the Persian war ; yet even this conflict was decided in two battles by sea and two by land. The Peloponnesian war, on the other hand, was a protracted struggle, and attended by calam- ities such as HeUas had never known within a like period of time. Never were so many cities captured and depopulated — some by barbarians, others by Hellenes themselves fighting against one another. . . . Never were exile and slaughter more frequent, whether in the war or in civil strife. . . . There were earthquakes unparalleled in their extent and fury, and ecKpses of the sun more numerous than are recorded to have happened in any former age ; there were also in some places great droughts causing famines, and lastly the plague, which did immense harm and destroyed numbers of people" (i. 23). This high valuation of the present as compared with the past he shares with the sophists. He is at one with them also in his desire to impart useful information. The chief object of Herodotus had been to entertain the public, that of Thucydides was to furnish information useful to the general and statesman: "Very likely the strict historical character of my narrative may be disappointing to the ear. But if he who desires to have before his eyes a true picture of the events which have happened, and of the like events which may be expected to happen hereafter in the order of human affairs, shall pronounce what I have written to be useful, then I shall be satisfied. My history is a possession for- ever, not a prize composition to be heard and forgotten" (i. 23). THUCYDIDES 29 Although it is now recognized that history does not repeat itself, there can be no doubt that a knowledge of the past greatly aids the statesman in maturing his judgment and in enlarging his ex- perience of human affairs. Such knowledge must above all things be accurate; and this quality Thucydides claims for himself: "As to the events of the war I have not ventured to speak from any chance information, nor according to any notion of my own; I have described nothing but what I either saw myself or learned from others, of whom I made the most careful and particular inquiry. The task was laborious because eye-witnesses of the same occur- rences give different accounts of them according as they remember or are interested in the actions of one side or the other" (i. 22). It is universally granted that Thucydides, though by no means infallible, possesses the quality of accuracy in an extraordinarily high degree. His theme is extremely narrow — a war rather than a period of national development ; yet within this limited field he is deep and thorough. With marvelous analytical power he lays bare the spirit of government and the soul of political factions. When he has to do with persons, he tells us nothing of their outward appear- ance, their habits, or mannerisms, but reveals the mind only. His philosophy has taught him that as a rule the individual counts for Httle in history. The life of a nation is the surging of mighty cur- rents, in which ordinary statesmen are mere straws whose move- ments indicate the ebb and flow and conflict of forces. A few master spirits combine reason and force in a sufl&cient degree to control the destinies of their people. They have their creative plan, which they are able to realize by bending the masses to their will. Such were preeminently Themistocles and Pericles. They have a uni- versal and eternal interest, whereas a Cleon or Hyperbolus is the t3^e of a politician ofttimes repeated. A large place in his history is occupied by the speeches, which must not be taken as verbatim reports : "As to the speeches which were made either before or during the war, it was hard for me and for others to recollect the exact words. I have therefore put into the mouth of each speaker the sentiments appropriate to the oc- casion, expressed as I thought he would be likely to express them, while at the same time I endeavored as nearly as I could to give 30 THE SOURCES the general purport of what was actually said" (i. 22). They are usually grouped in pairs expressing the opposing" sides of a crisis, and may be regarded as largely the author's interpretation of the situation or the events to which they apply. In the year 411 his narrative comes abruptly to an end. At that point he seems to have ceased writing, to devote his attention to the revision of the part already written — a work which he did not complete before his death ; for the fifth and eighth books lack his stylistic finish. A means of verifjong and correcting our literary sources and of greatly enlarging our knowledge of Hellenic life is afiford'ed by the inscriptions. Reference is made to Minoan writing in the introduc- tion to Chapter II. With the decline of the Minoan civilization the art of writing seems to have been lost to Hellas, and the Greek alpha- bet was not invented before the tenth, or possibly the ninth, century. Jn the seventh century, with the first importation of papyrus from Egypt, writing began to be extensively used. From that century, too, come the earliest extant inscriptions. They appear in increas- ing numbers during the sixth century and in the fifth they become abundant. From that time to the end of ancient civilization they are among the most important of our sources. BIBLIOGRAPHY I. Hellanicus. — Fragments in Miiller, Frag. hist, greec. I. 45-69 ; IV. 629 sqq. Kullmer, H., "Die historiai des Hellanikos von Lesbos," in Jahrb. f. kl. Phil. Supplb. XXVII (1901). 455-698, an attempt at reconstruction; Von Wilamowitz-Moellendorff, Arist. u. Ath. II. 19 sq.; Bury, Anc. Greek Historians, 27 sqq. ; Perrin, in Am. Journ. Philol. XXII (1901). 38 sqq. The most recent and thorough treatment is by Gudeman, "Hellanikos," in Pauly- Wissowa, Red-Encycl. VIII (191 2). 104-55. II. THUC-romES. — Critical edition by Bekker (2d ed., Berlin, 1892); by Poppo, E. F., rev. by Stahl, J. M., 4 vols. (Leipzig, 1875-89) ; by Sitzler, J. (Gotha, 1891-igoi) ; by Hude, C, 2 vols. (Leipzig, 1898, 1901) ; by Jones, H. S. (Oxford: Clarendon Press, 1902); with detailed explanatory notes by Classen, J., 8 vols. (4th ed., Berlin, 1897). The best English translation is . by Jowett, B. (see review by Freeman, E. A., in Fortnightly Review, 1882, pp. 273-92). Selections from this translation for the present volume have been revised and improved by comparison with the Greek text by E. G. S. Reports of recent literature on Thucydides in Jahresb. 1905, 1908; and by Lange, E., "Die Arbeiten zu Thukydides seit 1890," in PhOollMl (1897). COMPETITIVE GAMES 31 658-711 ; LVII (1898). 436-500. 658. See also Cornford, F. M., Thucydides Mythhistoricus (London: Arnold, 1907); Grundy, G. B., Thucydides and the History of his Age (London: Murray, 191 1) ; Bury, J. B., Ancient Greek His- torians, lect. iii; Meyer, Ed., "Thukydides und die Entstehung der wissen- schaftlichen Geschichte," in Mitt, des Wiener Vereins der Freunde des hum. Gymn. XIV; Forsch. II (1899). 269-436; Kirchhoff, A., "Ueber die von Thukydides benutzten Urkunden," in Berl. Akad., 1881-1884; Biidinger, M., Poesie und Urkunde hei Thukydides (Vienna, 1891); Jebb, R. C, "Speeches of Thucydides," in Essays and Addresses (Cambridge, 1907), 359-445 ; Lange, E., Thukydides und sein Geschichtswerk (Giitersloh, 1893) ; Von Wilamowitz- Moellendorff, "Die Thukydides-Legende," in Herm. XII (1877). 326-67; Aristoteles und Athen, I. 99-120; MUchhofer, A., "Athen und Thukydides ii. IS," in Philol. LV (1896). 170-9; Petersen, E., "Zu Thukydides. Urathen und Tettix," in Rhein. Mm. LXII (1907). 536-49; Morris, C, "Chronology of the irtvTTjKovTaerta," in Am. Journ. Philol. VII (1886). 323-43 ; Busolt, Griech. Gesch. III. 616-93; Kornemann, E., "Thukydides und die romische Historiographie," in Philol. LXIII (1904). 148-53. VIII. The Fifth-century Poets For the spirit of the great age of Hellas, 480-404 B.C., its social customs and thought, religious rites and aspirations, moral and intellectual attainments and ideals, we 'have to depend upon the poets even more than upon the historians. The study of Pindar leads us to the very heart of the national games, which were among the most characteristic of Hellenic activities. The devotion of the Greeks to competitions was in a high degree stimulating and fruitful. The fact that their communities were small and isolated, either surrounded by water or narrowly limited by mountain ranges, added importance to their •• periodic reunions, "all-gatherings" (panegyreis). In time as they spread in colonies to the mouth of the Nile, to Cyprus, to the Black Sea, to Sicily and southern Italy, and to the coasts of Gaul and Spain, these gatherings, with the contests which gradually grew more diversified, came to be almost the only form of union known to their national life. The competitions (agones) were connected with their legends and re- ligion, with their literature and art. They furnished, too, a sphere in which music was almost equal to the other forms of art in dignity, importance, and technical development. The games were many and were frequently held. In addition to the annual festivals of every city, there were four great national games : those at Olympia 32 THE SOURCES and Delphi came once in four years, the Isthmia and Nemea once in two years. Through his Odes of Victory (Epinikia) Pindar of Boeotia (about 520-441) is one of the most important exponents of the Greek spirit. His relations were mainly with the rich and great. They alone were able not only to contend at the national games, but also to remu- nerate the poet, whose Muse wrought for money. He was the com- poser not only of the verses but also of the accompan3Tng music and the instructor who trained the chorus chosen to chant the Odes. As the singers had to be taken from the locality where the prize-winner resided, or at the place of the actual contest, it is clear that Pindar had the opportunity through visit and sojourn to make himself acquainted with many parts of Hellas. His rivalry with his eminent contemporary Simonides was noted by their own generation. Hieron of Syracuse was patron of both. To the modern reader Pindar's most striking feature is the heavy propor- tion of myth and legend in these choral odes. The reason is not only that the several communities, but specifically the more emi- nent families therein, so cherished legendary traditions that their very pedigree and pride of race were inextricably bound up with such myths. Thus the tone of the Odes is essentially noble and lofty, and the spirit intensely aristocratic. Pindar was a contemporary of ^schylus. There are many points of resemblance between them, and their handling of legends is not essentially different. In the nature of the case the lyre of the Boeotian devoted itself to the happy and brilliant side of myth and of human life, whereas the tragic poet necessarily presented their somber aspects. In style Pindar, like ^schylus, is bold, original, and elevated. Many obscurities of allusion may never be cleared up ; and the texts, without the music, without the choral chanting, without the well- ordered movements of the original production in strophe, antis- trophe, and epode, in its present effects must fall far short of the poet's actual achievement. In addition to choral lyric Pindar composed many forms of poetry. His writings were collected in seventeen books, probably by the Alexandrine scholar Aristophanes of Byzantium. Dio- nysius of Halicarnassus makes the same scholar responsible, too, | for the editing of the lines and the metrical schemes. PINDAR AND ^SCHYLUS 33 Valuable to the student of Greek history are Pindar's ideas on religion, morals, and other features of society. From what has already been said it will be understood that these ideas are decidedly conservative, aristocratic. This side of Hellenic life and thought is especially recommended for examination in view of the fact that most modern histories of the fifth century treat abnost exclusively of democratic ideas and movements. A contemporary of Pindar was .^schylus of Athens, who was born in 525. When the Persians were driven back to their fleet at Marathon, 490, he was in the prime of manhood and fought on that field. In the time of Xerxes' invasion he witnessed the abandon- ment of town and country, and Persian torches in the sanctuaries and homes of Athens, a requital for the burning of Sardis. These experiences were the inspiration of his life's work. In his earlier career he was a composer of what we may roughly compare with modern cantatas and oratorios. His choruses sang; and only gradually, as two actors were introduced, his productions became more distinctly dramatic. He composed about seventy plays, not counting the so-called satyr dramas ; the' function of the latter was to lighten the gloom and the severe strain superinduced by the presentation of the three tragedies which each of the authors pro- duced in competition for the first prize, ^schylus distinctly ex- celled the competitors of his earlier manhood and middle life, such as Phr)Tiichus and Pratinas. He came forward for the first time in 500 B.C., and, according to the Marmor Parium, gained his first victory, i.e. the First Prize, in 485. In all, he won this distinction thirteen times, each time with three pieces : thus thirty-nine of his tragedies were crowned. Twice he visited Sicily : the first time, it seems, in consequence of an invitation by Hieron, tyrant of Syracuse, whose splendid generosity to men of letters, such as Pindar and Simonides, was well known to that generation. In 468, at the first competition in which Sophocles appeared on the Attic stage, the latter triumphed over the veteran. It was not for this reason, however, as some have imagined, that^schylus retired from Athens to Sicily. The brilliant court of Hieron, the great demand in Syracuse for dramatic productions, were sufficient attractions. His last days were spent in Gela, where he died in 456. 34 THE SOURCES The austere loftiness of ^schylus was coupled with a genuine rehgious spirit, deepened by the stirring experiences of the struggle with Persia. He was bold, original, and creative — in a large sense the intellectual and moral parent of the succeeding Attic dramatists and of the philosophers. Sophocles, mentioned above as a younger rival of ^Eschylus, lived through the greater part of the fifth century, 496-406. Though he learned much from his elder contemporary, he belongs distinctly to a new age. Whereas ^schylus gives expression to the notable achievements and gigantic aspirations of the war heroes, Sophocles represents the calmer and more reasoned spirit of the Periclean age. The father of Sophocles was a manufacturer, probably of knives and swords ; so that the Peloponnesian war, while impoverishing the majority of Athenians, by no means dimin- ished his income or detracted from the serenity of his life. His easy circumstances, joined with a naturally balanced character, found reflection in his dramas. For the problems of religion and of human life and character he was inclined to accept gentle solu- tions. In opposition to the sophistic movement he was strongly conservative, and in religion he represents, with Herodotus, an enlightened orthodoxy. We appreciate him as a man of wonderful intellectual and moral strength, as well as a perfect master of dra- matic art, in brief, as the highest expression of Hellenism both in the age of Pericles and in the subsequent conflict between conservatism and the more modern thought of Euripides and the sophists. Euripides was about fifteen years younger than Sophocles^ though both died in 406. Throughout his life, therefore, he was a rival of the older poet. In the conflict, however, between Hellen- ism and modernism which arose within this century Euripides was wholly for the new movement. Thus it happens, that though iEschylus and Sophocles, when compare,d with one another, stand an age apart, they should be placed together in contrast with Eurip- ides. We know little of his life. His father seems to have been a landowner of moderate circumstances but of no distinction ; and certainly the gifted son was free from all aristocratic connections with the past. As a youth he had an athletic training, and it is said that he afterward studied as a painter ; at all events he had a keen eye for art and landscape. Of science and philosophy he SOPHOCLES AND EURIPIDES 35 learned what he could from books. While attaching himself to no system, he shows a lively interest in all manner of philosophic problems. With the sophists he rejects traditional reUgion; and in Ms own field he casts away the art of his predecessors, to build the drama anew on principles which we recognize as relatively modern. He shows a deep and varied knowledge of human nature, and especially sympathizes with the weak and unfortu- nate, with women, slaves, beggars, and cripples. While as an exponent of Hellenism Sophocles has a voice for the Greeks only and their admirers, the humanism of Euripides appeals to the world. In the use of dramatic Kterature as a historical source we have to consider (i) what elements are traditional-, (2) what are the ideas of the poet, (3) what is contemporary thought or custom. In considering the personal element of the author we have further to distinguish between settled conviction and the passing thought or feeling assigned to a character. The persons and the essentials of the plot are an inheritance from the remote past, from the epics and especially from those of the cycle ; the rest of the drama is the poet's creation from his own imagination, character, and environ- ment. Beyond this point the problem of analysis is complex and difficult, and incapable of solution by any ready-made process. Each drama requires individual study ; and although there is much that defies analysis, it cannot be doubted that the plays of the three great tragic poets constitute an invaluable store of informa- tion relating to the customs, thought, feehng, and character of the Hellenes in the most splendid period of their history. Much later than was the case with tragedy did the Attic govern- ment recognize comedy and provide choruses for it. This occurred probably between 465 and 460. In a certain sense the Old Comedy of Athens is but a single symptom, but certainly the most significant symptom, of that absolute freedom of speech (•n-apprja-ia) which attained its most unbridled development in the Peridean democracy. Aristophanes, born about 450, was a mere lad when Pericles died. A few years later the young genius, incomparably endowed for pohtical satire — beyond all Dean Swifts or Punches of a later time — secured from the archon choruses for the children of his rollicking muse. His first three pla.ys, Daitdgs (Banqueters), 36 THE SOURCES 427 B.C., The Babylonians, 426, and The Acharnians, 425, were pre- sented under the imaginary authorship of an actor, Callistratus. It was long the custom, as in the heavy and ultra-serious essay by Ferdinand Ranke, to assign to the author of the Knights, Clottds, Wasps, Peace, Birds, and Frogs a niche among the thoughtful patriots, deep political thinkers, and even moral reformers who gave lasting distinction to Athens. On this subject, however, there is room for difference of opinion. It is always a question how far our poet should be taken seriously. Thucydides and his great work afford a curious foil to the political comedy of the Pelopon- nesian war : they iUumine one another in the most admirable man- ner. The faculty of sjmibolical caricature and a drastic felicity of allegory and invective, intermingled with lofty lyrics and harle- quinade, language sometimes running on the even keel of current Attic dialogue, but often interlarded with sudden and incalculable spurts of slang and vulgarity, an abandon of obscenity and semi- intoxication of demeanor — all in close harmony with the es- sential character of the vintage festivals — sudden attacks on some familiar minor figures, with sustained persecution of some greater personage in public life — these, and many other ingredients may be found in the plays of Aristophanes. Besides the eleven plays preserved he wrote about twenty-nine others. Was the poKtical influence of an Aristophanes comparable to that of the orators who addressed the Ecclesia directly, when all were sober and in a deliberative frame of mind? Plato has borne witness that the caricature of Socrates in the Clouds had a lasting and an evil effect on the reputation of that philosopher. The t3^ical humanist who would duly revere both the philosopher and his reckless traducer finds himself in a somewhat difficult plight. That Aristophanes pleaded for peace, and that, with his brilliant and piercing intellect, he discerned the evils of the developed Attic democracy cannot be denied ; but it seems to be equally true that sheer love of fun in- terfered with the earnest pursuit of any serious object. BIBLIOGRAPHY I. Pindar. — Edition by Christ, W. (2d ed. , Teubner, 1896) ; by Schroder, O., in Bergk, Th., Poetm lyrici graci, I (Teubner, 1900). Olympian and Pythian Odes, by Gildersleeve, B. L. (2d ed., N. Y., 1890). The best translation is by ' ARISTOPHANES; BIBLIOGRAPHY 37 Myers, E. (MacmiUan, 1892), from which selections have been taken for this volume. Wilamowitz-MoellendorfE, V., "Hieron und Pindaros," in Sitzb. Berl. Akad. 1901, pp. 1273-1318; Christ, Griech. Lit. I. 216-35. II. BACCHVLmES. — Editio princeps of the newly discovered poems by Kenyon, F. G. (London, 1897) ; also by Blass, F. (3d ed., Teubner, 1904) ; by Jebb, R. C, with introduction, notes, and prose translation (Cambridge, 1905). There is also an English translation by Poste, E. (Macmillan, 1898). See further the article by Jebb on Bacchylides in Encycl. Brit, nth ed. ; Meiser, O., Mythograpkische UrUersuchungen zu Bacchyl. (Munich, 1904), dissertation. Although no selections have been made from Bacchylides for this volume, he may be recommended for study along with Pindar. III. iEscHYLUS. — Edition by Weil, H. (2d ed., Teubner, 1907) ; by Campbell, L. (Macmillan, 1898); by Sidgwick, A. (Clarendon Press, 1902). English translation by Blackie, J. W. (London: Parker, 1850), verse; by Headlam, W., 5 vols. (London: Bell, 1900-08), from revised text; by Plump- tre, E. H., 2 vols. (Boston : Heath, 1901) ; text with verse translation by Way, A. S., 3 pts. (Macmillan, 1906-08), from which selections, revised by E. G. S., have been made for this volume; Persians, Seven against Thebes, Prometheus, and Suppliants, by Morsehead (Macmillan, 1908). Myers, E., "/Eschylus," in Abbott, E., Hellenica (London: Rivingtons, 1880), 1-32; Cauer, F., "Aischylos und der Areopag," in Rhein. Mus. L (189s). 348-565 Sihler, E. G., Testimonium Ani^, 148-59; V. Wilamowitz- MoellendorflE, "Die Buhne des .Eschylus," in Hermes, XXI (1886). 597-622; Dieterich, "Aischylos," in Pauly-Wissowa, Real-Encycl. I. 1065-84. IV. Sophocles. — Edition by Schneidewin, F. W., and Nauck, A. (Ber- lin, 1897-1909) ; by Tyrrell, R. V. (London, 1897) ; by Campbell, L., and Abbott, E., 2 vols. (Oxford, 1899, 1900) ; with explanatory notes by Wecklein, N., 2 vols. (Munich, 1897) ; by Jebb, R. C, plays in separate vols, with copious notes and Eng. trans. (Cambridge: University Press). Translations by Whitelaw, R. (Longmans, 1904) ; by Storr, F. (Loeb CI. Libr. 1912, 1913) ; by Campbell, L. (London: Frowde, 1906) ; by Way, A. S., 2 vols. (Macmillan, 1909, 1914); by Coleridge, E. P. (Bohn); by Jebb, R. C. (Cambridge: Uni- versity Press, 1912), from which the selections for this volume have been taken. For studies in the author, see Campbell, L., Sophocles (Macmillan, 1880) ; Abbott, E., " Theology and Ethics of Sophocles," in Hellenica (London, 1880). 33-66; Tyrrell, R. Y., Essays on Greek Literature (London, 1909) ; Post, C. R., "Dramatic Art of Sophocles," in Eari). St. in CI. Philol. XXIII (1912). 71-129 ; Miiller, A., Msthetischer Kommentar zu den Tragodien des Sophokles (Pader- bom, 1904) ; Patin, A., Msthetisch-kritische Studien zu Sophokles (Paderborn, 191 1) ; Sihler, E. G., Testimonium AnimcB, ch. ix. ; Botsford, Hellenic History, eh. xvii. § 2. V. Euripides. — Edition by Prinz, R., and Wecklein, N., 3 vols. (Leipzig, 1883-1902) ; by Nauck, A., 3 vols. (3d ed., Teubner, 1892-1895) ; by Murray G., 2 vols. (Oxford, 1902, 1905). Among the editions of individual 38 THE SOURCES plays especially valuable for interpretative matter are Wilamowitz-Moellen- dorff, U. v., Herakles, 2 vols. (2d ed., Berlin, 1895); Eippolytos (Berlin, 189s). The scholia are edited by Schwartz, E., 2 vols. (Berlin, 1887, 1895). Translations by Way, A. S., with text, Loeb CI. Libr., 4 vols. (Macmillan, 1912) ; Coleridge, E. P., 2 vols. (Bohn) ; Medea, Trojan Women and Electra by Murray, G. (Oxford, 1907). The selections for this volume are from Coleridge and Way. For studies in Euripides, see Macurdy, G. H., Chronology of the Extant Plays 0} Euripides. Diss. (Lancaster, Pa., 1905) ; Decharme, P., Euripides and the Spirit of his Dramas, trans, by Loeb, J. (Macmillan, 1905) ; Murray, G., Euripides and his Age (Holt, 1913) ; Verrall, A. W., Euripides the Ra- tionalist; a Study of Art and Religion (Cambridge : University Press, 1913) ; Steiger; H., Euripides, seine Dichtung und seine Personlichkeit (Leipzig: Dieterich, 191 2) ; Haussleiter, F., Ueher die Frage der SittUcHkeit bei SophoMes und Euripides (Erlangen, 1907); Bartels, R., Beziehung zu Athen und seiner Geschichte in den Dramen des Euripides, Progr. (Berlin, 1889) ; Huddilston, J. H., Greek Art in Euripides, Aischylos and Sophokles, Diss. (Munich, 1898) ; Sihler, Testimonium Anim^, ch. x. ; KirchhoS, C, Dramatische Orchestik der Hellenen (Leipzig, 1899) ; Verrall, A. W., The Bacchants of Euripides and other Essays (Cambridge: University Press, 1910) ; Nestle, W., "Die Bacchen des Euripides," in Philol. LVIII (1899). 362-400. Fragments erf all the tragic poets : Nauck, A., Tragicorum grcecorum frag- menta (2d ed., Teubner, 1889). VI. Akistophanes. — Edition by Leeuwen, J. van (Leiden, 1893-1906) ; by Hall, F. W., and others (Clarendon Press, 1902) ; facsimile of the Codex Venetus Marcianus 474 by White, J. W. (Boston, 1902) ; text with translation and explanatory notes by Rogers, B. B., each play in a separate vol. (Macmil- lan, 1902-), from which selections for the present volume have been taken. Scholia by Rutherford, W. G., 3 vols. (London, 189&-190S). Translations, « in addition to Rogers, by Walsh, B. D., 3 vols. (London, 1837) ; by Hickie, W. J., 2 vols. (Bohn) ; select plays by Frere, J. H. (London: Routledge, 1887). Dunbar, H., Complete Concordance to the Comedies and Fragments of Aris- tophanes (Oxford, 1883) ; Miiller-Striibing, H., Aristophanes und die historiscke Kritik, etc. (Leipzig, 1873) ; Mazon, P., Essai sur la composition des comldies d' Aristophanes (Paris, 1904) ; Leeuwen, J. van. Prolegomena ad Aristophanem (Leiden, 1908) ; Sihler, E. G., De parodiis comicorum gmcorum, etc. (Leipzig, 187s) ; White, J. W., "The 'Stage' in Aristophanes," in Harv. St. in CI. Philol. II (1891). 159-205; Richards, H., Aristophanes and Others (London: G. Richards, 1909) ; Suss, W., Aristophanes und die Nachwdt, 2 vols. (Leipzig, 1911) ; Emerson, A., "On the Conception of Low Comedy in Aristophanes," in Am. Journ. Philol. X (1889). 265-79; Droysen, J. G., "Des Aristophanes Vogel und die Hermokopiden," in Kleine Schriften (2d ed., 1894). 1-51 ; Kock, Th., "Aristophanes als Dichter und PoUtiker," in Rhein. Mus. XXXIX (1884). 118-40; Croiset, M., Aristophanes and the Political Parties at Athens, trans. by Loeb, J. (Macmillan, 1909); Willems, A., "Aristophane et la ddmocratie XENOPHON 39 Ath6menne," in Acad. roy. de Belg. Bull. 1907, pp. 338-73; Sheppard, J. T., "Politics in the Frogs of Aristophanes," in /. H. S. XXX (1910). 249-59; Jebb, R. C, "Aristophanes," in Encycl. Brit. s. v. (nth ed.) ; Kaibel, G., "Aristophanes," in Pauly-Wissowa, Real-Encycl. s. v. IX. The Fourxh-century Historians and Chroniclers Whereas in general the fourth century is the great age of prose, of oratory and philosophy, in history we find a notable decline. Xenophon, whose works are preserved to us mainly by the interest of after ages in Socrates, is far inferior to Thucydides. Xenophon was born about the beginning of the Peloponnesian war and lived to 354 or thereabout. As a member of a well-to-do family of pro- nounced conservative sentiments he grew up in the narrow laco- nizing circle of aristocrats at Athens, whose most commendable interests lay in athletics, hunting, and the exercise of conventional virtue and religion. It was his good fortune to become a pupil of Socrates, whose character and teachings were henceforth the in- spiration of his hfe. The pupil's Memorabilia of Socrates not only gives the author's impressions of the great teacher, but forms an invaluable source for the social condition of Athens during the Peloponnesian war and the early years of the fourth century. His Anabasis describes the expedition of Cyrus the Younger against his brother Artaxerxes the Persian king, and more particularly the retreat of the Ten Thousand Greeks who had accompanied Cyrus as mercenaries. Among the Greeks was Xenophon, who after the death of Cyrus in battle was elected to their board of generals, and who according to his own account was the inspiring genius of the retreat. His narrative affords us a rare insight into this mer- cenary force, its organization and spirit, and the characters of prominent officers. At the same time it gives interesting infor- mation concerning the covmtries and peoples along the route. The pubHcation of the work must have had an important influence on the Hellenic attitude toward Persia. The chief historical product of this author is the Hellenica, a continuation of the history of Thucydides. It is a narrative of Hellenic affairs during the period extending from 411 to the battle of Mantineia, 362. The greater part of the work (bks. iii-vii) was • composed while the author was an exile from Athens and a prot6g6 40 THE SOURCES of Sparta. It represents, accordingly, the Lacedaemonian point of view. Although in comparison with the history of Thucydides it is shallow and partisan, we value it as our only continuous nar- rative of the period which it covers. The author has the qualities of a biographer rather than of a historian ; and for that reason the Hellenica shows an interest in personal traits and incidents, which are totally wanting in Thucydides but which appeal strongly to the student of Hellenic life and culture. Xenophon had a wide ex- perience with the world; and in his breadth of mind, his liberal education, and his ethical and religious principles he represents the best features of the cultured class of his generation. Other works of the author, such as his Constitution of the Lacedcemonians, Economicus, and Ways and Means, of great value as sources, are introduced in their appropriate places. We are made to feel keenly the loss of the great historians of the fourth century by the recent discovery of a fragment of what was evidently a far more detailed and more valuable Hellenica than that of Xenophon. It is published by Grenfell and Hunt, Oxy- rhynchus Papyri, V (1908). 147 sqq. The fragment gives an ac- count of the events of 396, and includes a surprisingly interesting digression on the Boeotian federal constitution. Scholars assign the treatise variously to Theopompus, Ephorus, and Cratippus. On the whole the weight of evidence seems to incline in favor of the last-named historian. Both Thucydides and Xenophon are philosophic, akin to the sophists and Socrates. After Xenophon and Cratippus the greater part of the historical field is usurped by rhetoric, which acquires an excessively powerful influence over literature. It was largely through Isocrates that this development took place; and accordingly the first rhetorical historians were his pupils, Ephorus of Cym6, Asia Minor, and Theopompus of Chios. The principal work of Ephorus was a History of Universal Avoirs, which treated of Hellas from the Return of the Heracleidae to his own time. Our interest in this last history is due to the fact that it was the chief source of Diodorus for the period which it covered, and that Strabo and Plutarch drew extensively from it. Although Ephorus pos- sessed some degree of critical abiHty, his work fell lamentably below the standard of accuracy set by Thucydides. FOURTH-CENTURY fflSTORIANS 41 Theopompus wrote a Hellenica in twelve books, which was a continuation of Thucydides, and, more important, a Philippica in fifty-eight books, which treated in great detail of recent and con- temporary affairs, with Philip of Macedon as a unifying center. The extant fragments, preserved especially in Athenaeus, show a noteworthy interest in culture and character, with a dispropor- tionate love of exhibiting the luxuries and vices of mankind. In spite of the shortcomings of Ephorus and Theopompus, the dis- covery of the works of either author would doubtless vastly enlarge our knowledge of Greek history and civilization. A portion of the historical field scarcely touched by rhetoric was occupied by the chroniclers of Athens, whose interest, like that of the scientists, lay in the collection and the systematizing of facts. Such chronicles of Athens were termed Atthides (plural of Atthis). They began with the earliest mythical kings; and for the regal period they seem to have grouped events and institutions according to reigns. For the historical period the material was arranged annalistically under the appropriate archons. Far from limiting himself to political and mihtary happenings, the atthid-writer included all kinds of institutional, personal, and cultural matter. The earliest of the class after Hellanicus (see p. 25) was Cleidemus, whose Atthis evidently appeared after 378, but of whose work we have little information. To us the chronicler of greatest interest was Androtion, a pupil of Isocrates and for thirty years a prominent statesman of Athens. While he was in exile at Megara he completed and published his Atthis in 330; His attraction for us Ues in the circumstance that his chronicle was the chief source for Aristotle, Constitution of the Athenians, published a few years afterward. An introduction to the latter work will be found in no. 27 infra. With the help of his pupils Aristotle composed the constitutional histories of a hundred and fifty-eight states, most of them Hellenic. Each work consisted of (i) the narrative of constitutional growth to the philosopher's own time, (2) a contemporary survey of the con- stitution. The treatise on the Athenian constitution, the greater part of which was recovered in Egypt about the close of the year 1890, is the only one we have of the vast collection. To the early Hellenistic age belongs Philochorus, who was murdered about 260 at the instigation of the Macedonian ruler, and whose Atthis seems 42 THE SOURCES to have been the ablest and most extensive of the series. In addition to his chronicles he composed a variety of works on religion and other subjects. BIBLIOGRAPHY I. Xenophon. — Review of recent literature on Xenophon in Jahresb. 1903, 1909. Edition by Sauppe, G. A., 5 vols. (Leipzig, 1867-70) ; by Mar- chant, E. C, 3 vols. (Clarendon Press, 1900) ; Hdlenka by Keller, O. (Leipzig, 1890) ; by Breitenbach, L., with explanatory notes (Weidmann) ; Economicus by Holden, H. A., sth ed. (London, 1895). Translation by Dakyns, H. G., 3 vols. (MacmiUan, 1890-97). Selections from this work for the present volume have been compared with the Greek text and revised by E. G. S. Bury, Ancient Greek Historians, lect. v; Wachsmuth, C, Einieitung in das Stvdium der alten Geschickte, 529-36; Richter, E., Xenophon-Studien (Teubner, 1892) ; Lincke, K., "Xenophon's persische PoUtie," in Pkilol. LX (1901). 541-71; Taine, H., "Xenophon: L'Anabase," in Essais de critique et de I'histoire (nth ed., Paris, 1908), 49-95; Guernsey, R., "Elements of Interest in the Anabasis," in CI. Weekly, III. 66; Morris, C. D., "Xenophon's Economicus," in Am. Journ. PhUol. I (1880). 169-86; Thalheim, Th., "Zu Xenophons Oikonomikos," in Hermes, XLII (1907). 630-42; Kohler, U., "Ueber die HoXiTeta AaKcSaijixoi'tW," in Berl. Akad. 1896, pp. 361-77 ; Schanz, M., "Beitrage zur Kritik der Schrift IIcpi ndpuv," in Rhein. Mus. XXXVI (1881). 215-36; Diimmler, F., "Zu Xenophons Agesilaos," in Philol. LIV (1895). 577-86. II. The Lost Historians. — Fragments of Ephorus in Miiller, Frag, hist. grac. I. 234-77 ; IV. 641 sq. For studies in Ephorus, see Mess, A. v., "Untersuchungen iiber Ephoros," in Rhein. Mus. LXI (igo6). 360-407 ; Niese, B., "Warm hat Ephoros seine Geschichtswerk geschnehen?" in Hermes, XLIV (1909). 170-8; Schwartz, E., "Die Zeit des Ephoros," ib. XLIV (1909). 481- 502; "Ephoros," in Pauly-Wissowa, Real-Encycl. VI. 1-16; Laqueur, R., "Ephorus," ib. XL VI (1911). 161-206, 321-54; Ciaceri, E., "SuUa reinte- grazione della antichissima storia greca in Eforo," etc., in Rivista di Storia antica, N. S. VI. 2. 17-24. The fragments of Theopompus are in Miiller, Frag. hist, grcec. 1. 278-333 ; IV. 643-5 > for additions, see Cronert, W., in Rhein. Mus. LXII (1907). 382 sqq. For studies in this author and in the newly discovered Oxyrhynchus Hellenica, see Meyer, Ed., Theopomps Hellenika (Halle, 1909) ; Busolt, G., "Zur Glaubwurdigkeit Theopomps," in Hermes, XLV (1910). 220-49; "Der neue Historiker und Xenophon," ib. XLIII (1908). 255-85; Mess, A. von, "Die Hellenika yon Oxyrhynchos," in Rhein. Mus. LXIII (1908). 370-91, favors Cratippus as author ; " Die Hellenika von Oxyrhynchos und die Berichte Xenophons und Diodors," ib. LXIV (1909). 235-43; Bonner, R. J., "The New Greek Historian," in Class. Journ. V (1910). 353-9; Roberts, W. R., "Theopompus in the Greek Literary Critics," in Class. Reo. XXII (1908). BIBLIOGRAPHY 43 118-22; Goligher, W. A., "The New Greek Historical Fragment attributed to Theopompus or Cratippus," in (Eng.) Hist. Rev. XXIII (igo8). 277-83; Judeich, W., "Theopomps HeUenika," in Rhein. Mus. LXVI (191 1). 94-139; Walker, E. M., The Hellenica Oxyrhynchia: Its Authorship and Authority (Clarendon Press, 1913), contends for Ephorus. The fragments of Cratippus are in Miiller, Frag. hist, grtzc. II. 75 sqq. On the question as to whether he was the author of the newly discovered Hellenica, see the works cited above; also Grenfell and Hunt, Oxyrhynchus Papyri, V (1908). no sqq. For other studies in the historian, see Susemihl, F., "Die Zeit des Historikers Kratippos," in Philol. LIX (1900). 537 sqq. ; Schmidt, W., "Kratippos zum dritten Mai," ib. LX. 155-7. III. The Atthid-Writers and Aristotle's Constitution of the Athenians. — On the Atthis in general, see Schwartz, "Atthis," in Pauly- Wissowa, Real-Encycl. II. 2180-3 \ Wilamowitz-MoeUendorff, V., Aristoteks u. Ath. I. 260-90; Busolt, Griech. Gesch. II. 7 sqq. On Androtion, see Keil, B., Die solonische Verfassung, etc. (Berlin, 1892), 190 sqq.; Schwartz, "Androtion," in Pauly-Wissowa, Real-Encycl. I. 2173- 5 ; De Sanctis, G., "L'Attide di Androzione e un papirio di Oxyrhynchos," in R. Acad. d. sci. atti. XLIII (igo8). 331-56. On Philochorus, see Wright, J. H., "Did Philochorus quote the 'A.6rjvamv UoXiTaa as Aristotle's?" in Am. Journ. Philol. XII (1891). 310-18. The editio princeps of Aristotle, Constitution of the Athenians, is that of Kenyon, F. G. (London, 1891 : 3d ed., 1892) ; *he most thoroughly annotated edition^is by Sandys, J. E. (2d ed., MacmiUan, 1912); see also ed. by Her- werden, H. van, and Leeuwen, J. van (Leyden, 1891) ; by Blass-Thalheim (Teubner, 1909). The best complete translation is by Kenyon (London: BeH, 1912). There is one also by Poste, E. (Macmillan, 1891).. For studies in the subject, see Adcock, F. E., " Source of the Solonian Chapters," Klio, XII (1912). 1-16; Bauer, A., Literarische und historische Porschungen zu Aristo- teles 'Adrivtuiov HoXltcul (Munich, 1891) ; Berard, J., "Aristote, la constitu- tion d'Athenes," in Rev. hist. 1892, pp. 285-305; Blass, F., "Die sogenannte drakontische Verfassung," in N. Jahrb. CLI (1895). 476-9; Botsford, G. W., Development of the Athenian Constitution (Giim, 1893); "Beginnings of the Athenian Hegemony," in Class. Rev. VHI. 19s sq. ; "Trial of the Alcmeonidae and the Cleisthenean Constitutional Reform," in Harv. St. in Class. Philol. VIII (1897). 1-22; Brack, S., "HeUastengerichte im 4 Jahrh." in Philol. LII (1893). 295-317, 395-421; "Heliastentafelchen," ib. LIV. 64-79; Busolt, G., "Aristoteles oder Xenophon," in Hermes, XXXIII (1898). 71-86; Cauer, F., Hat Aristoteles die Schrift vom Staate der Athener geschrieben? (Stuttgart, 1891) ; Cauer, P., "Aristoteles Urteil uber die Demokratie," in N. Jahrb. CXLV (1892). 581-93; Corssen, P., "Das Verhaltniss der aristotelischen zu der thukidideischen Darstellung des Tyrannenmordes," in Rhein. Mus, LI (1896). 226-39; Droysen, H., Vorlaufige Bemerkungen zu Aristoteles 'kOtfrniw/ TLoKiiita. (Berlin, 1891) ; Dufour, M., La constitution d'Athbnes et I'oeuvre d' Aristote (Paris, 1896) ; Fowler, H. N., "Dates of the Ejdles of Peisistratus," 44 THE SOURCES in Harv. St. in Class. PMlol. VII (1896). 167-75; Francotte, A., VOrganisor Hon de la citS atMnienne et la riforme de ClisMne (Paris, 1893) ; Frederichs, J., "La valeur de la 'ABr/vaCmv Ilo\iTaa," in Rev. de I'instr. publ. en Belgique, XXXVII (1894). 26-43 ; Gilliard, Quelques reformesde Solon (Lausanne, 1907) ; De Sanctis, G., 'Ardk, Steria della repubblica ateniese (2d ed., Torino, 1912) ; Hofmann, J., Siiidien zur drakontischen Verfassung (Straubing, 1899) ; Keil, B., Die solonische Verfassung, etc. (Berlin, 1892) ; Anonymus Argentinensis, etc. (Strassburg, 1902) ; Lecoutere, C, L'Archontat . . . d'apresla'AOrivaXiov UoXirela (Louvain, 1893); Lehmann-Haupt, C. F., Solon of Athens, the Poet, the Merchant, and the Statesman (Liverpool, 1912); Lipsius, J. H., "Ueber das neugefundene Buch des Aristoteles," etc., in Sachs. Gesellsch. XLIII (1891). 41-69; Mess, A. v., "Aristoteles 'AflijTOtW UoXinui und die politische Schrift- stellerei Athens," in Rhein. Mus. LXVI (1911). 356-92 ; Meyer, P., Des Aris- toteles Politik und die 'AdrivaCosv IIoA.tTcta (Bonn, i8gi) ; Milchhofer, A., Unter- suchungen iiber die Demenordnung des Kleisthenes (Berlin, 1892); "Attische Localverfassung," in Ath. Mitt. 1893, pp. 277-304; Newman, W. L., "Aris- totle on the Constitution of Athens," in Class. Rev. V. 155-64; Nordin, R., Themistoklesfrage (Upsala, 1893); Seeck, O., "QueUenstudien," in Klio, IV. 164-326; Stern, E. v., "Solon und Peisistratos," in Hermes, XL VIII (1913). 426-41; Thalheim, Th., "Die drakontische Verfassung," in Hermes, XXIX (1894). 458-63; -Viedebantt, O., "Metrologische Beitrage, I, II," in Hermes, XLVII (1912). 422 sqq., 562; Wright, J. H., "The Date of Cylon," m Han. St. in Class. Philol. Ill (1892). 1-74; Ziehen, L., "Die drakontische Gesetz- gebung," in Rhein. Mus. LIV (1899). 321-44. X. The Attic Orators From Homeric times the Greeks had paid great attention to oratory ; but it was not till the period of the Peloponnesian war, in the mature growth of rhetoric, that men began to write their speeches. Oratory was of three kinds ; (i) epideictic for the dis- play of literary skiU at funerals, great public gatherings, or similar occasions ; (2) symbouleutic, deliberative, for council ot assembly, (3) judicial, for prosecution or defense in the law courts. In the democratic tribunals every man had to plead his own case, and the party to the trial who was not himself a rhetorician had his pleading composed for him by a professional speech writer, a rhetorician equipped with at least a smattering of the law. These profes- sional composers preserved their speeches chiefly that they might serve as models for similar work in the future. Literary critics of the Alexandrian age made up a list, termed the canon, of ten Attic orators to represent the various excellences of style. It is mainly LYSIAS AND IS^US 45 to the interest of these critics that we owe the preservation of a large body of Attic oratory. Those orators only whose works are represented in the present volume are mentioned below. Lysias belonged to a wealthy resident-aUen family, whose estate was destroyed by the tyranny of the Thirty, 404-403. This mis- fortune converted him into a teacher of rhetoric and a professional writer of speeches for others to dehver. He died in 380 or shortly afterward, and could not therefore have followed this profession more than a quarter of a century ; and yet we are informed by a credible authority that he composed at least two hundred and thirty-three speeches. His productive power was in fact astound- ing. Of the whole number we have but thirty-four, of which one or two are fragmentary. Most of them are judicial. They are com- posed in a simple graceful style, resembling in appearance the lan- guage of every-day life though in fact artistic. They are dramatic in their adaptation to the characters of the individual pleaders and possess the quaUty known to the Greeks as ethos — the gentle current of feeling which wins the sympathy of the hearers. The orations deal fully with the parties to the trial, their characters, history, financial and social circumstances; thus they bring us into contact with actual persons and social-economic conditions. While the other orators differ in style and mentality, it may be said once for all that their productions, equally with those of Lysias, lead us into direct touch with public and private Kfe. Regarding the personal affairs of Isseus we have little informa- tion. His activity as a speech writer extended from the close of the Peloponnesian war to about the middle of the fourth century, while his extant speeches lie within the years 389-353. Though he is reputed a pupil of Isocrates, he betrays no sign of that master's influence, and should be regarded rather as the successor, and younger contemporary, of Lysias, and a connecting link between that writer and Demosthenes. All the twelve extant speeches are concerned with the law cases in which the writer excelled — inherit- ances and adoptions. His best recent editor, Wyse, has added no glory to the orator's moral reputation. Isseus was an extremely clever family lawyer who knew how to twist legal points most skilfully in order to win his case. The same thing, in a varying degree, may be said of all Greek writers of judicial speeches ; and 46 THE SOURCES with careful criticism the speeches of Isseus may be made as profitable for history as those of Lysias. The general tendencies of life and thought during the fourth century were toward the breaking down of the city-state with all its traditional associations and the corresponding enlargement of ideas and sympathies, of social and political relations. These tendencies, recognizable in Xenophon, found more complete ex- pression in Isocrates of Athens, 436-338, whose life was contem- porary with the whole development of prose literature, and with the culmination and incipient decay of the city-state system. He was a schoolmaster, who for a fee of 1000 drachmas gave a course of three or four years in statesmanship. Along with a training in oratory he supplied the pupil with such ethical and political knowl- edge as he deemed essential to public leadership. The sons of princes and other notables throughout Hellas, particularly in the East, gathered at his feet, and received from him most helpful instruction. From his school issued generals, statesmen, orators, and historians. Undoubtedly through his pupils he exercised a wide influence on Hellenic opinion. While teaching, Isocrates engaged in the composition of Orations, which, not being intended for de- livery, may more properly be termed essays. With a delicate taste for literary form he gave the most nainute and prolonged attention to the elaboration of a nicely adjusted periodology, and to the exquisite choice and arrangement of words. At least in appearance the stylist in him dominates over the thinker. His writings treat of political conditions; he was the first and most eminent of ancient publicists. In home politics he was a conserva- tive who preferred the constitution of Solonian and Cleisthenean times when the Council of the Areopagus kept parental watch over citizens and magistrates. These views he sets forth in his Areo- pagiticus. In the larger field of inter-state politics he long favored the union of all the Hellenes, under the joint leadership of Athens and Sparta, for a war of conquest against Persia. The Panegyriciis, his greatest masterpiece, 380 B.C., embodies this doctrine. Finally recognizing the futility of this hope, he appealed to various emi- nent men to take the leadership. Among them were DionysiuSi of Syracuse, Archidamus of Sparta, and lastly Philip of Macedon. The study of Isocrates has been given a new importance and a new ISOCRATES AND DEMOSTHENES 47 impetus by the contention of certain German scholars, among whom is Eduard Meyer, that he is the truest interpreter of his time, that the study of fourth-century conditions should proceed from his outlook (C/. Gesch. d. Alt. V. p. 280). Although space does not permit a discussion of tlii§ view, it is to be presumed that no thinker, however useful as sources his writings may be, possesses a monopoly of the political wisdom of his age. See further on this subject the introduction and notes to the Philippus, no. 127 infra. With Isocrates, his fellow-citizen Demosthenes, 384-322, pre- sents a striking contrast, that of the practical against the theoretical, energy against lassitude, the dense massing of facts in irresistible phalanxes of persuasion as opposed to a high dilution of ideas in multitudes of perfumed, sweet-sounding words. The circumstances of his early life, his mistreatment at the hands of unfaithful guar- dians, and his prosecution of the latter are touched upon in connec- tion with the excerpt from his Oration against Aphobus, no. 156 infra. From this prosecution he emerged with a reputation as a writer of judicial speeches — the foundation of his worldly fortune. These orations have equal value with those of Lysias as sources for social, economic, judicial, and general cultural conditions. In his early life appear two forces which admirably support and supple- ment each other : the first is a certain sternness and severity, the second a clear and direct manner of going to his point and of making it. The bald truth and its intrinsic force, rather than any technical skill in rousing emotion, form the vital quality of his oratory. In the general sweep of history the private orations are lost sight of in the struggle of this rare man against the power, the policy, and the personality of Philip, who, succeeding to the throne of Macedon in 359, made of his country, formerly insignificant, the most for- midable monarchy of Europe. It was Philip's achievement to estabhsh in his country a world power organized and fitted for the purpose which his son Alexander with dazzling promptitude accomplished — the destruction of the Persian reahn and the erection on its ruins of a vast Hellenistic empire. . Against the growth of this power, which overshadowed the freedom of the Greek republics, Demosthenes almost alone struggled like a hero but in vain. In the past century the pendulum of judg- ment on his character and principles has swung to violent extremes. 48 THE SOURCES At the time when Napoleon I was crushing Prussia beneath his iron heel, B. G. Niebuhr, the patriot scholar, saw a close resemblance between Philip of Macedon and the tyrant emperor, while he looked to Demosthenes as the champion of human freedom. But times have changed; and the grasping imperialism of Europe cannot afford to tolerate the memory of a man who contended according to his power for the liberty of the weak commonwealth. It is true that the empire of Alexander was the means of diffusing Hellenic civilization among mankind ; it is equally true that in the end, even if not so soon as Demosthenes expected, imperialism, beginning with Alexander and continuing with Rome, crushed local freedom and brought to ruin the civilization of the world. From these con- siderations it appears clear that while the success of the Macedonian cause brought great though not unalloyed benefits to the world, there was right also on the side of the local patriot ; and though he failed, his inspired eloquence and heroic struggle are a priceless and eternal treasure. iEschines, about 389-314, remembered chiefly as the political adversary of Demosthenes, was the son of a schoolmaster of humble circumstances. In earlier life .iEschines became a public scribe, then for a time an actor, and finally, under the patronage.of Eubulus, he entered the political arena. At first he favored the formation of a Hellenic league against Philip ; but in 346 he was a member of a peace embassy to the Macedonian king. After this first contact with Philip he remained a steadfast leader of the pro-Macedonian party at Athens. Whether this somersault was due to a change of conviction or a bribe is under controversy. Demosthenes, a mem- ber of the same embassy, prosecuted him on the charge that he had sold himself to Philip to betray his country ; and lie narrowly escaped condemnation (343). The opposing speeches of Demos- thenes and ^schines On the Faithless Embassage (Parapresbeia) are extant ; they are a hopeless tangle of contradictions. Afterward, .iEschines prosecuted Ctesiphon for proposing high honors to De- mosthenes. This great case, begun in 336,. was decided in 330. The aim of ^schines to destroy Demosthenes in public life called forth the noblest pleading of antiquity, the oration of Demosthenes On the Crown, a defense of the speaker's career and character. The failure of ^Eschines was so complete that he was forced to retire into CONTEMPORARIES OF DEMOSTHENES 49 exile. Besides the orations of ^schines on these two occasions we have his speech Against Timarchus, from which an excerpt is given in this volume. It hardly need be said that modern scholars who condemn Demosthenes are equally strenuous in attempting to rehabiUtate ^schines as a far-sighted statesman and a man of honor. Something can be done in this direction. Lycurgus, a distinguished contemporary and collaborator of Demosthenes, was hke the latter firm in support of measures hos- tile to the aggression of Macedon. In the diflScult times which followed the catastrophe of Chaeroneia he was preeminent through the firmness and the purity of his Attic patriotism. For twelve years he directed the finances, the first period of four years under his own name, the next two periods, eight years in all, under the formal control of others. During this time of twelve years, 14,000 talents, or according to some, 18,650 talents, passed through his hands. Modern scholars highly extol his financial administration. The extant discourse Against Leocrates exhibits a public character of great sternness. Of the published discourses mentioned in Suidas as genuine, eight were prosecutions. A vulnerable politi- cian as a rule eschews this form of public service. Uncompromising, vigorous no less than rigorous, he appears in the preserved speech as a man who appropriated the Hterature of the past in a practical and patriotic manner, to illustrate the underlying principles of right conduct and civic duty. Hypereides, 389-322, long an associate of Demosthenes in op- position to Macedon, was a man fond of the pleasures of life. In oratory he possessed in a notable degree the quality of grace (x'*P'') in contrast with the Demosthenic power, and an all-round abifity rather than preeminence in any one oratorical feature. The an- cients had fifty-two undoubted speeches ; but all were lost, and the world of scholarship could judge of him through the medium of ancient critics only, till about the middle of the nineteenth century, when individual orations began to come to Hght. We now have in whole or in large part six orations. Among them is the Epitaphios, delivered at the public funeral of those who had fallen in the Lamian war in defense of their country. The fact that Hj^ereides was chosen for this function is evidence of his repute both as a patriot and as an eloquent orator. so THE SOURCES BIBLIOGRAPHY I. Attic Orators. — Recent literature reviewed in Jahresb. 1907, 1912. Jebb, R. C, Auk Orators from Antiphon to Ismus, 2 vols. (2d ed., Macmil- lan, 1893) ; Blass, Fr., Geschichte der attischen BeredsamkeU, 4 vols. (2d ed., Teubner). II. Lysias, IsiEus, AND IsocRATES. — Edition of Lysias by Cobet, C. G. (2ded. 1882) ; by Scheibe (2ded., Teubner, 1885) ; by Thalheim, Th. (Leipzig, 1901) ; by Hude, C. (Clarendon Press, 1913). German translation by Falk, A. (Breslau, 1843). For studies in Lysias, see Jebb, Attic Orators, I. 142-316; n. 1-368 ; Devries, W. L., Ethopoiia. A Rhetorical Study of the Types of Char- acter in the Orations of Lysias. Diss. Johns Hopkins University (Baltimore, 1892) ; WolfE, Ud}er Lysias Epitaphios und Isokrates Panegyrikos (Berlin, 1896). The best edition of Isaeus is by Wyse, W., with detailed notes on matters of Attic law (Cambridge : University Press, 1904) ; see also the ed. of Thalheim (Leipzig, 1903). For studies in Isaeus, see Jebb, Attic Orators; Blass, Attische Beredsamkeit, 11. 452-541 ; Goligher, W. A., "Isaeus and Attic Law," in Her- mathena, XIV (1907). 183-204, 481-515. Edition of Isocrates by Blass, F., 2 vols. (Teubner, 1885) ; by Drerup, E., vol. I ready (Leipzig, 1906). English translation by Freese, J. H., vol. I (Bohn), from which selections have been taken for this volume. The entire work is translated by Dinsdale, J., rev. by Young (London, 1752). A useful work is the Index Isocrateus by Preuss, S. (Teubner, 1904). For studies in this author, see Adams, C. D., "Recent Views of the Political Influence of Isocrates," in Class. Philol. VII (1912), 343-50; Gercke, A., "Isokrates und Alkidamas," in Rhein. Mus. LIV (1899). 404-13 ; "Die RepUk Isokrates gegen Alkidamas," ib. (1907). 170-202; Hagen, B. v., "Isokrates und Alexander,'' in Philol. LXVn (1908). 113-33 ; HubbeU, H. M., Influence of Isocrates on Cicero, Dio- nysitis, and Aristeides, Diss. (Yale University Press, 1913) ; Kessler, J., "Iso- krates und die panhellenische Idee," in St. z. Gesch. u. Kult. des Alt. IV. 3 (1911) ; Kopp, F., "Isokrates als Politiker," in Preuss. Jahrb. LXX (1892). 472-87; Meyer, Ed., "Isokrates' zweite Philippika," in Sitzb. Berl. Akad. 1909, pp. 758- 79; Munscher, K., "Die Isokratesiiberlieferung," in Philol. LVIH (1899). 88- iio; Pohlmann, R. v., "Isokrates und das Problem der Demokratie," in Munch. Akad. (Munich, 1913) ; Raeder, H., "Alkidamas und Platon als Gegner des Isokrates," in Rhein. Mus. LXIII (1908). 495-511; Scala, R. v., "Iso- krates und die Geschichtschreibung," in Versamml. d. PhUolog. (Leipzig, 1892), 102-21 ; Wilamowitz-MoeUendorff, U. v., Aristoteles u. Ath. II. 380-99. III. Demosthenes. — Edition by DindorfE, rev. by Blass, F., 3 vols. (Leipzig, 1891-1907). In 1805 there was published at Leipzig a translation of his public orations, "in order that, by an example from ancient times, the German people might be warned against the t)Tanny of Napoleon which threatened them." An English translation by Kennedy, C. R., 4 vols. (Bohn) from which one or two of the selections from Demosthenes for this volume have BIBLIOGRAPHY 51 been taken, after a revision, on the basis of the Greek text, by E. G. S. An Index Demosthenius by Preuss, S. (Teubner, 1892), will be found useful. For studies in this orator, in addition to Jebb and Blass, see Brodribb, W. J., Demosthenes (new ed., London, 1898) ; Butcher, G. H., Demosthenes (Macmillan, 1881) ; Droysen, J. G., "Ueber die Echtheit der Urkunden in der Rede vom Kranz," in Kleine Schr. I (Leipzig, 1893). 95-297; Hug, A., "De- mosthenes als politischer Denker," in Sti4d. atis dem cl. Alt. I (1881). 51-103 ; Kahrstedt, Forschungen zur. Gesch. d. ausgehenden 5. u. des 4. Jahrh. (Berlin, 1910). 1-154 (rev. Bed. Philol. Woch. XXX, 1913, p. /^g&sqq. ; Gott. gelehrt. Am. 1912, p. 17 sqq., unfavorably) ; Francotte, H., "Etudes sur Demosthene," in Mtts. Belg. XVn (1913). 69-91, 237-88; Pickard-Cambridge, A. W., Demos- thenes and the last Days of Greek Freedom (Putnam, 1914) ; Schafer, A., Demos- thenes und seine Zeit, 3 vols. (Teubner, 1885-87) ; Thalheim, "Demosthenes," in Pauly-Wissowa, Real-Encycl. V. 169-88, with references to modern literature. IV. iEscHiNES, Lycurgus, and Hypereides. — Edition of ..Eschines by Schultz, F. (Leipzig, 1865); by Weidner, A. (Leipzig, 1872); by Blass, F. (2d ed., Leipzig, 1908). Recent literature on .iEschines reviewed in Jahresb. 1913) PP- 214-40. German translation by Benseler, G. E., 3 vols. (Leipzig, 1855-60; Two Orations on the Crown by Biddle, G. W. (Phila. 1881). See also Preuss, S., Index jEschineics (Teubner, 1896). For other studies, in addition to Blass, see Bougot, A., Rivaliti d'yEschine et de Dimosthhne (Paris, 1891) ; Bruns, I., Das literarische Portrdt der Griechen, etc. (Stuttgart, 1896), ch. iv. § 5; Thalheim, "Aischines," in Pauly-Wissowa, Real-Encycl. I. 1050-62. Edition of Lycurgus by Blass, F. (Leipzig, 1899) ; a new fragment by Rabe, H., in Rhein. Mtis. LXin (1908). 143 sqq. ; Index to Andocides, Lycurgus, and Dinarchus by Forman, L. L. (Oxford, 1897). German translation by Bender, H.' (3d ed., 1909). See also Durrbach, F., "L'Orateur Lycurge. Etude hist, etlit.," in Bibl. des Scales franc. d'Athines, etc. LVII (Paris, 1887) ; Droge, C., De Lycurgo atheniensi pecuniarum publicarum administratore. Diss. (Bonn, 1880). Edition of Hypereides by Blass. F. (3d ed., Leipzig, 1894) ; by Kenyon F. G. (Oxford, 1907) ; Orations against Athenagoras and PhUippides, with a translation, by Kenyon (London, 1893); Grenfell and Hunt, Oxyrhynchus Papyri, IV (1904). Recent literature on Hypereides in Jahresb. 1913, pp. 186- 213 ; Sandys, J. E., "Recent Editions of Hypereides," in Class. Rev. IX (1895). 71-4. See also Bruner, L., Studien zur Gesch. u. Sprache des Hypereides, Progr. (Bamberg, 1906). IX. Plato anb Aristotle Plato, 427-347, belonged to the oldest nobility of Athens, and enjoyed the literary, musical, and athletic education of his class. Through such accomplishments and more through his long pupilage under Socrates he unfolded a brilliant literary genius paralleled in 52 THE SOURCES the fourth century by that of Demosthenes alone. His nature was essentially poetic : his Dialogues are, in poetic prose, the creation of a wonderfully versatile imagination. His philosophy, which need not concern us here, is not, as expressed in the Dialogues, an orderly consistent system of reason ; it is rather an ever changing revelation of mingled thought and emotion. The only permanent element is idealism. In politics he was by birth and education a pronounced oligarch, whose hatred of the democracy was intensified by the condemnation of Socrates. For the attitude of men of his class the democracy was only in small part responsible. The oli- garchs had long preferred conspiracy and sedition to open political conflict or to conciliation and compromise. When opportunity oflFered, as in the time of Critias, a relative of Plato, they seized despotic power, throttled free speech, robbed and murdered their fellow-citizens, and tried to reduce the masses to serfdom. In times of quiet their aloofness from public life was due largely to a narrowness of political vision and class egoism and to a selfish love of sensual, social, or intellectual pleasure. If their abnegation of civic duty made the democracy worse, they and not the masses of voters should bear the weight of blame. ' Plato was the most refined and gifted of his class. In him an- tipathy to free institutions, the ambition of the few for class des- potism, is glorified by aspirations for perfect knowledge, justice, and righteousness. But the standard of jiidgment which permits him to condenm Themistocles, Pericles, and the greatest statesmen of his country is one which would equally force the condemnation of every government in the world's history to the present day. Only three or four of his masterpieces will here be mentioned. His Protagoras, a work of great dramatic interest, assails the fun- damental principles and the thought methods of the more eminent sophists. His Gorgias is a protest against democracy as well as against rhetoric. His Republic sets forth the ideal state, in which the masses, practically serfs, are absolutely ruled by a military- aristocratic-philosophic class. It is his greatest masterpiece, the most splendid of Utopias. As the expression of a brilliant intellect on educational, social, moral, and political questions, it commands our attention ; but the state here pictured, if realized, would have crushed the genius of the author, a state that no man, not even a PLATO AND ARISTOTLE 53 member of the ruling class, could endure. The Laws, composed in later life, is a more sober and practicable construction of the ideal state, and hence more serviceable to the student of actual con- ditions. To one interested in social history, however, the ideas of Plato are less valuable than his many and diverse pictures of life, which, if not true of the individual persons portrayed, are at least representative of existing social phases. In passing from Plato to Aristotle, 384-322, we come to a new type of mind. Whereas the authors of prose and verse thus far mentioned are essentially creative, Aristotle is a scholar, in fact the greatest as well as the first scholar in history. It was his achievement to systematize and reduce to writing the knowledge which the Hellenes had thus far accumulated, and to add to this store by his own researches. His writings include metaphysics, psychology, the natural and physical sciences, logic, rhetoric, ethics, and politics. His authorship of a hundred and fifty-eight consti- tutional histories has already been noticed (p. 41). On the basis of accumulated facts relating to the institutions of individual states Aristotle constructed his Politics, the mo^st notable treatise on the state thus far produced in the history of the world. The circum- stance that this work, published within the years 336-332, appeared somewhat earlier than the collection of individual constitutions (p. 41) presents no serious problem ; the gathering of material for the vast collection was undoubtedly far advanced before the com- position of the Politics. For an introduction to the treatise we must look to his Nicomachean Ethics, which in discussing the principles of virtuous living conducts the reader logically to the state, as to an organism, not merely for the protection, but for the perfection of hxmian Hfe {Ethics, x. 10). The Politics treats exclusively of the city-state untrammeled by connection with any higher political organization. Its ap- pearance at the time when Alexander was founding his world mon- archy has puzzled inodern scholars. In justification it may be said that although under Alexander and his successors Greek com- .munities enjoyed a high degree of local freedom, this condition existed on sufferance only. The imperial statesmen of the ancient world failed to guarantee to the municipalities local freedom and self-government. It is only in modern times, notably in the case 54 THE SOURCES of Great Britain, that monarchy has been reconciled with democ- racy. As against the world monarchy, therefore, Aristotle was right in his exclusive devotion to the city-state. The same thing, however, cannot be said of his neglect of the federation ; but it was long after his death that Greece saw the maturity of the federal union — the most highly developed and perfected political crea- tion of the Hellenes, and in fact of the world before the founding of the United States of America. Regarding Aristotle's views of the several forms of government the selected passages, with their introductions and notes, will afford the necessary information. BIBLIOGRAPHY I. Plato. — Edition byBiJrnet, J., s vols. (Oxford, 1900-1907) ; Protagoras by Sihler, E. G. (Harper) ; Gorgias and Protagoras by Sauppe, H., and Gercke, A. (Weidmann) ; Republic by Jowett, B., and Campbell, L., 3 vols. (Oxford, 1894) ; by Adams, J., 2 vols. (Cambridge, 1902). Translation of works by Jowett, S vols. (3d ed., Macmillan, 1892) ; of Republic by Vaughan, D. J., and Davies, J. L. (Macmillan, 191 2). The selections in this volimie are from Jowett. Recent literature on Plato is reviewed in Jahresb. 1912, 1913. For studies in Plato, see the various histories of Greek philosophy by Zeller, Gomperz, etc. ; also Adams, J., The Vitality of Platonism, etc. (Cam- bridge : University Press, 191 1) ; Adamson, J. E., Theory of Education in Plato's Republic (London, 1903) ; Barker, E., Political Thought of Plato and Aristotle (London: Methuen, 1906); Boyd, W., Introduction to the Republic (London: Sonnenschein, 1904); Dittenberger, W., " Sprachliche Criterien fiir die Chro- nologie der platonischen Dialoge," in Hermes, XVI (1881). 321-45 ; Grote, G., Plato and the Other Companions of Socrates, 4 vols, (new ed., London, 1888) ; Huit, C, Etudes sur la politique oMribuS A Platon (Paris, 1888) ; La vie et I'xuvre de Platon, 2 vols. (Paris, 1893) ; Muller, J., Platons Staatslehre und der moderne Socialismus, etc. (Sondershausen, 1886) ; Nettleship, R. L., "Theory of Educa- tion in the Republic of Plato," in Abbott, E., Hellenica, 67-180 ; Pater, W. H., Plato and Platonism (Macmillan, 1908) ; " Genius of Plato," in Contemp. Rev. 1892, pp. 249-61 ; Ritchie, D. G., Plato (Scribner, 1902) ; Ritter, C, Platon: sein Leben, seine Schriften (1909) ; Platons Gesetze; Kommeniar (Teubner, 1896); Sihler, E. G., "Vergil and Plato," in Trans. Am. Philol. Assoc. 1880; Taylor, A. E., Plato (New York: Dodge, 1908) ; Usener, H., "Platon und Aristoteles," in Vortrdge und Aufsdtze (Teubner, 1907). 67-102. II. Aristotle. — Edition of complete works, Acad. reg. boruss. s vols. (BerUn, 1831-70), the pages of which are generally cited; the fragments by Rose, V. (Teubner, 1886) ; Politics, by Susemihl, F. (Teubner, 1909) ; ed. with essays and notes, by Newman, W. L., .2 vols. (Clarendon Press, 1887). Trans- lation of works under editorship of Smith, J. A., and Ross, W. D. (under way, THE NEW COMEDY 55 Oxford : Clarendon Press). Politics, translated by Welldon, J. E. C. (Macmil- lan, 1905) ; by Jowett, B., 2 vols. (Clarendon Press, 1885), from which the selections in this voliirsie have been taken. For literature on Aristotle prior to 1896, see Schwab, M., BiUiographie d'Aristote (Paris, 1896). See also Barker, E., Political Thought of Plato and Aristotle (Putnam, 1906) ; Bradley^ "Aris- totle's Conception of the State," in Abbott, E., Hellemca, 181-243 ; Eucken, R., Lebensanschauungen der grossen Denker (7th ed., Leipzig, 1907), I. 3 ; Giesen, K., "Quaestiones graecae und Aristoteles Politien," in Philol. LX (1901). 446- 71 ; Loos, I. A., Stttdies in the Politics of Aristotle and the Republic of Plato (Iowa City : University Press, 1899) ; Oncken, W., Staatslehre des Aristoteles, 2 vols. (Leipzig, 1870, 1875) ; Shute, R., History of the Process by which the Aristotelian Writings arrived at their Present Form (Clarendon Press, 1888). Further studies in the political theories of Aristotle wiU be found in the various histories of Greek philosophy by ZeUer, Gomperz, and others, and in works on the political theories of the ancients, such as Duiming, W. A., History of Polit- ical Theories, Ancient andMediceval(Ma.cmiR3.n, 1902), and Witloughby,W. W., Political Theories of the Ancient World (Longmans, 1903). XII. Writers of the Hellenistic and Roman Periods As to minor authors and those but briefly excerpted for this volume, the necessary facts are given in the introductions to the selections from their writings. This arrangement applies also to the scientific and medical works quoted in the volume. Polybius, who ranks among the greatest historians of antiquity, is given especial attention in connection with the selections from his history which illustrate the condition of historical science in the Hellenistic age (ch. xviii). A characteristic form of literature of this period is the New Comedy, which has been given fresh interest by the discovery of a considerable part of four plays of Menander, 342-290, its chief representative. Other productions in the field are the comedies of Plautus and Terence, which are translations of contemporary Greek plays modified more or less in adaptation to their Roman audience. The change in the character of comedy, beginning in the last ac- tivities of Aristophanes, was now complete ; particularly it had for- saken politics, to devote itself wholly to social Hfe. It had also shaken off many of the coarser indecencies and immoralities of the Aristophanic period. As has been pointed out by Ferguson (Hel- lenistic Athens, 75 sqq.), however, respectable women still kept themselves for the most part modestly within doors, so that the 56 THE SOURCES female characters on the stage were as a rule those of ill repute. Restricting itself to street scenes, the New Comedy had to avoid the inner life of the family and the more respectable activities of society, to picture the exposure of infants, the intrigues of young men and hetaeras, and other such immoral or indecent aspects of Kfe. But however one-sided and imperfect may be the information contained in this branch of hterature, it throws a welcome light on its limited field of thought, feeling, character, and social customs of an age but scantily known. Another equally characteristic form of literature is the Idyll, represented in this volume by Theocritus. He was bom about 305, probably in Syracuse (Christ, Griech. Lit. H. 141 sq.), and passed some years at the courts of Syracuse and Alexandria. His pictures of common life are marked by dehcacy and grace. "Theocritus gives us nature, not behind the footlights, but beneath the truthful blaze of Sicily's sunlit sky" (Kynaston) ; and certainly nothing can bring us into so close and pleasing touch with life in the home and on the streets of Alexandria as the fifteenth Idyll reproduced in this volume. A few epigrams, too, of the age, whose authors are uncertain, will be found in their appropriate chapter (xix). As we pass from the Hellenistic to the Roman age, we may notice but briefly the Roman biographer CorneUus Nepos, about 99-24 B.C., a part of whose work On Famous Men {Deviris illustribus) has been preserved. The greater number of biographies in this frag- ment are of Greek generals. We see in his Epaminondas, for ex- ample, a love of artificial characterizations. His work is uni- versally pronounced unreliable, and must be used for historical purposes with great caution. His Greek contemporary, Diodorus of Sicily, affords us no better proof t)f the historiographic capabiUties of the age. The work of the latter was a Library so named — in fact a general history of the world from the earliest times at least to 60 B.C., in forty books. In his Preface (i. 4) he makes great pretensions that he has labored thirty years on his work, and has experienced extreme sufferings and dangers in visiting the scenes of his narrative in Europe and Asia that he might write with the knowledge of an eye-witness. The truth is that he was merely a compiler. Much of his work he vitiated by the use of inferior sources ; in general he shows a lack HELLENISTIC AND ROMAN AUTHORS 57 of knowledge of military and political affairs, and still worse, a want of judgment. Some parts of his historical library, however, are better than others ; and for some subjects and periods, as for Sicily during the fifth and fourth centuries and for the earlier Hel- lenistic age, he is our only continuous source. We feel the loss, therefore, of the second half of his compilation, books xxi-xl, cov- ering 301-60 B.C., now represented only by fragments. Books vi-x likewise exist only in fragments, arranged in order with great intelligence in Vogel's edition. In Strabo we come into touch with an authority immeasurably superior to Diodorus. He was born in Pontus about 64 B.C. and lived to 1.9 A.D. His principal work was a history, Historical Mem- oirs, in forty-three books, mainly a continuation of Polybius. This treatise has been lost and we know little of it. As a supplement to his history he wrote a Geography in seventeen books, which is still preserved. Composed in the main under Augustus, it was revised and slightly extended under Tiberius (Pais, Ancient Italy, ch. xxvi). In his own words it was a " colossal work," requiring many years, including travel and personal inspection, for the collection of details relating to thousands of localities distributed over the known world. The treatise is not a geography pure and simple, but includes much mythical and historical information associated with the various localities. In the earlier part he gives the general views of the earth held by himself and his predecessors of the Alexandrian age. While he cannot compare in originaKty with Eratosthenes (no. 210), he is a credit to his generation, and his treatise is worthy of respect- ful consideration as a geographical and historical source of the first rank. Pliny the Elder, 23-79 A.D., was a native of the Roman munici- pality of Como (Novum Comum) and an officer of the empire. His leisure he devoted with amazing diligence and economy to study and authorship in many fields (Pliny the Younger, Letters, iii. 5). The only work preserved is his Natural History in thirty-seven books, an encyclopedia of arts, sciences, and antiquities by a gentleman with a keen interest in every kind of knowledge, yet lacking in scientific method and precision. In his treatment of the arts and sciences he necessarily has to do chiefly with the Greeks. Three late Hellenic writers will be briefly grouped together. S& THE SOURCES Pausanias, who lived in the latter part of the second century a.d., wrote a Description of Greece in ten books, which is still extant. The author was an amateur in his subject and an archaist in style. His work, however, though compiled with mediocre talent, is a treasury of information on topography, archaeology, religion, and mythology, including much historical and biographical matter. It is the foundation of modern studies in the topography and archae- ology of Greece. Diogenes Laertius, probably belonging to the early third century, composed the Lives of the Philosophers, a work of perhaps even less ability than that of Pausanias, yet valuable for the information contained in it. Athenaeus, seemingly a con- temporary, composed a work named Symposium of the Sophists, a great part of which has come down to us. The dinner he assigns to a time shortly after the death of Commodus (Christ, Griech. Lit. II. 626 sq.). During the symposium the learned guests (sophists) hold discourse, centering in the food and the customs of banquets, but extending to a multiplicity of subjects. The aim of the writer seems to be to display his erudition by quoting as many authors — the majority of whom we know only through him — and on as wide a variety of subjects as possible. Through this work, accordingly, we come to appreciate how vast a treasure of ancient literature has been lost to the world. It is a pleasure to close this introduction with a notice of one of the most admirable and lovable spirits of classical antiquity, Plu- tarch of Chasroneia, Boeotia, about 46-125 a.d. He belonged to an old and respectable family, and received a many-sided education in rhetoric, history, biography, physics, mathematics, and philosophy. While broadening his experiences by travel, he retained to the end his attachment to his native city. His writings on social, political, moral, and philosophic subjects are grouped together under the title M'oralia. They show a surprising versatility and productive power operating in the Platonic spirit, which at that time and through him was entering a new religious-mystic path. Much of this material can be utilized in historical study. Our chief interest here, however, is in his Parallel Lives, the most popular work created by classical antiquity. Forty-six biographies are in pairs, notable Greeks and Romans compared and contrasted, with only four — Artaxerxes, Aratus, Galba, and Otho — standing as individuals. PLUTARCH 59 Several important biographies, including the Epaminondas, have been lost. The parallelism is artificial ; far better would be a his- torical order. It is to be noted, too, that Plutarch has no concep- tion of historical development. Men of primitive times, like Ly- curgus, Romulus, and Theseus, are furnished with the same mental equipment as the author himself. He is equally devoid of the fac- ulty of historical criticism. With him all sources enjoy equal credi- bility. The truth of any statement therefore can be determined only by an inquiry into its source. We must admit further that in dealing with conflicting statements regarding a person or event under consideration he rarely seems conscious of the necessity of eliminating the contradiction. Generally such critical discussions as appear in his Lives have been introduced from his authorities. By way of summary it may be stated that his biographies, only critically sifted, constitute one of the most important sources for the customs, institutions, and personal characters of Greece and Rome. The author himself regarded the Lives as a means of philosophic instruction, closely akin to his Moralia. ,.The object of his philos- ophy was to preserve the great, the good, and the ennobling from the classic past, and to use this material as a guide and an encour- agement to virtuous living and to the upbuilding of a broad, hu- mane, moral character. He never descends to mere preaching, and therefore never grows wearisome; but through every page shines in sunny happiness the liberal kindly human soul, warming the reader's heart to the, author and awakening in it aspirations for the Beautiful and Good. BIBLIOGRAPHY I. Menander and Theocritus. — Edition of the newly found plays to- gether with the earlier fragments, by Kock, Th., Com. att.frag. III. Ed. of the newly found Four Plays 0/ Menander by Capps, E. (Ginn, 1910) ; by Lefebvre and Croiset, M. (Cairo, 1907); ed. with translation by Unus Multorum (2d ed., Oxford : Parker, 1909), the basis for the selection in the present volume. See also Arnim, H. v., "Kunst und Weisheit in den Komodien Menanders," in N. Jahrb. XIII (1910). 241-53 ; Capps, E., "Plot of Menander's Epitrepontes," in Am. Journ. PMol. XXIX (1908). 410-31 ; Gerhard, G. A., "Zu Menanders Perikeiromene," in Philol. LXIX (1910). 10-34; Leo, F., "Der neue Menan- der," in Hermes, XLIII (1908). 120-67 ; Liibke, H., Menander und seine Kunst. 6q the sources Progr. (Berlin, 1892) ; Post, C. R., "Dramatic Art of Menander," in Cla PhUol. XXIV (1913). III-4S; Richards, H., "The New Menander," in Cla Quart. II (1908). 132-6, on the finding and the character of the plays. Edition of Theocritus with English notes by Kynaston, H. (sth ed., Clart don Press, 1892) ; by Edmonds, J., Greek Bucolic Poets, with Eng. trans. (Mi millan, 191 2). Translation also by Way, A. S. (Cambridge: University Pre 1913) ; by Lang, A. (Macmillan, 1892), from which the selection in this volm has been taken ; Theocritus and Vergil's Eclogues, trans, by Calverley (Londo Bell, 1908). II. Nepos and DiODORTJS SicuLUS. — Edition of Nepos by Fleckeisen, (Teubner, 1898) ; EngUsh translation by Watson, J. S. (Bohn), the basis of t selections for this volimie. Edition of Diodorus by Miiller, C. (Paris : Didot, 1842-4) ; by Vogel, 1 continued by Fischer, C. T., 5 vols. (Teubner, 1888-1906). There is an old ai poor English translation by Booth, G., 2 vols. (London, 1814), out of prin German translation by Wurm, J. F., 19 vols. (Stuttgart, 1827-40). See a] Mess, A. v., " Untersuchungen iiber die Arbeitsweise Diodors," in Rhein. Mt LXI (1906). 244-66; Schwartz, E., "Diodorus," in Pauly-Wissowa, Set Encycl. V. 663-704, an especially valuable study. in. Strabo, Puny, and Pausanias. — Edition of Strabo by Casaubon, , (Paris, 1587), to which page citations refer; by Miiller, C, with maps (Par 1858) ; by Meineke, A., 3 vols. (Teubner, 1866-77). Fragments of his Histo in Muller, Frag. hist, grosc. III. 490-4 ; Otto, P., " Strabonis 'Ioto/sikSv wi fivrumTiov frag.," in Leipziger Stud. XI (1889). 1-224. English translation 1 Hamilton and Falconer, 3 vols. (Bohn), from which selections, compared wii the Greek text and revised by E. G. S., have been taken for this volume. F studies in Strabo, see Bunbury, E. H., History of Ancient Geography, II. d xxi, xxii; Tozer, H. F., History of Ancient Geography (Cambridge: Universii Press, 1897), ch. xii ; Berger, H., Geschichte der wissenschaftlichen Erdkunde d Griechen (2d ed., Leipzig, 1903), see Index; Pais, E., Ancient Italy, ch. xxv "Straboniana," in Rivista di fUologia, 1887, pp. 97-246; Otto, P., "Quaestion strabonianse," ra. Leipzig. Stud. XI (1889). 225-350; Niese, B., "Beitrage z Biographie Strabos," in Hermes, XIII (1878). 33-45. Edition of Pliny's Natural History by Jahn and Mayhofi, 6 vols. (Teubnt 1892-X906). English translation by Bostock, J., and Riley, H. T., 6 vol (Bohn). Chapters on the History of Art, trans, by Jex-Blake, K., with coi mentary by Sellers, E. (Macmillan, 1896), from which selections have bei made for the present volume. See further Furtwangler, A., Plinitis in sein Quellen iiber die bildenden Kilnste (Teubner, 1877) ; Kalkmann, A. D., Quell der Kunstgeschichte des Plinius (Berlin, 1898); Jahn, O., "Uber die Kuns urtheile bei Plinius," in Sachs. Gesellsch. 1850. 2. pp. 105-42. Edition of Pausanias by Hitzig, H., and Bliimner, H., 3 vols. (Leipzi 1896-1910). English translation with extensive commentary and thirty ma by Frazer, J. G., 6 vols. (2d ed., London, 1913) ; also by Shilleto, A. R., 2 vol (Bohn), from which have been taken the selections for this volume. See al BIBLIOGRAPHY 6i Robert, C, Pausanias als Sckriflsieller. Stidien und Beobachtungen (Berlin, 1909). Works on Greek topography generally serve as commentaries on Pausanias. Works for General Reference I. Works on Greek Literature and Kindred Studies. — Bergk, Th., Griechische Liter aturgeschickle, 4 vols. (Berlin, 18,72-1887) ; Bruns, I., Das lite- rariscke Portrdt der Griechen, etc. (Berlin, 1896) ; Capps, E., From Homer to Theocritus (Scribner, 1901) ; Christ, W., Geschichte der griechischen Litteratur, 2 vols. rev. by Schmid, W. (Munich, 1908-1913) ; Croiset, A. and M., Histoire de la litter aiure grecque, 5 vols. (Paris, 1887) ; Abridged History of Greek Literor ture (Macmillan, 1904) ; Hall, F. W., Companion to Classical Texts (London, 1913) ; Keble, A. J., Lectures on Greek Poetry 1832-1841, translated from the Latin by Francis, 2 vols. (Oxford: Clarendon Press, 1912) ; Kirchner, J., Pro- sopographia Attica, 2 vols. (Berlin, 1901, 1902) ; Lawton, W. C, Introduction to Classical Greek Literature (Scribner, 1903) ; Jebb, R. C, Growth and Influence of Classical Greek Poetry (London, 1893) ; The Attic Orators from Antiphon to IscBus, 2 vols. (MacmiUan, 1876) ; Mackail, J. W., Lectures on Greek Poetry (Longmans, 1910) ; Mahaffy, J. P., History of Classical Greek Literature, 2 vols, (new ed., Macmillan, 1908) ; Murray, G., History of Ancient Greek Literature (Appleton, 1897) ; Misch, G., Geschichte der Autobiographic, I : Das Altertum (Leipzig, 1907) ; Putnam, G. H., Authors and their Public in Ancient Times (Putnam, 1894) ; Peck, H. T., History of Classical Philology from the Seventh Century B.C., etc. (Macnullan, 1911) ; Sandys, J. E., History of Classical Scholar- ship, 3 vols. (1906-1908) ; Schwartz, E., CharakterkSpfe aus der antiken Litteratur (Leipzig, 1906) ; Symonds, J. A., Studies in the Greek Poets, 2 ser. (London, 1873, 1876) ; Thompson, E. M., An Introduction to Greek and Latin Palceography (Oxford: Clarendon Press, 191 2); Whibley, L., Companion to Greek Studies (Cambridge: University Press, 1905); WUamowitz-Moellendorf, U. von, Krumbacher and others, Griechische und lateinische Literatur und Sprache (Teubner, 1905) ; Greek Literature: A Series of Lectures delivered at Columbia University (Columbia University Press, 191 2). II. General Histories of Greece. — Grote, G., History of Greece, 12 vols. (Harper, reprint from the edition of 1849-1853) ; Curtius, E., History of Greece, 5 vols. (Scribner, 1886) ; Abbott, E., History of Greece, 3 pts. (Put- nam, 1895-1900) ; Holm, A., History of Greece, 4 vols. (Macmillan, 1895-1898) ; Bury, J. B., History of Greece (2d ed. MacmiUan, 1913) ; Hall, H. R., Ancient History of the Near East (Methuen, 1913) ; Busolt, G., Griechische Geschichte, 3 vols. (2d ed. Gotha, 1893-1904) ; Beloch, J., Griechische Geschichte, 3 vols. (I and II. 1, 2ded. ; the remainder, 1st ed. Strassburg, 1912-1914; 1897-1904) ; Meyer, Geschichte des Altertums, 5 vols. (I, 3d ed. 1910; II-V, 1st ed. 1893- 1902) ; Freeman, E. A., History of Sicily, 4 vols. (Oxford: Clarendon Press, 1891-1894). III, Inscriptions. — Inscriptiones GrcEcx, 14 vols., ed. Kirchho£E, A., Kaibd, G., and others (Berl. Akad. 1873-1890) ; this is the new edition abbre- 62 THE SOURCES viated in this voliime as Inscr. grcec, whereas the earlier edition of the Corptu Inscriptionwm Atticarum, occasionally cited, is abbreviated as CIA.; Ditten- berger, W., Sylloge Inscriptionwm Gracarwm, 2d ed., 3 vols. (Leipzig, 1898- 1901) ; Hicks, E. L., and HiU, G. R, Manual of Greek Historical Inscriptions, (new ed., Oxford : Clarendon Press, 1901) ; Roberts, E. S., and Gardner, E. A., Introduction to Greek Epigraphy, 2 vols. (Cambridge : University Press, 1887, 1905) ; Michel, Ch., Recueil d' inscriptions grecques (Brussels, igoo) ; Dareste, R., Haussoullier, B., and Reinach, Th., Recueil des inscriptions juridiques grecques, adser. fasc. i-iii (Paris: Leroux, 1898, 1904); Collitz,!!., Samndung der griech- ische Dialektinschriften, 4 vols. (1884-1911) ; Larfeld, W., Griechische Epigraphik (3d ed., Munich: Beck, 1914) ; Wilhelm, A., Beitrage zur Inschriftskunde (Vienna, 1909); "Attische Psephismen," in Hermes, XXIV (1889). 108-152, 326-36; Bockh, A., Urkunden iiber das Seewesen des attischen Staaies (Berlin, 1840) ; Kbhler, U., "Attische Inschriften des V'"" Jahrhunderts," in Hermes, XXXI (1896). 137-54; Bleckmann, F., Griechische Inschriften zur griechischen Staatenkunde (Kleine Texte, no. 115, Bonn, 1913) ; Gardthausen, V., " Wieder- gefundene ■ Originale historischer Inschriften des Altertums," in N. Jahrb. XXXIII (1914). 248-54, inscriptions quoted in ancient works; Kern, O., Tahula in usum scholarum edits, etc. (Bonn: Marcus and Weber, 1913). IV. Atlases, Dictionaries, and Kindred Helps. — Shepherd, W. R., Atlas of Ancient History (Holt, 1913), the best historical atlas; Sieglin, W., Schulatlas zur Geschichte des Altertums (imported by Lemcke and Biichner, N. Y.) ; Kiepert, H.,.4/te.4«%M«5 (Boston: Sanborn). 'Haxpt.t's Dictionary of Classical Literature and Antiquities, by H. T. Peck (Harper, 1887), most con- venient ; Smith, W., Dictionary of Greek and Roman Biography and Mythology, 3 vols. (Boston, 1849), useful though old; Dictionary of Greek and Roman Geography, 2 vols. (Boston, 1854, 1857) ; Dictionary of Greek and Roman Antiquities, 2 vols. (3d ed., London: Murray, 1890, 1891); Daremberg et Saglio, Dictionnaire des antiquitis grecques et romaines (Paris, beginning 1873), in many volumes, still under way; Pauly, Real-Encyclopiidie der classischen Altertumswissenschaft, revised and greatly enlarged edition under the super- vision of Wissowa, G., and (the later volumes) of Kroll, W. (Stuttgart, begin- ning 1894), in many volumes, still under way; Hermann, K. F., Lehrbuch der griechischen Antiquitiiten (Freiburg i. B.: Mohr), new editions of the several volumes are constantly appearing; Muller, I. von, Handbuck der klassischen Altertumswissenschaft (Munich: Beck), new editions of the several volumes are constantly appearing; Gercke, A., and Norden, E., Einleitung in die Alter- tumswissenschaft (Teubner), in several volumes, stiU incompleted Works devoted to special periods or to special subjects will be mentioned in the several chapter bibliographies. CHAPTER n THE MINOAN AND HOMERIC CIVILIZATIONS Approximately 3000-750 B.C. The Minoan period begins with the Bronze age, in which it is probable that copper was used for a time before the introduction of bronze ; see Mosso, A., Dawn of the Mediterranean Civilization. The entire period is divided by Evans {Nine Minoan Periods, 1915), into three large epochs, which he terms Early, Middle, and Late Minoan, respectively. In the Middle Minoan period Crete reached the height of her brilKant civilization ; in the Late Minoan age, called also the Mycenaean age, she stagnated and declined, while Troy ("sixth dty"), Mycenae, and other cities on the Greek mainland rose to a brilliant height of culture and power. The Minoans had systems of writing, first picto- graphs, out of which developed linear scripts ; and a great store of inscribed tablets has been found in a room of the palac© at Cnossus, Crete. No one as yet has been able to read the script, but there can be no doubt that the accu- mulated tablets just mentioned were the archives of accounts, of dues, receipts, etc., belonging to the king. That the Minoans, endowed as they were with splendid mentality, possessed a literature of songs, epics, and perhaps chronicles, as did the less gifted Orientals of the same period, seems certain. Such liter- ature, however, must have been consigned to less durable material, doubtless papyrus from Egypt, and for that reason perished. One of the most impor- tant questions bearing upon the relation of the Minoan civilization to that of historical Hellas is whether any of this literature survived, in any form, the downfall of the culture, so as to be used by the Greeks. The accuracy with which Homer pictures the material civilization, not of the decadent period but of the splendid Middle Minoan age, suggests the possibility of a survival to his time. If his sources were im written, at least the oral traditions were remarkably definite and concrete. It is noteworthy, too, that Aristotle and Ephorus speak with such confidence of the conditions and institutions of the age of Minos, and at the same time in such harmony with the facts revealed by the spade, as to tempt us to believe it possible that they or their sources made use of written material directly or indirectly transmitted from the Minoan age to their time. Notwithstanding this possibility we are forced to deal with the fact that our sources are almost wholly archaeological, and that references in Greek literature to the Minoan age can be accepted as facts or as probabilities only 63 64 MINOAN AND HOMERIC CIVILIZATIONS in so far as they are supported by archaeological discoveries. With this under- standing a few selections from literature are presented below. Preceding those which relate to the Minoan age is an excerpt from .(Eschylus which treats of the begiimings of civilized life. I. The Primitive Condition of Man and the Origin of Civilization (iEschylus, Prometheus, 442-506. Paley's translation, revised on the basis of WeU'stextbyG. W. B.) It is a remarkable fact that twenty-five hundred years before the dawn of anthropology a Greek dramatist should, come so near the truth regarding the origin of civilization. It is interesting, too, to notice what /Eschylus consid- ered the most vital elements of civilization, and especially the great prominence given to its religious features. Hear of the evils that existed among mortals, — how I * made them, hitherto without reasoning powers, to have mind find to be possessed of intelligence. I shall tell you this, without any wish to disparage mankind, but by way of explaining the good feeling implied in my gifts. They in the first place, though seeing saw to no purpose, hearing they did not understand ; but like the forms of dreams, during all that long time they did everything in a con- fused and random way, and knew not brick-built houses turned to the sun, nor the craft of carpentry. But they used to dwell in holes made in the earth, Kke the tiny ants in the sunless recesses of caves. Further, they had no sign either of winter or of flowery spring, or of fruitful summer, to rely upon ; but they used to do everything without judgment, till at length I showed them the risings of the stars and their laboriously determined settings. Moreover, num- bers, the best of inventions, I devised for them, and the combining of letters, at once the origin of literature, and the means'of remem- bering every eve^it. I was the first, too, to join together under the yoke the animals that served them for drawing and for riding, that they might be used by mortals to relieve them in their severest toils. I brought also under the car horses, taught to love the rein, 1 The speaker is Prometheus, the friend of mankind, ancestor of the Hellenic race through Deucalion and his sons. THE CARIANS 65 the ornament of luxurious wealth.^ Besides, no other than myself found out for them the sea-traversing canvas-winged cars to con- vey mariners. Such were the contrivances I devised for man. . . . If any one had fallen into an illness there were no remedies to avert it, either to be swallowed as food, or to be used as ointments, or to be taken as draughts ; but for want of drugs they used to pine and waste away, till I showed them how to compose these assuaging remedies, by which they now repel from themselves every kind of malady.'' Many ways, too, of divination I arranged for them : first I taught them what sort of dreams were destined to prove realities : the obscure import of ominous sounds I made clear to them, and the meaning of objects met on the way. The flight too of crooked taloned birds of prey I clearly defined, both those which are lucky in their nature and the unlucky ones. ... I showed them also what the smoothness of the liver meant, and what par- ticular color it should have to be pleasing to the gods.' Such then were my services in these matters ; but those great benefits to man which lie hidden under the earth, — copper, iron, silver, and gold, — who can assert that he found them out before I did? . . . In fine, hear the whole matter: all arts came to mortals from Prometheus. 2. The Carians (Herodotus i. 171) It is now generally accepted that the Minoans were not Indo-Europeans, but belonged to the "Mediterranean" race (c/. Seig^, Mediterranean Race). Of the same race were the Carians who inhabited a part of Asia Minor, and in earlier time, as Herodotus states, the islands of the ^Egean Sea. Connections between the reUgion of Caria, Asia Minor, and Minoan Crete have been pointed out by scholars. It is to be noted, however, that the Caria here referred to had no part in the brilliant Minoan civilization. The Carians came to the mainland from the islands ; for being of old time subjects of Minos and being called Leleges, they used » Horses were not used by the Greeks as ordinary work animals, but for riding, driving in carriages, and war. They were so expensive that only the relatively wealthy could afford to have them. » In the time of iEschylus, early fifth century, medical science was rapidly devel- oping. Hippocrates flourished in the latter part of the same century; see nos. 79-81. ' This system of divination is now supposed to have been derived from Babylonia. 66 MINOAN AND HOMERIC CIVILIZATIONS to dwell in the islands, paying no tribute, so far back as I am able to arrive by hearsay ; but whenever Minos required it, they used to supply his ships with seamen : and as Minos subdued much land and was fortunate in his fighting, the Carian nation was of all nations much the most famous at that time together with him. And they produced three inventions of which the Hellenes adopted the use : that is to say, the Carians were those who first set the fashion of fastening crests on helmets, and of making the devices which are put upon shields, and these also were the first who made handles' for their shields, whereas up to that time all who were wont to use shields carried them without handles and with leathern straps to guide them, having them hung about their necks and their left shoulders.^ Then after the lapse of a long time the Dorians and lonians drove the Carians out of the islands, and so they came to the mainland.^ (Thucydides i. 8) The islanders were even more addicted to piracy than the mainlanders. They were mostly Carian or Phoenician settlers. This is proved by the fact that when the Athenians purified Deles during the Peloponnesian war and the tombs of the dead were opened, more than half of them were found to be Carians. They were known by the fashion of their arms which were buried with them, and by their mode of burial, the same which is still prac- tised among them.^ ' The Minoans used a man-covering shield suspended from the neck as here de- scribed. The question as to the origin of the round shield is uncertain. In the opin- ion of Ridgeway, Early Age oj Greece, ch. vi, the round shield was introduced from central Europe by invading Hellenes. * In the colonization described by no. ii. ' From this passage it is dear that Thucydides, the writer, used a method of research followed by the archaeologists of to-day. By this means he proves that the people buried in past ages in the island of Delos had the same civilization as the Carians of his own time. That they were of the same race is an inference which he and most archseologists have considered legitimate. Modem historians, on the contrary, are convinced that widely diverse races, as the Japanese, the negroes of North America, and the western Europeans, may enjoy the same civilization. THE MOST FAMOUS MINOAN 67 3. Minos (Homer, Odyssey xix. 178 sq.) In this excerpt "them" refers to the hundred cities of Crete. The "nme- year " period of the Cretan king was the same as in Laconia ; the Cretan king and the Lacedaemonian kings were compelled, on the renewal of a nine-year period, to seek divine sanction. The close connection of the Cretan king with his deity is also paralleled in Lacedaemon. In brief, the royal office in both countries seems to have been a Minban heritage. Among them was Cnossus, a mighty city, wherein Minos ruled in nine-year periods, he who had converse with great Zeus. (Diodorus v. 78) This excerpt from Diodorus is evidently derived from early Greek sources and well represents the conventional Greek idea of Minos and his legislation and naval power. The Colonization of western Hellas (Sicily and southern Italy), too, is repeated by many writers. There can be no doubt whatever that the later Minoans Colonized this region ; cf. no. 6. They say that many generations after the birth of the gods many heroes arose in Crete, the most illustrious of whom were Minos and Rhadamanthys and Sarpedon, who they say were the sons of Zeus and Agenor's sister Europa. She, the story goes, had by a device of the gods been carried off on a bull's back to Crete. Minos as the eldest was king of the island, in which he planted no few cities, the most famous among them being Cnossus in the part which inclines toward Asia, Phaestus on the southern coast, and Cydonia in the western regions opposite Peloponnesus. He en- acted for the Cretans many laws, professing to receive them from his father Zeus and to hold converse with him in a certain cave. It is said, too, that he acquired a great naval power, conquered most of the islands and was the first Greek to establish an empire at sea. After winning, great repute for bravery and justice, he ended his life in Sicily in an expedition against Cocalus. (Thucydides i. 8) In the opinion of Thucydides settled life and civilization made progress till the time of the Trojan war, after which came a period of confusion due to the Dorian and other migrations. Archaeological discoveries, on the contrary, seem to have proved that Troy, the "sixth" and most splendid city, was de- 68 MINOAN AND HOMERIC CIVILIZATIONS stroyed in a period, probably toward the end of the period, of confusion and turmoil of migration. The chronology of these early times could not be so well known to the historical Greeks as the spade has revealed it to us. On the other hand, the coimection of economy with political history is stated with remarkable clearness and accuracy : the willingness of many to submit to em- pire for the protection of their property, and the use of wealth as a means of conquest. After Minos had established a navy, communication by sea became more general. For after he had expelled the pirates, when he colonized the greater part of the islands, the dwellers on the sea- coast began to grow richer and to live in a more settled manner ; and some of them, finding their wealth increase beyond their ex- pectations, surrounded their towns with walls. The love of gain made the weaker willing to serve the stronger, and the command of wealth enabled the more powerful to subjugate the lesser cities. This was the state of society which was beginning to prevail at the time of the Trojan war. 4. Theseus and the Minotaur (Hellanicus, Atthis, quoted by Plutarch, Theseus, 15-17, who cites also Philochorus and Aristotle) There seems to be a kernel of truth in the myth related below. The favorite sport of the king and grandees of Cnossus came in the festival in which trained youths and girls grappled with bulls, turned somersaults over their backs, etc. ; Botsford, Hellenic History, ch. ii. The subject states, including some of the towns of Attica, had to furnish the girls and youths as tribute. The laby- rinth was the palace at Crete. The word is Carian and has reference to the double-ax, which was an attribute of Zeus. The Cnossian palace, in which this Zeus was worshiped, was named accordingly " the house of the double- ax." In time, however, the word labyrinth lost its original meaning, and came to refer to the intricate system of corridors and halls included in that palace. A further historical truth contained in the story is doubtless the liberation of Attica from the tribute by the hero. They (the Athenians) sent an embassy to Minos and prevailed on him to make peace on condition that every nine years they- should send him a tribute of seven youths and seven girls. The most tragic of the legends states that these poor children, when they reached Crete, were thrown into the Labyrinth, and there were THE MINOTAUR 69 devoured by the Minotaur ^ or else perished with hunger, being unable to find their way out. The Minotaur, as Euripides tells us, was A form conuningled, and a monstrous birth, Half man, half buU, in twofold shape combined. Philochorus states that the Cretans do not recognize this story, but say that the Labyrinth was merely a prison, Uke any other, from which escape was impossible, and that Minos instituted gym- nastic games in honor of Androgeus, a son who had been treacher- ously slain, in which the prizes for the victors were these children, who till then were kept in the Labyrinth. . . . Aristotle himself, in his treatise on The Constitution of the Botticeans,^ evidently does not believe that the children were, put to death by Minos, but that they lived in Crete as slaves to extreme old age, and that once the Cretans, in performance of an ancient vow, sent first-fruits of their population to Delphi. Among those who were thus sent were the descendants of the Athenians ; and as they could not maintain themselves there, they first passed over to Italy, and settled near lapygia.' Thence they removed to Thrtce, and took the name of Bottiasans. For this reason the Bottiaean maidens, when performing a certain sacrifice, sing, "Let us go to Athens." Plutarch next narrates the sailing of Theseus to kill the Minotaur, after which (§ 17) he quotes from HeUanicus the excerpt given below. Hellanicus says that the City did not select the youths and girls by lot, but that Minos himself came thither and chose them, and that he picked out Theseus first of all upon the usual conditions, that the Athenians should furnish a ship, and that the youths should embark in it and sail with him, not carrying with them any weapon of war ; and that when the Minotaur was slain, the tribute should cease. Formerly no one had any hope of safety ; hence they used to send out the ship with a black sail, as if it were going to a certain • The idea and the name of the Minotaur ("Minos-bull") easily arose from stories, of the great king Minos, his labyrinthine palace, and the festival of bull grappling, which drodated through Hellas. 'Bottia, Bottiaea, was a Macedonian, not a Thracian, town; cf. Oberhummer, in Pauly-Wissowa, Real-Encycl. III. 794 sq. The basis of Aristotle's connection of the inhabitants with Delphi, Italy, and Crete is unknown. ' Here again is a reference to the Minoan colonization of Italy ; cf. nos. 3, 6. 70 MINOAN AND HOMERIC CIVILIZATIONS doom ; but now Theseus so encouraged his father, and boasted that he would overcome the Minotaur, that he gave a second sail, a white one, to the pilot, and charged him on his return, if Theseus were safe, to hoist the white one, if not, the black one as a sign of mourning. 5. Crete and the Relation of her Institutions with those of lacediemon (Aristotle, Politics, ii. 10. 1-5, 1271 b. Jowett's translation, revised on the basis of Susemihrs text, by G. W. B.) The opinion of the writer is that the Lacedaemonians adopted many of their institutions from Crete, and the Hellenic Cretans from the earlier inhab- itants. We know, however, that the Minoan civilization flourished in Laconia, and it seems to us, therefore, at least equally probable that the Lacedaemonians derived these institutions directly from the Minoans of their own country. If what Aristotle says regarding the Minoan origin is true, it follows that the institutions which we have looked upon as peculiarly Dorian belong to this earlier civilization. The view is reasonable, especially as the complex social organization of Laconia and historical Crete seems to be the product of a highly developed civilization, like the Oriental, rather than of a relatively crude race of invaders, such as were the Dorians. The Cretan constitution nearly resembles the Lacedaemonian, and in some few points is quite as good, but for the most part less perfect in form. The Lacedaemonian is said to be, and probably is, in most respects a copy of the Cretan. In fact older constitutions are generally less elaborate than later. According to tradition, Lycurgus, when he ceased to be guardian of King Charilaiis, went abroad and spent most of the time of his absence in Crete. For the two countries are nearly connected ; the Lyctians are a colony of the Lacedaemonians, and the colonists, when they came to Crete, adopted the system of laws which they found existing among the inhabitants. [Even to this day the periceci are governed by the original laws which Minos enacted. The island seems to be in- tended by nature for dominion in Hellas and to be well situated ; it extends right across the sea, around which nearly all the Hellenes are settled ; and while one end is not far from Peloponnesus, the other almost reaches to the region of Asia about Triopium and CRETAN INSTITUTIONS 71 Rhodes. Hence Minos acquired the empire of the sea, subduing some of the islands and colonizing others ; at last he invaded Sicily, where he died near Camicus.]' The Cretan institutions resemble the Lacedaemonian. The helots were the husbandmen of the one, the periceci of the other ; and both Cretans and Lacedaemonians have common meals, which were anciently called by the Lacedaemonians, not phiditia but andreia; and the Cretans have the same word, the use of which proves that the common meals (syssitia) originally came from Crete. 6. Occupation Classes; the Public Tables and the Colo- nization OF Italy (Aristotle, Politics, vii. 10. 1-6, 1329 b. Revision by G. W. B., as in no. 5) It is no new or recent discovery that the state ought to be divided into classes, and that the warriors ought to be separated from the husbandmen. The system has continued in Egypt and in Crete to the present day, and was established, as is said, by Sesostris in Egypt and by Minos in Crete. The institution of common tables (syssitia) also appears to be of ancient date, being in Crete as old as the reign of Minos, and in Italy far older. The native historians there say that a certain Italus was king of (Enotria, from whom the inhabitants were called Italians instead of CEno- trians, and who gave the name Italy to the promontory of Europe which lies between the Scylletic and Lametic gulfs, which are dis- tant from one another only a half-day's journey. They say that this Italus converted the CEnotrians from shepherds into husband- men, and besides giving them other laws, he was the founder of their common meals. Even in our day some who are derived from him retain this institution and certain other laws of his. On the side of Italy toward Tyrrhenia (Etruria) dwelt the Opici, who are now, as of old, called Ausones ; and on the side toward lapygia and the Ionian Gulf, in the district called Siritis, the Chones, who are likewise of CEnotrian race. From this part of the world origi- nally came the institution of the common tables ; the separation into classes, which was much older, from Egypt ; for the reign of Sesostris is of far greater antiquity than that of Minos. ' Bracketed by Susemihl. On the naval power of Minos, see no. 3. 72 MINOAN AND HOMERIC CIVILIZATIONS (Athenaeus xii. 24, probably quoting from Clearchus, Lives, iv) As indicated by their language, the lapygians were related to the Illyrians, and must have migrated to Italy far later than the Minoan age. There can be no doubt, however, that toward the end of the Minoan age the Cretans or other .(Egean people colonized southern Italy and Sicily ; hence there may have been a Cretan element in the lapygian population. This passage, however, refers mainly to later time. Now the race of the lapygians came originally from Crete, being descended from those Cretans who came to seek for Glaucus, and settled in that part of Italy. Afterward forgetting the orderly life of the Cretans, they came to such a pitch of luxury and thence to such a degree of insolence that they were the first people who painted their faces, and who wore headbands and false hair, and who clothed themselves in robes embroidered with flowers, and who considered it disgraceful to cultivate the land or to do any kind of labor. Most of them made their houses more beautiful than the temples of the Gods. Thus, they say, the leaders of the lapygians, treating the Deity with insult, destroyed the images of the Gods in the temples, ordering them to yield place to their superiors. For this reason, stricken with fire and thunderbolts, they gave rise to this report; for in fact the thunderbolts with which they were stricken down were visible a long time afterward. To this very day all their descendants live with shaven heads and in mourning apparel, in want of the luxuries which previously belonged to them. 7. Cretan Education and the Public Tables (Ephorus, Histories, quoted by Strabo x. 4. 20) The most illustrious and powerful of the youths form troops (a76\ai), each individual assembling together as many youths of his age as possible. Generally the governor of the troop is the father of the youth who has gathered it, the former has the function of taking them to hunt, of exercising them in running, and of pun- ishing the disobedient. They are maintained at the public expense. On certain set days troop encounters troop, marching in time to the sound of the pipe and lyre, as is their custom in actual war. They inflict blows, some with the hand and some even with iron weapons. PUBLIC TABLES 73 A certain number are selected from time to time from the troop and compelled forthwith to marry. They do not, however, take the young women whom they have married immediately to their homes, but wait until they are qualified to administer household affairs. (Dosiades, Cretica, iv, quoted by Athenaeus iv. 22, 143) Dosiades was a native of Crete of the Hellenistic age, who composed the work named above, dealing evidently with the history and antiquities of his island. Little else is known of him (c/. Schwartz, in Pauly-Wissowa, Real- Encycl. V. 1596 sq.) ; but he must have had access to abundant sources of infor- mation lost to us. The people of Lycti conduct their public tables as follows. Each brings in a tenth of the produce, and also the revenues of the state, which the authorities of the state distribute among the several houses. And each slave contributed an ^ginetan stater as poll tax. On reaching manhood the youth then passed from the troop to the club (hetaria). All the citizens are grouped in clubs. These institutions they call andreia. The ^management of a syssition (common table of an andreion) is in charge of a woman, who calls to her assistance three or four common men (Sti/iotikoi) . Each of these men is accompanied by two slaves as wood-carriers, called KaXo The host besieging Troy are called Achaeans, Argives, and Dana^s, apparently without discrimination. It is not likely that all who are represented as taking part in the expedition against Troy had a common name (Thuc. i. 3 ; no. g) ; but a common name was necessary for Homer's literary purpose, and we may accordingly suppose that the use of the terms Achaean in his poems is essentially literary. 'Zeus seems to have harbored no scruple about practising deception, and in general the Homeric gods were far from being patterns of virtue. ' The " elders" were the members of his council. Throughout the Iliad we find Nestor initiating most of the plans of the council. I AGAMEMNON'S DREAM 89 "Sleepest thou, son of wise Atreus tamer of horses? To sleep all night through beseemeth not one that is a counsellor, to whom peoples are entrusted ' and so many cares belong. But now hearken straightway to me, for I am a messenger to thee from Zeus, who though he be afar yet hath great care for thee and pity. He biddeth thee call to arms the flowing-haired Achaeans with all speed, for that now thou mayest take the wide-wayed city of the Trojans. For the immortals that dwell in the halls of Olympus are no longer divided in counsel, since Hera hath turned the minds of all by her beseeching, and over the Trojans sorrows hang by the will of Zeus. But do thou keep this in thy heart, nor let forgetfulness come upon thee when honeyed sleep shall leave thee." So spake the Dream, and departed and left him there, deeming in his mind things that were not to be fulfilled. For indeed he thought to take Priam's city that very day ; fond man, in that he knew not the plans that Zeus had in mind, who was willed to bring yet more grief and wailing on Trojans alike and Danaans through- out the course of stubborn fights. Then woke he from sleep, and the heavenly voice was in his ears, ^o he rose up sitting, and donned his soft chiton, fair and bright, and cast around him his great cloak, and beneath his glistening feet he bound his fair sandals, and over his shoulder cast his silver-studded sword, and grasped his sire's sceptre, imperishable for ever, wherewith he took his way amid the mail-clad Achaeans' ships. Now went the goddess Dawn to high Olympus, foretelling day- light to Zeus and aU the immortals ; and- the king bade the clear- voiced heralds summon to the assembly the flowing-haired Achaeans. So did those summon, and these gathered with speed." But first the council* of the great-hearted elders met beside the ship of king Nestor the Pylos-born. And he that had assembled > Here is a hint of the divine basis of the king's ofiSce. Immediately bdow is an indication that the king was the special object of Zeus' care. * The usual Homeric manner of calling the assembly of the people is here indi- cated. Ordinarily the warriors formed the assembly, but sometimes the working- people on the ships attended; in fact it was not in this age in any way exclusive. ' Here are pictured the summoning of the council of elders and with great brevity the procedure of its meeting . From other meetings we learn that it was customary to continue the discussion till opposition to the proposal ceased. There was no idea of a majority vote. 90 MINOAN AND HOMERIC CIVILIZATIONS them framed his cunning counsel : "Hearken, my friends. A dream from heaven came to me in my sleep through the ambrosial night, and chiefly to goodly Nestor was very like in shape and bulk and stature. And it stood over my head and charged me saying: 'Sleepest thou, son of wise Atreus tamer of horses? To sleep all night through beseemeth not one that is a counsellor, to whom peoples are entrusted and so many cares belong. But now hearken straightway to me, for I am a messenger to thee from Zeus, who though he be afar yet hath great care for thee and pity. He biddeth thee call to arms the flowing-haired Achasans with all speed, for that now thou mayest take the wide-wayed city of the Trojans. For the immortals that dwell in the palaces of Olympus are no longer divided in counsel, since Hera hath turned the nainds of all by her beseeching, and over the Trojans sorrows hang by the will of Zeus. But keep thou this in thy heart.' So spake the dream and was flown away, and sweet sleep left me. So come, let us now call to arms as we may the sons of the Achaeans. But first I will speak to make trial of them as is fitting, and will bid them flee with their benched ships ; only do ye from this side and from that speak to hold them back." So spake he and sat him down ; and there stood up among them Nestor, who was king of sandy Pylos. He of good intent made harangue to them and said: "My friends, captains and rulers of the Argives, had "any other of the Achasans told us this dream we might deem it a false thing, and rather turn away therefrom ; but now he hath seen it who of all Achaeans avoweth himseK far greatest. So come, let us call to arms as we may the sons of the Achaeans." So spake he, and led the way forth from the council, and all the other sceptred chiefs rose with him and obeyed the shepherd of the host ; and the people hastened to them.^ Even as when the tribes of thronging bees issue from some hollow rock, ever in fresh pro- cession, and fly clustering among the flowers of spring, and some on this hand and some on that fly thick ; even so from ships and huts before the low beach marched forth their many tribes by companiesv to the place of assembly. And in their midst blazed forth Rumor, messenger of Zeus, urging them to go ; and so they gathered. And 1 Here begins the gathering of the people in the assembly. There can be no doubt that the popular assemblies of the Hellenic states originally had this informal characteL THE ASSEMBLY 91 the place of assemblage was in an uproar, and the earth echoed again as the hosts sat them down, and there was turmoil. Nine heralds restrained them with shouting, if perchance they might refrain from clamor, and hearken to their kings, the fosterlings of Zeus.^ And hardly at the last would the people sit, and keep them to their benches and cease from noise. Then stood up lord Agamemnon bearing his sceptre, that Hephaestus had wrought curiously. Hephaestus gave it to king Zeus son of Cronos, and then Zeus gave it to the messenger-god the slayer of Argus ; ^ and king Hermes gave it to Pelops the charioteer, and Pelops again gave it to Atreus shep- herd of the host. And Atreus dying left it to Thyestes rich in flocks, and Thyestes in his turn left it to Agamemnon to bear, that over many islands and all Argos he should be lord. Thereon he leaned and spake his saying to the Argives ' : — "My friends, Danaan warriors, men of Ares' company, Zeus Cronos' son hath bound me with might in grievous blindness of soul; hard of heart is he, for that erewhile he promised me and pledged his nod that not till I had wasted well-walled Ilios should I return ; but now see I that he planned»a cruel wile and biddeth me return to Argos dishonored, with the loss of many of my folk. So meseems it pleaseth most mighty Zeus, who hath laid low the head of many a city, yea, and shall lay low ; for his is highest power. Shame is this even for them that come after to hear ; how so goodly and great a folk of the Achasans thus vainly warred a bootless war, and fought scantier enemies, and no end thereof is yet seen. For if perchance we were minded, both Achasans and Trojans, to swear a solemn truce, and to number ourselves, and if the Trojans should gather together all that have their dwellings in the city, and we Achaeans should marshal ourselves by tens, and every company choose a Trojan to pour their wine, then would many tens lack a cup-bearer : so much, I say, do the sons of the Achaeans outnumber the Trojans that dwell within the city. But allies from many cities, even warriors that wield the spear, are therein, and they ' These were Agamemnon, the over-lord, and the members of his comica, all of them " kings " (basilees) and all under divine protection. ^The meaning of the word 'Apyei^Ai'TTjs, Argeiphontes, is uncertain; possibly it signifies, not " slayer of Argus," but " appearing in brightness." ' The history of the scepter is further evidence of the divine origin of Agamemnon's royalty. 92 MINOAN AND HOMERIC CIVILIZATIONS hinder me perforce, and for all my will suffer me not to waste the populous citadel of lUos. Already have nine years of great Zeus passed away, and our ships' timbers have rotted and the tackling is loosed ; while there our wives and little children sit in our halls awaiting us ; yet is our task utterly unaccomplished wherefor we came hither. So come, even as I shall bid let us all obey. Let us flee with our ships to our dear native land ; for now shall we never take wide-wayed Troy." So spake he, and stirred the spirit in the breasts of all throughout the multitude, as many as had not heard the council. And the assembly swayed like high sea-waves of the Icarian Main that east wind and south wind raise, rushing upon them from the clouds of father Zeus ; and even as when the west wind cometh to stir a deep cornfield with violent blast, and the ears bow down, so was all the assembly stirred, and they with shouting hasted toward the ships ; and the dust from beneath their feet rose and stood on high. And they bade each man his neighbor to seize the ships and drag them into the bright salt sea, and cleared out the launching-ways, and the noise went up to heaven of their hurrying homeward; and they began to take the props from beneath the ships. Then would the Argives have accompKshed their return against the will of fate, but that Hera spake a word to Athene : "Out on it, daughter of aegis-bearing Zeus, unwearied maiden! Shall the Argives thus indeed flee homeward to their dear native land over the sea's broad back? But they would leave to Priam and the Trojans their boast, even Helen of Argos, for whose sake many an Achaean hath perished in Troy, far away from his dear native land. But go thou now amid the host of the mail-clad Achaeans ; with thy gentle words restrain thou every man, neither suffer them to draw their curved ships down to the salt sea." So spake she, and the bright-eyed goddess Athene disregarded not ; but went darting down from the peaks of Olympus, and came with speed to the fleet ships of the Achaeans. There found she Odysseus standing, peer of Zeus in counsel, neither laid he any hand upon his decked black ship, because grief had entered into his heart and soul. And bright-eyed Athene stood by him and said "Heaven-sprung son of Laertes, Odysseus of many devices, will ye indeed fling yourselves upon your benched ships to flee homeward SOCIAL CLASSES IN THE ARMY 93 to your dear native land ? But ye would leave to Priam and the Trojans their boast, even Helen of Argos, for whose sake many an Achaean hath perished in Troy, far from his dear native land. But go thou now amid the host of the Achaeans, and tarry not ; and with thy gentle words refrain every man, neither suffer them to draw their curved ships down to the salt sea." So said she, and he knew the voice of the goddess speaking to him, and set him to run, and cast away his mantle, the which his herald gathered up, even Eurybates of Ithaca, that waited on him. And himself he went to meet Agamemnon son of Atreus, and at his hand received the sceptre of his sires, imperisha,ble for ever, where- with he took his way amid the ships of the mail-clad Achaeans. Whenever he found one that was a captain and a man of mark, he stood by his side, and refrained him with gentle words •.^" Good sir, it is not seemly to affright thee like a coward, but do thou sit thyself and make all thy folk sit down. For thou knowest not yet clearly what is the purpose of Atreus' son ; now is he but making trial, and soon he will aflSict the sons of the Achaeans. ^And heard we not all of us what he spake in the council ? Beware lest in his anger he evilly entreat the sons of the Achaeans. For proud is the soul of heaven-fostered kings ; because their honor is of Zeus, and the god of counsel loveth them." But whatever man of the people he saw and found him shouting, him he drave with his sceptre and chode him with loud words: "Good 5ir, sit still and hearken to the words of others that are thy betters ; but thou art no warrior, and a weakling, never reckoned whether in battle or in council. In no wise can we Achaeans all be kings here. A multitude of masters is no good thing ; let there be one master, one king, to whom the son of crooked-counselling Cronos hath granted it, [even the sceptre and judgments, that he may rule among you"].^ So masterfully ranged he the host ; and they hasted back to the assembly from ships and huts, with noise as when a wave of the loud-sounding sea roareth on the long beach and the main re- soundeth. ' Contrast the bearing of Odysseus toward the captains and the people respec- tively. 2 This line seems to have been irlterpolated. 94 MINOAN AND HOMERIC CIVILIZATIONS Now all the rest sat down and kept their place upon the benches, only Thersites ^ still chattered on, the uncontrolled of speech, whose mind was full of words many and disorderly, wherewith to strive against the chiefs idly and in no good order, but even as he deemed that he should make the Argives laugh. And he was ill-favored beyond all men that came to Ilios. Bandy-legged was he, and lame of one foot, and his two shoulders rounded, arched down upon his chest ; and over them his head was warped, and a scanty stubble sprouted on it. Hateful was he to Achilles above all and to Odys- seus, for them he was wont to revile. But now with shrill shout he poured forth his upbraidings upon goodly Agamemnon. With him the Achaeans were sore vexed and had indignation in their souls. But he with loud shout spake and reviled Agamemnon: "Atreides, for what art thou now ill content and lacking? Surely thy huts are^ full of bronze and many women are in thy huts, the chosen spoils that we Achseans give thee first of all, whene'er we take a town. Can it be that thou yet wantest gold as well, such as some one of the horse-taming Trojans may bring from Ilios to ran- som his son, whom I perchance or some other Achaean have led captive; or else some young girl, to know in love, whom thou mayest keep apart to thyself ? * But it is not seemly for one that is their captain to bring the sons of the Achaeans to iU. Soft fools, base things of shame, ye women of Achaea and men no more, let us depart home with our ships, and leave this fellow here in Troy-land to gorge him with meeds of honor, that he may see whether our aid avail him aught or no ; even he that hath now done dishonor to Achilles, a far better man than he ; for he hath taken away his meed of honor and keepeth it by his own violent deed. Of a very surety is there no wrath at all in Achilles' mind, but he is slack ; else this despite, thou son of Atreus, were thy last." So spake Thersites, reviHng Agamenmon shepherd of the host. But goodly Odysseus came straight to his side, and looking sternly at him with hard words rebuked him : "Thersites, reckless in words, ' Thersites was a man of the people. It was not forbidden such people to speak in the assembly, but they were imder obligations to show respect to the nobles. Ther- sites failed in the requirement and was punished. ' A right of the assembly of warriors after a victory was to divide the spoil and assign shares even to the leaders. • ^ THERSITES 95 shrill orator though thou art, refrain thyself, nor aim to strive singly against kings. For I deem that no mortal is baser than thou of all that with the sons of Atreus came before IKos. Therefore were it well that thou shouldest not have kings in thy mouth as thou talkest, and utter revilings against them and be on the watch for departure. We know not yet clearly how these things shall be, whether we sons of the Achaeans shall return for good or for ill. Therefore now dost thou revile continually Agamenmon son of Atreus, shepherd of the host, because the Danaan warriors give him many gifts, and so thou talkest tauntingly. But I will tell thee plain, and that I say shall even be brought to pass : if I find thee again raving as now thou art, then may Odysseus' head no longer abide upon his shoulders, nor may I any more be called father of Telem'achus, if I take thee not and strip from thee thy garments, thy mantle and chiton that cover thy nakedness, and for thyself send thee weeping to the fleet ships, and beat thee out of the assembly with shameful blows." So spake he, and with his staff smote his back and shoulders : and he bowed down and a big tear fell from him, and a bloody weal stood up from his back beneath the golden sceptre. Then he sat down and was amazed, and in pain with helpless look wiped away the tear. But the rest, though they were sorry, laughed lightly at him, and thus would one speak looking at another standing by : "Go to, of a truth Odysseus hath wrought good deeds without number ere now, standing foremost in wise counsels and setting battle in array, but now is this thing the best by far that he hath wrought among the Argives, to wit, that he hath stayed this prating railer from his harangues. Never again, forsooth, will his proud soul henceforth bid him revile the kings with slanderous words." So said the common sort ; but up rose Odysseus waster of cities, with the sceptre in his hand. And by his side bright-eyed Athene in the likeness of a herald bade the multitude keep silence, that the sons of the Achasans, both the nearest and the farthest, might hear his words together and give heed to his counsel. He of good intent made harangue to them and said : "Atreides, now surely are the Achseans for making thee, O king, most despised among all mortal men, nor wiU they fulfil the promise that they pledged thee when they still were marching hither from horse-pasturing Argos ; that thou shouldest not return till thou hadst laid weU-walled Ilios waste: 96 MINOAN AND HOMERIC CIVILIZATIONS For like young children or widow women do they wail each to the other of returning home. Yea, here is toil to make a man depart disheartened. For he that stayeth away but one single month far from his wife in his benched ship f retteth himself when winter storms and the furious sea imprison him ; but for us, the ninth year of our stay here is upon us in its course. Therefore do I not marvel that the Achaeans should fret beside their beaked ships ; yet nevertheless is it shameful to wait long and to depart empty. Be of good heart, my friends, and wait a while, until we learn whether Calchas ^ be a true prophet or no. For this thing verily we know well in our hearts, and ye all are witnesses thereof, even as many as the fates of death have not borne away. It was as it were but yesterday or the day before that the Achaeans' ships were gathering in Aulis, freighted with trouble for Priam and the Trojans; and we round about a spring were offering on the holy altars unblemished hecatombs to the immortals, beneath a fair plane-tree whence flowed bright water, when there was seen a great portent : a snake blood-red on the back, terrible, whom the god of Olympus himself had sent forth to the light of day, sprang from beneath the altar and darted to the plane- tree. Now there were there the brood of a sparrow, tender little ones, upon the topmost branch, nestling beneath the leaves ; eight were they and the mother of the little ones was the ninth, and the snake swallowed these cheeping pitifully. And the mother fluttered around wailing for her dear little ones ; but he coiled himself and caught her by the wing as she screamed about him. Now when he had swallowed the sparrow's little ones and the mother with them, the god who revealed him made of him a sign ; for the son of crooked- counselling Cronos turned him to stone, and we stood by and mar- velled to see what was done. So when the dread portent pvake in upon the hecatombs of the gods, then did Calchas forthwith prophesy, and said : 'Why hold ye your peace, ye flowing-haired Achaeans? To us hath Zeus the counsellor shown this great sign, late come, of late fulfOment, the fame whereof shall never perish. Even as he swallowed the sparrow's little ones and herself, the eight wherewith the mother that bare the little ones was the ninth, so shaJl we war there so many years, but in the tenth year shall we 1 Calchas the seer (/{. i. 68 sqq.). THE ASSEMBLY DECIDES 97 take the wide-wayed city.' So spake the seer ; and now are all these things being fulfilled. So come, abide ye all, ye well-greaved Achaeans, even where ye are, until we have taken the great city of Priam." So spake he, and the Argives shouted aloud, and all round the ships echoed terribly to the voice of the Achseans as they praised the saying of god-like Odysseus. And then spake among them ' knightly Nestor of Gerenia : "Out on it ; in very truth ye hold assembly like siUy boys that have no care for deeds of war. What shall come of our covenants and our oaths? Let all counsels be cast into the fire and all devices of warriors and the pure drink-offer- ings and the right hands of fellowship wherein we trusted. For we are vainly striving with words nor can we find any device at all, for all our long tarrying here. Son of Atreus, do thou still, as erst, keep steadfast purpose and lead the Argives amid the violent fray ; and for these, let them perish, the one or two Achaeans that take secret counsel — though fulfilment shall not come thereof — to depart to Argos first, before they know whether the promise of aegis-bearing Zeus be a Ue or no. Yea, for I say that most mighty Cronidn pledged us his word that day when the Argives embarked upon their fleet ships, bearing unto the Trojans death and fate ; , j i i j/for by his lightning upon our right he manifested signs of good. ' ' ' ' Therefore let no man hasten to depart home till each have lain by some Trojan's wife and paid back his strivings and groans for Helen's sake. But if any man is overmuch desirous to depart homeward, let him lay his hand upon his decked black ship, that before all men he may encounter death and fate. But do thou, my king, take good counsel thyself, and hearken to another that shall give it ; the word that I speak, whate'er it be, shall not be cast away. Separate thy warriors by tribes and by phratries, Agamemnon, that phratry may give aid to phratry and tribe to tribe.i If thou do thus and the Achaeans hearken to thee, then wilt thou know who among thy captains and who of the common sort is a coward, and who too is brave ; for they will fight each after their sort. So wilt thou know whether it is even by divine com- 'The division of the host into tribes and^^irabi^ was doubtless the military organization of the primitive Greeks. In time thephratnes disappeared from the army, but in many states, as in Athens, the tribes continued in it to the end. 98 MINOAN AND HOMERIC CIVILIZATIONS mand that thou shalt not take the city, or by the baseness of thy warriors and their ill skill in battle." And lord Agamemnon answered and said to him : "Verily hast thou again outdone the sons of the Achseans in speech, old man. Ah, father Zeus and Athene and Apollo, would that among the Achaeans I had ten such councillors ; then would the city of kiag Priam soon bow beneath our hands, captive and wasted. But aegis-bearing Zeus, the son of Cronos, hath brought sorrows upon me, in that he casteth my lot amid fruitless wranglings and strifes. For in truth I and Achilles fought about a damsel with violent words, and I was first to be angry ; but if we can only be at one in council, then will there no more be any putting off the day of evil for the Trojans, no not for an instant. But now go ye to your meal that we may Join battle. Let each man sharpen well his spear and be- stow well his shield, and let him well give his fleet-footed steeds their meal, and look well to his chariot on every side and take thought for battle, that all day long we may contend in hateful war. For of respite shall there intervene no, not a whit, only that the coming of night shall part the fury of warriors. On each man's breast shall the baldrick of his covering shield be wet with sweat, and his hand shall grow faint about the spear, and each man's horse shall sweat as he draweth the polished chariot. And whom-\ soever I perceive minded to tarry far from the fight beside ' the beaked ships, for him shall there be no hope hereafter to escape the dogs and birds of prey." So spake he, and the Argives shouted aloud,^ like to a wave on a steep shore, when the south wind cometh and stirreth it ; even on a jutting rock, that is never left at peace by the waves of all winds that rise from this side and from that. And they stood up and scattered in haste throughout the ships,^ and made fires in the huts and took their meal. And they did sacrifice each man to one of the everlasting gods, prajang for escape from death and the tumult of battle. But Agamemnon king of men slew a fat buU of five years to most mighty Cronion, and caUed the elders, the princes of the Achaean host, Nestor first and king Idomeneus, and then the two Aiantes and Tydeus' son, and sixthly Odysseus peer of Zeus ' This was an emphatic aflSrmative, dissent being indicated by silence. " This closes the f lillest account of the popular assembly given in Homer's poems. THE CALL TO ARMS 99 in counsel. And Menelaiis of the loud war-cry came to him un- bidden, for he knew in his heart how his brother toiled. Then stood they around the bull and took the barley-meal. And Aga- memnon made his prayer in their midst and said: "Zeus, most glorious, most great, god of the storm-cloud, that dwellest in the heaven, vouchsafe that the sun set not upon us nor the darkness come near, till I have laid low upon the earth Priam's palace smirched with smoke, and burnt the doorways thereof with con- suming fire, and rent on Hector's breast his doublet cleft with the blade ; and about him may full many of his comrades prone in the dust bite the earth." So spake he, but not as yet would Cronion grant him fulfilment ; he accepted the sacrifice, but made toil to wax unceasingly. Now when they had prayed and sprinkled the barley-meal they first drew back the bull's head and cut his throat and flayed him, and cut slices from the thighs and wrapped them in fat, making a double fold, , and laid raw coUops thereon. And these they burnt on cleft wood stript of leaves, and spitted the vitals and held them over Hephaestus' flame. Now when the thighs were burnt and they had tasted the vitals, then sliced they all the rest and pierced it through with spits, and roasted it carefully and drew all off again. So when they had rest from the tisk and had made ready the ban- quet, they feasted, nor was their heart aught stinted of the fair banquet. But when they had put away from them the desire of meat and drink, then did knightly Nestor of Gerenia open his saying to them : "Most noble son of Atreus, Agamemnon king of men, let us not any more hold long converse here, nor for long delay the work that god putteth in our hands ; but come, let the heralds of the mail-clad Achaeans make proclamation to the folk and gather them throughout the ships ; and let us go thus in concert through the wide host of the Achaeans, that the speedier we may arouse keen war." So spake he and Agamemnon king of men disregarded not. Straightway he bade the clear-voiced heralds summon to battle the flowing-haired Achaeans. So those summoned and these gathered with all speed. And the kings, the fosterKngs of Zeus that were about Atreus' son, eagerly marshalled them, and bright- eyed Athene in the midst, bearing the holy asgis that knoweth neither loo MINOAN AND HOMERIC CIVILIZATIONS age nor death, whereon wave an hundred tassels of pur^gold, all deftly woven and each one an hundred oxen worth. Therewith she passed dazzling through the Achaean folk, urging them forth; and in every man's heart she roused strength to battle without ceasing and to fight. So was war made sweeter to them than to depart in their hollow ships to their dear native land. Even as ravaging fire kindleth a boundless forest on a moimtain's peaks, and the blaze is seen from afar, even so as they marched went the dazzling gleam from the innumerable bronze through the sky even unto the heavens. And as the many tribes of feathered birds, wild geese or cranes or long-necked swans, on the Asian mead by Cayster's stream, fly hither and thither joying in their plumage, and with loud cries settle ever onwards, and the mead resounds ; even so poured forth the many tribes of warriors from ships and huts into the Scaman- drian plain. And the earth echoed terribly beneath the tread of men and horses. So stood they in the flowery Scamandrian plain, unnumbered as are leaves and flowers in their season. Even as the many tribes of thick flies that hover about a herdsman's stead- ing in the spring season, when milk drencheth the pails, even in like number stood the flowing-haired Achaeans upon the plain in face of the Trojans, eager to rend them asunder. And even as the goatherds easily divide the ranging flocks of goats when they mingle in the pasture, so did their captains marshal them on this side and on that, to enter into the fray, and in their midst lord Agamemnon, his head and eyes Uke unto Zeus whose joy is in the thunder, and his waist like unto Ares and his breast unto Poseidon. Even as a bull standeth out far foremost amid the herd, for he is pre-eminent amid the pasturing kine, even such did Zeus make Atreides on that day, pre-eminent among many and chief amid heroes. 13. The Shield of Achilles and the Scenes from Life that were wrought upon it (Homer, Iliad, xviii. 467-608) At the request of the goddess Thetis, Hephaestus the divine artisan fashions for her son Achilles a great shield and adorns it with scenes from life. It was formerly supposed that such Homeric creations were purely imagi- PICTURES FROM LIFE loi nary ; but since the explorations at Mycenae, Troy, Cnossus, and other Minoan sites have revealed a pre-Homeric skill in the fashioning and decoration of metals that fills us with astonishment, we can no longer doubt that his pictures of art objects have a basis of reality. We are by no means to suppose that he had knowledge, for example, of a shield precisely Uke the one here described, but rather that many of the elements of his pictures are real. In like manner the scenes from life wrought on the shield were probably taken from the world about him but idealized after the manner of a great creative poet. Thus sajdng he left her there and went unto his bellows and turned them upon the fire and bade them work. And the bellows, twenty in all, blew on the crucibles, sending deft blasts on every side, now to aid his labor and now anon howsoever Hephaestus willed, and the work went on. And he threw bronze that weareth not into the fire, and tin and precious gold and silver, and next he set on an anvil-stand a great anvil, and took in his hand a sturdy hammer, and in the other he took the tongs. First fashioned he a shield great and strong, adorning it all over, and set thereto a shining rim, triple, bright-glancing, and there- from a silver baldrick. Five were the folds of the shield itself ; and therein fashioned he much cunning work from his wise heart. There wrought he the earth, and the heavens, and the sea, and the tmwearying sun, and the moon waxing to the full, and the signs every one wherewith the heavens are crowned, Pleiads and Hyads and Orion's might, and the Bear that men call also the Wain, her that turneth in her place and watcheth Orion, and alone hath no part in the baths of Ocean. Also he fashioned therein two fair cities of mortal men. In the one were espousals and marriage feasts, and beneath the blaze of torches they were leading the brides from their chambers through the city, and loud arose the bridal song. And young men were whirling in the dance, and among them flutes and viols sounded high ; and the women standing each at her door were marvelling. But the folk were gathered in the assembly place ; for there a strife was arisen, two men striving about the blood-price of a man slain ; the one claimed to pay full atonement, expounding to the people, but the other denied him and would take naught ; and both were fain to receive arbitram^t at the hand of a daysman. And the J folk were cheering both, as they took part on either side. And I02 MINOAN AND HOMERIC CIVILIZATIONS heralds kept order among the folk, while the elders on polisha stones were sitting in the sacred circle, and holding in their hand staves from the loud-voiced heralds. Then before the people the] rose up and gave judgment each in turn. And in the midst lay tw( talents of gold, to be given unto him who should plead among then most righteously.^ But around the other city were two armies in siege with glitter- ing arms. And two counsels found favor among them, either tc sack the town or to share all with the townsfolk even whatsoevei substance the fair city held within. But the besieged were not yel 3delding, but arming for an ambushment. On the wall there stooc to guard it their dear wives and infant children, and with these thf old men ; but the rest went forth, and their leaders were Ares anc PaUas Athene, both wrought in gold, and golden was the vesture they had on. Goodly and great were they in their armor, even as gods, far seen aroimd, and the folk at their feet were smaller. And when they came where it seemed good to them to lay ambush, ii a river bed where there was a common watering-place of herds there they set them, clad in ghttering bronze. And two scouts were posted by them afar off to spy the coming of flocks and oi oxen with crooked horns. And presently came the cattle, and witt them two herdsmen playing on pipes, that took no thought of the guile. Then the others when they beheld these ran upon them and quickly cut off the herds of oxen and fair flocks of white sheep, and slew the shepherds withal. But the besiegers, as they sat before the speech-places ^ and heard much din among the oxen, mounted forthwith behind their high-stepping horses, and came up witt speed. Then they arrayed their battle and fought beside the rivei banks, and smote one another with bronze-shod spears. And among them mingled Strife and Tumult, and fell Death, grasping one man ahve fresh-wounded, another without wound, and drag- ging another dead through the mellay by the feet ; and the raiment ' We notice that the court was made up of " elders " without the king. The cast was not criminal ; it was a question of property, brought before the elders for arbitra- tion. The elders gave their opinion in succession while the people cheered. Probabl) that elder was thought to have spoken most wisely whom the people most vigorousl) cheered. Here, then, was the germ ot popular jurisdiction. The talent here mentionec must have been a small weight, far less than the later Attic talent. * From which the orators spoke; Aristarchus, cited >by Lang, Leaf, and Myres. RURAL SCENES 103 on her shoulders was red with the blood of men. Like living mor- tals they hurled together and fought, and haled the corpses each of the other's slain. Furthermore he set in the shield a soft fresh-ploughed field, rich tilth and wide, the third time ploughed ; and many ploughers therein drave their yokes to and fro as they wheeled about. Whensoever they came to the boundary of the field and turned, then would a man come to each and give into his hands a goblet of sweet wine, while others would be turning back along the furrows, fain to reach the boundary of the deep tilth. And the field grew black behind and seemed as it were a-ploughing, albeit of gold, for this was the great marvel of the work. Furthermore he set therein the demesne-land of a king, where hinds were reaping with sharp sickles in their hands. Some arm- fuls along the swathe were falling in rows to the earth, whilst others the sheaf-binders were binding in twisted bands of straw. Three sheaf-binders stood over them, while behind boys gathering corn and bearing it in their arms gave it constantly to the binders ; and among them the king in silence was standing at the swathe with his staff, rejoicing in his heart. And henchmen apart beneath an oak were making ready a feast, and preparing a great ox they had sacrificed ; while the women were strewing much white barley to be a supper for the hinds. Also he set therein a vineyard teeming plenteously with clusters, wrought fair in gold ; black were the grapes, but the vines hung throughout on silver poles. And around it he ran a ditch of cyanus, and round that a fence of tin ; and one single pathway led to it, whereby the vintagers might go when they should gather the vin- tage. And maidens and striplings in childish glee bare the sweet fruit in plaited baskets. And in the midst of them a boy made pleasant music on a clear-toned viol, and sang thereto a sweet Linos-song^ with delicate voice; while the rest with feet falling together kept time with the music and song. Also he wrought therein a herd of kine with upright horns, and the kine were fashioned of gold and tin, and with lowing they hurried from the byre to pasture beside a murmuring river, beside the ' "Probably a lament for departing summer;" Lang, Leaf, and Myres. I04 MINOAN AND HOMERIC CIVILIZATIONS waving reed. And herdsmen of gold were following with the kine, four of them, and nine dogs fleet of foot came after them. But two terrible hons among the foremost kine had seized a loud-roaring bull that bellowed mightily as they haled him, and the dogs and the young men sped after him. The lions rending the great bull's hide were devouring his vitals and his black blood ; while the herds- men in vain tarred on their fleet dogs to set on, for they shrank from biting the Uons but stood hard by and barked and swerved away. Also the glorious lame god wrought therein a pasture in a fair glen, a great pasture of white sheep, and a steading, and roofed huts, and folds. [Also did the glorious lame god devise a dancing-place like unto that which once in wide Cnossus Daedalus ^ wrought for Ariadne of the lovely tresses. There were youths dancing and maidens of costly wooing, their hands upon one another's wrists. Fine linen the maidens had on, and the youths well-woven doublets faintly glistening with oil. Fair wreaths had the maidens, and the youths daggers of gold hanging from silver baldrics. And now would they run round with deft feet exceeding hght, as when a potter sitting by his wheel that fitteth between his hands maketh trial of it whether it run : and now anon they would run in Hnes to meet each other. And a great company stood round the lovely dance in joy; and among them a divine minstrel was making music on his lyre, and through the midst of them, leading the measure, two tumblers whirled.] ^ Also he set therein the great might of the River of Ocean around the uttermost rim of the cunningly-fashioned shield. 14 (a). A Visit to the Homeric Palace at Sparta (Homer, Odyssey, iv. 1-46) Telemachus, son of Odysseus, king of Ithaca, resolves to go to Sparta to make inquiry of King Menelaiis concerning his father, who in returning from Troy has been wandering far and wide, driven by angry Poseidon. Telemachus • Such a dancing-place, orchestra, actually exists in the ruins of the palace at Cnossus ; Botsford, Hellenic History, ch. ii. ' This entire passage is bracketed by Dindorf-Hentze, ed. of 1909. THE PALACE AT SPARTA 105 is accompanied by Peisistratus, son of Nestor, king of Pylos. They make their journey in a two-horse car. The account of the palace, given in this selection and in the number follow- ing, corresponds so closely with the palaces unearthed at Tiryns, Mycenae, and elsewhere as to force us to the conclusion that Homer either actually saw palaces of the kind or learned of them through a perfectly reliable source. Excavations on the site of Sparta have shown that no Minoan city had existed there, and that the settlement was made about 1000 B.C. There were, however, Minoan cities in the vicinity and in various parts of Laconia. We should keep in mind the fact that whereas the ancients supposed Homer to have lived before the "Dorian migration," evidence now exists that he lived afterward : he knew, for instance, that there were Dorians in Crete (no. 10) and that at Sparta were Castor and Pollux, deities of the two royal families. And they came to Lacedaemon lying low among the caverned hiUs, and drave to the dwelling of renowned Menelaiis. Him they found giving a feast in his house to many friends of his kin, a feast for the wedding of his noble son and daughter. His daughter he was sending to the son of Achilles cleaver of the ranks of men, for in Troy he first had promised and covenanted to give her, and now the gods were bringing about their marriage. So now he was speed- ing her on her way with chariot and horses, to the famous city of the Myrmidons ^ among whom her lord bare rule. And for his son he was bringing to his home the daughter of Alector out of Sparta, for his well-beloved son, strong Megapenthes, born of a slave woman, for the gods no more showed promise of seed to Helen, from the day that she bare a lovely child, Hermione, as fair as golden Aphrodite. So they were feasting through the great vaulted hall, the neighbors and the kinsmen of renowned Menelaiis, making merry ; and among them a divine minstrel was singing to the lyre, and as he began the song two tumblers in the company whirled through the midst of them. Meanwhile those twain, the hero Telemachus and the splendid son of Nestor, made halt at the entry of the gate, they and their horses. And the lord Eteoneus came forth and saw them, the ready squire of renowned Menelaiis ; and he went through the palace to ' A tribe in Thessaly non-existent in historical times. The intermarriage between families of different states continued down to the early fifth century, when Athens and doubtless other states became too exclusive to permit the continuance of the custom ; Botsford, HeUmic History, oh. xiii. io6 MmOAN AND HOMERIC CIVILIZATIONS bear the tidings to the shepherd of the people/ and standing near spake to him winged words : 'Menelaiis, fosterhng of Zeus, here are two strangers, whosoever they be, two men like to the lineage of great Zeus. Say, shall we loose their swift horses from under the yoke, or send them onward to some other host who shall receive them kindly ? ' Then in sore displeasure spake to him Menelaiis of the fair hair : 'Eteoneus son of Boethous, truly thou wert not a fool aforetime, but now for this once like a child thou talkest folly. Surely our- selves ate much hospitable cheer of other men, ere we twain came hither, even if in time to come Zeus haply give us rest from aflBiction. Nay go, unyoke the horses of the strangers, and as for the men, lead them forward to the house to feast with us.' So spake he, and Eteoneus hasted from the hall, and called the other ready squires to follow him. So they loosed the sweating horses from beneath the yoke, and fastened them at the stalls of the horses, and threw beside them spelt, and therewith mixed white barley, and tilted the chariot against the shining faces of the gate- way, and led the men into the hall divine. And they beheld and marvelled as they gazed throughout the palace of the king, the fosterling of Zeus ; for there was a gleam as it were of sun or moon through the lofty palace of renowned Menelaiis. But after they had gazed their fill they went to the polished baths and bathed them.^ Now when the maidens had bathed them and anointed them with ohve oil, and cast about them thick cloaks and doublets, they sat on chairs by Menelaiis, son of Atreus. And a handmaid bare water for the hands in a goodly golden ewer, and poured it forth over a silver basin to wash withal; and to their side she drew a polished table, and a grave dame bare food and set it by them, and laid upon the board many dainties, giving freely of such things as she had by her, and a carver lifted and placed by them platters of divers kinds of flesh, and nigh them he set golden bowls. So Mene- laiis of the fair hair greeted the twain and spake: 'Taste ye food and be glad and thereafter when ye have supped, we will ask what men you are ; for the blood of your parents is not ' A common designation of the Homeric king. * A bathroom with drains has been found in the palace at Tiryns. THE PHEACIAN PALACE 107 lost in you, but ye are of the line of men that are sceptered kings the fosterhngs of Zeus ; for no churls could beget sons like you.' So spake he, and took and set before them the fat ox-chine roasted, which they had given him as his own mess by way of honor. And they stretched forth their hands upon the good cheer set before them. Now when they had put from them the desire of meat and drink Telemachus spake to the son of Nestor, holding his head close to him, that those others might not hear: "Son of Nestor, delight of my heart, mark the flashing of bronze through the echoing halls, and the flashing of gold and of amber and of silver and of ivory. Such like, methinks, is the court of Olym- pian Zeus within, for the world of things that are here; wonder comes over me as I look thereon." ^ 14(b). The Visit of Odysseus to the Palace of Alcinous, THE Ph^eacian King (Homer, Odyssey, vii. 78-132) Odysseus in his wanderings has been wrecked on Scheria, the Phaeacian island, and rescued by the princess Nausicaa, who sends him to the palace of her father AlcinoUs. The goddess Athena has met and conversed with him on the way, after which she takes her flight to Athens, and Odysseus enters the palace. This selection gives some features of the palace not mentioned in no. 14(a), and presents a charming picture of the garden attached to the palace. Therewith grey-eyed Athene departed over the unharvested seas, and left pleasant Scheria, and came to Marathon and wide- wayed Athens, and entered the good house of Erechtheus." Mean- while Odysseus went to the famous palace of Alcinous, and his heart was full of many thoughts as he stood there or ever he had reached the threshold of bronze. For there was a gleam as it were of sun or moon through the high-roofed hall of great-hearted Al- cinous. Brazen were the walls which ran this way and that from the threshold to the inmost chamber, and round them was a frieze of ' Excavations of palaces and tombs show that this passage is no great exaggera- tion of their interior decorations. ' These lines have been included in this selection in order to call attention to the existence of a temple to Athena and Erechtheus at Athens at the time of the com- position of this poem. It is curious that the poet thought of Marathon as the proper way of approach to Athens. io8 MINOAN AND HOMERIC CIVILIZATIONS blue/ and golden were the doors that closed in the good house. Silver were the door posts that were set on the brazen threshold, and silver the lintel thereupon, and the hook of the door was of gold. And on either side stood golden hounds and silver, which Hephaestus wrought by his cunning, to guard the palace of great- hearted Alcinotis being free from death and age all their days. And within were seats arrayed against the wall this way and that, from the threshold even to the inmost chamber * and thereon were spread light coverings finely woven, the handiwork of women. There the Phaeacian chieftains were wont to sit eating and drinking, for they had continual store. Yea, and there were youths fashioned in gold, standing on firm-set bases, with flaming torches in their hands, giving light through the night to the feasters in the palace. And he had fiity handmaids in the house, and some grind the yellow grain on the millstone, and others weave webs and turn the yarn as they sit, restless as the leaves of the tall poplar tree : ' and the soft olive oil drops off that linen, so closely is it woven. For as the Phaeacian men are skilled beyond all others in driving a swift ship upon the deep, even so are the women the most cunning at the loom, for Athene hath given them notable wisdom in aUfair handiwork and cunning wit. And without the courtyard hard by the door is a great garden, of four ploughgates,* and a hedge runs round on either side. And there grow tall trees blossoming, pear- trees and pomegranates, and apple-trees with .bright fruit, and sweet figs, and olives in their bloom. The fruit of these trees never perisheth neither faileth, winter nor summer, enduring through all the year. Evermore the West Wind blowing brings some fruits to birth and ripens others. Pear upon pear waxes old, and apple ' This blue-glass paste has been found in considerable quantities at Tiryns, a fact which proves that Homer in speaking of the frieze is dealing with something real. For patterns of friezes and other interior decorations, see any illustrated work on Minoan civilization. ' Such seats, arrayed along the wall, have been found in the palace at Cnossus. For an illustration, see Botsford, Ancient World, 71. ' In the palace at Cnossus an "industrial quarter" has been foimd, in which were manufactured by hundreds of hands the objects of use and luxury of the loyal family and their attendants. The palace of AldnoUs was far more modest, and the industrial equipment was on a correspondingly smaller scale. In Homeric life most of the working people of the palace were women. * This measure is imknown. THE PALACE GARDEN 109 upon apple, yea and cluster ripens upon cluster of the grape, and fig upon fig. There too hath he a fruitful vineyard planted, whereof the one part is being dried by the heat, a sunny plot on level ground, while other grapes men are gathering, and yet others they are treading in the wine-press. In the foremost row are unripe grapes that cast the blossom,^and others there be that are growing black to vintaging.^ There too, skirting the furthest line, are all manner of garden beds, planted trimly, that are perpetually fresh, and therein are two fountains of water, whereof one scatters his streams all about the garden, and the other runs over against it beneath the threshold of the courtyard, and issues by the lofty house, and thence did the townsfolk draw water. These were the splendid gifts of the gods in the palace of Alcinoiis. 15. The Creation of Earth, Heaven, and the Gods (Hesiod, Theogony, 1 16-138) When the Greeks first began to think of the origin of things, their lively imagination hit upon birth as the process of creation. In the following passage Hesiod expresses no idea of the manner in which Chaos, Earth, Tartarus, and Love were formed, but of them were born the remaining elements of the world. First verily was created Chaos, and then broad-bosomed Earth, the habitation unshaken forever of all the deathless gods who keep the top of snowy Olympus, and misty Tartarus within the wide- wayed Earth, and Love (Eros) which is the fairest among the death- less gods; which looseth the limbs and overcometh within the breasts of all gods and all men their mind and coimsel wise. From Chaos sprang Erebus and black Night ; and from Night in turn sprang Bright Sky (Ether) and Day, whom Night conceived and bare after loving union with Erebus. Earth first bare the starry Heaven, of equal stature to herself, that he might cover her utterly about, to the end that there might be for the blessed gods a habitation steadfast forever ; and she bare the lofty Hills, the pleasant haunts of the goddess Nymphs who dwell among the gladed Hills. Also she bare the unharvested deep with raging flood, 'It is evident that Homer was acquainted with all these fruits, although the garden, particularly with reference to the seasons, is idealized. no MINOAN AND HOMERIC CIVILIZATIONS even the Sea (Pontus), without the sweet rites of love. And then in the couch of Heaven (Ouranos) she bare the deep-eddying Oceanus, and Coeus and Crius, and Hyperion and lapetus and Theia and Rhea and Themis and Mnemosyne and Thebe of the golden crown and lovely Tethys. After these was born her young- est son, even Cronos of crooked counsels, of all her children most terrible, and he hated his lusty sire. i6. Earliest Attempts at History in Prose (Acusilaiis, Genealogies) The numbers of the excerpts are those of Muller, Frag. Hist. Grac. I. p. too sqq. Translated by G. W. B. 7. Deucalion, in whose time was the Deluge, was the son of Prometheus and, as most writers say, of ClymenS, according to Hesiod however, of Pandora ; but the authority of Acusilaiis is that he was born of Hesionfi, daughter of Oceanus, and of Prometheus. Well known is the story of Deucalion and Pyrrha, and Acusilaus testifies that the stones thrown behind their backs were made men. no. Throughout his first book Acusilaiis has made it clear that Acheloiis is the eldest of all rivers, for he says: Oceanus married Tethys, his own sister ; and of them were born three thou- sand rivers, and Acheloiis is the eldest and most highly honored. 12. Of Niobe and Zeus was born a son Argos, as Acusilaiis says, and Pelasgus, after whom were named the Pelasgians who inhabited Peloponnese. 13. Before Ogyges nothing was done among the Hellenes worth mentioning, apart from (the deeds of) Phoroneus, his contemporary, and Phoroneus' father Inachus, who, as Acusilaiis narrates, was the first king of the Argives, 15. Hellanicus and Acusilaiis and, in addition to them, Ephorus and Nicolaiis narrate that the ancients lived a thousand years. 16. The account ascribed to Acusilaus which makes Myceneus son of Sparto, and Sparto of Phoroneus, I could not for my part accept, as the Lacedaemonians themselves would not accept it. 31. The Homeridae : a genos of Chios, as Acusilaiis states in his third book. HISTORICAL CRITICISM iii (Hecataeus, Circuit of the Earth and Genealogies. Translated by G. W. B.) The numbers are those of Muller. I. I laugh when I see that many have drawn the circuit of the ea,rth with no show of sense, who mark out the Ocean flowing around it, and assume that the earth is a circle, as though drawn by a pair of compasses, and that Asia is equal to Europe (from Herodotus iv. 36). 276. Formerly when Hecataeus the logopoios was in Thebes and had traced his descent and connected his family with a god in the sixteenth generation before his time, the priests of Zeus did for him about the same as they did for me, although I had not traced my lineage. They took me into the sanctuary of the temple, which is of great size, and showing colossal wooden statues in number as they stated, they counted them up to that number ; for each chief priest in his lifetime sets up an image of himself. The priests, accordingly, counting and showing me these statues, declared that each one of them was a son succeeding his father, and they went up through the series of images from the image of the one who had died last, until they had declared this of the whole number. When Hecataeus had traced his descent and connected his family with a god in the sixteenth generation, they traced a descent opposed to his, in addition to their numbering, not accepting his idea that a man had been born of a god. In the following manner they traced their counter-descent, saying that each one of the statues had been 'piromis' son of 'piromis,' until they had declared this of the whole three hundred and forty-five statues, each surnamed 'pi- romis,' and neither with a god nor with a hero did they connect their descent. Now ' piromis ' means in Greek ' honorable and good man' (from Herodotus ii. 143). 355. Hecataeus of Miletus in the third book of his Genealogies, in describing an Arcadian dinner, says it consisted of barley-bread and pork. 362. After the Pelasgians had been expelled from Attica by the Athenians, whether justly or unjustly I am unable to say except what is reported, that Hecataeus son of Hegesander says in his narratives that it happened unjustly ; for when the Athenians saw the land at the foot of Hymettus which they had given them to 112 THE MINOAN AND HOMERIC CIVn^IZATIONS inhabit as pay for building the wall around the Acropolis, — when they saw this land well cultivated which was formerly barren and worthless, they entertained a grudge, and a desire for the land, and for that reason expelled them, not alleging any other pretext (from Herodotus vi. 137). 17. Certain Kings of Attica (Philochoras, Atthis, ii, quoted by Eusebius, Chronica, i ; Muller, Frag. Hist. Grate. I. 385. 10. Translated by G. W. B.) In their attempts to reconstruct the regal period of their country the chron- iclers adopted the habit of assigning existing customs and institutions to the various kings — a process illustrated by the following selections. Cecrops the diphyes (double-natured) reigned as king over Akte, now Attica, fifty years, so called because of the height of his person, as Philochorus says, or because, being an Egyptian, he understood two languages.^ (Philochorus, op. cit. in Strabo ix. 20; Muller, op. cit. I. 386. 11) Philochorus says that as the country was harried from the sea by Carians and on the land by the Boeotians, whom they called Aones, Cecrops first gathered the multitude into twelve cities, whose names are Cecropia,* Tetrapolis, Epacria, Deceleia, Eleusis, Aphidna, which many call also by the plural number Aphidnae, Thoricus, Brauron, Cytherus, Sphettus, Cephisia, Phalerus. Later, too, Theseus is said to have concentrated the twelve into the one city which now exists. (Philochorus, op. cit. in Athensus ii. 7) Philochorus relates that Amphictyon,' king of the Athenians, having learned of Dionysus the art of mixing wine, was the first man who ever did mix it, and that it is owing to him that men who have been drinking on his system can afterward walk straight, when before they used to stagger about after drinking clear wine. On ' In myth he was half-man, half -serpent, and in this respect " double-natured"; but the chronicler has rationalized the myth, as was the habit of such writers. ' Traditionally the earlier name of Athens. ' The historical truth at the basis of this mythical king is the fact that Athens in early time became a member of the Delphic amphictyony. CHRONOLOGICAL RECONSTRUCTION "3 this account he erected an altar to the straight Dionysus in the temple of the Seasons ; for they are the Nymphs who cherish the fruit of the vine. Near it he built also an altar to the Nymphs as a memorial to aU who used diluted drinks ; for the Nymphs are said to have been the nurses of Dionysus. Further he made a law to bring unmixed wine after meals, only just enough to taste, as a token of the power of the Good Deity. But the rest of the wine was put on the table ready diluted in whatever quantity any one chose. Then he enjoined the guests to invoke in addition, the name of Zeus Saviour, for the sake of instructing and reminding the drinkers that by using wine in that way they would be preserved from injury. i8. The Fully Developed List of Kings of Argos and of Athens Homer, Hesiod, and the logographers reckoned time by generations and by reigns. Gradually greater precision was acquired, and attempts were made to reconstruct the lists of kings with the length of their respective reigns. In earlier time the list of kings of a country contamed few names, but new names were gradually inserted. In the Alexandrian period scholars busied themselves with such chronologies, and their work has come down to us mainly thrpugh Eusebius, who lived in the fourth century a.d. The two lists given below will sufBciently illustrate the nature of their work. It is to be noted that perhaps not a single name in either list (or at most one or two) is that of a real person. ARGIVE AND ATHENIAN KINGS (Eusebius, Chronicle, ed. Karst, p. 148 sq.) ARGIVE KINGS Inachus Soyrs Phoroneus 60 Apis 35 Argus 70 Criasus 54 Phorbas 35 Triopas 47 €rotopus 21 Sthenelus 11 Danaiis 50 Linceus 41 ATHENIAN KINGS In the thirty-second year of the I. Cecrops Diphyes 50 yrs. Cranaus Amphiction Erichthonius Pantion Erechtheus Cecrops 11 9 10 5° 40 SO 40 reign of Phorbas, the first (king) reigned over the Athenians 114 THE MINOAN AND HOMERIC CIVILIZATIONS ATHENIAN KINGS ARGIVE KINGS Abas 23 Proitus 17 Acrisius 31 8. Pantion 2S 9- Egeus (son) of Pantion 48 10. Theseus (son) of Egeus 30 II. Menestheus (son) 1 of Peteus 23 13. Demophon (son) of Theseus 33 13- Oxintes 12 14- Aphidas I IS- Thimoitus 8 16. Melanthus 37 17- Codrus 21 19. Dates or Certain Great Events (Porphyry, Philosophic History, i, quoted by Eusebius, Chronicle, i. 31. Migne, PatrologUB GrcBCCB, XIX. 220.) From the capture of Ilium to the descent of the Heracleids upon Peloponnese, according to ApoUodorus, 80 years elapsed; then from the descent to the colonization of Ionia, 60 years ; thence to Lycurgus, 159 years; from Lycurgus to the first Olympiad, 108 years ; the sum total of years from the capture of Ilium to the first Olympiad was 407 years. For bibliography on the Homeric age, see p. 6. BIBLIOGRAPHY FOR THE MINOAN CIVILIZATION I. Sources. — Substantially the only sources are the objects discovered in explorations. They may be studied directly or by means of illustrations and descriptions. In addition to the illustrations in the works mentioned below, see especially Evans, A., Adas of Cnossian Antiquities (MacmiUan, 1915) ; Maraghiannis, G., AntiquiUs critoises, 2 vols. (Vienna, 1906, 1911). Tradi- tions from that period have been so contaminated by later conditions as to retain little or no independent value. II. General. — Botsford, Hellenic History, ch. ii. ; Bury, History of Greece (new ed. 1913), ch. i ; Hall, Ancient History of the Near East, 31-72 ; Meyer, E., Gesch. d. Alt. I. pp. 677-803. Schuchhardt, C., Sckliemann's Excavations, trans, by E. Sellers (Mac- nullan, 1891), contains the results of his labors, and the substance of his writ- BIBLIOGRAPHY 115 ings; Hawes, C. H. and H., Crete the Forerunner of Greece (Harper,, 1909), excellent scholarly summary, without illustrations; Evans, E., Nine Minoan Periods (MacmiUan, 1915), by the excavator of Cnossus; Baikie, J., Sea-Kings of Crete (London : Adam and Ch. Black, 1910), popular but generally accurate ; Mosso, A., Palaces of Crete (Putnam, 1907), useful for special topics; Dawn of Mediterranean Civilization (N. Y. : Baker and Taylor, 191 1), asserts the exist- ence of a copper age of considerable length; Dessaud, R., Les civilizations prShellenique dans le bassin de la mer Egie (2d ed., Paris, 1914), the most thoroughly illustrated treatment of the general subject ; Lichtenberg, R. F. v., Aegdische Kultur (Leipzig, 1911) ; Fimmen, D., Die Zeit und Dauer der kre- tisch-mykenischen Kultur (Freiburg, 1909), most valuable for chronology; Myres, J. L., Dawn of History (Holt, 191 1), general study of beginnings in the ancient world; Tsountasy C, and Manatt, J. I., Mycenaan Age (Houghton Mifflin, 1897), a brilliant work, in need of revision; Ridgeway, W., Early Age of Greece, I (Cambridge : University Press, 1901) ; Hall, H. R., Mgean ArchcB- ology (London: Warner, 1915). ni. Special. — (a) Of primary importance are the reports of excavators, as those of Evans and others, Annual of British School ^at Athens, beginning with vol. Vn (1900-1901) ; Journal of Hellenic Studies, beginning 1899 ; Boyd, H., in Transactions of the Department of Archaology, University of Penn- sylvania, I (1904), for her excavations at Gournia; Monumenti Antichi, be- ginning XII (1900-1901), for excavations at ?haestus, etc. ; Dorpfeld, W., and others, Troja und Ilion, 2 vols. (Athens, 1902) ; Seager, R. B., Exploration in the Island of Mochlos: American School of Classical Studies at Athens, 191 2 ; Excavations on the Island of Pseira (University Museum, Phila. 1910) ; Atkin- son, T. D., and others. Excavations at Philakopi in Melos (Macmillan, 1904) ; Wace, A. J. B., and Thompson, M. S., Prehistoric Thessaly (Cambridge: University Press, 1912); Ashmolean Museum Report, 1907; Frickenhaus, A., and others, Tiryns. Die Ergebnisse der Ausgrabungen des K. deutsch. arch. Inst. inAthen (Athens, 1912) ; Hall, E. H., Excavations in Eastern Crete, Anthropo- logical Publications, University of Pennsylvania, 1913. (6) Palaces and Tombs. — Dorpfeld, W., " Die kretischen, mykenischen und homerischen Palaste," in Ath. Mitt. XXX (1905). 257-97; Mackenzie, D., "Cretan Palaces and the Mgean Civilization," in Annual of the British School at Athens, XI {igoA-1905). 181-223; XII. 216-57; XIIL 423-45 ; XIV. 343- 422 (aims to derive civilization from north Africa) ; Noack, F., Homerische Paldster (Leipzig, 1903) ; Ovalhaus und Palast in Kreta (Teubner, 1908), im- portant; Evans, A., "Prehistoric Tombs of ELnossos," in ArchcBologia, LIX (igos). 391-562 ; Lichtenberg, R. F. v., Haus, Dorf, Stadt (Leipzig, 1909). (c) Pottery and Painting. — Hall, E. H., Decorative Art of Crete in the Bronze Age (Phila.: Winston, 1907); Mackenzie, D., "Potteryof Knossus,"in/. 5. 5. XXIII (1903). 157-206; "Middle Minoan Pottery," ib. XXVI. 243-67; Forsdyke, E. J., " Minoan Pottery from Cyprus and the Origin of the Mycenaean Style," ib. XXXI. 1 10-18; Furtwangler and Loeschke, Mykenische Vasen ii6 THE MINOAN AND HOMERIC CIVILIZATIONS (Berlin, 1886) ; Pfuhl, E., "Die griechische Malerei," in N. Jahrb. XIV (1911). 161-85. (i) Religion. — Harrison, J. E., Themis: A Study of the Social Origins of Greek Religion (Cambridge University Press, 1912), speculative; Prinz, H., "Bemerkungen zur altkretischen Religion," ^/A. Mitt.'XXXV (1910), 149-76; Reichel, A., "Die Stierspiele in der kretisch-mykenischen Kultur," Ath. Mitt. XXIV (1909). 85-99, has religious connections. Aly, W., "Ursprung und Entwickelung der kretischen Zeusreligion," in Philologus, LXXI(i9i2). 457-78; Bethe, "Minos," in Rkein. Mm. LXV (1910). 200-32 ; Frothingham, A. L., "Medusa, Apollo, and the Great Mother," in Am. Journ. Arch. XV (1911). 349-77, connections with Crete; Pernier, L., "Culto di Rhea a Phaestos," in Saggi di Storia antica, etc. (Rome, 1910), 241- 53 ; Schaefer, J., De Jove apud Gretas culto. Diss. (Halle, 1912). (e) Writing. — Evans, A., Scripla Minoa, I (Oxford : Clarendon Press, 1909) ; Sundwall, J., Ueber die vorgriechische linearische Schrift auf Kreta (brief study, 1914) ; Meyer, E., "Der Diskus von Phaestos und die Philister auf Kreta," in Sitzb. Berl. Akad. 1909, pp. 1022-9; Hall, H. R., "Note on the Phsestus Disk," in /. H. S. XXXI (1911). 119-23; Hempl, G., in Harper's Monthly, Jan. 1911, pp. 187-98, vain attempt at solution. (/) Problems and Gonnections. — Burrows, R. M., Discoveries in Grete and their Bearing on the History of Ancient Gimlization (London : Murray, 1907) ; Lichtenberg, R. F. v., in Mitt. Vorderas. Ges. XVI (191 2), for influence on Egypt and Palestine; MiiUer, W. Max, Asien und Europa nach altagyptischen Denk- malern (Leipzig, 1893) ; Baur, P., "Pre-Roman Antiquities in Spain," in Am. Journ. Arch. XI (1907). 182-93. (g) The Ethnic Question. — Sergi, G., Mediterranean Race (Scribner, 1901) ; Conway, R. S., " Pre-Hellenic Inscriptions of Praesos," in B. S. A. VIII (1901- 1902). 125-56; "A Third Eteo-Cretan Fragment," ib. X. 115-26; Kiessling, M., "Das ethnische Problem des alten Griechenland," in Zeitschr. f. Ethnol. XXXVII (1905). 1009-24; Luschan, F. v., "Beitrage zur Anthropologie von Kreta," ib. XLV. 307-93, includes ancient period ; Hirt, H., Die Indogermanen, 2 vols. (Strassburg, 1905, 1907); Schmidt, L., "Die Ursachen der Volk- erwanderung," in N. Jahrb. VI (1903). 340-50; Meltzer, H., "Griechen und Germanen," ib. XXIX (191 2). 385-405; Forrer, R., Reallexikon der prShis- torischen, klassischen und friihchristlichen Altertiimer (Berlin, 1907) ; Schrader, O., Reallexikon der indogermanischen Allertumskunde (Strassburg, 1901) ; Sprachvergleichung und Urgeschickte, 2 vols. (3d ed., Jena, 1906, 1907). Kretschmer, P., Einleitung in die Geschichte der griech. Sprache (Gottingen, 1896), epoch-making; Fick, A., Vorgriechische Ortsnamen als Quelle fi^ die Vorgeschichte Griechenlands verwertet (Gottingen, 1905) ; Hoffmann, O., Ge- schichte der griech. Sprache, I (Leipzig, 191 1) ; Buck, C. D., Introduction to the Study of the Greek Dialects (Ginn, 1910); "Interrelations of the Greek Dia- lects," in Glass. PhUol. II (1907). 241 ff. Meyer, E., "Die Pelasger," in Forsch. zur alt. Gesch. I (1892). 1-124; BIBLIOGRAPHY 117 Myres, J. L., "History of the Pelasgian Theory," in /. E. S. XXVII (1907). 170 sqq. ; Aly, W., Karer und Leleger, in Philol. LXVIII (1909). 428-44. (A) Miscdlaneims. — Miiller, S., L'Europe prShistorique (Paris, 1907) ; Kropp, P., Die minoisch-mykenische Kultur im Lichte der Ueberlieferung bei Herodot (Leipzig, 1905) ; Assmann, E., "Zur Vorgeschichte von Kreta," in Philol. LXVII (1908). 161-201; Fimmen, D., "Die Besiedlung Bootiens bis in fruhgriech. Zeit," in N. Jahrb. XV (1912). 521-41 ; Frost, K. T., "The Critias and Minoan Crete," in /. H. S. XXXm (1913). 189-206. CHAPTER m COLONIZATION During the Period 750-479 B.C. The period extending from about 750 to the close of the great war with Persia, 479, is one of colonial expansion, of economic development from pas- toral and agricultiural conditions to commerce and industry, and of such prog- ress in literature, art, and intelligence, including the beginnings of science and philosophy, that it may well be named the era of "intellectual awakening." The colonial movement did not continue to the end of the period, but came substantially to an end about the middle of the sixth century. 20. The Physical Condition of Europe and its Effect on THE Inhabitants (Strabo ii. S- 26) Now the whole of Europe is habitable with the exception of a small part which cannot be dwelt in, on account of the severity of the cold, and which borders on the Hamaxoeci,* who dwell by the Don, Maeotis, and Dnieper. The wintry and mountainous .parts of the habitable earth would seem to afford by nature but a miserable means of existence ; nevertheless, by good management, places scarcely inhabited by any but robbers may be got into con- dition. Thus the Greeks, though dwelling amidst rocks and moun- tains, live in comfort, owing to their economy in government and the arts and all the other appliances of life. Thus, too, the Romans, after subduing numerous nations who were leading a savage Ufe, either induced by the rockiness of their countries or want of ports or severity of the cold, or for other reasons scarcely habitable, have taught the arts of commerce to many who were formerly in total ignorance, and spread civilization among the most savage. Where the climate is equable and mild, nature herself does much toward 1 " Dwellers in wagons," a nomadic people. 118 ENVIRONMENT 119 the production of these advantages. As in such favored regions everything inclines to peace, so those which are sterile generate bravery and a disposition to war. These two races receive mutual advantages from each other, the one aiding by their arms, the other by their husbandry, arts, and institutions. Harm must result to both when failing to act in concert, but the advantage will lie on the side of those accustomed to arms, except in instances where they are overpowered by multitudes. This continent is very much favored in this respect, being interspersed with plains and moun- tains, so that everywhere the foundations of husbandry, civiliza- tion, and hardihood lie side by side. The number of those who cultivate the arts of peace, is, however, the most numerous, which preponderance over the whole is mainly due to the influence of the government, first of the Greeks, and afterward of the Macedonians and Romans.^ Europe has thus within itself resources both for war [and peace]. It is amply supplied with warriors, and also with men fitted for the labors of agriculture, and the life of the towns. It is Ukewise distinguished for producing in perfection those fruits of the earth necessary to life, and all the useful metals. Perfumes and precious stones must be imported from abroad, but as far as the comfort of hfe is concerned, the want or the possession of these can make no difference. The country likewise abounds in cattle, while of wild beasts the number is but small. Such is the general nature of this continent. 21. The Fertility of Sicily; the Worship of Demeter (Diodorus v. 2 sq.) Diodorus, who was a Sicilian, writes with great enthusiasm, as well as with truth, of the beauty and fertility of his native island. Having designed this book as a description of the islands, we will first speak of Sicily, as it is the most important of the islands and stands first in the antiquity of its stories. In ancient times it was called Trinacria from its form. After- * The alliances and federations of the Greeks contributed to peace, but far greater progress was made in this direction by the Macedonian and Ronaan empires, particu- larly the latter. I20 COLONIZATION ward it was named Sicania by the Sicanians, its first inhabitants, and at last called Sicily, from the Sicilians,^ who, with all their people, transported themselves thither from Italy. In circuit it is four thousand three hundred and sixty stadia ; * for one of the three sides, from the promontory Pelorus to Lilybasum, is a thousand and seven hundred stadia ; the other from Lilybaeiun to Pachinum, a promontory of Syracuse, runs out in length a thou- sand and five hundred stadia. The rest contains a thousand one hundred and forty stadia. The Sicilian inhabitants (from old tradition continued down to them from their forefathers) say that this island is dedicated to Demeter and Persephong. Some of the poets feign that at the marriage of Pluto and Persephone this island was given to the new bride by Zeus for a present. The most approved authors say that the Sicanians, who were the ancient possessors, were the indigenous inhabitants of this isle, and that the goddesses whonj we have before mentioned appeared first in their country ; and that the fertility of the soil was such, that grain first grew here of itself, which the most eminent of all the poets confirms in these words : — Within this island all things grow, Without the help of seed or plow, As wheat and barley, with the vine From whence proceed both grapes and wine, Which with sweet showers from above Are brought to ripeness by great Jove. For in the territory of Leontini and in many other parts of Sicily there grows up wild wheat at this very day. If it be asked in what part of the world these grains were first known, before the use of corn was found out, it is most probable that they were first brought to the best and richest country, and therefore upon that account we see that the SiciKans most especially worship those goddesses who were the first discoverers of these fruits. That the rape of Persephon6 was in this country (they say) is most clear and evident from hence, that neither of these goddesses ever resided in 'By the "Sicilians'' is here meant the Siculi, whose origin ancient writers assign to Italy. ' A stadium is 600 Greek feet. SICILY 121 any other place but in this island, wherein they delighted above all others.^ The rape, they say, was in the meadows of Enna, not far from the city, a place decked with violets and all sorts of other flowers, affording a most beautiful and pleasant prospect. It is said that the fragrance of the flowers is such, that the dogs sent out to hunt the game thereby loSe the benefit of their sense, and are made incapable by their scent to find out the prey. This meadow-ground, in the middle and highest part of it, is level and well watered, but all the borders round are craggy, guarded with high and steep preci- pices, and it is supposed to lie in the very heart of Sicily, whence it is called by some the navel of Sicily. Near at hand are groves, meadows, and gardens, surrounded with morasses, and a deep cave with a passage underground opening toward the north, through which, they say, Pluto passed in his chariot when he forced away Persephonfe. In this place the violets and other sweet flowers flourish continually all the year long, and present a pleasant and delightsome prospect to the beholders over all the flourishing plain. 22. The Colonization t)F Sicily (Thucydides vi. 2-5. Jowett, verified by E. G. S.) Thucydides probably drew this information from Antiochus of Syracuse, a slightly older contemporary, who wrote a treatise on Sicilian and Italian Affairs, now lost. We may contrast the serious tone of this selection with the uncritical, semi-poetic passage from Diodorus given under the preceding number. 2. I will now describe the original settlement of Sicily, and enumerate the nations which it contained. Oldest of all were (i) the Cyclopes and Laestrygones,^ who are said to have dwelt in a district of the island ; but who they were, whence they came, or whither they went, I cannot tell. We must be content with the leg- ends of the poets, and every one must be left to form his own opinion. (2) The Sicanians appear to have succeeded these early races, 'These claims to the exclusive possession of the Goddesses Twain and to the eariiest use of grain are merely evidence of an exaggerated insular pride. In like manner the Athmians clauned fhat Demeter gave them gram originally and that through them the knowledge of its cultivation extended to the rest of Hellas. There is no more truth in the one daim than in the other. 2 It hardly need be said that these two races are mythical. 122 COLONIZATION although according to their own account they were still older ; for they profess to have been children of the soil. But the fact is that they were Iberians, and were driven from the river Sicanus in Iberia by the Ligurians.^ Sicily, which was originally called Tri- nacria, received from them the name Sicania. To this day the Sicanians inhabit the western parts of the island. (3) After the capture of Troy, some Trojans who had escaped from the Achaeans came in ships to Sicily ; they settled near the Sicanians, and both took the name of Elymi . The Elymi had two cities, Eryx and Egesta. (4) These were joined by certain Phocians, who had also fought at Troy, and were driven by a storm first to Libya and thence to Sicily* (5) The Sicels were originally inhabitants of Italy, whence they were driven by the Opici, and passed over in Sicily ; according to a prob- able tradition they crossed upon rafts, taking advantage of the wind blowing from the land, but they may have found other ways of effecting a passage ; there are Sicels still in Italy, and that coimtry itself was so called from Italus, a Sicel king.^ They entered Sicily with a large army, and defeating the Sicanians in battie, drove them back to the southern and western parts of the country ; from .them the island, formerly Sicania, took the name of Sicily. For nearly three hundred years after their arrival imtil the time when the Hellenes came to Sicily they occupied the most fertile districts, and they still inhabit the central and southern regions. (6) The Phoenicians at one time had settlements all round the island.' They fortified headlands on the sea-coast, and settled in the small islands adjacent, for the sake of trading with the Sicels; but when the Hellenes began to find their way by sea to Sicily in greater numbers, they withdrew from the larger part of the island, and forming a union estabhshed themselves in Motya, Soloeis, and Panormus, in ' Most modem scholars, accordingly, connect the Sicanians in stock with the Iberians of Spain and the Ligurians of northern Italy. Others {cf. De Sanctis, Storia dei Romani, I. 98 sq.) consider the Sicani and Siculi branches of the same stock, which they pronounce Italic. * The hypothesis that the Sicels, Siculi, were immigrants from Italy, and of Italic stock, receives support from the fact that certain names, common and proper, in their language seem related to Latin. ' The absence of archaeological remains throws doubt upon this statement. Yet it is certain that the Phoenicians receded to some extent in the face of the Hellenic colonization. COLONIZATION OF SICILY 123 the neighborhood of the Elymi, partly trusting to their alliance with them, and partly because this is the point at which the passage from Carthage to Sicily is shortest. Such were the barbarian nations who inhabited Sicily, and these were their settlements. 3. (7) The first Hellenic colonists sailed from Chalcis in Eubcea under the leadership of Thucles, and founded Naxos ; ^ there they erected an altar in honor of Apollo the Founder, which is still standing without the city, and on this altar religious embassies sacrifice before they sail from Sicily. (8) In the following year Archias, one of the Heraclidae, came from Corinth and founded S3n:acuse, first driving the Sicels out of the island of Ortygia ; and there the inner city, no longer surrounded by the sea, now stands ; in process of time the outer city was included within the walls and became populous. (9) In the fifth year after the foundation of Syracuse Thucles and the Chalcidians went forth from Naxos, and driving out the Sicels by force of arms, founded first Leontini, then Catana. The Catanaeans however chose a founder of their own, nafiied Evarchus. 4. (10) About the same time Lamis came from Megara bringing a colony to Sicily, where he occupied a place called Trotilus, upon the river Pantacyas ; but he soon afterwards joined the settlement of the Chalcidians at Leontini ; with them he dwelt a short time, until he was driven out ; he then founded Thapsus, where he died. His followers quitted Thapsus and founded the city which is called the Hyblaean Megara ; Hyblon, a Sicel king, had betrayed the place to them and guided them thither. There they remained two hun- dred and forty-five years, and were then driven out of their town and land by Gelon* the tyrant of Syracuse ; but before they were driven out, and a hundred years after their own foundation, they sent out Pamillus and founded Selinus ; he had come from Megara, their own mother state, to take part in the new colony. (11) In the forty-fifth year after the foundation of Syracuse, Antiphemus of Rhodes and Entimus of Crete came with their followers and to- gether built Gela. The city was named from the river Gela, but the spot which is now the Acropolis and was first fortified is called ' The Greek colonization began about 750 B.C. The dates of the various foundings aie unreliable. ' Gelon became tyrant of Sjracuse in 485 ; Busolt, Griech. Gesch. H. 785. 124 COLONIZATION Lindii. The institutions of the new settlement were Dorian. Exactly a hundred and eight years after their own foundation the inhabitants of Gela founded Acragas (Agrigentum), which they named from the river Acragas ; ^ they appointed Aristonoiis and Pystilus founders of the place, and gave to it their own institutions. (12) Zancl^ was originally colonized by pirates who came from Cym6 the Chalcidian city in Opicia ; these were followed by a large body of colonists from Chalcis and the rest of Euboea, who shared in the allotment of the soil. The first settlement was led by Perieres of CymS, the second by Crataemenes of Chalcis. Zancl6 was the original name of the place, a name given by the Sicels because the site was in. shape like a sickle, for which the Sicel word is Zanclon. These earlier settlers were afterward driven put by the Samians and other lonians, who when they fled from the Persians found their way to Sicily. Not long afterward Anaxilas, tyrant of Rhegiimi, drove out these Samians. He then repeopled their city with a mixed multitude, and called the place Messend after his native country. 5. Himera was colonized from ZanclS by Eucleides, Simus, and Sacon. Most of the settlers were Chalcidian, but the Myletidse, .Sjnracusan exiles who had been defeated in a civil war, took part in the colony. Their language was a mixture of the Chalcidian and Doric dialects, but their institutions were mainly Chalcidian. (13) Acrae and Casmenae were founded by the Syracusans, Acrae seventy years after Syracuse, and Casmenae nearly twenty years after Acrae. Camarina was originally founded by the Syracusans exactly a hundred and thirty-five years after the foundation of Syracuse; the founders were Dascon and Menecolus. But the Camarinaeans revolted, and as a punishment for their revolt were violently expelled by the Sjnracusans. After a time Hippocrates, tyrant of Gela, receiving the territory of Camarina as the ransom of certain Syracusan prisoners, became the second founder of the place, which he colonized anew. The inhabitants were once more driven out by Gelon, who himself colonized the city for the third time. 1 See no. 23. NOTABLE GREEK COLONIES 125 23. ACRAGAS (Polybius ix. 27) The city of Acragas is not only superior to most cities in the particulars I have mentioned, but above all in beauty and elabo- rate ornamentation. It stands within eighteen stadia of the sea, so that it participates in every advantage from that quarter ; while its circuit of fortifications is particularly strong both by nature and by art. For its wall is placed on a rock, steep and precipitous, on one side naturally, on the other side artificially. And it is inclosed by rivers : for along the south side flows the river of the same name as the town, and along the west and southwest, the river called Hypsas. The citadel overlooks the city exactly at the southeast, girt on the outside by an impassable ravine, and on the inside with only one approach from the town. On the top of it is a temple of Athena and of Zeus Atabjnrius as at Rhodes : for as Acragas was founded by the Rhodians, it is natural that this deity should have the same appellation as at Rhodes. The city is sumptuously adorned in other respects also with temples and colonnades. The temple of Zeus Ol3nnpius is still unfinished, but in its plan and dimensions it seems to be inferior to no temple in Greece. 24. CUMiE, DlC^ARCHIA, AND NAPLES (Strabo v. 4. 4-7. Hamilton and Falconer, revised by E. G. S.) It is to be noted that in the time of Strabo the cotmtry described in this selection was far less populous and wealthy than it had been before the Roman conquest. After these [cities] comes Cumae, the most ancient settlement of the ChalcidenSes and Cumseans, for it is the oldest of all [the Greek cities] in Sicily or Italy. The leaders of the expedition, Hippocles the Cumsean and Megasthenes of Chalcis, mutually agreed that one of the nations should have the management of the colony, and the other the honor of conferring upon it its own name. Hence at the present day it is named Cumae, while at the same time it is said to have been founded by the Chalcidenses. Formerly this city was prosperous, as well as the Phlegraean plain, which mythology 126 COLONIZATION has made the scene of the adventures of the giants, for no other reason, as it appears, than because the fertility of the country had given rise to battles for its possession.^ Afterwards, however, the Campanians becoming masters of the city, inflicted many outrages on the inhabitants, and even took their wives. StiU, however, there remain numerous traces of the Grecian taste, both in their temples and in their laws. Some are of opinion that Cumae was so called from ra Kv/iara, the waves, the sea-coast near having a heavy and incessant surf. These people have excellent fisheries. On the shores of this gulf there is a scrubby forest, extending over numerous stadia of parched and sandy land. This they call the Galhnarian wood. It was there that the admirals of Sextus Pom- peius assembled their gangs of pirates, at the time when he drew Sicily into revolt.^ Beyond is the strand and city of Dicaearchia. Formerly it was nothing but a naval station of the Cumasans. It was built on an eminence. But at the time of the war with Hannibal, the Romans established a colony there, and changed its name into Puteoli, [an appellation derived] from its wells; or, according to others, from the stench of its waters, the whole district from hence to Baise and Cumae being full of sulphur, fire, and hot-springs. Some too are of opinion that it was on this account [that the country about] Cumae was named Phlegra, and that the fables of the giants struck down by thunderbolts owe their origin to these eruptions of fire and water. This city has become a place of extensive commerce,^ having arti- ficially constructed harbors, which were much facilitated by the nature of the sand, which contains much gypsum, and will cement and consohdate thoroughly. Therefore, mixing this sand with chalk-stones, they construct moles in the sea, thus forming bays along the open coast, in which the largest transport ships may safely ride. Immediately above the city lies the Formn-Vulcani,* a plain surrounded with hills which seem to be on fire, having in many parts ^ This explanation shows the bookish side of Strabo. Actually these legends aiose from the abundant traces of former volcanic activity. ^43-42 B.C.; c/. Livy, epitome, 123. ' The largest on the west coast of Italy in the time of Seneca and St. Paul, a gen- eration after Strabo. * The modem Solfatara. DIC^ARCHIA AND NAPLES 127 mouths emitting smoke, frequently accompanied by a terrible rumbling noise ; the plain itself is full of drifted sulphur. 7. After Dicaearchia is Neapolis, [founded originally] by the Cumaeans ; but afterwards being peopled in addition by Chalcidians, and certain Pithecussaeans and Athenians, it was on this account denominated Naples.* Here is pointed out the tomb of Parthenope, one of the sirens, and a gymnastic sport is celebrated by command of an oracle. In course of time the inhabitants, having disagreed amongst themselves, admitted certain Campanians, thus being forced to regard in the light of friends those most inimical to them, since their friends were estranged. This is proved by the names of their demarchi, the earher of which are Grecian, but the latter a mixture of Campanian with Grecian names. Many traces of Grecian civilization are still preserved, the gymnasia, the ephebeia,^ the phratries,* and the Grecian names of people who are Roman citizens. At the present time they celebrate, every fifth year,* public games for music and gymnastic exercises during many days, which rival ^ the most famous games of Greece. There is here a subterranean passage, similar^ to that at Cumae, extend- ing for many stadia along the mountain, between Dicaearchia and Neapolis : it is sufficiently broad to let carriages pass each other, and light is admitted from the surface of the mountain, by means of numerous apertures cut through a great depth. Naples also has hot springs and baths not at all inferior in quality to those at Baiae, but much less frequented, for another city has arisen there, not less than Dicaearchia, one palace after another having been built. Naples still preserves the Grecian mode of life, owing to those who retire hither from Rome for the sake of repose, after a life of labor from childhood, and to those whose age or weak- ness demands relaxation. Besides these, Romans who find a charm in this style of life, and observe the numbers of persons of the same tastes dwelling there, are attracted by the place, and make it their abode. ^ Nea-polis, " Newtown." *^ Places of exercise for youths. ° " Brotherhoods," associations of families assumed to be related in blood; no. 144. * Actually once in four years. 128 COLONIZATION 25. The Voyages of the Phoc^ans and their Colonization OF Corsica (Herodotus i. 163-6. Macaulay, revised by E. G. S.) About the middle of the seventh century B.C. a Samian explorer, Colxus, reached Tarshish, Tartessus, in Spain, the first of the Hellenes to visit that city. Shortly afterward the Phocaeans began making voyages to that place in the way described in the subjoined excerpt. The " round boats " had been in use for mercantile shipping along the coasts, but the fifty-oared galleys of the Pho- cffians were relatively narrow and straight, and were provided with bronze beaks for battering; cf. Busolt, Griech. Gesch. I. 432 sqq. About 560 they foimded Alalia in the island of Corsica (Greek Cyrnos). The new settlement was exposed to danger from the Etruscans (Tyrsenians, Tyrrenians) and Carthaginians, who were actively trading with each other on the basis of commerical treaties. The decisive naval battle oflE Alalia was fought about 535. , Harpagus, mentioned in the selection, was a lieutenant of Cyrus the Persian king, who after the conquest of Lydia, was aiming to subdue the Greek cities along the coast. 163. Now these Phocaeans were the first of the Hellenes who made long voyages, and these are they who discovered the Adriatic and Tyrsenia ^ and Iberia and Tartessus : and they made voyages not in roimd ships, but in vessels of fifty oars. These came to Tartessus and became friends with the king of the Tartessians whose name was Arganthonius : he was ruler of the Tartessians for eighty years and lived in all one hundred and twenty. With this man, I say, the Phocaeans became so exceedingly friendly, that first he bade them leave Ionia and dwell wherever they desired in his own land; and as he did not prevail upon the Phocaeans to do this, afterward, hearing from them of the Mede how his power was in- creasing, he gave them money to build a wall around their city: and he did this without sparing, for the circuit of the wall is many stadia in extent, and it is built all of large stones closely fitted together. 164. The wall of the Phocaeans was made in this manner : and Harpagus having marched his army against them began to besiege them, at the same time holding forth to them proposals arid saying that it was enough to satisfy him if the Phocaeans were willing to throw down one battlement of their wall and dedicate one single * Tyrsenia (Tyrrenia), the Greek for Etruria. ALALIA I 129 house. But the Phocaeans, being very greatly grieved at the thought of subjection, said that they wished to deliberate about the matter for one day, and after that they would give their answer ; and they asked him to withdraw his army from the wall while they were deliberating. Harpagus said that he knew very well what they were meaning to do, nevertheless he was willing to allow them to deliberate. In the time that followed, accordingly, when Har- pagus had withdrawn his army from the wall, the Phocaeans drew down their fifty-oared galleys to the sea, put into them their chil- dren and women and all their movable goods, and besides them the images from the temples and the other votive offerings except such as were made of bronze or stone or consisted of paintings ; all the rest, I say, they put into the ships, and having embarked themselves, they sailed toward Chios ; and the Persians obtained possession of Phocaea, the city being deserted by the inhabitants. 165. But as for the Phocaeans, since the men of Chios would not sell them at their request the islands called CEnussse, from the fear lest these islands might be made a seat of trade and their island might be shut out,* therefore they departed for Cyrnos : " for in Cyrnos twenty years before this they had established a city named Alalia, in accordance with an oracle (now Arganthonius by that time was dead). And when they were setting out for Cyrnos they first sailed in to Phocaea and slaughtered the Persian garrison, to whose charge Harpagus had delivered the city ; then after they had achieved this they made solemn imprecations on any one of them who should be left behind from their voyage, and moreover they sunk a mass of iron in the sea and swore that not until that mass should appear again on the surface would they return to Phocaea. However as they were setting forth to Cyrnos, more than half of the citizens were seized with yearning and regret for their city and for their native land, and they proved false to their oath and sailed back to Phocaea. But those of them who still kept the oath weighed anchor from the islands of (Enuss£e and sailed. 166. When these came to Cyrnos, for five years they dwelt together with those who had come thither before, and they fotmded temples there. Then, since they plundered the prop- ' Here is one -of many evidences of keen commercial rivalry among the Hellenes. * Corsica. I30 COLONIZATION erty of all their neighbors, the Tyrsenians and Carthaginians made expedition against them by agreement with one another, each with sixty ships. And the Phocaeans also manned their vessels, sixty in number, and came to meet the enemy in that which is called the Sardinian sea : and when they encountered one another in the sea-fight the Phocasans won a kind of Cadmean victory,* for forty of their ships were destroyed and the remaining twenty were disabled, having had their prows bent aside. So they sailed in to Alalia and took up their children and their women and their other possessions as much as their ships proved capable of carrying, and then they left Cyrnos behind them and sailed to Rhegium. BIBLIOGRAPHY I. Sources for Colonization. — We have no knowledge of any con- temporary source which treated of this period of colonization. Among the earliest sources known to us who touched upon the founding of cities were HeUanicus of Lesbos (MuUer, Frag. Hist. Grmc. I. p. 45 sqq.) and Aiitiochus of Syracuse {ih. I. p. 12 sqq.), both belonging to the fifth century B.C. For the colonization of Sicily, see Thuc. vi. 1-5. Ephorus, Timaeus, and other later writers treated of the subject. The authors thus far mentioned collected the material from which were drawn the late accounts that have svirvived to our time ; e.g., Diodorus v-viii, Strabo, and Pausanias. See also Scjmmbs of Chios (MiiUer, Geogr. gr. min. I. p. 196 sqq.). The chronology, as we have it at present, was gradually elaborated, and reached its final form in Eusebius, who lived in the fourth century a.d. II. Modern Works. — Botsford, Hellenic History, ch. iv; Bury, ch. ii; Holm, I. ch. xxi ; Abbott, I. ch. xi ; Curtius, bk. II. ch. iii ; Grote, IH. chs. xxii, xxiii ; IV. chs. xxvi, xxvii ; Freeman, E. A., Story of Sicily, chs. ii. iv ; History of Sicily, I (entire); Greenidge, A. H. J., Gk. Const. Hist. ch. iii; Phillipson, C, International Law and Custom of Ancient Greece and Rome, II. ch. xix; Cunningham, Western Civilization in its Economic Aspects, bk. U. ch. i; Morris, H. C, History of Colonization, I. 85-125. Beloch, Griech. Gesch. I. i. 229-64 (colonization); 264-308 (economy); Holm, A., Geschichte Siziliens, 1. 108-44 ; Giuliano, L., Storia di Siracusa antica, 1-15 ; Pais, E., Storia delta Sicilia e delta Magna Grecia (Torino, 1894) ; Ancient Italy (Chicago: University Press, 1908), especially for the relations between the Greeks and Rome ; Raoul-Rochette, D., Histoire ctitique de I'Stablissement des colonies grecques, 4 vols. (Paris, 181 5) ; Hertzberg, G. F., Kurze Geschichte der altgriechischen Kolonisation (Giitersloh, 1892). ' The idea of a Cadmean victory is perhaps derived from the story of the Sparti at Thebes (their mutual annihilation) or from that of Polyneices and Eteodes. The nature of that kind of victory may be inferred from the text; see Stein's note ad loc. CHAPTER IV GOVERNMENT AND POLITICAL CONDITIONS During the period 750-479 B.C. 26. Spartan Discipline (Xenophon, Constitution of the Lacedanionians. Dak3ms, revised on the basis of the Greek text by E. G. S.) The chief interest in the Lacedaemonian system lies not so much in the political institutions as in the severe disciphne exercised by the government over the citizens from birth to the grave. For that reason the following pas- sage has been selected ; unfortunately space does not permit the inclusion of the entire treatise. The picture drawn by Xenophon is idealized ; it may be sup- plemented by Plutarch, Lycurgus, and offset by the criticisms of Aristotle, Politics, ii. 9. For other selections, see Botsford, Source-Book of Ancient His- tory, ch. xii. No legislator could have been the author of all the institutions ascribed to Lyciurgus; in fact his historical personality has been seriously questioned. 1. I recall the astonishment with which I first noted the unique position of Sparta amongst the states of Hellas, the relatively sparse population, and at the same time the extraordinary power and pres- tige of the community. I was puzzled to account for the fact. It was only when I came to consider the peculiar institutions of the Spartans that my wonderment ceased. Or rather, it is transferred to the legislator who gave them those laws, obedience to which has been the secret of their prosperity. This legislator, Lycurgus, I must needs admire, and hold him to have been one of the wisest of mankind. Certainly he was no imitator of other states. It was by a stroke of invention rather, and on a pattern much in opposi- tion to the commonly accepted one, that he brought his fatherland to this pinnacle of prosperity. Take for example — and it is well to begin at the beginning — the whole topic of the birth and rearing of children. Throughout 131 132 GOVERNMENT AND POLITICAL CONDITIONS the rest of the world the young girl, who will one day become a mother (and I speak„of those who may be held to be well brought up), is nurtured on the plainest food attainable, with the scantiest addition of meat or other condiments ; whilst as to wine they train them either to total abstinence or to take it highly diluted with water. And in imitation, as it were, of the handicraft type, since the majority of artificers are sedentary, we, the rest of the Hellenes, are content that our girls should sit quietly and work wools. That is all we demand of them. But how are we to expect that women nurtured in this fashion should produce a splendid offspring? Lycurgus pursued a different path. Clothes were things, he held, the furnishing of which might well enough be left to female slaves. And believing that the highest function of a free woman was the bearing of children, in the first place he insisted on the training of the body as incumbent no less on the female than the male ; and in pujrsuit of the same idea instituted rival contests in running and tests of strength for women as for men. His belief was that where both parents were strong their progeny would be found to be more vigorous. . . . So opposed to those of the rest of the world are the principles which Lycurgus devised in reference to the birth of children. Whether they enabled him to provide Sparta with a race of men superior to all in size and strength any one who desires may examine. II. After this exposition of the customs in connection with the birth of children, I wish now to explain the systems of education in fashion there and elsewhere. Throughout the rest of Hellas the custom on the part of those who claim to educate their sons in the best way is as follows. As soon as thef children are of an age to understand what is said to them they are immediately placed under the charge of Paidagogoi (boy-escorts), who are also attend- ants, and sent off to the school of some teacher to be taught "letters," "music," and the concerns of the palaestra. Besides this they are given shoes to wear which tend to make their feet tender, and their bodies are made soft by various changes of clothing. As for food, the only measure recognized is that which is fixed by appetite. But when we turn to Lycurgus, instead of leaving it to each member of the state privately to appoint a slave to be his son's escort, he set over the young Spartans a public guardian, the pal- SCANT FOOD 133 don6mos or "manager of boys" to give him his proper title, with complete authority over them. This guardian was selected from those who fill the highest magistracies. He had authority to hold musters of the boys, and as their overseer, in case of any misbehavior, to chastise severely. The legislator further provided him with a body of youths in the prime of young manhood and bearing whips, to inflict punishment when necessary, with this happy result that in Sparta reverence and obedience ever go hand in hand, nor is there lack of either. Instead of softening their feet with shoes, his rule was to make them hardy through going barefoot. This habit, if practised, would, as he believed, enable them to go up steep ascents more easily and to go down descending slopes with less danger. In fact, with his feet so trained the young Spartan would leap and jump high and run faster unshod than another shod in the ordinary way. Instead of pampering them with a variety of clothes, his rule was to habituate them to a single garment the whole year through, thinking that so they would be better prepared to withstand the variations of heat and cold. Again, as regards food^ according to his regulation the EirSn, or head of the flock, must see that his messmates gathered to the club meal, with such moderate food as to avoid that heaviness which is engendered by repletion, and yet not to remain altogether imacquainted with inadequate sustenance. His beKef was that by such training they would be better able when it proved neces- sary to undergo hardships without food. They would be all the fitter, if the word of command were given, to remain on the stretch for a long time without extra dieting. The craving for a finer dish would be less, the readiness to take any victual set before them greater, and, in general, the regime would be found more healthy. Under it he thought the lads would increase in stature and shape into finer men, since, as he maintained, a dietary which gave supple- ness to the limbs must be more conducive to both ends than one which added thickness to the bodily parts by feeding. On the other hand, in order to guard against a too great pinch of starvation, though he did not actually allow the boys to help themselves without trouble to what they needed more, he did give them permissio%eA steal this thing or that in the effort to alleviate 134 GOVERNMENT AND POLITICAL CONDITIONS their hunger. It was not of course from any real difi&culty how else to supply them with nutriment that he left it to them to provide themselves by this crafty method. Nor can I conceive that any one wiU so misinterpret the custom. Clearly its explanation lies in the fact that he who would live the life of a robber must forego sleep by night, and in the daytime he must enjoy shifts and lie in ambuscade; he must prepare and make ready his scouts, and so forth, if he is to succeed in capturing the quarry. It is obvious, I say, that the whole of this education tended, and was intended, to make the boys craftier and more inventive in getting in supplies, whilst at the same time it cultivated their war- like instincts. An objector may retort : "But if he thought it so fine a feat to steal, why did he inflict many blows on the unfortunate who was caught?" My answer is : for the self-same reason which induces people, in other matters which are taught, to punish the mal-performance of a service. So they, the Lacedaemonians, visit penalties on the boy who is caught thieving as being but poor thieves. So to steal as many cheeses as possible off the shrine of Orthia was a feat to be encouraged; but, at the same moment, others were enjoined to scourge the thief, which would point a moral not obscurely, that by pain endured for a brief season a man may earn the joyous reward of lasting glory. Herein, too, it is plainly shown that where speed is requisite the sluggard will win for himself much trouble and scant good. Furthermore, and in order that the boys should not want a ruler, even in case the overseer himself was absent, he gave to any citizen who chanced to be present authority to lay upon them in- junctions for their good, and to chastise them if they failed in any- thing. By so doing he brought it about that boys of Sparta were more respectful. Indeed there is nothing which, whether as boys or men, they respect more highly than the ruler. Lastly, and with the same intention, that the boys must never be bereft of a ruler, even if by chance there were no grown man present, he laid down the rule that in such a case the most seasoned of the Leaders or Prefects was to become ruler for the noi^e, each of his own division. The conclusion is that under no circunis^nces whatever are the boys of Sparta destitute of one to rule them. .^. . III. Coming to the critical period at whi^'tcfc ^oy ceases to be a CAREFUL SUPERVISION 135 boy and becomes a youth, we find that it is just then that the rest of the world proceed to emancipate their children from the boy- escorts and from the teachers, and without substituting any further ruler, are content to launch them into absolute independence. Here, again, Lycurgus took an entirely opposite view of the matter. This, if observation might be trusted, was the season when the greatest conceit is developed in them, and insolence most luxuriates, when, too, the strongest desires for pleasures arise. At this point he imposed very many hardships upon them and devised the largest occupation. By a crowning enactment, which said that he who shrank from the duties imposed on him would forfeit hence- forth all claim to the glorious honors of the state, he caused, not only the public authorities, but those personally interested in each of them to take serious pains so that no single individual of them should by an act of craven cowardice find himself dishonored within the body politic. Furthermore, in his desire firmly to implant in their youthful souls a root of modesty he imposed upon these bigger boys a special rule. In the very streets they were to k^p their two hands within the folds of the cloak; they were to walk in silence and without turning their heads to gaze, now here, now there, but rather to keep their eyes fixed upon the ground before them. There also it has become manifest that, even in the matter of self-control, the males are stronger than the nature of females. At any rate, you might sooner expect a stone image to utter a sound than one of those Spartan youths ; to divert the eyes of some bronze statue were less difficult. As to quiet bearing, no bride ever stepped in bridal bower with more natural modesty. Note them when they have reached the public table. The plainest answer to the question asked, — that is all you need expect to hear from their lips. rV. But if he was thus careful in the education of the stripling, the Spartan lawgiver showed a still greater anxiety in dealing with those who had reached the prime of opening manhood ; considering their immense importance to the city in the scale of good, if only they proved themselves the men they should be. He had only to look around to see that wherever the spirit of emulation was most deeply seated, there, too, their choruses and gymnastic contests would present alike the highest charm to eye and ear. On the same 136 GOVERNMENT AND POLITICAL CONDITIONS principle he persuaded himself that he needed only to match his youthful warriors in the rivalry of excellence, and with like result. They also, in their degree, might be expected to attain to the fullest measure of manly virtue. What method he adopted to engage these combatants I wiU now explain. Their ephors select three men out of the whole body of the citizens in the prime of Ufa. These three are named hippagretae, or masters of the horse. Each selects one hxmdred others, being bound to explain for what reason he prefers some and rejects others. The result is that those who fail to obtain the distinction are now at open war, not only with those who rejected them, but with those who were chosen in their stead ; and they keep ever a jealous eye on one another to detect some slip of conduct contrary to the high code of honor there held customary. Thus is set on foot that strife, in truest sense acceptable to heaven, and for the purposes of state most politic. It is a strife in which not only is the pattern of a brave man's conduct fully set forth, but where each of them sep- arately train themselves for the highest efficiency, and if there be any need, they wiU individually come to the aid of the common- wealth with aU their strength. Necessity, moreover, is laid upon them to study a good habit of the body, coining as they do to blows with their fists on account of their feud wherever they meet. Albeit any one present has a right to separate the combatants, and, if obedience is not shown to the peacemaker, the manager of boys hales the delinquent before the ephors, and the ephors inflict heavy damages, since they will have it plainly understood that rage must never override obedience to law. With regard to those who have already passed the vigor of early manhood, and on whom the highest magistracies henceforth devolve, there is a like contrast. In Hellas generally we find that at this age the need of further attention to physical strength is removed, although the imposition of military service continues. But Lycur- gus made it customary for men of that age to regard hunting as the highest honor suited to their time of life ; albeit not to the exclusion of any public duty. His aim was that they might be equally able to undergo the fatigues of campaigning with those in the prime of early manhood. THE ATHENIAN CONSTITUTION 137 27. The Constitution of Athens before Solon (Aristotle, Constitution of the Athenians, i-iv. All the following selections from this treatise have been translated by G. W. B.) The greater part of Aristotle's treatise on the Athenian Constitution, written on a papyrus, was discovered in Egypt near the end of 1890, and the editio princeps, by F. G. Kenyon, appeared in the following January. The author's name is not given in the papyrus, but from quotations by ancient writers the authorship is established beyond a reasonable doubt. On internal evidence it is clear that the work, was composed between 328 and 325, some years after the publication of the Politics and shortly after the appearance of Androtion's Atthis, which Aristotle seems to have used as his main source. The discovery is especially helpful in clarifying our conceptions as to the nature of such treatises, and has helped solve many problems. For details, see intro- ductions to the editions of Kenyon and Sandys, and bibliography, p. 43. In the earlier part of the treatise, now lost, Aristotle evidently arranged his material according to reigns, as was the custom of ancient chroniclers (c/. no. 16 sq.), narrating in each the institutions and events traditionally assigned to it. The first period, that of the monarchy, extended to the accession of Theseus. Then began the first period of constitutional government, being originally a slight deviation from kingship.. During this period the government was aris- tocratic. At a time, not precisely dated, before Draco, began a new period of government (timocracy of the heavy infantry) in which the right to vote was enjoyed by all who could at their own expense furnish a panoply. This form of government continued to the archonship of Solon, 594. The extant fragment opens with the trial of the Alcmeonidae for sacrilege committed some years earlier in the slaughter of the followers of Cylon who had placed themselves under the protection of Athena. In giving an account of this event Plutarch {Solon 12) states that Solon persuaded the Alcmeonidae " to be tried before a court of three hundred chosen on the ground of nobility. With Myron as accuser the men were convicted, and the hving were banished," etc. By a comparison with this statement it is easy to reconstruct in substance the opening sentence of Aristotle's treatise. I. With Myron as accuser (they were tried) by a court taken from the noble families and sworn on the sacrifices. Convicted of impiety, they themselves ^ were cast forth from the tombs and their gens (genos) was condemned to eternal exile. Thereupon Epi- menides of Crete purified the city.^ 1 As years had elapsed between the sacrilege and the trial, all or nearly all the actual perpetrators were dead. The procedure admirably illustrates the belief in hereditary guilt. "The date of the visit of Epimenides is exceedingly uncertam, as is everything connected with him; see Sandys' note. 138 GOVERNMENT AND POLITICAL CONDITIONS 2. Afterward it came about that for a long time the nobles and commons disturbed the state by their sedition. For the govern- ment was oligarchic in all respects ; and particularly the poor, with their children and wives, were in slavery to the rich. They were called pelatae (clients) and hectemori (sixth-part men), for they tilled the fields of the wealthy for that amount of rent. AU the land was in the hands of the few ; and if they (the tenants) failed to render the rents due, they and their children were liable to en- slavement. There were loans on the security of every one's person down to the time of Solon ; and he was in fact the first to stand forth as a patron of the commons. Now it was a most hard and grievous feature of the constitution that the masses should be in slavery; not but that they had other grounds of complaint, for they were, so to speak, excluded from everything. 3. The organization of the original government (of the repubhc) as it existed before Draco, was as follows. Their appointments to office were based on the qualifications of birth and wealth. Orig- inally the offices were life-long and afterward decennial. The first and most important magistrates were the king, polemarch, and archon. The earUest of these three was the kingship, for it existed from the beginning. Secondly was instituted in addition the polemarchy because of the fact that some of the kings had proved incapable in war; hence they had sent for Ion on an oc- casion of especial need.' The last was the archonship : ^ the ma- jority say it was instituted in the time of Medon, others in the time of Acastus. The latter urge as proof the circumstance that the nine archons swear that they will fulfil their oaths as in the time of Acastus, with the idea that in his magistracy the Codridas sur- • The institution of the polemarchy is connected in tradition with the war waged by Athens against Eleusis (c/. Hdt. viii. 44 ; Paus. i. 1 3 1 . 3) , and it seems probable that on the annexation of Eleusis all Attica was organized, or reorganized, in the four Ionic tribes. This connection helps explain why Ion was regarded as a polemarch. It seems probable further that the oflSce was instituted before the kingship was thrown open to all the eupatrids (conventional date 713-712). The chroniclers before Aristotle pushed the institution of this office and of the archonship some three centuries back into the past. ' The archonship was instituted about 700, a decade or two after the polemarchy. The reason for the pushing back of these institutions (see preceding note) was the de- sire to make the repubUc begin as early as possible — with Acastus or Medon or even with Theseus. PERIOD OF THE ARISTOCRACY 139 rendered some of their royal power, corresponding prerogatives being transferred to the archons. Whichever way it was it matters little, for the change took place in that period. That is was the last of these offices, however, is proved by the circumstance that the archon administers none of the ancestral functions, as do the king and polemarch, but only those which were afterward added.^ It is therefore only recently that the ofl&ce has become great, in- creased by gradual accretions. The thesmothetse were for the first time chosen many years later — when the magistrates had already come to be elected an- nually — in order that they might record the customary laws and keep them for the trial of offenders. Therefore this alone of the offices has never been longer than a year in duration. Thus much do they precede one another in the time (of their institution). All nine archons did not occupy the same office ; but the king used the building now called the boucoleum, near the prytaneum; and a proof of it is that even now the marriage and union of the king's wife with Dionysus takes place there. The archon had the pry- taneum, the polemarch the epilyceum ; formerly it was called the polemarcheum, but after Epilycus had rebuilt and furnished it in his polemarchy, it was named the epilyceum.* The thesmothetae occupy the thesmotheteum. In the time of Solon all (nine archons first) met together in the thesmotheteum.' They had absolute power to settle cases without appeal, and not as now merely to hold a preliminary trial. These, then, were the regulations regarding the offices. The council of the Areopagus had the function of watching over the laws ; but in fact it managed the most numerous and important pubUc affairs with full power to chastise and fine all who acted disorderly. Birth and wealth were required of those who were elected archons; and from them the Areopagites were constituted. Hence the office of the latter has alone remained lifelong to the present day. ^ Such reasoning, found in many parts of the treatise, proves that Aristotle or his source had no contemporary record of the matters under consideration, but followed' the method of inferring the past from present conditions. ' Epilyceum (iirl AvKelip) doubtless means " Near the Lyceum." The author's ex- planation is characterisitic of the naive reasoning of the ancients in such matters. ' In other words, it was not till the time of Solon that these nine magistrates came to constitute a board — that of the nine archons. I40 GOVERNMENT AND POLITICAL CONDITIONS 4. Such is an outline of the original constitution. No long time afterward, in the archonship of Aristaschmus, Draco drew up his laws. But the constitution itself (as it then existed) had the following character.^ The franchise had (already) been granted to those who could furnish a panoply. They elected the nine archons and the treasurers from such as possessed an estate worth not less than ten minas ^ free from encumbrance, and the other, less important oflELces from those who had the franchise. The generals and hipparchs must show an estate free from encumbrance, worth no less than a hundred minas, and must be the fathers of children above ten years of age, bom of a lawful wife. It was necessary for these persons, namely the prytaneis,' generals and hipparchs, to give security for the year to the time of their audit, furnishing four securities of the same census class as the generals and the hipparchs. There was to be a Council of Four Hundred and One, appointed by lot from those who had a right to vote. This and other ofl&ces were filled by lot from the citizens above thirty years of age, and it was not permitted to hold the same office a second time till all had their turn, then the lot was drawn anew from the beginning. When there was a session of the council or assembly, if any councillor was absent, he was fined if a pentacosiomedinmus three drachmas,* if a knight two, if a zeugite one. The council of the Areopagus was guardian of the laws, and supervised the offices to see that they were legally administered. It was permitted to anyone who was injured, to bring an impeachment before the Areopagites, citing the law in violation of which he was suffering harm. However, there were ' Most modem scholars have declared this chapter, or the greater part of it, an interpolation. There is no space here for the discussion of the extremely complicated subject. The writer of these notes has preferred to assume, at least tentatively, the genuineness of the chapter and to attempt a translation in accordance with that view. It is to be noted that Aristotle does not say here or elsewhere that Draco T#as the author of a constitution ; and the abruptness of the change in this passage from ' ' laws " to "constitution " may be due to the omission of material found in his source relating in detail to the laws and courts of homicide. •This and the following property qualifications for office are suspicious; but mistakes are easily made in copying numbers. ' They were either prytaneis of the naucraries or of the council of four himdred and one mentiohed below. * There was little currency in Attica at this time, and that was of the iSginetan standard. A drachma of this standard was about twenty-five cents; a mina was a hundred drachmas. SOLON 141 loans on the security of the person, as has been said, and the land was in the hands of the few.^ 28. The Athenian Constitution from Solon to Peisistratus 594-560 B.C. (Aristotle, Constitution of the Athenians, 5-13. Of the poem in § 5 the first sentence only is from Aristotle, the rest is from another source (Antho- logia Lyrica, ed. Bergk, 4, also translated by G. W. B.) With this selection compare Plutarch, Solon. 5. Such being the organization of the government, while the many were in slavery to the few, the commons rose in revolt against the nobles. After the sedition had grown strong and the two parties had long been arrayed against each other, they in common elected Solon as arbitrator and archon,^ and intrusted to him the constitu- tion. The occasion was his composition of the elegy beginning thus: — "I perceive, and within my heart lie grie^, as I see the oldest country of laonia in distress. Never is it the will of Zeus and the thought of the blessed immortal gods that our city perish ; for in such wise the high-souled guardian of the city, Pallas Athena, daughter of a mighty sire spreads over it her hands. The nobles, persuaded by then: love of money, desire recklessly to destroy the great city. And as to the people, the mind of their magistrates is dishonest — magistrates who are destined to suffer many ills because of their monstrous violence. For they know not how to be satisfied or to enjoy the present feast in quiet. . . . They grow wealthy in obedience to unjust deeds.' . . . They spare neither sacred nor public property and they rob and steal, one here and one there. They guard not the revered foundations of Justice, who though silent, knows what is going on, what went on before, and has come to demand full settlement in time. This wound inevitable hath come upon all the city, namely evil slavery into which the state hath quickly fallen, and which stirs up civil strife and war, — war that destroys our lovely youth in numbers.* For our well-beloved city is consumed by the evil-minded in their meetings, in which unjust plans are held dear. These are the ills prevailing in the commons ; ' Draco's legislation in no way relieved the economic distress of the poor. ' Solon was elected archon, 594, and at the same time thesmothete (" legislator ") with absolute power. Although one object of this extraordinary authority was for the arbitration of the dvil strife, there was in Athens no political officer called " arbi- trator." ' These two lacunae are in the text. * Evidently dvil war had broken out, and blood was shed. 142 GOVERNMENT AND POLITICAL CONDITIONS " but many of the poor are going into a foreign land, sold and bound in unseemly chains and suffer hateful woes by force of slavery. HaU doors no longer will to hold the evil, it leapeth over the lofty hedge, and you find it everywhere, even if you hide in a chamber corner. This my soul bids me teach the Athenians, that misrule brings most iUs to a city ; but good rule makes all thiags harmoni- ous and at one. Good order puts bonds upon the wicked, smooths the rough, stays satiety, weakens violence, withers flowers that grow of Ate (reckless guUt), straightens crooked judgments, softens acts of cruelty, ends disputation, ends the wrath of hateful strife." Thus he marched to the attack and contended with each side against the other, reasoning with them, and finally exhorted them in common to put a stop to the existing strife. By birth and rep- utation Solon was among the first men in the state, whereas in property and circumstances he belonged to the middle class,^ as all admit, and as he himself testifies in his poems in which he urges the wealthy to refrain from avarice : — " Still your lordly heart within your breasts, you who have come into surfeit of abundant blessings ; nourish your proud soul in moderation ; for we shall not yield, nor shall you in everything have your way." From first to last he lays the blame of the sedition upon the wealthy ; hence in the beginning of the elegy he says he fears " their greed of gain and their overweening mind," with the idea that this spirit was the cause .of the existing strife. 6. When he had become master of the state, Solon freed the commons both for the present and for the future by forbidding loans on the security of the person ; and he enacted laws and made an abolition of debts both private and public, which they term seisachtheia ('disburdening'), with the idea that thus they shook off their burden.^ In these matters some attempt to slander him; ' In Greek literature the "middle dass" is the social class of moderate wealtfi, not necessarily the industrial or commercial class. • Aristotle does not say here that he abolished all debts. The only reliable informa- tion on the subject which he had was derived from Solon's poems quoted by him. From these poems we have a right to infer that Solon canceled those debts only which were based on the security (i) of land, (2) of the person. It is a pertinent fact, too, that Androtion {Atthis, quoted below, § 10) imderstood that Solon left some debts un- canceled. Grote {History of Greece, HI. 102 sqq.), a man of robust common-sense, maintains substantially the view presented in this note. Associated with the festival of the seisachtheia, however, was a popular but ill-founded tradition that Solon abol- ished all debts. THE SEISACHTHEIA 143 for it happened that when Solon was about to make the seisachtheia, he told his plan in advance to some of the nobles ; and then, as the popular party say, he was outgeneraled by his friends ; but as they say who wish to calumniate him, he shared in the gain. Now these nobles, borrowing money, bought up a large tract of land, and no long time afterward, when the abolition of debts took place, they became wealthy ; thus they say arose the f amihes reputed to be of ancient wealth.^ In point of fact, however, the account given by the popular party is more credible,; for it is not reasonable that a man who in other matters proved himself so moderate and so patriotic that, when it was permitted him by conspiring with either party to make himself tyrant of the state, he incurred the enmity of both factions and placed a higher value on honor and on the safety of the state than on his own advantage — it is not reasonable, I say, that such a man should debase himself in transactions so mean and unworthy. That he had this opportunity the disordered condition of affairs testifies, and he himself often mentions it in his poems, while all acknowledge it to be so. It is necessary, there- fore, to consider the charge false. 7. He established a constitution and made laws besides, and the ordinances of Draco they ceased using with the exception of those concerning homicide. Engraving the laws on tablets, he set them up in the King's Porch, and all swore to obey them. The nine archons, taking oath on a stone, swore that they would dedicate a golden statue in case they transgressed any of the laws, hence to the present day they continue to take this oath. He made the laws binding for a hundred years, and organized the constitution in the following manner. He divided (the population) into four census classes, just as it had been divided before, into pentacosiomedimni, knights (hippeis), zeugitse, and thetes. He assigned the ofl&ces to be filled from the pentacosiomedimni, knights and zeugitse, namely the nine archons, the treasurers, the commissioners of contracts, the eleven, and the ' This passage illustrates the extent to which the politics of the Athenians molded their conceptions of the past. Democrats and oligarchs had their opposing views of Solon, which found their way into literature. The statement regarding the dishon- orable origin of families of ancient wealth (eupatrids) must have come from one who was an oUgarch but not a noble. 144 GOVERNMENT AND POLITICAL CONDITIONS colacretse, distributing them among the several classes according to their property ratings. To the thetic class he granted a share in the assembly and the popular courts only. A pentacosiomedim- nus was one who produced from his own estate five hundred meas- ures ^ wet and dry together, a knight three hundred measures, but as some say, one who could support a horse ; and they adduce as proof the name of the class, with the idea that it was derived from this circumstance, and they cite the dedicatory ofiEerings of the ancients, for there stands on the Acropohs a statue with the fol- lowing inscription : — " Anthemion, son of Diphilus, dedicated this statue to the gods when he esEchanged the thetic for the knightly census." The horse stands there in evidence that the word knightly ('hippie,' tTTircK, tTTTTt/eo'?, from Jtttto?, 'horse') has this meaning. But in fact it seems more reasonable that the class, like that of the pentacosiomedimni, was defined in terms of measures.^ The zeugitae were those who produced two hundred measures of both kinds, and the rest were thetes, who had no right to any mag- istracy. Hence even now when the question is asked of one who is to be taken by lot for any office, what census class he belongs to, no one answers, the thetic. 8. The arc honshi p he caused to be filled by lot from nominees whom the TfiBes severally selected. Each tribe chose ten nom- inees for the archonships and lots were drawn from them ; hence even now remains the custom for the tribes to draw severally by lot ten candidates, from whom the archons are then appointed by lot.' A proof that he caused them to be taken by lot from the cen- sus classes is the law which they continue even now to use concern- ing the treasurers ; it prescribes that they be appointed by lot from the pentacosiomedimni. Thus Solon legislated regarding the nine 1 The standard dry measure of Athens from the time of Solon was the medimnus, about I J bu. The wet measure was the metretes, 8 J gal. 'There is no contradiction in Aristotle's sources on this subject: the dass was doubtless defined in terms of measures, and members were required to furnish each a horse for military service. ' It is clear that Aristotle had no Solonian document for his statement regarding the mode of appointment of archons, but merely inferred the Solonian method from that of his own time. There can be no doubt, however, that he has here made a mistake, that election to the office continued to the year 487-486 ; c/. § 22 infra. CLASSES, OFFICES, AND COUNCILS 145 archons, whereas in the original form of constitution the council of the Areopagus had called up men and of its own judgment had as- signed them according to their qualifications to the several offices for the year. There were four tribes as before and four tribe-kings. From the several tribes were formed three trittyes, with twelve naucraries to each. Over the naucraries were established, as a magistracy, the naucrars, having charge of the current receipts and expenditures. In the laws of Solon, therefore, which they no longer use, it is often written that the naucrars shall pay into and expend from the naucraric fund.^ He constituted further a council of four hundred, a hundred from each tribe ; and he assigned the council of the Areopagus to the duty of protecting the laws, just as formerly it was guardian of the constitution. In fact it continued to super- vise in addition the most numerous and most important adminis- trative matters, while it corrected wrong-doers with full power to fine and punish, and it brought up the fines to the Acropolis with- out the obligation of stating the ground for their exaction. Fur- thermore it tri^d conspirators against the state under a law of im- peachment which Solon enacted concerning such offenders. Seeing the state often disturbed by sedition and many of the citizens through sheer inertness allowing such affairs to take their own course, he enacted with reference to them a peculiar law, that whoever, when the country is disturbed by sedition, shall not take up arms with either faction, shall be disfranchised and deprived of all part in the state. 9. Such were Solon's regulations regarding the offices. Three features of his constitution seem to have been especially favorable to the people : the first and most important was his prohibition of lending money on the security of the person ; the second his per- mission to anyone who wished to go to law in behalf of injured per- sons ; 2 the third (by which they say the populace has chiefly gained ' Noteworthy is the circumstance that Aristotle, or his source, had access to ob- solete laws preserved in the archives. Most of the institutional history of early Attica had been drawn by the chroniclers (atthid-writers) from such documents. ' This regulation is here mentioned by Aristotle for the first time. The injuries here referred to were not homicide, assault with intent to kill, or the like, for in such cases prosecution could be begun by kinsmen only. The author has in mind injury to parents by children; to orphans, heiresses, etc., by their guardians. In such cases any citizen could bring an accusation. 146 GOVERNMENT AND POLITICAL CONDITIONS power) the right of appeal to a popular court ; for being master of the vote, the commons have become master of the constitution. Still further because of the fact that the laws have not been com- posed simply and clearly, but like the statute concerning heiresses and wards of state,^ necessarily many disputes arise and the popular court comes to be arbiter of all things public and private. Some accordingly suppose that he made the laws obscure on purpose, that the commons might have power to determine their meaning. It is not reasonable : (their obscurity is owing rather) to his in- ability to reach perfection in the general terms of a statute ; for it is right to judge him, not by the present consequences, but by the intention he has shown in the rest of his constitutional legislation, lo. These features of his laws, accordingly, seem to be favorable to the people; but before his legislation he abolished debts, and afterward he made the increase in the measures and weights and in the money standard, for in his time the measures became greater than the Pheidonian ; ^ and the mina, which formerly contained nearly seventy drachmas, was filled up to a hundred.' The ancient type of coin was the double drachma.^ He established also stand- ard weights corresponding to the coinage, sixty-three minas making a talent, and divided the mina into staters and other denominations. For the sake of comparison a passage from Androtion, Atthis, quoted by Plutarch, Solon, 15, is here inserted. Some authorities, among whom is Androtion, have written that he relieved the poor, not by an abolition of debts, but by lowering ' Statutes relating to inheritance, adoption, and kindred subjects of family law were indeed complicated. This condition, however, is not due to any legislator but to the very complexity of family relations. The legislator did Uttle more than embody in enactments traditional customs in such matters. * Pheidon and his weights and measures are exceedingly obscure ; for references to the essential sources, see Sandys' note ad loc. It should be noticed that Aristotle speaks of him here only in connection with metra, measures of capacity. 'This statement has reference to the coinage. The usual explanation has been that Solon introduced the Euboic standard of coinage in place of the ^Eginetan, and that the proportion between the two was about as Aristotle has here stated it — that 70 drachmas of the Mginetaa standard equaled 100 drachmas of the Euboic. In that case Aristotle is wrong in assuming an increase instead of a diminution. Head, His- toria Numorum (2d ed., 191 1), 367 sq., presents in vindication of Aristotle a new inter- pretation, which however is not wholly convincing. * I.e., the ySginetan double drachma. RESULTS OF SOLON'S LEGISLATION 147 the rate of interest,' and that this benevolent act was called seisach- theia, and together with it the increase of the measures and the value of the coinage; for the mina, which formerly contained seventy-three drachmas, he made to contain a hundred, so that they (the drachmas) yielded an equal amount in number but less in value,^ and those who had great debts to pay were benefited, while the creditors remained uninjured. Aristotle's account is now resumed. 11. When he had arranged the government in the manner de- scribed, many people kept coming to him and annoying him in regard to the laws, finding fault with some points and asking questions concerning others; and as he wished neither to disturb these ar- rangements nor to remain and incur enmities, he went on a journey for trade and sight-seeing to Egypt, saying he would not return for ten years ; for he thought it was not right that he should remain and interpret the laws but that everyone should obey them to the letter. It was at the same time his misfortune that many of the nobles were at variance with him because of the abolition of debts and that both factions had shifted their attitude because his reform had turned out contrary to their expectation. For the commons supposed he would redistribute everything, whereas the nobles hoped he would restore to them the same constitution or make but Uttle change in it. He, however, opposed both parties, and though it was permitted him by conspiring with either to make himself tyrant, he preferred to incur the enmity of both parties by saving his country and legislating for the best. 12. All others agree that such was the case, and he in a poem mentions it in the following terms : — "I gave the commons as much power as sufficed, neither detracting from their honor nor adding thereto. Those who possessed might and were illustrious in wealth, for them I planned that they should sufEer naught unseemly. I stood, too, with my strong shield about both parties, suffering neither to gain an unjust victory." ' There was a law of Solon which permitted any interest agreed upon by the con- tracting parties; Lysias x. i8. As Androtion, an Athenian statesman, must have known this fact, we may only suppose that Plutarch has misquoted him. *Here we have the authority of Androtion, against that of Aristotle, that the value of the coins was diminished ; and on the whole this seems to be the reasonable view. We have also his authority that some debts remained uncanceled. 148 GOVERNMENT AND POLITICAL CONDITIONS Again, revealing his mind regarding the populace, as to the way it ought to be treated : — " Thus the commons would best follow their leaders,' neither given too much rein nor yet oppressed. For satiety breeds insolence when abundant wealth comes upon men whose minds are not right." Again somewhere else he says concerning those who sought a redistribution of land : — "They came for plunder, cherishing a hope of riches, each one imagining he would get abundant bliss, and that I, now smoothly flattering, would r«veal a harsh intent. Then they idly prated ; now in wrath they all look at me askance as at an enemy. It is not fitting ; for what I promised, with the gods' help I performed. I wrought not in vain, nor did it please me to accomplish aught with a tyrant's force, nor that the good should share equally with the base in the rich soil of the fatherland." Again in speaking of the abolition of debts and of those who had formerly been in slavery and had been set free by the seisachtheia, he says : — "As to the purpose for which I organized the populace, why should I have desisted before reaching this end. In the just fulness of time the most mighty mother of the Olympian gods will bear me witness, even black Earth, most excellent, that I removed the mortgage pillars which stood in many places, — she was formerly in slavery but now set free. To Athens our country divinely founded, I restored many men who had been sold, some illegally, others under the law, others whom hard necessity forced into exile, who in their many wan- derings had forgot the Attic tongue. Others held here in unseemly slavery and trembling under their masters' caprices I set free. These things I did by the power of law, uniting force with justice, and I fulfilled my promise. Ordinances, too, alike for the bad and the good I enacted, adapting straightforward justice to every case. Had another than I, some evil-minded, avaricious man, seized the goad, he would not have restrained the commons ; for had I willed what would then have pleased this opposing party, or again what their foes devised for them, this state would now be bereft of many men. Therefore gathering courage from every source, I stood at bay like a wolf amid a pack of dogs." Further, while rebuking both parties for their later grumblings : "If I ought openly to reprove the commons — what they now have they would never have set eyes on even in dreams, while those who, are greater, and superior in might, should commend me and hold me as their friend." 1 Magistrates. This quotation proves that Solon had no intention of creating a democraqr. SEDITION 149 For if anyone else, he says, had obtained this office — "He would not have restrained the commons or held them back till by their disturbance they had robbed the milk of its richness. Therefore I took my stand as a landmark between two armies." 13. For these reasons, accordingly, he went on a journey abroad. During Solon's absence, while the state was still in confusion, they kept the peace for four years ; but in the fifth year after Solon's archonship they failed to elect an archon because of the sedition, and again in the fifth year they left the office vacant for the same reason. Then after an equal interval * Damasias, elected archon, ruled two years and two months, till he was forcibly expelled from his office. Thereupon they resolved because of the sedition to elect ten archons,^ five from the eupatridae, three from the farmers (aypoiKot)^ and two from the artisans {Brifiiovpryoi) ^^ and these persons held office in the year after Damasias. From this circumstance it is evident that the archon possessed the chief power, for they seem always to have been striving with one another for his office. Al- together they continued in a state ef d^order among themselves, some taking as a cause and pretext the abolition of debts ; for it had resulted in their impoverishment. Others were discontented 'In the interpretation of these chronological data editors are widely at variance; see Sandys' note ad he. The subject is too complicated for treatment here. 2 In the opinion of Meyer, Forsck. II. 537 sqq., this measure transferred the func- tions of the office of Archon (eponymus), chief archon, to a commission of ten. Logi- cally this was Aristotle's idea, for he considered that the dissensions concerned the chief archonship only. In truth, however, he or his source found the fact of the ' ' ten archons " in a document, and interpreted it as in the text. While the view of Meyer is in any event perfectly possible, it is equally possible that the lower classes were content to leave the chief archonship in the hands of the eupatrids, provided they were fairly rep- resented on the board. Furthermore Aristotle does not state whether the ten archons and the peculiar representation of the three classes were a temporary expedient or a lasting arrangement; but as there were no more dissensions over the office we may infer that the arrangement continued to the usurpation of Peisistratus. In the Cleis- thenean system the secretary of the board counted, in the representation of the tribes, as a tenth archon. 'This measure is generally set down as reactionary, a return to conditions existing before the introduction of property qualifications for office. We may believe, however, that in spite of the broadening of eligibility the eupatrids still monopolized the offices, and that the measure here mentioned, like the Lex Lidnia-Sextia at Rome, required actual usage to conform with law. This explanation was proposed by Botsford, Development of the Athenian Constitution (1893), 182 sq. See also De Sanctis, Atthis (2d ed., 1912), 264-8. ISO GOVERNMENT AND POLITICAL CONDITIONS with the constitution because of the great change that had taken place, while others were actuated by mutual hatred. There were (accordingly) three factions : one of the Paralians (Shore Men), led by Megacles the Alcmeonid, who seemed particularly to favor a moderate form of government; another of the Pediaeans (Plain Men), who favored an oligarchy, and who were under the leader- ship of Lycurgus; the third of the Diacrians (Hill Men) led by Peisistratus, who seemed most devoted to the people's interest. To the last-named faction were joined, because of their poverty, those whose securities had been cancelled, and, through fear, those who were not of pure descent. A proof is that after the overthrow of the tyranny they made a revision of the Usts of citizens, with the idea that many were enjoying the franchise who had no right to it.^ The several names of these factions were derived from the districts where they held their lands. 29. The Tyranny (Aristotle, Constitution of the Athenians, 14-19) «i4. Peisistratus appeared to be most devoted to the popular cause, and had won a brilliant reputation in the war with Megara. Having wounded himself, he persuaded the people, on the supposi- tion that his injuries were inflicted by political enemies, to grant him a guard for his person. Taking the club-bearers, as they were called, he conspired with them against the state, and seized the AcropoKs in the archonship of Comeas,^ in the thirty-second year after (Solon's legislation). The story is told that when Peisis- tratus was asking for a guard, Solon opposed him, saying that he was wiser than some and braver than others — wiser than those who failed to see that Peisistratus was aiming at the tyranny, and braver than those who knew it but kept silent. As he accomplished nothing with words, he brought out his armor and placed it before his door, saying he had aided his coimtry to the best of his ability '■ This revision was probably made by the party of Cleisthenes after its return from exile but before Cleisthenes took up the cause of the people; § 20; Hdt. v. 69; qf. Botsford, in Harvard Studies in Classical Philology, VIII (1897). 9-11. ^560 B.C. "Thirty-second" is probably a copyist's error for "thirty-fourth" (Sevripif for Terdprif), EXILES AND RESTORATIONS 151 (for he was at this time a very old man) and asking the rest now to perform this service. But Solon accomplished nothing by his exhortations at that crisis. Peisistratus, however, assuming the government, managed affairs constitutionally rather than des- potically. Before his supremacy was firmly rooted, the party of Megacles, joining in friendship with that of Lycurgus, expelled him in the sixth year after his first establishment, in the archonship of Hegesias. But in the twelfth year afterward Megacles, harassed by sedition, again made overtures of peace to Peisistratus on con- dition that the latter should take the daughter of the former in marriage.^ Megacles brought him back in an exceedingly old- fashioned and simple way. Spreading a report that Athena was restoring Peisistratus, he found a tall, handsome woman — of the Paeanian deme as Herodotus says, whereas others describe her as a Thracian flower-girl, named Phye, of CoUytus ^ — and dressing her up in imitation of the goddess, he brought her in along with Peisis- tratus, the latter seated in the chariot with the woman at his side, while the people of the city on their knees received them with adoration. * 15. Thus was brought about the first restoration. He went again into exile about the seventh year after his return ; for he did not maintain himself long, but because he was unwilHng to treat the daughter of Megacles as his wife, and consequently feared a combination of the two factions, he secretly withdrew from the country. First he colonized a place called Rhascelus about the Thermaic Gulf ; then he crossed over to the neighborhood of Moimt Pangaeus. Making money in that locality and hiring soldiers, he came to Eretria in the eleventh year. Then for the first time he attempted to recover his supremacy by force, with the cooperation of the Thebans, of Lygdamis of Naxos, and of the knights who had the government at Eretria. Gaining a victory at Pallene and thus recovering his authority, he deprived the people of their arms and 'These chronological data are unreliable; cf. also § 17 and Aristotle, Politics, v. 9- 23, 131S b. There is an utter lack of harmony among the various statements. On the whole it would seem reasonable that his first tyranny and first exile were relatively brief, amounting together to perhaps ten years, that his second exile was ten years in duration and his final tyranny ten or eleven years. 2 Many demes (townships) must have existed under the tyranny, though they had no legal being before Cleisthenes; no. 30. 152 GOVERNMENT AND POLITICAL CONDITIONS firmly established his despotism. Then taking possession of Naxos, he appointed Lygdamis governor. The people he deprived of their arms in the following manner. • Holding a review of the citizens under arms at the Theseum, he attempted to address them, but spoke in a low voice ; and when they declared they could not hear him, he bade them come up near the gateway of the Acropolis in order that his voice might sound louder. While he was passing the time making his speech, persons appointed to the task took the arms and locking them in a building near the Theseum, came and made a sign to Peisistratus. He finished his speech and then told them about the arms, bidding them not wonder or be dejected but go and attend to their private affairs, as he would himself manage all public matters. 1 6. Such was the origin of the tyraimy of Peisistratus and such were its vicissitudes. He, as has been said, conducted the govern- ment moderately and more ia the character of a statesman than of a tyrant. In general he was humane and unusually mild and for- giving to wrong-doers, and especially he lent money to the needy for use in their labors, in order that they might gain a livelihood by agriculture. This he did for two reasons, that they might not pass their time in the city but be scattered throughout the country, and that, being moderately well off and occupied with their private concerns, they might have neither the desire nor the leisure to attend to public affairs. At the same time the cultivation of the land resulted in the increase of his revenues, for he collected a tenth of the produce. For this reason, too, he established judges to go throughout the demes, and he himself often journeyed into the country to inspect it and to settle disputes. While Peisistratus was on one of these expeditions, it is said that he had the adventure with the man on Hymettus who was cultivating the so-called tax- free farm. Seeing a certain man digging and working among the rocks with a stake, he bade his servant ask what was produced in the place. The otiber replied, " Only aches and pains, and of these aches and pains Peisistratus must have his tenth." The man an- swered without knowing him; but Peisistratus, pleased with his candor and his love of work, made him exempt from all taxes. In all other respects he absolutely refrained from disturbing the masses by his government, and he always preserved peace and CHARACTER OF THE TYRANNY 153 maintained quiet; so that the tyranny of Peisistratus was often spoken of proverbially as the age of Cronos (golden age) ; for after- ward when his sons had succeeded to the throne, the result was that the government became much harsher. Most praiseworthy of all his qualities was his popular and kindly character ; for in general he chose to manage all affairs in accordance with the laws, giving himself no advantage, and once when cited for murder before the council of the Areopagus, he presented himself with a view to mak- ing his defence, but the accuser failed through fear to come forward. Hence he remained in power for a long time, and whenever he was banished, he easily recovered his position ; for many of the nobles and commons were pleased with his rule. The former he attached to himself by his associations with them, the latter by aid in their private affairs. Throughout these times the laws of the Athenians concerning tyrants were mild, and particularly the one referring to the establishment of tyranny. The law runs thus: "These are the ancestral usages of the Athenians. If anyone attempts to make himseK tyrant, or if anyone has a hand in establishing a tyranny, let him and his gens be disfranchised." • 17. Peisistratus accordingly grew old in office and died of illness in the archonship of Philoneos,"^ having lived thirty-three years after the time when he first became tyrant, but having actually remained in power nineteen years ; for during the rest of the time he was in ejdle. Evidently therefore they speak foolishly who assert that Peisistratus was a youthful favorite of Solon and a general in the war with Megara for the possession of Salamis. Their ages do not agree, if one reckons the length of their respective lives and the dates of their deaths. After the decease of Peisistratus his sons secured the power and conducted the administration in the same way. Of his lawful wife he had two sons, Hippias and Hipparchus, and two of his Argive wife,^ lophon and Hegesistratus, surnamed Thettalus. Peisistratus had married from Argos the daughter of an Argive named Gorgilus. This lady, Timonassa, had formerly ^ 527 B.C. 'In 451 a statute of Perides ordered that those only should be citizens whose parents were both Athenians. Aristotle and other ancient writers wrongly assumed that this regulation was in force from the earliest times. Naturally they regarded the foreign marriage of Peisistratus as illegal. 154 GOVERNMENT AND POLITICAL CONDITIONS been the wife of the Cypselid Archinus of Ambracia. Thence arose his alliance with the Argives, a thousand of whom fought on his side in the battle of Pallene, having been brought by Hegesis- tratus. Some say he married the Argive woman after his first banishment, others while he was in possession of his authority. i8. Because of their greater reputation and age Hipparchus and Hippias were rulers of the state, while Hippias the elder, who was naturally statesmanlike and intelligent, was at the head of the government. Hipparchus, however, was youthful and amorous, and fond of literature. He it was who invited to Athens Anacreon and Simonides and the rest of the poets. [But Thettalus was much younger, and was bold and insolent in manner.] ^ He was the source of all their misfortunes. In love with Harmodius but failing to win his affection, he could not restrain his anger. On all oc- casions he showed himself bitter; and finally when the sister of Harmodius was about to act as basket-carrier at the Panathenaea, he forbade it, at the same time accusing Harmodius of being effem- inate. Hence it resulted that in their rage Harmodius and Aristogeiton did the deed with the help of many others. At the Panathenaea they were watching Hippias on the Acropolis (as he chanced to be sacrificing while Hipparchus was arranging the procession), and seeing one of the participants in the plot talking in a friendly manner with Hippias, they believed he was informing against them. Wish- ing accordingly to accomplish something before their arrest, they descended, and beginning action before the others, they killed Hip- parchus while he was arranging the procession near the Leocorium. Thus they ruined the whole plot.* Harmodius was immediately killed by the guards, and Aristogeiton, arrested afterward, died by prolonged torture. Under constraint he accused many who be- longed by birth to the nobility and were friends of the tyrants. For they were unable forthwith to find a clue to the plot. The current opinion, however, that Hippias disarmed those who were in the procession and searched them for concealed daggers is untrue, for they did not march armed in the procession ; this custom was afterward introduced by the democracy. ' This sentence seems to be an interpolation. ' With this account of the conspiracy compare Thucydides i. 20 ; vi. SS^SO- THE TYRANNY DEGENERATES 155 He accused the tyrants' friends, purposely as the democratic writers say, in order that the tyrants might commit impiety and at the same time be weakened by the destruction of innocent persons and their own friends, though as some say, he did not deceive but actually informed against his accomplices. Lastly as he was un- able, whatever he did, to find death, he proposed to denounce many others, and after persuading Hippias to give him his right hand as a pledge, he grasped it, at the same time reproaching Hippias with having offered his hand to the murderer o'f his brother. In this way he so exasperated Hippias that the latter could not restitiia his wrath but drew his dagger and killed him. 19. From these events it resulted that the tyranny became far harsher ; for in taking vengeance for his brother and in slaying and banishing many citizens, Hippias became distrustful and embittered toward all. About the fourth year after the death of Hipparchus, as his affairs in the city were in a bad condition, he undertook the fortification of Munichia with the idea of changing his residence to that place. While engaged in this work he was ej^elled by Cleomenes, king of the Lacedaemonians, inasmuch as oracles were continually given to the Laconians to the effect that they should abolish the tyranny. The reason for the oracles is as follows. The exiles, led by the Alc- meonidae, were unable by their own means to effect their return. In all their other undertakings they failed and particularly when they fortified Leipsydrium on Mount Fames within the country of Attica. Here, -joined by certain men from the city, they were besieged by the tyrants, wherefore after their disaster people used to sing in skolia * : — ' "Alas, Leipsydrium, traitor to your friends, how good the men you slew, how brave in fight, how nobly bom! They showed in that fray their illustrious parentage." Having failed in everything else, they contracted to build the temple at Delphi. This transaction provided them well with the means of gaining the aid of the Laconians. Whenever, accordingly, the Lacedasmonians consulted the oracle, the Pythia always replied that they must set Athens free, till she succeeded in persuading the ' On the meaning of the term, see no. 52. iS6 GOVERNMENT AND POLITICAL CONDITIONS Spartans, notwithstanding that they were guest-friends of the Pei- sistratidse. There was added a no small cause of the undertaking on the part of the Laconians in the alliance existing between the Argives and the Peisistratidae. In the first place they despatched Anchimolus with an army by sea. He was beaten and slain with the aid of Cineas the Thessalian, who came with a thousand cavalry. Enraged at the event, they sent by land with a larger force Cleo- menes the king, who after defeating the Thessalian horsemen in their endeavor to prevent his invasion of Attica, drove Hippias _.into the so-caUed Pelargic wall, and besieged him there with the aid of the Athenians. This event took place in the archpnship of Harpactides,^ after they had held the tyranny about seventeen years since the death of their father, and including his reign, forty- nine years in all. 30. CUEISTHENES AND THE DEMOCRACY 508-480 B.C. (Aristotle, Constitution of the Athenians, 20-22) 20. When the tyranny had fallen, a sedition arose between Isagoras, son of Teisander, a friend of the tyrants, and Cleisthenes of the gens of the Alcmeonidae. Beaten by means of the clubs, Cleisthenes attached the commons to himself by promising the franchise to the masses. Isagoras, now proving inferior in strength, called to his aid Cleomenes, his guest-friend, and persuaded him to expel the pollution ; for it was the common opinion that the Alc- meonidae were under a curse.^ Thereupon Cleisthenes with a few persons secretly withdrew from the country, while Cleomenes pro- ceeded to expel as polluted seven hundred Athenian families. Having accomplished this object, he attempted to dissolve the coun- cil ' and to make Isagoras and three hundred of his partisans mas- ters of the state. But as the council opposed and the multitude ' Sio B.C. On the tyranny and its downfall, cf. Hdt. i. 59-64; v. 57-65. ' The curse was brought upon them by the guilt inctirred in slaughtering the followers of Cylon ; no. 27. ' This was the council of Four Hundred ; that of the Five Hundred had not yet been instituted. CLEISTHENES 157 gathered, Cleomenes and Isagoras with their party took refuge in the Acropolis. The commons thereupon encamped and besieged them two days ; on the third day they permitted Cleomenes and all with him to depart under a truce, but recalled Cleisthenes and the rest of the exiles. Now that the commons had become masters of the state, Cleisthenes was their leader and champion : for the Alcmeonidse were perhaps the chief cause of the tyrants' expulsion and were almost always at sedition with them. Still earlier Cedon the Alcnieonid had made an attempt on them, hence the people used to sing to him in skolia ' : — • "Pour out to Cedon, boy, and forget it not, if ever our duty is to pour an offering of wine to the memory of brave men." 21. For these reasons the people trusted Cleisthenes. On that occasion, as he was leader of the people in the fourth year after the overthrow of the tyrants, in the archonship of Isagoras,^ in the first place he distributed all the people among ten tribes in place of four, with the object of intermixing them in order that more might have a share in the franchise. Hence arose the saying, '"Do not discriminate between the tribes" with reference to those who wished to scrutinize the gentes.' Then he constituted the council of five hundred in place of four himdred, fifty from each tribe instead of a hundred as formerly. The reason for his not distributing the people among twelve tribes was his desire to avoid the division into the existing trittyes as the four tribes contained twelve trittyes; so that, had he made twelve tribes, he would not have succeeded in redistributing the population.* The country he divided by demes into thirty parts, ten about the city, ten in the paraUa, ten in the midland ; and calling these parts trittyes, he assigned three by lot to each tribe in such a way that every tribe might have a trittys in each of the three local ' For an explanation of the term, see no. 52. ' S08 B.C. ' The meaning seems to be that whereas in the old tribe lists of citizens accoimt was taken of the gentes, imder the new system that was not the case. The proverb, however, may or may not have arisen from such a circumstance. * Aristotle feels called upon to make this explanation in view of the fact that twelve tribes, one for each month, would have been a far more convenient arrangement. The number was increased to twelve in 307 ; Ferguson, Hellenistic Athens, 64. 158 GOVERNMENT AND POLITICAL CONDITIONS sections. The inhabitants of the respective demes he made demes- men of one another in order that they might not expose the new citizens by calling them after the names of their fathers, but that they might be named after their demes. Hence the Athenians con- tinue to call themselves by the names of their demes. He insti- tuted demarchs with the same function as the earlier naucrars, for he made the demes to take the place of the naucraries. Some of the demes he named after localities, others after their founders ; for all the localities did not preserve the names of their founders. Their gentes and phratries and priesthoods he permitted them severally to keep according to ancestral usage.^ As eponyms of the tribes he appointed the ten whom the Pythia had selected from the hundred founders nominated to her.^ 22. Through these changes the constitution became far more democratic than that of Solon. The fact is that the tyranny had abolished some of the laws of Solon through failure to observe them, and Cleisthenes in his efifort to win the populace enacted new regu- lations, among which was the law of ostracism. It was not however tiU the fifth year after his legislation that, in the archonship of Hermocreon,' they drew up for the council of Five Hundred the oath which the members continue even now to swear. Then they began to elect the generals by tribes, one from each tribe,^ whereas the commander of the entire army was the polemarch. In the twelfth year afterward, in the archonship of Phsenippus,® they won the battle of Marathon. Two years after the victory, while the people were elated, they for the first time made use of the law of ostracism through suspicion of persons in power, because it was as 1 It is sufficiently known that Cleisthenes did not disturb the composition of the gentes. From Aristotle, Politics, vi. 4. 18, 1319 b, we infer that he increased the num- ber of phratries. It would be easy to reconcile the two passages by assuming that the old citizens remained in their several phratries, while new phratries were created for the multitude of new citizens. Many sacerdotal offices, too, remained hereditary in the noble families which had originally held them. 'I.e., he sent to the prophetess of Apollo at Delphi the names of a hundred local heroes (founders), from which she selected the ten tribal eponyms. ' The Attic year 501-500. * From the fact that the council of Five Hundred and the army of ten tribal regi- ments were not definitely organized before the date here given, we may assume that some years had been required for organizing the demes and fixing their boundaries. 6 490-489. CASES OF OSTRACISM 159 popular leader and general that Peisistratus had made himself tyrant. The first to be ostracized was one of his kinsmen, Hip- parchus, son of Charmus of Collytus, on account of whom in par- ticular Cleisthenes had enacted the law, as he wished to expel him.^ But the Athenians with the accustomed leniency of the democracy permitted to remain in the city such friends of the tyrants as re- frained from joining in their evil deeds in times of civil disturbance. The leader and patron of these friends was Hipparchus. In the next year following, in the archonship of Telesinus,^ they appointed by lot the nine archons, according to tribes, from five hundred nominees presented by the demesmen.' This was the first time after the tyranny, for hitherto aU had been elected. Megacles, son of Hippocrates * of Alopece, was ostracized. For three years in fact they continued to ostracize the friends of the tyrants, on account of whom the law had been enacted; and in the fourth year they began to ostracize any others who had the reputation of possessing excessive power. The first to be ostracized who had no connection with the tyranny was Xanthippus,^ son of Ariphron. Three years later, in the archonship of Nicodemus,* as mines had been opened in Maroneia and a hundred talents had accrued to the state from the works, while others were advising the division of the silver among the people, Themistocles prevented it. He did not say what use he would make of the money but bade them lend it to the hundred wealthiest Athenians, a talent to each ; then if the use of it should prove satisfactory, the expense should be the state's; otherwise the state should recover the money from the borrowers.^ Receiving the money on these terms, he built a hun- dred triremes, each of the hundred men constructing one ; and with these ships they fought at Salamis against the barbarians. In ' This statement seems most unlikely. ' 487-486. ' Through this change in the method of appointment the archons lost their impor- tance ; they ceased to be the chief magistrates, that position passing to the ten generals. ♦Hippocrates was a brother of Cleisthenes. From the fact that Megacles was considered a friend of the tyrants, we may perhaps infer that he had made a political "deal" with them. ^485-484. As the vote of ostracism took place in the winter, Xanthippus was exiled early in 484. . ■ 483-482- ' The anecdote certainly does not belong here. i6o GOVERNMENT AND POLITICAL CONDITIONS these times Aristeides, son of Lysimachus, was ostracized. Four years afterward, in the archonship of Hypsichides/ they recalled all the ostracized because of the invasion of Xerxes ; and for the future they laid down for the ostracized the rule that they must not dwell within Geraestus and Scyllaeum on penalty of being for- ever disfranchised.^ 31. The Procedure in Votes of Ostracism In view of the fact that the question as to the number of votes required for the ostracism of an individual has been reopened by Carcopino, J., Histoire de I'ostracisme athSnien, in M61anges d'histoire ancienne (Paris, 1909), the two principal passages bearing upon the question are given below. (Plutarch, Aristides, 7. Translated by G. W. B.) The general character of the procedure was as follows. Each man took an ostrakon,' and having written on it the name of the citizen whom he wished to exile, brought it to a part of the market- place which had been fenced in with palings. Then in the first place the archons counted the whole number of ostraka ; for if the number of voters was less than 6000, the vote of ostracism was in- effectual.^ Next they counted by itself the number of times each name occurred, and proclaimed the banishment for ten years of the one whose name had been written by the greatest number, per- mitting the banished the enjoyment of his own property.^ > 481-480. ^ The object was to prevent the ostracized from living so near at home as to inter- fere in politics. 'The ostrakon was a potsherd, specimens of which, with the names of famous Greeks, may be seen in the British Museum. ' The object was to determine whether a quorum of 6000, required for the vote of a privilegium, had actually voted. If the number fell below 6000, the individual names remained uncounted in order that no one might be prejudiced. After the introduction of pay for attendance at the assembly, early in the fourth century, there were officiab who kept a record of every citizen's attendance ; but it is unlikely that Cleisthenes made any such arrangement. It was only through the preliminary counting described in the text, therefore, that the number present could be ascertained. ' Plutarch's statement of the procedure is remarkably clear, and seems to have come from a reliable source. According to this statement 6000 constituted a quorum, and a plurality (not majority) of votes decided. His interpretation is confirmed by the well-known fact that pnvilegia (yjnilaiiaTa irf ivSpi) required a quorum of 6000 ; cf. Gilbert, Const. Antiq. 307 sqq. THE VOTING OF OSTRACISM i6i (Philochonis, Atthis, iii, Muller, Frag. hist. grcBC. I. p. 396, frag. 79 b. Translated by G. W. B.) Philochonis, writing in the third book, explains ostracism thus.^ Before the eighth prytany the people in assembly, by a preliminary, vote, determine whether they will have recourse to ostracism. Whenever the decision was affirmative, the market-place was fenced in with palings, and there were left open ten approaches through which (the citizens), entering by tribes, carried their ostraka, keep- ing the inscriptions concealed. The nine archons and the council presided. The votes were cotuited; the one against whom the greatest number was cast, and not less that 6000,^ having settled his cases at law regarding his private business transactions, had to leave the country within ten days, for a period of ten years. The term was afterward changed to five. He could enjoy the use of his own property but was not permitted to enter within a line drawn through the promontory of Eubcea. HjTperbolus alone of men of no repute was ostracized through' . . . because of the baseness of his character, not through suspicion, of his attempting the ty- ranny. After his exile they abolished the custom which originated through the legislation of Cleisthenes, after he had overthrown the tyranny, in order that, he might also banish the friends (of the tyrant).* ' It is to be noted that Phflochorus himself is not speaking ; this passage is a quo- tation, made directly or indirectly from him by Photius. The passage is exceedingly condensed and obscure, and contains at least one primary error — the statement that the period of ten years was afterward cut down to five. The statement, too, regarding the Umitation of the exile's movements is imperfect; cf. Aristotle, Const. Aih. 22, in no. 30 supra. These imperfections detract from the reliability of the passage. * It is possible that this phrase, too (see preceding note), has suffered through ex- cessive condensation. The statement of Philochorus may have read substantially, " and the total number of votes being not less that 6000," which would put it into agree- ment with the source of Plutarch's account. 'The person or persons (Alcibiades, Nicias) instrumental in his ostracism were probably named by Philochorus, but in Photius only the word " through " {SiA) remains. * On the whole this imperfect quotation from Philochorus cannot be taken in dis- proof of the dear, consistent account given by Plutarch. i62 GOVERNMENT AND POLITICAL CONDITIONS 32. Persian Tolerance of Greek Religion (Letter of Darius to the Persian official Gadatas, about 5°° B.C. ; Hicks and Hill, no. 20 ; Ditt. I. no. 2 ; Cousin and Deschamps, in Bulletin de Cor- respondance kellenique, XIII (1889). 529-42, text with French translation and commentary. Translated by C. J. O.) From this number to the end of the chapter the selections illustrate the relations between the Hellenes and their enemies, the Persians. Though dating from Roman time, the inscription is proved to be a copy of the original rescript of the Persian king Darius I (reigned 522-486 B.C.) by the resemblance between its style and that of the Old Persian inscriptions. We have no further information about the Gadatas to whom the letter is addressed ; but he must have been an official of the Ionian province, perhaps the governor (satrap), more probably the overseer of a royal park. The document shows both the careful administration and the religious tolerance of Darius, who, though himself a worshiper of Auramazda, maintains here the immunities of a sanctuary of ApoUo. The king of kings, Darius, the son of Hystaspes, to his slave Gadatas says thus : — I learn that thou dost not obey my com- mands in all respects. In that thou cultivatest my land by trans- planting the fruits (of the country) beyond the Euphrates ^ to the lower parts of Asia, I commend thy purpose, and by reason of this there shall be laid up for thee great favor in the king's house.'' But, in that thou settest at naught my policy towards the gods, I will give thee, if thou dost not change, a proof of my wronged feelings ; for thou didst exact a payment from the sacred gardeners of Apollo and didst command them to dig unhallowed ground, not knowing the mind of my forefathers towards the god, who hath told the Persians the whole truth.* . . . ' Syria, which was "beyond the Euphrates" to the Persians. ' I.e., Gadatas is enrolled in the official list of the king's benefactors, concerning which see Herodotus, viii. 85; Esther, chap. 6. A similar eicpression occurs in a letter of Xerxes quoted by Thucydides, i. 129. ' The reference seems to be to oracles of Apollo received by Cyrus or Cambyses, the predecessors of Darius. On the selection in general, see E. Meyer, Entstehung des Judentums (Halle, 1896), 19-21. PERSIAN AGGRESSIONS 163 33. The Attempt of the Persians to Conqtjee Naxos, 500 B.C. (Herodotus v. 30-34) In his policy of aggression Darius was gradually pushing the western bound- ary of his empure into Europe. He had conquered Thrace, had received the nominal subjection of Macedon, and had thus extended the empire to the north- ern border of Thessaly. The ^Egean Islands lying near the coast of Asia Minor had submitted. The subjoined excerpt describes an attempt to extend the empire across the ^gean to the island of Naxos. The selection especially illustrates the fact that the greatest enemies of Hellas were her own people. 30. . . . At the time of which I speak evils began to come to Ionia from these states (Paros and Miletus, mentioned in the pre- ceding paragraph) in the following manner : — From Naxos certain men of the wealthier class were driven into exile by the people, and having gone into exile they arrived at Miletus. Now of Miletus it happened that Aristagoras son of Molpagoras was ruler in charge, being both a son-in-law and also a cousin of Histiseus son of Lysagoras, whom Darius was keeping at Susa : ' for Histiasus was despot of Miletus, and it happened that he was at Susa at this time when the NaxianS came, who had been in former times guest- friends of Histiaeus. When accordingly the Naxians arrived, they made request of Aristagoras, to see if perchance he would supply them with a force, that so they might return from exile to their own land : and he, thinking that if by his means they should return to their own state, he would be ruler of Naxos, but at the same time making a pretext of the guest-friendship of Histiaeus, made proposal to them thus : "I am not able to engage that I can supply you with sufficient force to bring you back from exile against the will of those Naxians who have control of the state ; for I hear that the Naxians have an army which is eight thousand shields strong and many ships of war ; but I will use every endeavor to devise a means ; and my plan is this : it chances that Artaphrenes ^ is my friend. Now Ar- taphrenes, ye must know, is a son of Hystaspes and brother of ' Why Darius summoned Histiaeus to Susa and kept him there in honorable cap- tivity is told by Herodotus v. 23 sq. 2 Artaphrenes, the correct spelling; Cauer, in Pauly-Wissowa, Red-Encycl. II. 1306; On this person, ib. 1037. 2. i64 GOVERNMENT AND POLITICAL CONDITIONS Darius the king ; and he is ruler of all the people of the sea-coasts in Asia, with a great army and many ships. This man, then, I think will do whatsoever we shall request of him." Hearing this, the Naxians gave over the matter to Aristagoras to manage as best he could, and they bade him promise gifts and the expenses of the ex- pedition, saying that they would pay them ; for they had full expecta- tion that when they should appear at Naxos, the Naxians would do all their bidding, and likewise all the other islanders. For of these islands — the Cyclades — not one was as yet subject to Darius. 31. Aristagoras, accordingly, having arrived at Sardis, said to Artaphrenes that Naxos was an island not indeed large in size, but fair nevertheless and of fertile soil, as well as near to Ionia, and that there were in it much wealth and many slaves : "Do thou therefore send an expedition against this land, and restore to it those who are now exiles from it ; and if thou shalt do this, first I have ready for thee large sums of money apart from the expenses incurred for the expedition (which it is fair that we who conduct it should supply), and next thou wilt gain for the king not only Naxos itself but also the islands which are dependent upon it, Paros and Andros and the others which are called Cyclades ; and setting out from these thou wilt easily attack Euboea, an island which is large and wealthy, as large indeed as Cyprus, and very easy to conquer. To subdue all these a hundred ships are sufficient." He made answer in these words: "Thou makest thyself a reporter of good things to the house of the king ; and in all these things thou advisest well, except as to the number of the ships ; for instead of one hundred there shall be prepared for thee two hundred by the beginning of spring. And it is right that the king himself also should join in approving this matter." 32. So Aristagoras hearing this went back to Miletus greatly rejoiced; and Artaphrenes meanwhile, when he had sent to Susa and commujiicated that which was said by Aristagoras, and Darius himself also had joined in approving it, made ready two hundred triremes and a very great multitude both of Persians and of their allies, and appointed to be commander of these Megabates a Per- sian, one of the Achaemenidae ' and a cousin to himself and to Darius, ' The royal famfly of Persia, to whom Darius belonged. For the principal members of this djmasty, see Pauly-Wissowa, RecU-Encycl. I. 200 sqq. ATTEMPT TO CONQUER NAXOS 165 to whose daughter afterward Pausanias the son of Cleombrotus the Lacedaemonian (at least if the story be true) betrothed himself, having formed a desire to become despot of Hellas. Having ap- pointed Megabates, I say, to be commander, Artaphrenes sent away the armament to Aristagoras. , 33. So when Megabates had taken up from Miletus Aristagoras and the Ionian force together with the Naxians, he sailed with the pretence of going to the Hellespont ; but when he came to Chios, he directed his ships to Caucasa, in order that he might from thence pass them over to Naxos with a North Wind. Then, since it was not fated that the Naxians should be destroyed by this expedition, there happened an event which I shall narrate. As Megabates was going round to visit the guards set in the several ships, it chanced that in a ship of Myndos there was no one on guard ; and he being very angry bade his spearsmen find out the commander of the ship, whose name was Scylax, and bind him in an oar-hole of his ship in such a manner that his head should be outside and his body within. When Scylax was thus bound, some one reported to Aristagoras that Megabates had bound his guest-friend of Myndos and was doing to him shameful outrage. He accordingly came and asked the Persian for his release, and as he did not obtain any- thing of that which he requested, he went himself and let him loose. Being informed of this, Megabates was exceedingly angry and broke out in rage against Aristagoras ; and he replied : "What hast thou to do with these matters ? Did not Artaphrenes send thee to obey me, and to sail whithersoever I should order? Why dost thou meddle with things which concern thee not?" Thus said Aris- tagoras ; and the other being enraged at this, when night came on sent men in a ship to Naxos to declare to the Naxians all the danger that threatened them. ! 34. For the Naxians were not at all expecting that this expedition would be against them ; but when they were informed of it, forth- with they brought within the wall the property which was in the fields, and provided for themselves food and drink as for a siege, and strengthened their wall. These then were making preparations as for war to come upon them ; and the others meanwhile having passed their ships over from Chios to Naxos, found them well defended when they made their attack, and besieged them for four . i66 GOVERNMENT AND POLITICAL CONDITIONS months. Then when the money which the Persians had brought with them had all been consumed by them, and not only that, but Aristagoras himself had spent much more in addition, and the siege demanded ever more and more, they built forts for the Naxian exiles and departed to the mainland again with ill success. 34. Proceedings of the Hellenic Congress of 481 b.c. (Herodotus vii. 145-162. Macaulay, revised by E. G. S.) This congress was called at the suggestion of Athens, but on the formal invitation of Lacedaemon, to meet at the shrine of Poseidon on the Isthmus of Corinth. It was composed of deputies from the loyal states of Hellas, and its object was to concert measures of defense against Xerxes, who was on the point of invading Greece. The nucleus of the Hellenic union thus forming was the Peloponnesian league, which had grown up in the preceding century. For sources illustrative of the latter institution, see Botsford, Source-Book of Ancient History, iig-21. The preceding selection and the one given below throw light upon the internal condition of the Greek states and their relation to one another at a time when they were facing the greatest crisis in their history. For a selection from iEschylus, Persians, describing the battle of Salamis, see Botsford, op. cit. 169-74. 145. When those Hellenes who had the better mind about Hellas came together to one place, and considered their affairs and interchanged assurances with one another, then deliberating to- gether they thought it well first of all things to reconcile the en- mities and bring to an end the wars which they Had with one another. Now there were wars engaged between others also, and especially between the Athenians and the ^ginetans. After this, being in- formed that Xerxes was with his army at Sardis, they determined to send spies to Asia to make observation of the power of the king ; and moreover they resolved to send envoys to Argos to form an alhance against the Persian, and to send others to Sicily to Gelon^ the son of Deinomenes and also to Corcyra, to urge them to come to the assistance of Hellas, and others again to Crete ; for they made it their aim that if possible the Hellenic race might unite in one, and that they might join all together and act toward the same end, ' Tyrant of Sjracuse. GREEK SPIES AT SARDIS 167 since dangers were threatening all the Hellenes equally. Now the power of Gelon was said to be great, far greater than any other Hellenic power. 146. When they had thus resolved, they reconciled their enmi- ties and then sent first three men as spies to Asia. These men, having come to Sardis and having got knowledge about the king's army, were discovered, and after having been examined by the generals of the land army were being led off to die. For these men, I say, death had been determined ; but Xerxes, being informed of this, found fault with the decision of the generals and sent some of the spearmen of his guard, enjoining them, if they should find the spies yet alive, to bring them to his presence. Therefore having found them yet surviving, they brought them into the presence of the king ; and upon that Xerxes, being informed for what purpose they had come, commanded the spearmen to lead them round and to show them the whole army both foot and horse, and when they should have had their fill of looking at these things, to let them go unhurt to whatsoever land they desired. 147. Such was the com- mand which he gave, adding at the same time this saying, namely that if the spies had been put to death, the Hellenes would not have been informed beforehand of his power, how far beyond description ; it was ; while on the other hand by putting to death three men they : would not very greatly have damaged the enemy ; but when these returned back to Hellas, he thought it likely that the Hellenes, hearing of his power, would deliver up their freedom to him them- selves, before the expedition took place which was being set in motion; and thus there would be no need for them to have the labor of marching an army against them. This opinion of his is like his manner of thinking at other times ; for when Xerxes was in Abydos, he saw vessels which carried corn from the Pontus sailing out through the Hellespont on their way to .^gina and the Peloponnese. Those then who sat by his side, being informed that the ships belonged to the enemy, were prepared to capture them, and were looking to the king to see when he would give the word ; but Xerxes asked about them whither the men were sailing, and they replied: "Master, to thy foes, conveying to them corn:" he then made answer and said : "Are we not also sailing to the same place as these men, furnished with corn as well as with other things nee- i68 GOVERNMENT AND POLITICAL CONDITIONS essary? How then do these wrong us, since they are conveying provisions for our use ? " 148. The spies then, having thus looked at everything and after that having been dismissed, returned back to Europe; and meanwhile those of the Hellenes who had sworn alliance against the Persian, after the sending forth of the spies proceeded to send envoys next to Argos. Now the Argives report that the matters concerning themselves took place as follows : They were informed, they say, at the very first of the movement which was being set on foot by the Barbarian against HeUas : and having been informed of this and perceiving that the Hellenes would endeavor to get their alliance against the Persian, they had sent messengers to inquire of the god at Delphi, and to ask how they should act in order that it might be best for themselves ; because lately there had been slain of them six thousand men by the Lacedaemonians and by Cleomenes^ the son of Anaxandrides, and this in fact was the reason that they were sending to inquire: and when they inquired, the Pythian prophetess made answer to them as follows : — "Thou to thy neighbors a foe, by the gods immortal beloved, Keep thou thy spear within bounds, and sit well-guarded behind it : Guard well the head, and the head shall preserve the limbs and the body." Thus, they say, the Pythian prpphetess had replied to them before this; and afterwards when the messengers of the Hellenes came, as I said, to Argos, they entered the council-chamber and spoke that which had been enjoined to them ; and to that which was said the council replied that the Argives were ready to do as they were requested, on condition that they got peace made with the Lacedaemonians for thirty years and that they had half the leadership of the whole confederacy : and yet by strict right (they said) the whole leadership fell to their share, but nevertheless it was sufficient for them to have half. 149. Thus they report that the council made answer, although the oracle forbade them to make the alliance with the Hellenes ; and they were anxious, they say, that a truce from hostilities for thirty years should be made, although they feared the oracle, in order, as they allege, that their sons might grow to manhood in these years ; whereas if a truce did not exist, * King of the Lacedsemoruans. ARGOS AND SICILY 169 they had fear that, supposing another disaster should come upon them in fighting against the Persian in addition to that which had befallen them already, they might be for all future time subject to the Lacedaemonians. To that which was spoken by the council those of the envoys who were of Sparta replied, that as to the truce they would refer the matter to their public assembly, but as to the leadership they had themselves been commissioned to make reply, and did in fact say this, namely that they had two kings, while the Argives had one ; and it was not possible to remove either of the two who were of Sparta from the leadership, but there was nothing to prevent the Argive king from having an equal vote with each of their two. Then, say the Argives, they could not endure the grasping selfishness of the Spartans, but chose to be ruled by the Barbarians rather than to yield at aU to the Lacedaemonians ; and they gave notice to the envoys to depart out of the territory of the Argives before sunset, or, if not, they would be dealt with as enemies. . . . 153. That which concerns the Argives has now been said. Mean- while envoys had come to Sicily from the allies, to confer with Gelon, among whom also was Syagrus from the Lacedaemonians. ... 157. . . . They came to speech with him and said as follows: "The Lacedaemonians and their allies sent us to get thee to be on our side against the Barbarian ; for we suppose that thou art certainly in- formed of him who is about to invade Hellas, namely that a Persian is designing to bridge over the Hellespont, and to make an expedi- tion against Hellas, leading against us out of Asia aU the armies of the East, under color of marching upon Athens, but in fact meaning to bring all Hellas to subjection under him. Do thou therefore, seeing that thou hast attained to a great power and hast no small portion of Hellas for thy share, being the ruler of Sicily, come to the assistance of those who are endeavoring to free Hellas, and join in making her free ; for if all Hellas be gathered together in one, it forms a great body, and we are made a match in fight for those who are coming against us ; but if some of us go over to the enemy, and others are not willing to help, and the sound portion of Hellas is consequently small, there is at once in this a danger that all Hellas may fall to ruin. For do not thou hope that if the Persian shall overcome us in battle he will not come to thee, but guard thyself I70 GOVERNMENT AND POLITICAL CONDITIONS against this beforehand ; for in coming to our assistance thou art helping thyself ; and the matter which is wisely planned has for the most part a good issue afterwards." 158. The envoys spoke thus ; but Gelon was very vehement with them, speaking to them as fol- lows : "Hellenes, a selfish speech is this, with which ye have ven- tured to come and invite me to be your ally against the Barbarian ; whereas ye yourselves, when I in former time requested of you to join me in fighting against an army of Barbarians,^ contention having arisen, between me and the Carthaginians, and when I charged you to exact vengeance of- the men of Egesta for the death of Dorieus the son of Anaxandrides, while at the same time I of- fered to help in setting free the trading-places, from which great advantages and gains have been reaped by you, — ye, I say, then neither for my own sake canie to my assistance, nor in order to exact vengeance for the death of Dorieus ; and so far as ye are con- cerned, all these parts are even now under the rule of the Barbarians. But since it turned out well for us and came to a better issue, now that the war has come round and reached you, there has at last arisen in your minds a recollection of Gelon, However, though I have met with contempt at your hands, I will not act like you ; but I am prepared to come to your assistance, supplying two himdred triremes and twenty thousand hoplites, with two thousand horse- men, two thousand bowmen, two thousand slingers and two thousand light-armed men to run beside the horsemen ; and moreover I will undertake to supply com for the whole army of the Hellenes, until we shall have finished the war. These things I engage to supply on this condition,, namely that I shall be commander and leader of the Hel- lenes against the Barbarians ; but on any other condition I will neither come myself nor will I send others." 159. Hearing this Syagrus could not contain himself but spoke these words : "Deeply, I trow, would Agamemnon son of Pelops lament, if he heard that the Spartans had had the leadership taken away from them by Gelon and by the Syra- cusans. Nay, but make thou no further mention of this condition, namely that we should deliver the leadership to thee ; but if thou art desirous to come to the assistance of Hellas, know that thou wilt be under the command of the Lacedaemonians ; and if thou dost 'The bistorian, who composed this speech, has confused the chionology: the Garthaginian invasion occurred in the following year, 480. RIVALS FOR LEADERSHIP 171 indeed claim not to be under command, come not thou to our help at all." 160. To this Galon, seeing that the speech of Syagrus was ad- verse, set forth to them his last proposal thus: "Stranger from Sparta, reproaches sinking into the heart of a man are wont to rouse his spirit in anger against them ; thou, however, though thou hast uttered insults against me in thy speech, wilt not bring me to show myself unseemly in my reply. But whereas ye so strongly lay claim to the leadership, it were fitting that I should lay claim to it more than ye, seeing that I am the leader of an army many times as large and of ships many more. Since however this condition is so distasteful to you, we will recede somewhat from our former pro- posal. Suppose that ye should be leaders of the land army and I of the fleet ; or if it pleases you to lead the sea forces, I am willing to be leader of those on land ; and either ye must be contented with these terms, or go away without the alliance which I have to give." 161. Gelon, I say, made these offers, and the envoy of the Athenians, answering before that of the Lacedaemonians, replied to him as follows : " king of the Syracusans, it was not of a leader that Hellas was in want when it sent us to thee, but of an army. Thou however dost not set before us the hope that thou wilt send an army, except thou have the leadership of Hellas ; and thou art striving how thou mayest become commander of the armies of Hellas. So long then as it was thy demand to be leader of the whole army of the Hellenes, it was sufficient for us Athenians to keep silence, knowing that the Lacedaemonian would be able to make defense even for us both; but now since being repulsed from the demand for the whole thou art requesting to be commander of the naval force, we teU thee that thus it is : — not even if the Lacedasmonian shall permit thee to be commander of it, will we permit thee ; for this at least is our own, if the Lacedaemonians themselves do not desire to have it. With these, if they desire to be the leaders, we do not contend ; but none others beside ourselves shall we periftit to be in command of the ships ; for then to no purpose should we be possessors of a sea force larger than any other which belongs to the Hellenes, if, being Athenians, we should yield the leadership to Syracusans, we who boast of a race which is the most ancient of all and who are. of all the Hellenes the only people who have not 172 GOVERNMENT AND POLITICAL CONDITIONS changed from one land to another ; to whom also belonged a man who Homer the Epic poet said was the best of all who came to lUon in drawing up an army and setting it in array. Thus we are not justly to be reproached if we say these things." 162. To this Gelon made answer thus : "Stranger of Athens, it would seem that ye have the commanders, but that ye will not have the men to be commanded. Since then ye will not at all give way, but desire to have the whole, it were well that ye should depart home as quickly as possible and report to the Hellenes that the spring has been taken out of their year." * Now this is the meaning of the saying : — evidently the spring is the noblest part of the year ; and so he meant to say that his army was the noblest part of the army of the Hellenes : for Hellas therefore, deprived of his alliance, it was, he said, as if the spring had been taken out of the year. BIBLIOGRAPHY I. LACEDiEUON. (1) Sources. — The sources for early Lacedaemon are relatively abtmdant. New light has been thrown on her civilization by the excavations of the English, see B. S. A., beginning with XI (1904-05). The seventh century is represented by Alcman and Tyrtaeus. A large part of Herodotus (see Index) is given to Lacedaemonian affairs. Xenophon, Cofir stitution of the Lacedcemonians, treats mainly of early conditions, as does also Plutarch, Lycurgus. (2) Modern Writers. — Botsford, Hellenic History, ch. vi ; Bury, ch. iii ; Greenidge, Gk. Const. Hist. ch. v ; Gilbert, Const. Antiq. 1-81 ; Abbott, I. chs. vi, viii ; Curtius, bk. 11. ch. i ; Grote, II. chs. vi, vii ; Busolt, Griech. Gesch. I. S10-611, 700-11. The following studies are more special: Niese, B., "Herodotstudien be- sonders zur spartanischen Geschichte," in Hermes, XLII (1907). 419-68; Decker, De, "La genese de I'organisation civique des, Spartiates," in Archiv sac. bull. no. 25 (Brussels, 1913). 306-13 ; Nilsson, M. P., "Die Grundlagen des spartanischen Lebens," in Klio, XII (1912). 308-40; Bolte, F., "Beitrage zur Topographic Lakoniens," in Ath. Mitt. XXXIV (1909). 376-92 ; Sihler, E. G., "Aristotle's Criticisms on the Spartan Constitution," in Class. Rev. VH (1893), 435-43 ; Niese, "Neue Beitrage zur Geschichte und Landeskunde Lakedamons," in Gott. Gesellsch. ( 1906) . pp. 101-42, very valuable ; Heidemann, L. , Die territoride Entwickelung Lakedaimons bis auf Alexander (Berlin, Diss.) ; Toynbee, A. J., "The Growth of Sparta," in /. H. S. XXXIII (1913). 246-75 ; Kuchtner, K., Entstehung und Urspriingliche Bedeutung des spartanischen Ephorats (Munich, ' The foregoing conversation, though a fiction, truly represents the Greek spirit. BIBLIOGRAPHY 173 1897); Jeanmaire, H., in Rev. des St. gr. XXVII. no. 117, on the crypteia; Girard, P., "Ciypteia," in Daremberg-Saglio, Diet. III. 871-3 ; Caillemer, E. ; •ycpouo-ta, ib. II. 1549; "Hjrpomeiones," ib. III. 350-2; "Homoioi," ib. III. 233-4; Lecrivain, C, "Helotse," ib. III. 67-71; Miller, J., "Gerontes, Gerusia," in Pauly-Wissowa, Real-Encyd. VTI. 1264-7 > Szanto, "Ephoroi," ib. V. 2860-4; Oehler, J., "Heloten," ib. 203-6; Schulthess, "Homoioi," ib. VIII. 2252-9 ; Solari, A., Ricerche spartane (Livorno, 1907), reprints of studies; Wide, S., Lakonische Ktdte (Leipzig, 1893) ; Droop, J. P., "Dates of the Vases called 'Cyrenaic,'" in /. H. S. XXX (1910). 1-34; Bethe, E., "Die dorische Knabenliebe," in Rkein. Mus. LXII (1907). 438-75; Semenov, A., same sub- ject, in Philol. LXX (191 1). 146-50. II. Athens, (i) Sources. — For Attica before the middle of the seventh century, no contemporary written material, excepting perhaps a list of annual officials, is know to have existed. The earliest known source is the Draconian code, a part of which has survived. On the conditions immediately following Draco the Poems of Solon throw a clear light. His Laws, too, including some which soon became obsolete, are known to us through later writers. From about 600, inscriptions begin to appear, though during the sixth century they remain scant. A considerable part of the History of Herodotus (c/. i. 59-64 ; V. 62-96, and see Index) is given to Athens ; then Thucydides i. 20 ; iii. 104 ; vi. 53-9. In the fourth century special histories of Attica, termed Atthides, began to appear ; the most important were thosg of Androtion and Philochorus. The former was the main source of Aristotle, Constitution of the Athenians, which traces the development of the constitution from the earliest times to 404-03, and describes in detail the government and administration during the writer's own time. From the History of Ephorus, also fourth century, Dio- dorus drew the greater part of his material on Athenian history. Later sources, though of great value, are Plutarch, Theseus; Solon; Aristeides; Themistocles ; Pausanias, bk. i. See also references to the scattered literature in the modern authorities on the subject. (2) Modern Writers. — Botsford, Hellenic History, ch. vii ; Bury, chs. iv, v ; Hokn, I. chs. xxvi, xxviii ; Curtius, bk. II. ch. ii (tyranny) ; Greenidge, Gk. Const. Hist. 124-62. More special are Gilbert, Const. Antiq. 95-153 ; Busolt, Griech. Gesch. II. 1-449, most thorough treatment ; Grote, III. chs. x, xi ; IV. xxx, xxxi ; Bots- ford, Ath. Const, chs. vii-xi ; Glotz, G., Etudes sociales et juridiques sur I'anti- quitl grecque (Paris, 1906) ; De Sanctis, G., Storia della repubblica ateniese (2d ed. Torino, 1912) ; Reinach, A., "Atthis, les origines de I'etat athdnien," in Reoue Synthese kistorique, XXIV (1912). 297-318; XXV. 1-25, 143-80; Ledl, A., Studien zur alter en athenischen Verfassungsgeschichte (Heidelberg: Winters, 1914) ; Wellmann, M., "Beitrage zur Geschichte der attischen Konigsliste," in Hermes, XLV (1910). 554-63 ; Wilbrandt, M., "Politische und sociale Bedeutung der attischen Geschlechter vor Solon," in Philol. supplb. VII (1899). 133-228; Szanto, E., "Die griechischen Phylen," in Ausgewdhlte Schriften (Tubingen, 1906). 216-88; Lezius, " GentUizische und lokale Phylen 174 GOVERNMENT AND POLITICAL CONDITIONS in Attika," in Philol. LXI (1907). 321-35 ; Bolkstein, H,, "Zur Entstehung der 'ionischen' Phylen," in Klio, XIII (1913). 424-50; Solmsen, F., NavKpapos, NavxAa/Dos, NauKAi/pos, in Rhein. Mus. LIII (1898). 151-8; Helbig, W., "Les vases du Dipylon et les naucraries," Acad, des inscr. XXXVI. i (1898). 387- 421: "Les iTTTreis atheniens," i6. XXXVII. i (1904). 157-264; Hofmann, J., Studien zur drakontischen Verfassung (Straubing, 1899); Ziehen, L., "Die drakontische Gesetzgebung," in Rhein. Mus. LIV (1899). 321-44; Hirzel, R., Themis, Dike und Verwandtes (Leipzig, 1907) ; Adcock, F. E., "Source of the Solonian Chapters of the Athenaion Politeia," in Klio, XII (191 2). 1-16; "Source of Plutarch, Solon, 20-24," in Class. Rev. XXVIII (1914). 38-40; GUliard, Quelques reformes de Solon (Lausanne, 1907) ; Viedebantt, O., "Met- rologische Beitrage, I, II," in Hermes, XL VII (191 2). 422 sq., 562 sq., includes Solon's coinage; Stern, E. v., "Solon und Peisistratos," in Hermes, LXVIII (1913). 426-41 ; Ure, "Origin of the Tyrannies," in /. H. S. XXVI (1906). 131-42; Milchhofer, A., " Untersuchungen iiber die Demenordnung des Kleis- thenes," Abhdl. Berl. Acad. (1892) ; "Zur attischen Lokalverfassung," in Aih. Mitt. XVIII (1893), 2'jT sqq.; SchoefEer, v., "A^/iot," in- Pauly-Wissowa, Real-Encycl. V. 1-131 ; Martin, A., Notes sur I'Ostracisme dans Athbnes (Paris, 1907) ; Carcopino, J., "Histoire de I'ostracisme ath6nien," in MUanges histoire ancienne (Paris, 1909). 85-266. Dorpfeld, W., "Alt-Athen zur KSnigszeit," in Philol. LXV (1906). 129-41 ; Drerup, E., "Beitrage zur Topographic von Alt-Athen," ib. LXIV (1905). 66-94; Milchhofer, A., "Athen und Thukydides II. 15," ib. 170-9; Gfaber, F., "Die Enneakrunos," in Ath. Mitt. XXX (1905). 1-64, the water-system; Schrader, H., Auswahl archaischer Marmorskulpturen im Akropolis Museum; Frickenhaus, A., "Das Athenabild des alten Tempels in Athen," in Ath. Mitt. XXXIII (1908). 17-32; "Erechtheus," ib. 171-6. III. The Ionic Revolt and the Great War with Persia and Car- thage, (i) Sources. — Besides memorial inscriptions the only contemporary lit- erary source is iEschylus, Persians. With book iv Herodotus, in narrating the " Scythian expedition " of Darius, begins his account of the great conflict between the Orient and Hellas, which continues through the remainder of his history. Scattered through all subsequent literature of the ancients are passages of varying length and reliability relating to the same period. (2) Modern Writers. — Botsford, Hellenic History, chs. x, xi ; Bury, His- tory of Greece, vi, vii ; Holm, I. ch. xxiii ; II. chs. i-vi ; Abbott, 11. i-v, xii ; Grote, IV. chs. xxxii-xxxv, xxxviii-xliii ; Freeman, History of Sicily, II. chs. v, vi ; Grundy, G. B., Great Persian War (Scribner, 1901) ; Hall, H. R., Ancient History of the Near East (Methuen, 1913), ch. xii. Beloch, Griech. Gesch. II. 1-74 ; Busolt, Griech. Gesch. II. 450-806 ; Meyer, Gesch. d. Alt. III. 3-484. CHAPTER V ECONOMY AND SOCIETY During the period 750-479 B.C. The only contemporary sources for this subject are the poets (see p. 7 sgq.). The character of the extant fragments of their poems is such as to make a topical arrangement impracticable. In most cases, therefore, the poet's name is given as the heading. A few passages from prose writers of a later date are also included. 35. A Prototype of the Malthusian Theory {Cypria, opening lines ; from Lawton, Successors of Homer, 16 sq.) Once on a time was Earth by the races of men made weary, Who were wandering numberless over the breadth of her bosom. Zeus with pity beheld it, and took in his wise heart counsel How to relieve of her burden the Earth, life-giver to all things, Fanning to flame that terrible struggle, the war upon Troia. So should the burden by death be removed : and they in the Troad Perished — the heroes ; the counsel of Zeus was brought to ful- filment. 36. The Captive Wroow and her Young Son {Little Iliad; from Lawton, op. cit. 32) Then the illustrious son ^ of the noble-hearted Achilles Down to the hollowed vessels the widow of Hector conducted. As for the child, from the breast of the fair-tressed servant he tore him, Grasped by the feet, and hurled him down from the tower ; and upon him Crunson death as he fell laid hold — and a destiny ruthless. 'Neoptolemus. The widow of Hector is Andromache, and her son is Asty- anax. 17s 176 ECONOMY AND SOCIETY 37. The Festival to Apollo at Delos (Homeric Hymn to the Delian Apollo, 140-64) But thyself, O Prince of the Silver Bow, far-darting Apollo, didst now pass over rocky Cynthus, now wandering among temples and men. Many are thy fanes and groves, and dear are all the head- lands, and high peaks of lofty hills, and rivers flowing onward to the sea ; but with Delos, Phoebus, art thou most delighted at heart, where the long-robed lonians gather in thine honor, with children and chaste dames. Mindful of thee, they delight thee with boxing and dances and minstrelsy in their games. Whoso then encoun- tered them at the gathering of the lonians, would say that they are exempt from eld and death, beholding them so gracious, and would be glad at heart, looking on the men and fair-girdled women and their much wealth and their swift galleys. Moreover, there is this great marvel of renown imperishable, the Delian damsels, hand- maidens of the far-darter. They, when first they have hymned Apollo and next Leto and Artemis the Archer, then sing in memory of the men and women of old time, enchanting the tribes of mortals. They are skilled, too, to mimic the notes and dance music of all men, so that each would say himself were singing, so well woven is their fair chant. 38. The Five Races (Hesiod, Works and Days, 109-201. All the selections from Hesiod are from Mair's translation, revised on the basis of the Greek text by E. G. S.) First of aU, a golden race of mortal men did the Immortal Dwellers in Olympus fashion. These Uved in the time of Cronos when he was king in Heaven. Like gods they hved, having a soul unknowing sorrow, apart from toil and travail. Neither were they subject to miserable eld, but ever the same in hand and foot, they took their pleasure in festival apart from all evil. And they died as overcome of sleep. All good things were theirs. The bounteous earth bare fruit for them of their own will, in plenty and without stint. And they in peace and quiet Uved on their lands with many good things, rich in flocks and dear to the blessed gods. But since this race was hidden in the earth, Spirits they are by the will of DECLINE OF MAN 177 mighty Zeus : good Spirits, on earth, keepers of mortal men : who watch over dooms and the sinful works of men, faring everywhere over the earth, cloaked in mist : givers of wealth. Even this kingly privilege they received. Then next the Dwellers in Olympus created a far inferior race, a race of silver, nowise like to the golden race in body or in mind. For a hundred years the child grew up by his good mother's side, plajdng, in utter childishness within his home. But when he grew to manhood and came to the fuU measure of age, for but a little space they lived and in sorrow by reason of their foolishness. For they could not keep heinous insolence from the other, neither would they worship the deathless gods, nor do sacrifice on the holy altars of the Blessed Ones, as is the manner of men wheresoever they dwell. Wherefore Zeus in anger put them away, because they gave not honor to the blessed gods who dwell in Olympus. Now since this race too was hidden in earth, they are called the blessed mortals under ground : of lower rank, yet they too have their honor. Then Zeus the Father created a third race of mortal men, a race of bronze, not resembling the silver race, terrible and strong from their ashen spears : whose delight was in the dolorous works of Ares and in insolence. Bread they ate not ; but souls they had stubborn of adamant, unapproachable : great was their might and invincible the arms and hands that grew from their shoulders on stout frames. Of bronze was their armor, of bronze their dwellings, with bronze they wrought. Black iron was not yet. These by their own hands slain went down to the dank house of chill Hades, nameless. And black Death slew them, for all that they were mighty, and they left the bright light of the sun. Now when this race also was hidden in earth, yet a fourth race did Zeus the Son of Cronos create upon the bounteous earth, a juster race and better, a godlike race of hero men who are called demigods, the earlier race upon the boundless earth. And them did evil war and dread battle slay, some at seven-gated Thebes, the land of Cadmus, fighting for the flocks of Oidipod6s : some.when war had brought them in ships across the great gulf of the sea to Troy for the sake of fair-tressed Helen. There did the issue of death cover them about. But Zeus the Father, the Son of Cronos, gave them a life and an abode apart from men, and estabhshed them at the ends 178 ECONOMY AND SOCIETY of the earth afar from the deathless gods : among them is Cronos king. And they with soul untouched of sorrow dwell in the Islands of the Blest by deep eddying Oceanos : happy heroes, for whom the bounteous earth beareth honey-sweet fruit fresh thrice a year. I would then that I lived not among the fifth race of men, but either had died before or had been bom afterward. For now verily is a race of iron. Neither by day shall they ever cease from toil and woe, neither in the night from wasting, and sore cares shall the gods give them. Howbeit even for them shall good be mingled with evil. But this race also of mortal men shall Zeus destroy when they shall have hoary temples at their birth. Father shall not be like to his children, neither the children like unto the father : neither shall guest to host, nor friend to friend, nor brother to brother be dear as aforetime: and they shall give no honor to their swiftly ageing parents, and shall chide them with words of bitter speech, sinful men, knowing not the fear of the gods. These will not re- turn to their aged parents the price of their nurture: but might shall be right, and one shall sack the other's city. Neither shall there be any respect of the oath abiding or of the just or of the good : rather shaU they honor the doer of evil and the man of insolence. Right shall lie in might of hand, and Reverence shall be no more : the bad shall wrong the better man, accosting him with crooked words and abetting them with an oath. Envy, brawling, rejoicing in evil, of hateful countenance, shall follow all men to their sorrow. Then verily shall Reverence and Retribution veil their fair bodies in white robes and depart from the wide-wayed earth unto Oljonpus to join the company of the Immortals, forsaking men : but for men that die shall remain but miserable woes : and against evil there shall be no avail. 39. Righteousness and Justice (Hesiod, Works and Days, 202-69) Now will I tell a tale to princes though they themselves are wise. Thus spake the hawk to the nightingale of speckled neck, as he bore her far aloft to the clouds in the clutch of his talons, while she, on his crooked talons impaled, made pitiful lament : unto her he spake masterfully: 'Wretch! wherefore dost thou shriek? Lo ! thou RIGHTEOUSNESS AND JUSTICE 179 art held in the grasp of a stronger. There shalt thou go, even where I carry thee, for all thy minstrelsy. And as I will, I shall make my meal of thee, or let thee go. A fool is he who would con- tend with the stronger. He loseth the victory and sufEereth an- guish with his shame.' So spake the swift-flying hawk, the long- winged bird. . . . Whoso to stranger and to townsman deal straight judgments, and no whit depart from justice, their city flourisheth and the people prosper therein. And there is in their land peace, that reareth the young, and Zeus doth never decree troublous war for them. Neither doth Famine ever consort with men who deal straight judgments, nor Doom : but with mirth they tend the works that are their care. For them earth beareth much livehhood, and on the hills the oak's top beareth acorns, the oak's midst bees : their fleecy sheep are heavy with wool : their wives bear children hke unto their fathers : they flourish with good things continually, neither go they on ships, but bounteous earth beareth fruit for them. But whoso pursue evil insolence, and froward works, for them doth Zeus of the far- seeing eyes, the Son of Cronos, decree justice. Yea, oftentimes a whole city reapeith the recompense of the evil man who sinneth and worketh the works of foolishness. On them doth the Son of Cronos bring from Heaven a grievous visitation, even famine and plague together, and the people perish. Their women bear not children : their houses decay by devising of Olympian Zeus : or anon He destroyeth a great host of them within a waU it may be, or the Son of Cronos taketh vengeance on their ships in the sea. Princes, do ye too consider this vengeance. For the Im- mortals are nigh among men and remark them that with crooked judgments oppress one another, taking no heed of the anger of the gods. Yea, thrice ten thousand Immortals are there on the boun- teous earth, who keep watch over mortal men : who watch over judgments and froward works, clad in mist, faring everywhere over the earth. Also there is the maiden Justice, the daughter of Zeus, glorious and worshipful among the gods who hold Olympus. And whenever one injureth her with crooked reviling, straightway she sitteth by Zeus the Father the Son of Cronos, and telleth of the unrighteous mind of men, till the people pay for the folly of their kings, who with ill thoughts wrest aside judgments, declaring falsely. i8o ECONOMY AND SOCIETY Beware of these things, Kings, and set Straight your speech, bribe-devourers, and utterly forget crooked judgments. He de- viseth evil for himself who deviseth evil for another, and the evil counsel is worst for him that counseUeth. The eye of Zeus, that seeth all things and remarketh all, beholdeth these things too, and He will, and He f aileth not to notice what manner of justice this is that our city holdeth. ... 40. Rural Economy (Hesiod, Works and Days, 405-705) Get a house first and a woman and a plowing ox ^ — a slave woman — not a wife — who might also follow the oxen : and get all gear arrayed within the house, lest thou beg of another and he deny thee and thou go lacking, and the' season pass by, and thy work be minished. Neither put off till the morrow nor the day after. The idle man fiUeth not his bam, neither he that putteth off. Dili- gence prospereth work, but the man who putteth off ever wrestleth with ruin. What time th'e might of the keen sun abateth sweltering heat, when Zeus Almighty raineth in the autumn and the flesh of men turneth lighter far — for then the star Sirius goeth over the heads of men" born to death but for a brief space in the daytime, and taketh a greater space of the night — then is wood cut with iron axe less hable to be wormeaten, but sheddeth its leaves to earth and ceaseth to sprout. Then be thou mindful to cut wood : a sea- sonable work. Three foot cut thy mortar, a pestle of three cubits an axle of seven feet : so will it be right meet. Howbeit if thou cut it of eight feet, thou canst cut therefrom a mallet. Three spans cut thou the felloe for a wagon of ten pahns. Cut therewithal many bent planks. And bring thou home a plowbeam, when thou findest it by search on hill or field — of holm oak : For this is the strongest to plow with, when Athene's servant fasteneth it in the share beam and fixeth it with dowels to the pole. Get thee two plows, fashioning them at home, one of the natural wood, the other jointed, since it is far better to do so. So if thou break the one, 1 These directions evidently are for the farmer of small means. Soon, however, and without notice, he takes in mind the lord of a considerable estate. DIRECTIONS FOR FARMING i8i thou canst yoke the oxen to the other. Freest of worms are poles of bay or elm. Get thee then sharebeam of oak, plowbeam of holm, and two oxen, bulls of nine years. For the strength of such is not weak, in the fulness of their age : they are best for work. They will not quarrel in the furrow and break the plow, and leave their work undone. And with them let a man of forty follow, his dinner a loaf of four quarters, eight pieces, who will mind his work and drive a straight furrow, no more gaping after his fellows, but having his heart in his work. Than he no younger man is better at sowing. For the mind of a younger man is fluttered after his age-fellows. Take heed what time thou hearest the voice of the crane from the high clouds uttering her yearly cry, which bringeth the sign for plowing and showeth forth the season of rainy winter, and biteth the heart of him that hath no oxen. Then feed thou the oxen of crooked horn in their stalls. For an easy thing it is to say, Give me a team of oxen, and a wagon; but easy also is it to refuse: Mine oxen have work to do. The man whose wealth is in his im- agining Saith he will build a wagon. Fool ! who knoweth not that a wagon hath a hundred pieces of wood? Whereof take thou thought beforehand to lay them up at home. And when first plow- ing appeareth for men, then haste thyself and thy thralls in wet and dry to plow in the season of sowing, hasting in the early mom that so thy fields may be full. Plow in spring, but the field that is fallowed in summer will not belie thee. Sow the fallow field while yet the soil is Ught. Fallow land is a defender of doom, a com- forter of children. And pray thou unto Zeus the Lord of Earth and unto pure Demeter that the holy grain of Demeter may be full and heavy : thus pray thou when first thou dost begin thy plowing, when grasp- ing in thy hand the end of the stilt-handle thou comest down on the backs of the oxen as they draw the pole by the yoke collar. And let a young slave follow behind with a mattock and cause trouble to the birds by covering up the seed. For good husbandry is best for mortal men and bad husbandry is worst. So will the grain ears nod with ripeness to the ground, if the Lord of Olympus himself vouchsafe a good issue. So shalt thou drive the spider's web from thy vessels and I have hope that thou wilt rejoice as thou takest of thy store of livelihood. And in good case thou shalt come i82 ECONOMY AND SOCIETY to grey spring and shalt not look to others, but another shall have need of thee. But if at the turning of the sun thou dost plow the goodly earth, sitting shalt thou reap, grasping a little in thy hand, binding it contrariwise, covered with dust, no way rejoicing. And in a basket shalt thou bring it home, and few there be that shall admire thee. Otherwise at other times is the will of Zeus the Lord of the .(Egis and hard for mortal men to know. But if thou plowest late, this shaU be a charm for thee. When first the cuckoo uttereth his note amid the leaves of the oak and rejoiceth men over the limitless earth, then may Zeus rain on the third day and cease not, neither overpassing the hoof ^ of an ox nor falling short thereof : so shall the late plower vie with the early. Keep thou all things well in mind nor fail to mark either the coming of grey spring or seasonable rain. But pass by the smith's forge and crowded assembly place ^ in the winter season when cold constraineth men from work, wherein a diligent man would greatly prosper his house, lest the helplessness of evil winter overtake thee with poverty and thou press a swollen foot with lean hand. But the idle man who waiteth on empty hope, for lack of livelihood garnereth many sorrows for his soul. Hope is a poor companion for a man in need, who sitteth in an as- sembly place of men when he hath no livelihood secured. Nay, declare thou to thy thralls while it is still midsummer : It will not be summer always ; build ye barns. But the month Lenaion,' evil days, cattle-flaying every one, do thou shun, and the frosts that appear for men's sorrow over the earth at the breath of Boreas, which over Thrace the nurse of horses bloweth on the wide sea and stirreth it up : and earth and wood bellow aloud. Many an oak of lofty foliage and many a stout pine in the mountain glens doth his onset bring low to the bounteous earth, and aU the unnumbered forest crieth aloud, and wild beasts shudder and set their tails between their legs, even they whose hide is covered with fur. Yea, even through these, shaggy-breasted though they be, he bloweth with chill breath. Through the hide of the ox he bloweth, and it stayeth him not, and through the thin- ' I.e., filling the cavity in the soil made by the imprint of a hoof. ' Meeting place of a club. ' December-January. MARRIAGE; LUCKY DAYS 183 haired goat : but nowise through the sheep doth the might of the wind Boreas blow, because of their year's growth of wool. But it maketh the old man trip along. Through the delicate maiden it bloweth not, who within the house abideth by her dear mother's side, not yet knowing the works of golden Aphrodite : when she hath bathed her tender body and anointed her with olive oil and lieth down at night within the house, on a winter day, when the Boneless One ' gnaweth his own foot within his fireless house and cheerless home. In the flower of thine age lead thou home thy bride, when thou art not far short of thirty years nor far over. This is the timely marriage. Four years past maturity be the woman : let her marry in the fifth. Marry a maiden that thou mayest teach her good ways. Marry a neighbor best of all, with care and circumspection, lest thy marriage be a joy to thy neighbors. For no better spoil doth a man win than a good wife, even as than a bad wife he win- neth no worse — a gluttonous woman, that roasteth her husband without a brand, and giveth him over to untimely age. 41. Items from a Farmer's Calendar (Hesiod, Works and Days, 793-828) On the great twentieth * at full day ' should a wise man be bom. Verily such a one shall be of discreet mind. The tenth day is a good day for the birth of males, the middle fourth for the birth of a girl. On that day tame thou by touch of hand sheep and horned trailing kine and sharp-toothed dog and sturdy mules. But beware in thy heart that griefs assail thee not on the fourth, whether of the waning or the waxing month. It is a very fateful day. On the fourth of the month lead home thy bride, distinguishing the birds that are best for this business. The fifth days avoid since they are hard and dread. On the fifth day they say the Erinyes attended the birth of Horcos, whom Eris bare to be the bane of men that swear falsely. ' A mollusk. 2 The twentieth of that month in which is the longest day of the year ; Flach's note. ' The Romans, too, considered a birth in the daytune as of better omen, hence the frequency of their praenomen Lucius. i84 ECONOMY AND SOCIETY On the middle seventh circumspectly cast the grain of Demeter on the rounded threshing-floor. And let the woodman cut wood for the house, and much timber for ship-building, even such timber as is meet for ships. On the fourth day begin the building of slender ships. The middle ninth is a better day toward afternoon. The first ninth is utterly harmless for men. A good day is this to beget or to be born, whether for man or woman : and it is never a day of evil. Few men, however, know that the twenty-seventh is best to broach the jar and to set the yoke on necks of oxen and of mules and swift-footed horses, and to draw down to the wine-dark sea the swift ship many-benched. Few men call it truly. On the fourth day open the jar. The middle fourth is above all a holy day. Few again know that the fourth which followeth the twentieth of the month is the best at dawn, but it is worse toward afternoon. These days are a great boon to men on earth. But the others are shifty and fateless, and bring naught. Another praiseth another day but few men know. Anon a day is a stepmother, anon a mother. Therein happy and blessed is he who, knowing all these things, worketh his work blameless before the deathless gods. 42. Tyrt^tjs For a translation of the only extant poem, substantially complete, of Callinus, see Botsford, Source-Book of Ancient History, 141. For a translation of a fragment of Tyrtaeus not given here, op. cit. 141-3. (The fragments given below are from the Eunomia, "Good Government." The nimibers are those of Bergk, Anthologia Lyrica. Translated by E. G. S.) Aristotle, Politics, v. 6. 2: "In the aristocratic governments risings occur . . . further, whenever one class is excessively resourceless, and the others are well off, and especially does this happen in wars. And this came to pass also in Lacedaemon at the time of the Messenian war. It is also evident from the verse of Tyrtseus, the so-called Eunomia ; for some, being hard-pressed on ac- count of the war, demanded that the land be divided afresh." Pattsanias iv. 18. i: "The Lacedsemonians made a decree, since they were tilling the soil more for those in Eira (a fortress held by the Messenians) than for themselves, that Messenia and the contiguous strip of Laconia, while they were engaged in war, should be left unseeded. And from this resulted a scarcity of grain in Sparta, and with the scarcity of grain a civD disturbance : for those who had their possessions there would not endure it that their own should be untilled : and for these Tyrtsus solved their differences." SPARTA 185 2. For Cronion himself, the spouse of fair- wreathed Hera, Zeus, gave this commonwealth to the scions of Heracles, With whom, forsaking windy Erineos, we arrived in the Broad Isle of Pelops.' 3. Greed for money will undo Sparta and nothing else ; ^ For thus he with the silver bow, the far-working lord Apollo, He of the Golden locks, gave oracle from his rich shrine. 4. Having listened to Phoebus, they bore from Delphi home The oracles of the god and consummating words : That god-honored kings should be rulers of counsel Whose concern is the winsome commonwealth of Sparta, And aged elders ; and then men of the people In full harmony with straightforward sentences Should utter what is fair and nought but justice do,. Nor counsel for this town [unseemly things] . . . And for the commons' multitude should victory and power ensue : For thus did Phoebus reveal for the commonwealth about these things ' 5. To our king Theopompus, beloved of the gods. On whose account we captured broad Messenfe, Messene good to plow and good to plant ; For it they fought full nineteen years, Ceaselessly ever, possessing enduring spirit. Men of the lance, the sires of our sires ; And in the twentieth year the one party did leave their fertile fields. And fled from the great mountains of IthomS.^ 'This is the earliest reference to the "Dorian migration." Erineos is a town in Doris, from which according to the view here presented the "scions o£ Heracles" with their followers migrated to Peloponnese. ' From this statement and from other evidence it is clear that the social conditions at Sparta in the seventh century were quite different from those of the fifth and fourth centuries; cf. Botsford, Hellenic History, chs. vi, xxi. ' In this stanza the poet declares that the organization of the Lacedaemonian govern- ment into kings, elders, and assembly of citizens, with their several f imctions, is a divine dispensatidn, the revelation of Apollo. On this ground it is the religious duty of every one to attend to his appointed function. * The first Messenian war, here briefly described, was waged about 700 B.C. ; Busolt, Griech. Gesch. t. 589 sq. According to the text the object of the Spartans was conquest. The two remaining stanzas, 6 and 7, describe the condition of the subject Messenians. i86 ECONOMY AND SOCIETY 6. Like asses ground by heavy burdens, Bringing to their masters from grievous necessity One half of all the product that the soil doth bear, 7. Lamenting their masters, both wives and themselves, Whenever the pernicious lot of death overtakes one. 43. Alcman {Parthenion, "Girls' Choral Song," 4. 36 sqq. Translated by E. G. S.) On Alcman and the importance of his poetry, see p. 12. 4. From the gods is vengeance ; but he is happy who cheerily weaves the web of his days unweeping. I sing the light of Agido ; I see her like the sun, which Agido attests is shining for us. As for myself, may the illustrious maiden-leader of the choir not let me be either praised or blamed at all.^ For she seems to be distin- guished for her comeliness in such a manner, as though one were to place among the grazing cattle a steed compactly made, that won the prizes with ringing hoof, (a creature) of winged dreams. 5. Indeed, seest thou not? The swift steed is an Enetan;* and the streaming tresses of my maiden-cousin grace her like gold unalloyed ; silver-like her countenance : frankly what shall I tell you? Agesichora is she. But she who is second after Agido in form, will run as a steed from Scythia to the Eibeni.* For the stars of the Pleiades struggle with us as we are bearing a mantle to Artemis, rising during the ambrosial night like Sirius. 6. For neither is there so great a satiety of purple as to ward off (our competitors), nor serpent-shaped variegated (bracelet), lior Lydian head-band, adornment of maidens with long eyelashes,* nor the tresses of Nanno, but not even divine Areta, nor Sylacis and Cleesisera ; nor will you come into the chorus of /Enesimbrota and say: "Would that Astaphis were mine! and would that Philylla ' Evidently Alcman is the trainer of the chorus for whom he is writing this ode. 'The Eneti were a people of Paphlagonia; Pauly-Wissowa, Real-Encyd. V. 2562. Hence the horse is supposed to have come from that country. 'The word Kolaxaios signifies "Scythian" (Hdt. iv. 5). The Eibeni were a race in Lydia that bred horses, Greek forerunners perhaps of the lonians — the lonitae ; cf. Stephanus of Byzantium, s.v. * If the text is correct, it means eyelashes like a garment, veiUng the eye. A SOLDIER OF FORTUNE 187 direct her glance toward me!" But Agesichora keeps me safe."^ . . . 44. Archilochus (Translated by E. G. S.) 3. In my lance is kneaded bread; in my lance is wine of Ismarus ; and I drink while leaning on my lance.^ 5. But come, with earthen drinking-vessel through the rowers' seats of the swift ship ' wend thou thy way, and puU the lids from hollow jars, and gather red wine from the must : for not even we will be able to be sober on this watch. 6. My shield is now the boast of some Saian, (my shield) which by a thicket imscathed I forsook against my will ; but I myself escaped death's consummation. As for that shield, good riddance ! another time I shaU acquire one that will not be worse.* 9. Groanful troubles lamenting, O Pericles,* neither will any one of the citizens nor the city itself rejoice in feasts ; such men the' wave of the loud-roaring sea washes aiyay, and our hearts are swollen with grief. But for incurable ills, the gods, my friend, have set endurance as the mighty remedy : sometimes this one, some- 'times that one has the aflSiction ; but now it has turned to us, and we lament a bleeding wound. Another time to others it will turn ; but forthwith bear up, thrusting from you womanish sorrowing sore. 20. This (island) ® like a donkey's spine doth stand ; covered 'Agido and Agesichora, daughters of the king, are leaders of the chorus for whom Alcman writes. Stanzas 4 and S sing their praises. St^za 6 describes the competing chorus: Agesichora alone saves us from defeat at its hands! On the poem in general, see Diels, H., "Alkmans Partheneion," in Hermes, XXXI (1896) 339-74- ' This verse is a drastic expression of his mercenary life. ' He is serving on shipboard ; perhaps he is now a pirate, as when he says : "There were seven dead men trampled under foot and we were a thousand murderers ; " Murray. * Here he boasts of having thrown away his shield — a soldier's most disgraceful act. ^This stanza is addressed to Pericles on the death of friends by shipwreck; it illustrates the character of a man subject indeed to great griefs, but whose courageous spirit forthwith rallies from despondency. • The island is Thasos, to which he had gone as a colonist in quest of gold. He con- trasts the island with charming Italy in the neighborhood of Sybaris. i88 ECONOMY AND SOCIETY with savage forests ; for there is no fair spot nor a lovely one, nor charming such as is about the currents of the Siris stream. 24. For Gyges ' care I not, the one so rich in gold, nor ever did envy possess me, nor do I look with jealousy upon the works of gods ; of mighty princely power I shall not speak : for it is far away from, mine eyes. 56. Glaucus, look ! for now the deep is troubled by the waves, and about the heights of Gyros stands a towering cloud, a sign of storm: from lack of hope doth fear come over me. 58. Leave all things to the gods : ofttimes from evils they lift men up that lie upon the black soil, and ofttimes do they overturn them, even when they stand firmly, and lay them on their backs ; then many troubles come ; and in quest of life he wanders, and his mind is overturned. 45. Semonides (Smonides) of Amorgos (Translated by E. G. S.) In way diverse did God fashion woman's mind At first ; one out of the long-bristled swine, In whose abode all is upside down in mire, And lies in foul disorder, rolls along the ground, Herself unwashed, her garments unlaundered She sits mid filth and groweth fat. Another woman God created from the wicked fox, Of all aknowing ; of evil nothing Nor of better things doth aught escape her mind ; And some of this she often calleth bad, Another, excellent : her wrath is ever so or so. Another from the dog, of speedy gait, her mother's other self. Set all to hear and all to know Agazing everywhere and roving so, She screams, though she sees no mortal soul. Not even though he threatened could her husband make her stop, ' Gyges was king of Lydia about this time. The poem is the expression of modera- tion in desires. TYPES OF WOMEN 189 Not even if in angry fit he'd break her teeth with a stone Nor even if to gentle speech resorteth he Nor either if 'mid guest-friends she should chance to sit, But firmly does she hold her ineffectual scream. Another the Olympians shaped of earth And then bestowed on man — half-witted she Nor evil nor the good such woman knows ; Of works she only knows how to eat ; Not even when God an evil tempest makes, Though shivering will she draw her chair closer to the fire. Another from the sea, which has but two-fold thought ; One day she laughs and blithesome is ; The guest within the house who sees her will commend : No other woman better than this one In all mankind nor fairer is to see. Another day she is insufferable, to see her with one's eyes Or to approach her, but she rages then _ Without measure, like bitch for pups concerned, Ungentle she to all, repelling them. To foes and friends alike demeans herself Just as the sea without a quiver often Stands propitious, a great joy to seafaring men In Summer's season, but oftentimes does rage. With heavy beating billows moving on ; To such, a woman of such kind resembles. Another from the ashen-colored and much beaten ass, Which whether by constraint or by the urging call Is satisfied to do all her toilsome task. With full complacence : meanwhile she munches in a comer All night, all day, she eateth by the hearth. . . . Another one a dainty steed with flowing mane produced. Who turns aside from servile work and toil. A gristmill she'd not touch nor sieve Would lift, nor dirt throw from the house. Nor sit by the fire, keeping from the soot : I90 ECONOMY AND SOCIETY It is by sheer constraint she wins her husband's friendship. On every day she washes off each spot Twice, sometimes thrice ; with ointments fragrant is : And always wears her manelike tresses combed Deep ; with blossoms shades she them. A comely thing to see is such a wife For others, but to him who weds her proves an ill, Unless he be a prince or sceptered sovereign. Who with such things his fancy doth adorn. Another from the ape : this decidedly Zeus Did bestow on husbands as the greatest evil. Most ugly is her face ; a woman such as she Goes through the town, all mankind laughs at her. Thickest in neck, she barely plies her limbs. No curving hips, of withered limbs : O wretched goodman he Who does embrace such evil thing ; All counsels and the ways of people does she know. Just like a monkey, ridicule concerns her not. Nor would she do a goodly tmrn to anyone, but this she sees And this all day long doth she plot and plan, To work the greatest evil in her might. The other from the bee ; fortunate he who gets her : For she alone to censure furnishes no occasion, But by her Ufe doth bloom and doth increase ; Dear to her loving spouse she groweth old. Often hath she given birth to children fair and famed. Distinguished is she among the women all — A grace divine doth play about her form. Nor does she pleasure take to sit among the women, Where they do hold converse of scandals bold. Such are the wives which Zeus doth grant to men A boon of grace, the best there are, the wisest of the sex. For Zeus did make this greatest evil. The woman ; for even if tjiey seem to furnish usefulness, To him who weds them most they prove a bane. JOYS ARE FEW AND FLEETING 191 For never he with cheerful spirit passes through a day Complete, who with a woman is. . . . And when the husband most does seem to please his mood At home abiding, be it fate divine or kindliness of man, She finds some word of censure, helms herself to fight. For where a woman is, not even into the home With wiUing mind (the husband) would receive a stranger Who arrives. ... 46. MiMNERMXrS (Translated by E. G. S.) 1. What living is there and what charm without golden Aphrodite ? I would be dead, when no more these things were my concern. . . . If youth's blossoms may be plucked For men and for women ; but when there comes on Lamentable age, which renders ugly even the comely man. Ever his mind is ground by evil cares about. Nor does he rejoice in gazing at beams of the sim, But he is hateful to boys, unhonored by women, So grievous has God rendered old age. 2. Our growth is hke the leaves in the season of much-blossoming Spring ; when swiftly they do increase in the beams of the sun. Like unto these, for a mere ell of time youth's blossoms Do we enjoy, from gods knowing nor evil Nor good. The murky Fates stand by our side. This one holding goal of troublesome old age, And the other, of death ; slender the measure of the Harvest of youth; as far as the sun sheds his light on the earth. But when this consummation of bloom has passed, S.raightway to die is better than living; For many evils ensue in the spirit ; one time one's house Is ruined, lamentable are the works of poverty ; Another again lacks children, yearning chiefly for whom He passes under the earth to Hades' realm ; Another has a disease that consumes his spirit, nor is there Any of men to whom Zeus gives not evils abundant. 192 ECONOMY AND SOCIETY 14. Not his courage ^ and spirit heroic, such as I learn from my fathers, who saw him driving before him the hnes of the Lydians fighting on steeds, all through the Hermian plain, wight with ashen spear, — by no means his spirit did censure Pallas Athene ; pierc- ing was his hearty courage, when he among the fore-fighters would saUy, in the onset of bloody war, bitterly beset by the missiles of f oemen ; for not any wight 'mong the enemies was better then he, to advance into the performance of the mighty din of battle, when it was borne along in the beams of the swift sun-god. 47. Alc^us There was fierce strife between the nobles and the democracy. The people were led by demagogues, who, Alcaeus protested, were aiming to make them- selves tyrants. Chief among them was Myrsilus. Alcaeus, the inspiring genius of the aristocratic faction, inveighed against Myrsilus in the following well known lines : — This man, this raving idiot here, With rank supreme and power great, Will quickly overthrow the state ; Already is the crisis near. The conspiracy of the poet and his adherents against Myrsilus is vouched for in a scholium attached to a new fragment: "In the first banishment, when after conspiring against Myrsilus, Alcaeus and Phan . . . and their adherents failed in their plot and fled to Pyrrha [Lesbos] before they could be brought to trial." While in exile Alaeus thus addressed his country : — A. APOSTROPHE TO HIS COtJNTRY (Newly discovered fragment ; translated by J. M. Edmonds, Classical Review, XXIII, 1 9 10, pp. 241-3) What purpose or intent i^ in thee, my country, that thou hast been so long time afraid? Be of good cheer; for thus saith the great son of Cronos himself, whensoever fear of dread war hath seized upon thee, never shall neighbor foeman, nay nor one that 1 The object of this poem, which portrays an Ionian hero battling for his country against the Lydians, is evidently to hold up to his fellow-citizens a pattern of martial virtue at a time when the lonians were too devoted to peace to defend their fatherland against hostile neighbors. SQNGS OF CIVIL WAR 193 with far-flung misery hither on shipboard passeth the sea, compass thee about with tearful combat, unless thou of thyself send afar all the best of thy people to sunder them from thee. For 'tis men that are a city's tower in war. But if one do other than Zeus did will it, him, strive as he may, fate ever overwhelmeth. . . . For what did Tenages, son of .lEolus prove, whom in woeful war the spear of his brother Macar slew of old. Touching suth matters, this is now my prayer : may I ho longer behold the sunKght, if the son of Cleanax, or yonder Split-Foot, or the son of Archeanax, be suffered yet to Hve by one whom, casting him forth from his dear, sweet home, Myrsilus hath done to death. While in exile Alcaeus addressed the following poem to Melanippus, who besought him to come back. To return home, the poet says, woujd be as diffi- cult as to recross the Acheron from Hades' realm. Sisyphus hoped to escape death but met with a worse fate. B. TO MELANIPPUS (Newly discovered fragment ; translated by J. M. Edmonds, Classical Review, XXVm, 1914, p. y6) There are extensive lacunae, which the translator has filled by conjecture. why, Melanippus, do you pray you might be with me? or why, when once fate has sent me to eddying Acheron, shall I hope to recross it and see again the pure Ught of the sun ? Nay, set not your desire on things too great. King Sisj^jhus son of .^olus • thought with a craft unsurpassed to have escaped death, but for all his cuiming he crossed the eddying Acheron in fate the second time ; and the son of Cronos ordained that he should have below a toil the woefullest in all the world. So I pray you bewail not these things [or lament not so]. If ever cries were unavaiUng, our cries are unavailing now. Assuredly some of these things were to be suffered with an enduring heart. When the wind rises in the north, no skilful pilot puts out into the wide sea. We do not know how long after these events the death of Myrsilus, perhaps by violence, gave Alcaeus occasion for the following outburst of joy : — Now for wine and joy divine, Myrsilus is dead ! 194 ECONOMY AND SOCIETY Now 'tis meet the earth to beat With quick and happy tread ; For Myrsilus is dead, Myrsilus is dead ! This version is the rendering of an amended text. The manuscript read- ing (Bergk, 20) is simpler ; " Now 'tis meet to drink perforce and get thor- oughly drunk, for Myrsilus is dead." It was on a similar occasion of civil strife, when his fortunes were at a low ebb, that he composed the following poem. C. THE SHIP OF STATE (Newly discovered fragment ; translated by J. M. Edmonds, Classical Review, XXVIII. 78) The sailors have cast all their cargo overboard and are saving themselves as best they can. Meanwhile beaten with the roaring wave, she (the ship) bethinks her that she no longer desires to fight with storm and tempest, but would wilhngly strike a reef and go to the bottom. That is her plight ; but for me, dear companions, I would forget these things and make merry here with you and with Bacchus. And yet why do we take our love off our country, even though fools have thrown all she hath into confusion? D. THE ARMORY This is one of his "Songs of Party Strife," in which he tried to inspire his comrades with new courage and new hope of success. The spacious hall in brazen splendor gleams, And all the house in Ares's honor beams. The helmets gUtter ; high upon the wall The nodding plumes of snowy horse's hair, Man's noblest ornaments, wave over all ; And brightly gleaming brazen greaves are there. Each hanging safe upon its hidden nail, A sure defence against the arrowy hail. And many coats of mail, and doublets stout. Breast-plates of new-spun linen, hollow shields, Well-worn and brought from foe-abandoned fields, And broad Chalcidian swords are stacked about. Bear well in mind these tools of war, they make Easy and sure the work we undertake. A FORMER PUPIL 195 E. Spring I feel the coming of the flowery Spring, Wakening tree and vine ; . A bowl capacious quickly bring And mix the honeyed wine. Weave for my throat a garland of fresh dill, And crown my head with flowers, And o'er my breast sweet perfumes spill In aromatic showers. 48. Sappho a. concerning the pupil atthis who has gone to another TEACHER A newly discovered fragment, translated with commentary by J. M. Edmonds, Classical Review, XXIII (1910) 103 sq.. Atthis, a pupil, left Sappho for another teacher named Andromeda. This fact comes from frag. 41 (Bergk) : "Atthis, it has become hateful for thee to think of me, and now thou flutterest after Andromeda." In frag. 33 she says, " I loved thee once, Atthis, long ago." The new fragment is from a different poem, as the meter is different and the third person is used, though the subject is the same. Contrary to our own notion of propriety, Sappho felt no repugnance to regarding the details of toilet and the eating of dainties as subjects for lyrical treatment. The chief interest, however, is the relation between teacher and pupU. So my Atthis has not come back, and in sooth I would I were dead. And yet she wept full sore to leave me behind, and said, ' Alas ! how sad our lot, Sappho ; I swear 'tis all against my will I leave thee.' To her I answered, 'Go thy way rejoicing and re- member me ; for thou knowest how fond I was of thee. And if thou rememberest not, Oh then I am fain to remind thee of what thou forgettest, how dear and beautiful was the life we led together. For with many a garland of violets and sweet roses mingled thou hast decked thy flowing locks by my side, and with many a woven necklet made of a hundred blossoms thy dainty throat ; and with many a jar of myrrh both of the precious and of the royal hast thou anointed thy fair young skin before me, and lying upon the couch, hast thou satisfied thyself with dainty meats and with sweet drinks.' 196 ECONOMY AND SOCIETY B. MNASIDICA, SOMETIME PUPIL OF SAPPHO A newly discovered fragment, translated with commentary by J. M. Edmonds, Classical Review, XXIII (1910) 99-104. The poem is addressed to a pupil who is stiU with Sappho, but the subject is another pupil, who has gone to hve at Sardis, probably having married some Lydian grandee. The poem throws further light on Sappho's school, and a£Eords an interesting glimpse of the social relations between Lesbos and Lydia. Atthis, our beloved Mnasidica dwells in far-off Sardis, but she often sends her thoughts hither, recalling how once we used to live in the days when she thought thee like a glorious goddess, and loved thy song the best. Now she shines among the dames of Lydia, as after sunset the stars that are about her, when she spreads her light o'er briny sea and eke o'er flowery field, while the good dew lies on the ground and the roses revive and the dainty anthrysc and the honey lotus with all its blooms. And oftentimes when our beloved, wandering abroad, calls to mind her gentle Atthis, the heart devours her tender breast with the pain of longing ; and she cries aloud for us to come thither ; and what she says we know full well, thou and I, for Night, the many-eared, calls it to us across the dividing sea. C. TO A LADY UNLEARNED (Translated by J. A. Symonds) Yea, thou shalt die. And lie Dumb in the silent tomb ; Nor of thy name Shall there be any fame In ages yet to be or years to come : For of the flowering Rose, Which on Pieria blows. Thou hast no share : But in sad Hades' house, Unknown, inglorious. 'Mid the dim shades that wander there Shalt thou flit forth and haunt the filmy air. SONGS OF LOVE 197 D. FAIREST IS THE HEART's BEHOVED (Newly found fragment translated by J. M. Edmonds, Classical Review, XXVm, 1914, p. 75) Mr. Edmonds supposes that Sappho is in exile and that Anactoria and another woman are in Mytilene. Anactoria has fallen in love with a soldier and therefore neglects her girl friend. Sappho writes to Anactoria lamenting that she (Sappho) has not the joy of close contact with the girl neglected by Anactoria. It is possible, however, that Sappho personates a young man. All these newly discovered fragments abound in lacunae and the conjec- tures offered for filling them are only tentative. The fairest thing in all the world some say is a troop of horse- men, and some a host of foot, a,nd some again a navy of ships ; but to me 'tis the heart's beloved. And 'tis easy to make this under- stood by any. When Helen surveyed much mortal beauty, she chose for best the destroyer of all the honor of Troy, and thought not so much either of child or of parent dear, but was led astray by Love to bestow her heart afar ; for woman is ever easy to be bent when she thinks hghtly of what is near and dear. Even so you to-day, my Anactoria, remember not, it seems, when she is with you one of whom I would rather the sweet sound of her foot- fall and the sight of the brightness of her beaming face than all the chariots and armored footmen of Lydia. I know that in this world man cannot have the best ; yet to pray for a share in what was once shared is better than to forget it. E. A LOVE SONG (Translated by J. A. Symonds) Peer of gods he seemeth to me, the blissful Man who sits and gazes at thee before him. Close beside thee sits, and in silence hears thee Silverly speaking, Laughing love's low laughter. Oh this, this only Stirs the troubled heart in my breast to tremble! For should I but see thee a little moment, Straight is my voice hushed ; 198 ECONOMY AND SOCIETY Yea, my tongue is broken, and through and through me 'Neath the flesh impalpable fire runs tingling ; Nothing see mine eyes, and a noise of roaring Waves in my ear sounds ; Sweat runs down in rivers, a tremor seizes All my limbs, and paler than grass in autumn, Caught by pains of menacing death, I falter. Lost in the love-trance. For other selections from Alcaeus and Sappho, see Botsford, Source-Book of Ancient History, 143-6. 49. Anacreon the upstart artemon (Preserved in Athenseus xii. 533 e. Translated by E. G. S.) Blond Eurypyte is interested in Artemon, who moves in a litter, who formerly had a shabby garment, coverings tied about him, and wooden dice in his ears, and a worn oxskin about his flanks, the unwashed cover of a worthless shield, the comrade of bread-selling women and volvintary prostitutes, the scoundrelly Artemon, de- vising the life of a cheat ; oft putting his neck in the stocks, and oft in the wheel, and often scourged on back with leather whip, his hair and beard pulled out. But now he bravely moves along in chariot, wearing golden ear-rings, the son of Cyc6, and carries an umbrella with ivory frame, quite like the women. 50. Theognis (Translated by E. G. S.) Know this thus: but have no fellowship with the bad, yet always hold to the good,^ and with them do drink, and eat and with them do sit, and them do please : for from the noble thou wilt learn noble lessons but if thou minglest with the bad, thou wilt destroy even what sense thou hast. Hast thou learned this, then have fellowship with the good and some day thou wilt say that well I counselled my friends. . . . ' Generally with Theognis "the good" are the blooded nobility, "the bad," the commons whether rich or poor. ARISTOCRATIC SENTIMENTS 199 No good men, O Cyrnus, ever did ruin any town : but wkenever it pleases the bad to be overweening, and they ruin the land, and give their verdicts in favor of the unrighteous for their own lucre's sake, and power, — then do not hope that long that commonwealth will be still, not even if now it lies in perfect rest, whenever these things prove pleasing to the bad men, namely gains that come about at- tended with evil to the land. For from them come risings and civil slaughterof men: never may autocrat^ be pleasing to this state. . . . Cyrnus, the city is still the same, but the people are other, who before knew neither rightful verdicts nor laws, but about their flanks wore out the skins of goats, apd 'yond the town like stags did feed from soil. And now they are the Good, O son of Polypais, and those erst noble now are mean. Who could endure to behold this? One another they cheat while laughing at each other, know- ing neither the minds of the bad nor minds of the good.'^ . . . Rams we seek and asses, O Cyrnus, and stallions of noble breed, and men desire to have the acquisition of the good, yet a nobleman does not care to marry a mean woman daughter of a mean man, (even) if she bring him much money. But a maid does not decline to be the spouse of a mean man ; she wills a rich man instead of a good. For it is money they honor, and mean man's offspring marries the noble, a;nd the mean man mates with the child of the good : ' riches blended the stocks. Thus marvel thou not, son of Polypais, that the race of the citizens loses its lustre, for the noble is mixed with the mean. He himseM though he knows this maid to be of mean sire, leads her to his home, induced by money, he of fine repute, her of mean repute: since forceful necessity urges him on, (necessity) which rendered patient the mind of the groom. * Monarch {jMivapxoi). ' I.e., the country people, once clad in skins, have come to power, and the blooded nobles are beneath them. ' Theognis, the noble, is horrified at such mesalliances. 200 ECONOMY AND SOCIETY 51. SiMONIDES (Translated by E. G. S.) A. ON THE BATTLE OF PLAT^A Centre held these who dwell in Ephyra ' blessed by fountains, Experts in every form of valor in war ; And they who reside in the city of Glaucus, Corinthian town, Who set up fairest witness of their toils, Of precious gold in open sky ; and for them it extols Their own wide fame and their fathers : For of witnesses best is gold resplendent in ether. B. VARIOUS EPITAPHS Balttling for Greece the Athenians at Marathon level'd the power of Persians, wearers of gold. With myriads three hundred here once fought from Peloponnesus thousands four.* Stranger, report to the Spartans, that here we lie, obedient to their laws. Stranger, once we dwelled in well-watered Corinth ; But now Salamis, isle of Ajax, possesses us ; [Capturing with ease Phoenician ships and Persians and Medians, holy Hellas we saVed.] ' • An earlier name of Corinth. ' This epitaph on the Peloponnesians who fought at Thermopylse is taken from Herodotus vii. 228. From the same source is the following epitaph on the three hun- dred Spartans who fell in the same battle. ' This epitaph is quoted by Die Chrysostom, Or. XXXVII. log (R) imder the name of the poet Simonides. It is quoted likewise but without the name by Plutarch, De maUgmtaie Herodoti, to show the unfairness of Herodotus in even repeating the story that the Corinthians tried to run away from the battle of Salamis (Hdt. viii. 94). Herodotus adds that the story is told and believed only by the Athenians, while the Corinthians maintain that they were among the bravest in the battle — a contention in which they are borne out by the rest of the Greeks. In 189s M. Dragoumis found in Salamis a stone which had long served as a door- step to a peasant's cottage, and which was inscribed with the first two lines of the epi- taph. The remainder, — the part inclosed in brackets, — did not belong to the genuine epitaph. Before this discovery it had been suspected by certain scholars on philological grounds. The information contained in this note has been^ kindly supplied by Professor E. D. Perry, Columbia University. EPITAPH AND SKOLION 201 Sons of Athenians having destroyed the host of the Persians, Warded away from their fatherland grievous slavery.^ This is the tomb of that Adimantus, on account of whose plans Hellas placed on her head the wreath of freedom.^ C. TO ARCHEDICE, DAUGHTER OF HIPPIAS, TYRANT OF ATHENS Of a man who once in Hellas in his own generation held foremost rank, Of Hippias, the daughter Archedice this dust doth conceal ; Who, with father and husband and brothers as princes. And children, was not elated in mind to sinful presumption. 52. Skolion TO Harmodius and Aristogeiton (Translated by E. G. S.) Skolia the Greeks called brief poems declaimed by individual guests at banquets, in turn, or when some one of them was called upon, to the accom- paniment of a lyre played by the contributor himself. They were called Skolia (crooked) on account probably of a permissible freedom or irregularity of metre. The subjoined specimen was ascribed to an Athenian, Callir stratus. — E. G. S. In a branch of myrtle will I bear my sword Just Hke Harmodius and Aristogeiton, When they slew the tyrant. And made Athens a place of equal rights.' Dearest Harmodius, you are not dead, I ween. But in the islands of the Blessed they say thou art, Where are swift footed Achilles And Tydeus' son, they say, the worthy Diomede. In a branch of myrtle will I bear my sword, Just hke Harmodius and Aristogeiton, ' This epitaph probably refers to the achievements of the Athenians at Platsea. ' Adimantus was admiral of the Corinthians in the battle of Salamis. ' For the story of the assassination of Hipparchus by Harmodius and Aristogeiton, see no. 29, § 18. As a reward for this deed the democratic government of Athens de- creed to the descendants of the two tyrannicides exemption from public burdens and various public honors forever. 202 ECONOMY AND SOCIETY When at the sacrifices of Athena, They slew the autocrat Hipparchus. Ever the renown of you two will be upon the earth, Dearest Harmodius and Aristogeiton, Because you slew the tyrant And made Athens a place of equal rights. 53. A Sedition nsr Miletus (Heracleides of Pontus, Concerning Justice, ii, quoted by Athensus xii. 26) Heracleides of Heracleia on the Pontus was a pupil of Plato. He wrote many works on a great variety of subjects, literary, musical, scientific, and philosophical. His treatise on Justice, from which the following excerpt was taken by Athenaeus, contained three books; Diogenes Laertius v. 86. The fragments are collected in Muller, C, Frag. hist. gr6povs, "tributes," to ^potfpous. "guards." The tributes were regularly brought in by the allies themsdves, arrears only being collected by Athenian fleets. The ships here referred to probably had the task of transporting the garrisons to places where they were needed. 212 GENERAL POLITICAL CONDITIONS Judging is what he dotes on; and he weeps Unless he sits on the front bench of all. At night he gets no sleep, no, not one grain ; Or if he doze the tiniest speck, his soul Flutters in dreams about the water-clock.^ So used is he to holding votes, he wakes With thumb and first two fingers closed,^ as one That offers incense on a new moon's day. If on a gate is written Lovely Demus* Meaning the son of Pyrilamp, he goes And writes beside it, Lovely Verdict-Box. The cock which crew from eventide, he said. Was tampered with, he knew, to call him late, — Bribed by officials whose accounts were due. Supper scarce done, he clamors for his shoes, Hurries ere daybreak to the Court, and sleeps Stuck like a limpet to the doorpost there. So sour he is, the long condemning line He marks for all, then homeward, like a bee Laden with wax beneath his finger-nails.* Lest he lack votes, he keeps, to judge withal, A private pebble-beach * secure within. Such is his frenzy, and the more you chide him The more he judges ; so with bolts and bars We guard him straitly that he stir not out. For ill the young man brooks the sire's disease. And first he tried by soft emollient words • Water-dock, clepsydra (fcXe^Mpo), was used for measuring the amount of time allowed to the speakers, and was therefore one of the most prominent features of the court room. ' As though he were holding the pebble, ballot, ready to cast. ' It was a habit of the lover to write the name of his beloved on gates and walls. Demus, son of Pyrilampes, was a noted beauty. • In a considerable class of cases the law permitted the prosecutor to propose a penalty. The defendant could then propose a lighter penalty, and the jurors had to decide between the two. A short mark on a waxen tablet, used in such cases as a ballot< indicated the lighter penalty and a. longer mark the heavier. The sour juror always made the long mark, digging his nails deeply into the wax. • See note 2. THE TYPICAL JUROR 213 To win him over, not to don his cloak Or walk abroad ; but never a jot he yielded. He washed and cleansed him then ; but never a jot. A Corybant ^ next he made him, but old master, Timbrel and all, into the New Court bursts And there sits judging. So when these rites failed, We cross the strait, and in ^gina place him, To sleep the night inside Asclepius' temple ; " Lo ! with the dawn he stands at the Court rails ! Then after that we let him out no more. But he ! he dodged along the pipes and gutters. And so made off ; we block up every cranny. Stopping and stuffing them with clouts of rag : Quick he drove pegs into the wall, and clambered Up like an old jackdaw, and so hopped out. Now then we compass all the house with nets. Spreading them round, and mew him safe within. Well, sirs, Philocleon is the old man's name ; Ay truly ; and the son's, Bdelycleon : ' A wondrous high-and-mighty mannered man. (Aristophanes, Wasps, 214-78) Bdelycleon, the son, and Sosias, another slave, are outside the house on guard. They especially fear that when the rest of the jurors, swarming in from the country, pass the house, they will contrive somehow to free their caged comrade. The description of these old men trudging through the night along the rough, muddy roads, some accompanied by their sons carrying lan- terns, is a striking feature of life at Athens in those times. Particularly it is to be noticed that the jurors here referred to are all old men, and are from country homes. Bdelycleon ... In a little while His fellow-justices will come this way Calling him up. Sosias. Why, sir, 'tis twilight now. ' Corybant, priest of Cybele, worshiped with noisy music and wild excitement. ' For a passage illustrating incubation in a. temple of Asdepius, see no. 78. ' Philocleon signifies "Lover of Cleon," the famous demagogue; Bdelycleon means "Hater of Cleon." 214 GENERAL POLITICAL CONDITIONS Bdel. Why then, by Zeus, they are very late to-day. Soon after midnight is their usual time To come .here carrying lights, and warbling tunes Sidono-Phrynich-beautiful-antique,' Wherewith they call him out. Sos. And if they come, Had we not better pelt them with some stones ? Bdel. Pelt them, you rogue ! You might as well provoke A nest of wasps ^ as anger these old men. Each wears beside his loins a deadly sting. Wherewith they smite, and on with yells and cries They leap, and strike at you, like sparks of fire. Sos. Tut, never trouble, give me but some stones, I'U chase the biggest wasps-nest of them all. Chorus of Jukors — Step out, step out, my comrades stout: no loitering, Comias, pound along. You're shirking now, you used, I vow, to pull as tough as leathern thong ; Yet now, with ease, Charinades, can walk a brisker pace than you. Come, every dear and tried compeer, come, quickly come, ere morning break. And as you go, be sure to throw the light around on every side ; Lest somewhere nigh a stone may lie, and we therefrom be dam- nified. Boy. O father, father, here's some mud ! look sharp or in you'll go. Chor. Pick up a stick and trim the wick,' a better light to show. Boy. Nay father, with my finger thus I choose to trim the lamp. Chor. How dare you rout the wick about, you little wasteful scamp, '■ Phrynichus, a dramatic poet, was an older contemporary of jEschylus. There was much song and little dialogue in his plays, and evidently he delighted in compound- ing words, as did jEschylus. 'The Chorus of jurors were dressed to represent wasps, hence the name of the ■comedy. ' The lantern was a vessel containing olive oil, in which floated a wick. Outside the larger towns of Greece the same kind of lamp is still in use. ON THE WAY TO COURT 215 And that with oil so scarce ? But no, it don't disturb your quiet, However dear the oil may be, when I have got to buy it. Boy. If with your knuckles once again you 'monish us, I swear We'll douse the light and take to flight, and leave you floundering there. Then wading on without the lamp in darkness, I'll be bound You'll stir and splash the mud about, like snipes in marshy ground. Chor. Ah, greater men than you, my boy, 'tis often mine to beat. But, bless me, this is filth indeed I feel beneath my feet ; Ay, and within four days from this, or sooner, it is plain, God will send down upon our town a fresh supply of rain. So dense and thick around the wick these thieves* collect and gather. And that's, as everybody knows, a sign of heavy weather. Well, well, 'tis useful for the fruits, and all the backward trees, To have a timely fall of rain, and eke a good north breeze. But how is this?^ Our friend not here! How comes it he's so slack? * By Zeus, he never used to be at all a hanger-back. He always marched before us all, on legal cares intent, And some old tune of Phrynichus he warbled as he went. he's a wonder for the songs ! Come, comrades, one and all, Come stand around the house and sing, its master forth to call. If once he hears me tuning up, I know it won't be long Before he comes creep, creeping out, from pleasure at the song. How is it our friend is not here to receive us ? Why comes he not forth, from his dwelling? Can it be that he's had the misfortune to lose His one pair of shoes : Or striking his toe in the dark, by the grievous Contusion is lamed, and his ankle inflamed ? 1 Thieves {/tOKirres), fungous growths on the wick, caused by the heaviness of the atmosphere. The roads are now bad enough but will be worse after that rain ; but the fields and trees need it. ' They halt in the road and look toward Philocleon's house. 2i6 GENERAL POLITICAL CONDITIONS (Aristophanes, Wasps, 291-317) The following conversation between the boy and his father indicates the straitened condition of the small farmer at this time. His fields had been ravaged by the enemy, and he had nothing but his juror's fee to depend upon for the daily food of his family. Boy. Father, if a boon I pray, Will you grant it, father, eh ? Chor. Certainly I will, my son. Tell me what you'd have me buy. Dibs,"^ my son ? Hey, my son ? Dibs it is undoubtedly. Boy. Dibs, my father ! No, my father ! Figs! for they are sweeter far. Chor. You be hanged first : yet you shall not Have them, monkey, when you are. Boy. Then, my father, woe betide you ! Not another step I'll guide you. Chor. Is it not enough that I With this paltry pay must buy Fuel, bread, and sauce for three ? Must I needs buy figs for thee ! Boy. Father, if the Archon say That the court won't sit to-day, Tell me truly, father mine. Have we wherewithal to dine ? O my father, should not we Then in "Straits of HeM" ^ be? Chor. Out upon it ! Out upon it ! Then indeed, I should not know For a little bit of supper Whither in this world to go. Boy. Why, my mother, didst thou breed me, giving nothing else to feed me, But a store of legal woe ? ' Dibs, knucklebones, commonly played by children. ' Straits of Hellfi ; the boy means to say that they will be in straits, but the word reminds him of a poetic phrase, which he proceeds to utter, though it makes mere nonsense. A JUROR'S ADVANTAGES 217 Chor. Empty scrip ! empty show, Bootless, fruitless ornament ! Boy. O! O! Woe! Woe! Ours to sorrow and lament. (Ibid. 548-614) As the action of the comedy develops, Philocleon, the father, proposes to discourse on the enviable features of the juror's position, while his son, Bdely- cleon, takes note of the points he makes. Philocleon. Away, away, like a racer gay, I start at once from the head of the lists. To prove that no kingher power than ours in any part of the world exists. Is there any creature on earth more blest, more feared and petted from day to day. Or that leads a happier, pleasanter life, than a Justice of Athens, though old and gray ? For first when rising from bed in the morn, to the criminal Court betimes I trudge. Great six-foot fellows are there at the rails, in anxious haste to salute their judge. And the delicate hand which has dipped so deep in the public purse, he claps into mine, And he bows before me and makes his prayer, and softens his voice to a pitiful whine ; '0 pity me, pity me. Sir,' he cries, 'if you ever indulged your long- ing for pelf. When you managed the mess on a far campaign, or served some office of state yourself.' The man would never have heard my name, if he had not been tried and acquitted before. Bdelycleon (Writing). I'll take a note of the point you make that 'suppliant fellows your grace implore.' Phil. So when they have begged and implored me enough, and my angry temper is wiped away, I enter in and take my seat, and then I do none of the things I say. 2i8 GENERAL POLITICAL CONDITIONS I hear them utter all sorts of cries, designed expressly to win my grace, What won't they utter, what won't they urge, to coax a Justice who tries their case ? Some vow they are needy and friendless men, and over their poverty wail and whine, And reckon up hardships, false and true, till he makes them out to be equal to mine. Some tell us a legend of days gone by, or a joke from Msop witty and sage, Or jest and banter to make me laugh, that so I may doff my terrible rage. And if all this fails, and I stand unmoved, he leads by the hand his little ones near, He brings his girls and he brings his boys ; and I, the Judge, am composed to hear. They huddle together with piteous bleats ; while trembling above them he prays to me. Prays as to a God his accounts to pass, to give him a quittance, and leave him free. 'If thou lovest a bleating male of the flock, O lend thine ear to this boy of mine ; Or pity the sweet little delicate girl, if thy soul delights in the squeak- ing of swine.' So then we relax the pitch of our wrath, and screw it down to a peg more low. Is this not a fine dominion of mine, a derision of wealth with its pride and show ? Bdel. (Writing). A second point for my note-book that, 'a derision of wealth with its pride and show.' . . , Phil. But the nicest and pleasantest part of it all is this, which I'd wholly forgotten to say, 'Tis when with my fee in my wallet I come, returning home at the close of the day, O then what a welcome- 1 get for its sake ; my daughter, the darling, is foremost of all, And she washes my feet and anoints them with care, and above them she stoops and a kiss lets fall, PRINCIPLES OF GOVERNMENT 219 Till at last by the pretty Papas of her tongue she angles withal my three-obol away. Then my dear little wife, she sets on the board nice manchets of bread in a tempting array, And cosily taking a seat by my side, with loving entreaty constrains me to feed ; 'I beseech you taste this, I implore you try that.' This, this I delight in, and ne'er may I need To look to yourself and your pantler, a scrub, who, whenever I ask him my breakfast to set. Keeps grumbling and murmuring under his breath. 61. The Relative Valxje of the Three Principal Forms OF Government (Herodotus iii. 80-82) In the age of Pericles and of Herodotus the Greeks began for the first time to take a lively interest in discussing the principles of government — a study which finally led to the creation of Political Scfbnce. The following passage contains the earliest known comparison of monarchy, ohgarchy, and democracy. Although Herodotus puts it in the mouths of certain Persian grandees shortly before the accession of Darius, 521 B.C., there can be no doubt that the ideas were Greek, and that in the lifetime of the historian discussions of the kind were novel. 80. And now when five days were gone, and the hubbub had settled down, the conspirators ^ met together to consult about the situation of affairs. At this meeting speeches were made, to which many of the Greeks give no credence, but they were made never- theless. Otanes recommended that the management of public affairs should be entrusted to the whole nation. "To me," he said, "it seems advisable that we should no longer have a single man to rule over us — the rule of one is neither good nor pleasant. Ye can- not have forgotten to what lengths Cambyses went in his haughty tyranny, and the haughtiness of the Magi ye have yourselves ex- ' They were the grandees above mentioned. The conspiracy had been for the slaying of a certain Magian who had usurped the Persian throne after the death of Cambyses. Of those who were present three men, Otanes, Megabyzus, and Darius, engaged in the discussion. 220 GENERAL POLITICAL CONDITIONS perienced. How indeed is it possible that monarchy should be a well-adjusted thing, when it allows a man to do as he likes without being answerable ? Such, license is enough to stir strange and un- wonted thoughts in the heart of the worthiest of men. Give a person this power, and straightway his manifold good things puff him up with pride, while envy is so natural to human kind that it cannot but arise in him. But pride and envy together include all wickedness — both of them leading on to deeds of savage violence. True it is that kings, possessing as they do all that heart can desire, ought to be void of envy ; but the contrary is seen in their conduct toward the citizens. They are jealous of the most virtuous among their subjects, and wish their death ; while they take delight in the meanest and basest, being ever ready to listen to the tales of slan- derers. A king, besides, is beyond all other men inconsistent with himself. Pay him court in moderation, and he is angry because you do not show him more profound respect ; show him profound respect, and he is offended again, because (as he says) you fawn on him. But the worst of all is that he sets aside the laws of the land, puts men to death without trial, and subjects women to violence. The rule of the many, on the other hand, has, in the first place, the fairest of names, to wit, isonomy;^ and further it is free from all those outrages which a king is wont to commit. There, places are given by lot, the magistrate is answerable for what he does, and measures rest with the commonalty. I vote, therefore, that we do away with monarchy, and raise the people to power. For the people are all in all." 8i. Such were the sentiments of Otanes. Megabyzus spoke next, and advised the setting up of an oligarchy : — "In all that Otanes has said to persuade you to put down monarchy," he ob- served, "I fully concur; but his recommendation that we should call the people to power seems to me not the best advice. For there is nothing so void of understanding, nothing so full of wantonness as the unwieldy rabble. It were folly not to be borne, for men, while seeking to escape the wantonness of a tyrant, to give them- selves up to the wantonness of a rude unbridled mob. The tyrant, in aU his doings, at least knows what he is about, but a mob is al- 1 Isonomy, equality before the law. MONARCHY IS BEST 221 together devoid of knowledge ; for how should there be any knowl- edge in a rabble, untaught, and with no natural sense of what is right and fit ? It rushes wildly into state affairs with all the fury of a stream swollen in the winter, and confuses everything. Let the enemies of the Persians be ruled by democracies; but let us choose out from the citizens a certain number of the worthiest, and put the government into their hands. For thus both we our- selves shall be among the governors, and with power entrusted to the best men, it is Ukely that the best counsels will prevail in the state." 82. This was the advice which Megabyzus gave, and after him Darius came forward, and spoke as follows : — "All that Megabyzus said against democracy was well said, I think ; but about oligarchy he did not speak advisedly ; for take these three forms of govern- mgit — democracy, oligarchy, and monarchy — and let them each be at their best, I maintain that monarchy far surpasses the other two. What government can possibly be better than that of the very best man in the whole state? The counsels of such a man are like himself, and so he governs the mass of the people to their heart's content ; while at the same time his measures against evil-doers are kept more secret than in other states. Contrariwise, in oligarchies, where men vie with each other in the service of the commonwealth, fierce enmities are apt to arise between man and man, each wishing to be leader, and to carry his own measures ; whence violent quarrels come, which lead to open strife, often ending in bloodshed. Then monarchy is sure to follow ; and this result, too, shows how far that rule surpasses all others. Again, in a democracy it is impossible but that there will be malpractices; these malpractices, however, do not lead to enmities, but to close friendships, which are formed among those engaged in them, who must hold well together to carry on their villainies. Thus things go on until a man stands forth as champion of the commonalty, and puts down the evil-doers. Straightway the author of so great a service is admired by all, and from being admired soon comes to be appointed king ; so that here too it is plain that monarchy is the best government. Lastly, to sum up all in a word, whence, I ask, was it that we got the freedom which we enjoy ? — did democracy give it us, or oligarchy or a mon- arch ? As a single man recovered our freedom for us, my sentence 222 GENERAL POLITICAL CONDITIONS is that we keep to the rule of one. Even apart from this, we ought not to change the laws of our forefathers when they work fairly; for to do so is not well." 62. Strictures on the Athenian Democracy (Polity of the Athenians, by an unknown author. The translation of Dakyns, Works of Xenophon, has been revised, on the basis of a comparison of the Greek text, by E. G. S.) In the introduction to the preceding selection reference has been made to the dawning interest in the principles of government. One- of the ILaes- along, which political thought was advancing was the criticism of existing constitu- tions. An example is the treatise here given, which has come down to us among the works of Xenophon, but which is certainly earlier than any of his writings. Evidently it was composed early in the Peloponnesian war, about 425 or 424. The real author, unknown by name, is aptly styled "Old Oligarch" by Zimmern, Greek Commonwealth, 444. The work itself is evidence that the author was a man of mature years, experience, and judgment, who set forth the blemishes of democracy usually with truth, however hostile his spirit, and always with clearness and logic. His pamphlet should be studied along with the Funeral Oration of Pericles, as the two documents balance and correct each other. Naturally we are repelled by the tone of the pamphlet, by the author's narrow, unsympathetic treatment of common people, slaves, and aliens — by his total lack of humanity, his complete absorption in the welfare of his narrow class. He cannot entertain a thought of compromise ; the only alternative to democracy is the rule of his own class and the enslavement of the masses. It is interesting to the student of political science as the earliest known political treatise in any language, while to anyone investigating the history and the society of that age it is an invaluable source of information. Notable is 'the author's interest in economic conditions. Because of its unusual impor- tance the entire document is printed below. I. I. Now, as concerning the Polity of the Athenians, and the type or manner of constitution which' they have chosen, I praise it not, in so far as the very choice involves the welfare of the baser folk as opposed to that of the better class. I repeat, I withhold my praise so far ; but, given the fact that this is the type agreed upon, I propose to show that they set about its preservation in the right way; and that those other transactions in connection with it, which are looked upon as blunders by the rest of the Hel- lenic world, are the reverse. CONSIDERATION FOR THE POOR 223 2. In the first place, I maintain, it is only just that the poorer classes and the People of Athens should have the advantage over the men of birth and wealth, seeing that it is the people who row the vessels, and put round the city her girdle of power. For the steersman, the boatswain, the commanders of fifty, the lookout- man at the prow, the shipwright — these are the people who engird the city with power far rather than her heavy infantry and men of birth and quality. This being the case, it seems only just that of- fices of state should be thrown open to every one both by the lot and by the show of hands,^ and that the right of speech should belong to any citizen who likes, without restriction. 3. Further, there are many of these offices which, according as they are in good or in bad hands, are a source of safety or of danger to the People and in these the People prudently abstain from sharing; as, for instance, they do not think it incumbent on themselves to share in the drawing of lots for general or commander of cavalry. The sovereign People recognize the fact that in foregoing the personal exercise of these offices and leaving them to the control of the more competent citizens, they secure the balanee of advantage to them- selves. It is only those departments of government which bring emolument and assist the private households that the People care to keep in their own hands.^ 4. In the next place, in regard to what some people are puzzled to explain — the fact that everywhere greater consideration is shown to the base, to poor people and to common folk, than to persons of good quality, — so far from being a matter of surprise, this, as can be shown, is the keystone of the preservation of the democracy. It is these poor people, this common folk, this riff-raff, whose prosperity, combined with the growth of their numbers, en- hance the democracy. Whereas a shifting of fortune to the ad- vantage of the wealthy and the better classes implies the establish- ment on the part of the commonalty of a strong power in opposition to itself. 5. In fact, all the world over the cream of society is in ' The' ordinary method of electing officials who were not appointed by lot. Voting in the law courts,- on the other hand, was by ballot. 2 The democratic theory was that for most offices the Athenians were all sufficiently qualified, but that for certain magistracies special qualifications were necessary. The former were filled by lot, the latter by election. 224 GENERAL POLITICAL CONDITIONS opposition to the democracy. Naturally, since the smallest amount of intemperance and injustice, together with the highest scrupu- lousness in the pursuit of excellence, is to be found in the ranks of the better class, while within the ranks of the People will be foimd the greatest amount of ignorance, disorderliness and rascality,^ — poverty acting as a strong incentive to base conduct, not to speak of lack of education and ignorance, traceable to the want of means which afflicts some portions of mankind. 6. The objection may be raised that it was a mistake to allow the universal right of speech and a seat in council. These privileges should have been reserved for the cleverest, the flower of the com- munity. But here again it will be found that they are acting with wise deUberation in granting to even the baser sort the right of speech, for supposing only the better people might speak, or sit in council, blessings would fall to the lot of those like themselves, but to the commonalty the reverse of blessings. Whereas now, any one who likes, any base fellow, may get up and discover some- thing to the advantage of himseK and his equals. 7. It may be retorted: "And what sort of advantage either for himself or for the People can such a fellow be expected to discern ? " The answer is, that in their judgment the ignorance and the baseness of this fellow, together with his good will, are worth a great deal more to them than your superior person's virtue and wisdom, coupled with aversion. 8. What it comes to, therefore, is that a state founded upon such institutions will not be the best state ; but, given a de- mocracy, these are the right means to secure its preservation. The People, it must be borne in mind, do not demand that the city should be well governed and themselves slaves. They desire to be free and to be masters. As to bad legislation, they do not concern themselves about that. In fact, what you believe to be poor leg- islation is the very source of the People's strength and freedom. 9. But if you seek for good laws, in the first place you will see the cleverest members of the community la3dng down the laws for the rest. And in the next place, the better class will curb and chastise ' The view here offered is rejected, and the opposite view maintained, by Sociates, in Xenophon, Memorabilia, iii. $. 19. He asserts — and there is no reason for doubting it — that the poor were far more obedient to authority than the knights and theieavy infantry. SLAVES AND RESIDENT ALIENS 225 the lower orders ; the better class will deliberate in behalf of the state, and not suffer men in fits of madness to sit in council, or to speak, or vote in the assembly. No doubt ; but under the weight of such blessings the People would in a very short time be reduced to slavery. 10. Another point is the extraordinary amount of license granted to slaves and resident aliens at Athens, where a blow is illegal, and a slave will not step aside to let you pass him in the street. I will explain the reason of this peculiar custom. Supposing it were legal for a slave to be beaten by a free citizen, or for a resident alien or f reedman to be beaten by a citizen, it would frequently happen that an Athenian might be mistaken for a slave or an aUen and receive a beating ; since the Athenian People are not better clothed than the slave or alien, nor in personal appearance is there any superiority. II. Or if the fact itself that slaves in Athens are allowed to indulge in luxury, and indeed in some cases to live magnificently, be found astonishing, this too, it can be shown, is done of set purpose. Where we have a naval power dependent upon wealth, we must perforce be slaves to our slaves, in order that we may get in our slave-rents, and let the real slave go free. Where you have wealthy slaves it ceases to be advantageous that my slave should stand in awe of you. In Lalcedaemon my slave does stand in awe of you. But if your slave is in awe of me, the chances are he will give away his own money to avoid running a risk, in his own person. 12. It is for this reason then that we have established an equality of speech between our slaves and free men; and again between our resident aliens and full citizens, because the city stands in need of her resident aliens to meet the requirements of such a multiplicity of arts and for the purposes of her navy. That is, I repeat, the justification of the equality conferred upon our resident ahens. 13. Citizens devoting their time to gymnastics and to the cul- tivation of music are not to be found in Athens; the sovereign People have dissolved their power,' not from any disbehef in the ' This statement is not true, and is partly contradicted by what follows. It is natural, however, for the oligarch to imagine that the democratization of athletics was equivalent to their abolition, especially in view of the fact that in general the democ- racy did not pursue athletics and prepare for the great national games with the zeal of the aristocracy. 226 GENERAL POLITICAL CONDITIONS beauty and honor of such training, but recognising the fact that these are things the cultivation of which is beyond their power. On the same principle, in the case of the choregia, the gymnasiarchy, and the trierarchy, the fact is recognised that it is the rich man who trains the chorus, and the People, for whom the chorus is trained ; it is the rich man who is trierarch or gymnasiarch,^ and the People that profit by their labors. In fact, what the People deem proper is to make wages by singing and running and dancing and manning the vessels but only in order that they may be the gainer, while the rich are made poorer. Thus too in the courts of justice, justice is not more an object of concern to the jurymen than what touches personal advantage.^ 14. To speak next of the allies, and in reference to the point that emissaries from Athens come out and, according to common opinion, calumniate and vent their hatred upon the better sort of people, this is done on the principle that the ruler cannot help being hated by those whom he rules ; but that if wealth and respecta- bility are to wield power in the subject cities, the empire of the Athe- nian People has but a short lease of existence. This explains why the better people are punished with infamy, robbed of their money, driven from their homes, and put to death, while the baser sort are promoted to honor.* On the other hand, the better Athenians throw their aegis over the better class in the alhed cities. And why ? Because they recognise that it is to the interest of their own class at all times to protect the best element in the cities. 15. It may be urged that if it comes to strength and power, the real strength of Athens lies in the capacity of her allies to contribute their money quota. But to the democratic mind it appears a higher advantage still for the individual Athenian to get hold of the wealth of the a^hes, leaving them only enough to live upon and to cultivate their estates, but powerless to harbor treacherous designs.* 16. Again, it is looked upon as a mistaken policy on the part of ' On these liturgies, expensive public services performed unpaid by the wealthy, see Botsford, Hdlenic History, ch. xii. ' On the jurors see no. 60. ' On the character of the Delian confederacy as a democratic alliance, see Botsford, Hellemc History, ch. xiv. * This statement is absolutely untrue ; under Athenian rule the allies greatly in- creased in wealth and prosperity; Botsford, loc. cit. IMPERIAL JURISDICTION 227 the Athenian democracy to compel her allies to voyage to Athens in order t6 have their cases tried. On the other hand, it is easy to reckon up what a number of advantages the Athenian People derive from the practice impugned. In the first place, there is the steady receipt of salaries throughout the year derived from the court fees. Next, it enables them to manage the affairs of the aUied states while seated at home without the expense of naval expeditions. Thirdly, they thus preserve the partisans of the democracy, and ruin her opponents in the law courts. Whereas, supposing the several allied states tried their cases at home, being inspired by hos- tility to Athens, they would destroy those of their own citizens whose friendship to the Athenian People was most marked. 17. But besides all this the democracy derives the following advantages from hearing the cases of her allies in Athens. In the first place, the one per cent levied in Peiraeus is an advantage to the state ; ^ again, the owner of a house for a number of families ^ does better, and so, too, the owner of a pair of beasts, or of slaves to be let out for hire. 18. Again, heralds and criers are a class of people who fare better owing to the sojourn of the allies at Athens. Further still, supposing the allies had not to resort to Athens for the hearing of cases, only those of the Athenians who sail out to them would be held in honor, such as the general, or trierarch, or ambassador; whereas now every single individual among the allies is forced to pay flattery to the People of Athens because he knows that he must betake himself to Athens and lose or win his case at the bar, not of any stray set of judges, but of the sovereign People themselves, such being the law and custom at Athens. He is compelled to be- have as a suppKant in the courts of justice, and when some juryman comes into court, to grasp his hand. For this reason, therefore, the alUes find themselves more and more in the position of slaves to the democracy of Athens. 19. Furthermore, owing to the possession of property beyond the hmits of Attica, and the exercise of magistracies which take them into regions beyond the frontier, they and their attendants have insensibly acquired the art of navigation. A man who is perpet- ually voyaging is forced to handle the oar, he and his slave aUke, ^ This was the amount of duty levied on imports and exports. ■ ' SvmiKia. 228 GENERAL POLITICAL CONDITIONS and to learn the terms familiar in seamanship. 20. Hence a stock of skilful navigators is produced, bred upon a wide experience of voyaging and practice. They have learnt their business, some in piloting a small craft, others a merchant vessel, whilst others have been drafted off from these activities for service on a ship-of- war. So that the majority of them are able to row the moment they set foot on board a vessel, having been in a state of prehminary practice all their Kves. II. I. As to the heavy infantry, an arm the deficiency of which at Athens is well recognized, this is how the matter stands. They recognize the fact that, in reference to the hostile power, they are themselves inferior, and must be, even if their heavy infantry were more numerous. But relatively to the allies, who pay the tribute and are quite strong on land, they are even satisfied to have the hoplite element carry on the government, if they (the Athenians) are stronger than the allies. 2. Apart from all else, to a certain extent fortune must be held responsible for the actual condition. The subjects of a power which is dominant by land have it open to them to form one commonwealth from several small states and fight with all their forces gathered into a compact union. But with the subjects of a naval power it is different. As far as they are groups of islanders, it is impossible for their states to meet together for united action; for the sea lies between them, and the dominant power is master of the sea. And even if it were possible for them to assemble in some single island unobserved, they will only (do so to) perish by famine. 3. And as to the states subject to Athens which are not islanders, but situated on the continent, the larger are held in check by apprehension, and the small ones absolutely by want, since there is no state in existence which does not depend upon imports and exports, and these she will forfeit if she does not lend a wilKng ear to those who are masters by sea. 4. In the next place, a power dominant by sea can do certain things which a land power is debarred from doing ; as, for instance, ravage the territory of a superior, since it is always possible to coast along to some point, where either there is no hostile force to deal with or merely a small body ; and in case of an advance in force on the part of the enemy they can take to their ships and sail away.^ Such a performance is ' Such was the poKcy of Perides in the Peloponnesian war; Thucydides ii. 23. ADVANTAGES OF NAVAL SUPREMACY 229 attended with less difliculty than that experienced by the relieving force on land. 5. Again, it is open to a power so dominating by sea to leave its own territory and sail off on as long a voyage as you please, whereas the land power cannot place more than a few days' journey between itself and its own territory, for marches are slow affairs ; and it is not possible for an army on the march to have food supplies to last for any great length of time. Such an army must either march through friendly territory or it must force a way by victory in battle. The voyager meanwhile has it in his power to disembark at any point where he finds himself in superior force, or, at the worst, to coast by until he reaches either a friendly district or an enemy too weak to resist. 6. Again, those diseases to which the fruits of the earth are liable as visitations from Zeus fall severely on a land power, but are scarcely felt by the naval power, for such sicknesses do not visit the whole earth everywhere at once. Thus the ruler of the sea can get in supplies from a thriving district. 7. If one may descend to more trifling particulars, it is to this same lordship of the sea that the Athenians owe the discovery, in the first place, of many of the luxuries of life through intercourse with other countries. Thus it is that the choice things^ of Sicily and Italy, of Cyprus and Egj^t and Lydia, of Pontus, of Peloponnese, or wheresoeveJr else it be, are all swept, as it were, into one center, and all owing, as I say, to their maritime empire. 8. Again, in process of listening to every form of speech, they have selected for themselves this from one place and that from another. Hence while the rest of the Hellenes employ each pretty much their own pecuh'ar mode of speech, habit of life, and style of dress, the Athe- nians-have adopted a composite type, to which all sections of Hellas and the foreigner alike, have contributed. 9. As regards sacrifices and temples and festivals and sacred enclosures, the Attic Democracy sees that it is not possible for every poor citizen to do sacrifice and hold festival, or to set up temples and to inhabit a large and beautiful city. But it has hit upon a means of meeting the difficulty. They sacrifice — that is, the whole state sacrifices — at the public cost a large number of victims; but it is the Attic Democracy that keeps holiday and distributes the victims by lot amongst its members. 10. Rich men have in some cases private g5annasia and baths with dressing-rooms, but 230 GENERAL POLITICAL CONDITIONS the People take care to. have built at the public cost a number of palaestras, dressing-rooms, and bathing estabhshments for their own special use, and the mob gets the benefit of the majority of these luxuries rather than the select few or the well-to-do. II. As to wealth, the Athenians are exceptionally placed with regard to Hellenic and foreign communities alike, in their ability to hold it. For given that some state or other is rich in timber for shipbuilding, where is it to find a market for the product except by persuading the ruler of the sea ? Or suppose the wealth of some state or other to consist of iron, or may be of bronze, or of hemp, where will it find a market except by permission of the supreme maritime power ? Yet these are the very things, you see, which I need for my ships. Timber I must have from one, and from an- other iron, from a third bronze, from a fourth hemp, from a fifth wax, etc. 12. Besides they will not suffer our antagonists in these parts to carry these products elsewhither, or they will cease to use ^ the sea. Accordingly I, without one stroke of labor, from land pos- sess all these good things, thanks to my supremacy on the sea; whilst not a single other state possesses as much as two of them ; not timber, fqj: instance, and hemp together, has the same city, but where hemp is abundant, the soil will be light and devoid of timber. And in the same way bronze and iron will not be products of the same city. The same rule holds for the rest, never two, or at best three, in one state, but one thing here and another thing there. 13. Moreover, above and beyond what has been said, the coastline of all the mainland presents either some jutting promontory, or adjacent island, or narrow strait of some sort, so that those who are masters of the sea can come to moorings at one of these points and inflict injury on the inhabitants of the mainland. 14. There is just one thing which the Athenians lack. Suppos- ing they were the inhabitants of an island, and were still as now rulers of the sea, they would have had it in their power to inflict whatever mischief they liked, and to suffer no evil in return (as long as they kept command of the sea), neither the ravaging of their territory nor the expectation of an enemy's approach. At present the farming portion of the community and the wealthy land- owners are ready to cringe before the enemy overmuch, whilst the 1 Another reading is fl oB xp'}"'*'^"' ''B SaKirTji "or where they shall use the sea." THE PEOPLE IRRESPONSIBLE 231 People, knowing fuU well that, come what may, not one stock or stone of their property will suffer, nothing will be cut down, nothing burnt, live in freedom from alarm, without fawning at the enemy's approach. 15. Besides this, there is another fear from which they would have been exempt in an island home — the apprehension of the city's being at any time betrayed by a handful of men and the. gates thrown open, and an enemy bursting suddenly in. How could such incidents have taken place if an island had been their home ? Again, had they inhabited an island there would have been no stirring of sedition against the people ; whereas at present, in the event of a rising, those who set it on foot would base their hopes of success on the introduction of an enemy by land. But a people inhabiting an island would be free from all anxiety on that score. 16. Since, however, they did not chance to inhabit an island from the first, what they actually do is this — they deposit their property in the islands, trusting to their command of the sea, and they suffer the soil of Attica to be ravaged without a sigh. To expend pity on that, they know, would be to deprive themselves of other blessings still more precious. 17. Further, states oligarchically governed are forced to ratify their alliances and solemn oaths in a substantial fashion, and if they fail to abide by their treaties, the offence, by whomsoever committed, lies nominally at the door of the oligarchs who entered upon the contract. But in the case of engagements entered into by a democracy it is open to the People to throw the blame on the single individual who spoke in favor of some measure, or who put it to the vote, and to enter a denial for the rest of the citizens, averring that one was not present, or did not approve of the terms of the agreement. Inquiries are made in a full meeting of the People, and should any of these things be disapproved of, the demus has devised already innumerable excuses to avoid doing whatever they do not wish. If too any mischief should spring out of any de- liberations of the assembly, the People charge that a handful of men acting against the interests of the citizens have ruined the state. But if any good result ensue, they, the People, at once take the credit of that to themselves. 18. In the same spirit it is not allowed to caricature on the comic stage or otherwise libel the People, because they do not care to hear 232 GENERAL POLITICAL CONDITIONS themselves ill spoken of. But if any one has a desire to satirize his neighbor, he has full leave to do so. And this because they are well aware that, as a general rule, the person caricatured does not belong to the People, or the masses. He is more likely to be some wealthy or well-born person, or man of means and influence. In fact, but few poor people and of the popular stamp incur the comic lash, or if they do, they have brought it on themselves by excessive love of meddling or some covetous self-seeking at the expense of the People, so that no particular annoyance is felt at seeing such folk satirized. 19. What I venture to assert is therefore that the People of Athens have no difficulty in recognizing which of their citizens are of the better sort and which the opposite. Recognizing, accordingly, those who are serviceable and advantageous to themselves, even though they be base, the People love them ; but the good folk they are disposed the rather to hate. This excellence of theirs, the People hold, is not ingrained in their nature for any good to itself, but rather for its injury. In direct opposition to this, there are some persons who, being born of the People, are yet by natural instinct not commoners. 20. For my part I pardon the People their democ- racy, as indeed it is pardonable in any one to do good to himself. But the man who, not being himself one of the People, prefers to live in a state democratically governed rather than in an oligarchical state takes steps to commit wrong. He knows that a bad man has a better chance of slipping through the fingers of justice in a demo- cratic than in an oligarchical state. HI. I. I repeat that my position concerning the polity of the Athenians is this : the type of polity is not to my taste, but given that a democratic form of government has been agreed upon, they do seem to me to go the right way to preserve the democracy by the adoption of the particular type which I have set forth. But there are other objections brought, as I am aware, against the Athenians by certain people, and to this effect : It not seldom happens, they tell us, that a man is unable to transact a piece of business with the council or the People, even if he sit waiting a whole year. Now this does happen at Athens, and for no other reason save that, owing to the immense mass of affairs, they are unable to work off all the business on hand and dismiss the appli- cants. 2. How in the world should they be able, considering in the GOVERNING INSTITUTIONS OVERBURDENED 233 first place, that they, the Athenians, have more festivals to cele- brate than any other state throughout the length and breadth of Hellas? During these festivals necessarily the transaction of any sort of affairs of state is still more out of the question. In the next place, only consider the number of cases they have to decide, — private suits and public causes and scrutinies of accounts, etc. — more than the whole of the rest of mankind put together ; while the council has multifarious points to advise upon concerning peace and war, concerning ways and means, concerning the framing and passing of laws, and concerning the thousand and one matters affect- ing the state perpetually occurring, and endless questions touching the allies, besides the receipt of the tribute, the superintendence of dockyards and temples, etc. I ask again, can any one find it at all surprising that, with all these affairs on their hands, they are unequal to attending to the business of all the world ? 3. But some people tell us that if the applicant will only address himself to the council or the People with a fee in his hand, he will have his business done. For my part I would agree with these persons that a good many things are aecomplished at Athens by dint of money ; and I will add that a good many more still might be done, if the money flowed still more freely and from more pockets. One thing, however, I know full well, that as to transacting with every one of these applicants all he wants, the state could not do it, not even if all the gold and silver in the world were the inducement offered. 4. Here are some of the cases which have to be decided on. Some one fails to fit out his ship : judginent must be given. An- other puts up a building on a piece of public land : again judgment must be given. Or to take another class of cases : adjudication has to be made between the choregi for the Dionysia, the Thargelia, the Panathenaea year after year. [And again in behalf of the gym- nasiarchs a similar adjudication for the Panathenaea, the Prome- theia, and the Hephaestia, also year after year.] ^ Also as between the trierarchs, four hundred of whom are appointed each year ; of these, too, any who choose must have their cases adjudicated on, year after year. But that is not all. There are various magis- 1 Probably spurious. On the liturgies, see p. 226, n. i, supra. In the distribution of liturgies many contentions arose as to who were liable. 234 GENERAL POLITICAL CONDITIONS trates to examine and approve and decide between ; there are or- phans whose status must be examined ; and guardians of prisoners to appoint. 5. These, be it borne in mind, are all matters of yearly occurrence; while at intervals there are exemptions and absten- tions from mihtary service which call for adjudication, or in con- nection with some extraordinary misdemeanor, some case of outrage and violence of an exceptional character, or some charge of impiety. A whole list of others I simply omit ; I am content to have named the most important part with the exception of the as- sessments of tribute which occur, as a rule, at intervals of five years. I put it to you, then : can any one suppose that all or any of these disputes may dispense with adjudication ? If so, will any one say which ought, and which ought not to be adjudicated on, there and then ? 6. If, on the other hand, we are forced to admit that these are all fair cases for adjudication, it follows of necessity that they should be decided during the twelve-month ; since even now the boards of judges sitting right through the year are powerless to stay the tide of evildoing by reason of the multitude of the people. 7. So far so good. "But," some one will say, "try the cases you certainly must, but lessen the number of the jurors." Yet if so, it follows of necessity that unless the number of courts them- selves are diminished, there will be only a few jurors sitting in each court; with the further consequence that in dealing with so small a body of jurors it will be easier for a litigant to present an invulnerable front to the court, and to bribe the whole body, to the great detriment of justice. 8. But besides this we cannot escape the conclusion that the Athenians have their festivals to keep, during which the courts cannot sit. As a matter of fact these festivals are twice as numer- ous as those of any other people. However I will reckon them as merely equal to those of the state which has the fewest. This being so, I maintain that it is not possible for business affairs at Athens to stand on any very different footing from the present, except to some slight extent, by adding here and deducting -there. Any large modification is out of the question, short of cur- tailing the democracy itself. 9. No doubt many expedients might be discovered for improving the constitution, but if the problems be to discover some adequate means of .making it better while INTERSTATE DEMOCRACY 235 at the same time the democracy is to remain intact, I say it is not easy to do this, except, as I have just stated, to the extent of some trifling addition here or deduction there. 10. There is another point in which it is sometimes felt that the Athenians are ill advised, in their adoption, namely, of the less re- spectable party, in those states divided by faction. But they do this advisedly. If they chose the more respectable, they would not be choosing those who held convictions identical with their own ; for there is no state in which the best element is friendly to the people. It is the worst element which in every state favors the democracy — on the principle that like favors like. The case is simple enough. The Athenians choose what is most akin to them- selves. II. Also on every occasion on which they have attempted to side with the better classes, it has not fared well with them, but within a short interval the democratic party has been enslaved, as for instance in Boeotia ; ^ or, as when they chose the aristocrats of the Milesians, and within a short time these nobles revolted ^ and cut the people to pieces ; or, as when they chose the Lacedaemonians as against the Messenians,' and within a short time the Lacedaemo- nians subjugated the Messenians and went to war against Athens. 12. I seem to overhear a retort, "No one, of course, has been deprived of his civil rights at Athens unjustly." My answer is, that there are some who are unjustly deprived of their civil rights, though the cases are certainly rare. But it will take more than a few to attack the democracy at Athens. 13. You may consider it an established fact that it is not the man who has lost his civil rights justly who takes the matter to heart, but the victims, if any, of injustice. Yet how in the world can any one imagine that many are in a state of civil disability at Athens, where the People and the holders of office are one and the same ? It is from iniquitous exer- cise of office, from iniquity exhibited either in speech or action, and the like circumstances, that citizens are punished with deprivation ' After the battle of Tanagra, 457. This passage is discussed by Botsford, in Pol. Set. Quart, xxv (1910). 281-3. 2 The Lesbian revolt took place in 428 (Thuc. iii. 2 sgq.), shortly before the com- position of this oligarchic treatise. ' The author here refers to the aid brought by Cimon to the Lacedaemonians who were besieging the helots on Mount Ithome, 462 ; Thucydides i. 102 ; Plutarch, Cimon, 16; Aristophanes, Lysistrate, 1143; Botsford, Hellenic History, ch. xii. 236 GENERAL POLITICAL CONDITIONS of civil rights in Athens. Due reflection on these matters will serve to dispel the notion that there is any danger at Athens from persons visited with disfranchisement. 63. The First Ideal Constitution iXhe Constitution of Hippodamus of Miletus, summarized and commented upon by Aristotle, Politics, ii. 8, 1267 a sq. Jowett, verified by E. G. S.) The two selections last given represent the beginnings of political thought in the criticism and comparison of existing forms of government. Another line of political study, beginning nearly at the same time and running parallel, was the creation of ideal constitutions. The first constitution of the kind was that of Hippodamus, a contemporary of Pericles. As a civil engineer he had planned the cities of Peirseus and Thurii (Italy) ; see Botsford, Hellenic History, ch. xvii. ch. 8. I. Hippodamus, son of Euryphon, a native of Miletus, the same who invented the art of planning cities, and who also laid out Peirseus, was a strange man, whose fondness for distinction led him into a general eccentricity of life, which made some think him affected ; for he would wear flowing hair and expensive ornaments ; and yet he dressed himself in the same cheap warm garment both in winter and in summer. Besides aspiring to be an adept in the knowledge of nature, he was the first person not a statesman who made inquiries about the best form of government. 2. The city of Hippodamus was composed of 10,000 citizens divided into three parts, — one of artisans, one of husbandmen, and a third of armed defenders of the state. 3. He also divided the land into three parts, one sacred, one public, the third private. The' first was set apart to maintain the customary worship of the gods, the second was to support the warriors, the third was the prop- erty of the husbandman. 4. He also divided his laws into three classes, and no more ; for he maintained that there are three sub- jects of lawsuits, — insult, injury, and homicide. He hkewise instituted a single final court of appeal, to which all cases seemuig to have been improperly decided might be referred ; this court he formed of elders chosen for the purpose. 5. He was further of the opinion that the decisions of the courts ought not to be given by the use of a voting pebble, but that every one should have a tablet on CONSTITUTION OF HIPPODAMUS 237 which he might not only write a simple condemnation, or leave the tablet blank for a simple acquittal ; but, if he partly acquitted and partly condemned, he was to distinguish accordingly. To the existing law he objected that it obliged the judges to be guilty of perjury, whichever way they voted. 6. He also enacted that those who discovered anything for the good of the state should be re- warded ; and he provided that the children of citizens who died in battle should be maintained at the public expense, as if such an enactment had never been heard of before ; yet it actually exists at Athens ' and in other places. 7. As to the magistrates, he would have them all elected by the people, — that is, by the three classes already mentioned, and those who were elected were to watch over the interests of the public, of strangers, and of orphans. These are the most striking points in the constitution of Hippodamus. There is not much else. The first of these proposals to which objection may be taken, is the threefold division of the citizens. 8. The artisans, the husband- men, and the warriors, all have a share in the govenmient. But the husbandmen have no arms, and the»artisans neither arms nor land, and therefore they become all but slaves of the warrior class. 9. That they should share in all the offices is an impossibility ; for generals and the guardians of the citizens, and nearly all the prin- cipal magistrates, must be taken from the class of those who carry arms. Yet if the two other classes have no share in the government, how can they be loyal citizens ? It may be said that those who have arms must necessarily be masters of both the other classes, but this is not so easily accomplished unless they are numerous. 10. If however they are, why should the other classes share in the govern- ment at all, or have power to appoint magistrates? Artisans there must be ; for they are wanted in every city, and they can live by their craft, as elsewhere ; and the husbandmen, too, if they really provided the warriors with food, might fairly have a share in the government. But in the republic of Hippodamus they are sup- posed to have land of their own, which they cultivate for their private benefit. 11. Again, as to this common land out of which the soldiers are maintained, if they are themselves to be the cul- tivators of it, the' warrior class will be identical with the husband- 1 See Thuc. ii. 46 {Funeral Oration of Pericles) ; no. 64. 238 GENERAL POLITICAL CONDITIONS men, although the legislator intended to make a distinction between them. If, again, there are to be other cultivators distinct both from the husbandmen, who have land of their own, and from the warriors, they will make a fourth class, which has no place in the ' state and no share in anything. 12. Or if the same persons are to cultivate their own lands and those of the public as well, they will have a difl&culty in supplying the quantity of produce which will maintain two households : and why in this case should there be any division, for they might find food themselves and give to the warriors from the same lots? There is surely a great confusion in all this. 13. Neither is the law to be commended which says that the judges, when a simple issue is laid before them, should distinguish in their judgment ; for the judge is thus converted into an arbitrator. Now, in an arbitration, although the arbitrators are many, they confer with one another about the decision, and therefore they can distinguish ; but in courts of law this is impossible ; and in fact most legislators take pains to prevent the judges from holding any communication with one another. 14. Again, will there not be con- fusion if the judge thinks that damages should be given, but not so much as the suitor demands ? He asks, say, for twenty minae, and the judge allows him ten minae, or one judge more and another less ; one five, another four minae. In this way they will go on appor- tioning the damages, and some will grant the whole and others nothing. 15. How is the final reckoning to be taken? Again, no one who votes for a simple acquittal or condemnation is compelled to perjure himself, if the indictment is quite simple and in right form ; for the judge who acquits does not decide that the defendant owes nothing, but that he does not owe the twenty minae. He only is guilty of perjury who thinks that the defendant ought not to pay twenty minae, and yet condemns him. 16. To reward those who discover anything which is useful to the state is a proposal which has a specious sound, but cannot safely be enacted by law ; for it may encourage informers, and perhaps even lead to political commotions. This question involves another. It has been doubted whether it is or is not expedient to make any changes in the laws of a country, even if another law be better. 17. Now if all changes are inexpedient, we can hardly assent to the SHALL LAWS BE CHANGED? 239 proposal of Hippodamus; for under pretence of doing a public service, a man may introduce measures which are really destructive to the laws or to the constitution. But since we have touched upon this subject, (18) perhaps we had better go a little into detail ; for as I was saying, there is a difference of opinion, and it may sometimes seem desirable to make changes. Such changes in the other arts and sciences have certainly been beneficial ; medicine, for example, and gymnastic and every other art and science have departed from traditional usage. If accordingly politics be an art, change must be necessary ia this as in any other art. 19. The need of improvement is shown by the fact that old customs are exceedingly simple and barbarous. For the ancient Hellenes went about armed, and bought their wives of each other. 20. The remains of ancient laws which have come down to us are quite absurd ; for example, at CymS there is a law about murder, to the effect that if the accuser produce a certain number of witnesses from among his own kinsmen, the accused shall be held guilty. 64. Athenian Character and Ideals (Pericles, Funeral Oration, in Thucydides ii. 35-46. Jowett, revised by E. G. S.) Pericles, who brought his community to a summit of civilization never before reached by the human race, expressed in his own pubUc life the noblest aspirations of his age. No one could doubt the competence of this man of clear, penetrating vision to interpret the character and ideals of his people. This task he sets before himself in the Funeral Oration delivered over those who fell in the first year of the great war with Peloponnesus, 431. As given by Thucydides, the essential ideas are those of the statesman, but the style is certainly that of the historian (p. 29 supra), who in inserting this oration in his narrative after the dose of the war, undoubtedly colored even the thought with somber hues from his city's overthrow in 404. However the credit may be divided between Pericles and Thucydides, the speech is certainly one of the most precious documents which treat of the history of civilization. See Zim- mern, Greek Commonwealth, ,a large part of which is avowedly a commentary on this document. For a briefer interpretation in the same spirit, see Ferguson, Greek Imperialism, lect. ii. 35. Most of those'TOio have spoken here before me have com- mended the lawgiver who added this oration to our other funeral , customs; it seemed to them a worthy thing that such an honor 240 GENERAL POLITICAL CONDITIONS should be given at their burial to the dead who have fallen on the field of battle. But I should have preferred that, when men's deeds have been brave, they should be honored in deed only^ and with such an honor as this public funeral, which you are now wit- nessing. Then the reputation of many would not have been im- perilled by the eloquence or want of eloquence of one, and their virtues believed or not as he spoke well or ill. For it is difficult to say neither too little nor too much; and even moderation is apt not to give the impression of truthfulness. The friend of the dead who knows the facts is likely to think that the words of the speaker fall short of his knowledge and of his wishes ; another who is not so well informed, when he hears of anything which surpasses his own powers, will be envious and will suspect exaggeration. Man- kind are tolerant of the praises of others so long as each hearer thinks that he can do as well or nearly as well himself ; but when the speaker rises above him, jealousy is aroused and he begins to be incredulous. However, since our ancestors have set the seal of their approval upon the practice, I must obey, and to the utmost of my power shall endeavor to satisfy the wishes and beliefs of all who hear me. 36. I will speak first of our ancestors, for it is right and becoming that now, when we are lamenting the dead, a tribute should be paid to their memory. There has never been a time when they did not inhabit this land, which by their valor they have handed down from generation to generation, and we have received from them a free state. But if they were worthy of praise, still more were our fathers, who added to their inheritance, and after many a struggle trans- mitted to us, their sons, this great empire. And we ourselves as- sembled here to-day, who are still most of us in the vigor of life, have chiefly done the work of improvement, and have richly en- dowed our city with all things ; so that she is sufficient for herself both in peace and war.^ Of the military exploits by which our various possessions were acquired, or of the energy with which we or our fathers drove back the tide of war, Hellenic or Barbarian, ' Because of the insecurity of commerce in Hellenic times, and of the dangers which continually threatened the communications of every city-state with the outside world, the general policy of statesmen was to make their communities as self-su£Eicing as lie. HOW ATHENS BECAME GREAT 241 I will not speak ; for the tale would be long and is familiar to you. But before I praise the dead, I should like to point out by what principles of action we rose to power, and under what institutions and through what manner of life our empire became great. For I co'nicei^e. that such thoughts are not unsuited to the occasion, and that this numerous assembly of citizens and strangers may profit- ably listen to them. '"37. Our form of government does not enter into rivalry with the institutions of others. We do not copy our neighbors, but are an example to them. It is true that we are called a democracy, for the administration is in the hands of the many and not of the few. But while the law secures equal justice to all alike in their private disputes, the claim of excellence is also recognized; and when a citizen is in any way distinguished, he is preferred to the public service, not as a matter of privilege, but as the reward of merit. Neither is poverty a bar, but a man may benefit his coun try what- ever be the obscurity of his condition. There is no exclusiveness in our public life, and in our private intercourse we are not sus- picious of one another, nor angry with -our neighbor if he does what he likes ; we do not put on sour looks at him which, though harm- less, are not pleasant. While we are thus uyconstrained in our private intercourse, a spirit of reverence pervades our public acts ; we are prevented from doing wrong by respect for authority and for the laws, having an especial regard to those which are ordained for the protection of the injured as well as to those unwritten laws which bring upon the transgressor of them the reprobation of the general sentiment. 38. And we have not forgotten to provide for our weary spirits many relaxations from toil ; we have regular games and sacrifices throughout the year ; at home the style of our Uf e is refined ; and the delight which we daily feel in all these things helps to banish sadness. Because of the greatness of our city the fruits of the whole earth flow in upon us ; so that we enjoy the goods of other countries as freely as of our own. 39. Then, again, our military training is in many respects su- perior to that of our adversaries. , Our city is thrown open to the world, and we never expel a foreigner, or prevent him from seeing or learning anything of which the secret, if revealed to an enemy, 242 GENERAL POLITICAL CONDITIONS might profit him.^ We rely not upon management or trickery, but upon our own hearts and hands. And in the matter of educa- tion, whereas they from early youth are always undergoing laborious exercises which are to make them brave, we live at ease, and yet are equally ready to face the perils which they face. And here is the proof. The Lacedaemonians come into Attica not by them- selves, but with their whole confederacy following; we go alone into a neighbor's country ; and although our opponents are fighting for their homes and we on a foreign soil, we have seldom any diffi- culty in overcoming them. Our enemies have never yet felt our united strength ; the care of a navy divides our attention, and on land we are obliged to send our own citizens everywhere. But they, if they meet and defeat a part of our army, are as proud as if they had routed us all, and when defeated they pretend to have been vanquished by us all. If, then, we prefer to meet danger with a light heart but without laborious training, and with a courage which is gained by habit and not enforced by law, are we not greatly the gainers ? Since we do not anticipate the pain, although, when the hour comes, we can be as brave as .those who never allow themselves to rest ; and thus too our city is equally admirable in peace and in war. 40. For we are lovers of the beautiful, yet simple in our tastes, and we cultivate the mind without loss of manliness. Wealth we employ, not for talk and ostentation, but when there is a real use for it. To avow poverty with us is no disgrace ; the true disgrace is in doing nothing to avoid it. An Athenian citizen does not neglect the state because he takes care of his own household ; and even those of us who are engaged in business have a very fair idea of politics. We alone regard a man who takes no interest in public affairs, not as a harmless but as a useless character ; and if few of us are originators, we are all sound judges of a policy. The great impediment to action is, in our opinion, not discussion, but the want of that knowledge which is gained by discussion preparatory to action. For we have a peculiar power of thinking before we act and of acting too, whereas other men are courageous from ignorance but hesitate upon reflection. Further, they are surely to be esteemed the bravest spirits who, having the ' In contrasting the Athenians with "others," Pericles has especially the Lacedae- monians in mind. THE SCHOOL OF HELLAS 243 clearest sense both of the pains and pleasures of life, do not on that account shrink from danger. In doing good, again, we are unlike others ; we make our friends by conferring, not by receiving, favors. Now he who confers a favor is the firmer friend, because he would fain by kindness keep alive the memory of an obligation ; but the recipient is colder in his feelings, because he knows that in requiting another's generosity he will not be winning gratitude but only paying a debt. We alone do good to our neighbors not upon a calculation of interest, but in the confidence of freedom and in a frank and fearless spirit./ 41. To sum up : I say that Athens is the school of Hellas, and that the individual Athenian in his own per- son seems to have the power of adapting himself to the most varied forms of action with the utmost versatility and grace. This is no passing and idle word, but truth and fact; and the assertion is verified by the position to which these qualities have raised the state. For in the hour of trial Athens alone among her contem- poraries is superior to the report of her. No enemy who comes against her is indignant at the reverses which he sustains at the hands of such a city; no subject complains that his masters are unworthy of him. It is true, too, that we shall assuredly not be without witnesses; there are mighty monuments of our power which wiU make us the wonder of this and of succeeding ages; we shall not need the praises of Homer or any other panegyrist whose poetry may please for the moment, although his representation of the facts will not bear the light of day. For we have compelled every land and every sea to open a path for our valor, and have everywhere planted eternal memorials of our friendship and of our enmity. Such is the city for whose sake these men nobly fought and died ; they could not bear the thought that she might be taken from them ; and every one of us who survive should gladly toil on her behalf. 42. I have dwelt upon the greatness of Athens because I want to show you that we are contending for a higher prize than those who enjoy none of these privileges, and to establish by manifest proof the merit of these men whom I am now commemorating. Their loftiest praise has been already spoken. For in magnifying the city I have magnified them, and men like them whose virtues made her glorious. Of how few Hellenes can it be said as of them, that 244 GENERAL POLITICAL CONDITIONS their deeds when weighed in the balance have been found equal to their fame ! Methinks that a death such as theirs has been gives the true measure of a man's worth ; it may be the first revelation of his virtues, but is at any rate their final seal. For even those who come short in other ways may justly plead the valor with which they have fought for their country ; they have blotted out the evil with the good, and have benefited the state more by their public services than they have injured her by their private actions. None of these men were enervated by wealth or hesitated to resign the pleasures of life ; none of them put off the evil day in the hope, natural to poverty, that a man, though poor, may one day become rich. But deeming that the punishment of their enemies was sweeter than any of these things, and that they could fall in no nobler cause, they determined at the hazard of their lives to be honorably avenged, and to leave the rest. They resigned to hope their unknown chance of happiness ; but in the face of death they resolved to rely upon themselves alone. And when the moment came they were minded to resist and suffer, rather than to fly and save their lives ; they ran away from the word of dishonor, but on the battle-field their feet stood fast, and in an instant, at the height of their fortune, they passed away from the scene, not of their fear, but of their glory. 43. Such was the end of these men ; they were worthy of Athens, and the living need not desire to have a more heroic spirit, although they may pray for a less fatal issue. The value of such a spirit is not to be expressed in words. Any one can discourse to you for ever about the advantages of a brave defence which you know already. But instead of listening to him I would have you day by day fix your -eyes upon the greatness of Athens, until you become filled with the love of her; and when you are impressed by the spectacle of her glory, reflect that this empire has been acquired by men who knew their duty and had the courage to do it, who in the hour of conflict had the fear of dishonor always present to them, and who, if ever they failed in an enterprise, would not allow their virtues to be lost to their country, but freely gave their lives to her as the fairest offering which they could present at her feast. The sacrifice which they collectively made was individually repaid to them ; for they received again each one for himself a praise which TO DIE FOR COUNTRY 245 grows not old, and the noblest of all sepulchers — I speak not of that in which their remains are laid, but of that in which their glory survives, and is proclaimed always and on every fitting oc- casion both in word and deed. For the whole earth is the sepulcher of famous men ; not only are they commemorated by columns and inscriptions in their own country, but in foreign lands there dwells also an unwritten memorial of them, graven not on stone but in the hearts of men. Make them your examples; and esteeming courage to be freedom and freedom to be happiness, do not weigh too nicely the perils of war. The unfortunate who has no hope of a change for the better has less reason to throw away his life than the prosperous who, if he survive, is always Kable to a change for the worse, and to whom any accidental fall makes the most serious difference. ^ To a man of spirit, cowardice and disaster coming together are far more bitter than death striking him unperceived at a time when he is full of courage and animated by the general hope. 44. Wherefore I do not now commiserate the parents of the dead who stand here ; I would rather comfort them. You know that your life has been passed amid manifold vicissitudes ; and that they may be deemed fortunate who have gained most honor, whether an honorable death like theirs, or an honorable sorrow like yours, and whose days have been so ordered that the term of their hap- piness is likewise the term of their life. I know how hard it is to make you feel this, when the good fortune of others will too often remind you of the gladness which once lightened, your hearts. Sorrow is felt at the want of those blessings, not which a man never knew, but which were a part of his life before they were taken from him. Some of you are of an age at which they may hope to have other children, and they ought to bear their sorrow better ; not only will the children who may hereafter be born make them forget their own lost ones, but the city will be doubly a gainer. She will not be left desolate, and she will be safer. For a man's counsel cannot have equal weight or worth, when he alone has no children to risk in the general danger. To those of you who have passed their prime, I say : " Congratulate yourselves that you have been happy during the greater part of your days ; remember that your life of sorrow will not last long, and be comforted by the glory of those 246 GENERAL POLITICAL CONDITIONS who are gone. For the love of honor alone is ever young, and not riches, as some say, but honor is the delight of men when they are old and useless. 45. To you who are the sons and brothers of the departed, I see that the struggle to emulate them will be an arduous one. For all men praise the dead, and however preeminent your virtue may be, hardly will you be thought, I do not say to equal, but even to ap- proach them. The living have their rivals and detractors, but when a man is out of the way, the honor and good-will which he receives is unalloyed. And if I am to speak of womanly virtues to those of you who will henceforth be widows, let me sum them up in one short admonition : To a woman not to show more weakness than is nat- ural to her sex is a great glory, and not to be talked about for good or for evil among men. 46. I have paid the required tribute, in obedience to the law, making use of such fitting words as I had. The tribute of deeds has been paid in part ; for the dead have been honorably interred, and it remains only that their children should be maintained at the public charge until they are grown up : this is the solid prize with which, as with a garland, Athens crowns her sons living and dead, after a struggle like theirs. For where the rewards of virtue are greatest, there the noblest citizens are enlisted in the service of the state. And now, when you have duly lamented, every one his own dead, you may depart. / 65. Athenian and Lacedaemonian Policy and Character Contrasted {Speech of Corinthian deputies in the Peloponnesian Congress at Sparta, 432, as given by Thucydides i. 68-71. Jowett, revised, on the basis of a com- parison of the Greek text, by E. G. S.) This selection is placed with those which immediately precede, to represent, in the conflict of feelings and of interests which resulted in the Peloponnesian war, a view hostile to Athens. The Corinthian speech and the reply of the Athenians given immediately afterward by Thucydides i. 72-8, but not in- cluded in this volume, are masterpieces of pure political reasoning, and they set forth, not merely the political status and the underlying sentiment in the leading states as they were before the outbreak of the Peloponnesian war, but also involve a retrospect of the political development of the /Egean world as it passed through the half cfentury which elapsed since Salamis and Plataea. GRIEVANCES AGAINST ATHENS 247 68. The spirit of trust, LacedEemonians, which animates your own poHtical and social Hfe, makes you distrust others who, like ourselves, have something unpleasant to say, and this temper of mind, though favorable to moderation, too often leaves you in ignorance of what is going on outside your own country. Time after time we have warned you of the mischief which the Athenians would do to us ; but instead of taking our words to heart, you chose to suspect that we only spoke from interested motives. And this is the reason why you have summoned these alhes here to Sparta too late, — not before but after the injury has been inflicted, and when we are smarting under the sense of it. Of all persons who has a better right to speak than ourselves, who have the heaviest ac- cusations to make, outraged as we are by the Athenians, and neg- lected by you? If the crimes which they are committing against Hellas were being done in a corner, then you might be ignorant, and we should have to inform you of them : but now, what need of many words? Some of us, as you see, have already been en- slaved ; they are at this moment intriguing against others, notably against allies of ours ; and long ago they ha.d made all their prepara- tions in expectation of war. Else why did they seduce from her allegiance Corcyra, which they still hold in defiance of us, and why are they blockading Potidsea, — the latter a most advantageous post for the command of the Thracian peninsula, the former a great naval power which might have assisted the Peloponnesians ? ^ 69. And the blame of all this rests on you ; for you originally allowed them to fortify their city after the Persian War,^ and after- wards to build their Long Walls ; ' and to this hour you have gone on depriving of liberty not only tho§e enslaved by them but are now beginning to take it away even from your own aUies. For the true enslaver of a people is he who can put an end to their slavery but has no care about it ; and all the more, if he be reputed the champion of liberty in Hellas. — And barely now have we met in a congress and not even yet on the basis of a clear- situation. By this ' Athens had recently made a defensive alliance with Corcyra, a colony of Corinth. Potidaea, another colony of Corinth, had long been a tributary member of the Athenian empire but had recently revolted. The Athenians accordingly were attempting by blockade to reduce the city. See Thucydides i. 24 sqq. ; Bury, History of Greece, ch. X. § I ; Botsford, Hellenic History, ch. xvii (init.). * See Thucydides i. 90-92. 'The walls connecting Athens with Peiraeus; Thuc. i.-io7. 248 GENERAL POLITICAL CONDITIONS time we ought to have been considering, not whether we are wronged, but how we are to be revenged. The aggressor is not now threatening, but advancing; he has made up his mind, while we are resolved about nothing. And we know too well by what road and how little by little the Athenians move upon their neighbors. While they think that you are too dull to observe them, they are more careful, but when they perceive that you with full knowledge overlook their aggressions, they will strike and not spare. Of all Hellenes, Lacedaemonians, you are the only people who keep at rest warding off (an enemy) not with your active power but with delay : and you are the only people who do not destroy the increase of your foes in the beginning but when it has grown to fulness. How came you to be considered safe? That reputation of yours was never justified by facts. We all know that the Persian made his way from the ends of the earth against Peloponnesus before you encountered him in a worthy manner ; and now you are blind to the doings of the Athenians, who are not at a distance as he was, but close at hand. Instead of attacking your enemy, you wait to be attacked, and take the chances of a struggle which has been deferred until his power is doubled. And you know that the Barbarian miscarried chiefly through his own error ; and that we have oftener been delivered from these very Athenians by blunders of their own, than by aid from you. Some have already been ruined by the hopes which you inspired in them ; for so entirely did they trust you that they took no precautions themselves. These things we say in no accusing or hostile spirit — let that be understood — but by way of expostulation. For men expostulate with erring friends, they bring accusation against enemies who have done them a wrong. 70. Still we have a right to find fault, with our neighbors, if any one ever had. There are important interests at stake to which, as far as we can see, you are insensible. You have never considered what manner of men are these Athenians with whom you will have to fight, and how utterly unlike yourselves. They are ready to resort to novel devices, equally quick in the conception and in the execution of every new plan ; while you are conservative — careful only to keep what you have, originating nothing, and in execution achieving not even what is urgently necessary. Again they are SPARTANS AND ATHENIANS CONTRASTED 249 bold beyond their strength ; they run risks which prudence would condemn ; and in critical situations they are full of hope. Whereas it is your way to have your action fall short of your strength and of your conviction to put faith not even in sound things: when calamities come upon you, to think that you will never be delivered from them. They are impetuous, and you are dilatory ; they are always abroad, and you are always at home. For they hope to gain something by leaving their homes; but you are afraid that any new enterprise may impair what you have already. When conquerors, they pursue their victory to the utmost ; when defeated, they faU back the least. In behalf of their commonwealth they make use of the physical service of men who are complete strangers to Athens ; while the directing mind is in supreme degree Athens' own.^ When they do not carry out an intention which they have formed, they seem to have sustained a personal bereavement; when an enterprise succeeds, they have gained but an iustalment of what is to come ; if they fail, however, they at once conceive new hopes and so fill up the void. With them alone to hope is to have, for they lose not a moment in the execution of an idea. This is the life-long task, full of danger and toil, which they are always imposing upon themselves. None enjoy their good things less, because they are always engaged in acquisition. To do their duty is their only hoKday, and they deem the quiet of inaction to be as disagreeable as the most laborious occupation. Therefore if a man should say of them, in a word, that they were born neither to have peace them- selves nor to allow peace to other men, he would simply speak the truth. 71. In the face of such an enemy, Lacedaemonians, you procrasti- nate and you do not believe that peace is most enduring to those who use their preparation for Just action, but are clearly minded not to yield if they be wronged, whereas justice with you seems to consist in giving no annoyance to others and in defending yourselves only against positive injury. But this policy would hardly be successful, even if your neighbors were like yourselves ; and in the present case, as we pointed out just now, your ways compared with theirs are 1 Jowett's rendering is quite different : "Their bodies they devote to their country as though they belonged to other men; their true self is their mind, which is most truly their own when employed in her service." 250 GENERAL POLITICAL CONDITIONS old-fashioned. Furthermore, as in the arts, so also in politics, the new must always prevail over the old. In settled times the tradi- tions of government should be observed : but when circumstances are changing and men are compelled to meet them, much additional devising is required. The Athenians have had a wider experience, and therefore the administration of their state has adopted novelties in a greater degree than yours. But here let your procrastination end; send an army at once into Attica and assist especially the Potidaeans, to whom your word is pledged. Do not allow friends and kindred to fall into the hands of their worst enemies; nor drive us in despair to seek the alliance of others ; in taking such a course we should be doing nothing wrong either before the gods who are the witnesses of our oaths, or before men whose eyes are upon us. For the true breakers of treaties are not those who, when forsaken, turn to others, but those who forsake allies whom they have sworn to defend. We will remain your friends if you choose to bestir yourselves ; for we should be guilty of an impiety if we deserted you without cause ; and we shall not easily find alhes equally congenial to us. Take heed then : you have inherited from your fathers the leadership of Peloponnesus ; see that her greatness suffers no dimi- nution at your hands. 66. The Revolution at Corcyra, 427; the Morals of Political Seditions (Thucydides iii. 81-3. Jowett, revised, on the basis of a comparison of the Greek text, by E. G. S.) Shortly before the events mentioned in the following selection the oligarchs of Corcyra had seized the government, put down the democracy, and murdered the leading men among their opponents ; Busolt, Grieck. Gesch. III. 1040 sqq. Hearing soon afterward that a Peloponnesian fleet was sailing to the support of the oligarchy, the Athenians despatched Eurymedon with sixty triremes to Corcyra for the protection of their own interests in that island ; Thuc. iii. 80. After devastating the country, the Peloponnesians, on the- approach of -the Athenian fleet, withdrew, leaving the Corcyraean oUgarchs in the lurch. The relentless keenness, the depth, and the undoubted truth of this analysis of the motives and the character of political factions, which not only imdermined the foundations of right conduct, but even distorted the terms and phrases of current judgment, make the passage here quoted one of the most remarkable in the history of literature.^ A BLOODY REVOLUTION 251 81. The Pelopoimesians set out that very night on their way home, keeping close to the land, and transporting the ships over the Leucadian isthmus, that they might not be seen sailing round. When the Corcyraeans perceived that the Athenian fleet was ap- proaching, while that of the enemy disappeared, they took the Messenian troops, who had hitherto been outside the walls, into the city, and ordered the ships which they had manned to sail round into the Hyllaic harbor. These vessels proceeded on their way. Meanwhile they killed any of their enemies whom they caught in the city. On the arrival of the ships they disembarked those whom they had induced to go on board, and despatched them ; they also went to the temple of Hera, and persuading about fifty of the suppliants to stand their trial, condemned them all to death."^ The majority of the suppUants would not come out, and when they saw what was going on, destroyed one another in the enclosure of the temple where they were, except a few who hung themselves on trees, or put an end to their own lives in any other way which they could. During the seven days, too, while Eury- medon after his arrival remained with his sixty ships, the Cor- cyraeans continued slaughtering those of their fellow-citizens whom they deemed their enemies ; they professed to punish them for their designs against the democracy, but in fact some were killed from motives of personal enmity, and some because money was owing to them, by the hands of their debtors. Every form of death was to be seen, and as is wont to be the case in such a crisis, there was nothing that did not come to pass, and in fact there was more than ever.^ For the father slew the son, and the suppliants were torn from the temples and slain near them ; some of them were even walled up in the temple of Dionysus, and there perished. 82. To such extremes of cruelty did revolution go; and this seemed to be the worst of revolutions, because it was the first. For afterward even the whole Hellenic world was stirred in civil dis- order; in every city the chiefs of the democracy and of the oligarchy were struggling, the one to bring in the Athenians, the other the ' Here the democrats, regaining the upper hand and looking to Athenian support, began to retaliate upon the oligarchs. " This statement is hyperbolical ; the author means to express the unusual character of the proceedings. will be while human nature Dr less aggravated and differ fall under the dominion of takes away the comfortable 252 GENERAL POLITICAL CONDITIONS Lacedjemonians. Now in time of/peace, men would have had no excuse for introducing either, and Iwould not be ready to do so, but when they were at war and both\sides could easily obtain allies to the hurt of their enemies and th\ advantage of themselves, the dissatisfied party were only too readyAto invoke foreign aid. Thus revolution brought upon the cities of |Hellas many terrible calami- ties, such as have been and always remains the same, but which are more in character with every new combination of circumstances. In peace and prosperity both states and individuals are actuated by higher motives, because they do not imperious necessities ; but war, which provision of daily life, is a hard master ,\9,nd tends to assimilate the wrathful excitement of the many to the prevailing situation.' When troubles had once begun in the cities, those who followed carried the revolutionary spirit further and further, and determined, by the ingenuity of their enterprise and the atrocity of their re- venges, to outdo the report of all who had preceded them. The meaning of words had no longer the same relation to things, but was changed by them as they thought proper. Reckless daring was held to be loyal courage ; prudent delay was specious coward- ice; moderation was the disguise of unmanly weakness; to be thoughtful in meeting every issue was inactivity. Frantic energy was the true quaUty of a man. A conspirator who wanted to be safe was a recreant in disguise. The lover of violence was always trusted, and his opponent suspected. He who succeeded in a plot was deemed knowing, but a still greater master in craft was he who detected one. On the other hand, he who plotted from the first to have nothing to do with plots was a breaker up of his faction and a poltroon who was afraid of the enemy. In a word, he who could outstrip another in a bad action was applauded, and so was he who encouraged to evil one who had no idea of it. The tie of party was stronger than the tie of blood, because a partisan was more ready to dare without asking why. In fact party associations are not based upon any established law, nor.do they seek the public good ; they are founded in defiance of the laws and from self-interest. The seal ' irpbs T& ■irap6rra tAs dfryiis rCiv iroWuJi' hjiaiaX; the translation of this clause here given is more predse than that of Jowett. THE MORALS OF FACTIONS 253 of good faith was not divine law but fellowship in crime. If an enemy when he was in the ascendant offered fair words, the opposite party received them not in a generous spirit, but with a jealous watchfulness of his actions. Revenge was dearer than self-preser- vation. Any agreements sworn to by either party, when they could do nothing else, were binding for the moment only, when they had no strength from other sources. But he who on a favorable opportunity first took courage and struck at his enemy when he saw him undefended, had greater pleasure in a perfidious than he would have had in an open act of revenge. He congratulated him- self that he had taken the safer course, and also that he had over- reached his enemy and gained the prize of superior ability. In general, the dishonest more easily gain credit for cleverness than the simple for goodness; men take a pride in the one, but are ashamed of the other. The cause of all these evils was the love of power, originating in avarice and ambition, and the party-spirit which is engendered by them when men are fairly embarked in a contest. For the leaders on either side used specious names^ the one party professing to uphold the constitutional equality of the many, the other the wisdom of an aristocracy, while they made the public interests, to which in name they were devoted, in reality their prize. Striv- ing in every way to overcome each other, they committed the most monstrous crimes; yet even they were surpassed by the magni- tude of their revenges which they pursued to the very utmost, neither party observing any definite limits either of justice or public expediency, but both alike making the caprice of the moment their law. Either by the help of an imrighteous sentence, or grasping power with a strong hand, they were eager to satiate the love of victory ^ of the moment. Neither faction cared for religion ; but any specious pretence which succeeded in effecting some odious purpose was greatly lauded. And the citizens who held an inter- mediate position fell a prey to both sides ; either they were disliked because they held aloof, or men were jealous of their surviving. 83. Thus revolution gave birth to every form of wickedness in Hellas. The simplicity which is so large an element in a noble » TJJK airlxa (piKoviKlav iKTiiarK&vai (StaM's text). 254 GENERAL POLITICAL CONDITIONS nature was laughed to scorn and disappeared. An attitude of perfidious antagonism everywhere prevailed; for there was no word binding enough, nor oath terrible enough to reconcile enemies. Each man was strong only in the conviction that nothing was secure ; he had to look to his own safety, and could not afEord to trust others. Inferior intellects generally succeeded best. For aware of their own deficiencies, and fearing the capacity of their . opponents, for whom they were no match in powers of speech, and whose subtle wits were likely to anticipate them in contriving evil, they struck boldly and at once. But the clever sort, presuming in their arrogance that they would be aware in time, and disdaining ■ to act when they could think, were taken off their guard and easily destroyed. BIBLIOGRAPHY Botsford, Hellenic History, chs. xii-xix; Ferguson, Greek Imperialism, 23 sqq. ; Bury, chs. viii-xi ; Holm, 11. chs. vi-xxviii ; Abbott, Greece, II. ch. vi to end of vol. Ill; Pericles and the Golden Age of Athens; Curtius, bk. III. ch. ii-bk. IV. ch. v ; Grote, chs. xliv-brv ; Freeman, History of Sicily. Zimmem, A. E., Greek Commonwealth (see Contents) ; Grundy, G. B., Thucydides and the History of his Age (London, 191 1) ; "Population and Policy of Sparta in the Fifth Century," in Journ. Hell. St. XXVIII (1908). 77-96. Meyer, Gesch. d. Alt. III. 418 to end of vol. IV; Beloch, Griech. Gesch. II. r. 74 to end of pt. ; Attische Politik seit Perikles (Leipzig, 1884) ; Busolt, Griech. Gesch. Ill entire ; Cavaignac, E., Histoire de I'antiquitS, II (Paris, 1913). 1-234; Etudes sur I' histoire financibre d'Athenes auV' sibde (Paris, 1908). Whibley, L., Political Parties at Athens in the Time of the Peloponnesian War (Cambridge: University Press, 1889) ; Croiset, M., Aristophanes and the Political Parties at Athens, trans, by J. Loeb (Macmillan, 1909) ; Stawell, F. M., "Pericles and Cleon in Thucydides," in Class. Quart. II (1908). 41-6; Gilbert, G., Beitrdge zur inneren Geschichte Athens im Zeitalter des Pdoponnesischen Krieges (Leipzig, 1877) ; Nestle, W., " Politik imd Aufklarung in Griechenland im Ausgang des V. Jahrhunderts v. Chr." in N. Jahrh. XXIV (1903). 1-22. CHAPTER VII THE CONFEDERACY OF DELOS AND THE ATHENIAN EMPIRE 478-404 B.C. 67. The First Step Toward Confederation (Herodotus ix. 106) In 479 a land force of Hellenes won the great battle of Platsea, Bceotia. Meanwhile their fleet crossed to Asia Minor, where the crews landed and won an equally splendid victory over the Persians intrenched at Mycale, a prom- ontory on the Ionian coast. The subsequent movement of the victors is well told by Herodotus in the following passage. « Having set fire to the wall and the ships, they sailed away; and when they came to Samos, the Hellenes deliberated about removing the inhabitants of Ionia, and considered where they ought to settle them in those parts of Hellas of which they had command, leaving Ionia to the Barbarians : for they considered it impossible for them to be always stationed as guards to protect the lonians, and unless they did protect them in this way, they had no hope that the lohians would escape with impunity from the Persians. It seemed good, therefore, to those of the Peloponne- sians who were in authority that they should remove the inhabitants of the trading ports which belonged to those peoples of HeUas who had taken the side of the Medes, and give that land to the< lonians to dwell in. The Athenians, however, did not think it good that the inhabitants of Ionia should be removed at all, nor that the Peloponnesians should consult about Athenian colonies; and as they vehemently resisted the proposal, the Peloponnesians gave way. The result was, accordingly, that they joined as allies to their league the Samians, Chians, Lesbians, and the other islanders who chanced to be serving with the Hellenes, binding them by 2SS 2S6 ■ DELIAN CONFEDERACY pledge and by oaths to remain faithful and not withdraw from the league. "Those in authority," here mentioned, were King Leotychidas of Lace- daemon and the ephors who accompanied him, whereas the chief admiral of the Athenians was Xanthippus, father of Pericles. The arbitrary transplanting of an entire people from one region to another was an Oriental custom totally foreign to Hellenic ideas. In repudiating it the Athenians were actuated, not only by their feeling of kinship with the lonians, but also by their ambition to build up an alliance of their own. While mentioning the admission of the Samians and other islanders to the general Hellenic league, Herodotus leaves the reader to infer the important fact that, at the same time, the Athenians entered into close relations of friendship and alliance with the lonians, perhaps also with other Asiatic Greeks. This was the slight beginning of a union which afterward developed into the Confederacy of Delos. 68. Organization of the Confederacy (Thucydides i. 95-6) The Lacedasmonians, however, might lo^ have retained the naval com- mand, had they possessed a competent admiral. During the siege of Byzan- tium by the Hellenes and after its fall, Pausanias, the Lacedaemonian com- mander, treated the lonians, Lesbians, and other newly acquired allies with such arrogance and brutality as to drive them to open rebeUion. They turned for leadership to Aristeides, Cimon, and the other generals in command of the Athenian contingent. Pausanias was recalled, and after another vain attempt to supply the Hellenes with an admiral, the Lacedaemonians shielded the naval leadership to Athens (Thuc. i. 95 ; Arist. Const. Ath. 23 ; Plut. Arist. 23). Henceforth the Lacedaemonians sent out no more conunanders, for they were afraid that those whom they appointed would be corrupted, as they had found to be the case with Pausanias ; they had had enough of the Persian war; and they thought that the Athenians were fully able to lead, and at that time believed them to be their friends. Thus the Athenians by the good-will of the allies, who detested Pausanias, obtained the leadership. They immediately fixed which of the cities should supply money and which of them ships for the war against the Barbarians, the avowed object being to compensate themselves and the allies for their losses by devastating the King's country. Then was first instituted at Athens the office of Hellenic THE FIRST ASSESSMENT 257 Treasurers,^ who received the tribute, for so the impost was termed. The amount was originally fixed at 460 talents. The island of Delos was the treasury, and the meetings of the allies were held in the temple.^ (Plutarch, Aristeides, 23 ; cf. Aristotle, Constitution of the Athenians, 23 ; for other sources, see Hill, Sources for Greek History, pp. 5-11) As they (the allies) wished each city to be assessed for a reason- able contribution, they asked the Athenians to appoint Aristeides to visit each city, learn the extent of its territory and revenues, and fix upon the amount which each was capable of contributing according to its means. Although he was in possession of such great power — the whole of Hellas ' having, as it were, given itself up to be dealt with at his discretion — yet he laid down his office a poorer man than when he accepted it, but having completed his assessment to the satisfaction of all.* As the ancients used to tell of the blessedness of the golden age, even so did the states of Hellas honor the assessment of Aristeides, calling the time when it was made, fortunate and blessed for Hellas. ■ ' There were ten Hellenic Treasurers ('EXXTjroTo^ioi), one elected from each of the ten Attic tribes ; CIA . i. no. 259 sqq. ; cf. i88. Naturally while the treasury re- mained in Delos, they were located there. The president of the federal council was also an Athenian, while Athenian generals served as commanders-in-chief of the federal army and navy. * The temple of Apollo, the seat of an Ionian (so-called DeUan) amphictyony, which reached the height of its splendor in the eighth and seventh centuries ; see the Homeric Hymn to the Delian Apollo; Thuc. iii. 104. In the winter of 426-5 the Athenians puri- fied the island, and revived the amphictyonic festival; Thuc. loc. cit. While the amphictyony served as a religious basis of the new union, the political and military organization of the latter was patterned, with important modifications, after the Pelo- ponnesian league. ' This is a greatly exaggerated statement ; at this time the Confederacy included but a part of the island and coast region of the ^gean Sea. * Craterus, a generally trustworthy historian, stated (Plut. Arist. 26) that a certain Athenian, Diophantus of Amphitrope, obtained a verdict against Aristeides on the charge of his having been bribed by the lonians to make their assessment less than their proportional due, and that, unable to pay the fine of fifty talents, the condemned statesman ended his days in exile. Although Aristeides may not have been guilty of the crime, there is considerable evidence that in his own Ufetime he did not enjoy the universal reputation for absolute probity which centuries later he acquired among moralists and rhetoricians. 258 DELIAN CONFEDERACY 69. Commercial Treaty with Phaselis {Inscr. grcec. II. no. 11 ; Hicks and Hill, no. 36. Translated by G. W. B.) Under the arrangements above described Athens proceeded to make treaties with individual states of the Confederacy to regulate her commercial relations with them. Among the earliest of these agreements is the treaty with Phapelis preserved in an inscription. Phaselis was a Dorian colony on the Lycian coast, and was annexed to the Delian Confederacy in that campaign of Cimon which culminated in the battle of the Eurymedon, 468 (Thuc. i. 100 ; Plut. Cim. 12). From this document we learn that a similar treaty had already been concluded with Chios. 1. Be it resolved by the BouM and theDemus. Acamantis was the prytanizing tribe. Onasippus was secretary. ...des was chairman. Leon moyed the resolution : ^ — 2. That there be engraved the decree for the Phaselitans, to the effect that if there shall be made at Athens a contract with any of the Phaselitans, the suits arising from it shall be tried at Athens before the polemarch — just as is done in the case of the Chians ^ — and nowhere else. 3. That suits arising from other kinds of contracts under treaty are to be settled with the Phaselitans in the same way as in the treaty with the Chians ; and the reference of such cases to arbitra- tors is hereby abohshed.' ^This is the usual heading (prescript) of an Athenian decree (^tJ^iit/jo). The Boulfi is the Council of Five Hundred ; the Demus, " commons,'' is the people in as- sembly (iKKKiiala). The ten tribal delegations took their turns in acting as an ad- ministrative and legislative committee, each for a tenth of the year. The fifty dele- gates on duty for the time being were termed pry taneis, " foremen " (or " the piytanizing tribe," as here), and the period of their duty was, accordingly, termed a prytany. The chairman of the prytaneis was also chairman of the entire boulS and of the assembly. On the Five Hundred and the assembly, see Gilbert, Const. Antiq. 26s sqg. ' Reference to the Chians is due not only to the fact that the treaty with Chios was earlier, and served therefore as a model for all similar treaties, but also to the fact that it was the Chians who persuaded Phaselis to enter the Confederacy (Plut. Cim. 12). Chios was not only free but among the most favored of the allies; and this article of the treaty accorded with general Greek usage. ' Unfortunately, as the treaty with Chios has not been preserved, we do not know what the arrangements were for this class of suits. Doubtless, however, they were complex ; a contract made between a Phaselitan and an Athenian at Phaselis was prob- ably actionable in that dty ; if the Athenian resided, for instance, at Chios and the contract was made there, it may have been actionable at Chios, etc. The clause relating to arbitrators is a conjectural reading. If the passage is correctly restored, it has reference to the choice of arbitrators from a disinterested state ; see Hesychius, ^kkXijtoi SUai • ol M f tviis Xevijuerai, Kal o6k iv tj ir6\E(. CHANGE TO EMPIRE 259 4. That if the magistrate ^ receive against any of the Phaselitans one of the cases which belong elsewhere, and the Phasehtan be con- demned in the suit to pay, the suit shall be invalid. > 5. That if the magistrate shall be shown to have violated this decree, he shall be liable to a fine of 1000 drachmas, to be consecrated to Athena. 6. That the secretary of the boul^ inscribe this decree on a stone pillar and place it on the Acropolis at the expense of the Phaselitans. 70. The Transformation of the Confederacy into an Athenian Empire (Thucydides i. 97-99) At first the allies were independent and deliberated in a common assembly under the leadership of Athens. But in the interval be- tween the Persian and the Peloponnesian wars, by their military success and by policy in dealing with ^e Barbarian, with their, own rebellious allies, and with the Peloponnesians who from time to time crossed their path, the Athenians made immense strides in power. . . . The Naxians revolted, and the Athenians made war against them and reduced them by blockade. This was the first of the allied cities which was enslaved contrary to Hellenic law-; the turn of the others came later. The causes which led to the defection of the allies were various, , the principal being their neglect to pay the tribute or to furnish ships, and in some cases, failure of military service. For the Athenians were exacting and oppressive, using coercive measures toward men who were neither willing nor accustomed to work hard. For various reasons, too, they soon began to prove less agreeable leaders than at first. .They no longer fought upon an equahty with the rest of the confederates, and they had no diflSculty in reducing them when they revolted. Now the allies brought all this misfortune upon themselves ; for thp majority of them disliked ' The magistrate (ipx'^") mentioned here and in the following article is necessarily the polemarch. 26o ATHENIAN EMPIRE military service and absence from home; hence they agreed to contribute a regular sum of money instead of ships. In this way the Athenian navy was proportionally increased, while the allies themselves were always untrained and unprepared for war when they revolted. 71. The Constitution of Erythrs; (Inscr. GrcBC. I. 9 ; Hicks and Hill, no. 32 ; Ditt. 8 ; trans, by C. J. O.) The independence of a Greek city consisted essentially of two rights : (i) to enter freely into relations of war, peace, and alliance with other states, (2) to have whatever form of government it pleased. Gradually Athens deprived her allies of these rights, and imposed on them democratic constitutions. Under the new arrangements they varied greatly in the degree of their subjection to Athens; particularly these constitutions, or charters, limited the judicial power of the respective states and prescribed what cases were to be sent to Athens for trial. The constitution of Eiythrae, issued about 450, was found on a large block of marble near the Erechtheum, on the Acropolis. Unfor- tunately the marble has been lost, but a somewhat mutilated copy of the inscription is extant. Busolt, Griech. Gesch. III. 235 sqq.; other references. Hicks and Hill, p. 46. 1. {A few letters only are left of the prescript!) ^ 2. The Erythraeans^ shall bring to the Greater Panathenaea '. ofiEerings worth not less than three minas. The ten Commissioners of the Sacrifices shall distribute the meat among those of the Ery- thrseans who are present, a drachma's worth to each. If the sacri- ficial animals are acceptable, but are not worth three minas as above stated, the Cattle-Buyers shall purchase oxen for sacrifice and the account shall be charged to the demus of the Erythraeans ; and anyone so desiring may feast upon the meat. 3. There shall be a council of the Erythraeans, filled by lot, and ' For examples tif the opening formula (prescript), see nos. 69, 72. * Erythrae, an Ionian city on the Asiatic coast opposite Chios, was one of the orig- inal members of the Confederacy. In general on this city, see Pauly-Wissowa, Real- Encycl. VI. S7S sqq. ' The Fanathensa, a festival of all the Athenians in honor of their guardian goddess, was held annually in July. From the time of Peisistratus every fourth-year festival of this name was celebrated with especial splendor, and was known accordingly as the Greater Panathenaea. It is significant that the members of the empire were sharers in the same worship, and further that Athenian imperialism tended to substitute Athena for Apollo as the protecting deity of the empire. CONSTITUTION OF ERYTHR^ 261 consisting of one hundred and twenty men. A man so appointed shall undergo scrutiny ^ before the council, and it shall not be law- ful for anyone under thirty years of age to be a councillor. Those who are disqualified shall be liable to prosecution and shall not be councillors within four years. The council shall be drawn by lot and established at present by the overseers " and the commandant of the garrison,' in future by the council (in office) and the commandant. 4. Each of those who are to be councillors at Erythras shall, before entering office, swear by Zeus and ApoUo and Demeter, imprecating destruction upon himself and upon his children if he commits perjury; and he shall swear the oath upon the burning sacrffices. The councillors in office shall compel the performance of these things ; and if they fail to do so, they may be fined 1000 drachmae or whatever sum the Erythraean people may decree for them to pay. The councillors shall swear in the following terms : 5. I will be councillor as well and truly as I am able for the people of the Erythraeans and of the Athenians and of the Allies. And I will not revolt against the commonwealth of the Athenians, or against the Allies of the Athenians, either of my own accord or at the will of another. Neither will I desert them, either of my own accord or at the will of another. Neither will I receive back, either of my own accord or at the will of another, any one of those who fled to the Medes, except with the sanction of the Athenians and of the (Erythraean) people. Neither will I drive away any who are remaining, except with the sanction of the Athenians and of the people. 6. If any Erythraean shall kill another Erythrsean, let him be put to death. If anyone shall be condemned to perpetual banish- ment, let him be banished [at the same time ?] from the (territory ' Scrutiny (doKi/uurla), an examination into the character and qualification of officials, at Athens and elsewhere in Hellas, before entering upon their public duties. ' Overseers {iirUricmoi) were a board of civil officials sent by Athens to various dependent states. Along with the commandant of the garrison they took care that the state pursued a policy of loyalty toward Athens. On this magistracy, see Pauly- Wissowa, Real-Encyd. VI. 199. ' In some states, as at Erythrae, permanent garrisons were established (c/. Isoc. Areop. 64), and in such a case the commandant exercised civil as well as military func- tions; cf. Busolt, Griech- Gesch. III. 226 and notes. 262 ATHENIAN EMPIRE of the) Athenian alliance, and let his property be confiscated by the Erythraeans. If anyone is convicted of attempting to betray the city of the Erythraeans to the tyrants,^ let him be put to death [with itopunity], both himself ( ?) and his children, unless his children are shown to be [favorably] disposed towards the Erythraean people and tiat of the Athenians. The children, after surrendering the property of one convicted, shall receive one half of it back, and the other half shall be confiscated. The same shall be the case if anyone is convicted of attempting to betray the Athenian people or the garrison at Erythrae.* {The rest of the inscription is fragmentary.) 72. The Constitution of Chalcis (Jnscr. grac. I. Supplem. i. no. 27 a; Hicks and Hill, no. 40; Ditt. no. 17 and Add. vol. ii. p. 807'; for other references, see Hicks and Hill, p. 63 ; trans, by C. J. O.) In 446 Eubcea revolted against Athens but was subdued in the autumn of the same year. In punishment for the massacre of Athenian prisoners the people of Histisea were expelled and their territory was occupied by colonists from Athens. The rest of the island submitted under an agreement (Thuc. i. 114) which fixed the general status of the cities. This convention was supple- mented by decrees which in greater detail regulated the constitutions of the several states and their relations with Athens. The document given below is a decree of the kind for settling the afEairs of Chalcis. On this city in general, see Pauly-Wissowa, Real-Encyd. III. 2078 sqq. ^^,^ Hjc /■^la.i^- c/ I. Be it resolved by the Boul^ and the Demus.' Antiochis was the prytanizing tribe. Dracontides was chairman. Diogne- tus moved the resolution : — That the council and the jurors * of the Athenians shall swear the oath in the following terms : "I will not expel the Chalcidians ' This reference to the tyrants is obscure. The oligarchy of the Basilidse had given way to democracy in far earlier time (Arist. Polit. viii. 5. 4, 1305 b. 18), which, so far as we know, was not overthrown by a tyrant. " The restoration of the last clause, by Dittenberger, is uncertain. 'C/. no. 69; literally, "It seemed good to the BouU and the Demus." * The council here meant is the Council of Five Hundred, as in the decree concern- ing the Erythraeans ; no. 71. There were in Athens 6000 jurors drawn by lot from the citizens above thirty years of age, and serving for the year; Arist. Const. Ath. 24, 63; Gilbert, Co»rf. Antiq. 391 sqq. Interesting is their participation, as here, in interstate affairs. CONSTITUTION OF CHALCIS 263 from Chalcis or destroy their city ; ^ and I will not punish any pri- vate citizen with loss of civil rights or with exile or give judgment of arrest or of death or of confiscation of goods against him without a trial, except by (authority of) the Athenian people ; ^ and I will not put to vote ' (a motion) against either the community or any private citizen (of Chalcis), when a summons has not been issued against them ; and if an embassy comes, I will introduce it to the council and the people within ten days, when I am prytanis, to the best of my ability ; and I will maintain these things for the Chal- cidians, if they are obedient to the Athenian people." An embassy from Chalcis shall administer the oath to the Athenians with the help of the Commissioners of Oaths, and shall register (the names of) those who swear it. Let the Generals see to it that all swear. 2. The Chalcidians shall swear in the following terms:* "I will not revolt against the Athenian people by any art or device, either in word or in deed, and I will not follow one who undertakes to revolt ; and if anyone incites to revolt, I will denounce him to the Athenians. And I will pay the tribute to the Athenians, as I may induce them (to assess it).^ And I will be to them as good and true an ally as I can ; and I will aid and succor the Athenian people, if anyone wrongs the Athenian people ; and I will be obedient to the Athenian people." 3. All the men of Chalcis who are of age shall swear ; and if anyone shall not swear, he shall lose his civil rights ; his property shall be confiscated, and a tenth of it shall be consecrated to Olym- pian Zeus.® An Athenian embassy shall go to Chalcis and adminis- ter the oath with the help of the Commissioners of Oaths in Chalcis, and shall register (the names of) the Chalcidians who swear. 4. Anticles moved (the further resolution) : — With good fortune to the Athenians, — the Athenians and the > After the expulsion of the Histiaeans the remaining inhabitants of Euboea must have appreciated this guarantee. 2 Demus of the Athenians, — the people in assembly. ' This reference is to the prytaneis and their president; no. 69, n. i. * Cf. the oath of the Erythrsean councillors in the decree above given; no. 69. * In relation to the assessment of the tribute the allies had merely the right of petition, as here indicated. ' Worshiped at Chalcis ; see infra. 264 ATHENIAN EMPIRE Chalcidians shall take the oath on the same terms as the Athenian people decreed for the Eretrians.' Let the Generals see to it that this be done as soon as possible. The people shall choose immedi- ately five men to go to Chalds and administer the oath. Concern- ing the hostages the reply shall be made to the Chalcidians that for the present the Athenians are pleased to abide by what they have decreed, but when it shall please them, they will take counsel and will make an arrangement as may seem proper for the Athenians and the Chalcidians. The aliens resident in Chalcis, except those who are taxed in Athens and any to whom exemption has been granted by the Athenian people, shall be taxed in Chalds like the Chalcidians themselves. 5. The Secretary of the coundl shall record this decree and the oath on a stone stele and shall place them on the Acropolis at Athens,'* at the expense of the Chalcidians ; and the council of the Chalddians shall record and place them in the temple of Oljonpian Zeus at Chalds. — Such shall be the decree regarding the Chal- cidians ; but furthermore three men, whom the council shall choose from its members, shall, in company with Hierocles,' offer as soon as possible the sacrifices (demanded) by the oracles concerning Euboea. Let the Generals assist in seeing that the sacrifices are offered as soon as possible, and let them furnish the money therefor. 6. Archestratus moved as an amendment to (the motion of) Anticles : — The Chalddians may inflict punishments upon their own dtizens at Chalcis just as the Athenians (do on theirs) at Athens, excepting exile, death, or loss of dvil rights, concerning which there shall be an appeal to Athens to the court of the Thesmothetae^ ac- '■ Neighbors of the Chalcidians in Euboea. The decree containing this oath is not extant. ' Reference is necessarily to the inscription here translated. It was found on the Acropolis in 1876. ' Hierodes was evidently the seer who accompanied the Athenian army to Euboea, according to Hellenic custom. He was afterward ridiculed by Aristophanes, Peace, 1046 sq. * Thesmothetae, the six so-called junior archons. They had the public documents in their keeping, and in their judicial capacity they enjoyed especially cognizance of cases affecting the integrity of the laws and of agreements with other states; Arist Const. Ath. 3, 48, 59. Busolt, Griech. Gesch. III. 230 and n. i, interprets this passage to signify, not an appeal to the comi: of the Thesmothetee, but a reference of the case to it in the first instance. DECREE FOR FOUNDING A COLONY 265 cording to the decree of the people. Concerning the guarding of Eubcea the Generals shall see to the best of their ability that it be for the greatest advantage of the Athenians. 73. Athenian Decree for the Colonization of Brea, rsr Thrace {Inscr. grcec. I. no. 31 ; Hicks and Hill, no. 41 ; Ditt. no. 19 ; trans, by C. J. O.) Pericles followed systematically the policy of founding colonies of Athenians chiefly within the empire. "He sent out 1000 settlers to the Chersonese, 500 to Naxos, half as many to Andros, 1000 to dwell among the Thracian tribe of ^the Bisaltse, and others to the new colony in Italy . . . named Thurii. By these means he relieved the state of numerous idle agitators, assisted the needy, and overawed the allies of Athens by placing his colonies near them to watch theirbehavior"; Plut. Per. II. His objects are well stated by Plutarch. This passage may contain a reference to Brea, founded by Pericles in Thrace. The date of the decree of founding must be 446 or not materially later ; Busolt Griech. Gesch. HI. 417. This inscription is valuable as the only one extant which treats of the founding of a Greek colony. A. (The beginning is lost.) 7. . . . If he does import,^ the person who has brought the information or the indictment shall take [the goods(?)] in pledge. The [leaders of the colonists] shall provide [flocks of goats], as many as they shall deem sufficient, for the offering of auspicious sacrifices on behalf of the colony. [Ten men] shall be chosen as surveyors, one from each tribe, and these shall assign [the land]. Democlides shall have full power to establish the colony according to the best of his ability. 2. The sacred demesnes that have been set apart ^ shall be left as they are, and no others shall be consecrated. (The colonists) shall contribute an ox ' and [a suit of armor] for the Greater Pana- thenaea and a phallus for the Dionysia.* If anyone shall attack the land of the colonists, the cities^ shall render aid as [vigorously] as ' Evidently a prohibition of smuggling has preceded. ' The sanctuaries of the former Thracian inhabitants are meant. ' This contribution to the great quadrennial festival was obh'gatory upon all the Athenian colonies, cf. the schoUast on Aristophanes, Clouds, 386. * The Greater, or City, Dionysia, held every year in March. ^ /.«., the Athenian confederacy. 266 ATHENIAN EMPIRE possible, according to the statute that was passed in the secretary- ship of . . . regarding the [cities] of Thrace. 3. These provisions shall be inscribed upon a stele and placed on the Acropolis, and the colonists shall [furnish] the stele at their own [expense]. If anyone shall put to vote a motion contrary to (the provisions of) the stele, or shall speak (against them) as a public orator, or shall [attempt] to incite (others) to rescind or annul any portion of the decree, he shall [lose his civil rights] both he himself and his children, and his property shall be confiscated, one tenth of it to the Goddess (Athena) ; except that the colonists themselves may make [requests in their own behalf]. 4. Those of the soldiers^ who shall enroll themselves [as pro- spective colonists], shall be at Brea [as colonists] within thirty days after they have reached [Athens]. The colony shall be led forth within thirty days, ^schines shall follow and pay over the money.^ B. Phantocles moved as an amendment to the motion of Democlides regarding the colony to Brea : — 5. The prytaneis of (the tribe) Erechtheis^ shall introduce Phantocles to the council at the first session. The colonists to go to Brea shall be from the thetes * and the zeugitae. ' Perhaps those who were campaigning in Euboea in 446 b.c. ' For the expenses of the journey. ' Evidently the tribe that was to hold the following prytany. *The thetes were the lowest of the four classes into which the Athenians were divided according to the amount of their property. The zeugitae, who were the dass next to the lowest, comprised those who were Uable to service in the heavy infantry. Originally the estimate was made on the basis of produce from rural estates free from encumbrance (Arist. Const. Ath. 7), but before the age of Pericles an assessment in money had been substituted. TRIBUTES 267 74. Two Tribute Lists (The extant tribute lists will be found in Inscr. grac. I. nos. 226-72. C/. also Supplem. I ; as far as 432 B.C., in Hill, Sources for Greek History (Oxford, 1897), ch. ii. (A) is from Inscr. grac. I. no. 244 ; Hill, op. cit. ch. ii. no. 19 ; Hicks and Hill, Greek Hist. Inscr. no. 48. It is taken from the list for 436- S B.C. (B) is from the list of the year 425, "put together out of thirty frag- ments found at various times on the Acropolis." It is given also by Hill, op. cit. p. 14, no. 72 ; Hicks and HUl, op. cit, no. 64. In this inscription the island list alone is sufficiently complete to warrant reproduction. Translated by C. J. O.) The sum total of the contributions — generally termed tributes — to be paid by the members of the Delian Confederacy was originally fixed, 478 B.C., by Aristeides at 460 talents (Thuc. i. 96 ; Arist. Const. Ath. 23. 5 ; Plut. Arist. 24). The cities were re-assessed every four years ; but for a long time little variation was made from this norm, even after the Confederacy had been enlarged by the addition of many new members. Probably in 4S4-3, certainly not later than that date, the treasury was transferred from Delos to Athens. This event marks, better than any other, the completion of the gradual process of trans- forming the Confederacy into an Athenian empire. From this date begins a series of quota lists, imperfectly preserved in inscriptions, detailing, not as a rule the actual contributions paid by the several allies, but the offerings to Athena made from these respective sums. As the goddess received a sixtieth part of the tribute, a mina from every talent, it is a simple matter to compute from these lists the contributions of the individual states. In the following extracts from these inscriptions (A) is an example of such a list of offerings, the amounts of tribute, given in the third column, being calculated by multiplying the num- bers in the second column by sixty. The extract designated as (B) is from the only extant inscription which gives directly the amount of assessment. In 447-6 began an effort to arrange the states in local groups, and four years afterward the empire was definitely organized in the following tribute districts, Ionian, Hellespontine, Thracian, Carian, and Island. After 439 B.C. the Ionian and Carian tributes were combined under one heading, and the number of districts was thus reduced to four. Before the Peloponnesian war the Island district, to which alone the following extracts have reference, com- prised the Cyclades, Eubcea, Lemnos, Imbros, and .(Egina, the number of tribute-paying states being twenty-three or twenty-four. In the assessment of 425-4 the names of the Lemnian cities and of Imbros must have stood in the portion of the mscription now lost ; and ^gina, which was occupied by Athe- nian colonists in 431 (Thuc. ii. 27), is omitted. The islands of Melos and Thera, on the other hand, are added ; and a number of small towns, which had pre- viously been taxed with their larger neighbors, were made distinct tributaries. It will be seen, too, from a comparison of the figures in (A) and (B), that on the 268 ATHENIAN EMPIRE average the several assessments were more than doubled. This increase is generally credited by scholars to the ambitious war policy of Cleon. While granting this interpretation in part, we must bear in mind that the wealth of the states had vastly increased since the assessment of Aristeides (c/. Isoc. Paneg. 103 ; Plut. Cim. 11), that money was now far more plentiful, and that its pur- chasing power had correspondingly declined. It was just, therefore, that the contributions should be increased, though perhaps not doubled. The author of the decree — ^^«r/ia — which brought about this change was Cleonymus. On the increase, see Busolt, Griech. Gesch. III. 11 17 sqq. ; Philologus, XLI (1882). 688-92. THE LISTS I (A) From the quota list of 436-5 B.C. In the term of the nineteenth board,' of which Philetserus, son of Theodectus, . . . was secretary, Dionysius being (chief) Hellenotamias. . . {Here follows the quota of the Ionian tribute.) The People Of Seriphos Chalcis ^ Ceos Tenos Naxos Myconos Andros Siphnos Syros Styra * Eretria = Grynchae ? Rhenaea Athenae ' Dium of Cenxum ' los ^gina [more Island TRiBtrrE Quota Paid to Athena^ [3]oo drachmae 400 drachmae 300 drachmae 666f drachmae 600 drachmae 300 drachmae 25 drachmae bJoo drachmae (1000 drachmae) (300 drachmae) (2000 drachmae) (2000 drachmae) (3000 drachmae) than] 300 talents Calculated Amount of Tribute (3 talents) (4 talents) (3 talents) (6f talents) (6 talents) (3 talents) (J talent) (3 talents) 10 talents 3 talents 20 talents 20 talents (30) talents (more than 3 talents) ' The board of Hellemc treasurers is probably here meant, not that of the auditois, who reckoned the offering of the sixtieth part. ' Concerning the places in Eubcea mentioned in these lists see Geyer, Topographic und GeschicMe der Inset Euboia, Part I (Berlin, 1903), passim. ' These figures are restored from a fragment of another tribute list, probably for the year 439-438, published by KShler in Hermes, XXXI (1896), 142 sq. TRIBUTES 269 {Ten lines are wanting. Then follow the quotas of the Hellespontine and of the Thracian tribute, then a heading "Self -assessing cities," ' with eleven quotas, then another heading, " Cities which were enrolled to pay tribute on the motion of private citizens," ^ with six quotas among which is that of the Diacrians of Chalcis, 13J drachmae (800 dr.).) (B) From the assessment of tribute in 425-4 B.C. The tribute was assessed as follows upon the cities by the council of which Pleistias was the first secretary, [and by the court (?)] in the archonship of Stratocles ' and in the term of the introducers ' whose [secretary was . . .] Island The People Of Paros Naxos Andros Melos " Siphnos Eretria • Thera ' Ceos Carystus ' Chalcis » Cythnos Tenos Styra • Myconos Seriphos los Dium* Athenae • Syros Grynchae ' Rhenasa Diacrians of Chalcis • Tribute Assessment 30 talents 15 talents 15 talents IS talents 9 talents 15 talents 5 talents 10 talents 5 talents 10 talents 6 talents 10 talents 2 talents I talent I talent 2000 drachmae 1000 drachmas 2000 drachmae ' Cf. Busolt, Griech. Gesch. III. 207, n. 4. ^Cf. Ibid., 210, n. I. ' In 425-424 B.C. * Officials who presided at the trial of cases that had to be decided within a month. ' Though the Melians were assessed as tributaries, they never acknowledged the supremacy of Athens until they were overcome and destroyed in 416-415 ; cf. Thu- cydides, iii. 91 ; v. 84, 116. ' Concerning the places in Euboea mentioned in these lists see Geyer, Topographic und Geschichte der Insel Euboia, Part I (Berlin, 1903). passim. ' Thera was not subject to Athens at the beginning of the Peloponnesian war; cf. Thuc. ii. 2. 270 ATHENIAN EMPIRE The People Of Assessment Anaphe looo drachmae Ceria, lof dr.' Pholegandros 2000 drachmae Belbina ^ 300 drachmae Cimolos ■ 1000 drachms Sicinos 1000 drachmae Posideum 100 drachmae Diacrians in Eubcea ' i J talents [Hephaestia ( ?)] in Eubcea ' 4 talents {The remainder of the assessment of the Island trihvie is lost in (B). Then follow fragments of the assessments of the Ionian, the Eellespontine, and the Thracian tribute respectively. At the bottom of the inscription is the line " Sum total, [500 +] 460 + ■ ■ • Talents." «) 75. Athenian Decrees in Honor of the Democrats or Samos (Hicks and Hill, no. 81 ; Ditt. nos. 56, S7 ; Michel, Recueil, no. 80 ; Szanto, Griech. BUrgerrecht, 95 sq. Translated by C. J.O.) The Athenians rarely granted citizenship to aliens. In 427, however, after the destruction of Plataea they conferred the citizenship on all the survivors who could prove that they were Plataeans and friendly to the Athenian state (Busolt, Griech. Gesch. III. 1038). This was thus far the most striking example of their liberality. After the Sicihan disaster there was talk of admitting to the state all loyal metics amd all the allies of Ionian speech (Aristoph. Lysist. 571 sqq) but such discussion bore no fruit, and in fact it was then too late to save the empire by concessions of that nature (c/. Thuc. viii. 48. 5). When the allies heard of the Athenian defeat at ^Egospotami (405), all revolted excepting the Samians, who remained loyal chiefly through fear of the oligarchs whom they had banished. Putting to death, therefore, a number of oligarchs who still remained in the island, the Samians sent two embassies to Athens to report what they had done and to assure her of their continued loyalty (Xen. Hdl. ii. 2. 6). Thereupon the Athenians passed the first of the following decrees. 1 Possibly the' small island now called Karos near Naxos. The peculiar position of the figures may indicate that the town paid merely Athena's sixtieth in lieu of the full assessment. * An islet at the entrance of the Saronic Gulf, now Hagios Georgios. ' Concerning the places in Eubcea mentioned in these lists see Geyer, Topographic und Geschichte der Insel Euboia, Part I (Berlin, 1903), passim. * If this figure is correct, and the tributaries paid in full, the annual revenue under the increased assessment was over $1,000,000. THE SAMIANS BECOME ATHENIANS 271 A. FIRST DECREE Cephisophon of Paeania was secretary.^ For the Samians who sided with the Athenian people. 1. Be it resolved by the BoulS and the Demus. Cecropis was the prytanizing tribe. Polymnis of Euonymon was secretary. Alexias was archon.^ Nicophon of Athmonon was* chairman. Cleisophus and his fellow-prytaneis moved the resolution : To commend both the former and the present embassy of the Samians as well as the council, the generals, and the rest of the Samians, inasmuch as they are good and true men and are ready to do whatsoever good they can; furthermore (to approve) their acts,' because they seem to have done right by the Athenians and the Samians. 2. Whereas also they have benefited the Athenians and are now making much of them and are proposing good measures, be it resolved by the BoulS and the Demus : — That the Samians shall be Athenians, using such form of govern- ment as they themselves may desire ; and according to their own suggestion, a joint consultation concerning the remaining points, with a view to making this arrangement most satisfactory to both parties, shall be held upon the conclusion of peace.* They shall use their own laws and be autonomous ; and in other respects they shall act according to the oaths and the agreements entered into by the Athenians and the Samians ; and with regard to the mis- understandings that may arise between them, both parties shall grant and receive legal recourse according to the existing compacts.* 3. If by reason of the war, any pressing question concerning the right of citizenship shall arise sooner, then, according to the sugges- tion of the embassy, they shall consult and act as may seem to be best in view of the circumstances. If peace is concluded, the pres- ^ When, as here, decrees passed at diflEerent times were engraved together, the name of the latest secretary appears in the title. ' 405-404 B-C. ' Reference is doubtless to their massacre of oligarchs ; see introduction to the decree. *With the Peloponnesians. It was made in 404, but the Samians were not included. I" Sv/uiSoXds — treaties, generally regulating commercial and other relations, and providing for the settlement of cases at law arising from such relations. 272 ATHENIAN EMPIRE ent ' inhabitants of Samos shall share in it upon the same terms as the Athenians; but if it is necessary to carry on the war, they shall make preparations in concert with the generals to the best of their ability. If the Athenians send an embassy to any quarter, those who are present from Samos may join in it by sending some- one if they wish, and they may offer whatever good advice they can. 4. The "triremes that are at Samos ^ shall be given to the Samians to repair and to use as they please. The names of the captains (trierarchs) ' to whom these ships belonged shall be reported by the ambassadors to the secretary of the boule and to the generals; and if the trierarchs are charged in the records of the treasury [with any indebtedness] on account of their receipt of the triremes, the dock wardens shall [cancel it all] wheresoever found, and shall reclaim the tackle for the treasury [as soon as possible and] compel those who have any of it to return [it in full]. 5. [Proposal of Cleisophus and his] fellow-pry taneis as an amendment to that of the bouM ; — [The grant shall be made to those of the Samians] who have come, as they themselves request, and they shall be assigned [immediately to demes and to] tribes* in ten divisions. Passage shall be provided [for the ambassadors by the generals] as soon as possible. Eumachus and [all the other Samians who have come with Eumachus] shall be commended for being [good and true toward the Athenians], and Eumachus shall be invited to dine in the Prytaneum ^ on the morrow. The secretary of the boulfe together with the generals shall record the decree upon a stone pillar and shall place it on the Acropolis, and the Hellenic Treasurers * shall give the money therefor. It shall be recorded at Samos in the same way at the expense of the Samians. ' Provision was hereby made to exclude the (digarchs then in exile. 'Twenty Athenian triremes had been left at Samos (Died. xiii. 104. 2). ' The trierarch (captain of a trireme) was responsible to the state for his ship during his year of command, and was obliged to retxrm it, or deliver it to his successor, unim- paired; hence the need of this provision to exonerate the captains when their ships were ttuned over to the Samians. * Compare the language of the decree admitting the Platseans to citizenship in 427 ; Pseudo-Demosth. lix. 104: "The Plataeans shall be assigned to demes and to tribes." ' The City Hall, containing the sacred hearth of the community, and the tables at which certain officials, together with guests honored by the state, dined at public expense. ' This board, mentioned here for the last time, was abolished at the dose of the vai. FAVORS TO THE SAMIANS 273 Unfortunately the terms of the agreement could not be carried out ; for in the spring of 404 Athens was compelled to surrender to the Peloponnesians ; and soon afterward Lysander conquered Samos (Xen. Hell. ii. 3. 6). Expelled from their homes, the Samian democrats found refuge in the Ionian cities on the coast of Asia Minor. The next year, 403, when on the point of sending a petition to Sparta, these exiles invoked the good offices of the Athenians, who by the terms of a second decree, given below, complied with the request and also confirmed the favors granted in the earher decree.' B. SECOND DECREE 1. Be it resolved by the boul6 and the demus. Pandionis was the prytanizing tribe. Agyrrhius of CoUytus was secretary. Eucleides was archon.^ Callias of Oa was chairman. Cephisophon moved the resolution : — To commend the Samians inasmuch as they are good and true men toward the Athenians, and to ratify all that the Athenian people have previously decreed for the Samian people. 2. [The Samians may send] to Lacedaemon, as they themselves urge, whomsoever [they wish ; and since] they entreat the Athenians to join in the negotiations, there shall ba chosen additional [ambas- sadors, and these shall join] with the Samians in effecting whatever good they can, [and shall consult in common with] them." Further- more, the Athenians commend the people of Ephesus and Notium ' [inasmuch as they readily received] the Samians who were in exile. The Samian embassy shall be introduced to (the assembly of) the people to transact business, if they shall have need of anything, and the embassy shall be invited to dine in the Prytaneum on the morrow. 3. Cephisophon moved as an amendment to the proposal of the boul6 : — Be it decreed by the Athenian people that the pre- vious decree concerning the Samians be ratified, as the boulS re- ported to the demus in its proposal, and that the Samian embassy be invited to dine in the Prytaneum on the morrow. BIBLIOGRAPHY This subject is included in all histories of Greece (cf. p. 61 supra) and in all works on the constitutional history and the public antiquities of the Greeks. ' 403-402 B.C. « The restoration of this passage by Hicks is conjectural but gives the general sense. ' A town on the coast a few miles north of Ephesus. 274 ATHENIAN EMPIRE See also Herzog, E., Zur Verwallungsgeschickte des attischen Staats (Tubingen, 1897). On the tribute, see Bannier, W., "Die Tributeinnahmeordnung des attischen Staates," in Skein. Mus. LIV (1899). 544-54; Pedroli, "I tributi degli alleati d'Atene," in Beloch, Sttidi di Storia antica, I (1891). 101-207 \ Busolt, G., Griech. Gesch. III. 192-222. On the coinage, Gardner, P., "Coinage of the Athenian Empire," in Journ. Hell. St. XXXIII (1913). 147-88. On jurisdiction, see Goodwin, W. W., Aticai otto (tvh^oXmv koI Aticoi avii/SoXauu in Am. Journ. PhUol. I (1880). 4-16 ; Stahl, De sociorum atheniensium iudiciis (Munster, 1881) ; Morris, C. D., "Jurisdiction of Athenians over their AUies,'' in Am. Journ. Philol. V (1884). 298 sqq.; Meyer and Schomann, Der attische Process (2d edj, Berlin, 1883-1887), 994-1006; Gilbert, G., Const. Antiq. 429- 34; PhUlipson, C., International Law and Custom of Ancient Greece and Romei I. 198-209 ; Meyer, E., Gesch. des Alt. III. 496-500 ; Busolt, G., Griech. Gesch. III. 230-36 ; Weber, H., " Attisches Processrecht in den attischen Seebundes- staaten," in Slttd. zur Gesch. und Ktdtur des Alt. I. 5 (1908). , CHAPTER VIII PRIVATE AND CRIMINAL LAW In the Period 479-404 In this chapter the private law of the fifth century is represented by the Laws of Gortyn, and criminal law by the Draconian Law concerning Homicide, as republished in 409. 76. The Laws of Gortyn In Greek tradition Crete was an early home of law. The scanty notices of Cretan law preserved in literature refer mainly to public law; and the dis- covery in the nineteenth century of a Gortynian code, in the form of a mural inscription, has given us for the first time a clea^ view of some portions at least 1 of Cretan private law. This code deals fully with family relations and with inheritance ; less fully with tools ; slightly with property outside of the house- hold relations ; slightly, too, with contracts ; but it contains no criminal law or criminal procedure. This inscription is the largest document of Greek law in existence. It is to be noted, however, that many fragments of other Gorty- nian laws have been found, some of which are edited and translated in Kohler und Ziebarth, Stadtrecht von Gortyn (Gottingen, 1912), now the best treatment of the subject in general. From these fragments we may justly infer that the inscription now under consideration formed but a small fraction of a great Gortynian code. This document itself recognizes the existence of earlier law, not repeated but still in force, — .particularly in the phrase, "as has been written," or "as is the established statute." In the opinion of Burchner, Pauly-Wissowa, Real- Encycl. VII (191 2). 1669, the oldest extant legislation of Gortyn belongs to the sixth century, followed by a period of revision or reformation in the fifth cen- tury, to which the present document belongs. References to " kettles " and "tripods" as standards of value led the earlier commentators to the conclusion that these laws preceded the period of coinage. More recently Svoronos, Journal internat. d'archSol. numismat. IX (1906). 217 sq., has made it clear that the figures of these articles were stamped upon silver coins of Gortyn and other Cretan cities, and that accordingly without doubt the laws refer to the coins rather than to the articles. See also De Sanctis, Monumenti Antichi, XVIII. 303 sq. From various considerations it appears highly probably that these 27s 276 PRIVATE AND CRIMINAL LAW laws were enacted about the middle of the fifth century; cf. Kohler and Ziebarth, op. cii. p. vi sg. The most saUent tendencies of the reformation represented by the docu- ment are the restriction of self-help and the betterment of the legal position of women. "They receive rights of inheritance, which they probably had not before ; and because they now have these rights, gifts to them and dowries are limited. The power to dispose of women's property is restricted, in their favor, as against husbands, fathers, sons .and uncles ; and here for the first time, perhaps, a way is opened to heiresses to escape, by a sacrifice of a part of their property, from the burdensome compulsion to marry near kinsmen." It is a curious fact that at a time when the Athenians were repressing the social freedom of women, the Cretans were giving them larger liberties and rights. Interesting, too, is the admirable status of the class of persons described as " serfs." Various features of the statute make it akin to Indo-European rather than to Oriental usage. A new importance has been given to Hellenic law by the discovery of papyri which prove its continued existence in parts of the Roman empire. Briefly, Hellenic law is of vast importance to the student, not merely of jurisprudence, but also of ancient culture. The translation which follows was originally made by Professor Augustus C. Merriam of Columbia University, published in the American Journal of Archaology, II. (1886). 24-45 (c/. !• 3So*99-)- Professor Munroe Smith has compared it with the German versions of Bucheler (Bucheler und Zitelmann, Das Recht von Gortyn (1885), and Lewy, H., Altes Stadtrecht von Gortyn (1885), and has contributed annotations. Finally the translation has been revised, on the basis of the improved text of Kohler and Ziebarth, op. cit., by £. G. S. THE GODS ! ^ I. Suit for the ownership of a slave or of one so claimed.^ — Who- ever intends to bring suit in relation to a free man or a slave, shall not take action by seizure before trial ; ' but if he do seize him, let the judge fine him 10 staters for the free man, 5 for the slave, be- cause he seizes him, and let him adjudge that he shall release him within three days. But if he do not release him, let the judge sentence him to a stater for a free man, a drachma * for a slave, each ' By this formula the gods are invoked to protect and bless the enactment. It is often prefixed to documents. ^ The divisions and headings here given are the translator's. Of the abbreviations used below, B refers to the edition of Bucheler and Zitelmann; L to that of Lewy; M.S. to Professor Munroe Smith. ' "Before judgment" (L). * As the J&gm&taxi standard prevailed (Head, Historia numorum, 457) the drachma approximately equaled 23 cents. A stater was two drachmas. SLAVES 277 day until he shall have released him ; and according to the time (of non-payment) * the judge shall decide, confirming it by oath. But if he should deny that he made the seizure, the judge shall render decision with confirmatory oath, unless a witness testify. But if one party contend that he is a free man, the other that he is a slave, those who testify that he is free shall be preferred. And if they contend about a slave, each declaring that he is his, if a witness testify, the judge shall decide according to the witness; but if they testify either for both parties or for neither of the two, the judge shall render his decision by oath. If the one who holds (the person in question) lose the suit, he shall set the free man at liberty within 5 days, and the slave he shall deHver in hand ; and if he do not set at hberty or deliver in hand, let the judge pronounce that (the successful party) shall have judgment against him in 50 staters for the free man and a stater each day till he sets him free, and for the slave 10 staters and a drachma each day till he deUvers him in hand. But if the judge shall have sentenced him to a fine, within a year thrice the amount or less shall be exacted, but not more ; and according to the time ' the judge shall decide, confirming it by oath. But if the slave on account of whom (the defendant) was de- feated take refuge in a temple (the defendant), summoning (the plaintiff) in the presence of two witnesses of age and free, shall point out (the slave) at the temple, wherever he may be a suppliant, either himself or another in his behalf ; but if he do not issue the summons or do not point out, he shall pay what is written. And if he do not return him, even within the year, he shall pay in addi- tion the sums one-fold. But if he die while the suit is progressing, he shall pay his value one-fold. And if one, while cosmos,' (so) seize a man, or another for him while he is cosmos, when he has retired from office the case shall be tried, and if (the delinquent) be convicted he shall pay what is v/ritten from the day he made the seizure. ' "And as regards the time," i.e., the period of disobedience (B). - "As regards the' time" (see note above). 'The chief magistrates were ten cosmi, "Keepers of Order," who commanded in war, exercised judicial and general administrative functions, and enforced discipline ^ong the citizens; Botsford, Bellemc History, ch. vi. § i. 278 PRIVATE AND CRIMINAL LAW For one seizing the person in the possession of the defeated party, and the (slave) that has been mortgaged, there shall be no penalty. II. Rape and assault. — If one commit rape on a free man or woman, he shall pay loo staters, and if on (the son or daughter) of an apetairos ^ lo, and if a slave on a free man or woman he shall pay double, and if a free man on a male or female serf ^ 5 drachmas, and if a serf on a male or female serf, 5 staters. If one debauch a female house-slave by force he shall pay 2 staters, but if one already de- bauched, in the daytime an obol, but if at night 2 obols ; and the slave shall have preference in taking the oath. If one tries to seduce a free woman, under the tutelage of her relative, he shall pay 10 staters, if a witness testify. III. Adultery. — If one be taken in adultery with a free woman in her father's, or in her brother's, or in her husband's house, he shall pay 100 staters, but if in another's house, 50 ; and with the wife of an apetairos, 10 ; but if a slave with a free woman, he shall pay double, but if a slave with a slave's wife, 5. And let (the captor) give notice in the presence of three witnesses to the relatives of the man taken, that they shall ransom him within 5 days, and to the master of the slave in the presence of two wit- nesses. But if one do not ransom him, it shall be in the power of the captors to do with him as they wiU. But if he assert that the other has enslaved him, in the case of 50 staters or more, the captor himself with four others shall swear, each calling down curses on himself, and in the case of the apetairos, (the captor) himself with two others, and in case of the domestic, the master himself and another, that he took him in adultery, and did not enslave him. IV. Divorce. — If a husband and wife be divorced, she shall have her own property that she came with to her husband, and the half of the income if it be from her own property, and whatever she has woven, the half, whatever it may be, and 5 staters, if her hus- ^ Apetairos, one who did not belong to a hetaeria, or association of fully privileged citizens. The apetairos seems to have been personally free but politically dependent, somewhat like the Lacedasmonian pericecus. ' The serf (okeiJs, German Hdusler) was somewhat like the Laconian helot, but enjoyed a far better legal position. With his family he tilled a piece of ground belong- ing to his lord, occupying a farm house, whence the name of the class. The serf is often contrasted with the slave, who lived in the house of the lord in the city, and performed domestic service. DIVORCE, WIDOWS, AND CHILDREN 279 band be the cause of her dismissal ; but if the husband deny that he was the cause, the judge shall decide, confirming his decision by oath. But if she carry away anything else belonging to her hus- band, she shall pay 5 staters and the thing itself, whatever she car- ries, and whatever she has purloined she shall return the thing it- self ; but of whatsoever she makes denial the judge shall decide: the woman shall take her oath of denial by Artemis, who stands next to the Amyclaean (Apollo),^ the archer-goddess. And what- ever anyone may take away from her after she has made her oath of denial, he shall pay 5 staters and the thing itself. If an unrelated person assist in removing (the effects) he shall pay 10 staters and the amount two fold of whatever the judge swears that he assisted in removing. V. Rights of the widow. — If a man die, leaving children, if his wife wish she may marry, taking her own property and further whatever her husband may have given her, according to what is written, in the presence of 3 witnesses of age and free. But if she carry away anything belonging to her children she shall be answer- able. And if he leave her childless, she shall have her own property and whatever she has woven, the half, and of the produce on hand in possession of the heirs, a portion, and whatever her husband has given her as is written. But if she should carry away anything else she shall be answerable. If a wife should die childless, (the husband) shall return to her heirs her property, and whatever she has woven within, the half, and of the produce, if it be from her own property, the half. If a husband or wife wish to give komistra,^ (it shall be) either clothing or 12 staters, or something worth 12 staters, but not more. If a female serf be separated from a male serf while alive or in case of his death, she shall have her own property, but if she carry away anything else she shall be answerable. VI. Children born after divorce. — If a woman bear a child while living apart from her husband (after divorce), she shall have it conveyed to the husband at his house, in the presence of 3 wit- nesses ; and if he do not receive the child, it shall be in the power of the mother either to bring up or expose,^ and the relatives and the 1 The reading is that of B. ' Komistra, gifts (of regard or aSEection). 28o PRIVATE AND CRIMINAL LAW witnesses shall have preference in taking the oath as to whether they carried it. And if a female serf bear a child while living apart, she shall carry it to the master of the man who married her, in the presence of 2 witnesses. And if he do not receive it, the child shall be in the power of the master of the female serf. But if she should marry the same man again before the end of the year, the child shall be in the power of the master of the male serf and the one who carried it and the witnesses shall have preference in taking the oath. If a woman living apart should cast away her child before she has presented it as written, she shall pay, for a free child, 50 staters, for a slave, 25, if she be convicted. But if the man have no house to which she may carry it, or she do not see him, if she expose her child, there shall be no penalty. If a female serf should conceive and bear without being married, the child shall be in the power of the master of the father; but if the father be not living, it shall be in the power of the masters of the brothers. VII. Division of property among children. — The father shall have power over his children and the division of the property, and the mother over her property. As long as they live, it shall not be necessary to make a division. But if any one (of the children) should be condemned to pay a fine, his portion may be divided off to him who has been condemned to pay a fine, as is written. But if a (father) die, the houses in the city and whatever there is in the houses in which a serf residing in the country does not hve, and the sheep and larger animals which do not belong to the serf, shall belong to the sons ; but all the rest of the property shall be divided fairly, and the sons, how many soever there be, shall receive two parts each, and the daughters, how many soever there be, one part each. The mother's property also shall be divided, in case she dies, as is written for the father's. And if there should be no property but a house, the daughters shall receive their share as is written. And if a father while living may wish to give to his married daughter, let him give according to what is written, but not more. But to which daughter he gave before or promised, she shall have this, but shall not receive anything further in the distribution. If a woman have no property, either by gift from father or brother, or by promise, or received by inheritance as (was written) when the INHERITANCE 281 ^thalean startos ' — Cyllus and his colleagues — ruled as cosmi, such shall receive their portion ; but, against those (who received) before, there shall not be ground for action. VIII. Heirs at law. — If a man or woman die, if there be chil- dren, or grandchildren or great-grandchildren, they shall have the property; but if there be none of these and there be brothers of the deceased and children or grandchildren from the brothers, they shall have the property; but if there be none of these, but sisters of the deceased, and children from these, or children from the children, they shall have the property ; but if there be none of these, to whomsover it belongs where there may be property, these shall receive it. But if there should be no relations of the klaros^ whoever be the body designated by lot, these shall have the property. IX. Partition of property. — And if (of) the relatives some may wish to divide the property and others not, the judge shall decide ; and all the property shall be in the power of those who wish to divide, imtil they make the division. And if after the judge has rendered his decision, anyone enter by force, or drive or carry off anything, he shall pay 10 staters and double the thing in question. And of perishable objects and crops and clothing and ornaments and furniture, if the sons do not wish to make a division, the judge under oath shall decide with a view to matters in litigation. If further when dividing the property, they cannot agree about the division, they shall offer the property for sale, and having sold it to him who offers most, let them share each his just due of the values received. And while they are dividing the property witnesses shall be present, of age and freemen, three or more. If a father give to a daughter, (let the procedure be) the same. X. Property rights of the family. — As long as a father lives, no one shall purchase any of his property from a son, or take it on ' The startos is one of the puzzles of Cretan public life. Evidence is furnished by Kohler and Ziebarth, op. cit. 47 sq., that it was closely related to the hetaeria, that it had a military character, and was perhaps a military company drawn from the hetseria. Its relation with the cosmi is not dear. The text here seems to indicate that the cosmi were drawn from the starti in rotation. ^ Klaros is evidently a group of kinsmen wider than the family and the near kin above enumerated ; it is substantially the genes, gens, whose members have a right to inherit in failure of the near kin. 282 PRIVATE AND CRIMINAL LAW mortgage; but whatever the son himself may have acquired or obtained by inheritance, he may sell if he will ; nor shall the father sell or promise the property of his children, whatever they have themselves acquired or succeeded to,^ nor the husband that of his wife, nor the son that of the mother. And if any one should pur- chase, or take on mortgage, or accept a promise, otherwise than as written in these writings, the property shall still belong to the mother and the wife, and the one who sold or mortgaged or promised shall pay to the one who bought, or accepted the mortgage or promise, two-fold, and if he shall have caused any other loss, he shall pay one-fold in addition ; but as regards transactions under earlier laws, there shall be no ground for action. If however the defendant shall contend in court, in relation to the matter about which they are disputing, that it does not belong to the mother or the wife, the case shall be adjudicated as is proper before the judge, as each thing is written. If a mother die leaving children, the father shall be trustee of the mother's property,^ but he shall not sell or mortgage unless the children assent, being of age ; and if any one should otherwise purchase or take on mortgage, the property shall (still) belong to the children; and to the purchaser or mortgagee the seller or mortgagor shall pay two-fold the value, and if he shall have caused any other loss, one-fold. But if he wed another wife, the children shall have control of the mother's property. XL Ransomed prisoners. — If any one be brought out of mis- fortune from sojourn abroad (where he has been) held by force,' and one have released him at his desire, he shall be in the power of the one who released him until he pay what is proper ; but if they do not agree upon the amount, or he did not himseK request (the other) to release him, the judge shall decide with a view to the matters in controversy. XII. Miscegenation. — [If a slave ( ?)] going to a free woman shall wed her, the children shall be free ; but if the free woman to a slave, the children shall be slaves ; and if from the same mother ' The Cretan father accordingly had less right to the pecuKum of children than had the Roman father. 2 "The father shall have control of the mother's property" (B and L). 8 "If anyone has been brought out of duress abroad by reason of alienage" (B). THE HEIRESS 283 free and slave children be born, if the mother die and there be property, the free children shall have it ; but if free children should not be born of her, her relatives shall succeed to the property. XIII. Responsibility for the acts of a slave. — If a person should purchase a slave from the market-place, and should not complete the transaction within 60 days, in case he shall have done any wrong before (the 60 days have expired) or after, there shall be ground for action against the one who has acquired him. XrV. Rights and obligations of heiresses. — The heiress shall marry the brother of her father, the eldest of those living ; and if there be more heiresses and brothers of the father, they shall marry the eldest in succession."^ But if there be no brothers of the father, but sons from his brothers, she shall marry the first one from the eldest (brother) ;^ and if there be more heiresses and sons from brothers, they shall marry the sons of the eldest in succession. The pertinent relative shall have one heiress, but not more. As long as the pertinent relative or the heiress is too young to marry, the heiress shall have the house, ' if there be one, but the pertinent relative shall receive half of the income of all the property. And if the pertinent relative be still under age (under 17) but above puberty, and the heiress also, but he do not wish to marry her, all the property and the income shall belong to the heiress, until he marry her. But if he, being of age (above 17), do not wish to marry the heiress, now of proper age and wilhng to marry him, the relatives of the heiress shall bring the matter to trial, and the judge shall order him to marry her within two months ; and if he do not marry as is written, she with all the property shall wed the next in succession, if there be another: but if there be none, she may marry any one of the tribe whom she wishes, who may demand her hand. And if she, being of age to marry, do not wish to marry the pertinent relative, or the pertinent relative be too young and the heiress do not wish to wait, the heiress shall have the house, if there be one in the city, and whatever there is in the house, but sharing half of the remaining property, she may marry another, ' That is, each heiress in succession shall marry the next eldest uncle (M.S.) . 2 She is to marry the eldest son of the eldest brother of her father. 284 PRIVATE AND CRIMINAL LAW whomsoever she wish of her tribe demanding her hand ; and they shall portion off (the half) of the property to the first one. If the heiress should have no kinsmen within the limits pre- scribed, holding all the property she may marry any one of the tribe she wishes. But if no one of the tribe desire to marry her, the relatives of the heiress shall proclaim throughout the tribe, "Does no one wish to marry her?" and if any one will marry her, (it shall be) within the 30 days, as they shall have declared ; and if not, she shall wed another, whomsoever she may be able to. If she become an heiress after her father or brother shall have given her in marriage, in case she do not wish to marry the one to whom they gave her, though he be wilKng, if she have borne children, partitioning (with him) the property as is written, she shall wed another of the tribe; but if she have no children, with all the property she shall marry the pertinent relative if there be one, but if not, as is written. In case a husband should die leaving children to an heiress, if she wish, let her wed any one of the tribe she may be able to, but it is not compulsory. If the deceased should leave no children, she shall marry the pertinent relative as is written. If the one to whom it falls to marry the heiress should not be in the country, and the heiress be of age to marry, she shall wed the (next) in suc- cession as is written. She shall be an heiress if she have no father, or brother from the same father; and the father's relatives shall have control of the income of the property, and share half the proceeds, as long as she is unmarriageable. In case there be no pertinent relative while she is unmarriageable, the heiress shall have possession of the property and the income, and as long as she is unmarriageable she shall be brought up among her mother's relatives. And if any one should marry an heiress, while it is written otherwise, the pertinent relatives shall institute an investi- gation before the cosmi. If any one dying leave an heiress, either she herself or in her behalf the father's or mother's relatives may mortgage or sell some of the estate and the sale and mortgage shall be legal, — but if in another way some one were to purchase the estate or secure a mortgage of the heiress's estate,^ the property shall (still) belong ^ This reading is based on the restored text of Kohler and Ziebarth. SPECIAL CASES 285 to the heiress, and the seller or mortgagor if he be convicted/ shall pay double to the buyer or mortgagee ; and if there be any further loss, he shall pay an equivalent besides, as these writings are written ; but in case of previous ^ transactions, there shall not be ground for action. But, if the defendant should contend, in rela- tion to the thing about which they are disputing, that it does not belong to the heiress, let the judge under oath decide ; and if he should gain his case, to the effect that it does not belong to the heiress, suit (for ownership) shall be tried, where it is pertinent, according as each thing is written. XV. Actions in special cases. — If a person should die who has become a surety, or lost a suit, or owes a loan, or has defrauded any one, or has entered into an agreement, or another (hold like rela- tions) toward him, the case shall be reviewed before the close of the year, and the judge shall decide according to the testimony; if indeed the case be renewed in relation to a judgment, the judge and the clerk of the court,' if he be alive and a citizen, and the wit- nesses who are the pertinent ones (shall testify) ; while in a case of surety, and loans, and fraud, and agreemAit, the heirs shall testify as witnesses; but if they refuse, let the judge under oath pass upon their case and declare that (their opponents) have judgment against the witnesses in the amount in question. If a son should become surety while his father is living, he shall be held, himself and the property which he owns. If any one have a dispute about a venture abroad, or do not reimburse one who has contributed to such a venture, should wit- nesses of age testify, — 3 in a case of 100 staters or more, 2 in a case of less down to 10 staters, i for still less, — let the judge de- cide according to the testimony; but if witnesses do not depose, in case the contracting party comes, whichever of the two courses the complainant may choose, either to make oath of denial, or . . . {nine lines lacking). XVI. Legality of gifts. — A son may give to a mother or a ' Better "if decision is rendered against him." The buyer or mortgagee has com- mitted no crime; the decision simply takes the property from him, leaving him redress against the seller or mortgagor (M.S.). *That is, previous to the establishment of this rule (M.S.). ' Mnamon, recorder. 286 PRIVATE AND CRIMINAL LAW husband to a wife loo staters or less, but not more ; if he should give more, the pertinent relatives shall have the property, (only) paying the money if they wish. If any one owing money, or under obUgation for damages,^ or during the progress of a suit, should give away anything, unless the rest of his property be equal to the obligation, the gift shall be null and void. One shall not buy a man while mortgaged until the mortgagor release him, nor one in dispute, nor accept him (as a gift), nor accept a promise or mortgage upon him; and if one should do any one of these things, it shall be void if 2 witnesses should testify. XVII. Adoption. — Adoption may take place whence one will; and the declaration shall be made in the market-place, when the citizens are gathered,^ from the stone from which proclamations are made. And let the adopter give to his hetaeria* a roast sacrifice and a can of wine. And if he (the adopted) receive all the property and there be no legitimate children, he shall fulfil all the divine and human obUgations of his adoptive father, and receive as is written for legitimate children ; but if he be not wilhng to do as is written, the kinsmen shall have the property. If there be legitimate chil- dren of the adoptive father, the adopted son shall receive with the males just as the females receive from the brothers. If however there be no males, but females, the adopted son shall have an equal share, and it shall not be compulsory upon him to pay the obliga- tions of the adopter and accept the property which the adopter leaves, for the adopted son shall succeed to no more (than an equal share with the daughters).* If the adopted son should die without leaving legitimate children, the property shall return to the pertinent relatives of the adopter. , If the adopter wish, he may renounce him (the adopted son) in the market-place, from the stone from which proclamations are made, when the citizens are gathered. '"Or adjudged a debtor" (B and L). The meaning of this passage seems to be that if one owes money on a judgment, or if a suit for money has been brought against him, any gift in fraud of the judgment creditor or of the plaintiff is voidable (M.S.). * Cf. the adrogaiio in older Roman law. ' An association of citizens corresponding somewhat to the phratry, brotherhood, of other Greek states. * "To more (than his share of property and obligations) the adopted son shall not succeed" (B and L). SUPPLEMENTAL PROVISIONS 287 And he shall deposit ten staters with the court, and the clerk of the court shall pay it to the person renounced as a parting gift of hospitality. A woman shall not adopt, nor a person under puberty. These things shall (now) be transacted as he (the legislator) has written these writings; but in previous cases, however one hold (property), whether by adoption or from an adopted son, it shall not be further subject to a legal claim. XVIII. Supplemental provisions. — If one take action by seizure against a man before trial, (the defendant) shall always receive him under his surety.^ Whatever is written for the judge to decide according to wit- nesses or by oath of denial, he shall decide as is written,^ but touching other matters shall decide under oath according to matters in controversy. If a person die owing money or having a judgment against him, if those who are next of right to receive the property desire, they can pay the damages in behalf of the deceased, and the money to whom it is owing, and then have the property ; but if they do not wish to do so, the property shall belong to those who have won the suit or to those to whom the money is owing, and there shall be no other loss to the heirs-at-law. The property of the father may be seized in behalf of the father, as also the mother's in behalf of the mother. V If a wife be separated from her husband, in case the judge de- cide upon the oath,' let her take the oath of denial within 20 days in the presence of the judge. Whatever he charges let the be- ginner of the suit announce to the woman and the judge and the clerk of the court, 4 days before in the presence of witnesses. . . . {Sixteen lines are lacking.) If a son have given property to his mother, or a husband to his wife, as was written before these writings, it shall not be illegal; but hereafter gifts shall be made as here written. If heiresses have no orphan judges while they are not of full maturity, they shall be treated as is wiitten. And where, in de- ' " (The man seized) is always to be protected" (B). "Against the person making the seizure opposition is to be raised whenever possible" (Zitelmann). ^ "In other cases he shaU decide the points in controversy upon his oath" (B and L). 'That is, if the judge decides that she is to take an oath (M.S.). 288 PRIVATE AND CRIMINAL LAW fault of a pertinent relative or orphan judges (public guardians) an heiress is brought up in her mother's house, the father's and mother's relatives that have been described shall manage the property and the income as they can best increase them until she marry. And she shall marry at 12 years or older. 77. Athenian Decree Ordering the Publication of Draco's Law of Homicide {Inscr. grcsc. I. no. 61 ; Hicks and Hill, no. 78 ; Daxeste, HaussouUier et Rei- nach, Recueil des inscriptions juridiques grecques, II. 1-24 (fullest restora- tions and commentary) ; Ditt. I. no. 52 ; Roberts and Gardner, Greek Epigraphy, II. no. 25. Translated by C. J. O.) To the oligarchy of the Four Hundred succeeded the government, theoreti- cally of the Five Thousand, practically of those who were able to equip them- selves for service in the heavy infantry (411 B.C. ; Botsford, Hellenic History, ch. xix). In the following year, however, the brilliant victory of Alcibiades off Cyzicus encouraged Athens to reestabUsh the democracy. This movement was accompanied by unusual legislative activity. The Athenians appointed (410) a board of Anagrapheis ("Avaypa^eis), Recorders of Law, whose duty was to eliminate inconsistencies from the code and to engrave anew the individual statutes. From Lysias, xxx, it appears that they continued in office six years and that they abused their power in their own financial interest. A part of the legislative activity of these years was the enactment of a decree for Umiting the power of the council of Five Hundred and for determining its relation to the Assembly and probably to the Heliastic courts. The inscription (Jnscr. grac. I. 57) is badly mutilated, but additional information may be gathered from Aristotle, Const. Atk. 45. The decree, however, with which we are here concerned is an order of the Five Hundred and the Assembly to the anagrapheis above mentioned to receive from the basileus ("king," or as modem writers generally say, "king archon"), and to engrave anew on a stone, the law of Draco concerning homicide. It had originally been published in 621, and probably contained provisions appl3dng to wilful murder as well as to other degrees of homicide. The present docu- ment, however, does not contain the article on murder in the first degree. The problem involved is exceedingly difficult ; but the most satisfactory solution seems to be the assumption that Solon aboUshed that article and substituted a provision of his own. This sufjposition best accounts for the fact that nowhere in his legislation did Draco mention the Areopagites, who had cognizance in cases of wilful murder, but throughout his law of homicide referred only to the ephetas (Plutarch, Solon, 19). In other words, the antiquarians, from whom Plutarch directly or indirectly drew his knowledge of this subject, had not seen LAW OF HOMICIDE 289 the original law of Draco but only the revision — perhaps the document given below. The text of the inscription is fragmentary, and can only be restored in part with the aid of Demosthenes xxiii {Against Aristocrates) and xliii {Con- cerning Macartatus), our most valuable sources for the general subject. See also Arist. Const. Ath. 57. On the laws of Draco and the revision of 409-8, see Meyer, Gesch. des Alt. II. 573-9; Busolt, Griech. Gesch. II. 225-43 ; III. 1538, n. 3; Gilbert, Const. Antiq. 379 sqq.; "Beitrage zur Entwicklungsgeschichte des griechischen Gerichtsverfahrens," in Jahrbiicher fiir class. Philologie, Supplb. XXIII (1897). 443-536; Botsford, Development of the Athenian Con- stitution, 146 sqq. DIOGNETUS OF PHREARRHOE WAS SECRETARY: DIOCLES WAS ARCHON* Be it resolved by the Boule and the Demus. (The tribe of) Acamantis held the prytany ; Diognetus was secretary ; Euthydi- cus was chairman ; Xenophanes offered the resolution : — That the Anagrapheis^ (Recorders of the Laws) shall receive from the basileus * the law of Draco concerning ijiurder, and shall record it, with the help of the secretary of the council, upon a stone stele and shall place it [in front of] the King's Porch.* The poletae ^ shall let the contract according to law, and the hellenotamiae * shall give the money. First Table.' And* if anyone shall kill another without pre- ' 409-8 B.C. ^ Anagrapheis, see introduction to this document. 'Basileus (BotrtXeiis), "king," or "king archon," originally the monarch of Athens but now a member of the board of nine archons; Arist. Const. Ath. 3. * On the King's Porch, see Botsford, Hellenic History, ch. xiii. The laws of Solon were likewise set up in this building ; Aristotle, Const. Ath. 7. ' Poletae, commissioners attending to the sale of public goods, the letting of public contracts, etc. •No. 68, n. I. 'The word here translated by "table" is axon, a revolving pillar faced with four rectangular tablets, on which the law was originally written. It is doubtful whether the law is quoted directly from the "first table" of Draco or was incorporated into the first table of Solon's code. ' This word shows that the opening provisions of the original law of Draco are not quoted — a fact which helps substantiate the view that the original law contained an article on wilful murder. Below are collected some of the principal passages relating to murder in the first degree : — I. Demosthenes xxiii. 24 : "It is written in the law that the Council has cognizance 290 PRIVATE AND CRIMINAL LAW meditation, [he shall be exiled.] The kings ^ shall administer justice on a charge of murder or [if anyone charges another with contriving it ( ?)] and the ephetm ^ shall decide. If there is a father or a brother or sons, all shall forgive,' or else the opposition of one shall prevail ; [if there are no] such persons, the relatives as far as the degree of first cousin [may forgive, if all of them] are wilUng, after swearing the oath. If there is not any one of these persons and the homicide was involuntary and the fifty-one ephetae decide that it was involun- tary, the slayer shall be admitted (to the country) by ten members of the phratry,* if they are willing. These persons shall be chosen by of murder and wounding with premeditation and arson and poisoning if anyone by administering it kills (another) ." .i. Aristotle, Const. Ath. 57. 3 : "Prosecutions for homicide and wounding, if anyone wilfully kills or wounds, are tried on the Areopagus, and for poisoning, if anyone kills by administering it, and for arson. These cases alone the boul£ tries." 3. Dem. xxiii. 67 sq. : "You all know surely that on the Areopagus, where the law grants and commands that there shall be trials for murder, in the first place the one who charges another with having committed such a crime must take an oath, imprecating destrucrion upon himself and his kin (genos) and family ; and it is no ordinary oath which he will take but one that no person swears in any other matter : he must stand on the vitals of a boar and ram and buU slain by fitting persons and at fitting times, so that with regard both to the time and the officiating persons the requirements of religious law have been met. Afterward the one who has sworn such an oath is not yet believed ; but if he shall be convicted of falsehood, he will fasten the guilt of perjury on his children and his kin, and will gain no advantage by it. But if it shall appear that his accusation is just, and he shall convict the other of having perpetrated the murder, not even thus will he become the master of the convicted person, but the laws and the authorities concerned shall have power over the latter ; he has it in his power to see the guilty person sufEer the penalty imposed by the law and nothing more. These are the things that fall to the prosecutor; the accused, on the other hand, must take the oath in Uke manner ; and after making the first pleading may retire into exile, and neither the prosecutor nor the judges nor any one else can prevent it." Cf. also Pollux viii. 117 ; Pausanias i. 28. s ; Lysias iii. 46. If the accused decides to take his trial, the punishment in case of conviction is death with the confiscation of property; Antiphon v (On the Murder of Herodes), 10; Lysias iii. 38. ' The question as to who these kings were is under controversy. The most likely view is that the four tribe kings assisted the "king archon" in the presidency of the court. ' A court of fifty-one jurors who were chosen from the nobihty and were above fifty years of age. Before the fourth century they had cognizance of all cases of homi- cide excepting wilful murder, which came before the Areopagites. The origin of the court and the reason for the number are unknown. ' This formal act of reconciliation permitted the slayer, who was in exile, to re- turn to his country. * An association of citizens with their wives and children which was both religious and dvic. The chief public function of the association was to maintain the racial LAW OF HOMICIDE 291 the fifty-one from those of noble birth.^ This ordinance shall be applicable also to those who have committed homicide previously.* The warning * to the slayer shall be given, in the market-place, by the relatives nearer than the degree of first cousin, but first cousins and sons of first cousins and sons-in-law * and fathers-in-law and members of the phratry shall aid in the prosecution. {Then follow several lines which cannot be restored.) If ainyone shall kill the murderer * or cause him to be slain while he is keeping away from the market-place on the frontier, from (public) games, and from amphictyonic sanctuaries,* such a person shall be subject to the same penalties as one who has killed an Athenian, and the decision shall rest with the ephetge. It shall be allowable to kill or arrest murderers in our own co]untry, but not to mistreat them or to take a ransom, under penalty of paying double the amount of the damage. (The next line is lost.) If anyone shall kill another in self-defence ^ ... if the homicide is involuntary, the kings shall try the case on a charge of murder, and the ephetse shall decide. [One who has killed a slave shall be subject to trial for murder in the same way as one who has killed] a free man. If anyone in his own defence shall kill on the spot one who is forcibly and unlawfully plundering, the homicide shall not be punished. {The remaining ten lines cannot be restored.) purity of the citizens by excluding all of alien blood, and to care for the civic interests of the children of citizens from the time of their introduction into the association to the enrolment of youths in the deme registers and the marriage of girls. ^This tmdoubtedly is the original meaning of the word ipurTivSrfv; it is evident that at least from the time of Draco the phratries comprised both nobles and commons. In the fifth century, however, it probably had reference to precedence in respectability as determined by the ephetse. ' As the present doomient was not a new law, there was no injustice in this pro- vision. ' As a polluted person the slayer was formally interdicted from the market-place, the sanctuaries, and religious ceremonies. *The Greek word (gambros, yan^pbi) may also include brothers-in-law. ' This section refers to the case of one who has been convicted of accidental homi- cide and has gone into exile; cf. Demosthenes xxiii. 37-41. ' In the fifth century the principal amphictyony was that of Delphi. The Delian amphictyony, which had flourished in the eighth and seventh centuries, had declined ; but an effort was made by the Athenians in the fifth century to revive it. .'Literally, "kill one who has made a beginning of unjust hands." 292 PRIVATE AND CRIMINAL LAW BIBLIOGRAPHY On the Gortynian laws, in addition to the works mentioned in the introduc- tion, see Bernhoft, Fr., " Das Gesetz von Gortyn," in Zeitschr. f. vergleichende Rechtswissenschaft, VI. 281-304, 430-40 ; Lipsius, H., Zum Recht von Gortyn (Teubner) ; Burchner, "Gortyn," in Pauly-Wissowa, Real-Encycl. VII (1912) 1665-71 (with references to recent studies in the subject). On Greek law, and particularly Attic law, see Telfy, I. B., Corpus iuris attici (Leipzig, 1868), a. collection of laws; Meier, M. H. E., and Schomann, G. F., Der attische Process, revised by Lipsius, J. H., 2 vols. (Berlin: Calvary, 1883-1887) ; Lipsius, Das attische Recht und Rechtsverfahren mil Benutzung des ' Attischen Process' von Meier und Schomann, 2 vols. (Leipzig: Reissland, 1905-1908) ; Beauchet, L., L'Histoire du droit privS de la ripuUique athSnienne, 4 vols. (Paris, 1897), the most useful work for the student of general Greek his- tory ; Gilbert, G., " Beitrage zur Entwicklungsgeschichte des griechischen Ge- richtsverfahrens," in Jahrh. fUr CI. Philol. Supplb. XXIII (1897). 445-536; Constitutional Antiquities of Sparta and Athens, 376-416; Swoboda, H., "Bei- trage zur griechischen Rechtsgeschichte," in Zeitschrift der Savigny-Stiftung fiir Rechtsgeschichte, XXVI (1905). 149-280; Szanto, E., Ausgewdhlte Abhand- lungen (Tubingen: Mohr, 1906), including various studies in Greek law; Bonner, R. J., Evidence in Athenian Courts (Chicago, 1905), dissertation. Minor studies are Allen, J. T., " On Secrecy in Voting in the Athenian Courts in the Fifth Century B.C.," in Class. Rev. XVIII (1904). 456-8; Arvanito- poullos. A., Zitfrriiiara rau 'Attikov SiKoum II. Hept t&v evOwZv (Athens, 1900) ; Brehier, L., De grcecorum iudiciorum origins (Paris, 1899) ; Bonner, R. J., "Did Women testify in Homicide Cases in Athens," inClass. Philol. I (1906). 127-32; Caillemer, E., "Etudes sur les antiquites juridiques d'Athenes," etc., in Ass. pour . . . Etudes grecques, XU (1878). 184-200; Dareste, R., "Le droit criminel athSnien," ib. XII. 29-47; Francotte, H., "L'antidosis," etc., M€m. acad. roy. des sciences, etc., LI (Brussels, 1895) ; Goldstaub, M., De aSetas notione et usu in iure attico (Breslauer Philol. Abhdl., 1889) ; Goligher, W. A., "Is£eusandAtticLaw,"infl'efmo/i}ri;s) an extraordinary magistrate in some Hellenic states, elected by the people and vested with a power somewhat like that of the Roman dic- tator; Pauly-Wissowa, Red-Encyd. I. 1088-91. 349 35° RELIGION the supreme magistrate, let him perish, both himself and his kin. If anyone in future, while supreme magistrate in Teos or in the Teian territory, should put to death illegally [an innocent man or say that he has betrayed] the city and the territory of the Teians, or should betray the men [in the island or on the sea or those who have come to the aid of the commonwealth of the Teians],^ or if he should practise highway robbery or harbor highway robbers or practise piracy or harbor pirates with knowledge, when they are plundering in the Teian territory or on the sea, or if he should knowingly plot any evil concerning the commonwealth of the Teians either with Greeks or with barbarians, let him perish, both himself and his kin. If any persons, while office-holders,^ should not pronounce the imprecation to the best of their ability during sessions of the assembly, at the Anthesteria,^ the festival of Heracles, and that of Zeus, let them be subject to the imprecation. If any- one shall break the stelae on which the imprecation is written, or shall cut away the lettering, or shall remove them, let him perish, both himself and his kin. 103. Athenian Decree Concerning the Temple and the Priestess of Athena Nike (Hicks and Hill, no. 37 ; Roberts and Gardner, no. 4 ; trans, by G. W. B.) This inscription provides for the building of a shrine which is undoubtedly to be identified with the beautiful .little temple of "Wingless Victory." The document belongs to 450-447. Callicrates, who drew up the plan, was also one of the architects of the Parthenon, begun about the same time. The in- scription is interesting for the light it throws, not only upon the construction of temples of the kind, but also upon the salaries and perquisites of priestesses. First Side of the Stele ...cus moved the resolution: That a priestess be established for Athena Nike, who shall be a citizen, bom of citizen parents, taken from the whole body of Athenian women (thus qualified). That the shrine shall be furnished with a door, according as Calli- ' This reading follows the suggestion of Haussoullier, adopted by Michel, Recuett, no. 1318, but the reading is very uncertain. ' Office-holders, timuchi (Ti/aouxot) were probably the ordinary annual magistrates, suspended on the election of an aisymnetes. ' A festival celebrated in February in honor of Dionysus. THE TEMPLE OF NIKE 351 crates shall draw up the specifications. That the commissioners of sales * shall let the contract in the prytany of the tribe Leontis. That the priestess shall have a living of fifty drachmae together with the legs and hides of the public sacrificial animals. That the temple and a stone altar be erected according to the specifications of Callicrates. Hestiseus further moved : . That a committee of three men be elected from the boul6, and that they shall assist CalUcrates in drawing up the specifications, and present to the boule their judg- ment on the letting of the contract ; and that the prytaneis report to the demus. . . . Second Side Be it resolved by the Boule and the Demus. ^geis was the prytanizing tribe. Neocleides was secretary. Agnodemus was chairman. CalUas moved the resolution : That the Colacretae,^ who may be in office in the month [Poseideon '], shall pay to the priestess of Athena Nike the fifty drachmae, recorded on the stele, to the priestess of Athena Nike. . . . 104. Additional Decree on the Same Subject (Roberts and Gardner, no. 6 ; Ditt. I. no. 16) . . . The Acropolis ... to build, so that no runaway slave or sneakthief may gain entrance. Callicrates shall draw up the specifications for it, and the commissioners of sales shall prepare to let the contract as advantageously and as inexpensively as possible. They shall see that it be ready within sixty days. The guards shall be three archers drawn from the prytanizing tribe.^ ' Poletae, whose duty in general was to let out state contracts. 2 Originally the Colacretse had been the chief treasurers of the state, but their im- portance had shrunk with the institution of various other finance officials ; cf. Meyer, Forsch. II. 136 sg. ' Corresponds roughly with December. For a list of the Attic months with their English equivalents, see Gulick, Life of the Ancient Greeks, 241. * It is evident that these guards were citizens {cf. Wernicke, in Hermes, XXVI. SI sqq. ) . The ordinary poUcemen of Athens, however, were pubUc slaves, brought originally from Scythia, and known therefore as Scythian archers. They were intro- duced in the sixth century; cf. Walters, Ancient Pottery, II. 176 (illustration). 3S2 RELIGION 105. Athenian Decree Concerndtg the Repayment of Sums bokrowed from the treasuries of the gods (Hicks and Hill, no. 49; Ditt. I. no. 21; Roberts and Gardner, II. no. 10; *Boekli, Staatshmishaltung der Athener, II. 42-8 (text, translation, and com- mentary) ; trans, by C. J. O.) This inscription is on a marble slab, formerly part of the altar of a Greek church but now in the Louvre. It belongs most probably to 435-4. At this time the Athenians had attained to a high degree of prosperity. Notwithstanding large sums expended on temples and other public works, accumulations in the state treasury had enabled them in recent years to repay 3000 talents formerly borrowed from the treasury of Athena. It is noteworthy that among ancient Hellenic states there was no system of public credit or of public debt, such as burdens every modem state, county, and municipality; but in time of need the government could borrow from a temple. As religion was a part of the state, such loans were merely a transfer of funds from one department to another, to be returned should circumstances permit. Accu- mulations in temples, accordingly, constituted a reserve fund for the state. In addition to the repayment of sums borrowed from Athena, the government was now in a position to return certain smaller sums drawn in like manner from the funds of other gods. The decree here translated provides for the latter trans- action. The money so paid, however, was to constitute the beginning of a new treasury, to be placed under the charge of Treasurers of the Other Gods, drawn by lot, as were the Treasurers of Athena, from the highest property class (the pentacosiomedimni). The style of the inscription proves that it was not engraved till some fifteen years after the date of enactment above given. See further on the document, Busolt, Griech. Gesch. 111. 562-5; Meyer, Forsch. II. 88 sqq. ; Cavaignac, L'Histoire financitre d'Athhnes au V' siicle, 104 sqq. Be it resolved by the Boul6 and the Demus. Cecropis was the prytanizing tribe. Mnesitheus was secretary. Eupeithes was chairman. CaUias moved the resolution. That the moneys owed shall be repaid to the gods, since there have been brought up into the Acropolis for Athena the three thousand talents' in our own coin, as had been voted. The repay- ment shall be made from the moneys which have been voted for repaying the gods; namely, the sums now in the hands of the ' This was the sum recently paid Athena in liquidation of the debt due her by the state. At $1100 to the talent it would amount to $3,300,000. About this time the total amount of money stored in the treasuries on the AcropoUs was 9700 talents, an immense reserve for a Greek state. Before the opening of the Peloponnesian war the erection of temples and other public works had reduced it to 6000 talents; Thuc. ii. 13. SACRED FUNDS 353 Hellenic Treasurers,^ the remainder that belongs to these funds, and the proceeds of the tithe,^ when it shall have been farmed out. The thirty accountants* now in oflftce shall audit with exactness the sums due to the gods, and the boule shall have full power* to convoke the accountants. The prytaneis, together with the (whole) boule, shall repay the moneys and shall cancel (the indebtedness) upon making payment, searching for the tablets and the account books and whatever other records there may be. The priests, the com- missioners of sacrifices, and any other person who has knowledge, shall be obliged to produce the records. Treasurers* of these funds shall be taken by lot at the same time as the other magistrates and upon the same terms as the Treasurers of the Sacred Funds of Athena. They shall deposit the funds of the gods, so far as is possible and allowable, in the Opisthodomos * on the Acropolis, and they shall join with the Treasurers of Athena in opening and closing and sealing the doors of the Opisthodomos. The funds (received) from the present treasurers and the superintendents and the com- missioners of sacrifices in the temples, who have the management at present, shall be counted and weighed out in the presence of the boule on the Acropolis by the Treasurers to be appointed, and these ' Hellenotamise were the imperial treasurers, in charge of the fund made up of trib- utes from the allies. ' Probably a rent of ten per cent on public lands let by the state to private persons. ' Logistae (Xoyurral), a board filled by lot, to whom aU public accounts had to be submitted. * This the boulg could do on its own responsibility, without consulting the assembly of citizens. ' Hereby was instituted the office of Treasurers of the Other Gods (see introduc- tion). Like the Treasurers of Athena they were doubtless ten in number, and were taken by lot from members of the highest property class. For a fragment of their account for the year 429-8, see Inscr. grac. I. nos. 194, 195, where, however, only five names appear. 'Opisthodomos (^OirurdiSoiMt), "Rear Chamber," applsang to the rear chamber of a temple. Some scholars have supposed that the Opisthodomos here mentioned was the rear chamber of the Parthenon ; but a careful examination of the sources proves that view untenable. Certain scholars, accordingly, have taken the ground that the term has reference to the back part of the old Athena temple, north of the Parthenon, and contend that this part, consisting of three rooms, was rebuilt as a Treasury after the Persian war. The most complete defense of this view is given by J. W. White, Harvard Studies in Classical Philology, VI (1895). Another view, repre- sented by Judeich, Topographic von Athen, 230, which regards the Opisthodomos as a building to the west of the Parthenon, erected about 454 as an imperial Treasury, seems to have less evidence in the sources. 354 RELIGION oflScers shall receive the funds from the persons now in office and shall record them all on a single stele, both the amounts belonging to each of the gods respectively and the sum total, the silver and the gold separately. And in future the Treasurers for the time being shall make record upon a stele and shall account to the auditors for the funds at hand and for those accruing to the gods, and for whatever is expended during the year. They shall submit to examination,^ — -and shall render their account from Panathenasa to Panathenaea,^ like the Treasurers of Athena. The Treasurers shall place on the AcropoKs the stelae on which they record the sacred funds. When the moneys shall have been repaid to the gods, the surplus shall be used for the dockyard and the fortifications. io6. The Athenian Decree for Regulating the Offerings OF First Fruits to the Goddesses of Eleusis (,Inscr. grac. I. Supplem. no. 27 b,p. 59; Ditt. no. 20; Prott and Ziehen, Leges gracorum sacra, pt. II (Leipzig, 1906), p. 19 sqq. ; Foucart, in Bulletin de correspondance helUnique, TV (1880). 229 sqq. ; trans, by C. J. O.) One of the aims of Pericles was to use religion as a means of securing to Athens a recognized leadership in Hellenic affairs. Such was his project for the restoration of temples destroyed by the Persian invader (Plut. Per. 17). If, as seems probable, the decree given in Inscr. grasc. I. no. i ; Supplem. p. 3, 133, belongs to the time shortly following 460 (Busolt, Griech. Gesch. III. 473), we may infer that he wished to apply the Eleusinian worship to that end. He had all the greater hope for success in this policy because of the fact that the Eleusinian cult had already extended far beyond the borders of Attica — e.g., to Sicily (Athenaeus ix. 17, 374 d). To a somewhat later period — evidently to a time of peace, perhaps 444-436 — belongs the following decree (Busolt, op. cit. III. 474 and n. 2), which regulates the offering of first fruits to the God- desses Twain of Eleusis on the part of the Athenians and their allies, and in- vites all other Hellenes to participate. Be it resolved by the Boul6 and the Demus. Cecropis was the prytanizing tribe. Timoteles was secretary.' Cycneas was chair- ' Euthjrna (EifSui/o), a general investigation to which outgoing officials were sub- jected and more thorough than formal accounting. ^ That is, their term begins with the Panathenaic festival Quly), and not with the civil year. ' At this time a new secretary of the boulfi was appointed for each prytany. FIRST FRUITS 355 man. The commissioners of legislation ^ drafted (the statute) in the following terms : The Athenians shall offer first fruits from the harvest to the Two Goddesses^ according to ancestral custom and the oracle from Delphi : ^ namely, from every hundred medimni of barley not less than one sixth of a medimnus,* and from every hundred medimni of wheat not less than one twelfth of a medimnus. If anyone has a har- vest of greater, or of equal, or of less amount, he shall offer the first fruits in the same proportion. The demarchs^ shall collect the offering by demes and shall bring it to Eleusis, to the commissioners of sacrifices. Three corn pits shaU be constructed according to ancestral custom, wherever the commissioners of sacrifices and the architect may think proper, with the money of the Two Goddesses; and the commissioners shall store therein the grain that they may receive from the demarchs. The allies * also shall offer first fruits on the same terms, and the cities shall choose col- lectors of the grain, according as they may think that the grain will best be collected. When it is collected, they shall send it to Athens, and those who take it shall bring it to Eleusis to the com- missioners of sacrifices at Eleusis ; and if the commissioners shall not accept it within five days after announcement and tender are made by the men of the city from which the grain comes, they shall be fined a thousand drachmas ^ apiece. They shall accept it from the demarchs also on the same terms. Let the council choose heralds and send them to the cities to announce the [present] decree of the people, (and let it do so) for the present occasion as soon as possible, ' Syngrapheis (Su77pa0ets), a committee appointed to draw up a comprehensive law. ^ Demeter and Persephone (Corfi), in whose worship the Eleusinian mysteries were celebrated. ' Cf. Isocrates, Paneg. 31 (composed 390-380) : "Most of the cities sent us every year offerings of the first fruits of grain in remembrance of our ancient benefactions ; and the Pythia (the priestess of Apollo at Delphi) has often enjoined the neglectful to contribute their tithes of the harvest, and to show toward our city the conduct pre- scribed by ancestral usage"; see also the scholiast on Aristoph. Phttus, 1054. *A medimnus was about ij bu.; a sixth would therefore be about a peck. ^ Demarch (SiJ/uopx"'), chief officer of the deme, or township. Attica was divided into considerably more than a hundred demes. « The states of the Delian Confederacy and Athenian empire. ' A drachma was about eighteen cents. 356 RELIGION and in future whenever it thinks best. Let both the hierophant and the torch-bearer at the celebration of the Mysteries ^ bid the Greeks offer first fruits from the harvest according to the ancestral custom and the oracle from Delphi. Let them (the commissioners) write upon a tablet both the amount of grain received from the de- marchs according to demes and that received from the cities ac- cording to cities, and let them place (a tablet) in the Eleusinion" at Eleusis and in the council-hall. The council shall send word also to all the other Greek cities, wheresoever in its opinion it may be possible to send, by men who shall tell them how the Athenians and the allies offer first fruits, and who, without commanding them, shall urge them to offer if they so desire according to the ancestral custom and the oracle from Delphi. The commissioners of sacrifices shall receive (offerings) on the same terms from these cities also, if anyone brings (offerings). They (the commissioners) shall sacrifice from the sacred porridge according as the Eumolpidae * shall direct, and, from (the proceeds of) the barley and the wheat, an ox and two other animals * with gilded horns to each of the Two Goddesses, a full-grown sheep to Triptolemus and the God and the Goddess and Eubulus ^ severally, and an ox with gilded horns to Athena. The commissioners shall sell the remainder of the barley and of the wheat and, together with the council, shall make and dedicate offerings to the Two Goddesses, such as shall seem good to the Athenian people, and they shall inscribe upon the offerings the fact that they were dedicated from (the proceeds of) the first fruits of the harvest and the name of the Greeks who offered the first fruits. And may those who do thus have many blessings and good and abundant harvests, provided that they do not wrong the Athenians or the city of the Athenians or the Two Goddesses. ' Celebrated annually at Eleusis in September. About that time the contributions of grain were probably brought to Eleusis; cf. A. Mommsen, Feste der Stadt Athen (Leipzig, i8g8), 192-5. ""The temple of Eleusis. Ditteuberger, however, would transpose the followmg words so as to read : "in the Eleusinion (a sanctuary at Athens) and at Eleusis in the council-hall." ' A gens (an association of families assumed to be of one kin) who had the function of regulating the Eleusinian ceremonial. * Literally, ''a triad headed by an ox" — an ox, a ram, and a he-goat. ' On these divinities, see Famell, Cults of the Greek States, III (Oxford, 1907). 13s sg., 144 sq. FIRST FRUITS; PELARGICUM 357 Lampon^ moved as an amendment to the statute concerning the offering of the first fruits of the harvest to the Two Goddesses : The secretary of the council shall record the statute and the fol- lowing decree on two stone stelas and shall place one of them in the sanctuary at Eleusis and the other on the Acropolis. The poletEe ^ shall let the contract for the stelae, and the colacretae ' shall give the money therefor. These provisions concerning the offering of the first fruits of the harvest to the Two Goddesses shall be recorded upon the stelae ; but furthermore the new archon shall intercalate the month Hecatombaeon.* The king archon * shall mark the bounds of the sanctuaries in the Pelargicum/ and in future altars shall not be set up in the Pelaxgicum without (the authority of) the council and the people. Neither shall the stones be quarried from the Pelargicum nor shall earth or stone be taken thence. If anyone shall violate any of these provisions, he shall pay (a fine of) five hundred drachmae, and the king archon shall denounce him to the council. Lampon shall draft a statute concerning the offering of the first fruits of oil and shall exhibit it to the council in the ninth prytany, and the council shall o| necessity bring it before the people. 107. The Construction of the Erechtheum A. CONDITION of THE MATERIAL IN 409-8 B.C. (Inscr. grmc. I. 322. Translated by E. G. S.) In 409-8, shortly after the restoration of the absolute democracy (no. 77, introduction) the Athenians resumed work on the Erechtheum, on the Acrop- olis, a temple second only to the Parthenon in beauty. We do not know when it had been begun, whether after the peace of Nicias, 421, or possibly before • An influential soothsayer, often mentioned by writers of comedy in that age. ^ See no. 103, n. i. ' See no. 103, n. 2. < In order to adjust the Iimar months of the Attic calendar to the seasons, an extra month was inserted every second or third year by the head Archon, usually after the sixth month in midwinter. . The msertion of an extra Hecatombaeon (July) in this case seems to have been for the purpose of allowmg more time for the sending of the contri- butions. ' The chief religious official. 6 A precinct at the western extremity of the Acropolis, by the gateway of the orig- inal fortifications; cj. Judeich, Topographie von Athen, 107 sqq. For the " taboo" upon it see Thucydides, ii. 17. 3S8 RELIGION the outbreak of the Peloponnesian war; D'Ooge, Acropolis, 196. It was devoted to Athena Polias — guardian of the city — whose statue was a log rudely carved in human form, and to Erechtheus, a hero-king of Athens ; see Botsford, Hellenic History, ch. xx. The following passage comprises a few items excerpted from a lengthy report to the government on the condition of the material for the Erechtheum, at the time of the resumption of its construc- tion, drawn up by the committee of supervisors for the building of that temple. The Committee of Supervisors ^ of the temple on the Acropolis, in which is the ancient cult statue,^ Brosunes of Cephisia, Chariades of Argyle, Diodes of Cephisia, the chief architect Philocles of Acharnae, Etearchus of Cydathenaion the secretary, recorded the following works of the temple in the condition in which they took them over in accordance with a resolution of the demus — (comprising material) finished and half-wrought — in the archon- ship of Diodes, when the tribe Cecropis held the first prytany, in the term of that boul6 ' in which Nicophanes of Marathon was first to serve as secretary. Of the temple we took over the following (material) half- wrought : — At the corner near the Cecropion * — 4 blocks not set, 4 feet in length, 2 feet in width, 35 in thickness. I 'armpit' piece, 4 feet in length, 3 feet in width, i| feet in thickness. 5 blocks of toplayer, 4 feet in length, 3 feet in width, i| feet in thickness. I angle block, 7 feet in length, 4 feet in width, i| feet in thickness. I curved stone not set, corresponding to the toplayer blocks, 10 feet in length, if feet in height. . . . Of the columns at the wall on the side of the Pandroseion ; * of (half-done material) : — ' 'En-tffTdToi, the committee appointed to supervise the construction of the bxiild- ing. The names of the supervisors follow. 'This was the wooden statue mentioned in the introduction. Individuals are distinguished by their demes (townships). ' On demus, prytany, and boulfi, see no. 69, n. i. * Cecropion, shrine of Cecrops, hero-king of Athens. It stood near the southwest comer of the Erechtheum; D'Ooge, Acropolis, 216 sgq. ^ As the only wall columns connected with the Erechtheum were on the west, it follows that the Pandroseion, shrine of Fandrosos, daughter of Cecrops, was on that side ; cf. D'Ooge, lac. cit. ARCHITECTURAL MATERIALS 359 4 pieces of columns in position uncut for i| feet of each column from the inner anthemion.^ It is necessary to set in addition a volute at the inside of the south wall. The following are unpolished and not fluted : — The wall on the inside of the south wing is not polished except that one in the portico near the Cecropion. The upright blocks are unpolished, the outside .ones all around, except those in the portico contiguous to the Cecropion. All the rounded base mouldings are unfluted; the columns all unfluted except the one at the wall ; the entire founda- tion around is unfluted; parts of the inner wall are un- poUshed. . . . In the f af ade which is at the portal : — (We found) the altar of the sacrificing priest unset ; the cross- beams (of the roof) and tie-beams unset (not firmly set). At the f agade near the Cecropion : — It is necessary to work the roofstones (3) lying on the maidens," on their upper surfaces, for a length of 13 feet, a width of 5. The bronze ornaments on the architraves ought to be wrought to completion. Items of stone completely wrought which are on the ground : — II blocks, 4 feet in length, 2 feet in width, i^ feet in thickness. I 'armpit' block 4 feet in length, 3 feet in width, of a thickness of i| feet. . . . Facing the wall at the Pandroseion, a length of 7I feet, width of 3I feet, half-wrought in smooth work. I length of 6 feet, width of 3 feet and i pahn, thickness of 5 palms, at the wall facing the Pandroseion ; five feet of this part did not have the bead-work carved in. 6 pieces of pediment, those from the colonnade, 7I feet in length, 3I feet in width, i foot in thickness — half-wrought. . . . 4 doors of stone 8 feet long and a palm ; 2| feet wide ; of these parts the rest have been completed, but the black stones should be inserted in the rails (of the doors) : — ' For the architectural terms used in this inscription, see Fowler and Wheeler, Greek Archaology, and Tarbell, History of Greek Art (indices). ' These are the famous statues of maidens (Caryatids) in the south porch. 36o RELIGION The console ^ for the space above the eastern door, half-done. 3 for the altar of the sacrificing priest, of PenteUc marble, 4 feet in length, 2 feet high, and 2 feet and i palm in thickness. . . . 108. Construction of the Erechtheum b. account of expenses for work and material (Inscr. grcBC. I. no. 324. Translated by E. G. S.) The following selection is made up of items excerpted from the account of expenditures on the construction of the Erechtheimi for the year 408. The inscription is so mutilated that we cannot determine the sum total of expendi- tures. The value of the document lies chiefly in the information it affords regarding the social classes of laborers, their wages, and the cost of certain materials. The Athenian citizen is distinguished by the name of his deme, as " ArescBchmus of Agryle "; rarely by the name of his father and that of his deme. The metic (alien resident) is described as residing in a deme, as "Manis residing in CoUytus." The name of the slave is followed by that of the master in the genitive case, as"Cerdon (slave) of Axiopeithes"; see Francotte, L' Industrie dans la Grice, I. 204, n. 2. Francotte has thus calculated that of eighty-one men engaged in the work, twenty-four were citizens, forty metics, and seventeen slaves. There are many besides who cannot be classifled ; but from the pro- portions given we can see that the citizens, though on the verge of famine, were not favored, and that the greater part ot the work was done by free hands. It is clear, too, that the supervisors engaged either individuals or extremely small groups, as a man and his co-worker, a master with a slave or two; in other words, labor was not capitalized. A most remarkable fact is that slave, metic, and citizen, underling and architect received the same daily wage of one drachma. * * ifc :)( * * * For completing roof : to the men who brought on the rounded plank and the others for each seat : To Manis residing in Collytus , i drachma. To Croesus residing in Scambonidae i dr. To Andreas residing in Melite i dr. To Prepon residing in Agryle i dr. ******* To the six men who took down the scaffolding from the columns of the fagade To Teucrus residing in Cydathenaion ' i dr. ' Roberts and Gardner. * Evidently the workmen thus far mentioned were metics ; see introduction. WORKMEN'S WAGES 361 To Cerdon (slave) of Axiopeithes ' i dr. ******* To the men who did the scafiolding for the encaustic artists under the roof : To Manis residing in Coll)rtus 4 dr. ******* Total for underworkers 84 dr. si obols. To the sawyers working day by day, 16 days for 2 men, 1 dr. per day per man To Radius residing in Collytus and his co-worker 32 dr. To sawyers working by the day, for third period of twelve days, wooden laths for the roofs, for seven days, i dr. per day (each) for two men To Radius residing in Collytus and his co-worker 14 days. Total for the sawyers 46 dr. For the encaustic painters : To the one who made the encaustic cymatium which is on the inner archi- trave, s obols per foot.'' ******* Total to encaustic painters 30 dr. To goldsmiths (lit. gold pourers) : We further gave to him who gilded bronze figures what was due of the pre- ceding prytany,' that of Oeneis. ******* To the architect ArchUochus of Agryle 37 dr.* To the underclerk Pyrgion 30 dr. 5 obols. Total for wages 67 dr. 5 obols. Total for entire expenditure 1790 dr. 3 J obols. In the seventh prytany, that of the tribe of Leontis : Received from the treasurers of the Goddesses,^ from Aresaech- mus and his fellow-ofiScials, 4302 dr. i obol. ' For the fact that this workman was a slave, see introduction. ' Here we notice that some of the artists were paid according to the amount of work accomplished. ' It is dear that these accounts were kept according to prytanies, a prytany being a tenth of the year: see no. 69, n. i. Each prytany was named after the tribe whose delegation in the council constituted the prytaneis (supreme administrative committee) for the time being. * As this prytany doubtless included 37 days, we learn here that the architect re- ceived only a drachma a day, the same as a common laborer. From the item below it is not necessary to suppose that the underclerk received less, as he may have worked fewer days. 6 On the Treasurers of the Goddess (Athena), see no. 105, introduction. 362 RELIGION Expenditure; purchases: . . . Phyromachus of Cephisia, the youth by the breastplate 60 dr. Praxias residing in Melite, the horse and the figure appearing behind, turning the horse round 120 dr. Hi 4i * * * * * Phyromachus of Cephisia, the man leaning on the staff, the one next to the altar 60 dr. lasos of CoUytus, the woman whom the young girl has embraced 80 dr. Total for the making of religious figures 3315 dr. Received 4302 dr. Expenditure the same. In the Pandionis, the eighth prytany : Received from the Treasurers of the Goddess, Aresaechmus and his fellow-oflScials 1239 dr. i ob. Expenditure ; purchases : 2 planks (wooden tablets) on which we are entering the account ; each I dr.^ 2 dr. The stone- work account : for fluting the columns on the east side, those by the third altar from the altar of Dione : Ameiniades residing in Ccele 18 dr. (In another prytany) ******* Expenditure ; purchases : 2 pieces of papyrus were purchased, on which we entered the copies (of the accounts) 2 dr. 4 obols. 4 tablets 4 dr. Gold was purchased for the bronzes, leaves 165 dr. i obol. Each leaf at i dr., from Adonis residing in Melite 166 dr. Lead was purchased, 2 talents, for the clamping of the small figures, from Sostratus, residing in MeUte ^ 10 dr. Gold, 2 leaves, was purchased to gild the 'eyes' of the column, from Adonis residing in Melite 2 dr. Total of purchases 189 dr. 1 obol. For stone-work : for fluting pillars toward the east, those by the altar. That by the altar of Dione : Laossus of Alopece, Philon of Erchia, Parmenon slave of Laossus, Carion slave of Laossus.' . . . ^It appears that the clerk kept the running accounts on wooden tablets, which were copied on papyrus, as is stated below ; and the accounts as finally approved were engraved on stone, which alone has been preserved. ' It is an interesting fact that this merchant and another, Adonis, mentioned im- mediately above, were both metics. In these transactions there seems to have been no '^^ea of giving native Athenians the preference. ' Here is an interesting combination of workmen : the citizen Laossus with two slaves has wdtked by the side of another citizen, Philon, in fluting certain pillars. DEITIES OF THE ERECHTHEUM 363 109. The Completed Erechthextm and the Worship of Athena (Fausanias i. 26) There is also a building called the Erechtheum. Before the entrance is an altar of Supreme Zeus, where they sacrifice no living thing ; but they lay cakes on it, and having done so they are for- bidden by custom to make use of wine. Inside of the building are altars : one of Poseidon, on which they sacrifice also to Erechtheus in obedience to an oracle; one of the hero Butes; and one of Hephaestus. On the walls are paintings of the family of the Butads.^ Within, for the building is double, there is sea-water in a well. This is not surprising, for the same thing may be seen in inland places, as at Aphrodisias in Caria. But what is remarkable about this well is that, when the south wind has been blowing, the well gives forth a sound of waves ; and there is the shape of a trident in the rock. These things are said to have been the evi- dence produced by Poseidon in support of his claim to the country. The rest of the city and the whole land are equally sacred to Athena; for although the worship of other gods is established in the townships, the inhabitants none the less hold Athena in honor. But the object which was universally deemed the holy of holies many years before the union of the townships, is an image of Athena in what is now called the Acropolis, but what was then called the city. The legend is that the image fell from heaven, but whether this was so or not I will not inquire. As to this I shall not give an opinion, whether it was so or not. Callimachus made a golden lamp for the goddess. When they fill this lamp with oil, it lasts a whole year, although it bums continually night and day. There are various other indications in this inscription that citizens, metics, and slaves worked side by side on the same architectural piece. It is interesting, too, that slaves could do as dehcate artistic work as citizens or metics. ' The Butads, who after the time of Cleisthenes called themselves Eteobutadae, to distinguish themselves as members of a noble clan from the Butad demesmen, were hereditary priests of Poseidon; TopSer, J., Attische Genealogie (Berlin, 1889). 113 jgj. 364 RELIGION up. Law of the City of Iulis in Ceos for Regulating Funerals ilnscr. greBC.XLI.ao. 593; Ditt. II. no. 877; Michel, Recueil, no. 398 A; Dareste-Haussoullier-Reinach, Recueil des inscriptions juridiques grecques, I (1891). 10-17; Buck, Greek Dialects, II. no. 8; and especially Prott and Ziehen, Leges Grcecorum Sacrce, II. i. 260-67, including an elaborate commentary. Translated by C. J. O.) This inscription, found at lulis on the island of Ceos, belongs on philologi- cal grounds to the last quarter of the fifth century (425-400) ; but the funda- mental laws contained in it must be far older. They were either simply repub- lished or more probably revised in some points. Sumptuary regulations, directed against extravagant and ostentatious funeral ceremonies, were com- mon in ancient Hellenic states, and were ascribed to various eminent lawgivers, notably to Solon ; Cicero, De Legibus, ii. 59-66 ; Plutarch, Solon, 20 sq. For the most part, however, we have only scattered allusions to the subject in ancient authors, and this stringent law of lulis is valuable as a connected though brief account of Hellenic burial customs, in addition to its mention of curious superstitions. The similar ordinance of the Labyadae at Delphi (Ditt. II. no. 438 C ; Michel, no. 995 C) should be compared ; and for a general view of the subject, see Rohde, Psyche (4th ed. Tubingen, 1907). I. 216-58. The following (are the) laws regarding the departed. They shall bury * the dead person in the following manner : in three pieces of white cloth,^ namely, a sheet, A, garment, and a coverlet — it shall also be permitted to use fewer — all three not to exceed one hundred drachmae ' in value. They shall bear him forth on a bed with wedge-shaped feet,* and shall not cover the . . ^ with the cloths. They shall take to the tomb not more than three choes of wine and not more than one chous of olive oil ; * and they shall take the vessels away with them. They shall carry the dead person (with his face) covered,' observing silence as far as the tomb. They shall perform the preliminary sacrifice * according to ancestral ' The Greek word thaptein (ffiirTeiK), which may be used of either interment or cremation, seems here to signify all the funeral rites. ' Cloth in which the body is to be wrapped. ' Drachma, about 18 cents. The entire cost therefore is not to exceed $18. * I.e., unornamented. ° Both the reading and the interpretation of the word here omitted are uncertain. ' About nine quarts of wine and three of oil. ' So as to avoid polluting.the streets of the dty and the light of day. 'Probably a sacrifice offered in the grave itself before the burial; Prott and Ziehen, op. cit. II. 264 sq. THE DEAD 365 custom. They shall take the bed and the coverings ^ home from the tomb. On the following day a free person shall sprinkle the house with sea water first,^ and then all the rooms(?) * with hyssop.* When the house has been sprinkled throughout, it shall be pure, and they shall offer sacrifices upon the hearth. The women who go to the funeral shall not(?) ^ go away from the tomb before the men. They shall not perform rites on the thirtieth day ' for the dead person. They shall not place a cup beneath the bed, nor pour out the water, nor shall they carry the sweepings to the tomb.^ Wherever a person dies, no women shall go to the house after the body is borne forth, except those who are polluted (by the death), namely, the mother, the wife, sisters and daughters, and not more than five women besides them ; also children of daughters and of cousins (are polluted), but no one else.* Those who are polluted, after washing themselves ... by pouring water, shall be pure. (The remainder is lost.) III. Worship of the Dead at Athens (Sophocles, Electra, 404-500) The following passage offers further information on the relations between the kinsmen and their dead, as represented in Attic tragedy. Noteworthy is the beUef that the spirit of the deceased father, when duly invoked, will come from the tomb to aid his daughter against enemies. ' Probably the sheet and coverlet already mentioned. * Cf. Euripides, Iphigeneia in Tauris, 1193 : "The sea washes away all the ills of men." ' So Prott and Ziehen. Buck would restore thus : "And then a slave shall step in (and shall sprinkle the house). " * For the use of hyssop in purifications, see Leviticus xiv. 49-53. ' The insertion of the word is very doubtful. * At Athens a memorial feast was held thirty days after the funeral ; cf. Rohde, Psyche, I. 233, n. 3. ' These superstitions are not mentioned by ancient writers, but may be compared with similar practices among the modem Greeks and the German peasantry ; Cf. Prott and Ziehen, op. cit. II. 265 sqq. ' The sense of this passage is slightly confused, but it seems to mean that the rela- tives as far as the fifth degree are rendered impure, but only five women from their number, in addition to the immediate family, shall join in the lamentations. 366 RELIGION Clytemnestra, queen of Argos, has murdered her husband Agamemnon, and now lives in dread of punishment for the crime. Frightened by a dream, she sends her daughter Chrysothemis with a sacrifice to offer at the tomb of the slain king. Electra, another daughter, meets Chrysothemis on the way, and the following conversation takes place. Chrysothemis. Then I will go fortlj upon mine errand. Electra. And whither goest thou? To whom bearest thou these offerings ? Chr. Our mother sends me with funeral libations for our sire. El. How sayest thou? For her deadliest foe? Chr. Slain by her own hand — so thou wouldest say. El. What friend hath persuaded her ? Whose wish was this? Chr. The cause, I think, was some dread vision of the night. El. Gods of our house ! be ye with me — now at last ! Chr. Dost thou find any encouragement in this terror? El. If thou wouldest tell me the vision, then I could answer. Chr. Nay, I can teU but little of the story. El. Tell what thou canst ; a little word hath often marred, or made men's fortunes. Chr. 'Tis said that she beheld our sire, restored to the sunlight, at her side once more ; then he took, the scepter, — once his own, but now borne by .^gisthus, — and planted it at the hearth ; and thence a fruitful bough sprang upward, wherewith the whole land of Mycenae was overshadowed.^ Such was the tale that I heard told by one who was present when she declared her dream to the Sun-god. More than this I know not, — save that she sent me by reason of that fear. So by the gods of our house I beseech thee, hearken to me, and be not ruined by folly ! For if thou repel me now, thou wilt come back to seek me in thy trouble. El. Nay, dear sister, let none of these ^things in thy hands touch the tomb ; for neither custom nor piety allows thee to ded- icate gifts nor bring libations to our sire from a hateful wife. No — to the winds with them; or bury them deep in the earth, where none of them shall ever come near his place of rest ; but, when she dies, let her find these treasures laid up for her below. And were she not the most hardened of all women, she would ' This omen foretells the growth of her son Orestes, now an exile, to manhood and his succession to the throne of his father. OFFERINGS TO THE DEAD 367 never have sought to pour these offerings of enmity on the grave of him whom she slew. Think now if it is likely that the dead in the tomb shall take these honors kindly at her hand, who ruthlessly slew him, like a foeman, and mangled him, and for ablution wiped off the bloodstains on his head? Canst thou believe that these things which thou bringest will absolve her of the murder ? It is not possible. No, these things cast aside ; give him rather a lock cut from thine own tresses, and on my part, hapless that I am, — scant gifts these, but my best, — this hair, not glossy with unguents, and this girdle, decked with no rich ornament. Then fall down and pray that he himself may come in kindness from the world below, to aid us against our foes ; and that the young Orestes may live to set his foot upon his enemies in victorious might, that henceforth we may crown our father's tomb with wealthier hands than those which grace it now. I think, indeed, I think that he also had some part in sending her these appalling dreams; still, sister, do this service, to help thyself and me, and him, that most beloved of all men, who rests in the realm of Hades, thy sire and mine. Chorus. The maiden counsels piously ; and thou, friend, wilt do her bidding. Chr. I win. When a duty is clear, reason forbids that two voices shall contend, and claims the hastening of the deed. Only, when I attempt this task, aid me with your silence, I entreat you, my friends ; for should my mother hear of it, methinks I shall yet have cause to rue my venture. Ch. If I am not an erring seer and one who fails in wisdom. Justice, that hath sent the presage, wiU come, triumphant in her righteous strength, — will come ere long, my child, to avenge. There is courage in my heart, through those new tidings of the dream that breathes comfort. Not forgetful is thy sire, the lord of Hellas ; not forgetful is the two-edged axe of bronze that struck the blow of old, and slew him with foul cruelty. The Erinys ^ of untiring feet, who is lurking in her dread am- bush, wiU come as with the march and with the might of a great host. For wicked ones have been fired with passion that hurried * Erinys, the avenging Fury of the slain man ; she will soon punish the murderess. 368 RELIGION them to a forbidden bed, to accursed bridals, to a marriage. stained, with guilt of blood. Therefore am I sure that the portent will not fail to bring woe upon the partners in crime. Verily mortals can- not read the future in fearful dreams or oracles, if this vision of the night find not due fulfilment. 112. COLONtrS AND ITS RELIGIOUS ASSOCIATIONS (Sophocles, CEdiptis of Colonus, 668-719) Colonus was a deme (township) of Attica, about a mile and a quarter northwest of Athens, and not far from the Academy. It was the birthplace of Sophocles. In that age Greece was well watered, and Colonus was most beautiful,, as this description shows, though it is now desolate. The passage is included in this chapter to illustrate the religious associations which clustered even about places not distinguished for famous shrines. At the same time it is evidence of the marvelous beauty of the place and of the poet's appreciation of the loveliness of nature. • Stranger,^ in this land of goodly steeds thou hast come to earth's fairest home, even to our white Colonus ; where the nightingale, a constant guest, trills her clear note in the covert of green glades, dwelling among the wine-dark ivy and the god's inviolate bowers, rich in berries and fruit, unvisited by sun, unvexed by wind of any storm; where the reveller Dionysus ever walks the ground, com- panion of the nymphs that nursed him. And fed of heavenly dew, the narcissus blooms morn by morn, with fair clusters, crown of the great Goddesses ^ from of yore ; and the crocus blooms with golden beam. Nor fail the sleepless founts whence the waters of Cephissus wander, but each day with stainless tide he moveth over the plains of the land's swelhng bosom, for the giving of quick increase ; nor hath the Muses' choir abhorred this place, nor Aphrodite of the golden rein. And a thing there is such as I know not by fame on Asian ground, or as ever born in the great Dorian isle of Pelops, — a growth unconquered, self-renewing, a terror to the spears of foe- men, a growth which mightily flourishes in this land, — the gray- *The stranger is (Edipus, who wandering in exile is now approaching Colonus. The speaker is the Chorus, composed of the elders of Colonus. ' Demeter and her daughter Persephone. COLONUS; ATHEISM 369 leafed olive, nurturer of children. Youth shall not mar it by the ravage of his hand, nor any one who dwells with old age ; for the sleepless eye of the Morian Zeus ^ beholds it, and the gray-eyed Athena. And another praise have I to tell for this the city of our mother, the gift of a great god, a glory of the land most high ; the might of horses, the might of young horses, the might of the sea. For thou, son of Cronos, our Lord Poseidon,'' hast throned her in this pride, since in these roads first thou didst show forth the curb that cures the rage of steeds. And the shapely oar, apt to men's hands, hath a wondrous speed on the brine, following the hundred- footed Nereids. 113. The Gods are Man's Invention (Critias, Sisyphus; Nauck. Frag. p. 771 sq. Translated by E. G. S.) The author is the famous leader of the " Thirty " who governed Athens with terror and violence for a short time after the close of the Peloponnesian war. Though his talent was remarkably versatile, he lacked moral character, wanting even the generous impulses of the friend of his youth, Alcibiades. The follow- ing passage from his Sisyphus is a bolder denial of the existence of the gods than anything that can be found in Euripides ; See Botsford, Hellenic History, ch. XX. A time once existed when unordered was the life of men, and kindred to the beasts — a life enslaved to brute force, when no reward existed for the good, nor for the bad was wrought chastise- ment. Then, methinks, did men establish laws as means of punish- ment, that Justice might be autocrat . . . and have Insolence for slave ; and penalty was meted out to any who transgressed. When the laws restrained them openly from doing deeds of force, but secretly they did them, then, methinks, some man, adroit and wise, conceived the notion of devising gods for mankind, that awe might be for the bad, even if secretly they should perform or say or think (some evil) . Thence he did introduce divinity : that there is a Supernal Being flourishing with life imperishable, and mind, hearing and seeing and thinking, and attending to these things and 'Zeus Morios, guardian of the sacred olives {ixoplai) of the Academy, a public garden near by. 2 Poseidon, god of the sea and of horses, had a shrine here. 370 RELIGION bearing divine nature, who will hear all that is spoken among mortals and will perceive all that is enacted. Even if in silence thou some evil plannest, this will not escape the gods. For faculty of thought . . . abides in them. These sayings uttering, he did bring forward doctrine winsome, greatly blinding truth with fraudulent discourse. The gods, he said, dwelt in that place by mention whereof he would most terrify mankind — the region whence he knew men had their fears ; benefactions, too, (they had) for their life of toil from circular movement above, where he discerned the thunderbolts, and terrible reports of thunder and the gleaming stars of heaven, the fair and varied work of Time, the knowing architect, whence gleams the fiery mass of shining orb, and drenching rain issues upon the earth. Such fears he stationed around about mankind; with awe beset and cleverly he housed the power supernal and in befitting place ; thus he extinguished lawlessness with fears. ... In such wise, I believe, did some one first persuade the mortals that there was a race of supernal beings.^ BIBLIOGRAPHY Prott, J. de, and Ziehen, L., Leges gracorum sacra e titidis collecta, I, n. i (Leipzig, 1 896-1 906) ; Dinsmoor, W. B., "Attic Building Accounts," in Am. Journ. Arch. XVII (1913). 53-80, 242-65, 371-98 ; Elderkin, G. W., Problems in Peridean Buildings (Princeton University Press, 1912); Dorpfeld, W., "Zu den Bauwerken Athens," in Ath. Mitt. XXXV (1910). 39-72 ; Caskey, L. D., "Die Baurechnung des Erechtheion fur das Jahr 409-08 v. Chr.," ib. XXXVI. 3i7~43; Goodyear, H., Greek Refinements: Study in Temperamental Archi- tecture (J^nAon, 1912). The following titles are given as an aid to the general study of Greek reli- gion. Adams, J., Religious Teachers of Greece. Gifford Lects. (Edinburgh, 1908); BischofE, E. P., "Kauf und Verkauf von Priesterthiimem bei den Griechen," in Rhein. Mus. LIV (1899). 9-18; Caird, E., Evolution of Theology in the Greek Philosophers, 2 vols. (Glasgow, 1904) ; Campbell, L., Religion in Greek Literature (Longmans, 1898) ; Cumont, F., Astrology and Religion among the Greeks and Romans (Putnam, 1912) ; Decharme, P., La critique des traditions religieuses chez les Grecs, etc. (Paris, 1904) ; FarneU, L. R., Cults of the Greek States, s vols. (Clarendon Press, 1898-1909) ; Higher Aspects of Greek Religion. Hibbert Lects. (Scribner, 1912) ; Gardner, E. A., Religion and Art in Ancient Greece (Harper, 1910) ; Gardner, E. N., Greek Athletic Sports and Festivals (Macmillan, 1910) ; GUbert, O., Griechische ReligionsphUosophie (Leipzig, * The entire passage is here presented, the lacunse in the text being indicated in the usual way. BIBLIOGRAPHY 371 1911) ; Grappe, P. O., Griechische Mythologie und ReUgionsgeschichte, 2 vols. (Munich, 1906) ; Hamilton, M., Incubation; or the Cure of Disease in Pagan Temples and Christian Churches (London, 1906) ; Harrison, J. E., Prolegomena to the Study of Greek Religion (Cambridge, 1903) ; Themis: a Study of the Social Origins of Greek Religion (Cambridge, 191 2) ; Ancient Art and Ritual (Holt: University Library) ; Holderman, E. S., A Study of the Greek Priestess. Diss. (Chicago : University Press, 1913) ; Halliday, W. R., Greek Divination: a Study of its Methods and Principles (Macmillan, 1913) ; Kern, O., Ueber die Anfdnge der hellenischen Religion (Berlin, 1902) ; Lang, A., Myth, Ritual, and Religion (Longmans, 1887) ; Mommsen, A., Feste der Stadt Athen im Altertum (Teubner, 1898) ; Moore, G. F., History of Religions, I. chs. xvii-xx ; Murray, G., Four Stages of Greek Religion (Columbia University Press, 1912) ; Philios, M. D., Eleusis:' her Mysteries, Ruins, and Museums (Appleton, 1906) ; Reitzen- stein, R. A., Die hellenistischen Mysterienreligionen, etc. (Teubner, 1910) ; Rouse, W. H. D., Greek Votive Offerings (Cambridge, 1902) ; Wheeler, B. I., Dionysos and Immortality (Houghton Miflflin, 1899). CHAPTER XII HELLENIC INTERSTATE RELATIONS During the Period 404-337 Chapters xii-xv illustrate various activities of the Hellenes during the period extending from the close of the Pelopoimesian war, 404, to the formation of the Hellenic federation under Philip of Macedon in 337, the year following the battle of Chseroneia. 114. Ideal Hellenic Relations (Plato, Republic, 470 sq.) The principal speaker in this dialogue, as elsewhere in Plato, is Socrates. Neither shall we offer up arms at the temples of the gods, least of all the arms of Hellenes, if we care to maintain good feeling with other Hellenes ; and indeed, we have reason to fear that the offer- ing of spoils taken from kinsmen may be a pollution unless com- manded by the god himseK ? Very true. Again, as to the devastation of Hellenic territory or the burning of houses, what is to be the practice? May I have the pleasure, he said, of hearing your opinion? Both should be forbidden, in my judgment ; I would take the annual produce and no more. Shall I tell you why ? Pray do. Why, you see, there is a difference in the names 'discord' and 'war,' and I imagine that there is also a difference in their natures; the one is expressive of what is internal and domestic, the other of what is foreign and external; and the first of the two is termed discord, and only the second, war. That is a very proper distinction, he replied. And may I not observe with equal propriety that the Hellenic race is all united together by ties of blood and friendship, and alien and strange to the barbarians? 372 FRIENDS BY NATURE 373 Veiy good, he said. And therefore when Hellenes fight with barbarians and bar- barians with Hellenes, they will be described by us as being at war when they fight, and by nature enemies, and this kind of antagonism should be called war; but when Hellenes fight with one another we shall say that Hellas is then in a state of disorder and discord, they being by nature friends; and such enmity is to be called discord. I agree. Consider then, I said, when that which we have acknowledged to be discord occurs, and a city is divided, if both parties destroy the lands and burn the houses of one another, how wicked does the strife appear! No true lover of his country would bring himself to tear in pieces his own nurse and mother. There might be reason in the conqueror depriving the conquered of their harvest, but still they would have the idea of peace in their hearts and would not mean to go on fighting for ever. Yes, he said, that is a better temper than the other. And will not the city, which you are founding, be an Hellenic city? It ought to be, he replied. Then will not the citizens be good and civilized ? Yes, very civilized. And will they not be lovers of Hellas, and think of Hellas as their own land, and share in the common temples? Most certainly. And any difference which arises among them will be regarded by them as discord only — a quarrel among friends, which is not to be called a war ? Certainly not. Then they will quarrel as those who intend some day to be reconciled ? Certainly. They will use friendly correction, but will not enslave or destroy their opponents ; they will be correctors, not enemies ? Just so. And as they are Hellenes themselves they will not devastate Hellas, nor will they bum houses nor ever suppose that the whole 374 HELLENIC INTERSTATE RELATIONS population of a city — men, women, and children — are equally their enemies, for they know that the guilt of war is always confined to a few persons and that the many are their friends. And for all these reasons they will be unwilling to waste their lands, and raze their houses ; their enmity to them wiU only last until the many innocent sufferers have compelled the guilty few to give satisfaction ? I agree, he said, that our citizens should thus deal with their Hellenic enemies; and with barbarians as the Hellenes now deal with one another. 115. Monetary Union between Mytilene and Phocsa, Early Fourth Centxjry (Hicks and Hill, no. 94; Buck, Greek Dialects, U. no. 21. Translated by C. J. O.) This inscription was found on a block which was built into a house at Mytilene, but which has now disappeared. The subject is evidently an agree- ment between Mytilene, on the island of Lesbos, and the neighboring city of Fhocxa on the mainland, to the efiect that the two cities shoidd issue a common coinage, alternating year by year ; cf. Wroth, Catalogue of the Greek Coins of Troas, ^olis, and Lesbos, pp. Ixv-lxviiand 156-8. From the coins themselves we learn that the metal used was electrum, a natural or artificial alloy of gold with silver, and that the denominations were staters and "sixths," the latter weighing about 39 grains. Although this inscription, as indicated by the style of writing, belongs to the early part of the fourth century, the original agree- ment between the two cities may have been far earlier, for these coins were issued as early as 480. It is interesting to note that, in spite of the severe penalties for adulteration, the Phocaean coinage had a bad reputation and was not received in full value by other cities ; Hill, Hdb. of Greek and Roman Coins (London, 1899), 7°- On the general subject of monetary unions, of which this inscription furnishes the best example, ibid. 103-6 ; Head, Historia Numorum (Oxford, 1911), p. Ixxxiii sq. {The first part of the inscription is lost.) If the two cities . . . shall write anything upon the [stele or erase anything], such change shall be effectual. One who [debases] the gold coinage ' shall be liable to both cities. The judges shall be, ' That is, a careless or dishonest director of the mint. Noteworthy is the tact that the director, not the state, was responsible. We notice, also, that though the metal is in fact electrum, the coinage is officially termed gold. A MONETARY UNION 375 in the case of one who [coins] at Mytilene, all the magistrates of Mytilene for a majority of the court ; and at Phocaea all the magis- trates of Phocaea for a majority of the court. The trial shall be within six months after the termination of the year.^ If he is con- victed of purposely making the alloyed gold too base,^ he shall be punished with death ; if he is acquitted of doing wrong purposely, the court shall determine what he shall suffer or pay ; but the city shall be exempt from responsibility and from loss. The people of Mytilene drew the lot to mint first. (This agreement shall be in effect) beginning (with the term of) the prytanis succeeding Colonus (at Mytilene) and the successor of Aristarchus at Phocaea.' ii6. The Relation or Larisa, Thessaly, to Macedon A^^D to Sparta, about 400 b.c. (Pseudo-Herodes Atticus, On the Constitution — VLepl IlaAxrcuit Translated by E. G. S.) This curious document, which has come down to us under the name of Herodes (Atticus), 101-177 a.d., is in Codex Burneianus, no. 95, of the British Museum, following the sophistic declamations of Gorgias, Alcidamas, and Lesbonax. It began to attract the attention of historians in 1893, when Kohler, U., Sitzb. Berl. Akad. XXVI. 489-507, set forth its value fdr the political rela- tions of Thessaly at the close of the fifth century B.C. In his judgment Herodes, whom he accepts as the author, drew his historical material from Tlirasymachus of Chalcedon, On the Lariscsans — Ile/oi Aapurautity. Beloch, Griech. Gesch. II (1897). 132, n. 2, advancing a step farther, decided the treatise to have been the work of a sophist resident in Larisa, or perhaps rather a native sophist, of about 400. Meyer, Gesch. des Alt. V (1902). 56 sq., following Beloch, entertains no doubt that it is the work of a Larisaean. As far as the date is concerned, this view is accepted by Drerup, E., " ["HjomSov] Ilcpt IloXircuis : ein politisches Pamphlet aus Athen 404 vor Chr.," inGesch. u. KuU. des Alt. II. i (1908), who, however, prefers to consider the writer an Athenian of the school of Theramenes. In any event the author shows a far better acquaintance with the details of the Greek political situation about 400 b.c than could be credited to any sophist of the Christian era. The early date is favored, too, by the style. In the judg- ment of the present translator, it is too little polished, too inadequate on the score of formal perfection, often too awkward with its labored rather than bril- ' The year during which the accused director held office. ' Literally, "mixing the gold too weak," a metaphor from the mixing of wine with water. » i.e., with the beginning of the next official year. 376 HELLENIC INTERSTATE RELATIONS liant antitheses, to be the work of a late sophist ; and the language is not archaizing but distinctly archaic. Although the dialect is not ^Eolic but pure Attic, this circumstance need not hinder our believing it to have been addressed to a Thessalian community, even by a Thessalian; for Gorgias of Chalcidic Lepntini composed orations in Attic, and Isocrates addressed the Doric Dionysius and the Macedonian Philip in the same dialect. In favor of the early date, see also Nestle, W., N. Jahrb. VI (1903). 191 sqq. (who claims Thrasymachus of Chalcedon as author) ; Pohlmann, Griech. Gesch. (4th ed. 1909). 182, n. 4; Ferguson, Greek Imperialism, 20 sq.; Costanzi, V., in Studi italiani di filologia classica, VII (1899). 137-59- For the conservative view, Schmid, W., Khein. Mus. LIX (1904). 512-24; Wilamowitz-Moellendorff, U. v., in Kultur der Gegenwart, I. 8 (1905). 149 sq.; Adcock and Knox, in Klio, XIII (1913). 249-57 (whose contention is that the document does not precisely fit the political situation at any point of time in the neighborhood of 400 B.C., and that the language is not early Greek, or even good Greek of any period). The translation of the entire document is given below, partly because of its unusual nature, and partly because of its inaccessibility to the general student of Greek affairs. The peculiar style is rendered literally into English in so far as it does not put an excessive strain upon the language. The best treatment of the entire subject is by Drerup, op. cit., whose article includes the text with an introduction and an elaborate commentary. (i) I must first explain that it is necessary to speak about the present matter ' to men of this age and not to much younger per- ' For an appreciation of this document a few general facts regarding the political history of Thessaly, and its condition about 400 B.C., are necessary. First it is to be noted that neither Thessaly nor Larisa is mentioned by name ; and it is only from al- lusions in the pamphlet that scholars have been able to identify as Larisa the city-state to which it was addressed. They have noticed that its territory borders upon Macedon (§ 2S) and that the nearest neighbors on the Hellenic side are the Phodans (28). The description of the country (14 sq.) as the largest and most productive of Hellas, the reference to its oligarchic governments (30), and to its attitude in the Persian war (22 sq.) point unmistakably to Thessaly; cf. Drerup, in Gesch. a. Kult. des Alt. U. i. 87 sq. It is known further that about 400 Thessaly was ruled by a few great city-states, of which Pelasgiotis under Larisa lay nearest to Macedon. For these reasons there can he no doubt that the Larisseans were the people to whom the pamphlet appealed. Toward the end of the sixth century the Aleuadse, a noble family of Larisa, united all Thessaly under their royal sway (Hdt. vii. 6). They sided with the Persian in- vaders, whereas the commons sympathized with the patriot cause (Hdt. vii. 172-4). After the war the unity was broken and Thessaly fell into great confusion. In Larisa, as elsewhere, were factions of the Few and the Many in deadly strife with one another (cf. Thuc. ii. 22. 3, 431 B.C.). On their conflict hinged the history of the state, not only in its domestic affairs, but in its relations with outsiders. This fact is kept in the foreground throughout the present document. Taking advantage of sedi- tions, Archelaus, king of Macedon, 413-399, aimed to make himself master of Thessaly. The Few, in their strife with the Many, had invited his aid (§ 9). He had invaded REASONS FOR THE SPEECH 377 sons. That it is seemly to be silent when one has something to say, I neither can learn from another nor do I find it so myself. (2) For concerning another matter one might be able to censure those who speak, charging them with futility or with meddlesome- ness, namely, that they were not acquainted with the facts in the case before them ; but in affairs relating to the war ^ all have an interest in common ; and most necessary and pertinent it is that men in these stages of life ^ should know and speak about them. They to whom the danger comes most nearly home should most necessarily be concerned about it ; and they upon whom it is laid to be concerned should most certainly ascertain the facts.^ (3) For speaking I find much need, but for holding my peace I see no excuse. It was my desire that you yourselves, together with the Gods, should be the causes of your own blessings. If however it is this about which you are delajdng, and if it is sweet to you to owe your success to others, it seems to me that whatever takes place is due to the care of one of the Gods. (4) All that you ought to have brought about by persuading with money and by risking with your bodies, Fortune has accomplished for you without trouble or money, so that your own adversaries willingly pay you the penalty. Pirst, then, I shall teach you that it is well to follow those who propose war, and next that it is necessary. (5) For we were able to perceive the forces that were naturally hostile to this country, and perceiving in advance before suffering, Larisa, and, in cooperation with his partisans, had perpetrated a horrible massacre of the commons (16-18). His permanent gain was the occupation of the Ferrhaebian terri- tory, which, at least a generation earlier, Larisa had forcibly annexed (6). In the Peloponnesian war Archelaus had sympathized with Athens. It was nat- ural, then, that the Lacedaemonians shoidd feel unfriendly toward him. When there- fore they invited Larisa to join the Hellenic league, the writer composed this pamphlet, in the form of an address, to persuade the Larisasans to accept the terms, chiefly on the ground that it would guarantee protection from their northern enemy. The author was evidently a sophist, rather than a practical statesman. His Oration is like those of Isocrates in general character and purpose, though narrower in scope and relatively crude in style and thought. ' The question before the assembly was whether Larisa should join the Hellenic league, a step which was liable to involve them in war with King Archelaus of Macedon. * Particularly men of military age, taking part in the assembly. ' Notice the heavy, labored movement of the style here and throughout the docu- ment. The author seems a pioneer of prose, feeling his way with great difficulty through an unknown field. 378 HELLENIC INTERSTATE RELATIONS we would be on our guard, rendering their affairs weak in every way and our own affairs stronger than theirs, understanding that whatever is by nature hostile keeps quiet through inability to inflict evil. (6) But now from what has happened we have our instruction — that this man^ will never be our friend nor will there be any reconciliation between him and us. For not being injured by us but wishing to inflict injury, is he our adversary. He holds a territory which our fathers acquired and handed down to us,^ which on account of our weakness he will hold, and on account of our power will reluctantly restore. (7) This is one pre- text for his ill-will toward us. Another is that Greek common- wealths are satisfied to preserve their own power for their descend- ants, while for autocrats' this does not suffice, but they always need, in addition, to subjugate the richest (of their neighbors). (8) Now it is our conviction that we should not suffer this misfor- tune ourselves and should also prevent others from siiffering it. Hence that man has a grudge against us, desiring the hopes of those who trust in us to fail. Beginning then with a single device,^ he believes he will overcome us and those whom we are preventing him from ruling. (9) These things we were formerly permitted to conjecture but now clearly to experience in fact. Any means which gave him a chance to conquer community and territory did not escape him when he saw us in civil disruption ; but in alliance with the Few (the aristocracy) he did not hesitate to assail all these people (here assembled).* (10) He knew when he came that should he attack the Few he would accomplish nothing that he wished ; for by beating down the weaker party in joint warfare he would ' King Archdaiis; see 376, n. 1. •Undoubtedly the territory of the Fenhaebians, lying between Pelasgiotis and Macedon, a region conquered by Larisa and more recently taken from that dty by Macedon; see 376, n. i. ' Tv/xivrots, "tyrants." In fact he was a king; but the author applies to him the opprobrious title in order to rouse hatred against him. The contrast between the grasping nature of despots and the peaceful disposition of city-states is without his- torical foundation. * Evidently his device is to side with one of the factions found in every Thessalian state. ' That is, he joined .with the Few against the Many. The latter are represented in the assembly which the author is, in imagination, addressing. The govenmient about 400 was no longer a narrow oligarchy. On the other hand, it was not a democ- racy, as it did not include the laborers-, penestx. POLICY OF ARCHELAUS 379 by no means gain sway over the more numerous, as they would have been able to ward him off ; but if he were to subjugate the Many in aUiance with the Few, he beUeved he would easily have them aU in his power .^ Thus he naturally wishes us to be in civil disruption.^ If these things are profitable to him, you must believe, too, that he will do them. (11) To what extent his advantage is our misfortune, look ye, comparing it with the weightiest of other things. Now we all agree that war is the greatest of evils in pro- portion as peace is of blessings. Civil disruption, however, exceeds war in the degree that war exceeds peace. For in a foreign war they die while saving their country, but in civil strife while destroying it, so that not even those who have done the slaying have good repute ; (12) because in warring on others we fight in behalf of our friends ; in conquering foreigners we acquire others as friends ; but in conquering our own countrymen we are deprived even of the friends that exist. The seizure of territory, the destruction of property, the delight of enemies and the consequent disaster of friends, it is tedious to recount in detail. (13) When one begins such things, it is not easy to be rid of them, for no reconcihation * can be found. Men are not annoyed when neighbors have civil broils ; the weaker, that they may escape subjugation ; the equal, that they may become stronger; and the strong, that they may rule the more easily. (14) Of these facts I think it unnecessary to look for evidence elsewhere ; for we are a proof to others. For possessing the largest territory of the Hellenes, and one which can furnish most products not only to the inhabitants but also to neighbors, we do not appear to be richer than those who export from us, since they accumulate products for themselves, but we spend them on foreigners,* making the common property personal, ' The reasons are here given why he sided with the aristocrats against the commons. The "weaker" are the aristocrats. 2 It is by civil strife that he has gained his power, and by civil strife he expects to keep the upper hand. He has not given continued support to the Few, and the Many at present control the government. ' The translator prefers to emend dLd\ayov to StaWay/iv. * Tots wapoUois, evidently aliens who have taken up their residence in the ThessaUan towns for commercial objects. Agriculturally the country was the richest in the peninsula but was wholly backward in economy. As there was no accumulation of native capital adequate to the needs of the expanding trade, it was inevitable that the country should be commercially exploited by other Greeks. 38o HELLENIC INTERSTATE RELATIONS and that of private persons common. (15) Now is it not outrageous to support at common expense those who do not deliver the com- monwealth to us as a common possession? Furthermore, though possessing a territory best adapted to warding off invaders, and a country which furnishes native allies and horses,* not only do we thereby check ^ those who wish to injure us, but we even bring in those who will defend us, persuading them with money,' and we guard ourselves against strangers, but at the same time the power of the country is despised and we are ourselves a laughing-stock.* (16) The man who is responsible for all these ills and for many others you yourselves saw when he was present — the man who made before all such a display that no one is so hard or such a hater of mankind that he could describe it without tears.* For what one of the greatest evils did not come to pass? Did not children and women and aged fathers become witnesses of deaths, some of fathers, some of husbands, some of children, some of those who passed away in their own arms, others destroyed by the hands of the foe? (17) And houses razed and property taken away? And what was most terrible of all, whenever one who shared in the same worship, and performed the same sacred rites,* and was a member of the same tribe — whom it behoved to repel according to the law, but not lawlessly to destroy — when even to old men old age appeared a misfortune, and to orphans in hke manner ? (18) The man, then, who was responsible for these calamities, ought we not to injure when we can, repelhng those who were his aid, avenging the dead, and lamenting with the bereaved? Not only is it so great an advantage that we will get satisfaction for the past but that, offering this as an example, we will teach others not to consider our disharmony a piece of sheer luck nor to plot against us in alliance with our own countrymen. '■ Thessaly was the best country in Greece for rearing horses. ^ The translator emends SiaMo/iev to KuXionev. ' Mercenaries are thus described. ^ That is, through the interference of Archelalis as a result of civil broils. " Invited by the aristocrats, Archelaiis had intervened, and in company with his partisans had perpetrated a horrible massacre described below; cf. 376, n. i. 8 "0 ravTa Spuv should perhaps be i t4 airi Spdp, "who chances to be doing the same things," the connection seemingly indicating that reference is to the performance of sacred rites. LARISA AND PELOPONNESE 381 If this result is achieved, I am hopeful that we will have no more civil strife, when plotters are not aided by allies from abroad. (19) Thus it is well for us voluntarily to agree to Join in war with those who summon us; but that it is necessary we must now examine.^ Archelaiis did not march against the Peloponnesians along with the Athenians, nor did he stop the former when they wished to go dirough his territory,^ nor did he furnish them (the Athenians) funds against the others,' nor is there any pretext for hostility except that he was unwilling to join them in war against the Athe- nians, but kept quiet. (20) Since therefore the Peloponnesians have an adequate pretext for deeming as enemies those who did not support them in the war, let us be on our guard lest they on the same pretext make war on us, if being summoned we shall be un- willing to join the Peloponnesians in war, for he was not injured by the Athenians at all.* (21) What argument, then, is left to us? Is it that we were not injured? We shall teach them to do just what he did ; for it is not wrong if he who did it is no wrong-doer.* Shall we say, then, that we are wronged but unwilling to avenge ourselves? Much cowardice indeed we shall arouse in those who wish to injure us.® (22) But are we wilhng though unable? Who then will not despise our power, if, having the Hellenes as allies, ' In the preceding paragraphs the writer has been urging the advantage of a league with the Lacedsemonians in a wax against Macedon. He will now consider the neces- sity of such a union. *The only Peloponnesian march of the kind known to us was the expedition of Brasidas in 424 (Thuc. iv. 78). Though at that time Perdiccas, not Archelaus, was king, the principle alone is important. Notwithstanding the opinion of the writer, this permission was a breach of neutrality in favor of the LacedsEmonians. ' This statement is imtrue. After the Sicilian disaster Archelaiis suppUed Athens with ship timber (Thuc. viii. 4. i ; Andoc. ii. 11 ; Xen. Hell. vi. i. 11), and in return was aided by an Athenian force (Diod. xiii. 49. i). It is to be noted that Archelaus was a great admirer and patron of Athenian literary men and artists ; cf. Drerup, op. cit. 98 and n. 3. There was accordingly a far greater pretext for war than the writer states. * The argument is that we must either join with the Peloponnesians against Arche- laus or ourselves incur the danger of being assailed by the Peloponnesians. The latter are in fact so sensitive that they are making war upon Archelaus because he did not join them against the Athenians, even though this king had suffered no wrong at the hands of the Athenians. The argument is too finely spun to be appreciated at first glance. ' That is, if we excuse ourselves from the war on the ground that Archelaiis has not harmed us, we shall teach the Peloponnesians to treat us just as Archelaiis has. • This is, of course, ironical. 382 HELLENIC ESTTERSTATE RELATIONS we shall not even thus be able to repel our enemies ? The greatest consideration is, if we shall incur for a second time from the Greeks the accusation that we did not join in the war against the Persians, and secondly the one now announced.^ (23) As to the former, we had an adequate excuse : in behalf of ourselves we were willing to share their danger ; for it would have been on more equitable terms (to fight here) than to abandon our country and struggle in defence of theirs.^ Now, however, what shall we say? For they have themselves arrived, willing to face danger in behalf of us and of our country. (24) Is it not outrageous, too, if we along with the Greeks are not to be counted in with the Hellenic coalition? How great a thing it is, this man himself has made clear ; for though eager and willing to give money even to the Greeks to become their ally, he could not bring it about.' His conduct is a fair sign of two conditions : that it is a good thing (to join the coalition) and that it is difficult. To any one who objects to my view such is my argument. (25) I have already heard something said which is to me sufficient proof of the soundness of the view I hold against my political opponents.* If what they have said is true, there is no need of fear. (26) They say in fact that Archelaiis is powerful and that he, not the Peloponnesians, is our neighbor. Him we might keep at bay, if we wished, but not the Peloponnesians. Their idea is that it is better for us to have civil broils among ourselves than be slaves to others. If I saw that there was any need of choosing one of the two alternatives, I should deliberate as to which of the two I ought to take ; but the restful alternative I find is connected with the Peloponnesians. (27) I marvel also at those • That is, if we do not now join with the Greeks in war against this foreigner, we shall again be reproached with having deserted them in that war and again on this similar occasion. ' The writer means that in the Persian invasion the Thessalians would have fought against the foreigner had they been supported in their own country by the Hellenes. In the present instance the Hellenic forces are on the groimd, ready to help them. ' It seems clear that Archelaiis had recently asked for admission to the Hellenic league but had been refused. It is clear, too, from the general context that at the time of the composition of this pamphlet practically all Hellas, with the exception of Larisa, was in the Hellenic alliance under Lacedaemonian leadership. That could only have been after the downfall of Athens, 404. *The opponents of the speaker (writer) favored friendship with Archelaiis and opposed alliance with the Peloponnesians. LACEDEMONIAN POLICY 383 who set matters over against matters; for they do not compare similar things with similar; in the first place, what issues from him we know already, but the actions of the others we merely sur- mise. One thing we did suffer, but the other we do not know whether we will suffer. Is it reasonable, then, to refrain from anger at what has happened and to fear what is merely surmised? (28) From what precedents ought we to dread future events ? Do we not see the nearest of our neighbors among the Greeks, the Phocians, free, and those contiguous to them, the Boeotians, neither paying tribute nor any of the Lacedaemonians holding sway there, and further away, the Corinthians independent and governing their own, and near them the Achaeans, neither more numerous than we nor dwelling in more numerous commonwealths, and the Eleians, and those of Tegea, and the other Arcadians, who are neighbors ? (29) No one has ever found a Spartan ruling there or here, but everywhere, as we know, laws and governments are in operation, and these states enjoy the common revenues in common.^ (30) But perhaps some one may say : they everywhere establish oligarchy. Yes, such a form of government as we, long wishing and yearning for, having seen for a short time, have been deprived of, if indeed we ought to call those governments ohgarchies in com- parison with the forms in operation here. For where is there so small a community in which one third of the citizens are excluded from political life? (31) All those who have neither arms nor any other force to govern by were deprived of the franchise, not by the Lacedaemonians, but by fate. Deprived were they for a long time, till there came a change in the constitution. These things we have had with us. I believe that not even in our prayers would we pray to be otherwise governed ; but it is not reasonable that, while furnishing such examples, we should ourselves be in dread — •The favorable view of the Spartan supremacy was possible only in the period shortly following the close of the war, perhaps after the fall of the Thirty at Athens and of the decarchies in the Mgean cities ; for the Lacedaemonians soon began to show themselves tyrannical, and the allies began accordingly to chafe under the tyranny; Botsford, Hellenic History, ch. xxi. These circumstances would favor 404, or perhaps rather 403, as the date of the pamphlet. Naturally a political pleader could not be depended upon to state the exact facts in a given situation, to the impairment of his own cause. Adcock and Knox, in Klio, XIII. 249-57, have set too high a standard for mortal poUticians or even for mortal sophists. 384 HELLENIC INTERSTATE RELATIONS examples whose non-occurrence, rather than whose occurrence, would be a grievous thing.^ ' (32) As for the Lacedemonians, it is not in their natural dis- position to attack us ; for they dwell far from us and are unpre- pared to assail our territory. For in what we are strongest they are not a little inferior.^ In the first place it is improbable that they are plotting against us ; and again, if they undertake it, they will be discovered ; and if we discover it in advance, we shall not neglect them. (33) If this argument, too, is offered, that Arche- laiis has some of our children, and on account of the children it is impossible to join in the war, in the first place we ought to wonder at the man who would make mention of ten children but says nothing about the common interest or the community. The advantage of all he takes away but about the few he makes his' point. If it were necessary that the children should suffer some- thing, it would not be strange to say it ; but it is now clear that by overpowering him we shall gain the children at the same time; so that if we involve him in difl&culties,' we shaU easily recover the children. (34) My discourse bids you beat off the wrong-doer, avenge the dead, gratify their kinsfolk, receive fate, be allies to the Hellenes and foes to the barbarians,* trust those who benefit us and hold no dread of those who are not friends, consider as enemies those who wrong us and as friends those who defend us, and in addition, hold our insight more decisive than our conjectures. (35) This is my thesis ; but for my opponents, who will go to that limit of audac- ity, their argument is the opposite : to endure when wronged, to benefit the wrong-doer, to flee from those who wish to benefit, to distrust friends, to trust enemies, to dread what is far away, to ' The writer strongly favors a government in which the franchise is held by those who have property qualifications for the heavy infantry, and contends that the Lace- daemonians are supporting that form of constitution among their allies. From this political view of the writer, however, we cannot, with Drerup, deduce the conclusion that the writer was an Athenian of the school of Theramenes. ' That is, in cavalry. ' The reading d^eXAvres t&v iKelvovKaKuv makes no sense whatever, and it is diflScult to say how it should be emended. The translation here given, "if we involve him in difficulties," is a guess at the meaning. * It is noteworthy that the Hellenes of this time regarded the Macedonians as barbarians. UNITS OF REPRESENTATION 385 overlook what is close at hand, (36) and then not to become allies of the Hellenes but of the barbarians, and they our most bitter enemies; furthermore, to permit the dead to die unavenged and their relatives to be dishonored, to bring it about that there shall be no government or laws or Justice. (37) Such we must say is the thesis of those who speak against my contention. Following them, you will not miss the results to which they lead ; but if you receive the alliance with eagerness, we shall obtain satisfaction for what we suffered; and for the future we shall not suffer such things. 117. Constitution of the Bceotian League (Oxyrhynchus Hellenica, xi, in Grenfell and Hunt, Oxyrhynchus Papyri, V (1908). Translated by Grenfell and Hunt) The question as to the authorship of this Hellenica is touched upon in ch. i of the present volume. The most valuable part of the recovered fragment is the chapter translated below, which throws a new and valuable light on the constitution of the Boeotian league during the latter part of the fifth century and the beginning of the fourth. The year which the author refers to definitely is 395. For commentary, see Bonner, R. J., in Class. Journ. V (1910). 353-9; in Class. Philol. V (1910). 405-17 ; Botsford, G. W., in Pol. Sci. Quart. XXV (1910). 271-96; see also Bibliography at the close of the chapter. In the summer ^ the Boeotians and Phocians went to war. Their enmity was chiefly caused by a party at Thebes; for not many years previously the Boeotians had entered into a state of discord. The condition of Boeotia at that time was as follows. There were then appointed in each of the cities four boulai, of which not all the citizens were allowed to become members, but only those who possessed a certain amount of money; of these boulai each one in turn held a preliminary sitting and deUberation about matters of policy, and made proposals to the other three, and a resolution adopted by all became valid. Their individual affairs they continued to manage in that fashion, while the arrange- ment of the Boeotian league was this. The whole population of the country was divided into eleven units, and each of these pro- vided one Bceotarch, as follows. The Thebans contributed four, • The year 395. 386 HELLENIC INTERSTATE RELATIONS two for the city and two for Plataea, Scolus, Erythrae, Scaphae, and the other towns which formerly were members of one state with the PlatEcans, but at that time were subject to Thebes. Two Bceo- tarchs were provided by the inhabitants of Orchomenus and Hysise, and two by the inhabitants of Thespise with Eutresis and Thisbae, one by the inhabitants of Tanagra, and another by the inhabitants of Haliartus, Lebadeia, and Coroneia, each of these cities sending him in turn ; in the same way one came from Acrae- phion, Copae, and Chseroneia. Such was the proportion in which the chief magistrates were appointed by the different units, which also provided sixty bouleutcB for every Bceotarch, and themselves defrayed their daily expenses. Each unit wats, moreover, under the obligation to supply a corps of approximately a thousand hop- lites and a hundred horsemen. To speak generally, it was in proportion to the distribution of their magistrates that they enjoyed the privileges of the league, made their contributions, sent judges, and took part in everything whether good or bad. This nation then as a whole had this form of polity, and the general assemblies of the Boeotians used to meet in the Cadmeia. ii8. Political Factions at Thebes (Ox. Hdl. xii. The same translators) The selection given below is useful, not only for a view of the internal afiaiis of Thebes on the eve of the Corinthian war, but even more for the new light thrown upon the relation of that city to Athens in the Peloponnesian war and upon the economic condition of Attica in the same period. At Thebes the best and most notable of the citizens were, as I have already stated, divided against each other, one faction being led by Ismenias, Antitheus, and Androclidas, the other by Leon- tiades, Asias, and Corrantadas. The poUtical party of Leontiades sided with the Lacedaemonians, while that of Ismenias was accused of Atticizing, because it favored the Athenian democracy when the latter was exiled.^ Ismenias' party, however, was not con- cerned for the Athenians but . . . Such being the condition of * Reference is to the exiles under the Thirty, 404-403 ; Botsford, Hellenic History, cfa. xxi. GAINS FROM WAR 387 affairs at Thebes, and each of the two factions being powerful, many people from the cities throughout Bceotia then came forward and joined one or the other of them. At that time, and for a short period previously, the party of Ismenias and Androclides was the stronger both at Thebes itseK and in the boul6 of the Boeotians ; but formerly that of Asias and Leontiades was in the ascendant for a considerable period and (had complete control of?) the city. For when the Lacedaemonians in the war with the Athenians were occupying Deceleia ^ and collected a large concourse of their allies, this party prevailed over their opponents both by reason of the proximity of the Lacedaemonians and because the latter were in- strumental in conferring great benefits upon the city. The The- bans made a great advance in the direction of complete prosperity as soon as war between the Athenians and Lacedaemonians began ; for when the Athenians commenced to threaten(?) Bceotia, the inhabitants of Erythrae, Scaphae, Scolus, Auhs, Schcenus, and Potniae, and many other similar places which had no walls, congre- gated at Thebes, thus doubUng the size of the city. But it never- theless came to prosper in a much higher degree when the The- bans in conjunction with the Lacedaemonians fortified Deceleia against the Athenians; for they took over the prisoners and all the other spoils of the war at a small price, and as they inhabited the neighboring country, carried off to their homes all the furnish- ing material in Attica, beginning with the wood and tiles of the houses. The country of the Athenians at that time had been the most lavishly furnished in Greece, for it had suffered but slight injury from the Lacedaemonians in the former invasions, and had been adorned and elaborated with so much extravagance that . . . Such was the condition of Thebes and Bceotia. 119. The Olynthian Confederacy (Xenophon, Hellenica, v. 2. 11-19) The embassy mentioned in this excerpt belongs to the year 383. The selection is offered because of the remarkable character of the confederacy of which it treats. See Freeman, History of Federal Government, I. 190-97; Grote, History of Greece, X. 50 sqqr, Botsford, Hellenic History, ch. xxi. ' In the later years of the war ; op. cit. ch. xix. 388 HELLENIC INTERSTATE RELATIONS Now from yet another quarter ambassadors arrived in Lace- daemon; that is to say, from Acanthus and Apollonia, the two largest and most important states of the Olynthian confederacy. The ephors, after learning from them the object of their visit, presented them to the assembly and the allies, in presence of whom Cleigenes of Acanthus made a speech to this effect : "Men of Lacedaemon and of the allied states," he said, "are you aware of a silent but portentous growth within the bosom of Hellas? Few here need be told that for size and importance Olynthus now stands at the head of the Thracian cities. But are you aware that the citizens of Olynthus have already brought over several states by the bribe of joint citizenship and common laws ; that they have forcibly annexed some of the larger states; and that, so encouraged, they have taken in hand further to free the cities of Macedon from Amyntas ' the king of the Macedonians ; that, as soon as their immediate neighbors had shown compUance, they proceeded to attack larger and more distant communities; so much so, that when we started to come hither, we left them mas- ters not only of many other places, but of Pella itself, the capital of Macedon? Amyntas, we saw plainly, must ere long withdraw from his cities, was in fact already but a name, an outcast from Macedon. " The Olynthians have actually sent to ourselves and to the men of Apollonia a joint embassy, warning us of their intention to attack us if we refuse to present ourselves at Olynthus with a military contingent.* Now, for our part, men of Lacedaemon, we desire nothing better than to abide by our ancestral laws and institu- tions, to be free and independent citizens: * but if aid from without ' Archdaiis, the able and unscrupulous king of Macedon mentioned in no. ii6, was assassinated in 399. After several short reigns which ended violently, Amyntas, a member of the royal family but not a descendant of Archelaiis, succeeded to the throne. This man, noted for his success in unifjdng Macedon, and still more as the father of Philip and the grandfather of Alexander, reigned interruptedly twenty-four years, 393-369 ; of. Grote, op. cit. x. 45-9. At the time of the Chalcidic embassy to Sparta, described in the present excerpt, the fortunes of Amjmtas were at a low ebb ; he was obliged to yield his capital, Pella, to Olynthus and came near being driven from his kingdom. * That is, the Olynthians were planning to force these two cities into the league. • This was the sentiment of every Hellenic (ity — a longing for absolute political isolation. >' THE CHALCIDIC FEDERATION 389 is going to fail us, we too must follow the rest and coalesce with the Olynthians. Why, even now they muster no less than eight hundred heavy infantry (?) ^ and a considerably larger body of light infantry, while their cavalry, when we have joined them, will exceed a thousand men. At the date of our departure we left embassies from Athens and Boeotia in Olynthus, and we were told that the Olynthians themselves had passed a formal resolution to return the compUment. They were to send an embassy on their side to the aforesaid states to treat of an alliance.* And yet, if the power of the Athenians and the Thebans is to be further in- creased by such an accession of strength, look to it," the speaker added, "whether hereafter you wiU find things so easy to manage in that quarter. "They hold Potidaea, the key to the isthmus Pallene, and there- fore, you can well believe, they can command the states within that peninsula. If you want any further proof of the abject terror of those states, you have it in the fact that notwithstanding the bitter hatred which they bear to Olynthus, not one of them has dared to send ambassadors along with us to apprise you of these miatters.* "Reflect how you can reconcile your anxiety to prevent the unification of Boeotia * with your neglect to hinder the solidifying of a far larger power — a power destined, moreover, to become formidable not on land only, but by sea. For what is to stop it when the soil itself supplies timber for shipbuilding, and there are rich revenues derived from numerous harbors and commercial centers ? * — it can not but be that abundance of food and abun- ' The smallness of this number is utterly disproportionate to the number of cavalry, to the actual strength of the league, as known from other circumstances, and to the general tone of the context. Though it is evidently corrupt, we have no sure means of emending it; "eight thousand" is a mere possibihty. 'Remarkable is the intense diplomatic and military aggressiveness of the new league. ' In a situation of this kind we should not too confidently rely upon the speaker for his statement as to the feelings of others. The refusal of other cities to join the embassy may have been due to friendship for Olynthus. * It was at this time that, in fear of the growing power of Thebes in Boeotia, the Lacedaeinonians violently seized the acropolis of that city, and forced upon it an oli- garchy devoted to Sparta. ' The speaker here calls attention to the economic advantages of the Chalcidic 390 HELLENIC INTERSTATE RELATIONS dance of population will go hand in hand. Nor have we yet reached the limits of Ol3nithian expansion; there are their neighbors to be thought of — the kingless or independent Thracians. These are already to-day the devoted servants of Olynthus, and when it comes to their being actually under her, that means at once another vast accession of strength to her. With the Thracians in her train, the gold mines of Pangaeus will stretch out to her the hand of welcome.^ "In making these assertions we are but uttering remarks ten thousand times repeated in the democracy of Olynthus. Further- more as to their confident spirit, who shall attempt to describe it? It is God, for aught I know, who, with the growth of a new capacity, gives increase also to the proud thoughts and vast designs of humanity. For ourselves, men of Lacedaemon and of the allied states, our task is completed. We have played our parts in an- nouncing to you how things stand there. To you it is left to deter- mine whether what we have described is worthy of your concern. One only thing further you ought to recognize : the power we have spoken of as great is not as yet invincible, for those states which are involuntary participators in the citizenship of Olynthus will, in prospect of any rival power appearing in the field, speedily fall away. On the other hand, let them be once closely knit and welded together by the privileges of intermarriage and reciprocal rights of holding property in land — which have already become enact- ments ; let them discover that it is a gain to them to follow in the wake of conquerors (just as the Arcadians, for instance, find it profitable to march in your ranks, whereby they save their own property and pillage their neighbor's) ; let these things come to pass, and perhaps you may find the knot no longer so easy to unloose." ^ towns ; they exported ship timber, which commanded a high price throughout Hellas, and they were the medium of commercial intercourse between the Mediterranean world and Macedon. It was chiefly these circumstances which led Philip, son of Amyn- tas, to annex the coast region to his kingdom. ' Thesp gold mines afterward yielded PhiUp a thousand talents a year. ' From the words of these ambassadors, who were enemies of Olynthus, we infer that this city was building up a league on a principle broader and more generous than Hellas had known before — a principle so fair and attractive that a community once adjusted to membership had no desire of withdrawing. Clearly the citizens of one community had the rights of intermarriage, commerce, and landholding in every other. The union approached nearly to a state, in which the cities were municipalities. SECOND ATHENIAN CONFEDERACY 391 120. The Founding of the Second Athenian Confederacy, 377 B.C. {Inscr. grcec. U. 17, editio minor, 1913, no. 43 ; Hicks and Hill, no. 101 ; Ditt. I. no. 80; Roberts and Gardner, Greek Epigraphy, II. no. 32. Trans- lated by C. J. O.) This inscription has been pieced together from twenty fragments found at Athens. It is of cardinal importance as the best authority for the early history of the so-called Second Athenian Confederacy, the greatest step toward federa- tion voluntarily taken by the Greek states in the fourth century. This league, composed chiefly of maritime states under the leadership of Athens, was formed in 378-377, to check the aggressions of Lacedaemon, and endured, though with diminishing effectiveness, tiU the beginning of Macedonian supremacy, 338. The decree here given, passed by the Athenians in 377, recognizes the confeder- acy as already existing, and is principally concerned with reaffirming the indepen- dence and the privileges of the allies, who may well have feared that Athens might have attempted the restoration of her former empire. The list of states inscribed after the decree not only informs us of the extent of the confederacy, but also enables us to trace its growth as far as the year 373. The account of the founding and early history of the union given by Diodorus, xv. 28 sqq. — the chief literary source — may be compared. See also Marshall, F. H., The Second Athenian Confederacy (Cambridge,"i90s), chs. ii, iii, where the results of recent investigation are summarized. IN THE ARCHONSHIP OF NAUSINICUS. CALLIBITJS, SON OF CEPHISOPHON, of PiEANIA, WAS SECRETARY In the seventh prytany,' that of (the tribe) Hippothontis, it hath pleased the council and the people, — Charinus of Athmonon presided ; Aristoteles made the motion : — That, with good fortune to the Athenians and their aUies, and in order that the Lacedaemonians may allow the Greeks to live in quiet, free and autonomous, and to possess their respective territories in security "... be it decreed by the people : — That if any of the Greeks or of the barbarians dwelling on the mainland ' or of the islanders, except such as are subjects of the ' February or March, 377. 2 The three lines following, which probably contained a still more unfavorable characterization of the Lacedaemonians, were erased in andent times, perhaps in 370- 369, when Athens and Sparta were friendly. ' Thracians, Macedonians, and Epeirotes are meant. 392 HELLENIC INTERSTATE RELATIONS King,i wish to be allies of the Athenians and of their allies, they may become such while preserving their freedom and autonomy, using the form of government that they desire, without either admitting a garrison or receiving a commandant or paying tribute,^ and upon the same terms as the Chians,' the Thebans, and the other allies. In favor of those who make an aUiance with the Athenians and with the allies, the (Athenian) people shall release all the Athenians' landed possessions,^ whether public or private, that may chance to be in the territory of those who make the alliance ; and [the Athenians] shall give assurances to this effect. If with regard to the cities, that make the alliance with the Athe- nians, there chance to be at Athens inscriptions of a prejudicial character,^ the council holding ofl5.ce for the time being shall have authority to destroy them. From the date of the archonship of Nausinicus it shall not be allowable for any Athenian, either in behaK of the state or as a private person, to acquire either a house or a piece of land in the territories of the allies, whether by purchase or by mortgage, or in any other way. If anyone shall undertake to purchase or acquire or take property on mortgage, in any way whatsoever, any ally who wishes may lay an information against him before the delegates of the allies ; * and the delegates, after ^ • This provision is inserted in recognition of the peace of Antalcidas, 387-386 B.C., by the terms of which the Hellenic cities in Asia Minor were made subject to the Per- sian king. ' Unlike the confederacy in the previous century ; cj. the decrees regarding Ery- thrse and Chalcis, nos. 71, 72. ' Chios was the first state to enter the aUiance ; cj. the list infra, and Diodorus xv. 28.3. * These words, though of general application, are especially designed to prevent a return to the practice of forcible colonization by the Athenians (the system of cleru- chies), which under the former confederacy had proved so irritating to the allies. "/.e., copies of land grants made by the allied states, treaties confirming sudi rights, etc. ' Cj. Diod. l.c. : "The (Athenian) people . . . assembled a joint congress (syne- drion) of all the allies; and delegates (synedroi) were appointed for each city. It was ordained by a joint resolution that the congress should sit at Athens, and that each city, the small and the great alike, should be entitied to one vote." The congress of allies and the Athenian assembly had coordinate and independent authority ; cj. Mar- shall, op. cit. 22 sq. and note that throughout this document the "Athenians" and the "allies" are distinguished. In other words, the system comprised two equal powers, (i) the Athenians, (2) the allies, and was governed by two equal coSrdinate par- liaments, the Athenian assembly and the congress composed of delegates from all the THE ALLIES 393 selling the property, shall give one half (of the proceeds) to the informer, and the other half shall belong to the common fund of the allies. If anyone shall go to war against the members of the alliance, whether by land or by sea, the Athenians and the allies shall give aid to the party attacked, both by land and by sea, with all their might, according to their ability. If anyone, whether magistrate or private citizen, shall propose or put to vote a motion contrary to this decree with the effect of annulling any of the pro- visions of this decree, he himself shall incur loss of civil rights, and his property shall be confiscated, one tenth of it for the Goddess (Athena) ; and he shall be tried before the Athenians and the allies ^ on the charge of destroying the aUiance. The punishment shall be death or banishment from the domain of the Athenians and the allies ; and if he is sentenced to death, he shall not be buried in Attica or in the territory of the allies. The secretary of the council shall inscribe this decree on a stone stele and shall place it by (the statue of) Zeus the Deliverer.^ The money for inscribing the stele, sixty drachmas, shall be given by the treasurers of the Goddess from the fund of ten talents.' There shall be inscribed on this stele the names botii of the Cities now in the alliance and of any that may join it. Furthermore, the people shall choose immediately three envoys to go to Thebes and, so far as they can, to induce the Thebans to take good measures.* The following were chosen : Aristoteles of Marathon,* Pyrrhan- der of Anaphlystus, Thrasybulus of CoUytus. The following cities * are allies of the Athenians : — allies though not from Athens. A resolution adopted by the two parliaments was binding upon the system. ' This may possibly refer to a joint court of Athenians and allies ; cf. Marshall, op. cit. 35^7- ''On the west side of the Athenian market place; Judeich, Top. von Aihen, 302. ' A reserve fund, which, owing to a lack of. ready money, may have been borrowed from the treasury of Athena. *As the Thebans have already been mentioned among the aUies, this embassy must have had another object than that of attaching this people to the confederacy. 5 The mover of the decree. « For the situation of these towns — instead of which the Greek text gives the names of the inhabitants — see the map in Marshall, op. cit. i. Diodorus, xv. 30. z, informs us that seventy cities joined the alliance. For the historical details, see Dit- tenberger's notes and Marshall, op. cit. ch. iii. 394 HELLENIC INTERSTATE RELATIONS Chios/ Tenedos ' Thebes ' MytUene' ' Chalcis^ Methymna^ Eretria^ Rhodes/ Poeessa' Arethusa'' Byzantium ' Carystus ^ Perinthus" Icos^ Peparethos ^ Pall ... Sciathos'' Maronea^ Dion' Paros,' O ... Athenae,' P ... {Here follows a fragment of another motion made by Aristotdes.) {On the left face of the stone the following names* are written in a single column) : The democracy * of Corcyra, Abdera, Thasos, the Chalcidians in Thrace, ^nus, Samothrace, Dicaeopolis, the Acamanians, Pronni in Cephallenia, Alcetas,^ Neoptolemus, [Jason],' Andros, Tenos, Hestiaea, Myconos, Antissa, Eresus, Astraeus, lulis in Ceos, Car- thaea, Coresus, Elaeus, Amorgos, Selymbria, Siphnos, Sicinos, Dion in Thrace, Neapolis, the democracy of Zacynthus living in Nellus^ •These cities were allies at the time of the adoption of the decree, and their names were then inscribed, with the possible exception of Thebes. ' These cities, the names of which are inscribed by two different hands, joined the aUiance in 377. ' These cities probably joined after the battle of Naxos in the autumn of 376. * All these names except the last are inscribed by the same hand ; but the aUies first mentioned (up to Jason) seem to have joined in 375-374, and those from Andros to NeapoUs in 373. Kirchner, Inscr. grac. II, ed. minor, 1913, p. 28, would date all in 37S-374- ' This expression seems to indicate that the oligarchical and democratic factions were then at variance. ' King of the Molossians, Neoptolemus being his son. ' The name has purposely been erased but was probably that of Jason, tyrant of Pherae, Thessaly, who was friendly to Athens in 375, but fell away before 371. *This faction, which had possession of a fort on Mount Nellus, was enrolled in the aUiance in 372 ; Marshsdl, op. cit. 66 ; but cf. Kirchner, supra. The formation of this alliance secured comparative peace to the ^gean islands and afforded them an opportunity to regain the prosperity they had lost through recent wars. FORM OF ADMISSION 395 121. Admission of Methymna to the Confederacy, 377 b.c. {Inscr. grcec. II. s- no. 18 b, editio minor, no. 42 ; Hicks and HUl, no. 103 ; Ditt. no. 82 ; Scala, R. von, Staatsvertrdge, I. no. 140. Translated by G. W. B.) This inscription is on a marble stele found on the Athenian Acropolis. Methymna, already in alliance with Athens, desired to become a member of the new confederacy. The procedure in admitting this state was undoubtedly followed in other cases. First the state sent an embassy to Athens with a re- quest for admission. If the request was granted, the name of the community was enrolled in the list (see- preceding number) . Thereupon three oaths were taken : the first by the embassy of the state in the presence of the congress of allies and of the Athenian generals and hipparchs, next by the three groups of functionaries last mentioned ; and finally by a committee of the applying state- before a board consisting of one Athenian and a commission of the congress. After these oaths were taken, the city was recognized as a member ; cf. Pistorius, H., Beitrdge zur Geschichte von Lesbos, etc. (Bonn, 191 3). 37 sq. The oath is given in the number next following. (Be it resolved by the Council and the People. The tribe) ... is held the piytany. Call... of Alopece was secretary. Simon... ius was chairman. Astyphilus moved the resolution: Concerning the matters on which the Methymnaeans speak — inasmuch as the Methymnaeans are allies and friends of the city of the Athenians — in order that they may have an alliance also with the other allies of the Athenians, let the secretary of the council enroll them in the same way that the other allies have been enrolled. Also let the embassy of the Methymnaeans swear before the delegates of the allies and before the generals and hip- parchs the same oath which the rest of the allies have taken. Then let the delegates of the allies and the generals and hipparchs swear in the same terms before the Methymnaeans.^ Next let .iEsimus and 'the delegates on the ships' ^ see to it that the magis- trates of the Methymnaeans take the oath in the same manner as the rest of thie allies. Furthermore, let the community of the ' Here necessarily the ambassadors from Methymna are meant. ' ^simus was the representative of Athens who accompanied the congressional committee known as the " delegates on the ships " to receive the oath from the applying allies. "The delegates on the ships" were a standing committee, and received their name from their continual voyaging among the islands of the .lEgean for the purpose of receiving new members. 396 HELLENIC INTERSTATE RELATIONS Methymnseans be commended, and their ambassadors be invited to dinner.^ 122. Oaths of the Allies (Inscr. grac. II. S- 49 b- Translated by E. G. S.) The selection below is taken from the treaty which admitted Corcyra to the Confederacy in 377. The oaths are preceded by a statement that the alliance is to last forever : " Let there be an alliance of the Corcyraeans and Athenians forever. If any one in war shall invade the coimtry of the Corcyraeans, ... let the Athenians bring aid," etc. I shall give aid to the people of the Corcyraeans with all my strength to the best of my abiUty, if any one for the purpose of war, either by land or by sea, go against the territory of the Cor- cyraeans, in accordance with whatever notification the Corcjnraeans shall send ; and as concerning war and peace, I shall act in accord- ance with whatever may seem good to the fuU body of the allies,^ and other things I shall do * in accordance with the resolutions of the allies. These things I shall do, so help me Zeus and ApoUo and Demeter. To me, if I keep my oath, may there be many blessings ; if not, the opposite. I shall give aid to the people of the Athenians with all my strength to the best of my abiUty, if any one for the purpose of war, either by land or by sea, go against the territory of the Athe- nians, in accordance with whatever notification the Athenians shall send ; and as concerning war and peace, I shall act in accordance with whatever may seem good to the full body of the allies, and other things I shall do in accordance with the resolutions of the Athenians and the alhes. These things I shall do, so help me Zeus and Apollo and Demeter. To me, if I keep my oath, may there be many blessings ; if not, the opposite.* i'EjtJ l^vio, the hospitality due to honored guests. In' addition to the state dinner in the Prytaneum, they were regularly invited to front seats in the theater and a prominent place in such festivals as occurred. during their stay in Athens. * The congress in full session is here meant. ' That is, all other things involved in the relations between the contracting parties. * The obligations contained in these oaths we may regard as typical of the defensive alliances of that period. A MONOPOLY 397 123. Athenian Monopoly of Red Ochre produced in Ceos, 360-350 B.C. {Inscr. grasc. II. no. 546; Hicks and Hill, no. 137; Roberts and Gardner, Greek Epigraphy, II. no. 71. Translated by C. J. O.) This inscription, found on the Acropolis of Athens, contains decrees of three towns of Ceos. The opening portion, now lost, must have included an Athenian decree regarding the appointment of the commissioners named at the close. From the position of the Cean decrees that are preserved it seems probable that they had been passed as the result of previous negotiations, and that the commission here named was to see to their enforcement. The regulations, the general purport of which is plain in spite of the mutilation of the inscription, give an interesting view of an ancient trade monopoly and of the domineering poUcy of Athens toward her weaker allies in the fourth century. In spite of her promises on the founding of the Confederacy (see no. 120) she could not resist the temptation to turn the league to her own advantage as soon as she found herself in a commanding position. The island of Ceos, nearest of the Cyclades to Athens, was noted for its red ochre, or ruddle (/ulXros ; cf. Theophrastus, Be lapidibus, 52), which was used both in medicine and in the arts. Athens, therefore, by controlling the supply of this raw material, secured an advantage for her manufactures. On account of the writing, the inscription is assigned to the middle of the fourth century, probably not long after 363, when the Cean towns, which had seceded from the Confederacy, were reduced by force; cf. Hicks and HiU, no. 118. {Only a few fragments remain of the decree of Carthaa.) (De- cree of Coresus.) Theogenes moved : — Be it resolved by the council and the people of Coresus, with regard to the message of the Athenian commissioners, that red ochre shall be exported to Athens only ... as was formerly the case. In order to enforce the decrees ... [of the Athenians] and the Coresians regarding red ochre, it shall be exported in a ship which the * . . . shall assign, and not in any other ship. The producers shall pay as freight an obol [on each talent^ to the shipowners]. If anyone shall export it in another ship, he shall be subject [to the provisions of the law( ?)]. This decree shall be inscribed upon a stone stele and placed [in the temple] of Apollo, and the law, as it was formerly, shall be in force. A charge (of violating the law) shall be brought ' Perhaps the astynomi mentioned below. I.e., sesto- 398 HELLENIC INTERSTATE RELATIONS before the astynomi^ who shall refer it to the vote of the court within [thirty] days. The bringer of the information or of the charge ^ shall have the half (of the cargo) ; but if the bringer of the charge is a slave, he shall, if he belongs to the exporters, re- ceive his freedom and have [three fourths ?] (of the cargo) ; if he belongs to someone else, he shall receive his freedom. . . . Both the bringer of an information and the bringer of a charge shall also have the right of appeal to Athens.' Whatever other decrees the Athenians may make regarding the supervision of (the trade in) red ochre shall be in force (at Coresus) when brought hither. The duty of one fiftieth * shall be paid to the collectors by the [im- porters]. The Athenians shall be invited to dine in the Pryta- neum on the morrow. {The decree of lulls is here omitted as it contains substantially the same terms as the preceding.) {Names of the Athenian commissioners.) The following were chosen: Andron of Cerameicus, Lysias {or Lysiades), of . . ., ... of Phlya, Euphrosynus of Paeania. 124. Athenian Decree in Honor or Dionysius I or Syracuse {Inscr. grcK. II. no. 51, editio minor, 1913, no. 103 ; Hicks and Hill, no. 108 ; Ditt. I. no. 89; also Kohler, "Die griechische Politik Dionysius des Alteren," in Ath. Mitt,. I (1876). 1-26. Translated by C. J. O.) This document throws an interesting light upon the relations of Dionysius I, tyrant of Syracuse, 405-367 B.C., with the states of peninsular Hellas. As a friend of Sparta he had been opposed to Athens during the greater part of his rule, although there is a fragment of an Athenian decree in his honor belonging to 394-393 (Hicks and HiU, no. 91) ; but when Sparta and Athens were drawn together after the battle of Leuctra, 371, it was natural that the latter state shovdd enter into relations with Dionysius, at that time the ruler of the most ' These officials, who at Athens had charge of the public highways (Aristotle, Consi. Ath. 50), must have been also port wardens at Coresus. ' An information (Greek phasis) had to be prosecuted by the informer himself; a charge (Greek endeixis) might be prosecuted by the public authorities ; so that even a slave could bring it; cf. Ziebarth, in Hermes, XXXII (1897). 609-28, and espedally 612 sg. ' Or possibly, "shall have the right to bring the suit at Athens.'' ' Probably the duty of two per cent collected by Athens on all exports and imports. DIONYSIUS I 399 powerful state in the Hellenic world. The particular reason for his sending an embassy to Athens in 368 and for the honors conferred on him can only be con- jectured ; but as he is known to have assisted the Spartans and then: aUies with troops on two occasions (Xenophon, Hellenica, vii. i. 20, 28), either in 369 and 368, or in 368 and 367, it is probable that the decree has reference to one of these expeditions. Early in 367 a formal alliance was concluded between Athens and Dionysius (see Hicks and HUl, no. 112), but it was rendered ineflEectual by his death a few months later. In the archonship of Lysistratus, in the tenth * prytany, that of [Erechtheis], when Execestus, son of [Paeonides (?)], of Azenia, was secretary, the proedros^ who put the question was Evangelus* . . . Pandius moved the resolution : — That with regard to the message of the ambassadors from Dionysius, be it resolved by the council : — That with regard to the letters sent by Dionysius concerning the building of the temple * and the peace,' the aUies * shall bring before the people whatever resolution may seem best to them in their deliberations ; and that the proedri after inviting the allies, shall introduce the ambassadors to the people at the next assembly, and shall include their message in 'the business of the day, and shall also communicate the proposal of the council to the people, to the effect that it pleases the council : ' — To commend Dionysius, the archon* of Sicily, and his sons Dionysius and Hermocritus, inasmuch as they are good and true men toward the Athenian people and the allies, and aid the King's 1 June-July, 368. 2 From the early part of the fourth century nine proedri (" managers") were ap- pointed by lot to supervise each meeting of the assembly, and their president was named in the heading of decrees instead of the president of the prytaneis. ' In the obliterated line two wreaths may have been carved. * The temple of Apollo at Delphi, which had been at least partially destroyed by fire or earthquake in 373-372 ; of. Ditt. I. no. 93 ; Jacoby, Marmor Parium (Berlin, 1904), 18, 119. s If the peace congress at Delphi (Xen. Bell. vii. 1. 27) was held in 368, as is gen- erally assumed, the embassy of Dionysius was probably connected with it. Niese, however, in his "Beitrage zur griech. Geschichte," in Hermes, XXXTX (1904). 84-132. especially 88-93, 125-8, assigns the congress to the following year. 'I.e., the delegates from the cities of the Athenian confederacy, who held their sessions at Athens; cf. no. 120. ' The following bill, though in form only a resolution of the council, must have been accepted verbatim by the assembly. ' The official title of Dionysius in the Athenian decrees, " ruler," " chief magistrate." 400 HELLENIC INTERSTATE RELATIONS Peace/ which was made by the Athenians and the Lacedaemonians and the rest of the Hellenes ; and to send to Dionysius the crown (already) decreed to him by the people, and to crown each of the sons of Dionysius with a golden crown of the value of one thousand drachmas on account of their loyalty and their friendliness; and that Dionysius and his sons shall be Athenian citizens, they them- selves and their descendants, (and shall belong) to the tribe and the deme and the phratry that they wish. The prytaneis of (the tribe) Erechtheis shall refer this matter to the vote of the people {The remainder of the inscription is fragmentary^ 125. Decree of Amphipolis Ordering the Banishment of Two Partisans of Athens (Hicks and Hill, no. 125; Ditt. I. 113; Buck, Greek Dialects, 11. no. 12. Translated by C. J. O.) This inscription was found near the site of ancient Amphipolis. The town, which was situated on the border of Macedon and Thrace near the mouth of the river Strymon (now Struma), was originally a colony of Athens, but had maintained its independence many years, until it was annexed by Philip of Macedon, 357 B.C. The decree contained in the inscription must be assigned to the latter part of this year ; for the Stratocles whose banishment is ordered is undoubtedly the Stratocles who went as ambassador to the Athenians to urge them to take possession of Amphipolis ; Demosthenes, Olynthiac Oration, i. 8. The Athenians, however, refused; for they relied on the promise of Philip, who, instead of restoring the town to them, had the opponents of his rule sent into exile ; Diodorus xvi. 8. This inscription, therefore, though in form the decree of a free city, is in reality one of the earliest monuments of the .Macedonian supremacy. It hath pleased the people : that Philo and Stratocles shall be banished from Amphipolis and from the land of the Amphipolitans forever, both they themselves and their children ; and, if they are captured anywhere, they shall be treated as public enemies and may be put to death with impunity.^ Their property shall be confiscated and the tenth part shall be consecrated to ApoUo and 'The peace of Antalcidas, 387-386; see Botsford, Hellenic History, ch. xxi. '7.e., they are not merely exiled, but outlawed as weU. PHILIP OF MACEDON 401 to Strymon.^ The prefects ^ shall inscribe their names on a stone stele. If anyone shall demand another vote upon this decree or shall harbor these men by any art or device whatsoever, his prop- erty shall be confiscated and he himself shall be banished from Am- phipolis forever. 126. Philip's War upon Olynthus (Demosthenes, Olyntkiac Oration, II. Kennedy, revised by E. G. S.) Philip, who came to the throne of Macedon in 359, devoted himself (i) to the consolidation of his own kingdom from a loose aggregate of primitive tribes to a highly centralized monarchy, (2) to the formation of a more efficient army than Europe had known before, (3) to the extension of his supremacy not only over neighboring tribes of barbarians, but also over peninsular Hellas. The' first object of his foreign policy was to get possession of the coast towns, in order to gain access to the sea. It was for this purpose that he seized Amphip- olis, as mentioned in the preceding selection. His failure to restore it to Athens as promised involved him in a war with that country, 3S7~346. During the greater part of this period the war existed in name and in feeling only, though at times there were actual hostilities. Meanwhile Philip busied himself with the extension of his power over Thessaly and Thrace. For a time Olynthus with her Chalcidic allies (see no. 125) was friendly with him and hostile to Athens; but at length when the Olynthians found themselves menaced by the growing power and insolence of Philip, they became his enemies and called on Athens for an alliance and immediate aid. The act of Philip which precipitated this war was his demand for the surrender of his half-brother Arrhidaeus, who had fled to Olynthus to escape Philip's wrath. The Olynthians, true to their reli- gious obligation, refused to deliver the suppliant, whereupon Philip began war, 349. It was during the year 349-348 that Demosthenes delivered his three Olyntkiac Orations, urging the Athenians to send strong forces at once to the support of Olynthus. Dionysius of Halicarnassus concluded that the oration numbered the second was in reaUty spoken first, and this view was accepted by Grote, History of Greece, XI. 327 ; see also Blass, Attische Beredsamkeit, IH. i. 268 sqq. This is the oration given below. It is valuable for the political situation of that time. THE SECOND OLY>fTHIAC (i) On many occasions, men of Athens, one may see the kind- ness of the gods to this country manifested, but most signally, I think, on the present. That here are men prepared for a war ' The god of the river of the same name. ' Greek prostatae, officials whose function is unknown. 402 HELLENIC INTERSTATE RELATIONS with Philip, possessed of a neighboring territory and some power, and (what is most important) so fixed in their hostility, as to re- gard any accommodation with him as insecure, and even ruinous to their country; this really appears like an extraordinary act of divine beneficence. (2) It must then be our care, Athenians, that we are not more unkind to ourselves than circumstances have been ; as it would be a foul, a most foul reproach, to have abandoned not only cities and places that once belonged to us, but also the allies and emergencies provided by fortune. (3) To dilate, Athenians, on Philip's power, and by such dis- course to incite you to your duty, I think improper : and why ? Because all that may be said on that score involves matter of glory for him, and misconduct on our part. The more he has tran- scended his repute, the more is he universally admired ; you, as you have used your advantages unworthily, have incurred the greater disgrace. (4) This topic, then, I shall pass over. Indeed, Athenians, a correct observer will find the source of his greatness here, and not in himself. But of measures for which those who have managed the government in his interest, deserve his gratitude and your vengeance, I see no occasion to speak now. Other things are open to me, which it concerns you all to know, and which must, on a due examination, Athenians, reflect great disgrace on Philip. To these will I address myself. (s) To call him perjured and treachCTous, without showing what he has done, might justly be termed idle abuse. But to go through all his actions and convict him on the basis of the same, will take, as it happens, but a short time, and is expedient, I think for two reasons : first, that his baseness may appear in its true light ; secondly, that they, whose terror imagines Philip to be in- vincible, may see he has run through all the artifices by which he rose to greatness, and his affairs have reached their very termina- tion. (6) I myself, men of Athens, should most assuredly have regarded Philip to be an object of fear and admiration, had I seen him exalted by honorable conduct; but actually observing and considering, I find that in the beginning when certain persons drove away the Olynthians from here, who desired a conference with us, by saying that he was going to surrender AmphipoKs, and to execute the secret article once so much harped upon ; afterward PHILIP AND OLYNTHUS 403 he got the friendship of the Olynthians, by taking Potidaea from you, wronging you, his former aUies, and delivering it to them ; and lastly now the Thessalians, by promising to surrender Mag- nesia, and to undertake the Phocian war on their behalf.' In short, ^ none who have dealt with him has he not fooled. He has risen by conciliating and cajoling the weakness of every people in turn who knew him not. (8) As, therefore, by such means he grew great when each people imagined he would advance their interest, so ought he by the same means to be pulled down again when the selfish aim of his whole pohcy is exposed." To this crisis, O Athe- nians, are Philip's affairs come ; or let any man stand forward and prove to me, or rather to you, that my assertions are false, or that men whom Philip has once overreached will trust him hereafter, or that the Thessahans who have been degraded into servitude would not gladly become free. (9) But if any among you, though agreeing in these statements, thinks that by force Philip will maintain his power, by having occupied forts and havens and the like, this is a mistake. True, when a coahtion subsists by good-wHl, and all parties to the war have a common interest, men are willing to cooperate and bear hardships and persevere. But when one has grown strong, like Philip, by rapacity and artifice, on the first pretext, the slightest reverse, all is overturned and broken up. (10) Impossible is it, — impossible, Athenians, — to acquire a solid power by in- justice and perjury and falsehood. Such things last for once, or for a short period ; maybe, they blossom fairly with hope ; but 1 During her ascendancy, 371-362, Thebes had built up a strong federation in cen- tral Greece. Among the allies which she held by force only was Phods. Soon after the battle of Mantineia, 362, which was in efEect a defeat for Thebes, Phocis renounced her allegiance. To regain her power Thebes persuaded the Amphictyonic council to fine certain leading Phocians for sacrilege against the Delphic Apollo. Phocis resisted, and thus the so-called Sacred War began, 356. With the aid of the Delphic treasury the Phocians hired mercenaries, more than held their own against Thebes, and invaded Thessaly. Philip, taking the side of the Thessalians, succeeded finally in defeating the Phocians and in driving them from Thessaly. It was chiefly by these means that he acquired supremacy over that country. 2 The argument is that his successes have been due chiefly to the conduct of the Hellenes themselves, cajoled into friendship or aUiance by his false promises. Thus far the orator is right. He reasons further that if the HeUenes, at length aware of his character, should join in resisting him, they would succeed. This, we may say, is possible though not certain, so great had the power of Philip already become. 404 HELLENIC INTERSTATE RELATIONS in time they are discovered and collapse. As a house, a ship, or the like, ought to have the lower part firmest, so in human conduct, I ween, the principle and foundation should be just and true. But this is not so in PhiUp's conduct. (ii) I say then, we should at once aid the Olynthians (the best and quickest way that can be suggested will please me most), and send an embassy to the Thessalians, to inform some of our measures, and to stir up the rest ; for they have now voted to de- mand Pagasae, and remonstrate about Magnesia. (12) But look to this, Athenians, that our envoys shall not only make speeches, but have some real proof that we have gone forth as becomes our country, and are engaged in action. All speech without action appears vain and idle, but especially tl^at of our commonwealth; as the more we are thought to excel therein, the more is speaking distrusted by all. (13) You must show yourselves greatly re- formed, greatly changed, contributing, serving personally, acting promptly, if indeed any one is to pay attention to you. If ye will perform these duties properly and becomingly, Athenians, not only will it appear that Philip's alliances are weak and precarious, but the poor state of his native empire and power will be revealed. (14) To speak roundly, the Macedonian power, state, and empire are very weU as a help, as it was for you in Timotheus' time against the Olynthians; hkewise for them against Potidaea the conjunction was important; and lately it aided the Thessalians in their broils and troubles against the regnant house : and the accession of any power, however small, is undoubtedly useful. But the Macedonian state is feeble of itself, and full of defects. (15) The very operations which seem to constitute Philip's great- ness, his war and his expeditions, have made it more insecure than it was originally. Think not, Athenians, that Philip and his subjects have the same hkings. He desires glory, makes that his passion, is ready for any cohsequence of adventure and peril, (16) preferring to a hfe of safety the honor of achieving what no Macedonian king ever did before. But they have no share in the glorious result; ever harassed by these excursions up and down, they suffer and toil incessantly, allowed no leisure for their employments or private concerns, unable even to dispose of their hard earnings, the markets of the country being closed on account PHILIP'S ASSOCIATES 405 of war. (17) By this then it may easily be seen, how the Mace- donians in general are disposed to Philip. His mercenaries and guards, indeed, have the reputation of admirable and weU-trained soldiers ; as I heard from one who had been in the country, a man incapable of falsehood, they are no better than others. (18) For if there be any among them experienced in battles and campaigns, Philip is jealous of such men and drives them away, he says, wish- ing to keep the glory of all actions to himself ; ^ his jealousy (among other failings) being excessive. Or if any man be generally tem- perate and virtuous, unable to bear Philip's daily intemperances, drunkenness, and indecencies, he is pushed aside and accounted nobody.^ (19) The rest about him are brigands and parasites, and men of that character, who will get drunk and perform dances which I scruple to name before you. My information is undoubt- edly true; for persons whom all scouted here as worse rascals than mountebanks, Callias the town-slave and the like of him, antic-jesters, and composers of ribald songs to lampoon their companions, such persons Philip esteems and keeps about him. (20) Small matters these may be thought, Athenians, but to the wise they are strong indications of his way of thinking and his wrongheadedness. Success perhaps throws a shade over them now ; prosperity is a famous hider of such blemishes ; but on any miscarriage they will be fully exposed. And this (trust me, Athe- nians) will appear in no long time, if the gods so will and you deter- mine. (21) For as in the human body, a man in health feels not partial ailments, but when some illness occurs, every element of physical wellbeing is stirred from its composure, whether it be a rupture or a sprain or anything else unsound ; so with states and monarchs, whilst they wage external war, their weaknesses are un- discemed by most men, but the tug of a frontier war betrays all. (22) If any of you think Phihp a formidable opponent, because they see he is fortunate, such reasoning is prudent, Athenians. 'Fortune has indeed a great preponderance — nay, is everything in human affairs. Not but that, if I had the choice, I should prefer our fortune to Philip's, would you but moderately perform your 'In this matter Demosthenes was mismformed; Philip appreciated those who served him ably. 2 There seems to have been truth in this statement; see no. 167. 4o6 HELLENIC INTERSTATE RELATIONS duty. For I see you have many more claims to the divine favor than he has. But in fact we sit doing nothing ; (23) and a man who is himself idle cannot require even his friends to act for him, much less the gods. No wonder then that he, marching and toil- ing in person, present on all occasions, neglecting no time or reason, prevails over us delaying and voting and inquiring. I marvel not at that ; the contrary would' have been marvellous if we, doing none of the duties of war, had beaten one doing them all. (24) But this surprises me, that formerly, Athenians, you resisted the Lacedaemonians for the rights of Greece, and rejecting many opportunities of selfish gain to secure the rights of others, expended your property in contributions, and bore the brunt of the battle; yet now you are loth to serve, slow to contribute in defence of your own possessions, and, though you have often saved the other communities of Greece collectively and individually, under your own losses you sit stiU. (25) This surprises me, and one thing more, Athenians ; that not one of you can reckon, how long your war with PhiUp has lasted, and what you have been doing while the time has passed. You surely know, that while you have been delaying, expecting others to act, accusing, and passing judgment on one another, expecting again, doing much the same as ye so do now, all the time has passed away. (26) Then are ye so senseless, Athenians, as to imagine that the same measures, which have brought the country from a prosperous to a poor condition, will bring it from a poor to a prosperous? Unreasonable were this and unnatural; for all things are easier kept than gotten. The war now has left us nothing to keep ; we have all to get and the work must be done by ourselves. (27) I say then you must contribute money, serve in person with alacrity, accuse no one, till you have gained your objects ; then, judging from facts, honor the deserving, punish offenders ; for you cannot harshly scrutinize the conduct of others, unless you have done what is right yourselves. (28) Why, think you, do all the generals whom you commission avoid this war, and seek wars of their own? (for of the generals too must a little truth be told). Because here the prizes of the war are yours; for example, if AmphipoUs be taken, you will immediately recover it; the commanders have all the risk and no reward. But in the other case the risks are less, and the gains BE EFFICIENT, ATHENIANS! 407 belong to the commanders and soldiers : Lampsacus, Sigeum, the vessels which they plunder. (29) So they proceed to secure their several interests; you, when you look at the bad state of your affairs, bring the generals to trial; but when they get a hearing and plead these necessities, you acquit them. The result is that, while you are quarreling and divided, some holding one opinion, some another, the commonwealth goes wrong. Formerly, Athenians, you had divisions for taxes; now you have divisions for politics. There is an orator presiding on either side, a general under him, and three hundred men who will do the shouting ; ' the rest of you are attached some to the one party and some to the other. (30) This you must leave off; be yourselves again; establish a general liberty of speech, deliberation, and action. If some are appointed to command as with autocratic authority, some to be compelled to be ship-captains, tax-payers, soldiers, others only to vote against them, and help in nothing besides, no duty will be seasonably performed; the aggrieved parties will in each case fail you, and you will have to punish them instead of- your enemies. (31) I say, in short, you must all fairly contribute, according to each man's abihty; take your turns of service tiU you have all been afield ; give every speaker a hearing and adopt the best counsel ; then not only will you praise the speaker at the moment, but your- selves afterward, when the universal condition of things is improved.'' 127. The Condition of Hellas about 346, and Philip's Great Opportunity (Isocrates, Philippus) The effort of Demosthenes, expressed m the preceding selection, failed. The Athenians gave the Olynthians little aid. Philip conquered Olynthus and the allies who remained faithful to her. These cities he destroyed, and sold the inhabitants into slavery, 348. Two years later Athens concluded with ' See Calhoun, Athenian Clubs in Politics and Litigation, a work which has acquired an international reputation. 2 One of the facts most noticeable in this speech is the lack of military spirit and political ambition in the Athenians. Although they were still willing to defend their coimtry when attacked, they had lost all zest for fighting to defend distant possessions. Demosthenes here and elsewhere attempts to inspire them with their old military ardor. Although he met with a certain degree of success, it came too late and was insufficient. 4o8 HELLENIC INTERSTATE RELATIONS him a treaty known as the peace of Philocrates, after the Athenian who moved the resolution. In this year Philip, as champion of the Delphic amphictyony, crushed the Phocians, destroyed their cities, scattered the inhabitants in villages, and imposed upon them an annual tax for the repayment of the treasury taken from Delphi. At this time he was master of a great part of Greece, and the terror of his name filled the cities that were still free. In every city were his partisans who worked for his interest. In some cases they may have been moved by farsightedness, a conviction that Philip's lordship over Hellas would be best for the country's interests. In other cases they were bribed or were actuated by fear. Isocrates, who formerly in his Panegyricus had proposed a imion of aU Hellas under the joint leadership of Sparta and Athens against Persia, now looked to Philip for this leadership. The works of Isocrates are especially important in view of the fact that Ed. Meyer, von Pohlmann, and other modern scholars look upon him as the truest interpreter of the social and political conditions of his age. (2) Seeing that the war in which you and this state were in- volved concerning Amphipolis^ was producing many evils, I (at that time) essayed the task ^ of using concerning that city and its territory arguments bearing no resemblance to those which were in the mouths of your friends or the orators among us, but as far as possible removed from their line of thought. (3) They were inciting you to the war, by appealing to your passions ; I on the contrary expressed no opinion at all on disputed matters, but devoted my attention to the argument which of all others I sup- posed most likely to produce peace, urging that both of you were mistaken in your judgment of affairs, and that while you, Philip, were fighting in furtherance of our interests, our state was fighting in support of your power, — that it was to your advantage that we should possess the territory in dispute, and to ours not to ac- quire it by any means whatever.* (4) The opinion of my pupils,* ' This war between Philip and Athens is referred to in the introduction to no. 126. It began in 357 and closed with the treaty of Philocrates in 346, shortly before the writing of the PhUippus. ' Before the peace of Philocrates (see note supra) Isocrates was engaged in the preparation of an address to Philip on the relation between him and Athens. From § 7 it appears that the epistle was not yet complete when the treaty was signed. From this and other sources we see how slowly and, we might say, painfully Isocrates labored on his writings. The tenor of this unfinished letter Isocrates describes in § 2 sqq. ' His argument as here outlined was highly sophistical, and could have had little effect on Philip, had the letter been completed and sent to him. * Among the pupils of Isocrates were young men from the most eminent families in Hellas. Their ideas therefore had some degree of weight in forming public opinion. AMPHIPOLIS 409 too, as to my treatment of this question was such as to lead no one of them to praise the argument or the style for accuracy and clear- ness, as some are wont to do, but to cause them to admire the truth of the matter expressed,^ (5) and to consider that the only way for you to cease on either side from your rivalry was for you, Philip, to be convinced that the friendship of our state would be worth more to you than the revenues accruing from Amphipohs,^ and for our state to be able to recognize the policy of avoiding the kind of colonies which have brought ruin four or five times over on those domiciled in them, and of looking for places l)dng far from neigh- bors with a capacity for ruling, and near those who have become accustomed to slavery, such as the place to which the Lacedaemo- nians have sent the Cyreneans ; ^ (6) and further, you should recog- nize that a verbal renunciation of this territory to us will enable you in reality to become master of it, and also to earn our goodwill ; for all the colonists that we send within reach of your power will be- so many hostages of friendship for you from us. Our people, too, should be taught that if we take Amphipolis, we shall be com- pelled to observe the same kind of friendliness to your policy for the sake of the inhabitants of that plice, that we had to observe toward Amadocus* of old for the sake of those who tilled the soil of Chersonese. (7) By the use of many arguments of this char- acter I caused all who heard them to hope that, after my discourse had been circulated,^ you would conclude the war, change your ' In the case of Isocrates it is always a question whether the rhetorician or the thinker has the upper hand ; here he claims that in the judgment of his pupils the thought was better than the style. ' No amount of argument could bring Philip to this view ; to his ambitious policy it was all-important to incorporate in his kingdom the coast cities, so as to make Mace- don a maritime state. Isocrates fails to recognize this fact. Further, though Philip valued the goodwill of Athens, as he afterward showed, that consideration could not hinder him from pursuing his own independent policy of expansion. ' This statement involves a criticism on Athens for having colonized Amphipolis. At the time of that settlement, however, the condition of the surrounding region was very different; Macedon was still insignificant. ' Amadocus was a Thracian chief in the vicinity of Chersonese. Early in the fourth century Athens entered into relations of friendship with him in order better to safe- guard the interests of the Athenian colony in Chersonese. 5 Undoubtedly Isocrates had many copies of his Orations (in reality essays) and Epistles made and circulated among his pupils, friends, and influential men of Hellas. The effect of the epistle under consideration, therefore, would come not only directly to Philip but also indirectly, through the force of public opinion. 4IO HELLENIC INTERSTATE RELATIONS opinions, and adopt some common policy for your mutual good.^ Whether they were foolish or sensible in thinking thus, they are the proper persons to bear the responsibility; but while I was engaged in this business, you anticipated me by making peace before my discourse was finally completed, and in that you were wise; for it were better that peace should be concluded in any way whatever ^ than that we should be exposed to the evils arising in consequence of the war. (8) Rejoicing then at the resolution to which you had come concerning peace, and thinking that they would be to your advantage, and to that of all the rest of Hellas as well as to ours, I was unable to divert my thoughts from what was connected with it, but was in such a frame of mind that I set to work to consider at once how to give permanence to what we had achieved and to prevent our state from again, after a short interval, desiring other wars ; ' (9) an examination of these ques- tions in my own mind led me to the conclusion that there was no other way for her to live in quiet, except by the determination of the leading states to make up their mutual quarrels and to carry the war into Asia, and by their resolving to win from the barbarians the selfish advantages which they now look for at the expense of the Hellenes. This is the policy I had already advised in my Panegyric discourse.* (10) On these reflections, thinking that I could never find a subject nobler than this, or one of more general application or more conducive to the interests of us all, I was moved to write upon it again, not in any ignorance of my own deficiencies, but knowing that this discourse was not suited to one of my age,^ but required a man in the prime of life and with powers far beyond those of ' The mutual advantage of Philip and Athens. ' This was the peace of Philocrates, 346, referred to above. It seems that Isocrates was for "peace at any price !" Some agreed with him, whereas many, among them Demosthenes, were determined upon maintaining for their city an independent in- terstate policy. ' At this time the line was sharply drawn between the Macedonian and anti-Mace- donian parties at Athens. The latter looked upon the peace merely as an opportunity to prepare for war. * The Panegyricus, the ablest of all the writings of Isocrates, was published in 380. In it he advocated a union of all the Hellenes under the joint leadership of Athens and Sparta against Persia; cf. Botsford, Hellenic History, ch. xxi. ' Isocrates was now ninety years old. THE ORATIONS OF ISOCRATES 411 other men. (11) I am aware, too, that it is difficult to utter two discourses on the same subject in any fashion that can be tolerated, especially if the one first published has been written in such a man- ner that it is imitated and admired even more by our detractors than by our most extravagant eulogists.^ (12) Nevertheless, overlooking these disabilities, I have become so ambitious in old age that I resolved to combine with the observations I should address to you some hints to those who have worked with me, and to make it clear that to trouble the Great Festivals with oratory, and to speak to the crowds who come together there, is to speak without an audience. Speeches of this kind are as ineffectual as laws and constitutions written out by the sophists.^ (13) Those who wish, on the contrary, to do some practical good instead of idly trifling, and those who think they have formed ideas of value to the community, must leave others to figure at the Festivals, and must take a champion for their cause from among those who are powerful in speech and action and who have great reputations, if (that is to say) anyone is to pay attention to them.' (14) Know- ing these things, I elected to address my discourse to you, not making this choice to win your favor, although, it is true, I should consider it of great importance to speak in a manner acceptable to you, but it was not to this end that I directed my thoughts. In fact I saw that all other men of repute were living under the rule of states and laws, without power to do anything but obey orders, and moreover were far too weak for the enterprise which I shall propose, (15) while to you alone had fortune given full power to send ambassadors to whomsoever you chose and to receive them from whomsoever you pleased,^ and to say whatever you should ' Here he refers to the fact that the general subject of his present discourse is the same as that of the Panegyricus : the union of the Hellenes for a war against Persia is common to both, though the leadership is diflferent. ^ This is a confession that his Panegyricus has had Uttle effect. For the first ideal constitution, such as Isocrates has in mind, see no. 63. Plato's Republic is the most famous constitution of the kind. ' Both Plato and Isocrates (see § 81 omitted from this selection) had appealed in some such way to Dionysius, tyrant of Syracuse, but without result. * From this passage it appears that Isocrates supposed that the relations between Philip and Hellas would be conducted through embassies merely; he nowhere gives evidence of an idea of institutional relationship such as was actually established ; see no. 128. 412 HELLENIC INTERSTATE RELATIONS deem it expedient to say, and further that you were the possessor to a greater degree than any man in Hellas of wealth and power, the only two things in existence which can both persuade and com- pel ; things, too, which I think will be required by the enterprise which I am going to propose. (i6) My intention is to advise you to take the lead both in securing the harmony of Hellas and in conducting the expedition against the barbarians ; and persua- sion is expedient with Greeks and force useful with the barbarians.' Such, then, is the general scope of my discourse. . . . Some of his friends urge that Isocrates is too old for the task of advising Philip, who is himself too wise to need'counsd, and who has also the advantages mentioned below. (19) Further, he has at his side the most competent men in Macedon, who though unversed in other matters, probably under- stand his interests at least better than you (Isocrates) do. More- over, you will also find many of the Hellenes living in that country, men not devoid of reputation or good sense, but men by the help of whose counsels he has not diminished the power of his throne, but has achieved things worth praying for. (20) What is wanting to complete his success? Has he not caused the Thessalians, whose rule formerly extended over Macedon, to be so friendly disposed to him that they, one and all, have more confidence in him than in their compatriots ? '^ Further, as to the cities of that locality, has he not either won them over by kindness to alliance with him, or when they grievously vexed him, has he not reduced them to ruins? (21) Has he not overthrown the Magnesians and the Perrhaebians and the Paeonians, and brought them all into subjection, become lord and master of the lUyrians excepting those who live on the shores of the Adriatic, and placed the whole of Thrace under despots of his own choosing ? * . . . ' Isocrates expects Philip in his relations with the Hellenes to use persuasion only ; compulsion was to be reserved for barbarians. In this matter he was thoroughly mistaken. ' It was to such internal dissensions, leading to the calling in of outsiders, that the Greeks lost their freedom, having to surrender it partially to the Macedonians and after- ward fuUy to the Romans. ' The conduct of Philip up to this point ought to have convinced Isocrates of PhiUp's readiness to use force against Hellas, and to make himself master of free Hellenic cities which he was willing to spare from ruin. PHILIP A HERACLEID 413 In spite of friends Isocrates persists in his pxirpose to compose a letter of advice to Philip. (30) I will now direct my remarks to the subject itself. My idea is that, while neglecting none of your private interests, you ought to try to effect a reconciliation between Argos, Sparta, Thebes, and our state ; for if you are able to bring these states together, you will have no difl&culty in causing the other commonwealths to agree ; (31) for they are all under the influence of those I have mentioned, and when in fear they take refuge with one or another of those states, from which they draw their succor. If therefore you can persuade four states only to be wise, you will release the others also from many evils. (32) Now you will feel that there is no one of these common- wealths that you should despise, if you trace back their conduct toward your ancestors ; ^ for you will find that each one is to be credited with much friendship and great kindnesses toward your house. Argos is your fatherland, for which it is right for you to have as much regard as for your own parents.^ The Thebans honor the founder' of your race with procegsions and with sacrifices more than all the other gods. (33) The Lacedaemonians have bestowed on his descendants both royalty and leadership for all time ; and our state, say those whom we trust in matters of ancient history, contributed to win immortality for Heracles and deliver- ance for his children. . . . The conditions above mentioned are a ground for friendship between Philip and the four commonwealths respectively. Isocrates next proceeds to discuss the possibility of a general Hellenic reconciliation. (39) Someone will perhaps venture to oppose what I have said, on the ground that I am endeavoring to induce you to under- * Down to this time th^ citing of mythical antecedents formed part of the polite language of diplomacy, andv naturally Isocrates indulges in the practice. Although Philip may have been pleased by this reference to his ancestors, he certainly was not influenced by it. ' Undoubtedly the story that the founder of the reigning Macedonian dynasty was a genuine Greek, a colonist from Argos and descendant of Heracles, was composed by one of the many Greek literati who had enjoyed a happy existence at the court of the Macedonian kings. In the same way they made up stories and extended pedigrees to connect the origins of Rome with their own people. ' Heracles. 414 HELLENIC INTERSTATE RELATIONS take an impossible task. "The Argives," he may say, "can never be friends with the Lacedaemonians, or the Lacedaemonians with the Thebans, nor in a word can those who have always been ac- customed to seek their selfish interests ever cast in their lot with one another." (40) I think, however, that nothing of this kind could have been effected when our state, or again when Lacedaemon, held supremacy in Hellas; for either of them could easily have prevented what was going forward ; but now I no longer have the same opinion of them ; for I know that they have aU been brought to a level by their misfortunes, so that I think they will greatly prefer the benefits of union to the selfish advantages of their former policy. (41) Then again I admit that there is no one else who could reconcile these states, but to you no such undertaking is difficult ; for I see that you have accomplished many things which others considered hopeless and beyond expectation, so that it would not be strange if you alone should be capable of effecting this union. . . . To prove that the Hellenic states are capable of harmony, Isocrates cites their union against Persia at the time of the invasion of Xerxes, 480 B.C. (46) Now I think the best way for you to learn whether these commonwealths are disposed to peace or to war among themselves would be for me to give an account, not merely in general terms, nor yet too much in detail, of the chief features of their present condition.^ First let us consider the position of the Lacedaemo- nians. (47) These people, not so long ago the rulers of Hellas by land and sea, suffered such a reversal of fortune when defeated in the battle of Leuctra,^ that they were deprived of the supremacy over Hellas, and lost such men among them as chose to die rather than live in subjection to those whose masters they formerly were. (48) Furthermore, they had to look on and see all the Pelopon- nesians who formerly followed in their train against the rest of Hellas, joining the Thebans in invading their country, against whom they were compelled to fight, not in the country for the harvest, but in the midst of their city, even at the seat of government, to ' The brief account of contemporary Greece which follows is true and instructive. ' 371 B.C. CONTEMPORARY HELLAS 415 save their wives and children, — a struggle in which failure would have been immediate destruction, while victory has not released them from their miseries. (49) They were subjected to war by their neighbors, distrusted by aU the Peloponnesians, and hated by the majority of Hellenes. They are robbed and harried night and day by their own slaves,^ and no time passes but they are either making expeditions or fighting battles, or helping their perishing fellow-countrymen. (50) The greatest of their woes, however, is this : they continue in dread lest the Thebans should settle their quarrel with the Phocians,^ come against them again, and involve them in greater disasters than those they have already incurred. How can one fail to suppose that men in such a position would gladly see negotiations for peace presided over by a man of consid- eration, able to bring to a close the wars which threaten them ? (51) The Argives, moreover, you will find to be in some re- spects in a like condition with those we have mentioned, and in other respects worse off than they ; for ever since they have occu- pied their city they have been engaged in war with their neighbors, as the Lacedaemonians have, but with this difference, that the foes of the Lacedaemonians were weaker than themselves, those of the Argives stronger. Everyone will admit that this is the greatest misfortune. They have been so unfortunate in war that almost every year they have stood by to see their territory ravaged and laid waste. (52) But the worst of all is to come; whenever their enemies cease from injuring them, they themselves put to death the most distinguished and wealthy of their citizens, and feel more pleasure in doing these deeds than any other people feel in slaying their enemies.' The reason of their hving in such a state of con- ' The hdots. ' Isocrates refers to the Sacred War, which the Delphic Amphictyony, particularly its most powerful member Thebes, had been waging against Phocis since 356. At the time of the writing of this letter to Philip it seems that the fate of the Phocians had not yet been determined upon, or at least was still unknown to the writer (see introduction supra). Sparta had sympathized with the Phocians and had given them a little aid. ' The writer may have especially in mind the sedition that occurred in Argos shortly after the battle of Leuctra, 371. The democrats, who controlled the government, learning of an oUgarchic conspiracy, put to death thirty of the leading plotters. Then arming themselves with clubs, the populace rose up against the wealthier class, and beat to death twelve hundred, or possibly fifteen hundred. This massacre was called scytalism, cudgeling; Diodorus xv. S7 sq. Grote, History of Greece, x. 199-201. 4i6 HELLENIC INTERSTATE RELATIONS fusion is no other than war ; and if you put an end to it, you will not only release them from these miseries, but you will also cause them to be better advised in their general conduct. (53) The condition of the Thebans even you are acquainted with.' After having won a splendid victory and gained great glory from it, through failure to make good use of their success they are no better situated than are those who were defeated and unsuccessful. For they had hardly overcome their enemies, when, neglecting everything, they proceeded to annoy the Peloponnesian states, ventured to reduce Thessaly to slavery, threatened their neighbors the Megarians, robbed our state of a portion of its terri- tory, laid waste Euboea, and began to send triremes to Byzantium as if they were going to be lords of land and sea. (54) Finally they carried war against the Phocians with the intention of mas- tering their cities in a short time, occupying the whole of the sur- rounding region, and overcoming the Delphic treasures by the contributions they could levy upon their own resources. None of these hopes were realized; instead of having taken the cities of the Phocians, they have lost their own, and they inflicted less injury upon their enemies by invading their country than they suffer themselves in returning to their own; (55) for in Phocis they killed some of the mercenaries, to whom death is more prof- itable than life, but on their way home they lost the most dis- tinguished of their own citizens, and those most ready to die for their country. Their affairs have come to such a pass that, from hoping that all Hellas would be at their feet, they now rest on you their hopes for their own preservation. I think therefore that they, too, will speedily do what you urge and advise. (56) It would still have remained for me to speak about our own state, had she not wisely made peace before the others. Now I think she would even contend in support of your poUcy, especially if she can feel that you are settling these matters with a view to the campaign against the barbarians. . . . (68) Consider now the fitness of devoting yourself mainly to enterprises of the kind, in which by success you will place your ' The idea that Philip knew the condition of the Thebans but not that of the other Hellenes is wholly mistaken ; he probably understood the situation of Hellas far better than Isocrates. PHILIP AND HELLAS 417 reputation in competition with the first and the foremost, and if you fail in your expectation, you will at least win the goodwill of Hellas, the acquisition of which is a far nobler thing than the forcible capture of many Greek cities. For such achievements bring envy and illwill and much evil speaking, but the course which I have advised involves none of these things. Nay if some god should give you the choice of the kind of pursuit and occupation in which you would long to pass your life, you would choose no other, if you took my advice, in preference to this. (69) For not only will you be deemed happy by others, but you will recog- nize your own bliss. What indeed could surpass the happiness of your position, when from the greatest states the men of most renown are come as ambassadors to your throne, and you take counsel with them about the common welfare,^ for which no other man will appear to have entertained such thought; (70) when further the whole of Hellas is on tiptoe in regard to the proposals you may make, and no one is indifferent as to what is decided upon at your court, but some make inquiries concerning the state of affairs, others pray to Heaven that you may not fail to obtain the object of your desires, while othefs are afraid that something may happen to you before you have accomplished your under- taking? (71) If you should succeed, you would have a right to be proud, and could not help feeling highly dehghted all your life in the knowledge that you had been at the head of so great an undertaking. . . . Next Isocrates takes up several matters of less importance. Perhaps the most interesting point omitted from §§ 72-95 is the statement that Philip had many enemies in HeUas, who assert that his real intention is to make himself master of the Greeks (§ 73 sqg.). Isocrates repudiates the idea as foolish, alleg- ing that a descendant of Heracles, the greatest benefactor of HeUas, could not think of injuring a people whom his ancestor had so befriended. He then considers the expeditions of C3n'us the Yoimger and Agesilaus into Asia, and aims to show that Philip has far greater chances of success. (96) Further, you will find as many soldiers as you desire in readiness ; for such is the condition of Hellas that it is easier to get together a larger and better force from wanderers than from i-The fimction Philip is to perform in relation to Greece is that of giving advice through embassies; see 411, n. 4 supra. 4i8 HELLENIC INTERSTATE RELATIONS settled inhabitants. In those times, on the contrary, there were no hired forces, so that, when compelled to raise mercenaries from the towns, they spent more on presents to those who levied them than on the actual pay of the soldiers.^ . . . Isocrates now proceeds to give proof of the weakness of Persia and of the feasibility of her conquest. Afterward he discusses the policy of the Macedonian dynasty, beginning with its supposed founder Caranus, in relation to Hellas. (io6) Your father ^ was on friendly terms with all these states, to which I advise you to give your attention; and the founder (Caranus) of your empire, whose aspirations were higher than those of his own countrymen, and who desired undivided authority, did not adopt the same course of action as others whose projects were equally ambitious. (107) While they endeavored to gain this exalted position by causing strife, disturbance and bloodshed in their cities, he left Hellas alone altogether and devoted himself to establishing his kingdom in Macedon; for he knew that the Hellenes were not accustomed to put up with monarchies while the rest were unable to order their life aright without such a form of government.' (108) The result was that owing to his peculiar views on these subjects, his rule was one of quite a different char- acter than the rest ; for he alone among the Hellenes claimed rule over a people not of kindred race,* and alone was able to escape the dangers that beset monarchy. For we should find that amongst the Hellenes, those who have managed to acquire such an authority have not only been destroyed themselves, but that their race has been utterly blotted out from amongst mankind,^ while he not ' It is implied here, and from other indications it seems to be true, that the number of Greeks available for mercenary purposes had increased since the expedition of Cyrus the Yoimger, 401 ; see Botsford, Helhmc History, ch. xxv. ' King Amyntas ; Botsford, op. cil. ch. xxiv. ' The ascription of these ideas to Caranus, it need hardly be said, is pure fiction. The passage, however, is highly important in showing Isocrates' idea of the future relation of PhiUp to Hellas ; he was by no means to be a monarch. * Here Isocrates expresses the opinion that the Macedonians were not racially akin to the Hellenes ; and this was the prevalent view during his Uf etime. There can be no doubt, however, that they belonged to the Hellenic race, and that they spoke a dialect which the Greeks could understand, naturally with difficulty; see Bdoch, Griech. Gesch. III. i. i-g, with references. ^ The writer has in mind the tyrannic dynasties of Hellas, all of which were short- lived. In this passage he draws no distinction between legitimate monarchy and tyranny. PHILIP AND PERSIA 419 only passed his own life in happiness and prosperity, but bequeathed to his children the same honors as he himself enjoyed. . . . Isocrates then returns to Heracles, the mythical ancestor of Philip, and extols at length the virtues of that hero and especially his goodwill and benefi- cence to Hellas (109-112). He sets before Philip this example for imitation in character and conduct, that the king of Macedon may be filled with the same mildness and love of mankind, the same desire to do good service to the Hellenes,* and to imitate the Olympian gods, who have showered their blessings upon mankind, and in reward have received temples and altars from the beneficiaries of their bounty (113-17). After this digression the writer returns to some of the practical aspects of the campaign against Persia. (119) You might learn from many instances that this is the manner in which you ought to act, but above all from the fortunes of Jason.^ Without having achieved anything like yourself, he gained the highest renown, not from his deeds but from his utter- ances ; for he spoke as if he intended "to cross over from the con- tinent and to make war upon the King. (120) Since Jason, then, increased his power to such an extent merely by words, what opinion must we think all will have of you, if you do this in reahty, and endeavor if possible to destroy the whole kingdom, or if not, to take away from it as much territory as possible, to separate from it Asia from Cihcia to Sinope, as some describe this region, and in addition to build cities through the district, and to send thither as colonists those who are now wanderers from want of their daily bread, and who harass all whom they meet?' (121) For if we do not put a stop to their massing together by providing them with sufficient to live upon, they will imperceptibly become so numerous 1 The teachers of Hellas had long been accustomed to use the heroes of old as pat- terns of virtue ; in fact they had idealized these heroes to that end ; Botsf ord, Hellenic History, ch. xiii. * Jason was tyrant of Pherae, Thessaly, at the time of the battle of Leuctra, 371. For his power and his projects, see Grote, History of Greece, x. 138 sqq., 189 sq., 195-8. ' Isocrates has in mind the conquest of the entire Persian empire, or at least of Asia Minor, and the colonization of the conquered territory with the superfluous Hellenic population. Precisely how far Philip intended to carry out this program we do not know. The fact, however, that it was executed to the full by Alexander may be taken as evidence of the statesmanlike thought of the writer. As indicated by the notes above, it is clear that in many matters the judgment of Isocrates was sound, whereas on other important points, particularly in his idealization of the character of Philip and his future relations with Hellas, the ideas of the writer seem almost childish. 420 HELLENIC INTERSTATE RELATIONS that they will be as great a cause of alarm to the Hellenes as are the barbarians. . . . (154) It remains to summarize what I have said before, that in as few words as possible you may understand the chief point of my advice. I say that you ought to be the benefactor of the Hellenes,, the king of Macedon, and the ruler over as many bar- barians as possible. If you succeed in these matters, all will be grateful to you, the Hellenes by reason of advantages enjoyed, the Macedonians if you govern them like a king and not like a despot, the rest of mankind if they are freed by you from barbarian sway and gain the protection of Hellas. . . . 128. Oath of Alliance and List of the States of the Hellenic Confederacy Formed under Philip of Macedon IN 337 (Hicks and Hill, no. 154; Inscr. grac. U. editio minor (1913), no. 236. Translated by C. J. O.) These two fragments were discovered separately at Athens. The first (Inscr. grac. H. no. 160) was published by Dittenberger, {Syl. I. no. 149) ac- cording to the restoration made by Wilhelm, A., Archaeologisch-epigraphische Mittheilungen aus Oesterreichr-Ungarn, XVIJ (1894). 35-7. The second (Inscr. grcBc. n. no. 184; Ditt. I. no. 159) was formerly thought to belong to another inscription, and was supposed to refer to the Lamian war, 323-322 B.C., on account of its similarity to the catalogue of allies given by Diodorus, xviii. 11. 1-2. After Wilhelm discovered the connection between the two fragments, they were published together by Hicks and Hill, as indicated above. Since that time the inscription has been discussed, and the subject-matter interpreted, in great detail, by Wilhelm, in Sitzb. Wien. Akad. CLXV (1911). pt. 6. It is important as a record of the Greek confederacy organized by Philip at Corinth in the winter of 338-337 (cf. Schafer, Demosth. u. seine Zeit, HI. 51-7) and renewed by Alexander late in 336 (op. cit. III. 97 sq). From the fragmentary list of the allied states we learn that northern Greece was included in the con- federacy, a fact for which there was previously no direct evidence ; c}. Beloch, Griech. Gesch. II. 573, n. 2. The most important revelation of this document, however, is the fact that the numbers of deputies furnished by the allies were proportioned to their respective populations, as was the case with the Boeotian federation; see no. 117 supra and Ferguson, Greek Imperialism, 28 sq. (First fragment, much mutilated.) . . . And I will not bear arms for the purpose of injury against any of those that abide by the oaths, either by land or by sea. I will not seize for the pur- HELLENIC FEDERATION 421 pose of war a city or fort {or place) or harbor belonging to any of those that share in the peace, by any art or device whatever. I will not overthrow the kingship of Philip and his descendants or the governments existing in the respective states at the time when they swore the oaths regarding the peace.^ I will do nothing con- trary to this treaty either in person or by allowing another, in so far as I can prevent; and if any one shall commit any violation of the agreement, I will give aid to those who need it at the time, according as they may demand. I will make war upon him who violates the general peace, according as it may be required of me and the commander-in-chief may order.^ . . . {The second fragment is a part of the list of the allied states with the number of votes which they possessed in the congress.) . . the . . ., s; . . the Thessalians,' 10; . . the . . ., 2 ; . . the Elimiotse (?),< i (?); . . the Thasians,' 2 ; . . the . . ., 2; the Ambraciotae,' . . .; . . (the . . .) of Thrace and . . the Phocians, 3 ; the Locrians, 3 ; . . the (Etaeans ' and the Malians ' and . . the Agraeans " and the Dolopes,' S ; . . the Perrhaebi,'" 2 ; . . Zacynthus and Cephallenia, 3. (^Endoflist.) BIBLIOGRAPHY On the interstate relations of the fourth century, see the histories of Greece by Grote, Curtius, Bury, Holm, and Beloch ; also Schomann, G. F., Griechische Altertiimer, II. bk. iv; Scala, R. von, Die Staatsvertrage des Altertums (Leipzig, 1898); Hitzig, H. F., "Altgriechische Staatsvertrage iiber Rechtshilfe," in ' Cf. Pseudo-Demosthenes, On the Agreement with Alexander (XVII). lo : "For it is provided that, if any persons shall overthrow the governments in the respective states at the time when they swore the oaths regarding the peace, such persons shall be ene- mies of all those who share in the peace." ' Greek hegemon, the title of the Macedonian king as general-in-chief of the allied forces. ' I.e., the inhabitants of central Thessaly. * North of Thessaly. ' Perhaps joined with the inhabitants of the neighboring island of Samothrace. • Of Ambracia in southern Epirus. ' On the southern border of Thessaly. ' Of northern iEtolia. ' In southwestern Thessaly. " In northern Thessaly. 42 2 HELLENIC INTERSTATE RELATIONS Festgabe fiir Regelsberger (Zurich, 1907), 1-70 ; Burle, E., Essai historique sur le d&iieloppement de la notion de droit naturel dans I'antiquitS grecque (Trevoux, 1908) ; HoltzendorfE, F. von, and Rivier, A., Introdtiction au droit des gens (1891), I. ch. ii; Bortolucci, J., "De iure gentium criminali apud Graecos," in Rivista di storia antica (Padua), 1905, pp. 421-35 ; Bonucci, A., La legge comune nd pensiero greco (Perugia, 1903) ; Barth, B., De Gracorwm asylis (Strassburg, 1887) ; a Columbia University doctorate dissertation on ancient sanctuary by C. Huth is nearing completion ; PhiUipson, C, International Law and Customs of Ancient Greece and Rome, 2 vols. (MacmUlan, 1911) ; Kaerst, J., "Die Ent- wickelung der Vertragstheorie im Altertum," in Zeitschr. fiir Politik, II (1909). 305-38 ; Scholl, R., Die Anfdnge einer politischen Liiteratur hei den Griechen, Festrede Munch. Akad. (1890) ; Clerc, M., Les mittques athSniens: Etude sur la condition iSgale, la situation morale et le rdle social et economique des Strangers domiciliSs d Athhnes (Paris, 1893) ; "De la condition des etrangers domicili6s dans les differentes cites grecques," in Revue des universitSs du midi, IV (1898). 1-32, 153-80, 249-74; Freeman, E. A., History of Federal Government in Greece and Italy, I (London, 1893) ; Sonne, E., Z>e arbitris externis, quos Graci adhi- buerunt ad lites et intestinas et peregrinas componendas qucestiones epigraphicce (Gottingen, 1888) ; Berard, V., De arbitrio inter liberas Gracorum civitates (Paris, 1894); Westermann, W. L., "Interstate Arbitration in Antiquity," in Class. Journ. II (1906-07). 197 sqq. ; Raeder, A., L'arbitrage international chez les Hellenes (Putnam, 1912) ; Tod, M. N., International Arbitration amongst the Greeks (Oxford: Clarendon Press, 1913); Kahrstedt, U., Forschungen zur Geschichte des ausgehenden fUnften und des vierten Jahrhunderts (Weidmann, 1910) ; Kessler, Isokrates und die panhellenische Idee (Paderborn, 191 1) ; Meyer, E., "Isokrates' zweiter Brief an Philipp und Demosthenes' zweite Philippika," in Sitz. Berl. Akad. 1909. pt. i. 758-79; Kaerst, J., "Der korinthische Bund," in Rhein. Mus. LII (1897). Si9~S6; Kohler, U., "Die Eroberung Asiens durch Alexander den Grossen und der Korinthische Bund," in Sitz. Berl. Akad. 1898. pp. 120-34. CHAPTER XIII THE STATE In the Period 404-337 B.C. In this chapter are gathered materials for illustrating the relation of the state to the citizen, state regulation of social and economic conditions, and the character and relative value of various forms of democracy and oligarchy. 129. A Public-spirited Citizen (Isaeus vii. Concerning the Inheritance of Apollodorus, 39-42. Translated by G. W. B.) The speaker claims that ApoUodorus in his right mind and in due form adopted him as heir. His claim is contested by several adversaries, among whom is Pronapes. The passage below is typical of the appeal made to the jury — the demand for a favorable verdict'on the ground of services rendered in the past by the litigant and his kinsmen, and the promise of further services in case of a favorable decision. In general the jury seems to have been swayed more by a consideration of the character and usefulness of the parties to the trial than by the letter of the law. ApoUodorus himself did not, like Pronapes, have his property- assessed at a small value ; but as a member of the knightly class he took upon himseK the duty of holding office.^ He did not seek violent possession of other men's property nor fancied it no busi- ness of his to benefit you," but rendering his whole estate visible to you, he patriotically carried out all your orders and tried to live in such wise that no harm could come from him or his own, thinking it right to spend upon himself but a moderate amount and to place the rest at the disposal of the state that it might have enough to meet expenses. With these resources what liturgy did ' The knightly, or hippie, class, was the next to the wealthiest of the four property classes continuing from before the time of Solon (Botsford, Hellenic History, ch. vii. § 2 sq.). To what offices the knights alone were eligible is unknown. * "You," the jurors, are identified with the whole body of citizens and with the state. 423 424 THE STATE he not perform, or what war-tax did he not help contribute among the foremost of the citizens? ^ Or what duty did he evade? he who won a victory in a boys' chorus, in which a memorial of his pubUc spirit is the tripod standing there. Now what ought to be the conduct of a sober citizen? Was it not his duty, where others were wont violently to seize property not their own, to do nothing of the kind but to attempt to secure his own? and where the city needs money, to contribute among the foremost and not to conceal his possessions? Such a man was he, in return for which conduct it would be just for you to grant him this favor — leaving his own judgment to be master of his estate.^ As to me, too, so far as my early age permitted, you will find me neither base nor useless. I have taken part in military campaigns for the state ; I attend to whatever is ordered, for that is the task of men of my age. On the ground of these services it would be reasonable of you to exercise a foresight in our interest, particularly as these adversaries have seized an estate worth five talents and capable of performing the trierarchy, and have sold it and rendered it masterless, whereas we have already performed liturgies, and will continue to perform them, if you will approve the intention of ApoUodorus by granting us this inheritance. 130. State Aid to the Disabled (Lysias xxiv. Concerning the Cripple, 6-8, 15-17, 22 sq. Translated by G. W. B.) A certain cripple has been receiving an allowance of one obol (about three cents) daily from the state. Another citizen brings before the Coxuicil the charge that he does not deserve it, (i) because he is really of sound body, (2) because he has a trade, (3) because he associates with rich men, and must therefore be well-to-do, (4) because he is a man of bad character, violent, insolent, and of loose morals, (5) because his shop is the resort of evil men. The excerpts given below have a varied interest. My father left me nothing, and I ceased to support my mother only three years ago when she died, and my children are not yet old enough to support me. I have a trade which brings me scant returns, which I now carry on with great difficulty, and am unable ' On the liturgies, see Botsford, Hellenic History, ch. xii. ' That is, approving of his adoption of a son. THE CRIPPLE'S PENSION 425 to find any one to take it off my hands. I have no income besides this (allowance), and if you take it from me, I shall run the risk of falling into the direst straits. ... It would be unreasonable. Council, if when my misfortune was single I should receive this dole but should be deprived of it when old age and diseases and their attendant evils have been added to my lot. . . . (My adversary) asserts that I am insolent and violent and possessed of an excessively unbridled temper, as though he could only speak the truth if he used terrible words, and could not do so if he used only mild words and abstained from exaggeration. But I fancy. Council, that you know well how to distinguish be- tween men whose part it is to be insolent and men to whom such a thing is unbecoming. It is not reasonable that the poor and the desperately needy should be insolent; that rather falls to the lot of those who possess far more than a competence ; nor the disabled in body but those rather who trust to their physical strength ; nor those who have far advanced in age, but the young and the pos- sessors of youthful dispositions. For the wealthy with their money purchase exemption from the danger of punishment,^ whereas the poor are forced to sobriety by their present need. . . . Do not because of this man (my accuser) deprive me of the only part or lot in my country that fortune has granted me. . . . For since. Council, the deity (Daimon) has debarred us from the highest offices, the state has voted us this money, considering that the chances of good and ill are common to all.'' How then should I not be the most wretched of all men, if through my misfortune I should be deprived of the noblest and greatest things, and then through my accuser should lose what the state has bestowed in its forethought for men who are situated as I am ? ' Here we get the point of view of the poor man — that wealth is a shield against prosecution. Had more needy Greeks thus spoken to us, we should probably have had material to counterbalance the charge that the wealthy were often condemned that their property might fall to the state and be paid out to the jurors as fees ; cf. p. 466 and n. 2. ^ This is a peculiar theory, that as the state cannot bestow oflBce upon the poor and the crippled, it is under obligation to grant them a money allowance as a substitute. 426 THE STATE 131. State Regulation of the Grain Trade (Lysias xxii. Against the Grain-Dealers. Translated by E. G. S.) One of the first objects of an Athenian statesman was to provide for an adequate supply of imported grain, seeing that the country produced scarcely half the amount needed for consumption. Two-thirds of every cargo brought to Peiraeus had to be sold in the country; the rest might be carried farther. State regulations were established to prevent cornering the market and un- reasonable profits of dealers. Among the regulations was one which forbade a profit of more than an obol to the basket, phormos, holding about a medimnus, i.e., a bushel and a half. It was ordered further that no one should buy more than fifty phormi at a time. To enforce these regulations a board of Grain Inspectors (S'Toi^iJAaKes, Sitophylaces) was instituted. Death was the pen- alty for the violation of these laws. The case represented by the subjoined oration is made clear by the docu- ment itself; From this source, and from many others, we infer that the Hellenic state took far greater care of the citizens in general than does any moderri" state, in which any such care would be resented as an interference with business. (i) Many have approached me, gentlemen of the jury, won- dering that I attacked the grain dealers in the Council and saying that if you were ever so convinced of their acting wrongfully, you would none the less consider those who compose addresses about them, to be blackmailers. Why then I have been constrained to accuse them, I wish to explain first. (2) When the prytaneis reported to the Council about them, the members were so enraged at them, that some said they ought to haiid them over to the Eleven without trial and punish them with death. But thinking it awful that the Council should fall into the habit of doing such things, I arose and said that it seemed best to me to try the grain dealers according to the law, considering that if they have done what is worthy of death, you will none the less arrive at a just verdict ; but if they are no wrong doers, they ought not to perish without trial ... (3) And when the Council was convinced thereof they undertook to calumniate me, sajdng that I am making these discourses in order to save the grain dealers.^ As pertains to the Council then, I made my actual defence when ' Charges against these grain dealers were first brought into the Council, many members of which were for putting the accused to death without trial. The present speaker, however, persuaded that body to allow the case to come before an ordinary court. That resolution prevailed ; and the present oration was delivered before a jury in accusation. PURCHASES RESTRICTED 427 they had the trial; for while the others were keeping quiet, I arose and accused them and made it clear to all, that I did not speak in behalf of them but supported the established laws. (4) I began therefore because I feared the charges ; and I consider it disgraceful to cease before you give about it whatever verdict, you desire. (s) First, stand up and tell me, are you a metic?' "Yes." And are you a metic with the expectation of obeying the laws of the commonwealth, or of doing what you like? "Of obeying." Do you deserve anything else but death, if you have done anything contrary to the laws — any act on which the death-penalty is set? "I do not." Answer me then, whether you admit having bought up more grain than fifty phormi, which the law allows? "I bought it up under orders of the ofl&cials." (6) If then he demonstrates, gentlemen of the jury, that a statute exists, which orders the grain dealers to buy up the grain in case the officials order them to do so, acquit him ; but if not, it is just that you should find him guilty. For we presented to you the statute which prohibits anyone in the commonwealth from buying up more grain than fifty phornfi.^ (7) This charge then, gentlemen of the jury, ought to be suffi- cient, since this man admits that he bought it up, but the law appears as prohibiting that, and you have sworn to give your ver- dict according to the laws. It is necessary, however, to speak more at length about them. (8) When these men shifted the blame upon the grain inspectors, we called upon the latter and interrogated them. Two of them said they knew nothing of the matter, but Anytus explained that last winter when grain was high, and when these men bid up the price against one another, and fought among themselves, he had advised them to cease wrangling, thinking it ad- vantageous to you who bought from them, that they should make their purchases at as fair a figure as possible : , for it was necessary for them to sell at a rise of no more than one obol. (9) That he did not order them to buy up and store away, but not to outbid one another in the bu3dng, I shall produce Anytus himself as witness, and that this man made these statements in the term of the former 1 Metic, alien resident. Much of the trade was in the hands of this dass. 2 Phormi, see introduction. 428 THE STATE Council, but the accused appear as having formed a corner in the time of the present Council.^ (lo) That they bought up the grain without an order of the officials, you have heard ; and I hold that if their statements about these things are ever so true, they will not produce a defence of themselves, but will accuse these officials; for where statutes are specifically written, why should not the penalty be paid both by those who do not obey (the statutes) and those who bid them act contrary to the same? s(ii) But, gentlemen of the jury, I think they will not resort "~ta^ this plea; yet perhaps they will say, as they did in the Counc^ that they bought up the grain from devotion to the community, in order to sell it to you at as fair a price as possible. I will, however, bring before you a very great and very lucid proof that they lie. (12) For they ought, if indeed it was for your sake that they did these things, to appear selling at the same price for many days, until the grain which they had bought up, failed them, whereas in fact sometimes in the course of the same day they sold it one drachma higher, just as though they had bought it up at the rate of a single medimvus? And for these facts I shall offer you wit- nesses. . . . (13) It seems outrageous to me, if whenever a tax is to be paid, of which all are bound to have knowledge, they are unwilling but allege poverty as a pretext, yet in a matter in which death is set as a penalty and it is profitable for them to escape notice, they say they committed these illegal acts from devotion to you. Still you all know that it behooves these men least of aU to make such statements. For their advantage is the opposite to that of others : their gains are largest when upon the arrival of some bad news they sell their grain to the community at a high figure. (14) So gladly therefore do they see your troubles that some of them they ascertain earlier than others, and some they invent themselves, either that the ships in the Black Sea have perished, or while sailing out were captured by the Lacedaemonians, or that the harbors are closed, or that the truce is about to be cancelled, and they have •A Council held office one year; the trouble regarding these grain merchants began therefore in the preceding year. ' Medimnus, see introduction. A CORNER IN GRAIN 429 advanced to that point of enmity toward you, that they plot against you in precisely the same emergencies in which the public enemy do. (15) For when you happen to be most in want of grain, they grab it and are unwilling to sell, and you may be well satisfied to buy from them at any price whatever and take your leave of them, so that sometimes when there is peace we are reduced to a state of siege by them, v (16) For this reason the community long ago came to such a determination about their cunning and evil-mindedness that over all the other wares you appointed the marketmasters as guardians, but for this craft alone, separately, you appoint grain inspectors by lot ; and of ttimes you imposed upon them, citizens though they were, the most severe penalties, because they were unable to master the scoundrellism of these dealers. What then should the male- factors themselves suffer at your hands, when you even put to death those who are not able to maintain a watch over them ? (17) You ought to ponder on the fact that it is impossible for you to acquit them. For if you shall find them guiltless when they themselves admit that they made a combination against the importers, you will seem to plot against the skippers who come here. If' they make some other defence, no one could find fault with those who acquitted them ; for it lies with you to give credence to whichsoever of the two sides you choose ; but in the actual situa- tion how would you not seem to act outrageously if you are to let go scotfree the men who confess that they have been acting illegally ? (18) Remember, gentlemen of the jury, that you have condemned to death many men already who were subject to this charge and furnished witnesses, deeming more reliable the statements of the accusers. Why would it not be strange, if while sitting in judg- ment on the same misdemeanors you are eager to impose penalty on those who make denial? (19) In fact, gentlemen of the jury, I think it is clear to all that the contests about such things happen to be of the widest concern in common to every one in the community, so that they are going to discover what opinion you entertain about them, thinking, if you condemn them to death, the others will be more seemly ; but if you let them go scotfree, you will have voted them ample immunity to do what they like. (20) But it is necessary, gentlemen of the jury, to chastise them 430 THE STATE not only for the sake of the past, but also as an example for the future ; for as things now are, they will be hardly endurable. And consider that in consequence of this vocation very many already have stood trial for their life; and so great are the emoluments which they derive from it that they prefer to risk their life every day rather than cease to draw from you unjust profits. (21) And indeed not even if they entreat you and supplicate, would you justly pity them, but much rather the citizens who perished on account of their wickedness, and the importers against whom they made a combination. The importers you will gratify and cheer, if you impose a penalty on the dealers. Otherwise what opinion do you think they will have, when they learn that you acquitted the retailers who admitted plotting against the skippers ? (22) I do not know what I should say further; for concerning other evildoers one must learn from the prosecutors at the time of trial, but the wickedness of these men you all know. If then you shall condemn them, you will act justly and you wiU buy grain cheaper; otherwise, dearer. 132. A Plan for Increasing the Revenues of Athens (Xenophon, Ways and Means. Dakyns, revised by E. G. S.) In ancient times no doubt was expressed as to the authenticity of this work. Among modem scholars, however, there are some who wish to remove it from the list of Xenophon's genuine writings on the supposition, (i) that according to internal evidence it was composed as late as 346, and therefore after Xeno- phon's death ; (2) that the views expressed in the treatise were repugnant to the author's weU-known convictions. Others argue on the contrary that inter- nal evidence points to 3 5 5 as the date of composition. In favor of its authentic- ity we may say further that the style seems to be that of Xenophon, and that it was perfectly possible for Xenophon in old age to modify his political and social views. If then we accept the pamphlet as a genuine work of Xenophon, it is in place to notice the powerful influence of fourth-century socialism upon the intellectual class, to extort such concessions from a pronounced conservative. The entire pamphlet is here presented, partly because of the light which it throws upon the economic resources of Athens at that time and partly because of its unique ideas, which though utterly impracticable, cannot help attracting at least the curiosity of all who are interested in social history. I. (i) For myself I hold to the opinion that the qualities of the men in charge of the government, whatever they be, are re- produced in the character of the constitutions themselves. NATURAL RESOURCES 431 It has been maintained of certain leading statesmen in Athens that they know, as well as the rest of mankind, what is just, but that, owing to the pressure of poverty on the masses, a certain measure of injustice in their dealing with the allied states could not be avoided. I set myself therefore to discover whether by any manner of means it were possible for the citizens of Athens to be supported solely from the soil of Attica itseK, which would obviously be the most equitable solution. For if so, herein lay, as I believed, the antidote at once to their own poverty and to the feeling of suspicion with which they are regarded by the rest of Hellas. (2) I had no sooner begun my investigation than one fact presented itself clearly to my mind, which is that the country itself is made by nature to provide the amplest resources. And with a view to estabUshing the truth of this initial proposition I will describe the physical features of Attica. (3) In the first place, the extraordinary mildness of the cKmate is proved by the actual products of the soil. Numerous plants which in many parts of the world appear as stunted leafless growths are here fruit-bearing. As with the soil, so too with the sea in- denting our coasts, the varied productivity of which is exceptionally great. Again with regard to those boons which the gods bestow on man in the seasons, one and all they commence very early and end very late in this land.^ (4) Nor is the supremacy of Attica shown only in those products which year after year flourish and grow old, but the land contains treasures of a more perennial kind. Within its folds lies imbedded by nature an unstinted store of marble, out of which are chiselled temples and altars of rarest beauty and the most comely images of worship for the gods. This marble, moreover, is an object of desire to many foreigners, Hellenes and barbarians alike. (5) Then there is land which, although it yields no fruit to the sower, needs only to be mined in order to feed many times more mouths than it could as corn-land. Doubtless we owe it to a divine dispensation that our land is veined with silver ; if we consider how many neighboring states lie round us by 1 These remarks on the productivity of the soil of Attica are significant in view of the fairly grounded opinion that it was inferior to the average soil of Hellas. Not- withstanding the ravages of the Peloponnesian war and the later growth of industry, there can be no doubt that intelligent farming was still profitable ; c/. 499 and n. i. 432 THE STATE land and sea and yet into none of them does a single thinnest vein of silver penetrate. (6) Further it would be scarcely irrational to maintain that the city of Athens lies at the navel, not of Hellas merely, but of the habitable world. So true is it that the farther we remove from Athens the greater tl;ie extreme of heat or cold to be encountered ; or to use another illustration, the traveller who desires to traverse the confines of Hellas from end to end will find that, whether he voyages by sea or by land, he is describing a circle, the centre of which is Athens. (7) Once more, this land though not literally sea- girt has all the advantages of an island, being accessible to every wind that blows, and can invite to its bosom or waft from its shore all products, since it is peninsular ; whilst by land it is the emporium of many markets, as being a portion of the continent. (8) Lastly, whilst the majority of states have barbarian neigh- bors, the source of many troubles, Athens has as her next-door neighbors civilized states which are themselves far remote from the barbarians. n. (i) All these advantages, to repeat what I have said, may, I believe, be traced primarily to the soil and position of Attica itself. But these native blessings may be added to : in the first place, by a careful handling of our resident alien population. For my part, I can hardly conceive of a more splendid source of revenue than lies open in this direction. Here you have a self-supporting class of residents conferring large benefits upon the state, and instead of receiving payment themselves, contributing on the con- trary to the gain of the exchequer by the sojourners' tax. (2) Nor under the term of careful handling do I demand more than the removal of obligations which, while they confer no benefit on the state, have an air of inflicting various disabilities on the resident aliens. I would further relieve them from the obligation of ser- ving as hoplites side by side with the citizens proper ; since beside the personal risk, which is great, the trouble of quitting trades and homesteads is no trifle. (3) Incidentally the state itself would be benefited by this exemption, if the citizens were more in the habit of campaigning with one another,^ rather than shoulder to shoulder > The dislike of the Athenians for military service is one of the most significant factors of their political history during the fourth century, ' ALIEN RESIDENTS 433 with Lydians, Phrygians, Syrians, and barbarians from all quarters of the world, who form the staple of our resident alien class. (4) Be- sides the advantage of so weeding the ranks, it would add a positive lustre to our city, were it admitted that the men of Athens, her sons, have reliance on themselves alone for their battles rather than on foreigners. (5) I think, too, if we were to give to the alien res- idents a share in the other things which it is honorable to bestow a share in, and in the right of cavalry service, we should render them more loyal and at the same time render the city stronger and greater. (6) In the next place, seeing that there are at present numer- ous building sites within the city walls as yet devoid of houses,^ supposing the state were to make free grants of such land to for- eigners for building purposes in cases where there could be no doubt as to the respectability of the applicant, if I am not mistaken, the result of such a measure will be that a larger number of persons, and of a better class, will be attracted to Athens as a place of residence. (7) Lastly, if we could bring ourselves to appoint, as a new government ofl&ce, a board of guardians of foreign residents like our Guardians of Orphans, with, special privileges assigned to those guardians who should show on their books the greatest num- ber of resident aliens, — such a measure would tend to improve the goodwill of the class in question, and in all probability all people without a city of their own would aspire to the status of foreign residents in Athens, and so further increase the revenues of the city. III. (i) At this point I propose to oflfer some remarks in proof of the attraction and advantages of Athens as a center of commer- cial enterprise. In the first j)lace, it will hardly be denied that we possess the finest and safest harborage for shipping, where vessels of all sorts can come to moorings and be laid up in absolute security as far as stress of weather is concerned. (2) But farther than that, in most states the trader is under the necessity of lading his vessel with some merchandise or other in exchange for his cargo, since the current coin has no circulation beyond the frontier. But at ' The total citizen population of Attica was less in the fourth than in the fifth century, and the tendency of business men and of artisans was to gather in Peiraeus, leaving Athens with a dwindhng population. Aliens could not acquire land m Attica without especial permission. 434 THE STATE Athens he has a choice ; he can either in return for his wares export a variety of goods, such as human beings seek after, or if he does not desire to take goods in exchange for goods, he has simply to export silver, and he cannot have a more excellent freight to export, since wheresoever he Ukes to sell it, he everywhere realizes more than his capital investment. (3) Or again, supposing prizes were offered to the market officials for equitable and speedy settle- ments of points in dispute, to enable any one so wishing to proceed on his voyage without hindrance, the result would be that far more merchants would trade with us and with greater satisfaction. (4) It would indeed be a good and noble institution to pay special marks of honor, such as the privilege of the front seat, to merchants and shipowners, and on occasion to invite to hospitable entertainment those who, through something notable in the quahty of ship or merchandise, may claim to have done the state a service. The recipients of these honors would be devoted to us as friends, not only under the incentive of gain, but of distinction also, (s) Now the greater the number of people attracted to Athens either as visitors or as residents, clearly the greater the develop- ment of imports and exports. More goods will be sent out of the country, there wiU be more bu3dng and selling, with a consequent influx of money in the shape of rents to individuals and dues and customs to the state exchequer. (6) To secure this augmentation of the revenues, mark you, not the outlay of one single penny ; nothing is needed beyond one or two philanthropic measures and certain details of supervision. With regard to the other sources of revenue which I contem- plate, I admit, it is different. For them I recognize the necessity of a capital to begin with. (7) I am not, however, without good hope that the citizens of this state will contribute heartily to such an object, when I reflect on the large sums subscribed by the state on various late occasions, as, for instance, when reinforcements were sent to the Arcadians under the command of Lysistratus,^ and again at the date of the generalship of Hegesileos." (8) I am well aware that ships of war are frequently despatched and that too although it is uncertain whether the venture will be for the ' This expedition was made in 366 ; Xen. Bell. vii. 4. 3. ' In 362 ; Xen. Bell. vii. 5. 15. A FINANCIAL SCHEME 435 better or for the worse, and the only certainty is that the contributor will not recover the sum subscribed nor have any further share in the object for which he gave his contribution. (9) For a sound investment I know of nothing comparable with the initial outlay to form this fund. Any one whose contribution amounts to ten niinae may look forward to a return as high as he would get on bottomry, of nearly one-fifth, as the recipient of three obols a day.^ The contributor of five minse will on the same prin- ciple get more than a third, (10) while the majority of Athenians will get more than cent per cent on their contribution. That is to say, a subscription of one mina will put the subscriber in possession of nearly double that sum, and that, moreover, without setting foot outside Athens, which, as far as human affairs go, is as sound and durable a security as possible. (11) Moreover I am of opinion that if the names of contributors were to be inscribed as bene- factors for all time, many foreigners would be induced to contrib- ute, and possibly not a few states, in their desire to obtain the right of inscription ; indeed I anticipate that some kings, princes and satraps would display a keen desire to share in such a favor. (12) To come to the point : were such a capital once furnished, it would be a magnificent plan to build lodging-houses for the benefit of shipmasters in the neighborhood of the harbors, in addition to those which exist; and again on the same principle, if suitable places of meeting for merchants — for the purposes of buying and selhng — and thirdly, (13) if public lodging-houses and stores for vending goods, were fitted up for retail dealers in Peiraeus and the city, they would at once be an ornament to the state and a fertile source of revenue. (14) Also it seems to me it would be a good thing to try to see if, on the principle on which at present the state possesses public warships, it would not be possible to secure public merchant vessels to be let out on the security of guarantors just like any other pubUc property. If the plan were found feasi- ble, this public merchant navy would be a large source of extra revenue. • The idea is that every Athenian will receive three obols daily, whatever he sub- scribes. One who contributes ten minas, or 1000 drachmas, will receive for the yeaL_ 3 X 360 obols, or 1080 obols, which equals i8o drachmas. That is, his return will be 18 per cent. The contributor of half that sum will receive double the rate of interest, and so on. 436 THE STATE IV. (i) I come to a new topic. I am persuaded that the estab- lishment of the silver mines on a proper footing would be followed by a large increase of wealth apart from other sources of revenue. I should like, therefore, for the benefit of those who may be ignorant, to point out what the capacity of these mines really is. You will then be in a position to decide how to turn them to better account. (2) It is clear, I presume, to every one that these mines have for a very long time been in active operation ; at any rate no one will venture to fix the date at which they first began to be worked. Now in spite of the fact that the silver ore has been dug and carried out for so long a time, I would ask you to note that the mounds of rubbish so shovelled out are but a fractional portion of the series of hillocks containing veins of silver, and as yet unquarried. (3) Nor is the silver-bearing region gradually becoming circumscribed. On the contrary, it is evidently extending in wider area from year to year. That is to say, during the period in which the greatest num- ber of workers have been employed within the mines, no hand was ever stopped for want of work to do. Rather, at any given moment, the work to be done was more than enough for the hands employed. (4) Thus it is today with the owners of slaves working in the mines ; no one dreams of reducing the number of his hands. On the con- trary, the object is perpetually to acquire as many additional hands as the owner possibly can. The fact is that with few hands to dig and search, the find of treasure will be small, but with an increase of labor the discovery of the ore itself is more than pro- portionally increased. So much so that of all operations with which I am acquainted, this is the only one in which no sort of jealousy is felt at a further development of the industry. (5) I may go a step farther : every proprietor of a farm will be able to tell you exactly how many yoke of oxen are sufficient for the estate, and how many farm hands. To send into the field more than the exact number requisite every farmer would consider a dead loss. But in silver mining [operations] the universal complaint is the short supply of hands. Indeed there is no analogy between this and other industries. (6) With an increase in the number of bronze-workers articles of bronze may become so cheap that the bronze-workers are ruined. And so again with ironfounders. Or again, in a plethoric condition of the corn and wine market these UNLIMITED NEED OF SILVER 437 fruits of the soil will be so depreciated in value that the particular husbandries cease to be remunerative, and many a farmer will give up his tillage of the soil and betake himseK to the business of a merchant, or of a shopkeeper, to banking or money-lending.^ But the converse is the case in the working of silver ; there the larger the quantity of ore discovered and the greater the amount of silver extracted, the greater the number of persons ready to engage in the operation. (7) One more illustration : take the case of movable property. No one when he has got sufficient furniture far his house dreams of making further purchases on this head, but . of silver no one ever yet possessed so much that he was forced to cry "enough." On the contrary, if ever anybody does become possessed of an immoderate amount he finds as much pleasure in digging a hole in the ground and hoarding it as in the actual employ- ment of it. (8) And from a wider point of view ; when a state is prosperous there is nothing which people so much desire as silver. The men want money to expend on beautiful armor and fine horses, and houses, and sumptuous outfittings of all sorts. The women betake themselves to expensive apparel and ornaments of gold. (9) Or when states are sick, either through barrenness of corn and other fruits or through war, the demand for current coin is even more imperative (whilst the ground lies unproductive), to pay for necessaries or military aid. (10) Furthermore if it be asserted that gold is after all just as useful as silver, without gainsaying the proposition I may note this fact about gold, that, with a sudden influx of this metal, it is the gold itseK which is depreciated whilst causing at the same time a rise in the value of silver. (11) The facts given above are, I think, conclusive. They en- courage us not only to introduce as much human labor as possible into the mines, but to extend the scale of operation within, by increase of plant, etc., in full assurance that there is no danger either of the ore itself being exhausted or of silver becoming depre- ciated.^ In advancing these views I am merely following a pre- • This was precisely the tendency of the farming population of Attica at the time when this pamphlet was being written ; the cheapness of imported grain and the at- tractions of an expanding city economy were drawing many agriculturists from their fields. 2 On both these points the writer is wholly wrong : in fact the amount of silver remaining in the mines was then very Umited, and further the production of unlimited 438 THE STATE cedent set me by the state herself. (12) So it seems to me, since the state permits any foreigner who desires it to undertake mining operations on a footing of equality with her own citizens. (13) But to make my meaning clearer on the question of main- tenance, I will at this point explain in detail how the silver mines may be furnished and extended so as to render them much more useful to the state. Only I would premise that I claim no sort of admiration for anything which I am about to say, as though I had hit upon some recondite discovery. Since half of what I have to say is at the present moment patent to the eyes of all of us, and as to what belongs to past history, if we are to believe the testimony of our fathers, things were then much of a piece with what is going on now. (14) No, what is really marvellous is that the state, with the fact of so many private persons growing wealthy at her expense and under her very eyes, should have failed to imitate them. It is an old story, trite enough to those of us who have cared to attend to it, how once on a time Nicias,^ the son of Niceratus, owned a thousand men in the silver mines, whom he let out to Sosias, a Thracian, on the following terms. Sosias was to pay him a net obol a day, without charge or deduction, for every slave of the thousand, and be responsible for keeping up the number perpetually at that figure. (15) So again Hipponicus had six hundred slaves let out on the same principle, which brought him in a net mina a day without charge or deduction. Then there, was Philemonides, with three hundred, bringing him in half a mina, and others doubt- less there were, making profits in proportion to their respective resources and capital. (16) But there is no need to revert to ancient history. At the present moment there are hundreds of human beings in the mines let out on the same principle. (17) Supposing therefore that my proposal were carried into effect, the only novelty in it is that, just as the individual in acquiring the ownership of a gang of slaves finds himself at once provided with a permanent source of income, so the state, in like fashion, should possess herself of a body of public slaves, to the number, say, of three for every quantities would have greatly depreciated the value. The depreciation of gold, which he mentions just above, ought to have taught him better. ' Nicias, the famous Athenian general in the Peloponnesian war ; Botsf ord, BeUmic History, chs. xviii, xix. A SPECULATION IN SLAVES 439 Athenian citizen. (18) As to the feasibility of our proposals, I challenge any one whom it may concern to test the scheme point by point, and to give his verdict. With regard to the price then of the men themselves, it is obvious that the public treasury is in a better position to provide funds than any private individual. What can be easier than for the Council to invite by public proclamation all whom it may con- cern to bring their slaves, and to buy up those produced? (19) As- suming the purchase to be effected, is it credible that people will hesitate to hire from the state rather than from the private owner, and actually on the same terms? People have at all events no hesitation at present in hiring consecrated grounds, sacred victims, houses, etc., or in purchasing the right of farming taxes from the state. (20) To ensure the preservation of the purchased property, the treasury can take the same securities precisely from the lessee as it does from those who purchase the right of farming its taxes. In fact fraudulent dealing is easier on the part of the man who has purchased such a right than of a man who hires slaves; (21) for it is not easy to see how the misappropriation of public money is to be detected, when it differs in^no way from private money. It will however take a clever thief to make off with these slaves, marked as they will be with the public stamp, and in face of a heavy penalty attached at once to the sale and exportation of them. Up to this point then it would appear feasible enough for the state to acquire property in men and to keep a safe watch over them. (22) But with reference to an opposite objection which may present itself to the mind of some one; what guarantee is there that, along with the increase in the supply of laborers, there will be a corresponding demand for their services on the part of con- tractors ? It may be reassuring to note, first of all, that many of those who have already embarked on mining operations will be anxious to increase their staff of laborers by hiring some of these public slaves, for they have a large capital at stake; and again, many of the actual laborers now engaged are growing old; and secondly, there are many others, Athenians and foreigners alike, who, though unwilling and indeed incapable of working physically in the mines, will be glad enough to earn a livelihood by their wits as superintendents. 440 THE STATE (23) Let it be granted, however, that at first a nucleus of twelve hundred slaves is formed. It is hardly too sanguine a supposition that out of the profits alone, within five or six years this number may be increased to at least six thousand. Again, out of that number of six thousand — supposing each slave to bring in an obol a day clear of all expenses — we get a revenue of sixty talents a year. (24) Supposing further twenty talents out of this sum laid out on the purchase of more slaves, there will be forty talents left for the state to apply to any other purpose it may find advisable. By the time the round number of ten thousand is reached, the yearly income will amount to a hundred talents. (25) As a matter of fact, the state will receive much more than these figures repre- sent, as any one here will bear me witness who can remember what the dues derived from slaves realized before the troubles at Deceleia.^ Testimony to the same effect is borne by the fact, that in spite of the countless number of human beings employed in the silver mines within the whole period, the mines present exactly the same appearance today as they did within the recollection of our fore- fathers. (26) Once more, everything that is taking place today tends to prove that, whatever the number of slaves employed, you will never have more than the works can easily absorb. The miners find no limit of depth in sinking shafts or laterally in piercing gal- leries. (27) To open cuttings in new directions today is just as possible as it was in former times. In fact no one can take on himself to say whether there is more silver ore in the regions already cut into, or in those where the pick has not yet struck. (28) Well then, it may be asked, why is it that there is not the same rush to make new cuttings now as in former times? The answer is, be- cause the people concerned with the mines are poorer nowadays. The attempt to restart operations, renew plant, and the like, is of recent date, and any one who ventures to open up a new area runs a considerable risk. (29) Supposing he hits upon a productive field, he becomes a rich man, but supposing he draws a blank, he loses the whole of his outlay ; and that is a danger which people of the present time are shy of facing. (30) It is a difficulty, but it is one on which, I believe, I can offer some practical advice. I have a plan to suggest which will '■ In the last years of the Peloponnesian war; Botsford, Hellenic History, ch. xix. THE MINES INEXHAUSTIBLE 441 reduce to a minimum the risk of opening up new cuttings. The citizens of Athens are divided, as we all know, into ten tribes.^ Let the state then assign to each of these ten tribes an equal num- ber of slaves, and let the tribes agree to associate their fortunes and proceed to open new cuttings. What will happen? Any single tribe hitting upon a productive lode will be the means of discover- ing what is advantageous to all. (31) Or supposing two or three, or possibly the half of them, hit upon a lode, clearly these several operations will proportionally be more remunerative still. That the whole ten will fail is not at all in accordance with what we should expect from the history of the past. (32) It is possible of course for private persons to combine in the same way, and share their fortunes and minimize their risks. Nor need you apprehend, sirs, that a state mining company, established on this principle, will prove a thorn in the side of the private owner, or the private owner prove injurious to the state. But rather like allies who render each other stronger the more they combine, so in these silver mines, the greater number of companies at work the larger the riches they will discover and carry off. (33) This then is a statement, as far as I can make it clear, of the method by which, with the proper state organization, every Athenian may be supplied with ample maintenance at the public expense. (34) Possibly some of you may be calculating that the capital requisite will be enormous. They may doubt if a sufficient sum will ever be subscribed to meet the needs. All I can say is, even so, do not despond. (35) It is not as if it were necessary that every feature of the scheme should be carried out at once or else there is to be no advantage in it at all. On the contrary, what- ever number of houses are erected, or ships built, or slaves pur- chased, or the like, these portions will begin to pay at once. (36) In fact, the bit-by-bit method of proceeding will be more advantageous than a simultaneous carrjdng into effect of the whole plan, to this extent : if we set about erecting buildings wholesale we shall make a more expensive and worse job of it than if we finish them off gradually. Again, if we set about bidding for hundreds of slaves at once, we shall be forced to purchase an inferior type at a higher ' On the tribal organization of the citizens by Cleisthenes, see Aristotle, Const. Ath. 21 (no. 30) ; Botsford, Hellenic History, ch. vi. § s- 442 THE STATE cost. (37) On the other hand, if we proceed tentatively, as we find ourselves able, we can complete any well-devised atterftpt at our leisure, and, in case of any obvious failure, take warning and not repeat it. (38) Again, if everything were to be carried out at once, it is we, sirs, who must make the whole provision at our expense, whereas if part were proceeded with and part stood over, the por- tion of revenue in hand will help to furnish what is necessary to go on with. (39) But to come now to what every one probably will regard as a really grave danger, lest the state may become possessed of an over-large number of slaves, with the result that the works will be overstocked. That again is an apprehension which we may escape if we are careful not to put into the works more hands from year to year than the works themselves demand. (40) Thus I am persuaded that the easiest method of carrjdng out this scheme, as a whole, is also the best. If, however, you are persuaded that, owing to the extraordinary property taxes to which you have been subjected during the present war,^ you will not be equal to any further contributions at present, what you should do is this : during the current year resolve to carry on the financial administration pf the state within the limits of a sum equivalent to that which your dues realized before the peace. That done, you are at hberty to take any surplus sum, whether directly traceable to peace itself, or to the more courteous treatment of our resident aliens and traders, or to the growth of the imports and exports, coincident with the collecting together of large masses of human beings, or to an augmentation of harbor and market dues: this surplus, I say, however derived, you should take and invest so as to bring in the greatest revenue. (41) Again, if there is an apprehension on the part of any that the whole scheme will crumble into nothing on the first outbreak of war, I would only beg these alarmists to note that, under the condition of things which we propose to bring about, war will have more terrors for the attacking party than for this state. (42) What possession, I should hke to know, can be more serviceable for war ' If this pamphlet was written in 355, as is generally supposed, the war referred to was the Social war, 357-354, in which Athens lost her more important allies; Beloch, Griech. Gesch. II. 313-19. IN TIME OF War 443 than that of men? Think of the many ships which they will be capable of manning on pubhc service. Think of the number who will serve on land as infantry and will bear hard upon the enemy. Only we must treat them with courtesy. (43) For myself, my calculation is that even in the event of war, we shall be quite able to keep a firm hold of the silver mines. I may take it, we have in the neighborhood of the mines certain fortresses — one on the southern slope in Anaphlystus ; and we have another on the northern side in Thoricus, the two being about seven and a half miles apart. (44) Suppose then a third breastwork were to be placed between these two, on the highest point of Besa, that would enable the operatives to collect into one out of all the fortresses, and at the first perception of a hostile movement it would only be a short distance for each to retire into safety. (45) In the event of an enemy advancing in large numbers they might certainly make off with whatever corn or wine or cattle they found outside. Even if they did get hold of the silver ore, it would be little better to them than a heap of stones. (46) But how is an enemy ever to march upon the mines in force? The nearest state, Megara, is distant, I take it, a good deal over sixty miles ; and the next closest, Thebes, a good deal nearer seventy. (47) Supposing then an enemy to advance from some such point to attack the mines, he cannot avoid passing Athens; and presuming his force to be small, we may expect him to be annihilated by our cavalry and frontier police. I say, presuming his force to be small, since to march with any- thing like a large force, and thereby leave his own territory denuded of troops, would be a startling achievement. Why, the fortified city of Athens will be much closer to the states of the attacking parties than they themselves will be by the time they have got to the mines. (48) But for the sake of argument, let us suppose an enemy to have arrived in the neighborhood of Laurium ; how is he going to stop there without provisions ? To go out in search of supplies with a detachment^^his^force would imply risk, both for the foraging party and for those who have to do the fighting ; whilst, if they are driven to do so ui force each time, they may call themselves be- siegers, but thejp will be practically in a state of siege themselves. (49) It is njft the income derived from the slaves alone to which we look to hi|) the state toward the effective maintenance of her 444 THE STATE citizens, but with the growth and concentration of a dense popu- lation in the mining district various sources of revenue would accrue, whether from the market at Sunium, or from the various state buildings in connection with the silver mines, from furnaces and all the rest. (50) We must expect a thickly populated city to spring up here, if organized in the way proposed, and plots of land will become as valuable to owners out there as they are to those who possess them in the neighborhood of the capital. (51) If at this point I may assume my proposals to have been carried into effect, I think I can promise, not only that our city will be relieved from a financial strain, but that she will make a great stride in orderliness and in tactical organization; she will grow in martial spirit and readiness for war. (52) I anticipate that those who are under orders to go through gynmastic training will devote themselves with a new zeal to the details of the training school, now that they will receive a large maintenance while under the orders of the trainer in the torch race. So again those on garrison duty in the various fortresses, those enrolled as peltasts, or again as frontier police to protect the rural districts, one and all will carry out their respective duties more ardently when the maintenance appropriate to these several functions is duly forth- coming. V. (i) If it is evident that, in order to get the full benefit of all these sources of state revenue, peace is an indispensable con- dition, — if that is plain, I say, the question suggests itself, would it not be worth while to appoint a board to act as guardians of peace ? Since no doubt the election of such a magistracy would enhance the charm of this city in the eyes of the whole world, and add largely to the number of our visitors. (2) But if any one is disposed to take the view, that by adopting a persistent peace policy, this city will be shorn of her power, that her glory will dwindle and her good name be forgotten throughout the length and breadth of Hellas, the view so taken by our friends here j^dtf^my poor judg- ment somewhat unreasonable. For they are surely the happy states ; they, in popular language, are most fortune-favored, which endure in peace the longest season. And of allmtates Athens is pre-eminently adapted by nature to flourish and'^ax strong in peace. (3) The while she abides in peace she cannlt fail to exer- COMMERCIAL VALUE OF PEACE 445 cise an attractive force on all. From the mariner and the merchant upward, all seek her, flocking they come ; the wealthy dealers in com and wine and oil, the owner of many cattle. Not these only, but the man who depends upon his wits, whose skill is to do busi- ness and make gain out of money and its employment. (4) Here another crowd, artificers of all sorts, artists and artisans, professors of wisdom, philosophers, and poets, with those who exhibit and popularize their works. Next a new train of pleasure-seekers, eager to feast on everything sacred or secular, which may capti- vate and charm eye and ear. Or once again, where are all those who seek to effect a rapid sale or purchase of a thousand com- modities to find what they want, if not at Athens? (s) If there is no desire to gainsay these views — only that certain people, in their wish to recover that headship which was once the pride of our city, are persuaded that the accomplishment of their hopes is to be found, not in peace but in war, I beg them to reflect on some matters of the Median war. (6) WasJ factors of Hellenes, that forces, and the trustee: when through the too thought, Athens was even in those days, ai once more reinstate presidents of the n; in return for certi leadership over suffered us Al discretion, not treatment. ( HeUas, if I and to begin at the beginning, ;h-handed violence, or as bene- ned the headship of the naval treasury of Hellas? Again, fiercise of her presidency, as men f her empire, is it not the case that tm we held aloof from injustice we were islanders, of their own free will, as (7) Nay, did not the very Thebans, ts, grant to us Athenians to exercise nd at another date the Lacedaemonians arrange the terms of hegemony at our o such submission, but in requital of kindly today, owing to the chaos which reigns in t, an opportunity has fallen to this city of Hellenes without pain or peril or expense ven to us to try to harmonize states which another : it is given to us to reconcile the dif- ctions within those states themselves, wherever indet 'but evident that we are minded to preserve the the Delphic shrine in its primitive integrity, not 446 THE STATE by joining in any way but by the moral force of embassies through^l; out the length and breadth of Hellas, — and I for one shall not be astonished if you find our brother Hellenes of one sentiment and eager under seal of solemn oaths to proceed against those, who- ever they may be, who shall seek to step into the place vacated by the Phocians' and to occupy the sacred shrine. (lo) Make it but evident that you intend to establish a general peace by land and sea, and if I mistake not, your efforts will find a response in the hearts of all. There is no man but will pray for the salvation of Athens next to that of his own fatherland, (ii) Again, is any one persuaded that, looking solely to riches and money-making, the state may find war more profitable than peace? If so, I can- not conceive a better method of deciding that question than to allow the mind to revert to the past history of the state and to note well the sequence of events. (12) He will discover that in times long gone by, during a period of peace, vast wealth was stored up in the Acropolis, the whole of which mas lavishly expended during a subsequent period of war. Hep^ perceive, if he examines closely, that even at the presenBtlpteSlie are suffering from its ill ^^ effects. Countless sources of rerentidBiave failed; or if they have still flowed in, they have h^^ jjiflaifrly expended on a mul- tiplicity of things. Whereas now tJiMspi^ is established by sea. th our revenues have expanded and thi their power to turn them to account (13) If you turn on me with mean that even in the event of unjus' the part of any, we are still resolutely to offender?" I answer distinctly. No! tain that we shall all the more promptly sion in proportion as we have done no wro: for that will be to rob the aggressor of his VI. (i) If none of these proposals be i: difficult of execution ; if rather by giving the: ciliate further the friendship of Hellas, whilst' ' The author refers to the Sacred war, which closed in 346 wj Fhocians from the Amphictyonic league. Some have though! treatise must have been composed after that date; but perhaps looking forward to the end of the war. of Athens have it in ;l!Kry|pke best. n, "Do you really upon our city on eace toward that intrary, I main- n such aggres- one ourselves. ,ble or even p may con- then our ion of the hat this merely GOD BLESS THE PLAN! 447 own administration and increase our fame ; if by the same means the people shall be provided with the necessaries of life, and our" rich men be relieved of expenditure on war ; if with the large sur- plus to be counted on, we are in a position to conduct our festivals on an even grander scale than heretofore, to restore our temples, to rebuild our forts and docks, and to reinstate in their ancient privileges our priests, our senators, our magistrates, and our knights — surely it were but reasonable to enter upon this project speedily, so that we too, even in our own day, may witness the unclouded dawn of prosperity in store for our city. (2) But if you are agreed to carry out this plan, there is one further counsel which I would urge upon you. Send to Dodona and to Delphi, I would beg you, and consult the will of Heaven whether such provision and such a policy on our part be truly to the interest of Athens both for the present and for the time to come. (3) If the consent of Heaven be thus obtained, we ought then, I say, to put a further question : whose special favor among the gods shall we seek to secure with a view to the happier execu- tion of these measures ? ^ In accordance with that answer, let us offer a sacrifice of happy omen to the deities so named, and commence the work; for if these transactions be so carried .out with the will of God, have we not the right to prognosticate some further advance in the path of political progress for this whole state? 133. The Political Capacity of Women (Plato, Republic, 451-7) Toward the close of the fifth century at Athens some members of the intel- lectual class began to talk of the political capacity of women, and even to sug- gest that they might be given the suffrage. To some extent this idea must have interested the public, to have called for the presentation of Aristophanes, Lysistrate (no. 100). While ridiculing the idea in his usual manner, Aristoph- anes invests it with a considerable sympathy. Early in the fourth century (389, or, according to some, 392) he presented his EcclesiazuscB, which treats satirically of " woman's rights," and the communism of wives and of property. Although there can be no doubt that such views were then agitated in intellec- tual circles, we have no reason for believing that Aristophanes was attacking ' This advice to seek the wisdom of the oracle and the blessings of the gods is in the true Xenophontic spirit. 448 THE STATE Plato, whose Republic was certainly not composed earlier than the decade 380-370 ; Christ, Griech. Lit. I. 646. The view presented by " Socrates ". in the dialogue below is in all earnest. For men born and educated like our citizens, the only way, in my opinion, of arriving at a right conclusion about the possession and use of women and children is to follow the path on which we originally started, when we said that the men were to be the guar- dians and watchdogs of the herd. True. Let us further suppose the birth and education of our women to be subject to similar or nearly similar regulations ; then we shall see whether the result accords with our design. What do you mean? What I mean may be put into the form of a question, I said : Are dogs divided into hes and shes, or do they both share equally in hunting and in keeping watch and in the other duties of dogs? or do we entrust to the males the entire and exclusive care of the flocks, while we leave the females at home, under the idea that the bearing and suckhng of their puppies is labor enough for them ? No, he said, they share alike ; the only difference between them is that the males are stronger and the females weaker. But can you use different animals for the same purpose, unless they are bred and fed in the same way ? You cannot. Then if women are to have the same duties as men, they must have the same nurture and education? Yes. The education which was assigned to the men was music and gjonnastic ? Yes. Then women must be taught music and gymnastic and also the art of war, which they must practice like the men? . . . Can you mention any pursuit of mankind in which the male sex has not all these gifts and qualities in a higher degree than the female? Need I waste time in speaking of the art of weaving, and the management of pancakes and preserves, in which woman- kind does really appear great, and in which for her to be beaten by a man is of all things the most absurd ? A J WOMEN ARE LIKE MEN 449 You are quite right, he replied, in maintaining the general in- feriority of the female sex: although many women are in many things superior to many men, yet on the whole what you say is true. And if so, my friend, I said, there is no special faculty of ad- ministration in a state which a woman has because she is a woman, or which a man has by virtue of his sex, but the gifts of nature are alike diffused in both ; all the pursuits of men are the pursuits of women also, but in aU of them a woman is inferior to a man. Very true. Then are we to impose all our enactments on men and none of them on women? That will never do. One woman has a gift of healing, another not ; one is a musician, and another has no music in her nature? Very true. And one woman has a turn for gymnastic and mihtary exercises, and another is unwarKke and hates gymnastics ? Certainly. And one woman is a philosopher, and another is an enemy of philosophy; one has spirit, and another* is without spirit? That is also true. Then one woman will have the temper of a guardian, and another not. Was not the selection of the male guardians determined by differences of this sort? Yes. Men and women alike possess the qualities which make a guar- dian ; they differ only in their comparative strength or weakness. Obviously. And those women who have such qualities are to be selected as the companions and colleagues of men who have similar qualities and whom they resemble in capacity and character? Very true. Then ought not the same natures to have the same pursuits? They ought. Then, as we were saying before, there is nothing unnatural in assigning music and gymnastic to the wives of the guardians — to that point we come round again. Certainly not. 4SO THE STATE The law which we then enacted was agreeable to nature, and therefore not an impossibility or mere aspiration ; and the contrary practice, which prevails at present, is in reality a violation of na- ture. That appears to be true. We had to consider first, whether our proposals were possible, and secondly whether they were the most beneficial ? Yes. And the possibility has been acknowledged ? Yes. The very great benefit has next to be established ? Quite so. You wiU admit that the same education which makes a man a good guardian will make a woman a good guardian ; for their orig- inal nature is the same ? Yes. I should like to ask you a question. What is it? Would you say that all men are equal in excellence, or is one man better than another ? The latter. And in the commonwealth which we were founding do you con- ceive the guardians who have been brought up on our model system to be more perfect men, or the cobblers whose education has been cobbling ? What a ridiculous question ! You have answered me, I replied : Well, and may we not further say that our guardians are the best of citizens ? By far the best. And will not their wives be the best women ? Yes, by far the best. And can there be anything better for the interests of the state than that the men and women of a State should be as good as pos- sible ? There can be nothing better. And this is what the arts of music and gymnastic, when present in such a manner as we have described, will accomplish ? Certainly. COMMUNISM 4SI Then we have made an enactment not only possible but in the highest degree beneficial to the state ? True.^ . . . The law, I said, which is the sequel of this and of all that has preceded, is to the following effect, — that the wives of our guar- dians are to be common, and their children are to be common, and no parent is to know his own child, nor any child his parent.'' 134. The Muckraker versus the Patriot (Plato, Protagoras, 346) Bad men, when their parents or country have any defects, look on them with malignant joy, and find fault with them and expose and denounce them to others, under the idea that the rest of man- kind will be less likely to take themselves to task and accuse them of neglect ; and they blame their defects far more than they deserve, in order that the odium which is necessarily incurred by them may be increased ; but the good man dissembles his feelings, and con- strains himself to praise them ; and if they have wronged him and he is angry, he pacifies his anger and is reconciled, and compels himself to praise his own flesh and blood. 135. A Critique of the Statesmen of Athens (Plato, Gorgias, 515-19) It is well known that Plato had no sympathy with democracy ; and in the subjoined passage he denounces the statesmen of Athens both past and present. His contention is that a statesman ought to improve the moral character of his people, and within the few years of his career to make them so virtuous that the great majority will appreciate his services and render him due gratitude. If they fail in this respect, if they turn against him and fine him or ostracize him, as they did in the case of Cimon, Themistocles, and Pericles, the statesman has only himself to blame. It is hardly necessary to add that Plato thus imposes upon the statesman an utterly impossible task. " The part here omitted, though interesting, is too long for inclusion in this volume. * With the view of Plato regarding the qualitative equality of women with men we may contrast that of Xenophon, Economicus (no. 154). In the judgment of Xenophon women are the equals of men (each sex has its points of superiority to the other), but they are unlike in nature. It is clear that in this treatise Xenophon is consciously opposing the doctrine of those who, like Plato, contend for the qualitative equality of the sexes. 452 THE STATE Socrates. Now, my friend, as you are already beginning to be a public character, and are admonishing and reproaching me for not being one, suppose that we ask a few questions of one another. Tell me, then, Callicles, how about making any of the citizens better ? Was there ever a man who was once vicious or unjust or intemperate or foolish, and became by the help of Callicles good and noble ? Was there ever such a man, whether citizen or stranger, slave or freeman ? Tell me, Callicles, if a person were to ask these questions of you, what would you answer ? Whom would you say that you had improved by your conversation? There may have been good deeds of this sort which were done by you as a private person, before you came forward in pubUc. Will you not answer ? Callicles. You are contentious, Socrates. Soc. Nay, I ask you, not from a love of contention, but be- cause I really want to know in what way you think that affairs should be administered among us — whether, when you come to the administration of them, you have any other aim but the im- provement of the citizens ? Have we not already admitted many times over that such is the duty of a public man ? Nay, we have surely said so ; for if you will not answer for yourself I must answer for you. But if this is what the good man ought to effect for the benefit of his own state, allow me to recall to you the names of those whom you were just now mentioning, Pericles, Cimon, Miltiades, and Themistocles, and ask whether you stiU think that they were good citizens. Cal. I do. Soc. But if they were good, then clearly each of them must have made the citizens better instead of worse ? Cal. Yes.i Soc. Therefore when Pericles first began to speak in the as- sembly, the Athenians were not so good as when he spoke last ? Cal. Very likely. Soc. Nay, my friend, 'likely' is not the word ; for if he was a good citizen, the inference is certain. • Callicles loses his case by his too hasty admission : in fact the primary object of the state cannot be the moral regeneration of the citizens; that end, if it is to be achieved, must be reached by other agencies, as the family, social intercourse, educa- tion, and the church. THE TEST OF A STATESMAN 453 Cal. And what difference does that make ? Soc. None; only I should like further to know whether the Athenians are supposed to have been made better by Pericles, or on the contrary to have been corrupted by him ; for I hear that he was the first who gave the people pay,^ and made them idle and" cowardly, and encouraged them in love of talk and of money. Cal. You heard that, Socrates, from the laconizing set who bruise their ears. Soc. But what I am going to tell you now is not mere hearsay, but well known both to you and to me : that at first Pericles was glorious and his character unimpeached by any verdict of the Athenians — this was during the time when they were not so good — yet afterward, when they had been made good and gentle by him, at the very end of his life, they convicted him of theft and almost put him to death, clearly under the notion that he was a malefactor. Cal. Well, how does that prove Pericles' badness? Soc. Why, surely, you would say that he was a bad manager of asses or horses or oxen, who had received them originally neither kicking nor butting nor biting him, and implanted in them all these savage tricks ? Would he not be a bad manager of any animals who received them gentle, and made them fiercer than they were when he received them ? What do you say ? Cal. I will do you the favor of saying yes. Soc. And will you also do me the favor of saying whether man is an animal ? Cal. Certainly he is. Soc. And was not Pericles a shepherd of men ? Cal. Yes. Soc. And if he was a good political shepherd, ought not the animals who were his subjects, as we were just now acknowledging, to have become more just, and not more unjust ? ^ Cal. Quite right. 'Pay for naval and military service, also probably for some civil services, was introduced by Aristeides; for jury service, by Pericles; Botsford, Hellenic History, chs. xii, XV. * Here again Socrates favors an utterly erroneous theory : it is a simple thing for a man to train animals to certain tricks or habits but altogether a different matter to reform as many human beings, not to speak of the population of an entire state. 454 THE STATE Soc. And are not just men gentle, as Homer says? — or are you of another mind? Cal. I agree. Soc. And yet he really did make them more savage than he received them, and their savageness was shown toward himself; which he must have been very far from desiring. Cal. Do you want me to agree with you ? Soc. Yes, if I seem to you to speak the truth. Cal. Granted then. Soc. And if they were more savage, must they not have been more unjust and inferior ? Cal. Granted again. Soc. Then upon this view, Pericles was not a good statesman ? Cal. That is, upon your view. Soc. Nay, the view is yours, after what you have admitted. Take the case of Cimon again. Did not the very persons whom he was serving ostracize ' him, in order that they might not hear his voice for ten years ? And they did just the same to Themistocles, adding the penalty of exile; and they voted that Miltiades, the hero of Marathon, should be thrown into the pit of death, and he was only saved by the prytanis.^ And yet, if they had really been good men, as you say, these things would never have happened to them. For the good charioteers are not those who at first keep their place, and then, when they have broken in their horses, and themselves become better charioteers, are thrown out — that is not the way either in charioteering or in any other profession. What do you think ? Cal. I should think not. Soc. Well, but if so, the truth is as I have already said, that in the Athenian state no one has ever shown himself to be a good states- man. You admitted that this was true of our present statesmen, but not true of former ones, and you preferred them to the others ; yet they have turned out to be no better than our present ones. If therefore they were rhetoricians, they did not use the true art ' On ostracism, see no. 31 ; "Botsford, Hellenic History, ch. vii ; Gilbert, ConsH- Ititional Antiquities of Sparta and Athens, 309. • President, tlje individual drawn by lot from the fifty piytaneis to act as presi- dent of the prytaneis, of the entire council, and of the assembly. On the pr}rtaneis, see Botsford, Hellenic History, ch. vii. SHORTCOMINGS OF STATESMEN 455 of rhetoric or of flattery, or they would not have fallen out of favor. Cal. But surely, Socrates, no living man ever came near any one of them in his achievements. Soc. O, my dear friend, I say nothing against them regarded as the serving-men of the state; and I do think that they were certainly more serviceable than those who are hving now, and better able to gratify the wishes of the state. But as to transform- ing those desires and not allowing them to have their own way, and using the powers which they had, whether of persuasion or of force, in the improvement of their fellow citizens, which is the prime object of the truly good citizen, I do not see that in these respects they were a whit superior to our present statesmen, although I do admit that they were more clever at providing ships and walls and docks and aU that. ... You praise the men who feasted the citizens and satisfied their desires, and the people say that they have made the city great, not seeing that the swollen and ulcerated condition of the state is to be attributed to these elder statesmen ; for they have filled the city full of harbors and docks and walls and revenues and all that, and have left no room for justice and temperance. When therefore the crisis of the disorder comes, the people will blame the advisers of the hour, and applaud Themistocles and Cimon and Pericles, who are the real authors of their calamities ; and if you are not careful, they may assail you and my friend Alcibiades, when they are losing not only their new acquisitions but also their original possessions — not that you are the authors of these misfortunes of theirs, although you may perhaps be accessories to them. A foolish ado is al- ways being made, as I see and am told, now as of old, about our statesmen. When the state treats any of them as malefactors, I observe that there is a great uproar and indignation at the supposed wrong that is done to them; "after all their many services to the state, that they should unjustly perish" — so the tale runs. But the cry is all a falsehood ; for no statesman ever could be unjustly put to death by the city of which he is the head.* ' By the same argument Socrates could have been proved useless for his inability to reform Alcibiades and Critias, and these pupils might have justly punished him for his failure. 456 THE STATE 136. A Reason for Caution in the Bestowal of Citizenship (Aristotle, Politics, v. 3. 11-13, 1303 a) The illiberality of Greek states in the admission of aliens to the citizenship has generally been set down as strangely shortsighted. In the subjoined excerpt Aristotle gives a reason for such caution. From it we learn that the question involves a consideration, not only of the character of the state but also of the compatibility of the persons to be admitted. Generally the latter were so difficult of social and political assimilation that the admission of any large number proved disastrous to the state. In early Italy conditions were differ- ent ; and in modem times they are so utterly dissimilar that it is impossible for us without great effort to appreciate the attitude of the Greek state. Another cause of revolution is difference of races which do not at once acquire a common spirit ; for a state is not the growth of a day, neither is it a multitude brought together by accident. Hence the reception of strangers in colonies, either at the time of their foun- dation or afterward, has generally produced revolution; for ex- ample, the Achaeans who joined the Troezenians in the foundation of Sybaris, being the more numerous, afterward expelled them; hence the curse fell upon Sybaris. At Thurii the Sybarites quar- relled with their fellow-colonists ; thinking that the land belonged to them, they wanted too much of it, and were driven out. At By- zantium the new colonists were detected in a conspiracy, and were expelled by force of arms ; the people of Antissa, who had received the Chian exiles, fought with them and drove them out ; and the Zancleans, after having received the Samians, were driven by them out of their own city. The citizens of Apollonia on the Euxine, after the introduction of a fresh body of colonists, had a revolution ; the Syracusans, after the expulsion of their tyrants, having ad- mitted strangers and mercenaries to the rights of citizenship, quar- relled and came to blows ; the people of Amphipolis, having received Chalcidian colonists, were nearly all expelled by them. 137. The Kind of Equality underlying Oligarchy and Democracy Respectively (Aristotle, Politics, v. i. 12-15, 1301 b sq.) In the period now under consideration kingship had long disappeared from the progressive states of Hellas. Tyranny was less common than it had been in the seventh and sixth centuries, and was always temporary. Few traces of TWO KINDS OF EQUALITY 457 aristocracy remained. The prevailing forms of government, accordingly, were oligarchy and democracy. These are the two forms of government therefore which require illustration in the present chapter. Each of these two forms of government is based on a peculiar idea of equality. Equality is of two kinds, numerical and proportional. By the first I mean sameness or equality in number or size ; by the second, equality of ratios. For example, the excess of three over two is equal to the excess of two over one ; whereas four exceeds two in the same ratio in which two exceeds one ; for two is the same part of four that one is of two, namely, the half. As I was saying before, men agree about justice in the abstract, but they differ about pro- portion:^ some think that if they are equal in any respect they are equal absolutely ; others that if they are unequal in any respect, they are unequal in all. Hence there are two principal forms of government, democracy and oligarchy ; ^ for good birth and virtue are rare, but wealth and numbers are more common. In what city shall we find a hundred persons of good birth and of virtue ? ' whereas the poor everywhere abound. That a state should be or- dered simply and wholly according to either kind of equality is not a good thing ; the proof is that such forms of government never last. They are originally based on a mistake, and as they begin badly, cannot fail to end badly. The inference is that both kinds of equality should be employed, numerical in some cases and pro- portionate in others. ' Cf. Politics, V. I. 2. ' On the "mixed constitution" Aristotle writes as follows (ii. 6. 17 sq. 1265 b sq.) : " Some say that the best constitution is a combination of all existing forms, and they praise the Lacedaemonian because it is made up of oligarchy, monarchy, and democ- racy — the king forming the monarchy, the council of elders the oligarchy, while the democratic element is represented by the ephors; for the ephors are selected by the people. . . . They are near the truth who combine many forms; for the state is better which is made up of more numerous elements." Thus the ideal of a mixed con- stitution, existing before Aristotle, was accepted by him. 'The Greek word for virtue (dperi^), as Aristotle uses it, is much broader than the idea of moral excellence ; it signifies rather capacity or ability combined with moral excellence. It was in this sense only that there could have been so few as a hundred men of virtue in a large community. 4S8 THE STATE 138. The Principal Forms of Government and their Perversions (Aristotle, Politics, iii. 7. 1-5, 1279 a sq.) We have next to consider how many forms of government there are, and what they are ; and in the first place what are the true forms, for when they are determined, the perversions of them will at once be apparent. The words 'constitution' and ' form of gov- ernment ' have the same meaning ; ^ and the government, which is the supreme authority in states, must be in the hands of one, or of the few or of many. The true forms of government therefore are those in which the one or the few or the many govern with a view to the common interest ; but governments which rule with a view to the private interest, whether of the one or of the few or of the many, are perversions.^ For citizens, if they are truly citizens, ought to participate in the advantages of the state. Of forms of government in which one rules we call that which regards the com- mon interest kingship or royalty; that in which more than one, but not many, rule, aristocracy ; and it is so called, either because the rulers are the best men, or because they have at heart the best interests of the state and of the citizens. When however the citi- zens at large administer the state for the common interest, the gov- ernment is called by the generic name politeia (constitution, polity). There is a reason for this use of language. One man or a few may excel in virtue; but of virtue there are many kinds; and as the number increases it becomes more difficult for them to attain per- fection in every kind, though they may in miUtary virtue, for this quality is found in the masses. Hence in a politeia the fighting men have the supreme power, and those who possess arms are the citizens.' ' The words here used are iroXireia and iro\lTev/M respectively. * Such ethical distinctions are no longer held ; the truth is now recognized that no man or political party, when unrestrained by constitutional checks and by the force of public opinion, can be trusted to conduct the government in the common interest. ' Here is implied the theory that originally there were few men of virtue capacity in a state, and that as the number increased, the government expanded to an aristoc- racy and then to a .politeia. With the latter constitutional change the idea of civic virtue narrowed Jo military capacity. In Aristotle's opinion the politeia was a form of government in \yiiich those qualified for heavy-infantry service enjoyed the franchise, as in Athens before Solon, and again for a brief peri6d after the fall of the Four Hundred. OLIGARCHY AND DEMOCRACY 459 Of the forms mentioned above, the perversions are as follows : of royalty, tyranny ; of aristocracy, oligarchy ; of politeia, democ- racy. For tyranny is a kind of monarchy which has in view the interest of the monarch only ; oligarchy has in view the interest of the wealthy ; democracy, of the needy ; none of them the common good of all. 139. Prevalence of Oligarchy and Democracy (Aristotle, Politics, iv. 11. 16-19, 1296 a sq.) Before coming to the passage given below Aristotle calls attention to the middle class — the people of moderate wealth — as the chief element of stabil- ity in a state. These considerations will help us understand why most gov- ernments are either democratical or oligarchical. The reason is that the middle class is seldom numerous in them, and whichever party, whether the rich or the common people, transgresses the mean and predominates, draws the government to itself, and thus arises either oligarchy or democracy. There is another reason — the poor and the rich quarrel with one another, and whichever side gets the better, instead of establishing *a just or popular govern- ment, regards political supremacy as the prize of victory, and the one party sets up a democracy and the other an oligarchy. Both the parties which had the supremacy in HeUas looked only to the interest of their own form of government, and established in states, the one democracies, the other oligarchies; they thought of their own advantage, of the pubhc not at all.^ ... It has now become a habit among the citizens of states, not even to care about equality ; all men are seeking for dominion, or if conquered, are willing to submit. 140. Laudable and Blameworthy Forms of Democracy AND OF Oligarchy (Aristotle, Politics, v. 9. 7-15, 1309 a sq.) Those who think that all virtue is to be found in their own party principles push matters to extremes ; they do not consider that dis- proportion destroys a state. A nose which varies from the ideal of ' Here he is thinking of Athens and Lacedsemon respectively in the preceding cen- tury. 46o THE STATE straightness to a hook or a snub may still be of very good shape and agreeable to the eye ; but if the excess be very great, all symmetry is lost, and the nose at last ceases to be a nose at all on account of some excess in one direction or defect in the other ; and this is true of every other part of the human body. The same law of propor- tion equally holds in states. Oligarchy or democracy, although a departure from the most perfect form, may be at the same time a good enough government; but if any one attempts to push the principles of either to an extreme, he will begin by spoihng the government and end by having none at all.' The legislator and the statesman ought therefore to know what democratical measures save and what destroy a democracy, and what oligarchical measures save or destroy an oligarchy. For neither the one nor the other can exist or continue to exist unless both rich and poor are included in it. If equality of property is introduced, the state must of necessity take another form ; for when by laws carried to excess one or other element in the state is ruined, the constitution is ruined.^ There is an error common both to oligarchies and to democracies : in the latter the demagogues,' when the multitude are above the law, are always cutting the city in two by quarrels with the rich, whereas they should always profess to be maintaining their cause ; just as in ohgarchies, the oligarchs should profess to maintain the cause of the people, and should take oaths the opposite of those which they now take. For there are cities in which they swear: "I will be an enemy to the people, and will devise all the harm against them which I can ; " but they ought to exhibit and to en- tertain the very opposite feeling; in the form of their oath there should be an express declaration: "I will do no wrong to the people." But of all the things which I have mentioned, that which most ' In brief, Aristotle totally condemns neither oligarchy nor democracy, but only the extreme forms of each ; both forms of government are blameworthy in the degree that they approach the extreme. ' Throughout the Politics, Aristotle constantly calls attention to the necessity of governmental checks and balances, not only in the organization of the constitution, but also in the proportion of the social classes. ' It is a noteworthy fact that Aristotle nowhere blames the masses for the evils of democracy, but fastens the fault upon the demagogues. This attitude of mind, here suggested, is illustrated in his treatment of political education a few lines below, and still further in selection no. 143. POLITICAL EDUCATION 461 contributes to the permanence of constitutions is the adaptation of education to the form of government, and yet in our own day this principle is neglected. The best laws, though sanctioned by every citizen of the state, will be of no avail unless the young are trained by habit and education in the spirit of the constitution : if the laws are democratical, democratically, or oligarchically if the laws are oligarchical. For there may be a want of self-discipline in states as well as in individuals. Now to have been educated in the spirit of the constitution, is not to perform the actions in which oligarchs or democrats delight, but those by which the existence of a democ- racy or an oligarchy is made possible. Whereas among ourselves the sons of the ruUng class in an oUgarchy Uve in luxury, but the sons of the poor are hardened by exercise and toil, and hence they are both more inclined and better able to make a revolution. In democracies of the more extreme type also there has arisen a false idea of freedom which is contradictory to the true interests of the state. For two principles are characteristic of democracy, the government of the majority and freedom. Men think that what is just is equal ; and that equality is thg supremacy of the popular will ; and that freedom and equality mean the doing what a man likes. In such democracies every one lives as he pleases, or in the words of Euripides, ' according to his fancy.' But this is all wrong ; men should not think it slavery to live according to the rule of the constitution ; for it is their salvation. 141. Growth of Democracy (Aristotle, Politics, iii. 15. 12, 1286 b) Aristotle understands very clearly that there was a constitutional develop- ment of Hellas from the earliest times to the fourth century. It was due (i) to the increase of wealth and its distribution among an increasing number of citizens, (2) to the spread of virtue (intelligence, capacity) among the citizens, (3) to the deterioration of the parties successively in power. It was thus that kingship developed iiito an aristocracy. From that stage he traces the growth of democracy in the following passage. The ruling class (aristocracy) soon deteriorated and enriched themselves out of the pubUc treasury. Riches became the path to honor, and thus oligarchies grew up. These governments passed into tyrannies and tyrannies into democracies ; for the love of gain 462 THE STATE in the ruling classes was always tending to diminish their number, and so to strengthen the masses, who in the end set upon their masters and established democracies. Since cities have increased in size, no other form of government appears to be any longer pos- sible. (/Wrf. iv. 6. s sq., 1293 a) In our own day, when cities have far outgrown their original size, and their revenues have increased, all the citizens have a share in the government through the great preponderance of their num- bers ; and they all, including the poor who receive pay and there- fore have leisure to exercise their rights, share in the administration. In fact when they are paid, the common people have the most leisure, for they are not hindered by the care of their property, which often fetters the rich, who are thereby prevented from taking part in the assembly or in the courts ; ^ hence the state is governed by the poor, who are a majority, and not by the laws. 142. Agricultural and Pastoral Democracies (Aristotle, Politics, vi. 4. 1-15, 1318 b sq.) All democracies are not to be treated alike, to be equally praised or con- demned. There are among the various forms many degrees of excellence or the reverse. The more nearly a democracy approaches the politeia, the better it is. In iv. 4. 22-6, 1292 b sq. Aristotle enumerates five kinds of democracy. Of four kinds he approves, as they are all under the laws ; but the fifth form is that in which not the laws but the multitude rule, in which the law is superseded by decrees. This is a condition of affairs brought about by demagogues, and of this form only he disapproves. Again (iv. 14. 3-7, 1298 a) he classifies democracy on the basis of the extent to which the people participate in the deliberative function. Thus arise four forms of democracy, the last being that in which all the people are consulted on all subjects. This form he denounces. Furthermore (iv. 6. 1-6, 1292 b sq.) he enumerates four classes of democracy based on the matter of revenues. • The author here refers to a bourgeoisie, largely composed of men from the poorer classes, including even some freedmen, who had enriched themselves through fortunate business operations, and who cared more for their wealth, and for the comforts it brought, than for the state. In like manner there was a considerable class, including even eupatrids, addicted to gambling and sensual pleasures. There had grown up, too, a smaller but more influential class wholly devoted to intellectual pleasures, in- cluding philosophers and other Jiterary men. All these people alike, for their several individualistic reasons, held aloof from politics, and thus contributed to the growth of extreme democracy, and ultimately to the decay of the city-state. FARMERS AND SHEPHERDS 463 Under the first three forms, as there is a lack of revenue, the people have to work for a living ; and the offices, being unpaid, are filled by the well-to-do only. The constitution therefore, though democratic in name, is in fact a government by the competent. These three forms are earlier stages of growth, developing into the form described in no. 141. The most approved forms of democracy are described in the selection here given. Of the four forms of democracy, as was said in the previous dis- cussion, the best is that which comes first in order ; it is also the oldest of them all.^ I am speaking of them according to the natural classification of their inhabitants. For the best material of democ- racy is an agricultural population. There is no difficulty in form- ing a democracy where the mass of the people live by agriculture or by pasturing cattle. Being poor, they have no leisure, and there- fore do not often attend the assembly; and not having the nec- essaries of -Kfe, they are always at work, and do not covet the prop- erty of others. In fact they find their employment pleasanter than the cares of government or office where no great gains can be made from them, for the many are more desirous of gain than of honor. A proof is that even the ancient tyrannies were patiently endured by them, as they still endure ^oligarchies, if they are al- lowed to work and are not deprived of their property; for some of them quickly grow rich and the others are well enough off. More- over they have the power of electing the magistrates and of calling them to account ; their ambition^ if they have any, is thus satisfied. In some democracies, although they do not all share in the appoint- ment to offices, except through, representatives elected in turn out of the whole people, as at Mantineia, yet if they have the power of deliberating, the many are contented.^ Even this form of govern- ment may be regarded as a democracy, and was such at Mantineia. Hence it is both expedient and customary in such a democracy that all should elect to offices, and conduct scrutinies,' and sit in the law- courts, but that the great offices should be filled by election and from persons having a qualification : the greiater requiring a greater ' This principle of age holds for industrial states like Athens. ■ There were, how- ever, wide agricultural and pastoral areas, including Arcadia, Achaea, ^tolia, Acar- nania, Thessaly, etc., in which, as late as the time of Aristotle, such a form of democ- racy either existed or could be formed. ' This passage is a tribute to the moderation of the masses. ' Eieipeiv, to call a magistrate to accoimt after the expiration of his office. 464 THE STATE qualification, or if there be no oflices for which a qualification is required, then those who are marked out by special ability should be appointed. Under such a form of government the citizens are sure to be ruled well ; for the ofl&ces will always be held by the best persons ; the people are willing enough to elect them and are not jealous of the good. The good and the notables will then be satis- fied, for they will not be governed by men who are their inferiors ; and the persons elected will rule justly, because others will call them to account. Every man should be responsible to others, nor should any one be allowed to do just as he pleases; for where absolute freedom is permitted there is nothing to restrain the evil which is inherent in every man. The principle of responsibility, however, secures that which is the greatest good in states ; the right persons rule and are prevented from doing wrong, and the people have their due. It is evident that this is the best kind of democracy, and why ? because the people are of a certain quality. The ancient laws of many states which aimed at making the people husbandmen were excellent. They provided either that no one should possess more than a certain amount of land, or that if he did, the land should not be within a certain distance from the town or the acropolis.^ For- merly in many states there was a law forbidding any one to sell his original allotment of land. There is a similar law attributed to Oxylus, which is to the effect that there should be a certain portion of every man's property on which he could not borrow money. A useful correction to the evil of which I am speaking would be the law of the Aphytaeans,^ who although they are numerous and do not possess much land, are all husbandmen. For their properties are reckoned in the census not entire, but only in such small portions that even the poor may have more than the amount required. Next best to an agricultural population, and in many respects similar, are a pastoral people, who live by their flocks. They are the best trained for war, robust in body and able to camp out. The people of whom other democracies consist are far inferior to them, for their Hfe is. inferior ; there is no room for moral excellence in any ' The nearer a man lived to the city, the greater his opportunity to attend the as- sembly and other political functions. If therefore a few should be permitted to monop- olize the land in the neighborhood of the city, they would to that extent be depriving the masses of their opportunity to participate in civic rights. ' People of Aphy tis, a Hellenic dty of Chalcidice. THE TOWN POPULATION 465 of their employments, whether they are mechanics or traders or laborers. Besides, people of the latter classes can readily come to the assembly, because they are continually moving about in the city and in the market place ; .whereas husbandmen are scattered over the country and do not meet or equally feel the want of as- sembling together. Where the territory extends to a distance from the city, there is no difficulty in making an excellent democracy or politeia ; for the people are compelled to live in the country ; and even if there is a town population, the assembly ought not to meet when the country people cannot come. We have thus explained how the first and best form of democracy should be constituted; it is clear that the other or inferior forms will deviate in regular order, and that the population which is excluded will at each stage be of a lower kind.^ 143. Extreme Democracy (Aristotle, Politics, vi. 4. 15 to 5. 11, 1319 b-1320 b) In the following excerpt Aristotle gives the characteristics of extreme democ- racy and suggests remedies for its evils. Noteworthy is his optimism ; though the constitutions of many city-states are defe Works of this kind, characterized by exaggerated realism, were a feature of the Hellemstic age. SSo PERSONALITY, LITERATURE, AND ART demanded for it. No sum of money was considered equivalent ; it was a public ordinance that they should pledge their lives for its safety. (39) Of audacity countless instances can be given. For ex- ample, artists have conceived the idea of gigantic statues called colossi,* as tall as towers. Of this class is the Apollo in the Capitol, brought from ApoUonia in Pontus by Marcus LucuUus. It is forty- five feet high, and cost five hundred talents. Another is the Jupi- ter dedicated in the field of Mars by Claudius Caesar, which, how- ever, is dwarfed by its proximity to the theatre of Pompey. (40) Yet another is the Zeus at Tarentum by Lysippus, which is forty cubits ^ in height, and is noteworthy because the weight is so nicely bal- anced that the colossus can, they say, be turned round by a touch of the hand, and yet cannot be overthrown by the wind. The ar- tist is said to have provided against this possibility by placing a column a little way off, on the side where it was most necessary to break the violence of the wind. The size of the statue and the difficulty of transporting it prevented Fabius Verrucosus from touching it, although he brought the Heracles in the Capitol from Tarentum. (41) The most marvellous of all, however, is the statue of the Sun at Rhodes,' made by Chares of Lindus, a pupil of the Lysippus already mentioned. It was seventy cubits in height ; and after standing fifty-six years, it was overthrown by an earthquake, but even as it lies on the ground it arouses wonder. Few men can clasp their arms about its thumb; its fingers are taller than most statues, and wide caverns gape within its broken limbs, while inside can be seen huge fragments of rock, originally used as weights to steady it. According to tradition its construc- tion lasted twelve years, and cost three hundred talents, contribu- ted by the Rhodians from the siege-train left with them by king Demetrius when he wearied of the siege of Rhodes. ' Statues exceeding the human standard of size were made from the earliest times, but these enormous works were a product of the late classical and Hellenistic ages. 2 58 feet. ' The colossus at Rhodes was reckoned among the "seven wonders" of the world. The idea that it stood with one foot on each of the moles that bordered the entrance to the harbor, while ships passed between its legs, is a medieval error; Sellers, note; C. Torr, Rhodes in Ancient Times, g6 sg. 70 cubits is equivalent to 102 feet. PHEIDIAS 551 170. The Famous Sculptors and their Works (Pliny, Natural History, xxxiv. 53-84. Jex-Blake, revised by E. G. S.) The following are among the more convenient and reliable manuals of Hellenic art. TarbeU, F. B., History of Greek Art (Macmillan, 1896) ; Fowler, H. N., and Wheeler, J. R., Handbook of Greek ArchcBology (Am. Bk. Co., 1909) ; Gardner, P., Principles of Greek Art (MacmiUan, 1914) ; Sculptured Tombs of Hellas (Macmillan, 1896) ; Von Mach, E., Greek Sculpture, Its Spirit and Principles (Ginn, 1903) ; Gardner, E. A., Handbook of Greek Sculpture (Mac- millan, 1896) ; Six Greek Sculptors (Scribner, 1910). The most valuable guide to the collections at Rome is Helbig, W., Fuhrer durch die offentlichen Samm- lungen klassischer Altertilmer in Rom, 2 vols., 3d ed. revised by Amelung and other eminent scholars (Teubner, 191 2) . By the use of these manuals the various artists mentioned in the subjoined excerpt may be identified and studied. (53) I shall touch briefly on the great names, and group others under various heads. The most famous artists, although born at some distance of time from each other, still came into competition, since each had made a statue of an Amazon, to be dedicated in the temple of Artemis at Ephesus, when it was decided that the prize should be awarded to the one which the artists themselves, who were on the spot, declared to be the bpst. This proved to be the statue which each artist placed second to his own, namely that of Polycleitus. The statue of Pheidias was second, that of Cresilas third, Cydon's fourth, and Phradmon's fifth. (54) Besides his Olympian Zeus, a work which has no rival, Pheidias made in ivory the Athena at Athens, which stands erect in the Parthenon. In bronze, besides the Amazon already men- tioned, he made an Athena of such surpassing beauty that she was named the Fair (Forma) .^ He also made the Key-Bearer, another Athena which .^milius Paullus dedicated at Rome in front of the temple of the Fortune of this Day,^ two draped statues dedicated by Catulus in the same temple and a nude colossal statue. He is rightly held to have revealed the capabilities of sculpture and indicated its methods. (55) Polycleitus of Sicyon was a pupil of Hageladas.' He made ' Also known as the Lemnian Athena ; Paus. i. 28. 2. *This iEmilius PauUus was the conqueror of Perseus at Pydna, 168. The temple of Fortune of this Day was on the Palatine Hill. ' Hageladas of Argos flourished in the sixth century, too early therefore to have been the master of Polycleitus. The connection was probably deduced from a noticeable influence. 552 PERSONALITY, LITERATURE, AND ART an athlete binding the diadem about his head, which was famous for the sum of one hundred talents which it realized. This Diadu- menos has been described as ' a man, yet a boy ; ' the Doryphoros, or 'Spear-Bearer' as ' a boy, yet a man.' He also made the statue which sculptors call the 'canon,' referring to it as a standard from which they can learn the first rules of their art. He is the only man who has been held to have embodied the principles of his art in a single work. He also made an athlete scraping himself, a nude figure advancing with a weapon, and two boys, also nude, plajdng with knuckle-bones, who are known as the Astragalizontes, and are now in the atrium of Imperator Titus. Many think that the fault- less execution of this work has never been surpassed. (56) Other works of his are a Hermes which was at Lysimacheia ; a Heracles at Rome ; a Captain putting on his armor ; and finally a portrait of Artemon, known by the name of Periphoretos ('Man in the Litter'). He is considered to have brought the scientific knowl- edge of statuary to perfection, and to have systematized the art of which Pheidias had revealed the possibilities. It was his pe- culiar characteristic to represent his figures standing on one leg. Varro, however, says that they are square and almost exactly after the same type. (57) Myron was born at Eleutherse,^ and was also a pupil of Hageladas. He is best known by his heifer, thanks to the well- known verses written upon it, for people generally owe their repu- tations to the talent of others rather than to their own. He made, too, a dog and a Discobolos, or athlete hurling the discus, a Perseus, sawyers, a Satyr gazing with wonder at the pipes and Athena, win- ners in the five contests at Delphi, pancratiasts, and the Heracles which is near the Circus Maximus in the temple (aedes) of Pompey the Great. A poem by Erinna also tells us that he made the monu- ment of a cicada and a locust. (58) He also made the Apollo which was taken from the Ephesians by the triumvir Antony, and re- stored to them by the deified Augustus, in obedience to a dream. Evidently he was the first to multiply truth ; * he was more pro- ' Ob the Boeotian frontier of Attica. ' That is, he " widened the range of representation in art, inasmuch as he laid hold on moments disclosed by attentive observation of nature, but not utilized before " ; quoted from Brunn by Sellers, note. PYTHAGORAS; LYSIPPUS 553 ductive than Polycleitus, and a more diligent observer of symmetry. Nevertheless he too cared only for the physical form, and did not express mental sensations, and his treatment of the hair continued to betray an archaic want of skill. (59) Pythagoras of Rhegium in Italy surpassed Mjnron with the pancratiast placed at Delphi; with the same statue he also surpassed Leontiscus. Furthermore he made the statues of the runner Astylus and of a Libyan, which are to be seen at Olympia. For the same place he made the boy holding a tablet, and a nude male figure carrying apples. At Syracuse is a statue by him of a man limping, the pain of whose ulcer even the spectators seem to feel. He was the first to make the sinews and veins duly prominent, and to bestow greater pains upon the hair. (60) A second Py- thagoras, a Samian, was in early life a painter. Near the Temple of the Fortune of the Day are seven nude figures by him, and an old man, which are praised. According to tradition his personal resemblance to the other Pythagoras was so strong that the two could be mistaken. It was the Rhegine Pythagoras, however, of whom Sostratus was the pupil and nephew. (61) Duris declared that Lysippus of Sicyon was no man's pupil ; that he was originally a coppersmith, and was encouraged to venture on a higher path by the words of Eupompus. That painter, when asked which of the earlier artists he followed, pointed to a crowd of people, and replied that nature should be imitated and not any artist. (62) Lysippus produced more works than any other artist, possessing, as I have said, a most prolific genius. Among them is the 'man scraping himself (Apoxyomenos), which Marcus Agrippa dedicated in front of his baths. In this statue the princeps Tiberius took a marvellous delight, and though capable of self-control in the first years of his principate, he could not refrain from having the statue removed into his private chamber, substitut- ing another in its place. The populace of Rome resented this so deeply that they raised an outcry in the theatre, demanding the restitution of the Apoxyomenos, to which the princeps was fain to yield, in spite of the passion he had conceived for the statue. (63) Lysippus has also won fame by his drunken flute-player, his dogs and huntsmen, and above all by the four-horse chariot and the figure of the Sun made for the Rhodians. He also made a 554 PERSONALITY, LITERATURE, AND ART number of portraits of Alexander the Great, beginning with one of him as a boy, which the princeps Nero, who was greatly charmed with the statue, ordered to be gilded. Then as this costly addition spoiled the beauty of the work, the gold was removed, and the statue was considered the more valuable without it, in spite of the scars on it and the incisions for fastening the gold. (64) Further- more he miade a statue of Hephaestion, the friend of Alexander the Great, which some ascribe to Polycleitus, although that artist lived almost a hundred years earlier. We have also from his hand an Alexander in a hunting group, which is consecrated at Delphi, a Satyr at Athens and a troop of Alexander's personal guard, in which all his friends' portraits are rendered with great fideUty. This group was transported to Rome by Metellus after the conquest of Macedonia."^ By Lysippus too are various four-horse chariots. (65) His chief contributions to the art of sculpture are said to con- sist in his vivid rendering of the hair, in making the heads smaller than older artists had done, and the bodies shmmer and with less flesh, thus increasing the apparent height of the figures. There is no word in Latin for the canon of symmetry (symmetria) which he was so careful to preserve, bringing innovations which had never been thought of before into the square canon of the older artists, and he often said that the difference between himself and them was that they represented men as they were, and he as they appeared to be. His chief characteristic is extreme delicacy of execution even in the smallest details. (66) He left artists of high reputation in his sons and pupils, Laippus, Boedas, and above all Euthycrates. The latter however imitated not so much the refinement as the perseverance of his father, choosing to win approval by an austere rather than a lighter style of execution. In this manner he made for Delphi an admi- rable statue of .Heracles, for Thespiae an Alexander hunting, a group of the Thespiades, and a combat between horsemen, a statue of Trophonius with his oracular cave, several chariots with four horses, a horse carrying hunting prongs, and hunting dogs. (67) His pupil was Teisicrates, also a native of Sicyon, who followed more closely the school of Lysippus, so that many of his works can hardly be distinguished from those of the master. Wit- ' 146 B.C. PRAXITELES 555 ness his portrait of an old man at Thebes, of King Demetrius and of Peucestes, who saved Alexander's life and well deserves the honor of a statue. (68) Those sculptors who have written treatises on the subject give high praise to Telephanes of Phocaea, who is otherwise un- known, since, they say, he lived in Thessaly, where his works re- mained unnoticed. These writers, however, adjudge him a place beside Polycleitus, Myron and Pythagoras, praising his statues of Larissa, of Spintharus, a winner in the five contests, and of Apollo. Others give a different reason for his comparative obscurity saying that he passed into the service of king Xerxes and of Darius. (69) Praxiteles also, though more successful and consequently better known as a worker in marble, created admirable works in bronze; a rape of Persephone, the Catagousa ('Spinning Girl'), a Dionysus, a figure of Intoxication grouped with an admirable Satyr known among the Greeks as the 'Renowned,' and also the statues which stood in front of the temple of Felicity, and an Aphrodite which was destroyed when the temple was burned down in the prin- cipate of Claudius, the worthy peer of his famous marble Aphrodite. (70) Other works of his are the Stephanousa ('Woman presenting a Wreath'), the PselioumenS ('Woman clasping a Bracelet on her Arm'), Opora (Autumn), and statues of Harmodius and Aristo- geiton, Slayers of the Tyrant. These statues were carried off by Xerxes, king of the Persians, and restored to Athens by Alexander the Great after his conquest of Persia. He also made a young Apollo with an arrow watching a lizard as it creeps up, with the intent to slay it close at hand. This is known as the Sauroctonos ('Lizard-Slayer'). There are two statues by him expressing con- trary emotions, a mourning matron and a rejoicing courtesan. The latter is believed to be Phr)Tie. The sculptor's love may be read in the whole statue, and Phrjaie's satisfaction is depicted on her face. (71) There is also a statue which testifies to the kindness of Praxiteles; for he made a charioteer for a four-horse chariot by Calamis, not wishing it to be thought that Calamis failed in the man after succeeding with the horses. Calamis made other four- horse and two-horse chariot groups with varying success, though 5S6 PERSONALITY, LITERATURE, AND ART unrivalled in his horses. And yet, for it must not be thought that he was inferior to others in representing the human figure, no artist has better portrayed the poet Alcman. (72) Alcamenes, a pupil of Pheidias, produced works in marble as well as a winner in the five contests in bronze, called the Enkri- nomenos ('Undergoing the Test')- A pupil of Polycleitus, Aris- teides, made chariots with four horses and with two. Amphicrates is famous for his Leaina ('Lioness')- This Leaina was a courte- san, intimate, through her playing on the lyre, with Harmodius and Aristogeiton, whose plot of assassination she refused to betray, though tortured to death by the tyrants. The Athenians were anxious to pay her honor, and yet imwilhng to commemorate a courtesan by a statue. Accordingly they made a figure of the animal whose name she bore, and to indicate their reason for honor- ing her, they forbade the artist to give it a tongue. (73) Bryaxis made an Asclepius and a Seleucus ; Boedas a pra5dng figure ; Baton the Apollo and Hera which are in the temple of Concord at Rome ; (74) Cresilas a wounded man at the point of death, whose face betrays how fast his blood is ebbing, and also an 01)Tnpian Pericles, worthy of the epithet. The marvel of his art is that it made famous men yet more famous. Cephisodorus made a wonderful Athena in the harbor of Athens, and in the same city, in the temple of Zeus the Saviour, an altar to which few are comparable. (75) Canachus made the nude Apollo, which is named the Lover and is in the temple of Did3mia, of ^Eginetan bronze, and with it a stag so poised upon its feet that a thread can be drawn beneath them while the heel and toe alternately catch the ground, both parts working with a jointed mechanism in such a way that the impact sufl&ces to make them spring backward and forward. He also made boys on race- horses. {Then follow several less-known artists omitted from this selection). . . . (79) Lycius was a pupil of Myron. In the boy blowing a dying fire he created a work worthy of his master; further, he made statues of the Argonauts. The eagle of Leochares appears to know how precious a burden it is ravishing in Ganymede and to what master it bears him, and its talons hold the boy tenderly though his dress protects him. He also made a statue of Autolycus, who was victorious in the pancration and in whose honor Xenophon VARIOUS SCULPTORS 557 wrote the Banquet; the celebrated Zeus with the thunderbolt in the Capitol, a work of supreme excellence; Apollo wearing the diadem ; the slave-dealer Lyciscus and a boy, on whose face may be read the wily craft of the servile character. Lycius too made a woman burning perfumes. . . . (81) Styppax of Cyprus is known by one statue only, the Splanchnoptes (' Roaster of Entrails ')• This was a slave of Pericles the Olympian ; he is roasting entrails and blowing hard on the fire to kindle it, till his cheeks swell.. Seilanion cast a portrait of Apol- lodorus, who was also a sculptor, who often broke up a finished statue, being imable to reach the ideal he aimed at ; from this cir- cumstance he was called the 'Madman.' (82) This characteristic Seilanion rendered, and made his bronze, not a portrait of an in- dividual, but of a figure of Vexation itself. He also made a famous Achilles and a trainer exercising his athletes. Strongyhon made the Amazon called Euknemos, from the beauty of its legs. It was because of this special feature that the princeps Nero carried the statue about with him in his train. He also made the boy which Brutus of Philippi loved, and rendered illustrious by his name. (83) Theodorus, the maker of the laby- rinth at Samos, also cast a portrait of himself in bronze, famed as a wondrous Ukeness, and celebrated for the extreme delicacy of the workmanship. The right hand holds a file, while three fingers of the left hand support a tiny team of four horses, which is now at Praeneste — so small that the team, marvellous to relate, with chariot and charioteer, could be covered by the wings of a fly which the artist made to accompany it. Xenocrates was a pupil of Teisi- crates, or according to some authorities, of Euthycrates. He out- did both in the number of statues which he produced, and he also wrote books on his art. (84) The battles of Attains and Eumenes against the Gauls were represented by several artists, Isogonus, Pyromachus, Stratonicus and Antigonus, who also wrote books on his art. Boethus, though greater as a worker in silver, made a child hugging a goose till he throttles it. The best of all the works I have mentioned have now been dedicated at Rome by the princeps Vespasian in the temple of Peace and in his other galleries, Nero having first brought them by 558 PERSONALITY, LITERATURE, AND ART the strong hand to Rome, and placed them in the apartments of the Golden House. 171. The Most Famous Painters and their Works (Pliny, Natural History, xxxv. 15, 53-97. Jex-Blake, revised by E. G. S.) (15) The origin of painting is obscure, and hardly falls within the scope of this work. The claim of the Egyptians to have dis- covered the art six thousand years before it reached Greece is ob- viously an idle boast,^ while among the Greeks some say that it was first discovered at Sicyon, others at Corinth. All however agree that painting began with the outUning of a man's shadow. This was the first stage ; in the second a single color was employed ; and after the discovery of more elaborate methods this style, which is still in vogue, received the name of monochrome. . . . (53) I now propose to mention the most famous painters as briefly as may be, for a detailed account would be inconsistent with the scheme of my work. It will therefore be enough if I give some artists only a passing notice, or name them in connection with others. But I must still make separate mention of the most renowned paintings, whether they be still in existence or whether they have perished. . . . (57) Panaenus, brother of Pheidias, painted the battle between the Athenians and Persians at Marathon.^ So extensively were colors now used, so perfect had technique now become, that he is actually said to have given the real portraits of the commander on each side, of Miltiades, Callimachus and Cynsegeirus among the Athenians, of Datis and Artaphrenes among the barbarians. (58) Nay more, competitions for painters were instituted at Corinth and Delphi in the time of Panaenus, when in the first contest he tried for the prize against Timagoras of Chalcis, who conquered him — as we know from an old epigram by Timagoras himself — at the Pythian games — an evident proof that the chroniclers are wrong in their dates. Yet other painters became famous before the nine- tieth 01)mipiad,' as for example, Polygnotus of Thasos, who first • Though ridiculed by the Greeks, the claim of the Egyptians is now known to be substantially true. ' This picture is variously assigned to Pansenus, Micon, and Polygnotus ; Sellers, note. '420-417 B.C. POLYGNOTUS; ZEUXIS 559 painted women with transparent garments and gave them head- dresses of various colors. This artist made a first serious contri- bution to the development of painting by opening the mouth, showing the teeth, and varying the stiff archaic effect of the features. (59) He painted the picture now in the Portico of Pompey and for- merly in front of his Senate-Chamber, representing a warrior armed with a shield, about whom people argue whether he is ascending or descending. He also decorated the temple at Delphi, and at Athens the Painted Porch as it is called. For this work he took no money, while Micon, to whom part of the work was intrusted, accepted payment. The position he thus won for himseK was all the greater, so much so that the Amphictyonic council, or national assembly of Hellas, decreed that he should be a public guest. There was another Micon, distinguished as the Younger, whose daughter Timarete was also an artist. (60) In the ninetieth Olympiad lived Aglaophon, Cephisodorus, Erillus, and Evenor, the father and master of the great artist Parrhasius, whom I shall mention in due time. They were all not- able painters, yet they need not prevent my hastening on to the true luminaries of art, among whom the first to shine was Apollo- dorus of Athens in the ninety-third Olympiad.^ He was the first to give his figures the appearance of reality, and he first bestowed true glory on the brush. He painted a priest at prayer, and an Aias struck by Kghtning, which is still to be seen at Pergamon. No picture of any of his predecessors really rivets the gaze. (61) It was he who opened the gates of art through which Zeuxis of Heracleia passed in the fourth year of the ninety-fifth Olympiad,* giving to the painter's brush (for of the brush alone I speak as yet) the full glory to which it already aspired. Zeuxis is erroneously placed by some in the eighty-ninth Oljonpiad ; ' it is evident that Demophilus of Himera and Neseus of Thasos were among his con- temporaries, seeing that there is a controversy as to which of the two was his master. (62) In an epigram written against him by the ApoUodorus whom I mentioned above, it is said that 'Zeuxis bore away with him the art he had stolen from his masters.' He amassed great wealth ; and in order to make a parade of it at 01)anpia, he showed his name woven in golden letters into the embroideries of * 408-405 B.C. ' 397 B.C. • 424-421 B-c. S6o PERSONALITY, LITERATURE, AND ART his garments. Afterward he began to make presents of his pictures, saying that they were beyond all price. In this way he gave his Alcmena to the city of Agrigentum and his Pan to Archelaus. He also painted a Penelope, in whom he embodied Virtue's self, and an athlete with whom he was so well pleased that he wrote beneath it the line thenceforward famous ; (63) " Another may carp more easily than he may copy." He also painted a superb Zeus en- throned amid the assembled Gods, with the infant Heracles stran- gling the snakes in presence of his trembling mother Alcmena and of Amphitryon. (64) Zeiuds is criticised, however, as having exag- gerated the heads and extremities of his figures. For the rest he bestowed such minute pains upon his work that before painting for the people of Agrigentum a picture to be dedicated in the teniple on the Lacinian promontory, he inspected the girls of the city vmclad, and chose out five, whose peculiar beauties he proposed to reproduce in his picture. He also painted monochromes in white. Timanthes, Androcydes, Eupompus and Parrhasius were con- temporaries and rivals of Zeuxis. (65) The story runs that Parrhasius and Zeuxis entered into competition, Zeuxis exhibiting a picture of some grapes so true to nature that the birds flew up to the wall of the stage. Parrhasius then displayed a picture of a linen curtain realistic to such a degree that Zeuxis, elated by the verdict of the birds, cried out that now at last his rival must draw the curtain and show his picture. On discovering the mistake he surrendered the prize to Parrhasius, admitting candidly that he had deceived the birds, while Parrhasius had deluded himself, a painter. (66) Afterward we learn that Zeuxis painted a boy carrying grapes, and when the birds flew down to settle on them, he was vexed with his own work, and came for- ward saying with like frankness : 'I have painted the grapes better than the boy ; for had I been perfectly successful with the latter, the birds must have been afraid.' He also modeled certain terra- cottas which were the only works of art left in Ambrada when Fulvius Nobilior brought the statues of the Mjuses to Rome. The paintings in Rome by the hand of Zeuxis are: the Helen in the Portico of Philippus and the bound Marsyas in the temple of Concord. (67) Parrhasius, a native of Ephesus, also made great contri- PARRHASIUS S6i butions to the progress of art. He first gave painting symmetry, and added vivacity to the features, daintiness to the hair, and comeliness to the mouth, while by the verdict of artists he is un- rivalled in the rendering of outline. This is the highest subtlety attainable in painting. Merely to paint a figure in reUef is no doubt a great achievement, yet many have succeeded thus far. But where an artist is rarely successful is in finding an outline which shall express the contours of the figure. (68) For the contour should appear to fold back, and so enclose the object as to give assurance of the parts behind, thus clearly suggesting even what it conceals. Preeminence in this respect is conceded to Parrhasius by Antigonus and Xenocrates, writers on painting, who indeed not only concede but insist upon it. Many other traces of his draughtsmanship remain both in pictures and on parchments, which are said to be instructive to artists. Still, if tried by his own standard, he fails in modehng. (69) He painted an ingenious personification of the Athenian 'Demos,' discovering it as a fickle, passionate, unjust, changeable, yet exorable, compassionate and pitiful, boastful, proud and humble, bold and cowardly, in a word, everything at once. He also painted the Theseus formerly in the Capitol at Rome, an ad- miral in armor, and Meleager, Heracles and Perseus in a picture at Rhodes, where it has thrice been set on fire by Hghtning with- out being destroyed, a miracle which increases our wonder. (70) Further, he painted a priest of Cybele — a picture of which the princeps Tiberius was fond, and which according to Deculo,' although valued at 6,000,000 sesterces, he placed in his private apartments. Moreover he painted a Thracian nurse with an infant in her arms ; a portrait of Philiscus, Dionysus by the side of Virtue, two boys whose features express the confidence and the simplicity of their age, and a priest with a boy at his side holding a censer and a wreath. (71) Two other pictures by him are most famous, a hoplite in a race who seems to sweat as he runs, and a hopUte laying aside his arms, whose laboring breath we seem to hear. His picture of iEneias, Castor and Polydeuces is praised ; so is his Telephus with Achilles, Agamemnon and Odysseus. He was a prolific artist but carried his success with an arrogance that none ' One of Pliny's sources; he lived under or shortly after Tiberius; cj. F. Munzer, BeHiriige %ur Quellenkritik der NaturgeschicMe des Plinizts (Berlin, 1897), 400 sq. S62 PERSONALITY, LITERATURE, AND ART have equalled. He called himself the 'luxurious,' and said in an- other epigram that he was the prince of painting, that he had brought it to the highest point of perfection, and more than all, that he was of the seed of Apollo and had painted the Heracles of Lindos precisely as he had often seen him asleep.^ (72) Hence it was that when he was defeated by a large majority of votes in a competition with Timanthes at Samos, the subject of his picture being Aias and the Award of the Arms, he said in the name of the hero that he was grieved at being worsted a second time by an un- worthy rival. Further, he painted small pictures of licentious subjects, seeking relaxation in this wanton humor.^ (73) To return — Timanthes was a painter most curious in in- vention, for by him is that Iphigeneia, praised by the orators, whom he depicted standing by the altar ready for death. Having rep- resented all the onlookers, and especially her father's brothers, as plunged in sorrow, and having thus exhausted every presentment of grief, he has veiled the face of her father, for which he had reserved no adequate expression. (74) There are other examples of his inventiveness; for instance, being desirous of emphasizing, even in a small picture, the huge size of a sleeping Cyclops, he painted some Satyrs at his side, measuring his thumb with a thyrsos. He is the only artist whose works always suggest more than is in the picture; and great as is his dexterity, his power of invention yet exceeds it. He also painted a hero, a pictureiin which he touched perfection, having comprehended in it the whcfle art of painting the male form. The picture is now at Rome in the temple of Peace. (75) In this period Euxeinidas was the master of Aristeides, a famous artist, and Eupompus of Pamphilus, who in turn was the master of Apelles. We have, by Eupompus a victor in an athletic contest holding a palm. So great was this artist's reputation that it occasioned a new division of the schools of painting. Before his time there had been two schools, known as the Helladic proper and the Asiatic ; but now the Helladic was subdivided in his honor, and ^ This anecdote and the epigrams mentioned above may be found in Athensus xii. 62. The following especially he used to inscribe on his works : Parrhasius, a most luxurious man, And yet a follower of purest virtue, Painted this work. ' CJ. Suetonius, Tiberius, 44. PAMPHILUS; APELLES 563 thus the schools became three ; the Ionic, the Sicyonian, and the Attic, Eupompus himself being a Sicyonian. (76) By Pamphilus we have a family group, the victorious en- gagement of the Athenians at Phlius, and a picture of Odysseus on his raft. A Macedonian by birth, Pamphilus was the first painter who was thoroughly trained in every branch of learning, more particularly in arithmetic and geometry, without which, so he held, art could not be perfect. He taught no one for less than a talent — five hundred denarii ^ — a year — the fee paid him both by Apelles.and by Melanthius. (77) It was owing to his influence that first at Sicyon, and afterward throughout Hellas, drawing, or rather painting, on tablets of boxwood was the earliest subject taught to freebom boys, and that this art was accepted as the preliminary step toward a hberal education. At all events it was held in such honor that at all times the freeborn and afterward persons of distinction practised it, while by standing prohibition no slaves might ever acquire it ; and this is why neither in painting nor in statuary are there any celebrated works by artists who had been slaves. . . . (79) In the hundred and twelfth Olympiad " Apelles of Cos excelled all painters who came before or after him. He of himself perhaps contributed more to painting than all the others together ; he wrote treatises, too, on the theory of his art. The grace of his genius remained quite unrivalled, although the very greatest painters were living at the time. He would admire their works, praising every beauty and yet observing that they failed in the grace, called charis in Greek, which was distinctly his own. Everything else they had attained ; in this alone none equalled him. (80) He laid claim to another merit ; while admiring a work of Protogenes that betrayed immense industry and the most anxious elaboration, he said that, though Protogenes was his equal or even his superior in everything, he yet surpassed that painter in one point — namely in knowing when to take his hand from a picture — a memorable saying, which shows that too much care may often be hurtful. His candor was equal to his genius; he acknowledged the supe- riority of Melanthius in the distribution of figures, and that of Ascle- • In the time of Pliny a denarius was about 16 cents. ' 332-329 B.C. 564 PERSONALITY, LITERATURE, AND ART piodorus in perspective arrangement, that is, in giving accurate distances between different objects. (81) A neat story is told of him in cormection with Protogenes, who was living at Rhodes. Thither Apelles sailed, eager to see the works of a man known to him only by reputation, and on his arrival immediately repaired to the studio. Protogenes was not at home, but a solitary old woman was keeping watch over a large panel placed on the easel. In answer to the questions of Apelles, she said that Protogenes was out and asked the name of the visitor. 'Here it is,' said Apelles, and snatching up a brush, he drew a Kne of great deUcacy across the board. (82) On the return of Protogenes the old woman told him what had happened. When he had con- sidered the delicate precision of the line, he at once declared that his visitor was Apelles, for no one else could have drawn anything so perfect. Then in another color he drew a second still finer line upon the first, and went away, bidding her show it to Apelles if he came again, and add that this was the man he was seeking. It fell out as he had expected : Apelles did return, and ashamed to be beaten, drew a third line of another color cutting the two first down their length and leaving no room for any further refinements. (83) Protogenes owned himself beaten and hurried down to the harbor to find his visitor. They agreed to hand down the painting just as it was to posterity, a marvel to all but especially to artists. It perished, I am told, in the first fire of the house of the Caesars on the Palatine. Formerly we might look upon it; its wide surface disclosed nothing save lines which eluded the sight, and among the numerous works of excellent painters it was like a blank, and it was precisely this feature that lent it surpassing attraction and renown. (84) Apelles further made it an unvarying rule never to spend a day, however busy, without drawing a line by way of practise ; hence the proverb.^ It was also his habit to exhibit his finished wbrks to the passers-by in a balcony, and he would he concealed be- hind the picture and listen to the faults that were found with it, re- garding the public as more accurate critics than himself. (85) There is a story that when found fault with by a cobbler for putting one loop too few on the inner side of a sandal, he corrected the mis- take. Elated by this, the cobbler next d^y proceeded to find fault • The proverb is Nulla dies sine linea (No day without a line) ; Sellers, note. APELLES 56s with the leg, whereupon Apelles thrust out his head in a passion and bade the cobbler 'stick to his last,' a saying which has also passed into a proverb. . . . (88) His portraits were such perfect likenesses that, incredible as it may sound, Apio the grammarian has left it on record that a physiognomist was able to tell from the portraits alone how long the sitter had to live or had already lived. (89) When in Alexan- der's train he had been on unfriendly terms with Ptolemy, during whose reign he was once driven into Alexandria by a violent storm. As Apelles appeared at a banquet, to which his rivals had maliciously induced the king's fool to invite him, Ptolemy flew into a passion, and pointing to his chamberlains bade him say from which of them he had received his invitation. Thereupon the painter, snatching up a charred stick from the hearth, traced on the wall a likeness whose first strokes the king at once recognized as the face of the fool. (90) He also painted a portrait of king Antigonus, who was blind of one eye; and he was the first to devise a means of con- cealing the infirmity by presenting his profile, so that the absence of the eye would be attributed to the position of the sitter merely, not to a natural defect ; for he gave only the part of the face which could be shown uninjured. There are among his works some pic- tures of dying people, though it were difficult to say which were best. (91) His Aphrodite rising from the sea was dedicated by the deified Augustus in the temple of his father Csesar. She is known as the Anadyomend, being like other works of the kind at once eclipsed yet rendered famous by the Greek epigrams written in her praise. When the lower part was damaged, no one could be found to restore it, and thus the very injury redounded to the glory of the artist. In time the panel of the picture fell to decay, and Nero when princeps substituted for it another picture by the hand of Dorotheus. (92) Apelles had begun another Aphrodite at Cos, intending to surpass even the fame of his earlier achievement, but when only a part was finished envious death interposed, and no one was found to complete the outlines already traced. Further he painted, for twenty talents, in the temple of Artemis at Ephesus a portrait of Alexander holding a thunderbolt. The fingers seem to stand out 566 PERSONALITY, LITERATURE, AND ART and the thunderbolt to project from the picture. The reader should remember that all this was done with four colors. For this picture he was paid in gold coins, reckoned not by number but by measure. (93) He painted too the train of a megabyzus, or priest of Artemis at Ephesus, Cleitus on horseback going out to battle, and the pic- ture of a squire handing a helmet to one who asks for it. It were vain to enumerate the number of times he painted Alexander and Philip. At Samos we admire his Habron, at Rhodes his Menander king of Caria and his Antaeus, at Alexandria his Gorgosthenes the tragic actor, at Rome Castor and Polydeuces with Victory and Alexander the Great, and also a figure of War with his hands bound behind his back, and Alexander riding in triumph in a chariot. (94) These two pictures had been placed in the most crowded parts of his Forum with the restraint of good taste by the deified Augus- tus ; but the deified Claudius thought fit to cut out in both the face of Alexander and substitute that of Augustus. The Heracles with averted face, in the temple of Diana, is also attributed to Apelles ; by a triumph of art the picture seems not only to suggest, but actually to give the face. Moreover he painted a nude hero, a picture which challenges comparison with Nature herself. (95) A horse also exists, or did exist, painted for a com- petition, in which he appealed from the judgment of men to that of dumb beasts. When he saw that his rivals were likely to be placed above him through intrigue, he caused some horses to be brought in and showed them each picture in turn. They neighed only at the horse of ApeUes, and this was invariably the case ever afterward, so that the test was applied purposely to afford a dis- play of his skill. (96) He also painted Neoptolemus * on horseback fighting against the Persians, Archelaus in a group with his wife and daughter, and a portrait of Antigonus in armor advancing with his horse. Skilled judges of painting prefer among all his works his equestrian portrait of Antigonus and his Artemis amid a band of girls offering sacrifice, a painting thought to have excelled the lines of Homer '^ that describe the same scene. Further, he painted the unpaintable, thunder for example, lightning and thimder- bolts. . . . 'This Neoptolemus and the Archelafis following were officers of Alexander the Great; Sellers, note. ' Odyssey vi. 102 sgq. APELLES 567 (97) All have profited by his innovations, though one of them could never be imitated ; he used to give his pictures when finished a black glazing so thin that by sending back the light it could call forth a whitish color, while at the same time it afforded a protection from dust and dirt, only becoming visible itself on the closest in- spection. In using this glazing one main purpose was to prevent the brilliance of the colors from offending the eyes — the effect was as when they are looked at through talc — and also that when seen at a distance, those which were excessively vivid might be toned down.* > For an explanation of this rendering see Sellers, note. CHAPTER XVI ADMINISTRATION, INDUSTRY, AND EDUCATION IN THE HELLENISTIC KINGDOMS 337-30 B.C. A. ALEXANDER AND THE GREEK CITIES 172. Letter of Alexander to the People of Chios (333-332 B.C.) (Hicks and Hill, no. 158; Ditt., Syll. I. no. 150. Translated by W. L. W.) When Alexander invaded Asia, 334 B.C., Macedon was already an imperial state, and his position was a double one: he was king of Macedon and hege- mon (war-leader) of those Greek cities which had joined the league of the Hellenes established by Philip, his father, in the winter of 338-337 (no. 128). The Greek cities of the coast of Asia Minor, which were freed from Persia in the campaign of 334, added another and different element to the two "already under Alexander's sway. His plans for the final disposition of these cities, also his intentions in regard to the extent and the character of the authority of the council of the Hellenic league, are foreshadowed in this letter. The Persian admiral, Memnon, had occupied Chios in 333, and had estab- lished in power the oligarchic or Persian party, which had aided him in taking the city. Soon thereafter, probably in 332, the popular party handed the city over to the troops who were attempting to recapture it from the Persians. This letter was probably written immediately before the Macedonians retook the city. See Niese, B., Gesckichte der griechischen und makedonischen Staaien, I. 37-40; Ferguson, Greek Imperialism, ch. iv. When Dositheus was prytanis : ^ From Alexander to the demus of the Chians. The exiles from Chios are to return, all of them, and the form of government of Chios is to be a democracy. Law-givers * are to be chosen who shall write the laws and set them in order in such a way that nothing in them shall oppose the democracy or the return of the exiles. When arranged or written the laws are to be referred to Alexander. * The prytanis was the leading magistrate of the Chians by whose name the year was officially designated ; cf. Ditt., Syll. II. no. 570. ' A special committee. Called in Greek vofuiypiipoi. S68 STATUS OF THE CHIANS 569 The Chians are to furnish twenty triremes, with a full com- plement for them, and these are to sail so long as the rest of the naval force of the Hellenes shall sail with us. Of those who betrayed the city to the barbarians, as many as may already have escaped, are to be exiled from all the cities which have shared in the peace, and they are to be considered as outlaws according to the decree of the Hellenes. As many as may be cap- tured, are to be brought before the Council of the Hellenes for judgment. If any difficulty arises between the restored exiles and those in the city, they are to receive judgment in this matter in our presence. Until the Chians shall be reconciled, a garrison is to be stationed among them from Alexander, the king, as many as may be neces- sary. And the Chians shall support this garrison. 173. Award made by the Argive Assembly in a Case OF Arbitration (337-330 b.c.) (Hicks and Hill, no. 150; Ditt., Syll. II. no. 428. Translated by W. L. W.) The following award of the assembly of Argos is interesting as an example of Greek, arbitration and for the light it throws upon the use of the Common Council of the Hellenic League by Philip or Alexander. The date can only lie within a few years after the establishment of the Hellenic League by Philip II in 338-337 ; see Class. Journ. II (1906-1907), 197 sqq. IN god's name ! ^ The demus of the Argives has made the following decision in the case referred to it by the council of the Hellenes. The Cimo- lians and the Melians have agreed to abide by whatever decision the Argives might make regarding the islands. The judgment is that the islands Polyaegas, Etereia, and Libeia ^ belong to the CimoUans. They have adjudged that the CimoUans have won their case. Leon was priest in the second boulS of the year; Poseidaon was secretary of the boul^ ; Perillus was assistant. 1 Seis, an abbreviated prayer often found at the beginning of inscriptions. ' These are small islands l3ang near Cimolos and Melos. S70 THE HELLENISTIC KINGDOMS B. THE ROYAL DOMAINS IN ASIA UNDER ALEXANDER AND HIS SUCCESSORS 174. Edict of Alexander Regarding Priene and the Royal Domains in its Vicinity (334 b.c.) (Hicks and Hill, no. 1 55 ; Ditt., Or. grcec. inscrs. no. i. Translated by W. L. W.) When the westernmost portion of the Persian empire fell to Alexander by conquest, 334-333, a new administrative problem of vast importance was presented to the young king. This was the question of the handling of the royal domains of the Persian ruler. The elements at that time comprised within Alexander's sway may best be listed under four divisions, partly terri- torial and partly ethnic. They were the kingdom of Macedon, the Hellenic league, the Greek cities of Asia Mmor, and the conquered Persian territory. To each of these elements Alexander stood in a peculiar relation ; he was king of Macedon, hegemon of the Hellenic league, liberator of the Greek cities of Asia (he addresses them as king), and to the conquered population he was suc- cessor to the power and appurtenances of the Persian king. All this is shown in the present edict. The land about Priene was divided into the domain of that city-state, and the royal domain, which belonged by conquest to Alexander. The royal domains paid the pharos, tribute, the city-states a syntaxes, contribu- tion, unless as here they were especially exempt. This was the beginning of the problem of the royal domains confronting Alexander and his successors. EDICT OF KING ALEXANDER Of those settled in Naulochon,^ as many as are Prienians are to be autonomous and free, keeping their plots of ground and all their houses in the city * and their country property . . . {two broken lines). . . . And all the land round about I regard as my own,' and that they who dwell in these villages bear the tribute (phoros). I absolve the city of the Prienians from the contribution {syntaxis) and the guard for which. . . . 175. The Feudal Estates of the Persian Nobles (Plutarch, Eumenes, 8. Translated by W. L. W.) When Eumenes of Cardia, after defeating Craterus and Neoptolemus in Phrygia, 321, was preparing to defend his rights against the combined forces of the Macedonian generals, he found himself in financial straits. In order to ' Naulochon was the harbor of Priene, situated at the mouth of the Maeander river. ' This must refer to Piiene, since Naulochon was not a city. 'The land rdund about is therefore x"*?" jSoo-iXi/ci) (royal domain), and distinct from the land belonging to the city-state of Priene, as does Naulochon. LAND-HOLDING 571 keep the loyalty of his Macedonian troops, it was necessary to devise a method of paying them. The means he employed throws light upon the agrarian con- ditions then existing in Phrygia. A land-holding nobility evidently controlled great estates, and owned the peasants who tilled the soil, governing them from their tetrapyrgiai, 'four-turreted castles.' Eumenes had accepted the theory of Alexander that the domains of the conquered Persians were the spoils of the conqueror (no. 174). See Rostowzew, Romisches Kolonat, 253 sq. He had promised to give the soldiers their pay within three days. He therefore sold them the farms and turreted castles in the country district with their peasants ^ and cattle. The captain of a Mace- donian company or the officer of a foreign troop who bought these places captured them by siege, using war implements and siege engines furnished by Eumenes. Thereupon the soldiers divided each of the captured places proportionally according to the pay due them. 176. The Alienation of Royal Domains by the Successors OF Alexander (306-303?) {Am. Journ. Arch. XVI (1912). 12-82; Rostowzew, Romisches Kolonat, 248-53. Translated by Buckler "land Robinson.) This document is the record of a mortgage deed made out by a certain Mnesimachus to the treasury of the goddess Artemis, as represented by the priests of her temple at Sardis. The inscription was discovered in 19 10 by the American archaeologists, W. H. Buckler and D. M. Robinson, on one of the in- ner walls of the opisthodomus, or treasury, of the temple of Artemis. The circumstances which led to the mortgaging of these estates, which were evi- dently very large, can only be learned from the document itself . They are as follows : At some period before the date of the mortgage Antigonus Monophthahnos, in control of Asia Minor with the title of king from 306 to 301, made a large grant of lands in Lydia to this Mnesimachus, for reasons which do not appear. This grant is probably to be placed before 306, since Antigonus was not ad- dressed as king at the time when the grant was made (lines i and 2). Mnesi- machus was compelled later to borrow 1325 gold staters from the treasury of Artemis. When the loan became due he was unable to pay the debt. He, therefore, mortgaged the estates which he had received from Antigonus, to the goddess Artemis under a form called Trpao-ts tiri k-icra, ' sale subject to redemption.' The limit of the period of redemption is lost through an erasure of a part of the inscription. The present inscription is a copy of the original ' The Greek word triiiiara undoubtedly includes the serfs of these manorial es- tates as well as the slaves. 572 THE HELLENISTIC KINGDOMS mortgage. It was inscribed on the temple wall most probably after the period of redemption was past. It therefore represents a title-deed to the property, which fell to the temple at the end of the period of redemption. The document illustrates the attitude of Alexander's immediate successors toward the domain land of the former Persian kings. In western Asia the tendency followed by the Seleucids was to lessen these royal domains by gift or sale of large tracts to individuals or to city-states. The information that may be gleaned regarding the position of the peasants is one of the most im- portant features of this selection. Column I . . . Chaireas ' having made inquiry . . . and afterwards An- tigonus awarded the estate to me. Whereas now the temple- wardens are demanding from me the gold lent on deposit and be- longing to Artemis, but I have no funds wherewith to pay it to them, there are then the items of which the estate consists ; to wit, the villages named as follows : Tobalmoura, a village in the Sardian plain on the Hill of Ilus, and as appurtenances thereto other villages also : Tandus, as it is called, and Kombdilipia ; the rent payable by the said villages to the chiliarchy ^ of Pytheus ... is fifty gold staters a year. There is also an allotment at Kinaroa near Tobal- moura. Its rent is three gold staters a year. There is also another village, Periasasostra, in the River District of Morstas; its rent payable to the chiliarchy of ... arius, is fifty-Seven gold staters a year. There is also in the River District of Morstas an allotment at Nagrioa ; its rent, payable to the chiliarchy of Sagarins, son of Coreis, is three gold staters and four gold obols. There is also another village in the district of Attouda called Ilus' village; its rent is three gold staters and three obols. Now from all the villages, and from the allotments and the dwelling^plots thereto appertaining, and from the serfs {rSiv \a&v) with all their households and be- longings, and from the wine- vessels and the dues rendered in money ' Who Chaireas was and the nature of his inquiry cannot be determined because of the mutilation of the inscription. ' The chiliarchies were subdivisions of the satrapy of Lydia, evidently financial in character. The chiliarchy of Pytheus adjoined and probably included the city of Sardis. The editors are inclined to differentiate the chiliarchy of ... arius, pladiig it in the eastern part of the Lydian satrapy, from that of Sagarius, which they place on the Phrygian border of Lydia. The only known Attouda lies on the Lydian-Phry- gian border. ALIENATION OF ESTATES 573 and in labor, and from the revenues of other kinds accruing from the villages and still more beside these when the division took place, Pytheus ^ and Adrastus ^ received as their separate property a farmstead at Tobalmoura; and outside the farmstead are the houses of the serfs and slaves, and two gardens requiring fifteen artabas ' of seed, and at Periasasostra dwelling-plots requiring three artabas of seed, and gardens requiring three artabas of seed, as well as the slaves dwelling at that place : at Tobalmoura, Ephesus, son of Adrastus ; Kadoas, son of Adrastus ; Heraclides, son of Beletras ; Tuius, son of Maneus the son of Caicus; also those dwelling at Periasasostra, Kadoas son of Armanandes, Adrastus son of Ma- neus. . . . Column 2 neither to me [nor to my heirs, nor ...]... nor to anyone else any longer the right of redemption. Should any person lay claim to any of the villages or of the allotments or to the other things here specified in writing, I and my heirs will act as warrantors, and will oust the claimant. If, however, we shall fail so to act, or if we shall commit any breach of the contract hergby drawn up in respect to the villages and the allotments and the lands and all the slaves, these shall remain the property of Artemis, and the temple-wardens shall on account of the same conduct legal proceedings and obtain judgment against the claimants in any way that they may see fit ; and I Mnesimachus and my heirs will pay to the treasury of Artpmis 2650 gold staters ; * and on account of the produce and of the fruits, should the temple-wardens receive no fruits in that year, we will further pay to the treasury of Artemis such sum in gold as the same may be worth ; and the value of the buildings erected and of the lands brought imder cultivation by Artemis, or of such other things as the temple-wardens may do, whatever the same may be worth, we will pay ; and so long as we shall not have paid, the debt ' This Pytheus may be the chiliarch mentioned before. But the identity of the two is uncertain. ' This Adrastus must have been some important person, and cannot be identified with the father of the slaves mentioned below. The farmstead once owned by Pytheus and Adrastus is now listed in the property of Mnesimachus. ' The artaba was a imit of measure equaling about SS-S liters. The measure here used was the Persian artaba. * The Macedonian gold stater was worth about $4.70. S74 THE HELLENISTIC KINGDOMS shall continue a deposit-loan owing by us till we shall have paid the whole amount. Should the king on account of Mnesimachus take away from Artemis the villages or the allotments or any of the other things mortgaged, then the principal in gold of the deposit-loan, namely the 1325 gold staters, we ourselves — I Mnesimachus and my heirs — will forthwith pay to the treasury of Artemis ; and the value of the buildings erected and of the lands brought under cultivation by Artemis, whatever they may be worth, we wiU pay forthwith ; and on account of the produce and the fruits, should they receive no fruits in that year, we will further pay to the treasury of Artemis such sum in gold as the same may be worth ; and so long as we shall not have paid, the debt shall constitute a deposit-loan owing by me and my heirs until we shall have paid the whole to the treasury of Artemis ; and so long as this still remains unpaid by us, execution shall be lawful. 177. Alienation of Royal Domains by the Seleucids (Ditt. Or. grcec. inscrs. no. 221. Translated by W. L. W.) On this inscription see introduction to no. 176. The documents given under this heading illustrate the transfer of land from the Royal Domain to the Land Register of a city-state; see Droysen, Geschichte des Eellenismus, n. 2..377; Haussoullier, ini?CT. rfePAJioZogie, XXV (i90i).30S59. ; Rostowzew, Romisches Kolonat, 247 sqq. When a sale or gift occurred it was necessary that the transfer of the property be recorded upon the official registers containing the records and the plots of the Royal Domain. Since, for purposes of taxation, all the land must appear somewhere upon the state records, when any tract was to be sold or given away it became necessary to cancel that tract from the land register of the Royal Domain and transfer it to the land register of the city-state concerned. In other words, the great sources of revenue of the Seleucid state were two ; namely, the phoros, or tribute, from the Royal Domains, and the taxes which came in from the city-states. The peasants and the land, therefore, must be found enrolled either upon the register of the Royal Domains or upon that of some city-state. When land was alienated by sale or gift from the Royal Domain, the buyer or the person receiving the land was usually permitted to assign the land and its serfs to any city-state which he desired. The land thereupon became a part of the city-state territory. The following document contains three letters of Antiochus, king of Syria, in all probability Antiochus I (280-261 B.C.), addressed to Meleager, governor of the Hellespontine satrapy. In these letters Antiochus gives orders to Meleager to measure off to a certain Aristodicides, a portion of the Royal Domain in the A ROYAL GRANT 575 neighborhood of Ilium. Aristodicides is permitted to register the land thus granted him in any one of a group of neighboring city-states. Of the several cities which were anxious to have this territory attached to their city-state domain, he had selected lUum. Then Meleager sent copies of the three letters of the king to the people of Ilium, headed by a letter from himself to them (I). In this letter Meleager advises them to pay the customary honors to Aristodi- cides. I. Meleager to the BoulS and the Demus of Ilium, greeting: Aristodicides of Assos has given me letters from the king, Antio- chus, copies of which I have appended below for you. He also ap- peared in person before me and stated that many others also were discussing the matter with him and granting him a crown ; and I also know this to be true, because certain of the cities have sent em- bassies to me. Despite this he said that he desired the land granted to him by the king, Antiochus, to be attached to your city, both because of the temple and because of his good-will toward you. What he then desires to receive from your city, he himself will declare to you. You would do well to vote him all the customary decrees of friendship and to make a copy, according as he may agree, and inscribe it on a stele ^ and set it up in the temple, in order that the agreements may remain secure for you for all time. II. King Antiochus to Meleager, greeting : We have granted to Aristodicides of Assos two thousand plethra ^ of arable land, to be attached to the city of Ilium or of Scepsis. You, therefore, give or- ders to furnish to Aristodicides from the domain adjoining Gergitha or Scepsis, wherever you may judge best, the 2000 plethra of land, and attach it to the dty of Ihum, or of Scepsis. Farewell. III. King Antiochus to Meleager, greeting: Aristodicides of Assos has appeared before us asking that we give him Petra in the satrapy of the Hellespont, which Meleager' formerly held, and 1500 plethra of the arable land of the district of Petra and 2000 plethra more of arable land from that which borders upon the grant already made to him. And we have given Petra to him, unless it has already been given to another, and the land near Petra and ' A stele was a stone slab. ' A plethrum was a Greek unit of measure falling a little short of a quarter of an acre. ' This Meleager is a dififerent man from the satrap of the Hellespontine satrapy to whom the letter is addressed. 576 THE HELLENISTIC KINGDOMS 2000 plethra more of arable land, because he has shovm himself to have been our friend with all good will and eagerness. Do you therefore look to see whether this district has alrea,dy been given to another, and, if not, transfer it and the land around it to Aris- todicides ; and give orders to have measured off and transferred to him 2000 plethra from the royal domain bordering upon the land formerly given to Aristodicides, and allow him to register it with whatsoever city he may desire of those in the district and in the alliance. We have given orders to Aristodicides to permit the Royal Peasants ^ of the district in which Petra lies, to dwell in Petra if they wish to do so for the sake of safety. Farewell. IV. King Antiochus to Meleager, greeting. Aristodicides has come to us, asserting that he has not even yet received the place Petra and the land belonging with it, regarding which we have formerly written a letter granting it to him, through the fact that it had already been alloted to the Athenaeum,* the one at the harbor. And he has requested that, in place of the Petrite land an equal number of plethra be transferred to him, and that 2000 plethra more be granted him, to be registered with whatsoever city he may wish of those in our alliance, just as we wrote formerly. Seeing, then, that he is well-disposed and eager in our affairs we wish to be very careful of this man and have agreed to these things. He says that the part of the Petrite land granted to him was 1500 plethra. Give orders, therefore, to measure off and transfer to Aristodicides 2500 plethra of arable land, and, in place of that around Petra, 1500 plethra more of arable land from the Royal Domain bordering upon that given to him by us in the beginning. Permit Aristodicides, also, to register the land with whatsoever city he may wish of those in our alliance, just as we wrote in the former letter. Farewell. 1 The Greek is jSao-iXticat \aol. 'The temple aad precinct of the goddess Athena. RECORD OF A SALE 577 178. Alienation of Royal Domain by the Seleucids : Decree Recording the Sale of a Tract near Cyzicus (253 b.c.) (Ditt. Or. grcec. inscrs. no. 225. Translated by W. L. W.) The following document is the record of a sale to Laodice, queen of Antio- chus II, of a tract of the Royal Domain near Cyzicus. The upper portion of the stone is lost. It consisted, first, of the order of Nicomachus, oeconomus of the Hdlespontine satrapy, to the under-official, ...crates the h3T)arch, who is to see to it that this transfer is properly made. Below this order of Nicomachus stood the letter of Metrophanes, satrap of the Hellespontine satrapy, to Nicomachus, which contained a copy of the letter of King Antiochus II to Metrophanes. The inscription begins in the midst of the king's letter, III. Section IV is a copy of the official record by the hyparch, ... crates, of the transfer of the property. The actual steps taken in executing the sale occurred in the reverse order : i. Sale by the king to Laodice ; 2. the king writes to the satrap Metrophanes; 3. Metrophanes writes to Nicomachus, the oeconomus, who has charge of the Royal Domains in the Hellespontine satrapy, sending a copy of the king's letter ; 4. Nicomachus writes to an under official, the hyparch, who is in charge of the Royal Domain in the same satrapy, sending to him copies of Metrophanes' letter and the king's letter. 5. The hyparch adds to these three documents a copy of the record of sale and has them published in five places in accordance with the king's orders. Of these five copies of the correspondence our inscription is the one placed in the temple of Apollo at Didyma near Miletus. When portions of the Royal Domain were granted away or alienated by sale, the tract was transferred to the register of some city-state. The laoi, or serfs, did not ordinarily become the serfs of the individual who received the land. With the land they were attached to some city-state and became serfs upon the books of that city-state. That fact does not appear clearly defined in this document, probably because Laodice was a member of the royal household and the royal prerogative of owning serfs seems to be per- mitted her. See Rev. de PhUol. XXV (1901). 9 sqq. ; Rostowzew, RSmisches Kolonat, I. 243-53 ; Klio, 295-99, .424-26. Ill . . . (Laodice has bought) the village of Pannos and what- ever other (village) shall be formed later, and whatever places ^ fall within the territory, and the peasants (laoi) bebnging to them, with their entire households and all their possessions together with, the revenues of the fifty-ninth year," for thirty talents of silver. ■Yo Y^~ :-' * The meaning of the word " places " {rhirovt) is not clear. It seems to refer to the homesteads within the districts which are not in the village itself. * This is the fifty-ninth year of the Seleucid era, which dates from the year 312 B.C., when Seleucus I established his power in Babylon. S78 THE HELLENISTIC KINGDOMS Furthermore whatever laoi of this village have gone into other places belong to her on the understanding that she shall pay nothing into the royal treasury, and that she shall have the right to assign them to whatever city she may wish. Likewise those who have bought or received land from her shall have full possession of it, and shall attach it to whatever city-state they wish, unless Laodice happen to have attached it beforehand to a city ; and in that case they shall have proprietary rights wheresoever the land has been attached by Laodice. As to the purchase price, we have ordered that it be paid into the military treasury in three payments, the first to be made in the month Audnaeus ^ of the sixtieth year, the second in Xandicus, the third in the third month thereafter. Give orders to hand over to Arrhidaeus, who manages the es- tates of Laodice, the village and Baris ^ and the adjoining territory and the laoi with all their households and possessions, and to have the purchase booked in the royal archives at Sardis, and inscribed upon five stone stelae. Order that one of these stones be set up at lUum in the temple of Athena, the second in the -temple of Samo- thrace, the third in the temple of Artemis in Ephesus, the fourth in Didyma in the temple of Apollo, the fifth in Sardis in the temple of Artemis. Give orders straightway to deUmit the land and to mark it with terminal stones and to inscribe the boundaries upon the aforesaid stelae. . . . {Three fragmentary lines) IV. There has been handed over to Arrhidaeus, the overseer of the estates of Laodice by ... crates the hyparch, the village and Baris and the adjoining territory according to the order of Nico- machus, to which has been subjoined the letter from Metrophanes and the one from the king to him giving orders to mark off the territory. Upon the East, stretching from the territory of Zeleia to that of Cyzicus, the boundary line is the royal road, the old one, passing near the village of Pannos, above the village and Baris, the one pointed out by Menecratus, son of Bacchius, of the village of Pythes, and Daiis, son of Asaretus, and Medeus, son of Metrodorus, of the village of Pannos. It has been ploughed up by those living ' Audnaeus and Xandicus are names of months in the Macedonian calendar. ' Baris, a town situated on the right bank of the /Esepus River. AGREEMENT TO ARBITRATE 579 around the place. From this along past the altar of Zeus which lies above Baris to where the tomb Ues, on the right of the road. From this tomb the royal road is the boundary which traverses the Eupanese,^ to the river ^Esepus. Furthermore the territory has been marked off with stones following the boundaries indicated. 179. Agreement between the People of Pitana and Myti- lene to submit to arbitration a boundary dispute, AND THE Award made by the Pergamenes (middle of the second century B.C.) (Ditt. Or. greec. inscrs. no. 335. Translated by W. L. W.) As early as the seventh century B.C. the Greeks had already adopted the idea of arbitrating boundary questions and other disputes which arose between the different city-states. These must be regarded as real cases of interstate arbitration because the city-states concerned were, in the earlier period, politi- cally independent and approximately equal in military strength. In the period after the formation of the Hellenic League their freedom of independent action was, of course, curtailed. Philip of Macedon and Alexander made a conscious and apparent attempt to have the numerous disputes of the Greek states settled by arbitral decisions, using the Gener^ Council of the Hellenic League in the work. Under the Hellenistic kings who succeeded Alexander, many of the Greek states retained complete freedom and others a measure of their old independence in their foreign relations. The iEtolian and Achaean Leagues ac- knowledged the principle and resorted to the use of arbitration. We may, there- fore, regard the cases decided in that period as falling under the head of pure arbitration. With the advent of Rome and the ascendancy of the Roman senate in the affairs of the eastern Mediterranean the balance of power had so markedly shifted to the senate that it becomes increasingly difficult to deter- mine where arbitration ends and dictation to inferior and semi-dependent powers begins. It is safe to say that real arbitration between the Greek city- states ceased after 146 B.C. The following document is set together from twenty-five different fragments of a large stele of marble found in various places in the ruins of Pergamum. It deals with the arbitration of a dispute regarding the ownership of a large tract of land, situated on the mainland opposite Mytilene on the island of Lesbos. The document consi^s of three parts : I, the decree of the Pitanjeans by which the dispute is referra^ for arbitration to a board of five arbitrators from Pergamum ; II, a similar decree of the Mytilenaeans ; III, the award of the board of five arbitrators, containing an account of their investigation and a summary of the evidence presented by the Pitanaeans, who won the decision. 1 Eupanese is an imknown geographical term, possibly the name of a plain. S8o THE HELLENISTIC KINGDOMS The forms of the letters prove that the document was inscribed about the middle of the second century B.C. The summary of the evidence contains proof of the sale of the tract under dispute to the city-state of Pitana by Antiochus I from his Royal Domains. I. Decree of the Pitanmans The strategic have published the following statement: — The Pergamenes, our relatives and friends, well-disposed to our city from ancient times, have sent us a decree and an embassy regarding our outstanding differences with the Mytilenaeans. The embassy consists of Bacchius son of Eudemus, Apollodorus son of Athenodorus, Diogenes son of Asclepiades, Megistermus son of Attains, Scamon son of Asclapon. They have worked out together a plan for the removal of our differences . . . and the ambassadors, under this authority, have taken upon themselves much toil which is advantageous to both cities, and they have approached the task with a celerity and zeal worthy of the city which sent them out. Therefore it has seemed advisable to the assembly to pass a vote of thanks to the Pergamenes, the friends and relatives of our city, because not only in the present instance but also in the past they have shown a zealous friendship toward our people. . . . {The twelve following lines are too badly shattered to allow of translation or paraphrase. They contain a further declaration of the kindly relations between the Pergamenes and the Pitanceans.) ... we choose them as arbitrators ^ of our differences, since the Mytilenaeans also have agreed to select them as arbitrators. They shall be present at the place in the month called ... in Pitana, and ... by the Pergamenes, shall begin to take testimony and look at the matter from the standpoint of each party, shall report their award upon oath, and shall give a written declaration of their findings to each of the cities. Their decision is to be authoritative and not subject to alteration. Likewise also they shall inscribe upon a stele the agreements made, if accepted by both sides. And they shall also inscribe upon the stele the other boundaries there ' These are the highest magistrates in the city of Pitana. * The Pergamenes had requested that Pitana and Mytilene should accept the em- bassy named above as the arbitrating board. That request is here granted by the Pitanasans. A CASE OF ARBITRATION 581 which need to be defined, leaving nothing unfinished, on the ground that it does not pertain to them, not even if . . . But they shall decide everything alike, so that the causes of strife shall be entirely removed and no accusation or strife based upon difference of opinion shall be left. . . . {Five broken lines) . . . and to praise the ambassadors and invite them to a public banquet, and that the strategi are to see to it that these things are done. //. Decree of the Mytilenceans The boul^ and assembly has taken action regarding the decree passed by the assembly of the Pergamenes, which their appointed ambassadors have given to us : Bacchius son of Eudemus, Apollo- dorus son of Athanodorus, Diogenes son of Asclepiades, Megister- mus son of Attains, Scapon son of Asclapon. In this decree they have made clear that . . . {The following nineteen lines are so broken as to be unintelligible.) ... is given over to the same men as arbitrators of the matters in dispute, since the Pitanaeans also have agf eed to select them. They shall be present at the place in the month called ... in Mytilene, and ... by the Pergamenes, shall begin to take testimony and look at the matter from the standpoint of each party, shall report their award on oath, and shall give a written declaration of their findings to each of the cities. Their decision is to be authoritative and not subject to alteration. Likewise also they shall inscribe upon a stele the agreements made, if accepted by both sides. And they shall also inscribe upon the stele the other boundaries there which need to be defined, leaving nothing unfinished. {Seven lines which are badly broken) ... to praise the ambassadors for making the visit to Mytilene with devotion to their task and in a manner worthy of those who sent them out. ... ^ {Three broken hnes) ... let the kings ' invite them as guests to the Prytaneum * to 'These kings (^cwtX^es) were a board of magistrates at Mytilene. ' A public building an which the piytany, or committee of the senate, held its meetings. S82 THE HELLENISTIC KINGDOMS a pubKc banquet. Likewise let the strategi bring in a motion re- garding them within the period specified by law, that they are to be proxeni and citizens of our city. ///. Decree of the Pergamene Embassy (The first twenty lines are sadly broken. They contained a brief survey of the origin of the dispute and the empowering of the Pergamene embassy to act as a board of arbitration. The board of five first heard the statement of each party in the case. They then went out to examine the territory under dispute as is shown in the following passage.) . . . the one upon the ridge down to the stream, and as the road runs and the boundary stones lie to the road which bounds the ter- ritory of Pitana and the , and as the road runs and the boundary stones lie to the two rocks which . . . and from these to the meadow, as the boundary stone lies and the road leads to Asturene,* as the boundary stones lie to the road, and as the road leads and the boundiary stones lie along past Asturene to the tomb near the road, called the tomb of Epicratus ; and from this to the boundaries on the side toward Atarneus.* When all the differences had been re- moved, according to their agreement that not a single accusation or strife based upon difference of opinion should be left, and as they had declared in their decrees. . . . We went up to Pergamum . . . and swore the oath in the temple of the Dioscuri. . . . (The following ten lines are quite fragmentary. One line shows that the Pilaneeans introduced evidence taken from the historians in presenting their case.) . . . and after this when Seleucus conquered Lysimachus in battle and his son Antiochus' received the royal power, Antiochus sold the plain to them (the Pitanaeans) for 330 talents in addition to which he exacted 50 talents more. And they made written pledges regarding this transaction, Philetaerus * also giving • — ty talents to the Pitanaeans in connection with this matter, as they proved from a stele set up in our city in the temple of Athena. They, likewise ' A small town between Antandrus and Adramyttium on the south shore of the Adramyttian Gulf. ' A smaU town on the mainland opposite Lesbos. ' These are the two famous Diadochi, Seleucus I and Ly^machus, who was defeated and killed in a battle with Seleucus near the Hellespont in 281 B.C. Antiochus Soter succeeded his father Seleucus as king of Syria in that year. * The eunuch who founded the power of Pergamum and died in 263 B.C. THE ARBITRAL AWARD 583 proved that absolute possession and dominion over the territory had been conceded them also by the rulers through the documents upon the distribution of territory, showing this irrefutably from the stelae set up in Ilium, Delos and Ephesus, upon which the letter of Antiochus regarding the possession of this territory is recorded in full. And they also furnished testimony to the effect that Eumenes,^ when he assumed control of affairs, ratified the letter of Seleucus to the Pitanseans. In this letter, among other things, he wrote word for word, as follows : 'We also grant for all time the undisputed possession and complete dominion over this territory already agreed upon.' . . . (0/ the remaining fifteen lines very few words are left. It is evident that the award was in favor of the Pitanaans.) See Tod, Greek International Arbitration; Westermann, " Interstate Arbitration in Antiquity," in Class. Journ. II (1907). 197-211. C. GOVERNMENT OF EGYPT UNDER ALEXANDER, AND THE WHEAT MARKET 180. Oppression of Cleomenes, Financial Governor of Egypt under Alexander (Pseudo- Aristotle, Economics, 33. Translated by W. L. W.) For ten years after it fell to Alexander Egypt was under the provisional government established by the young king; He won the sympathies of the Egyptian priesthood by showing a tactful toleration of the religious prejudices of the inhabitants. His use of the native nobility in the civil division of the provisional government must have helped him greatly in establishing his administration without serious friction. The system devised was threefold. The military government was under three leaders; two for the land troops and one for the navy. These were Macedonians or Greeks. The civil adminis- tration remained under the control of two nomarchs, the Egyptians Doloaspis and Petesis. The financial administration was centered in the hands of an able but unscrupulous Greek from Naucratis named Cleomenes. Owing to the fertility of Egypt this position was easily the most important of all, and Cleo- menes, during the long absence of Alexander in the east, was able to assume and maintain the practical authority of a governor of Egypt. His greed of money led him into oppressions which alienated all classes of the Egyptians, especially the priesthood and the mercantile class. When Ptolemy I assumed control of Egypt as satrap immediately after the death of Alexander, the execution of Cleomenes (322 B.C.) won for him the support of the most powerful elements • Eumenes was in control of affairs in Pergamum from 263 to 241 B.C. 584 THE HELLENISTIC KINGDOMS in the state. The methods of extortion employed by Cleomenes are disclosed in the following extracts from Pseudo- Aristotle, (Economica, 33, 1352 a. See Schafer, Demosthenes und seine Zeit (2d ed.), III. 293 sqq. When Cleomenes of Alexandria was satrap * of Egypt and a great famine raged in other coimtries, but only a moderate one in Egypt, Cleomenes put a stop to the export of grain. The no- marchs ^ asserted that they were unable to pay the tribute because they could not export the grain. Cleomenes therefore gave them the right to export, but placed a high price upon the grain, so that he received a high revenue, although little grain was exported, and put an end to the excuses of the nomarchs. When Cleomenes was travelling by boat through the noma in which the crocodile is a god, one of his slaves was seized by a crocodile. Simimoning the priests he stated that a wrong had been done him and that he wished to punish the crocodiles. So he gave orders to hunt them. In order that their god ihight not be subjected to insult the priests brought together all the money that they could collect and gave it to him, and so put an end to the affair. When King Alexander bade Cleomenes build a city near Pharos ' and locate there the market which had formerly been at the Canopic mouth of the Nile, Cleomenes sailed down the river to Canopus and went to the priests and the wealthy citizens and said that he had come there in order to settle them elsewhere. The priests and inhabitants of Canopus brought money and gave it to him in order to induce him to leave the market in their district. He took the money and sailed away. Later, when he was quite ready to begin the building, he sailed down again and demanded an immense sum from them, saying that it was a great advantage to him to have the market at the other place rather than at Canopus. 'When Alexander conquered Egypt in 332-331 B.C. it was under Persian sway, with a Persian governor at its head called a satrap. Cleomenes of Naucratis held the position of financial head of Egypt. The powers which he assumed while Alexander was in the eastern portion of the Persian Empire, gave him the position of an all- powerful governor. It is this position which the Greeks recognized under the false title of satrap. ' The leading administrative officials of the nomes. The division into nomes, and the officials called nomarchs are inheritances from the old Pharaonic lule. 'An island in the harbor of Alexandria upon which the famous lighthouse of Pharos was built tmder the first two Ptolemies. CLEOMENES 585 When they said that they could not possibly pay the money, he took them away as colonists. ' When grain was selling in the country at ten drachmas he summoned those engaged in the grain business and asked them at what price they were willing to sell to him. They responded that they would sell it at a lower price than that at which they sold to the retailers. He ordered them to deliver it to him at the same price at which they sold to the others. He then fixed the price of grain at thirty-two drachmas and disposed of it at that price. He called the priests to him and said that the expenditure upon the temples throughout the country was very great, and that the number of temples and priests must therefore be decreased. The priests individually and in common gave him the sacred treasures, thinking that Cleomenes was in truth about to decrease the number and each one wishing that his own temple should be left and he himself remain its priest. 181. Methods and ErrECTS of Cleomenes' Operations in Wheat (Demosthenes, Against Dionysodorus, 7-10. Translated by W. L. W.) The wheat manipulations of Cleomenes in Egypt were evidently conducted upon a large scale. For we know from the speech written by Demosthenes against Dionysodorus that men of the time who were conversant with questions of the grain trade considered Cleomenes partially responsible for the astounding rise in the price of grain at Athens in the years 330-326 B.C. The following extract is taken from a speech written by Demosthenes in a suit instituted against one Dionysodorus for breach of contract. Two other Athenians had lent this Dionysodorus 3000 drachmas which he needed to finance a shipment of grain from Egypt to Athens. As security for the loan they received a mortgage upon the ship. Dionysodorus, however, did not have his cargo of wheat or his ship brought to Athens, but unloaded and sold at Rhodes. After the cargo had been disposed of, he attempted to make a settlement, agree- ing to pay the loan with interest up to the time of the sale of the cargo at Rhodes. His creditors, the plaintiffs in this case, then sued him for the interest in full from the time when the loan was made until the time of the trial, a space of two years. See Kohler, in Atk. Mitt. VIII (1883). 211 sqq. According to this contract (the one just read), gentlemen of the jury, Dionysodorus and his partner, Parmeniscus, received the money from us and sent the ship away to Egypt. Par- meniscus sailed with the ship, but Dionysodorus remained here. S86 THE HELLENISTIC KINGDOMS For all of these men, gentlemen of the jury, — you should not be ignorant of this fact — were agents and accomplices of Cleo- menes, who ruled in Egypt, and who has done no little harm he and his agents, to your city and even more to the rest of the Greeks by buying and selling and combining to fix the price of wheat. For some of them shipped the grain out of Egypt, others sailed to the marketing centers, others remained here and dis- posed of the grain which had been shipped. Then those who were located here sent letters to those who were abroad, keeping them in touch with the current prices so that they might send the grain here if the price were high, or sail to some other market if the price of grain were rather low. Chiefly through these letters and part- nerships, gentlemen of the jury, the price of grain has been fixed. Now when these men sent away their ship from here, the price of grain was fairly high. Therefore they agreed in the contract a proviso that they should sail to Athens and into no other market. After that, gentlemen of the jury, when the Sicihan grain fleet re- turned and the price of grain fell and their ship had arrived in Egypt, Dionysodorus sent a man to Rhodes to announce the fall in price to Parmeniscus, his partner, who was stationed there. For he knew with certainty that the ship must necessarily put in at Rhodes. There the matter ended. For Parmeniscus, his part- ner, when he received the letter sent to him by Dionysodorus and learned the current price of grain here, unloaded the grain at Rhodes and sold it there. They thereby showed their contempt for the contract, gentlemen of the jury, and the punishments to which these men themselves subscribed in case they should in any way violate the contract. And they showed their contempt for your laws, which expressly order the ship-masters and merchants to sail into the market agreed upon, and subject them, if they do not do so, to the heaviest fines. 182.- Decree of the CotmciL and Assembly at Athens Touching upon the Grain Supply (Ditt. Syll. no. 152.; Kohler, in Ath. Mill. VIII (1883). 211 sqq. Translated by W. L. W.) Further light is thrown upon the effects of these manipulations and other conditions which conspired to send up the price of foodstuffs at Athens in the THE GRAIN SUPPLY 587 years 330-326 B.C., by a series of decrees of the Athenian senate and assembly which are given in translation below. Their purpose and content is clear. Much more difficult is the question of the order in which they were presented and their interrelation. II B, which appears first upon the stone, was the last in the series in point of time. Though there are five parts of the pubUshed decree, the senate and assembly actually handled the matter but twice. The first action was taken shortly after the archonship of Aristophon, 330- 329 B.C. During that administrative year Heraclides had shipped in the 3000 medimni ' of grain and relieved the famine by selling it at five drachmas the medimnus. This generosity gives rise to the first decree I A, I B, I C, of which the final form (I C) appears first on the stone. Telemachus, who introduced the first motion, was not a member of the senate. Therefore he could not speak or introduce a motion in the senate. Consequently he made the pre- liminary motion in the assembly (I A) asking that the senate frame a decree and present it before the assembly. This was done by the senate upon the mo- tion of Cephisodotus (I B). This prohouleuma, however, contains a clause which permitted the assembly to confer additional honors upon Heraclides. When the senate's report (I B) came down to the assembly for action, Telemachus took advantage of the fact to add the matter regarding an ambassador to Dionysius, tyrant of Heraclea, who was to demand satisfaction for an injustice done to Heraclides (I C). With this addition the decree was adopted by the assembly. The second decree (II A, II B) arose out of another philanthropic act of the same Heraclides, in the archonship of Euthycritus (328-327 B.C.). This was a gift to the city of 3000 drachmas for the purchase of grain. In consequence of this Phyleus, a senator, introduced a motion before the senate which was passed (II A). It came before the assembly and was there enacted as the will of the people (II B). To it was appended a provision for the publication of the entire business relating to Heraclides. II B. May the gods grant it. In the archonship of Anticles in the fifth prytany, that of the tribe Aigeis, in which Antiphon, son of Corcebus, the Eleusinian, was secretary, in the eleventh month,^ upon the thirty-fourth day of the prytany. For the proedri ' Philyllus the Eleusinian put the question. Demosthenes, son of Democles, of Lamptrae moved : ' The Attic medimnus was about one and one-half bushels. ' This is the eleventh month of the common or calendar year of twelve months. ' The proedri (irpieSpot) were a board of nine members of the bouIS selected by lot by the chairman of the prytany {iirurTiTris) before each meeting of the assembly, one being chosen from each tribe except the prytanizing tribe. They were the inter- mediaries between the boulS and assembly. One of the proedri, also selected by lot^ . became the chairman of the progdri {iviar&TTii twv irpoiSpuv) and was president of the assembly for that meeting. This system is not known before 378 B.C. Cf. Greenidge, Greek Constitutional History, p. 167. S88 THE HELLENISTIC KINGDOMS Since Heraclides the Salaminian ^ has always acted with liber- ality toward and done whatever service he could to the people of Athens, and, formerly, in the time of the grain famine, first among the merchants saiKng into the harbor, presented the city with 3000 medimni of wheat at five drachmas, and later, when the volun- tary contributions occurred, gave in 3000 drachmas for the purchase ' of grain, and in other matters has always been well-disposed and Uberal toward the people, the assembly has voted to praise Hera- clides, son of Charichdes, the Salaminian, and to crown him with a golden crown because of his good-will and liberality toward the Athenian people ; and that he is to be a proxenus ^ and well-doer of the Athenians, both he himself and his descendants, and that they are to have the right of possession of land and house accord- ing to the law ; ' and that they are to be subject to miUtary ser- vice and the special property-tax along with Athenians ; and that the secretary of the prytany is to have this decree and the other praises which have been accorded him * inscribed on a stone stele and set up upon the Acropolis ; and that the treasurer is to grant for the inscribing of the stele thirty drachmas out of the funds being expended by the assembly upon the publishing of decrees. I C. Telemachus son of Theangelus of Acharnae moved : Since HeracHdes the Salaminian was the first of the merchants sailing into the harbor in the archonship of Aristophon to give grain to the people at five drachmas, the assembly has voted to praise Heraclides son of Chariclides'the Salaminian and to crown him with a golden crown because of his liberality toward the Athenian people. And since his ship was brought to land by the Heracleans when he was saiUng to Athens and his sails were seized by them, it is hereby decreed that one man be chosen from the Athenians at large as ambassador who shall go to Heraclea to Dionysius* and demand that he give back the sails and for the future do no ' Salamis on the island of Cyprus. ' An honorary title, usually coupled with the title of well-doer (eiepyHiis) granted to aliens for especial services to the state. It implies that the recipient stands in a special relation of friendship with the city-state which confers the honor. ' The right of purchase and possession of real property, granted to aliens by these special decrees, was circumscribed by some general law. •These "praises" are those recorded in I A B C and 11 A. See introduction. ' Dionysius was tyrant of Heraclea on the Pontus from 337 to 305 B.C. HONORS TO HERACLIDES 589 injustice to any one who is sailing to Athens, and state that, by doing so, Dionysius will do what is right and will not fail in meeting with justice from the Athenian people. The treasurer of the people^ is to give fifty drachmas for travelling expenses to the ambassador who is chosen, out of the money being expended by the assembly upon the publishing of decrees. Thebagenes the Eleusinian was selected as ambassador. I A. Telemachus son of Theangelus of Acharnae moved: It is decreed by the assembly that the senate should frame a decree and present it to the first meeting of the ecclesia regarding Heraclides, by which he shall receive all possible benefit from the Athenian people. I B. Cephisodotus son of Euarchidus of Acharnae moved : Regarding the order which the assembly has given to the sen- ate to prepare a decree concerning Heraclides the Salaminian, the senate has voted as follows : Since Heraclides sailed to Athens with grain and gave to the people 3000 medimni at five drachmas each, let the chairmen (proedri) who happen to be in office bring Heraclides into the ec- clesia before the people and attend to the matter, and .present to the people as the opinion of the senate, that the senate has voted to praise Heraclides son of Chariclides, the Salaminian, and to crown him with a golden crown worth 500 drachmas ; and that he have and receive all possible benefit, in order that others also may display their liberality in the knowledge that the senate honors and crowns those who act with liberality. n A. Phyleus son of Pausanias of (Enoe moved : Since Heraclides the Salaminian sailed to Athens with grain in the archonship of Aristophon and gave to the people 3000 me- dimni at five drachmas, and on this account the assembly voted that the senate prepare a decree that he be brought before the assembly that he might receive all possible benefit from the Athenian people ; and since again, in the archonship of Euthycritus he gave 3000 drachmas for the purchase of grain, it has been voted ' i Tantas rov SiiiMu. A finance oflScial of Athens of the fourth century B.C. He made the payments for the expenditures ordered by the assembly, such as those for the publication of decrees, expenses of ambassadors, etc. The office was probably abolished in 310 B.C., as it does not appear in the documents published after that date. S90 THE HELLENISTIC KINGDOMS by the senate that the chairmen who may be in office for the regular ^ ecclesia bring HeracUdes before the people and attend to the matter and present to the people as the opinion of the sen- ate that the senate has voted to praise Heraclides son of Chariclides the Salaminian and to crown him with a golden crown worth 500 drachmas ; and that he is to have and receive from the people whatever benefit he seems worthy of, in order that others also may desire readily to confer benefits upon the senate and people, see- ing that those acting liberally. . . . {Two broken lines) D. THE LAND SYSTEM IN PTOLEMAIC EGYPT 183. Reversion of a Land-Grant to the Crown on the Death of the Holder (243-242 b.c.) (Jouguet, Papyrus grecs, no. 41 ; WUcken, Papyrmkunde, I. 2. no. 335. Trans- lated by W. L. W.) The papyri recently discovered in Egypt have given us an entirely new understanding of the fundamental economic and political fact which underlies the history and civilization of Egypt in the Hellenistic period. This fact is that there was no private ownership of agricultural land in Ptolemaic Egypt. The right of ownership in all cases rested with the king. A large part of this very fertile land along the Nile was worked directly by the government through farmers who stood in a special relation to the crown and formed a distinct class in the rural population of Egypt. They were called Royal Cultivators (Paa-iXiKol yempyoi) and the land thus leased by the state directly to small farmers was classified as Royal Land (yrj jSao-iXtK?;). A second large division of the* state's lands was called Land under Grant (yrj iv o^eW). This included i, the lands opeiated by the temples, or Sacred Land (y^ Upa) ; 2, Land under Gift (yv ^v Stopeot), or land assigned to favorites and nobles who enjoyed the usufruct, but did not have the right of ownership or administration over the cultivators upon their land ; 3, Cleruch Land (y? KXijpouxtK^), or land assigned to soldiers in active service. Upon these soldiers rested the burden of cultivating the land and paying in a portion of the produce to the state through its officials. The following document is a letter from one official to another regarding the confiscation of an allotment of cleruch land because of the death of the 1 Ws r^v Kvplav {nxXria-lav. There were four regular meetings in each prytariy. The first of these was distinguished as the Kvpla ^KKXijo-io, or sometimes as the Trpiirri iKKKilffta. According to law, matters of the grain supply were to come before this meeting. See Aristotle, Const. Ath. 43. 4. CLERUCH LAND 591 cleruch. Ammonius and Aristarchus are evidently official scribes, the former being of higher rank than the latter. The letter is dated in the fifth year of Ptolemy Euergetes I. The document shows clearly that the cleruch land belonged to the state. Ammonius to Aristarchus, greeting. Artemidorus, agent of Stratius, has written to us announcing the death of one of those who held allotments near Pharbaitha,^ an epilarch " of the merce- nary cavalry, Theodorus, son of Phantocles, the Selymbrian,* of the detachment of Eteoneus. Take back, therefore, his allot- ment into the Royal Treasury {^aaiXiKov), and regarding the produce * see to it that it is all brought into the Royal Treasury since the accounting is in your hands. Keep your health. Year 5,' Pharmouthi i8th ' 184. The Cleruch Allotments become Heritable (218-217 B.C.) (Jouguet, Pap. grecs, no. 4 ; Wilcken, Papyruskunde, I. 2. no. 336. Translated by W. L. W.) That the military allotments belonged to the Crown is evident from the foregoing document. It is also to be noted in this connection that these allot- ments were never, in the wills which come from the Ptolemaic period, made over by legal testament from father to son. The right of private ownership, there- fore, did not develop undpr the Ptolemies. The right of possession, however, tended to become hereditary if the father at his death left a son who might take up the military duties which went with the allotment. But the ownership of the land by the Crown is emphasized by the fact that the property is taken in charge for the BasiKkon upon the father's death and must be reassigned to the son. The docimient marks an important step in the process of the development of inherited allotments. The entire correspondence evidently comes from the bureau of Stratocles and Lamiscus, who are two officials of equal powers in charge of the arrange- ments for military allotments (syntaxis officials). The first two groups of ' A village, known in the Ptolemaic and Roman periods, of the Faymn district. ' An oflScer of low rank in the Ptolemaic cavaby. ' From the Thracian city of Selymbria on the Propontis. The Thracians were well represented in the armies of the Ptolemies. * When the allotments (KXrjpoi) were taken back by the state, all the annual pro- duce reverted to the state. ' The year five of the reign-of Ptolemy III Euergetes I. 'Pharmouthi is the Egyptian month corresponding to March ayth-April 2Sth in our calendar. 592 THE HELLENISTIC KINGDOMS letters (I and II) are letters written /row their bureau, group III was written to their bureau. The officials who play a part in this complicated system of public accounts appear to stand in the following relation : Marsyas and Straton. Colleagues in some high "" financial office. Stratocles and Lamiscus, over military allotments I Horus, Royal Secretary — Heraclides, (Economus Theogenes, who makes the contracts with the cleruchs on military allotments. The two names, Hedulus and Dexandrus, seem to be those of two cleruchs (land-leasing soldiers) who had died. In I C arrangements are made so that the "produce" which the sub-lessees of the dead adjutant would have paid to him, may be taken over by the Basilikon. Also in II B the officials are giving orders that the government may get aU the proceeds of the sale of wine from the allotments of the dead adjutant, untU the allotment shall be reassigned. The object of the letter III B seems to be to acquaint the lower official, The- ogenes, with the fact that the allotment had been reassigned by Lamiscus. What effect this would have upon the previous orders to Theogenes (I C) we cannot teU, because the end of the papyrus is misusing. I a. I have appended for you a copy of the letter written by Marsyas to us, that you may note its contents. Year 5,^ Appel- laeus 7th, Pachon 7 th.* b. Marsyas to Stratocles and Lamiscus greeting. We have appended for you a copy of the letter to Theogenes, that you may act in accordance with its instructions. Year 5, Hyperberetaeus 28th, Phamenoth ' 29th. c. To Theogenes. I have appended . . . the ex-epimeletes * of the year 5, Gorpiaeus — , Mecheir — , . . . the allotments, all • The yea* five of the reign of Ptolemy IV Philopator. ^Apellseus is a Macedonian month, Fachon the Egyptian month coTresponding to April 26-May 25. In the third century B.C. the Macedonian calendar and Egyptian calendar had not been brought into harmony. Throughout this docimient the correct date is that of the Egyptian calendar. ' Hyperberetaeus is a Macedonian month, Phamenoth the Egyptian month covering the period Feb. 2S-March 26. Throughout the document the two do not correspond. * The epimeletes is a finance official whose competence seems to have stretched over a portion of a nome. Cf. Wilcken, Papyruskunde I. i, pp. 149-50. A HERITABLE ALLOTMENT 593 of them, with the produce of the present year. Year 5, Hyper- beretaeus 22d, Phamenoth 23d. Hedulus, son of Hedulus. Dexandrus, son of Nicon. II a. i-jth.} To Horus. Copy of the letter to [Posidonius] Heraclides, the QEconomus. b. To [Posidonius] Heraclides. Give special orders to turn over the proceeds of the sale of the wine, made through the contract of the agent of Theogenes, into the royal revenues of the fifth year, to the ofl&cial Mettaleus in amount 42 drachmas . . . and give order that a receipt be made for it. III a. i8th.^ Straton to Stratocles and Lamiscus, greeting. I append for you a copy of the letter to Theogenes, that you may act in accordance with its instructions. Year 5, ApeUaeus 13th, Pachon 13 th. t b. To Theogenes. Lamiscus, the official in charge of the syntaxis,' wrote to us that , adjutant of the Macedonians hold- ing allotments of 30 arourae of seed-land in the Arsinoite nome, to whom and to whose descendants the land belongs, died upon Tybi 15th of the year 5. ... sent orders at the same time to Heraclides, the (Economus, and Horus, the Royal Secretary,* to take in charge the allotment for the BasUikon with the produce of this year's seed, until the allotment may be assigned within the period conforming to the decree, if the deceased has sons. Accord- ingly a letter was sent to you, year 5, Hyperberetaeus nth, Pha- menoth 12 th, bidding you give orders to take the allotment in charge for the BasiHkon with the produce as stated above. Since, then, Stratocles wrote later that . . . and that Lamiscus had as- signed. . . {Here the papyrus breaks of.) ' Date of the month Apellseus-Pachon, when this letter was sent out from the bureau of Stratocles and Lamiscus. ^ This letter was received by the bureau of Stratocles and Lamiscus. On tiie i8th of Apellsus-Pachon it, too, was sent on to Horus. ' ToO brl a-vvrd^em. This official has charge of the changes of the cleruch al- lotments. * The Pa The numbers in this selection have been supplied by the present editor. 6i4 FEDERAL UNIONS Sicyon under the leadership of Aratus made the union a power to be reckoned with in international affairs. From that time Aratus was the inspiring genius of the federation. Under his direction it adopted a vigorous policy of freeing aU Peloponnesus from despots and from Macedonian control and of annexing the individual states by negotiation or force. In addition to Polybius an important source is Plutarch, Aratus (cf. also Philopcemen). Pausanias, too, gives a brief sketch, from which a short excerpt is inserted below. The Achseans, as I have stated before, have in our time made extraordinary progress in material prosperity and internal unity. For though many statesmen had tried in past times to induce the Peloponnesians to join in a league for the conunon interests of all, and had always failed, because every one was working to secure his own power rather than the freedom of the whole ; yet in our day this policy has made such progress, and has been carried out with such completeness, that not only is there in the Peloponnese a community of interests such as exists between allies or friends, but an absolute identity of laws, weights, measures, and currency.^ All the states have the same magistrates, senate, and judges. Nor is there any difference between the entire Peloponnese and a single city, except in the fact that its inhabitants are not included within the same wall; in other respects, both as a whole and in their individual cities, there is a nearly absolute assimilation of institu- tions. It will be useful to ascertain, to begin with, how it came to pass that the name of the Achseans became the universal one for all the inhabitants of the Peloponnese. For the original bearers of this ancestral name have no superiority over others, either in the size of their territory and cities, or in wealth, or in the prowess . of their men. For they are a long way from being superior to the Arcadians and Lacedaemonians in number of inhabitants and extent of territory; nor can these latter nations be said to yield the first place in warlike courage to any Greek people whatever. Whence then comes it that these nations, with the rest of the in- habitants of the Peloponnese, have been content to adopt the constitution and name of the Achseans? To speak of chance in 1 Although each state had a right to legislate for itself, even to the extent of regu- lating its own weights, measures, and coinage, the advantages of uniformity in such matters brought about an assimilation. ORIGIN OF THE ACH^AN LEAGUE 615 such a matter would not be to offer any adequate solution of the question, and would be a mere idle evasion. A cause must be sought ; for without a cause nothing, expected or unexpected, can be accomplished. The cause, then, in my opinion, was this. No- where could be found a more unalloyed and deUberately established system of equality and absolute freedom, — in a word, of de- mocracy, — than among the Achaeans.* This constitution found many of the Peloponnesians ready enough to adopt it of their own accord : many were brought to share it by persuasion and argument : some though acting upon compulsion at first, were quickly brought to acquiesce in its benefits ; for none of the original members had any special privilege reserved for them, but equal rights were given to all comers : the object aimed at was therefore quickly attained by the two most unfailing expedients of equality and fraternity. This then must be looked upon as the source and original cause of Peloponnesian unity and consequent prosperity. (Pausanias vii. 7) What is called the Achaean league was by common consent the design and the work of the Achaeans. This federation was formed at ^gium because, next to Helice, which had been swept away by a flood, it had been the foremost town in Achasa in former times, and was at this time the most powerful. Of the other Greeks the Sicyonians first joined the Achaean league. Next to the Sicyonians some of the other Peloponnesians joined it, some immediately, others later ; and outside the Isthmus the motive that brought people in was the knowledge that the league was be- coming more and more powerful. The Lacedasmonians were the only Greeks who were unfriendly to the Achaeans and who openly took up arms against them. ' Polybius does not mean that the city-states of the league were absolutely demo- cratic ; for among them political rights were evidently based on property ; the idea is that each enjoyed the rights which in his opinion belonged to him, and was therefore contented with his condition. In like manner each state enjoyed a fair share in the central government.' 6i6 FEDERAL UNIONS 200. Officers of the League; its Fttrther Progress (Polybius ii. 43) At the time (255 B.C.) when a single general was substituted for two, a lieutenant general was instituted as an aid to the commander-in-chief (Polyb. V. 94; xxiii. 16). There were also a hipparch for the cavalry and a nauarch for the navy (Polyb. v. 94 sq.). The general was chosen annually and could serve any number of terms though not in successive years. For the first twenty-five years of the league between the cities I have mentioned, a secretary and two generals for the whole union were elected by each city in turn. But after this period they determined to appoint one general only, and put the entire manage- ment of the affairs of the union in his hands. The first to obtain this honor was Margus of Caryneia. In the fourth year after this man's tenure of the oflBice, Aratus of Sicyon caused his city to join the league,^ which, by his energy and courage, he had, when only twenty years of age, delivered from the yoke of its tyrant. In the eighth year again after this, Aratus, being elected general for the second time, laid a plot to seize the Acrocorinthus, then held by Antigonus ; and by success freed the inhabitants of the Pelopon- nese from a source of serious alarm : and having thus Uberated Corinth he caused it to join the league. In his same term of office he got Megara into his hands, and caused it to join also. These events occurred in the year before the decisive defeat of the Carthaginians, in consequence of which they evacuated Sicily and consented for the first time to pay tribute to Rome.^ Having made this remarkable progress in his design in so short a time, Aratus continued thenceforth in the position of leader of the Achaean league, and in the consistent direction of his whole poUcy to one single end; which was to expel the Macedonians from the Peloponnese, to depose the despots, and to estabUsh in each state the common freedom which their ancestors had enjoyed before them. ^ 249 B.C. ; see no. 199. * 242 B.C. FOREIGN RELATIONS 617 201. A Meeting of the Ach^an Assembly (Polybius xxii. 10-12) The highest authority in the league was a federal assembly, composed of all the citizens who wished to attend. The voting, however, was not by heads but by states (Livy xxxii. 22 sq.; xxxviii. 32). Naturally the citizens of any state first determined among themselves how they would vote, and then the vote of the state was cast according to their resolution. It would have been unfair to make a little state equal in power to a great city like Corinth ; and in fact we know that a large state, such as Megalopolis, was divided into cantons for the purpose of federal representation (Weil, in Zdisckr. f. Num. IX (1882), 224, cf. no. 203 and n. 3). Hence we infer that this principle prevailed through- out the league. In other words the votes were distributed according to popu- lation, seemingly on a principle like that which prevailed in the Boeotian league (no. 117). The assembly elected magistrates, declared war, contracted alliances, and in a word transacted aU the more important domestic and foreign affairs of the union. There was a council, too, whose mmiber is unknown. Evidently it represented the states according to population. It assembled frequently to attend to the routine duties of administration or to take measures for meeting an emergency such as a hostile invasion (cf. Polyb. iv. 7. 5; iv. 9). Though an admirable institution, the federal union was weak in that the central government possessed too little po'v^'er to conduct a war efficiently. The troops and supplies were furnished by the individual states ; and the federal government could exercise little more than moral suasion in bringing these resources into the field. 10. I have already stated that in the Peloponnese, while Philopoemen ^ was still general, the Achasan league sent an embassy to Rome on the subject of Sparta, and another to Eling Ptolemy to renew their ancient alliance. Immediately after Philopoemen had been succeeded by Aris- taenus as general, the ambassadors of King Ptolemy arrived, while the league meeting '^ was assembled at Megalopolis. King Eu- menes ' also had despatched an embassy offering to give the Achae- ans one hundred and twenty talents, on condition that it be in- vested and the interest used to pay the council of the league at the time of the federal assemblies. Ambassadors came also from King Seleucus, to renew his friendship with them and offering a ' Philopoemen, about 252-183, was a native of Megalopolis and one of the most distinguished generals and statesmen of the Achsean league ; see Plutarch, Philopcemen. ' 187 B.C. ' King of Pergamum. 6i8 FEDERAL UNIONS present of a fleet of ten ships of war. But when the assembly got to business, the first to come forward to speak was Nicodemus of Elis, who recounted to the Achseans what he and his colleagues had said in the Roman senate about Sparta, and read the answer of the senate ; which was to the effect that the senate disapproved of the destruction of the walls, and of the execution of the men put to death at Campasium,i but ^hat it did not rescind any arrange- ment made. As no one said a word for or against this announce- ment, the subject was allowed to pass. Next came the ambassadors from Eumenes, who renewed the ancestral friendship of the king with the Achfeans, and stated to the assembly the offer made by him. They spoke at great length on these subjects, and retired after setting forth the greatness of the king's kindness and affection for the nation. II. After they had finished their speech, ApoUonidas of Sicyon rose and said that, as far as the amount of the money was concerned, it was a present worthy of the Achaeans. But if they looked to the intention of the donor, or to the purpose to which the gift was to be applied, none could well be more insulting and more unconstitutional. The laws prohibited any one, whether a private individual or magistrate, from accepting presents from a king on any pretence whatever ; but if they took this money, they would every one of them be plainly accepting a present, which was at once the gravest possible breach of the law, and confessedly the deepest personal disgrace. For that the council should take a great wage from Eumenes, and meet to dehberate on the interests of the league after swallowing such a bait, was manifestly dis- graceful and injurious. It was Eumenes that offered money now ; presently it would be Prusias; and then Seleucus. But as the interests of democracies and of kings are quite opposite to each other, and as our most frequent and most important deliberations concern the points of controversy arising between us and the kings, one of two things must necessarily happen; either the interests of the king will have precedence over our own, or we ' As general of the league Philopoemen had conquered Sparta, razed the walls, introduced Achaean laws,- and annexed the city to the league. About two years after- ward the Spartans massacred some Achaean sympathizers in their city, whereupon the Achasan general retaliated by putting to death some eighty Spartans at Campasium on the border of Laconia. These were the matters referred to the Roman senate. AN INDEPENDENT POLICY 619 must incur the reproach of ingratitude for opposing our pay- masters. He therefore urged the Achaeans not only to decline the offer, but to hold Eumenes in detestation for thinking of making it.^ Next rose Cassander of ^gina and reminded the Achaeans of the misfortunes which the .iEginetans had met with through being members of the Achaean league, when Publius Sulpicius sailed against them with the Roman fleet, and sold all the unhappy ^gine- tans into slavery. In regard to this subject I have already related how the .iEtolians, having got possession of M^na, in virtue of their treaty with Rome, sold it to Attains for thirty talents. Cassander therefore drew the attention of the Achaeans to these facts; and demanded that Eumenes should not seek to gain the affection of the Achaeans by offering them money, but that he should establish an incontestable claim to every sign of devotion by giving back ^gina. He urged the Achaeans not to accept presents which would place them in the position of being the destroyers of the hopes of ^ginetan restoration for all time. After these speeches had been delivered, the people showed such signs of enthusiastic approval thatt no one ventured to speak on the side of the king ; but the whole assembly rejected the offer by acclamation, though its amount certainly made it exceedingly tempting. 12. The next subject introduced for debate was that of King Ptolemy. The ambassadors who had been on the mission to Ptolemy were called forward, and Lycortas, acting as spokesman, began by stating how they had interchanged oaths of alliance with the king; and next announced that they brought a present from the king to the Achaean league of six thousand stands of arms for peltasts, and two thousand talents in bronze coinage. He added a panegyric on the king, and finished his speech by a brief reference to the good will and active benevolence of the king towards the Achteans. Upon this the general of the Achsans, Aristaenus, stood up and asked Lycortas and his colleagues in the embassy to Ptolemy, "which alliance it was that he had thus renewed?" As no one answered the question, but aU the assenibly began ' From this speech, and from other soiirces, we learn that Greek statesmen still maintained an independent spirit. 620 FEDERAL UNIONS to converse with one another, the hall was filled with confusion.. The cause of this absurd state of things was as foUows. There had been several treaties of alUance formed between the Achaeans and Ptolemy's kingdom, as widely different in their provisions as in the circmnstances which gave rise to them ; but neither had Ptol- emy's envoy made any distinction when arranging for the renewal, merely speaking in general terms on the matter, nor had the am- bassadors sent from Achaea ; but they had interchanged oaths on the assumption that there was but one treaty. The result was that when the general, quoting all the treaties, pointed out the differences in detail between them which chanced to be important, the assembly demanded to know which it was that it was renewing. And when no one was able to explain, not even Philopcemen him- self, who had been in office when the renewal was made, nor Lycortas and his colleagues, who had been on the mission to Alexandria, these men all began to be regarded as careless in conducting the business of the league ; while Aristaenus acquired great reputation as being the only man who knew what he was talking about; and finally, the assembly refused to allow the ratification, voting on account of this blunder that the business should be postponed. Then the ambassadors from Seleucus entered with their pro- posal. The Achaeans, however, voted to renew the friendship with Seleucus, but to decline for the present the gift of the ships.^ • 202. Deceee of the Ach^an League Regarding Orchomenus (about 234 b.c.) (Inscr. grcec. V. pt. ii. no. 344, superseding Dittenberger, Sylloge, I. no. 229, and Michel, Recueil, no. 199. Translated by C. J. O.) This inscription, one of the very few relating to the Achaean League, was discovered near the site of the ancient Orchomenus in Arcadia. The upper portion was broken away, but the remainder is evidently the conclusion of a decree of the Achaean League regarding the afiairs of Orchomenus, which had' just become one of its members. The date is most probably 234 B.C. or shortly thereafter, since a number of Arcadian towns are known to have joined the Achseans at that time ; but it might possibly be brought down to 199 B.C. • Throughout the proceedings the members of the assembly show a dignity and a soundness of principle that go far toward refuting the charge of degeneracy made against the Hellenes of this age. DECREE CONCERNING ORCHOMENUS 621 {The first five lines are fragmentary.) The same [oath shall be taken] by the Orchomenians and by the Achseans, in [^gium^ by the councillors of the Achaeans and the] general and the hipparch and the admiral,^ in [Orchomenus by the archons of the Orchomenians, in these terms :] "I swear by Zeus Amarius, Athena Amaria, Aphrodite, and by all the gods, that I will in all things abide by (the terms of) the stele and the agree- ment * and the decree passed by the commonwealth of the Achae- ans ; and if anyone shall not abide thereby, I will resist to the best of my abiUty. And may prosperity be nune if I keep my oath, but the reverse if I break it." None of those who have received a lot or a house in Orchomenus since the people became Achaeans shall have power to alienate thera within twenty years.* If any charges have been brought against Nearchus ^ or his sons dating from the time before the Orchomenians became Achae- ans, they shall all be quashed, and no one shall sue Nearchus or his sons, nor shall Nearchus or any of his sons sue anyone, upon charges arising before the Orchomenians became Achaeans. Who- ever might sue shall be fined 1000 drachmas, and the suit shall be void. Regarding the golden (statue of) Victory of Zeus Hoplosmius, after pawning which the Methydrians who removed to Orchomenus divided the money, some of them carrjdng it ofiE to Methydrium, — if they do not repay the money to the Megalopolitans,* as the city of Orchomenus has conceded, those who do not give satis- faction shall be liable to prosecution. • A town on the Corinthian Gulf and the capital of the League. 2 The three chief officials of the League, the last of whom is mentioned in this inscription only. ' I.e., the formal act of union by which Orchomenus was admitted into the League. * This provision was intended to assure the permanence of Achaean influence in Orchomenus by forbidding the newly introduced Achaean colonists to sell their prop- erties; cf. Dittenberger in Hermes, XVI (1881). 181-183. ' Probably a tyrant of Orchomenus who had voluntarily abdicated when the city joined the Achaeans. » Methydrium was a dependency of Megalopolis, which consequently claimed the proceeds of the pawned statue. 62 2 FEDERAL UNIONS 203. Arbitration of the ^tolians between Melitea AND PeREA (225-200 B.C.) {Inscr. grcec. IX. pt. ii. no. 205 ; Dittenberger, Sylloge, II. no. 425 ; Michel, RecueU, no. 22. Translated by C. J. O.) This inscription, discovered at Avaritza in Southern Thessaly, on the site of the ancient Melitea, records a decision of arbitrators appointed by the .lEto- lian League in a dispute between the city-state of Melitea and the neighboring settlement of Perea. The two were, at the time, politically united into one community, but the Pereans evidently were dissatisfied and desired the right of seceding if they should choose to do so. This the decision granted to them, and it also provided for the subsequent relations between the two communities, besides defining the boundary line, in the event of a separation. The inscrip- tion not only shows the preponderant influence of the jEtolian League in dis- putes between its member states, but also gives an interesting hint regarding the basis of representation in the federal council (c/. n. 3). The date is the last quarter of the third century B.C., when the power of the League extended into Southern Thessaly. Decision rendered to the MeKteans and the Pereans by the judges chosen by the ^EtoUans, (namely) Dorimachus, Polemaeus, and Argeius, Calydonians, the parties having submitted (their case) by agreement.^ The boundary Une for the MeUteans and the Pereans shall be . . .2 The public domain, namely Carandse and PhyUadon, shall not be sold by the MeUteans for the purchaser to hold in fee simple, while the Pereans are fellow-citizens of the MeUteans; but they shall lease it for a term, as hitherto. If the Pereans shall renounce the citizenship of the MeUteans, they shall employ the boundary above described, as regards their territory; and they shall keep a single senator when they secede. They shall pay their share of the loans that the city may owe, according to the ratio borne by their one senator,* and they shall '■ Or, perhaps, "according to the agreements" (by which they had become members of the League). * The description of the boundary consists mainly of a series of obscure geographical names, and has therefore been omitted in the translation. ' Hence it appears that the smaller communities, such as Perea, had only one sena- tor, or delegate, to the federal council of the League, whereas the larger, like Melitea, had several, probably according to their population. A CASE OF ARBITRATION 623 « contribute the dues accruing to the ^tolians ' in the proportion of their senator. The Pereans shall pay to their creditors the accrued tithes,* which they owe for three years after obtaining a three years' extension. The sums that the Pereans were hitherto accustomed to receive from the city yearly, namely three minae of silver for the archons, ten staters for the herald, ten staters for the oil for the youths, and five staters for the sacrifice of the Soteria, they shall still receive ; and in future the city of MeUtea shall look after the public funds in Perea as hitherto. The Pereans shall have the same laws as the Meliteans, and the suits brought before the agoranomi * by Pereans against Pereans shall be judged every four months in Perea by the agoranomi from Melitea. This decision shall be inscribed on stelae in Melitea and in Delphi and in Calydon and in Thermum.* Witnesses: the entire coimcil in the term of the secretary Lycus; the presidents of the council, Ortholaiis of Spattus and Dysopus of Apollonia; the secretary Lycus of Erythrse; the hipparch ^ Alexon of Hermattus ; (also) Pantaleon, son of Petalus, of Pleuron, Nicostratus, son of Nicostratus, of Naupactus, Damo- xenus, son of Theodorus, of Heraclea. 204. Decree of the ^tolian League Recognizeng the Inviolability of Teos (about 200 b.c.) (Dittenberger, Sylloge, I. no. 280; Michel, Recueil, no. 68. Translated by C. J. O.) Among the ruins of the city of Teos in Asia Minor there have been found a number of inscriptions containing decrees passed by various cities and states ' I.e., federal taxes imposed by the League. ' Meaning, probably, interest at ten per cent. 'I.e., minor commercial cases coming under the jurisdiction of the "controllers of the market-place." * In Melitea, as the city chiefly concerned; m Delphi, as the reUgious center of the League; in Calydon, as the home of the judges (?); m Thermum, as the poUtical capital of the League. A fragment of the Delphian copy has been found; cf. Inscr. grtzc. rx. pt. ii, Addenda Ultima, no. 205 iii B. * The cavalry commander, the highest oflScial of the League after the slrategus or general. 624 FEDERAL UNIONS in answer to the Teians' request that the mviolability of their city and of the surrounding territory might be recognized. According to Greek law, a citizen of one state who had a grievance against a member of another could as a last resort exercise the right of self-help by seizing the person or the property of his * adversary, or even of any citizen of the other state, wherever he might find him ; but this right came to be greatly abridged through the grant of asylia, i.e., inviolability or freedom from seizure, to individuals or to an entire cormnunity. {Cf. Pauly-Wissowa, Red-Encyklopddie, II. 1879-1881, s. v. a